Thanks to visit codestin.com
Credit goes to www.scribd.com

0% found this document useful (0 votes)
12 views616 pages

The Z Shell Manual

The document is the Z Shell Manual, which provides comprehensive information about the Zsh shell, including its features, usage, and documentation generation from the texinfo file zsh.texi. It covers various aspects such as interactive use, command completion, options, and programming within the shell. Additionally, it includes details about the authors, availability, mailing lists, and related resources for users seeking further information.

Uploaded by

tote-tangled0t
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
12 views616 pages

The Z Shell Manual

The document is the Z Shell Manual, which provides comprehensive information about the Zsh shell, including its features, usage, and documentation generation from the texinfo file zsh.texi. It covers various aspects such as interactive use, command completion, options, and programming within the shell. Additionally, it includes details about the authors, availability, mailing lists, and related resources for users seeking further information.

Uploaded by

tote-tangled0t
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 616

Table of Contents generated with DocToc

1 The Z Shell Manual


1.1 Producing documentation from zsh.texi

1 The Z Shell Manual


This document has been produced from the texinfo file zsh.texi, included in the Doc sub-directory of
the Zsh distribution.

1.1 Producing documentation from zsh.texi


The texinfo source may be converted into several formats:

The Info manual


The Info format allows searching for topics, commands, functions, etc. from the many Indices. The
command ‘makeinfo zsh.texi’ is used to produce the Info documentation.

The printed manual


The command ‘texi2dvi zsh.texi’ will output zsh.dvi which can then be processed with dvips and
optionally gs (Ghostscript) to produce a nicely formatted printed manual.

The HTML manual


An HTML version of this manual is available at the Zsh web site via:

https://zsh.sourceforge.io/Doc/.

(The HTML version is produced with texi2html, which may be obtained from
http://www.nongnu.org/texi2html/. The command is ‘texi2html –output . –ifinfo –split=chapter –
node-files zsh.texi’. If necessary, upgrade to version 1.78 of texi2html.)

For those who do not have the necessary tools to process texinfo, precompiled documentation
(PostScript, dvi, PDF, info and HTML formats) is available from the zsh archive site or its mirrors, in
the file zsh-doc.tar.gz. (See Availability for a list of sites.)

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 1 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

2 Introduction
2.1 Author
2.2 Availability
2.3 Mailing Lists
2.4 The Zsh FAQ
2.5 The Zsh Web Page
2.6 The Zsh Userguide
2.7 See Also

2 Introduction
Zsh is a UNIX command interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive login shell and as a shell script
command processor. Of the standard shells, zsh most closely resembles ksh but includes many
enhancements. It does not provide compatibility with POSIX or other shells in its default operating
mode: see the section Compatibility.

Zsh has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable command completion,
shell functions (with autoloading), a history mechanism, and a host of other features.

2.1 Author
Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad. Zsh is now maintained by the members of the zsh-
workers mailing list <[email protected]>. The development is currently coordinated by Peter
Stephenson <[email protected]>. The coordinator can be contacted at <[email protected]>, but
matters relating to the code should generally go to the mailing list.

2.2 Availability
Zsh is available from the following HTTP and anonymous FTP site.

ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
https://www.zsh.org/pub/

The up-to-date source code is available via Git from Sourceforge. See
https://sourceforge.net/projects/zsh/ for details. A summary of instructions for the archive can be
found at https://zsh.sourceforge.io/.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 2 of 616
:
2.3 Mailing Lists
Zsh has several mailing lists:

<[email protected]>
Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ.
(moderated)

<[email protected]>
User discussions.

<[email protected]>
Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.

<[email protected]>
Private mailing list (the general public cannot subscribe to it) for discussing bug reports with security
implications, i.e., potential vulnerabilities.

If you find a security problem in zsh itself, please mail this address.

To subscribe or unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative address for the mailing list.

<[email protected]>

<[email protected]>

<[email protected]>

<[email protected]>

<[email protected]>

<[email protected]>

YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED. All submissions to zsh-
announce are automatically forwarded to zsh-users. All submissions to zsh-users are automatically
forwarded to zsh-workers.

If you have problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing lists, send mail to
<[email protected]>.

The mailing lists are archived; the archives can be accessed via the administrative addresses listed
above. There is also a hypertext archive available at https://www.zsh.org/mla/.

2.4 The Zsh FAQ

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 3 of 616
:
Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by Peter Stephenson
<[email protected]>. It is regularly posted to the newsgroup comp.unix.shell and the zsh-announce
mailing list. The latest version can be found at any of the Zsh FTP sites, or at
https://www.zsh.org/FAQ/. The contact address for FAQ-related matters is <[email protected]>.

2.5 The Zsh Web Page


Zsh has a web page which is located at https://www.zsh.org/. The contact address for web-related
matters is <[email protected]>.

2.6 The Zsh Userguide


A userguide is currently in preparation. It is intended to complement the manual, with explanations
and hints on issues where the manual can be cabbalistic, hierographic, or downright mystifying (for
example, the word ‘hierographic’ does not exist). It can be viewed in its current state at
https://zsh.sourceforge.io/Guide/. At the time of writing, chapters dealing with startup files and their
contents and the new completion system were essentially complete.

2.7 See Also


sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)

IEEE Standard for information Technology - Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN 1-55937-
255-9.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 4 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

3 Roadmap
3.1 When the shell starts
3.2 Interactive Use
3.2.1 Completion
3.2.2 Extending the line editor
3.3 Options
3.4 Pattern Matching
3.5 General Comments on Syntax
3.6 Programming

3 Roadmap
The Zsh Manual, like the shell itself, is large and often complicated. This section of the manual
provides some pointers to areas of the shell that are likely to be of particular interest to new users,
and indicates where in the rest of the manual the documentation is to be found.

3.1 When the shell starts


When it starts, the shell reads commands from various files. These can be created or edited to
customize the shell. See Files.

If no personal initialization files exist for the current user, a function is run to help you change some
of the most common settings. It won’t appear if your administrator has disabled the zsh/newuser
module. The function is designed to be self-explanatory. You can run it by hand with ‘autoload -Uz
zsh-newuser-install; zsh-newuser-install -f’. See also User Configuration Functions.

3.2 Interactive Use


Interaction with the shell uses the builtin Zsh Line Editor, ZLE. This is described in detail in Zsh Line
Editor.

The first decision a user must make is whether to use the Emacs or Vi editing mode as the keys for
editing are substantially different. Emacs editing mode is probably more natural for beginners and
can be selected explicitly with the command bindkey -e.

A history mechanism for retrieving previously typed lines (most simply with the Up or Down arrow
keys) is available; note that, unlike other shells, zsh will not save these lines when the shell exits

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 5 of 616
:
unless you set appropriate variables, and the number of history lines retained by default is quite
small (30 lines). See the description of the shell variables (referred to in the documentation as
parameters) HISTFILE, HISTSIZE and SAVEHIST in Parameters Used By The Shell. Note that it’s
currently only possible to read and write files saving history when the shell is interactive, i.e. it does
not work from scripts.

The shell now supports the UTF-8 character set (and also others if supported by the operating
system). This is (mostly) handled transparently by the shell, but the degree of support in terminal
emulators is variable. There is some discussion of this in the shell FAQ, https://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.
Note in particular that for combining characters to be handled the option COMBINING_CHARS needs
to be set. Because the shell is now more sensitive to the definition of the character set, note that if
you are upgrading from an older version of the shell you should ensure that the appropriate
variable, either LANG (to affect all aspects of the shell’s operation) or LC_CTYPE (to affect only the
handling of character sets) is set to an appropriate value. This is true even if you are using a single-
byte character set including extensions of ASCII such as ISO-8859-1 or ISO-8859-15. See the
description of LC_CTYPE in Parameters.

3.2.1 Completion

Completion is a feature present in many shells. It allows the user to type only a part (usually the
prefix) of a word and have the shell fill in the rest. The completion system in zsh is programmable.
For example, the shell can be set to complete email addresses in arguments to the mail command
from your ~/.abook/addressbook; usernames, hostnames, and even remote paths in arguments to
scp, and so on. Anything that can be written in or glued together with zsh can be the source of what
the line editor offers as possible completions.

Zsh has two completion systems, an old, so called compctl completion (named after the builtin
command that serves as its complete and only user interface), and a new one, referred to as
compsys, organized as library of builtin and user-defined functions. The two systems differ in their
interface for specifying the completion behavior. The new system is more customizable and is
supplied with completions for many commonly used commands; it is therefore to be preferred.

The completion system must be enabled explicitly when the shell starts. For more information see
Completion System.

3.2.2 Extending the line editor

Apart from completion, the line editor is highly extensible by means of shell functions. Some useful
functions are provided with the shell; they provide facilities such as:

insert-composed-char
composing characters not found on the keyboard
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 6 of 616
:
match-words-by-style
configuring what the line editor considers a word when moving or deleting by word

history-beginning-search-backward-end, etc.
alternative ways of searching the shell history

replace-string, replace-pattern
functions for replacing strings or patterns globally in the command line

edit-command-line
edit the command line with an external editor.

See ZLE Functions for descriptions of these.

3.3 Options
The shell has a large number of options for changing its behaviour. These cover all aspects of the
shell; browsing the full documentation is the only good way to become acquainted with the many
possibilities. See Options.

3.4 Pattern Matching


The shell has a rich set of patterns which are available for file matching (described in the
documentation as ‘filename generation’ and also known for historical reasons as ‘globbing’) and for
use when programming. These are described in Filename Generation.

Of particular interest are the following patterns that are not commonly supported by other systems
of pattern matching:

**
for matching over multiple directories

|
for matching either of two alternatives

~, ^
the ability to exclude patterns from matching when the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set

( ... )
glob qualifiers, included in parentheses at the end of the pattern, which select files by type (such as
directories) or attribute (such as size).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 7 of 616
:
3.5 General Comments on Syntax
Although the syntax of zsh is in ways similar to the Korn shell, and therefore more remotely to the
original UNIX shell, the Bourne shell, its default behaviour does not entirely correspond to those
shells. General shell syntax is introduced in Shell Grammar.

One commonly encountered difference is that variables substituted onto the command line are not
split into words. See the description of the shell option SH_WORD_SPLIT in Parameter Expansion. In
zsh, you can either explicitly request the splitting (e.g. ${=foo}) or use an array when you want a
variable to expand to more than one word. See Array Parameters.

3.6 Programming
The most convenient way of adding enhancements to the shell is typically by writing a shell function
and arranging for it to be autoloaded. Functions are described in Functions. Users changing from
the C shell and its relatives should notice that aliases are less used in zsh as they don’t perform
argument substitution, only simple text replacement.

A few general functions, other than those for the line editor described above, are provided with the
shell and are described in User Contributions. Features include:

promptinit
a prompt theme system for changing prompts easily, see Prompt Themes

zsh-mime-setup
a MIME-handling system which dispatches commands according to the suffix of a file as done by
graphical file managers

zcalc
a calculator

zargs
a version of xargs that makes the find command redundant

zmv
a command for renaming files by means of shell patterns.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 8 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

4 Invocation
4.1 Invocation
4.2 Compatibility
4.3 Restricted Shell

4 Invocation

4.1 Invocation
The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to determine where the shell will read
commands from:

-c
Take the first argument as a command to execute, rather than reading commands from a script or
standard input. If any further arguments are given, the first one is assigned to $0, rather than being
used as a positional parameter.

-i
Force shell to be interactive. It is still possible to specify a script to execute.

-s
Force shell to read commands from the standard input. If the -s flag is not present and an argument
is given, the first argument is taken to be the pathname of a script to execute.

If there are any remaining arguments after option processing, and neither of the options -c or -s was
supplied, the first argument is taken as the file name of a script containing shell commands to be
executed. If the option PATH_SCRIPT is set, and the file name does not contain a directory path (i.e.
there is no ‘/’ in the name), first the current directory and then the command path given by the
variable PATH are searched for the script. If the option is not set or the file name contains a ‘/’ it is
used directly.

After the first one or two arguments have been appropriated as described above, the remaining
arguments are assigned to the positional parameters.

For further options, which are common to invocation and the set builtin, see Options.

The long option ‘--emulate’ followed (in a separate word) by an emulation mode may be passed to
the shell. The emulation modes are those described for the emulate builtin, see Shell Builtin
Commands. The ‘--emulate’ option must precede any other options (which might otherwise be
overridden), but following options are honoured, so may be used to modify the requested emulation
mode. Note that certain extra steps are taken to ensure a smooth emulation when this option is
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 9 of 616
:
used compared with the emulate command within the shell: for example, variables that conflict with
POSIX usage such as path are not defined within the shell.

Options may be specified by name using the -o option. -o acts like a single-letter option, but takes a
following string as the option name. For example,

zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr

runs the script scr, setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding letter ‘-x’ and the
SH_WORD_SPLIT option by name. Options may be turned off by name by using +o instead of -o. -o
can be stacked up with preceding single-letter options, so for example ‘-xo shwordsplit’ or ‘-
xoshwordsplit’ is equivalent to ‘-x -o shwordsplit’.

Options may also be specified by name in GNU long option style, ‘-- option-name ’. When this is done,
‘-’ characters in the option name are permitted: they are translated into ‘_’, and thus ignored. So, for
example, ‘zsh --sh-word-split’ invokes zsh with the SH_WORD_SPLIT option turned on. Like other
option syntaxes, options can be turned off by replacing the initial ‘-’ with a ‘+’; thus ‘+-sh-word-split’ is
equivalent to ‘--no-sh-word-split’. Unlike other option syntaxes, GNU-style long options cannot be
stacked with any other options, so for example ‘-x-shwordsplit’ is an error, rather than being treated
like ‘-x --shwordsplit’.

The special GNU-style option ‘--version’ is handled; it sends to standard output the shell’s version
information, then exits successfully. ‘--help’ is also handled; it sends to standard output a list of
options that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits successfully.

Option processing may be finished, allowing following arguments that start with ‘-’ or ‘+’ to be
treated as normal arguments, in two ways. Firstly, a lone ‘-’ (or ‘+’) as an argument by itself ends
option processing. Secondly, a special option ‘--’ (or ‘+-’), which may be specified on its own (which is
the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked with preceding options (so ‘-x-’ is equivalent to ‘-x --’).
Options are not permitted to be stacked after ‘--’ (so ‘-x-f’ is an error), but note the GNU-style option
form discussed above, where ‘--shwordsplit’ is permitted and does not end option processing.

Except when the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect, the option ‘-b’ (or ‘+b’) ends
option processing. ‘-b’ is like ‘--’, except that further single-letter options can be stacked after the ‘-b’
and will take effect as normal.

4.2 Compatibility
Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or ksh respectively; more precisely, it looks at
the first letter of the name by which it was invoked, excluding any initial ‘r’ (assumed to stand for
‘restricted’), and if that is ‘b’, ‘s’ or ‘k’ it will emulate sh or ksh. Furthermore, if invoked as su (which
happens on certain systems when the shell is executed by the su command), the shell will try to find
an alternative name from the SHELL environment variable and perform emulation based on that.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 10 of 616
:
In sh and ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not special and not initialized by the
shell: ARGC, argv, cdpath, fignore, fpath, HISTCHARS, mailpath, MANPATH, manpath, path, prompt,
PROMPT, PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status.

The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed. Login shells source /etc/profile followed
by $HOME/.profile. If the ENV environment variable is set on invocation, $ENV is sourced after the
profile scripts. The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion, command substitution, and
arithmetic expansion before being interpreted as a pathname. Note that the PRIVILEGED option also
affects the execution of startup files.

The following options are set if the shell is invoked as sh or ksh: NO_BAD_PATTERN, NO_BANG_HIST,
NO_BG_NICE, NO_EQUALS, NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO, GLOB_SUBST, NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT, NO_HUP,
INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS, KSH_ARRAYS, NO_MULTIOS, NO_NOMATCH, NO_NOTIFY,
POSIX_BUILTINS, NO_PROMPT_PERCENT, RM_STAR_SILENT, SH_FILE_EXPANSION, SH_GLOB,
SH_OPTION_LETTERS, SH_WORD_SPLIT. Additionally the BSD_ECHO and IGNORE_BRACES options
are set if zsh is invoked as sh. Also, the KSH_OPTION_PRINT, LOCAL_OPTIONS, PROMPT_BANG,
PROMPT_SUBST and SINGLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.

Please note that, whilst reasonable efforts are taken to address incompatibilities when they arise,
zsh does not guarantee complete emulation of other shells, nor POSIX compliance. For more
information on the differences between zsh and other shells, please refer to chapter 2 of the shell
FAQ, https://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.

4.3 Restricted Shell


When the basename of the command used to invoke zsh starts with the letter ‘r’ or the ‘-r’ command
line option is supplied at invocation, the shell becomes restricted. Emulation mode is determined
after stripping the letter ‘r’ from the invocation name. The following are disabled in restricted mode:

changing directories with the cd builtin


changing or unsetting the EGID, EUID, GID, HISTFILE, HISTSIZE, IFS, LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,
LD_AOUT_PRELOAD, LD_LIBRARY_PATH, LD_PRELOAD, MODULE_PATH, module_path, PATH,
path, SHELL, UID and USERNAME parameters
specifying command names containing /
specifying command pathnames using hash
redirecting output to files
using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another command
using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process’ argument and environment space
using the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external commands
turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED

These restrictions are enforced after processing the startup files. The startup files should set up
PATH to point to a directory of commands which can be safely invoked in the restricted
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 11 of 616
:
environment. They may also add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.

Restricted mode can also be activated any time by setting the RESTRICTED option. This immediately
enables all the restrictions described above even if the shell still has not processed all startup files.

A shell Restricted Mode is an outdated way to restrict what users may do: modern systems have
better, safer and more reliable ways to confine user actions, such as chroot jails, containers and
zones.

A restricted shell is very difficult to implement safely. The feature may be removed in a future
version of zsh.

It is important to realise that the restrictions only apply to the shell, not to the commands it runs
(except for some shell builtins). While a restricted shell can only run the restricted list of commands
accessible via the predefined ‘PATH’ variable, it does not prevent those commands from running any
other command.

As an example, if ‘env’ is among the list of allowed commands, then it allows the user to run any
command as ‘env’ is not a shell

So when implementing a restricted shell framework it is important to be fully aware of what actions
each of the allowed commands or features (which may be regarded as modules) can perform.

Many commands can have their behaviour affected by environment variables. Except for the few
listed above, zsh does not restrict the setting of environment variables.

If a ‘perl’, ‘python’, ‘bash’, or other general purpose interpreted script it treated as a restricted
command, the user can work around the restriction by setting specially crafted ‘PERL5LIB’,
‘PYTHONPATH’, ‘BASHENV’ (etc.) environment variables. On GNU systems, any command can be
made to run arbitrary code when performing character set conversion (including zsh itself) by
setting a ‘GCONV_PATH’ environment variable. Those are only a few examples.

Bear in mind that, contrary to some other shells, ‘readonly’ is not a security feature in zsh as it can
be undone and so cannot be used to mitigate the above.

A restricted shell only works if the allowed commands are few and carefully written so as not to
grant more access to users than intended. It is also important to restrict what zsh module the user
may load as some of them, such as ‘zsh/system’, ‘zsh/mapfile’ and ‘zsh/files’, allow bypassing most of
the restrictions.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 12 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

5 Files
5.1 Startup/Shutdown Files
5.2 Files

5 Files

5.1 Startup/Shutdown Files


Commands are first read from /etc/zshenv; this cannot be overridden. Subsequent behaviour is
modified by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options; the former affects all startup files, while the second
only affects global startup files (those shown here with an path starting with a /). If one of the
options is unset at any point, any subsequent startup file(s) of the corresponding type will not be
read. It is also possible for a file in $ZDOTDIR to re-enable GLOBAL_RCS. Both RCS and GLOBAL_RCS
are set by default.

Commands are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv. If the shell is a login shell, commands are read
from /etc/zprofile and then $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile. Then, if the shell is interactive, commands are read
from /etc/zshrc and then $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc. Finally, if the shell is a login shell, /etc/zlogin and
$ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.

When a login shell exits, the files $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout and then /etc/zlogout are read. This happens
with either an explicit exit via the exit or logout commands, or an implicit exit by reading end-of-file
from the terminal. However, if the shell terminates due to exec’ing another process, the logout files
are not read. These are also affected by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options. Note also that the RCS
option affects the saving of history files, i.e. if RCS is unset when the shell exits, no history file will be
saved.

If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead. Files listed above as being in /etc may be in another
directory, depending on the installation.

As /etc/zshenv is run for all instances of zsh, it is important that it be kept as small as possible. In
particular, it is a good idea to put code that does not need to be run for every single shell behind a
test of the form ‘if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...’ so that it will not be executed when zsh is invoked with the ‘-f’
option.

5.2 Files

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 13 of 616
:
$ZDOTDIR/.zshenv

$ZDOTDIR/.zprofile

$ZDOTDIR/.zshrc

$ZDOTDIR/.zlogin

$ZDOTDIR/.zlogout

${TMPPREFIX}* (default is /tmp/zsh*)

/etc/zshenv

/etc/zprofile

/etc/zshrc

/etc/zlogin

/etc/zlogout (installation-specific - /etc is the default)

Any of these files may be pre-compiled with the zcompile builtin command (Shell Builtin
Commands). If a compiled file exists (named for the original file plus the .zwc extension) and it is
newer than the original file, the compiled file will be used instead.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 14 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

6 Shell Grammar
6.1 Simple Commands & Pipelines
6.2 Precommand Modifiers
6.3 Complex Commands
6.4 Alternate Forms For Complex Commands
6.5 Reserved Words
6.6 Errors
6.7 Comments
6.8 Aliasing
6.8.1 Alias difficulties
6.9 Quoting

6 Shell Grammar

6.1 Simple Commands & Pipelines


A simple command is a sequence of optional parameter assignments followed by blank-separated
words, with optional redirections interspersed. For a description of assignment, see the beginning of
Parameters.

The first word is the command to be executed, and the remaining words, if any, are arguments to
the command. If a command name is given, the parameter assignments modify the environment of
the command when it is executed. The value of a simple command is its exit status, or 128 plus the
signal number if terminated by a signal. For example,

echo foo

is a simple command with arguments.

A pipeline is either a simple command, or a sequence of two or more simple commands where each
command is separated from the next by ‘|’ or ‘|&’. Where commands are separated by ‘|’, the
standard output of the first command is connected to the standard input of the next. ‘|&’ is
shorthand for ‘2>&1 |’, which connects both the standard output and the standard error of the
command to the standard input of the next. The value of a pipeline is the value of the last
command, unless the pipeline is preceded by ‘!’ in which case the value is the logical inverse of the
value of the last command. For example,

echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 15 of 616
:
is a pipeline, where the output (‘foo’ plus a newline) of the first command will be passed to the input
of the second.

If a pipeline is preceded by ‘coproc’, it is executed as a coprocess; a two-way pipe is established


between it and the parent shell. The shell can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the
‘>&p’ and ‘<&p’ redirection operators or with ‘print -p’ and ‘read -p’. A pipeline cannot be preceded by
both ‘coproc’ and ‘!’. If job control is active, the coprocess can be treated in other than input and
output as an ordinary background job.

A sublist is either a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more pipelines separated by ‘&&’ or ‘||’. If
two pipelines are separated by ‘&&’, the second pipeline is executed only if the first succeeds
(returns a zero status). If two pipelines are separated by ‘||’, the second is executed only if the first
fails (returns a nonzero status). Both operators have equal precedence and are left associative. The
value of the sublist is the value of the last pipeline executed. For example,

dmesg | grep panic && print yes

is a sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple command which will be executed if
and only if the grep command returns a zero status. If it does not, the value of the sublist is that
return status, else it is the status returned by the print (almost certainly zero).

A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is terminated by ‘;’, ‘&’, ‘&|’, ‘&!’, or a
newline. This terminator may optionally be omitted from the last sublist in the list when the list
appears as a complex command inside ‘(...)’ or ‘{...}’. When a sublist is terminated by ‘;’ or newline, the
shell waits for it to finish before executing the next sublist. If a sublist is terminated by a ‘&’, ‘&|’, or
‘&!’, the shell executes the last pipeline in it in the background, and does not wait for it to finish (note
the difference from other shells which execute the whole sublist in the background). A
backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.

More generally, a list can be seen as a set of any shell commands whatsoever, including the complex
commands below; this is implied wherever the word ‘list’ appears in later descriptions. For example,
the commands in a shell function form a special sort of list.

6.2 Precommand Modifiers


A simple command may be preceded by a precommand modifier, which will alter how the command
is interpreted. These modifiers are shell builtin commands with the exception of nocorrect which is a
reserved word.

The command is executed with a ‘-’ prepended to its argv[0] string.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 16 of 616
:
builtin

The command word is taken to be the name of a builtin command, rather than a shell function or
external command.

command [ -pvV ]

The command word is taken to be the name of an external command, rather than a shell function or
builtin. If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also be executed but certain special
properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag causes a default path to be searched instead of that
in $path. With the -v flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent to whence -v.

exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ]

The following command together with any arguments is run in place of the current process, rather
than as a sub-process. The shell does not fork and is replaced. The shell does not invoke TRAPEXIT,
nor does it source zlogout files. The options are provided for compatibility with other shells.

The -c option clears the environment.

The -l option is equivalent to the - precommand modifier, to treat the replacement command as a
login shell; the command is executed with a - prepended to its argv[0] string. This flag has no effect if
used together with the -a option.

The -a option is used to specify explicitly the argv[0] string (the name of the command as seen by the
process itself) to be used by the replacement command and is directly equivalent to setting a value
for the ARGV0 environment variable.

nocorrect

Spelling correction is not done on any of the words. This must appear before any other
precommand modifier, as it is interpreted immediately, before any parsing is done. It has no effect
in non-interactive shells.

noglob

Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on any of the words.

6.3 Complex Commands


A complex command in zsh is one of the following:

if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi

The if list is executed, and if it returns a zero exit status, the then list is executed. Otherwise,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 17 of 616
:
the elif list is executed and if its status is zero, the then list is executed. If each elif list
returns nonzero status, the else list is executed.

for name ... [ in word ... ] term do list done

Expand the list of word s, and set the parameter name to each of them in turn, executing list each
time. If the ‘in word ’ is omitted, use the positional parameters instead of the word s.

The term consists of one or more newline or ; which terminate the word s, and are optional when
the ‘in word ’ is omitted.

More than one parameter name can appear before the list of word s. If N name s are given, then on
each execution of the loop the next N word s are assigned to the corresponding parameters. If
there are more name s than remaining word s, the remaining parameters are each set to the empty
string. Execution of the loop ends when there is no remaining word to assign to the first name . It is
only possible for in to appear as the first name in the list, else it will be treated as marking the end of
the list.

for (( [ expr1 ] ; [ expr2 ] ; [ expr3 ] )) do list done

The arithmetic expression expr1 is evaluated first (see Arithmetic Evaluation). The arithmetic
expression expr2 is repeatedly evaluated until it evaluates to zero and when non-zero, list is
executed and the arithmetic expression expr3 evaluated. If any expression is omitted, then it
behaves as if it evaluated to 1.

while list do list done

Execute the do list as long as the while list returns a zero exit status.

until list do list done

Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit status.

repeat word do list done

word is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression, which must evaluate to a number n .
list is then executed n times.

The repeat syntax is disabled by default when the shell starts in a mode emulating another shell. It
can be enabled with the command ‘enable -r repeat’

case word in [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... esac

Execute the list associated with the first pattern that matches word , if any. The form of the
patterns is the same as that used for filename generation. See Filename Generation.

Note further that, unless the SH_GLOB option is set, the whole pattern with alternatives is treated by
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 18 of 616
:
the shell as equivalent to a group of patterns within parentheses, although white space may appear
about the parentheses and the vertical bar and will be stripped from the pattern at those points.
White space may appear elsewhere in the pattern; this is not stripped. If the SH_GLOB option is set,
so that an opening parenthesis can be unambiguously treated as part of the case syntax, the
expression is parsed into separate words and these are treated as strict alternatives (as in other
shells).

If the list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than ;;, the following list is also executed.
The rule for the terminator of the following list ;;, ;& or ;| is applied unless the esac is reached.

If the list that is executed is terminated with ;| the shell continues to scan the pattern s looking
for the next match, executing the corresponding list , and applying the rule for the corresponding
terminator ;;, ;& or ;|. Note that word is not re-expanded; all applicable pattern s are tested with
the same word .

select name [ in word ... term ] do list done

where term is one or more newline or ; to terminate the word s. Print the set of word s, each
preceded by a number. If the in word is omitted, use the positional parameters. The PROMPT3
prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor if the shell is interactive and that is active, or
else standard input. If this line consists of the number of one of the listed word s, then the
parameter name is set to the word corresponding to this number. If this line is empty, the selection
list is printed again. Otherwise, the value of the parameter name is set to null. The contents of the
line read from standard input is saved in the parameter REPLY. list is executed for each selection
until a break or end-of-file is encountered.

( list )

Execute list in a subshell. Traps set by the trap builtin are reset to their default values while
executing list ; an exception is that ignored signals will continue to be ignored if the option
POSIXTRAPS is set.

{ list }

Execute list .

{ try-list } always { always-list }

First execute try-list . Regardless of errors, or break or continue commands encountered within
try-list , execute always-list . Execution then continues from the result of the execution of try-
list ; in other words, any error, or break or continue command is treated in the normal way, as if
always-list were not present. The two chunks of code are referred to as the ‘try block’ and the
‘always block’.

Optional newlines or semicolons may appear after the always; note, however, that they may not

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 19 of 616
:
appear between the preceding closing brace and the always.

An ‘error’ in this context is a condition such as a syntax error which causes the shell to abort
execution of the current function, script, or list. Syntax errors encountered while the shell is parsing
the code do not cause the always-list to be executed. For example, an erroneously constructed if
block in try-list would cause the shell to abort during parsing, so that always-list would not be
executed, while an erroneous substitution such as ${*foo*} would cause a run-time error, after
which always-list would be executed.

An error condition can be tested and reset with the special integer variable TRY_BLOCK_ERROR.
Outside an always-list the value is irrelevant, but it is initialised to -1. Inside always-list , the
value is 1 if an error occurred in the try-list , else 0. If TRY_BLOCK_ERROR is set to 0 during the
always-list , the error condition caused by the try-list is reset, and shell execution continues
normally after the end of always-list . Altering the value during the try-list is not useful (unless
this forms part of an enclosing always block).

Regardless of TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, after the end of always-list the normal shell status $? is the
value returned from try-list . This will be non-zero if there was an error, even if
TRY_BLOCK_ERROR was set to zero.

The following executes the given code, ignoring any errors it causes. This is an alternative to the
usual convention of protecting code by executing it in a subshell.

{
# code which may cause an error
} always {
# This code is executed regardless of the error.
(( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
}
# The error condition has been reset.

When a try block occurs outside of any function, a return or a exit encountered in try-list does
not cause the execution of always-list . Instead, the shell exits immediately after any EXIT trap has
been executed. Otherwise, a return command encountered in try-list will cause the execution of
always-list , just like break and continue.

function [ -T ] word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }

word ... () [ term ] { list }

word ... () [ term ] command

where term is one or more newline or ;. Define a function which is referenced by any one of word .
Normally, only one word is provided; multiple word s are usually only useful for setting traps. The
body of the function is the list between the { and }. See Functions.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 20 of 616
:
The options of function have the following meanings:

-T
Enable tracing for this function, as though with functions -T. See the documentation of the -f option
to the typeset builtin, in Shell Builtin Commands.

If the option SH_GLOB is set for compatibility with other shells, then whitespace may appear
between the left and right parentheses when there is a single word ; otherwise, the parentheses will
be treated as forming a globbing pattern in that case.

In any of the forms above, a redirection may appear outside the function body, for example

func() { ... } 2>&1

The redirection is stored with the function and applied whenever the function is executed. Any
variables in the redirection are expanded at the point the function is executed, but outside the
function scope.

time [ pipeline ]

The pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported on the standard error in the form
specified by the TIMEFMT parameter. If pipeline is omitted, print statistics about the shell process
and its children.

[[ exp ]]

Evaluates the conditional expression exp and return a zero exit status if it is true. See Conditional
Expressions for a description of exp .

6.4 Alternate Forms For Complex Commands


Many of zsh’s complex commands have alternate forms. These are non-standard and are likely not
to be obvious even to seasoned shell programmers; they should not be used anywhere that
portability of shell code is a concern.

The short versions below only work if sublist is of the form ‘{ list }’ or if the SHORT_LOOPS
option is set. For the if, while and until commands, in both these cases the test part of the loop must
also be suitably delimited, such as by ‘[[ ... ]]’ or ‘(( ... ))’, else the end of the test will not be
recognized. For the for, repeat, case and select commands no such special form for the arguments is
necessary, but the other condition (the special form of sublist or use of the SHORT_LOOPS option)
still applies. The SHORT_REPEAT option is available to enable the short version only for the repeat
command.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 21 of 616
:
if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
An alternate form of if. The rules mean that

if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
print yes
}

works, but

if true { # Does not work!


print yes
}

does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.

if list sublist
A short form of the alternate if. The same limitations on the form of list apply as for the previous
form.

for name ... ( word ... ) sublist


A short form of for.

for name ... [ in word ... ] term sublist


where term is at least one newline or ;. Another short form of for.

for (( [ expr1 ] ; [ expr2 ] ; [ expr3 ] )) sublist


A short form of the arithmetic for command.

foreach name ... ( word ... ) list end


Another form of for.

while list { list }


An alternative form of while. Note the limitations on the form of list mentioned above.

until list { list }


An alternative form of until. Note the limitations on the form of list mentioned above.

repeat word sublist


This is a short form of repeat.

case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... }


An alternative form of case.

select name [ in word ... term ] sublist


where term is at least one newline or ;. A short form of select.

function word ... [ () ] [ term ] sublist


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 22 of 616
:
This is a short form of function.

6.5 Reserved Words


The following words are recognized as reserved words when used as the first word of a command
unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:

do done esac then elif else fi for case if while function repeat time until select coproc nocorrect
foreach end ! [[ { } declare export float integer local readonly typeset

Additionally, ‘}’ is recognized in any position if neither the IGNORE_BRACES option nor the
IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option is set.

6.6 Errors
Certain errors are treated as fatal by the shell: in an interactive shell, they cause control to return to
the command line, and in a non-interactive shell they cause the shell to be aborted. In older versions
of zsh, a non-interactive shell running a script would not abort completely, but would resume
execution at the next command to be read from the script, skipping the remainder of any functions
or shell constructs such as loops or conditions; this somewhat illogical behaviour can be recovered
by setting the option CONTINUE_ON_ERROR.

Fatal errors found in non-interactive shells include:

Failure to parse shell options passed when invoking the shell


Failure to change options with the set builtin
Parse errors of all sorts, including failures to parse mathematical expressions
Failures to set or modify variable behaviour with typeset, local, declare, export, integer, float
Execution of incorrectly positioned loop control structures (continue, break)
Attempts to use regular expression with no regular expression module available
Disallowed operations when the RESTRICTED options is set
Failure to create a pipe needed for a pipeline
Failure to create a multio
Failure to autoload a module needed for a declared shell feature
Errors creating command or process substitutions
Syntax errors in glob qualifiers
File generation errors where not caught by the option BAD_PATTERN
All bad patterns used for matching within case statements
File generation failures where not caused by NO_MATCH or similar options
All file generation errors where the pattern was used to create a multio
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 23 of 616
:
Memory errors where detected by the shell
Invalid subscripts to shell variables
Attempts to assign read-only variables
Logical errors with variables such as assignment to the wrong type
Use of invalid variable names
Errors in variable substitution syntax
Failure to convert characters in $’...’ expressions

If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, more errors associated with shell builtin commands are treated
as fatal, as specified by the POSIX standard.

6.7 Comments
In non-interactive shells, or in interactive shells with the INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option set, a
word beginning with the third character of the histchars parameter (‘#’ by default) causes that word
and all the following characters up to a newline to be ignored.

6.8 Aliasing
Every eligible word in the shell input is checked to see if there is an alias defined for it. If so, it is
replaced by the text of the alias if it is in command position (if it could be the first word of a simple
command), or if the alias is global. If the replacement text ends with a space, the next word in the
shell input is always eligible for purposes of alias expansion.

It is an error for the function name, word , in the sh-compatible function definition syntax ‘ word () ...’
to be a word that resulted from alias expansion, unless the ALIAS_FUNC_DEF option is set.

An alias is defined using the alias builtin; global aliases may be defined using the -g option to that
builtin.

A word is defined as:

Any plain string or glob pattern


Any quoted string, using any quoting method (note that the quotes must be part of the alias
definition for this to be eligible)
Any parameter reference or command substitution
Any series of the foregoing, concatenated without whitespace or other tokens between them
Any reserved word (case, do, else, etc.)
With global aliasing, any command separator, any redirection operator, and ‘(’ or ‘)’ when not
part of a glob pattern

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 24 of 616
:
Alias expansion is done on the shell input before any other expansion except history expansion.
Therefore, if an alias is defined for the word foo, alias expansion may be avoided by quoting part of
the word, e.g. \foo. Any form of quoting works, although there is nothing to prevent an alias being
defined for the quoted form such as \foo as well.

In particular, note that quoting must be used when using unalias to remove global aliases:

% alias -g foo=bar
% unalias foo
% unalias \foo
%

When POSIX_ALIASES is set, only plain unquoted strings are eligible for aliasing. The alias builtin
does not reject ineligible aliases, but they are not expanded.

For use with completion, which would remove an initial backslash followed by a character that isn’t
special, it may be more convenient to quote the word by starting with a single quote, i.e. ’foo;
completion will automatically add the trailing single quote.

6.8.1 Alias difficulties

Although aliases can be used in ways that bend normal shell syntax, not every string of non-white-
space characters can be used as an alias.

Any set of characters not listed as a word above is not a word, hence no attempt is made to expand
it as an alias, no matter how it is defined (i.e. via the builtin or the special parameter aliases
described in The zsh/parameter Module). However, as noted in the case of POSIX_ALIASES above,
the shell does not attempt to deduce whether the string corresponds to a word at the time the alias
is created.

For example, an expression containing an = at the start of a command line is an assignment and
cannot be expanded as an alias; a lone = is not an assignment but can only be set as an alias using
the parameter, as otherwise the = is taken part of the syntax of the builtin command.

It is not presently possible to alias the ‘((’ token that introduces arithmetic expressions, because until
a full statement has been parsed, it cannot be distinguished from two consecutive ‘(’ tokens
introducing nested subshells. Also, if a separator such as && is aliased, \&& turns into the two
tokens \& and &, each of which may have been aliased separately. Similarly for \<<, \>|, etc.

There is a commonly encountered problem with aliases illustrated by the following code:

alias echobar='echo bar'; echobar

This prints a message that the command echobar could not be found. This happens because aliases
are expanded when the code is read in; the entire line is read in one go, so that when echobar is
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 25 of 616
:
executed it is too late to expand the newly defined alias. This is often a problem in shell scripts,
functions, and code executed with ‘source’ or ‘.’. Consequently, use of functions rather than aliases is
recommended in non-interactive code.

6.9 Quoting
A character may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself) by preceding it with a ‘\’. ‘\’ followed by a
newline is ignored.

A string enclosed between ‘$’’ and ‘’’ is processed the same way as the string arguments of the print
builtin, and the resulting string is considered to be entirely quoted. A literal ‘’’ character can be
included in the string by using the ‘\’’ escape.

All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes (’’) that is not preceded by a ‘$’ are quoted. A
single quote cannot appear within single quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES is set, in which case a
pair of single quotes are turned into a single quote. For example,

print ''''

outputs nothing apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set, but one single quote if it is set.

Inside double quotes (""), parameter and command substitution occur, and ‘\’ quotes the characters
‘\’, ‘‘’, ‘"’, ‘$’, and the first character of $histchars (default ‘!’).

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 26 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

7 Redirection
7.1 Opening file descriptors using parameters
7.2 Multios
7.3 Redirections with no command

7 Redirection
If a command is followed by & and job control is not active, then the default standard input for the
command is the empty file /dev/null. Otherwise, the environment for the execution of a command
contains the file descriptors of the invoking shell as modified by input/output specifications.

The following may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or follow a complex
command. Expansion occurs before word or digit is used except as noted below. If the result of
substitution on word produces more than one filename, redirection occurs for each separate
filename in turn.

< word
Open file word for reading as standard input. It is an error to open a file in this fashion if it does not
exist.

<> word
Open file word for reading and writing as standard input. If the file does not exist then it is created.

> word
Open file word for writing as standard output. If the file does not exist then it is created. If the file
exists, and the CLOBBER option is unset, this causes an error; otherwise, it is truncated to zero
length.

>| word
>! word
Same as >, except that the file is truncated to zero length if it exists, regardless of CLOBBER.

>> word
Open file word for writing in append mode as standard output. If the file does not exist, and the
CLOBBER and APPEND_CREATE options are both unset, this causes an error; otherwise, the file is
created.

>>| word
>>! word
Same as >>, except that the file is created if it does not exist, regardless of CLOBBER and
APPEND_CREATE.

<<[-] word
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 27 of 616
:
The shell input is read up to a line that is the same as word , or to an end-of-file. No parameter
expansion, command substitution or filename generation is performed on word . The resulting
document, called a here-document, becomes the standard input.

If any character of word is quoted with single or double quotes or a ‘\’, no interpretation is placed
upon the characters of the document. Otherwise, parameter and command substitution occurs, ‘\’
followed by a newline is removed, and ‘\’ must be used to quote the characters ‘\’, ‘$’, ‘‘’ and the first
character of word .

Note that word itself does not undergo shell expansion. Backquotes in word do not have their
usual effect; instead they behave similarly to double quotes, except that the backquotes themselves
are passed through unchanged. (This information is given for completeness and it is not
recommended that backquotes be used.) Quotes in the form $’ ... ’ have their standard effect of
expanding backslashed references to special characters.

If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and from the document.

<<< word
Perform shell expansion on word and pass the result to standard input. This is known as a here-
string. Compare the use of word in here-documents above, where word does not undergo shell
expansion. The result will have a trailing newline after it.

<& number
>& number
The standard input/output is duplicated from file descriptor number (see dup2(2)).

<& -
>& -
Close the standard input/output.

<& p
>& p
The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the standard input/output.

>& word
&> word
(Except where ‘>& word ’ matches one of the above syntaxes; ‘&>’ can always be used to avoid this
ambiguity.) Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner of ‘>
word ’. Note that this does not have the same effect as ‘> word 2>&1’ in the presence of multios (see
the section below).

>&| word
>&! word
&>| word
&>! word

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 28 of 616
:
Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner of ‘>| word ’.

>>& word
&>> word
Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner of ‘>> word ’.

>>&| word
>>&! word
&>>| word
&>>! word
Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner of ‘>>| word ’.

If one of the above is preceded by a digit, then the file descriptor referred to is that specified by the
digit instead of the default 0 or

1. The order in which redirections are specified is significant. The shell evaluates each redirection
in terms of the (file descriptor, file) association at the time of evaluation. For example:

... 1> fname 2>&1

first associates file descriptor 1 with file fname . It then associates file descriptor 2 with the file
associated with file descriptor 1 (that is, fname ). If the order of redirections were reversed, file
descriptor 2 would be associated with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1 had been) and then
file descriptor 1 would be associated with file fname .

The ‘|&’ command separator described in Simple Commands & Pipelines is a shorthand for ‘2>&1 |’.

The various forms of process substitution, ‘<( list )’, and ‘=( list )’ for input and ‘>( list )’ for output,
are often used together with redirection. For example, if word in an output redirection is of the form
‘>( list )’ then the output is piped to the command represented by list . See Process Substitution.

7.1 Opening file descriptors using parameters


When the shell is parsing arguments to a command, and the shell option IGNORE_BRACES is not set,
a different form of redirection is allowed: instead of a digit before the operator there is a valid shell
identifier enclosed in braces. The shell will open a new file descriptor that is guaranteed to be at
least 10 and set the parameter named by the identifier to the file descriptor opened. No whitespace
is allowed between the closing brace and the redirection character. For example:

... {myfd}>&1

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 29 of 616
:
This opens a new file descriptor that is a duplicate of file descriptor 1 and sets the parameter myfd
to the number of the file descriptor, which will be at least 10. The new file descriptor can be written
to using the syntax >&$myfd. The file descriptor remains open in subshells

The syntax { varid }>&-, for example {myfd}>&-, may be used to close a file descriptor opened in this
fashion. Note that the parameter given by varid must previously be set to a file descriptor in this
case.

It is an error to open or close a file descriptor in this fashion when the parameter is readonly.
However, it is not an error to read or write a file descriptor using <&$ param or >&$ param if param
is readonly.

If the option CLOBBER is unset, it is an error to open a file descriptor using a parameter that is
already set to an open file descriptor previously allocated by this mechanism. Unsetting the
parameter before using it for allocating a file descriptor avoids the error.

Note that this mechanism merely allocates or closes a file descriptor; it does not perform any
redirections from or to it. It is usually convenient to allocate a file descriptor prior to use as an
argument to exec. The syntax does not in any case work when used around complex commands
such as parenthesised subshells or loops, where the opening brace is interpreted as part of a
command list to be executed in the current shell.

The following shows a typical sequence of allocation, use, and closing of a file descriptor:

integer myfd
exec {myfd}>~/logs/mylogfile.txt
print This is a log message. >&$myfd
exec {myfd}>&-

Note that the expansion of the variable in the expression >&$myfd occurs at the point the
redirection is opened. This is after the expansion of command arguments and after any redirections
to the left on the command line have been processed.

7.2 Multios
If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once, the shell opens the file
descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies its input to all the specified outputs, similar to tee,
provided the MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default. Thus:

date >foo >bar

writes the date to two files, named ‘foo’ and ‘bar’. Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 30 of 616
:
date >foo | cat

writes the date to the file ‘foo’, and also pipes it to cat.

Note that the shell opens all the files to be used in the multio process immediately, not at the point
they are about to be written.

Note also that redirections are always expanded in order. This happens regardless of the setting of
the MULTIOS option, but with the option in effect there are additional consequences. For example,
the meaning of the expression >&1 will change after a previous redirection:

date >&1 >output

In the case above, the >&1 refers to the standard output at the start of the line; the result is similar
to the tee command. However, consider:

date >output >&1

As redirections are evaluated in order, when the >&1 is encountered the standard output is set to
the file output and another copy of the output is therefore sent to that file. This is unlikely to be
what is intended.

If the MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator is also subjected to filename
generation (globbing). Thus

: > *

will truncate all files in the current directory, assuming there’s at least one. (Without the MULTIOS
option, it would create an empty file called ‘*’.) Similarly, you can do

echo exit 0 >> *.sh

If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once, the shell opens the file
descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies all the specified inputs to its output in the order
specified, provided the MULTIOS option is set. It should be noted that each file is opened
immediately, not at the point where it is about to be read: this behaviour differs from cat, so if
strictly standard behaviour is needed, cat should be used instead.

Thus

sort <foo <fubar

or even

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 31 of 616
:
sort <f{oo,ubar}

is equivalent to ‘cat foo fubar | sort’.

Expansion of the redirection argument occurs at the point the redirection is opened, at the point
described above for the expansion of the variable in >&$myfd.

Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

cat bar | sort <foo

is equivalent to ‘cat bar foo | sort’ (note the order of the inputs).

If the MULTIOS option is unset, each redirection replaces the previous redirection for that file
descriptor. However, all files redirected to are actually opened, so

echo Hello > bar > baz

when MULTIOS is unset will truncate ‘bar’, and write ‘Hello’ into ‘baz’.

There is a problem when an output multio is attached to an external program. A simple example
shows this:

cat file >file1 >file2


cat file1 file2

Here, it is possible that the second ‘cat’ will not display the full contents of file1 and file2 (i.e. the
original contents of file repeated twice).

The reason for this is that the multios are spawned after the cat process is forked from the parent
shell, so the parent shell does not wait for the multios to finish writing data. This means the
command as shown can exit before file1 and file2 are completely written. As a workaround, it is
possible to run the cat process as part of a job in the current shell:

{ cat file } >file >file2

Here, the { ... } job will pause to wait for both files to be written.

7.3 Redirections with no command


When a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators and zero or more
parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave in several ways.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 32 of 616
:
If the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD is set, an error is caused. This is
the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by default when emulating csh.

If the option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin ‘:’ is inserted as a command with the given redirections.
This is the default when emulating sh or ksh.

Otherwise, if the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a command with the given
redirections. If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD are set, then the value of the latter will be used
instead of that of the former when the redirection is an input. The default for NULLCMD is ‘cat’ and
for READNULLCMD is ‘more’. Thus

< file

shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a terminal. NULLCMD and
READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 33 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

8 Command Execution

8 Command Execution
If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it. If there exists a shell
function by that name, the function is invoked as described in Functions. If there exists a shell builtin
by that name, the builtin is invoked.

Otherwise, the shell searches each element of $path for a

If execution fails: an error message is printed, and one of the following values is returned.

127

The search was unsuccessful. The error message is ‘command not found: cmd ’.

126

directory or special file, or is not a script and is in a format unrecognized by the operating system.
The exact conditions and error message are operating system-dependent; see execve(2).

and the file is not a directory, it is assumed to be a shell script. /bin/sh is spawned to execute it. If
the program is a file beginning with ‘#!’, the remainder of the first line specifies an interpreter for the
program. The shell will execute the specified interpreter on operating systems that do

If no external command is found but a function command_not_found_handler exists the shell


executes this function with all command line arguments. The return status of the function becomes
the status of the command. Note that the handler is executed in a subshell forked to execute an
external command, hence changes to directories, shell parameters, etc. have no effect on the main
shell.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 34 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

9 Functions
9.1 Autoloading Functions
9.2 Anonymous Functions
9.3 Special Functions
9.3.1 Hook Functions
9.3.2 Trap Functions

9 Functions
Shell functions are defined with the function reserved word or the special syntax ‘ funcname ()’. Shell
functions are read in and stored internally. Alias names are resolved when the function is read.
Functions are executed like commands with the arguments passed as positional parameters. (See
Command Execution.)

Functions execute in the same process as the caller and share all files and present working directory
with the caller. A trap on EXIT set inside a function is executed after the function completes in the
environment of the caller.

The return builtin is used to return from function calls.

Function identifiers can be listed with the functions builtin. Functions can be undefined with the
unfunction builtin.

9.1 Autoloading Functions


A function can be marked as undefined using the autoload builtin (or ‘functions -u’ or ‘typeset -fu’).
Such a function has no body. When the function is first executed, the shell searches for its definition
using the elements of the fpath variable. Thus to define functions for autoloading, a typical
sequence is:

fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...

The usual alias expansion during reading will be suppressed if the autoload builtin or its equivalent
is given the option -U. This is recommended for the use of functions supplied with the zsh
distribution. Note that for functions precompiled with the zcompile builtin command the flag -U
must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as the corresponding information is compiled into
the latter.

For each element in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files, the newest of which is used to

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 35 of 616
:
load the definition for the function:

element .zwc
A file created with the zcompile builtin command, which is expected to contain the definitions for all
functions in the directory named element . The file is treated in the same manner as a directory
containing files for functions and is searched for the definition of the function. If the definition is not
found, the search for a definition proceeds with the other two possibilities described below.

If element already includes a .zwc extension (i.e. the extension was explicitly given by the user),
element is searched for the definition of the function without comparing its age to that of other
files; in fact, there does not need to be any directory named element without the suffix. Thus
including an element such as ‘/usr/local/funcs.zwc’ in fpath will speed up the search for functions,
with the disadvantage that functions included must be explicitly recompiled by hand before the shell
notices any changes.

element / function .zwc


A file created with zcompile, which is expected to contain the definition for function . It may include
other function definitions as well, but those are neither loaded nor executed; a file found in this way
is searched only for the definition of function .

element / function
A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for function .

In summary, the order of searching is, first, in the parents of directories in fpath for the newer of
either a compiled directory or a directory in fpath; second, if more than one of these contains a
definition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in the fpath is chosen; and third, within a
directory, the newer of either a compiled function or an ordinary function definition is used.

If the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is set, or the file contains only a simple definition of the function, the
file’s contents will be executed. This will normally define the function in question, but may also
perform initialization, which is executed in the context of the function execution, and may therefore
define local parameters. It is an error if the function is not defined by loading the file.

Otherwise, the function body (with no surrounding ‘ funcname () { ... }’) is taken to be the complete
contents of the file. This processing of the file results in the function being re-defined, the function
itself is not re-executed. To force the shell to perform initialization and then call the function
defined, the file should contain initialization code (which will be executed then discarded) in addition
to a complete function definition (which will be retained for subsequent calls to the function), and a
call to the shell function, including any arguments, at the end.

For example, suppose the autoload file func contains

func() { print This is func; }


print func is initialized

then ‘func; func’ with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both messages on the first call, but only the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 36 of 616
:
message ‘This is func’ on the second and subsequent calls. Without KSH_AUTOLOAD set, it will
produce the initialization message on the first call, and the other message on the second and
subsequent calls.

It is also possible to create a function that is not marked as autoloaded, but which loads its own
definition by searching fpath, by using ‘autoload -X’ within a shell function. For example, the
following are equivalent:

myfunc() {
autoload -X
}
myfunc args...

and

unfunction myfunc # if myfunc was defined


autoload myfunc
myfunc args...

In fact, the functions command outputs ‘builtin autoload -X’ as the body of an autoloaded function.
This is done so that

eval "$(functions)"

produces a reasonable result. A true autoloaded function can be identified by the presence of the
comment ‘# undefined’ in the body, because all comments are discarded from defined functions.

To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without executing myfunc, use:

autoload +X myfunc

9.2 Anonymous Functions


If no name is given for a function, it is ‘anonymous’ and is handled specially. Either form of function
definition may be used: a ‘()’ with no preceding name, or a ‘function’ with an immediately following
open brace. The function is executed immediately at the point of definition and is not stored for
future use. The function name is set to ‘(anon)’.

Arguments to the function may be specified as words following the closing brace defining the
function, hence if there are none no arguments (other than $0) are set. This is a difference from the
way other functions are parsed: normal function definitions may be followed by certain keywords
such as ‘else’ or ‘fi’, which will be treated as arguments to anonymous functions, so that a newline or
semicolon is needed to force keyword interpretation.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 37 of 616
:
Note also that the argument list of any enclosing script or function is hidden (as would be the case
for any other function called at this point).

Redirections may be applied to the anonymous function in the same manner as to a current-shell
structure enclosed in braces. The main use of anonymous functions is to provide a scope for local
variables. This is particularly convenient in start-up files as these do not provide their own local
variable scope.

For example,

variable=outside
function {
local variable=inside
print "I am $variable with arguments $*"
} this and that
print "I am $variable"

outputs the following:

I am inside with arguments this and that


I am outside

Note that function definitions with arguments that expand to nothing, for example ‘name=; function
$name { ... }’, are not treated as anonymous functions. Instead, they are treated as normal
function definitions where the definition is silently discarded.

9.3 Special Functions


Certain functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell.

9.3.1 Hook Functions

For the functions below, it is possible to define an array that has the same name as the function with
‘_functions’ appended. Any element in such an array is taken as the name of a function to execute; it
is executed in the same context and with the same arguments and same initial value of $? as the
basic function. For example, if $chpwd_functions is an array containing the values ‘mychpwd’,
‘chpwd_save_dirstack’, then the shell attempts to execute the functions ‘chpwd’, ‘mychpwd’ and
‘chpwd_save_dirstack’, in that order. Any function that does not exist is silently ignored. A function
found by this mechanism is referred to elsewhere as a hook function. An error in any function causes
subsequent functions not to be run. Note further that an error in a precmd hook causes an
immediately following periodic function not to run (though it may run at the next opportunity).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 38 of 616
:
chpwd

Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.

periodic

If the parameter PERIOD is set, this function is executed every $PERIOD seconds, just before a
prompt. Note that if multiple functions are defined using the array periodic_functions only one
period is applied to the complete set of functions, and the scheduled time is not reset if the list of
functions is altered. Hence the set of functions is always called together.

precmd

Executed before each prompt. Note that precommand functions are not re-executed simply because
the command line is redrawn, as happens, for example, when a notification about an exiting job is
displayed.

preexec

Executed just after a command has been read and is about to be executed. If the history mechanism
is active (regardless of whether the line was discarded from the history buffer), the string that the
user typed is passed as the first argument, otherwise it is an empty string. The actual command that
will be executed (including expanded aliases) is passed in two different forms: the second argument
is a single-line, size-limited version of the command (with things like function bodies elided); the
third argument contains the full text that is being executed.

zshaddhistory

Executed when a history line has been read interactively, but before it is executed. The sole
argument is the complete history line (so that any terminating newline will still be present).

If any of the hook functions returns status 1 (or any non-zero value other than 2, though this is not
guaranteed for future versions of the shell) the history line will not be saved, although it lingers in
the history until the next line is executed, allowing you to reuse or edit it immediately.

If any of the hook functions returns status 2 the history line will be saved on the internal history list,
but not written to the history file. In case of a conflict, the first non-zero status value is taken.

A hook function may call ‘fc -p ... ’ to switch the history context so that the history is saved in a
different file from that in the global HISTFILE parameter. This is handled specially: the history context
is automatically restored after the processing of the history line is finished.

The following example function works with one of the options INC_APPEND_HISTORY or
SHARE_HISTORY set, in order that the line is written out immediately after the history entry is added.
It first adds the history line to the normal history with the newline stripped, which is usually the
correct behaviour. Then it switches the history context so that the line will be written to a history file
in the current directory.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 39 of 616
:
zshaddhistory() {
print -sr -- ${1%%$'\n'}
fc -p .zsh_local_history
}

zshexit

Executed at the point where the main shell is about to exit normally. This is not called by exiting
subshells, nor when the exec precommand modifier is used before an external command. Also,
unlike TRAPEXIT, it is not called when functions exit.

9.3.2 Trap Functions

The functions below are treated specially but do not have corresponding hook arrays.

TRAP NAL

If defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever the shell catches a signal SIG NAL ,
where NAL is a signal name as specified for the kill builtin. The signal number will be passed as the
first parameter to the function.

If a function of this form is defined and null, the shell and processes spawned by it will ignore
SIG NAL .

The return status from the function is handled specially. If it is zero, the signal is assumed to have
been handled, and execution continues normally. Otherwise, the shell will behave as interrupted
except that the return status of the trap is retained.

Programs terminated by uncaught signals typically return the status 128 plus the signal number.
Hence the following causes the handler for SIGINT to print a message, then mimic the usual effect of
the signal.

TRAPINT() {
print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
return $(( 128 + $1 ))
}

The functions TRAPZERR, TRAPDEBUG and TRAPEXIT are never executed inside other traps.

TRAPDEBUG
If the option DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), executed before each command;
otherwise executed after each command. See the description of the trap builtin in Shell Builtin
Commands for details of additional features provided in debug traps.

TRAPEXIT

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 40 of 616
:
Executed when the shell exits, or when the current function exits if defined inside a function. The
value of $? at the start of execution is the exit status of the shell or the return status of the function
exiting.

TRAPZERR
Executed whenever a command has a non-zero exit status. However, the function is not executed if
the command occurred in a sublist followed by ‘&&’ or ‘||’; only the final command in a sublist of this
type causes the trap to be executed. The function TRAPERR acts the same as TRAPZERR on systems
where there is no SIGERR (this is the usual case).

The functions beginning ‘TRAP’ may alternatively be defined with the trap builtin: this may be
preferable for some uses. Setting a trap with one form removes any trap of the other form for the
same signal; removing a trap in either form removes all traps for the same signal. The forms

TRAPNAL() {
# code
}

(’function traps’) and

trap '
# code
' NAL

(’list traps’) are equivalent in most ways, the exceptions being the following:

Function traps have all the properties of normal functions, appearing in the list of functions
and being called with their own function context rather than the context where the trap was
triggered.
The return status from function traps is special, whereas a return from a list trap causes the
surrounding context to return with the given status.
Function traps are not reset within subshells, in accordance with zsh behaviour; list traps are
reset, in accordance with POSIX behaviour.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 41 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

10 Jobs & Signals


10.1 Jobs
10.2 Signals

10 Jobs & Signals

10.1 Jobs
If the MONITOR option is set, an interactive shell associates a job with each pipeline. command, and
assigns them small integer numbers. When a job is started asynchronously with ‘&’, the shell prints a
line to standard error which looks like:

[1] 1234

indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number 1 and had one (top-level)
process, whose process ID was 1234.

If a job is started with ‘&|’ or ‘&!’, then that job is immediately disowned. After startup, it to the job
control features described here.

If you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the key ^Z (control-Z) which
sends a TSTP signal to the current job: this key may be redefined by the susp option of the external
stty command. The shell will then normally indicate that the job has been ‘suspended’, and print
another prompt. You can then manipulate the state of this job, putting it in the background with the
bg command, or run some other commands and then eventually bring the job back into the
foreground with the foreground command fg. A ^Z takes effect immediately and is like an interrupt
in that pending output and unread input are discarded when it is typed.

A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from the terminal.

Note that if the job running in the foreground is a shell function, then suspending it will have the
effect of causing the shell to fork. This is necessary to separate the function’s state from that of the
parent shell performing the job control, so that the latter can return to the command line prompt.
As a result, even if fg is used to continue the job the function will no longer be part of the parent
shell, and any variables set by the function will not be visible in the parent shell. Thus the behaviour
is different from the case where the function was never suspended. Zsh is different from many
other shells in this regard.

One additional side effect is that use of disown with a job created by suspending shell code in this
fashion is delayed: the job can only be disowned once any process started from the parent shell has

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 42 of 616
:
terminated. At that point, the disowned job disappears silently from the job list.

The same behaviour is found when the shell is executing code as the right hand side of a pipeline or
any complex shell construct such as if, for, etc., in order that the entire block of code can be
managed as a single job. Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output, but this can be
disabled by giving the command ‘stty tostop’. If you set this tty option, then background jobs will
suspend when they try to produce output like they do when they try to read input.

When a command is suspended and continued later with the fg or wait builtins, zsh restores tty
modes that were in effect when it was suspended. This (intentionally) does not apply if the
command is continued via ‘kill -CONT’, nor when it is continued with bg.

There are several ways to refer to jobs in the shell. A job can be referred to by the process ID of any
process of the job or by one of the following:

% number
The job with the given number.

% string
The last job whose command line begins with string .

%? string
The last job whose command line contains string .

%%
Current job.

%+
Equivalent to ‘%%’.

%-
Previous job.

The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state. It normally informs you whenever a
job becomes blocked so that no further progress is possible. If the NOTIFY option is not set, it waits
until just before it prints a prompt before it informs you. All such notifications are sent directly to the
terminal, not to the standard output or standard error.

When the monitor mode is on, each background job that completes triggers any trap set for CHLD.

When you try to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended, you will be warned that ‘You
have suspended (running) jobs’. You may use the jobs command to see what they are. If you do this
or immediately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the suspended jobs will
be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent a SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.

To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs, either use the nohup(1) command or the
disown builtin.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 43 of 616
:
10.2 Signals
The INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the command is followed by ‘&’
and the MONITOR option is not active. The shell itself always ignores the QUIT signal. Otherwise,
signals have the values inherited by the shell from its parent (but see the TRAP NAL special functions
in Functions).

Certain jobs are run asynchronously by the shell other than those explicitly put into the background;
even in cases where the shell would usually wait for such jobs, an explicit exit command or exit due
to the option ERR_EXIT will cause the shell to exit without waiting. Examples of such asynchronous
jobs are process substitution, see Process Substitution, and the handler processes for multios, see
the section Multios in Redirection.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 44 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

11 Arithmetic Evaluation

11 Arithmetic Evaluation
The shell can perform integer and floating point arithmetic, either using the builtin let, or via a
substitution of the form $(( ... )). For integers, the shell is usually compiled to use 8-byte precision
where this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes. This can be tested, for example, by giving the
command ‘print - $(( 12345678901 ))’; if the number appears unchanged, the precision is at least 8
bytes. Floating point arithmetic always uses the ‘double’ type with whatever corresponding precision
is provided by the compiler and the library.

The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each is evaluated separately.
Since many of the arithmetic operators, as well as spaces, require quoting, an alternative form is
provided: for any command which begins with a ‘((’, all the characters until a matching ‘))’ are treated
as a double-quoted expression and arithmetic expansion performed as for an argument of let. More
precisely, ‘(( ... ))’ is equivalent to ‘let " ... "’. The return status is 0 if the arithmetic value of the
expression is non-zero, 1 if it is zero, and 2 if an error occurred.

For example, the following statement

(( val = 2 + 1 ))

is equivalent to

let "val = 2 + 1"

both assigning the value 3 to the shell variable val and returning a zero status.

Integers can be in bases other than 10. A leading ‘0x’ or ‘0X’ denotes hexadecimal and a leading ‘0b’
or ‘0B’ binary. Integers may also be of the form ‘ base # n ’, where base is a decimal number
between two and thirty-six representing the arithmetic base and n is a number in that base (for
example, ‘16#ff’ is 255 in hexadecimal). The base # may also be omitted, in which case base 10 is
used. For backwards compatibility the form ‘[ base ] n ’ is also accepted.

An integer expression or a base given in the form ‘ base # n ’ may contain underscores (‘_’) after the
leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation. Examples are 1_000_000 or
0xffff_ffff which are equivalent to 1000000 and 0xffffffff respectively.

It is also possible to specify a base to be used for output in the form ‘[# base ]’, for example ‘[#16]’.
This is used when outputting arithmetical substitutions or when assigning to scalar parameters, but
an explicitly defined integer or floating point parameter will not be affected. If an integer variable is
implicitly defined by an arithmetic expression, any base specified in this way will be set as the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 45 of 616
:
variable’s output arithmetic base as if the option ‘-i base ’ to the typeset builtin had been used. The
expression has no precedence and if it occurs more than once in a mathematical expression, the last
encountered is used. For clarity it is recommended that it appear at the beginning of an expression.
As an example:

typeset -i 16 y
print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
print $x $y

outputs first ‘8#40’, the rightmost value in the given output base, and then ‘8#40 16#20’, because y
has been explicitly declared to have output base 16, while x (assuming it does not already exist) is
implicitly typed by the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the output base 8.

The base may be replaced or followed by an underscore, which may itself be followed by a positive
integer (if it is missing the value 3 is used). This indicates that underscores should be inserted into
the output string, grouping the number for visual clarity. The following integer specifies the number
of digits to group together. For example:

setopt cbases
print $(( [#16_4] 65536 ** 2 ))

outputs ‘0x1_0000_0000’.

The feature can be used with floating point numbers, in which case the base must be omitted;
grouping is away from the decimal point. For example,

zmodload zsh/mathfunc
print $(( [#_] sqrt(1e7) ))

outputs ‘3_162.277_660_168_379_5’ (the number of decimal places shown may vary).

If the C_BASES option is set, hexadecimal numbers are output in the standard C format, for example
‘0xFF’ instead of the usual ‘16#FF’. If the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by default), octal
numbers will be treated similarly and hence appear as ‘077’ instead of ‘8#77’. This option has no
effect on the output of bases other than hexadecimal and octal, and these formats are always
understood on input.

When an output base is specified using the ‘[# base ]’ syntax, an appropriate base prefix will be
output if necessary, so that the value output is valid syntax for input. If the # is doubled, for example
‘[##16]’, then no base prefix is output.

Floating point constants are recognized by the presence of a decimal point or an exponent. The
decimal point may be the first character of the constant, but the exponent character e or E may not,
as it will be taken for a parameter name. All numeric parts (before and after the decimal point and in
the exponent) may contain underscores after the leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored
in computation.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 46 of 616
:
An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax and associativity of expressions as in C.

In the native mode of operation, the following operators are supported (listed in decreasing order of
precedence):

+ - ! ~ ++ –
unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement

<< >>
bitwise shift left, right

&
bitwise AND

^
bitwise XOR

|
bitwise OR

**
exponentiation

*/%
multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)

+-
addition, subtraction

< > <= >=


comparison

== !=
equality and inequality

&&
logical AND

|| ^^
logical OR, XOR

?:
ternary operator

= += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=


assignment

,
comma operator

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 47 of 616
:
The operators ‘&&’, ‘||’, ‘&&=’, and ‘||=’ are short-circuiting, and only one of the latter two
expressions in a ternary operator is evaluated. Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR, and
XOR operators.

With the option C_PRECEDENCES the precedences (but no other properties) of the operators are
altered to be the same as those in most other languages that support the relevant operators:

+ - ! ~ ++ –
unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement

**
exponentiation

*/%
multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)

+-
addition, subtraction

<< >>
bitwise shift left, right

< > <= >=


comparison

== !=
equality and inequality

&
bitwise AND

^
bitwise XOR

|
bitwise OR

&&
logical AND

^^
logical XOR

||
logical OR

?:
ternary operator

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 48 of 616
:
= += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
assignment

,
comma operator

Note the precedence of exponentiation in both cases is below that of unary operators, hence ‘-3**2’
evaluates as ‘9’, not ‘-9’. Use parentheses where necessary: ‘-(3**2)’. This is for compatibility with
other shells.

Mathematical functions can be called with the syntax ‘ func ( args )’, where the function decides if
the args is used as a string or a comma-separated list of arithmetic expressions. The shell currently
defines no mathematical functions by default, but the module zsh/mathfunc may be loaded with the
zmodload builtin to provide standard floating point mathematical functions.

An expression of the form ‘## x ’ where x is any character sequence such as ‘a’, ‘^A’, or ‘\M-\C-x’
gives the value of this character and an expression of the form ‘# name ’ gives the value of the first
character of the contents of the parameter name . Character values are according to the character
set used in the current locale; for multibyte character handling the option MULTIBYTE must be set.
Note that this form is different from ‘$# name ’, a standard parameter substitution which gives the
length of the parameter name . ‘#\’ is accepted instead of ‘##’, but its use is deprecated.

Named parameters and subscripted arrays can be referenced by name within an arithmetic
expression without using the parameter expansion syntax. For example,

((val2 = val1 * 2))

assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.

An internal integer representation of a named parameter can be specified with the integer builtin.
Arithmetic evaluation is performed on the value of each assignment to a named parameter declared
integer in this manner. Assigning a floating point number to an integer results in rounding towards
zero.

Likewise, floating point numbers can be declared with the float builtin; there are two types, differing
only in their output format, as described for the typeset builtin. The output format can be bypassed
by using arithmetic substitution instead of the parameter substitution, i.e. ‘${ float }’ uses the
defined format, but ‘$(( float ))’ uses a generic floating point format.

Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where necessary. In addition, if any
operator which requires an integer (‘&’, ‘|’, ‘^’, ‘<<’, ‘>>’ and their equivalents with assignment) is given
a floating point argument, it will be silently rounded towards zero except for ‘~’ which rounds down.

Users should beware that, in common with many other programming languages but not software
designed for calculation, the evaluation of an expression in zsh is taken a term at a time and
promotion of integers to floating point does not occur in terms only containing integers. A typical

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 49 of 616
:
result of this is that a division such as 6/8 is truncated, in this being rounded towards 0. The
FORCE_FLOAT shell option can be used in scripts or functions where floating point evaluation is
required throughout.

Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different times; there is no memory of
the numeric type in this case.

If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously being declared, it will be
implicitly typed as integer or float and retain that type either until the type is explicitly changed or
until the end of the scope. This can have unforeseen consequences. For example, in the loop

for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do


# use $f
done

if f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it to be created as an integer, and
consequently the operation ‘f += 0.1’ will always cause the result to be truncated to zero, so that the
loop will fail. A simple fix would be to turn the initialization into ‘f = 0.0’. It is therefore best to declare
numeric variables with explicit types.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 50 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

12 Conditional Expressions

12 Conditional Expressions
A conditional expression is used with the [[ compound command to test attributes of files and to
compare strings. Each expression can be constructed from one or more of the following unary or
binary expressions:

-a file
true if file exists.

-b file
true if file exists and is a block special file.

-c file
true if file exists and is a character special file.

-d file
true if file exists and is a directory.

-e file
true if file exists.

-f file
true if file exists and is a regular file.

-g file
true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.

-h file
true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

-k file
true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.

-n string
true if length of string is non-zero.

-o option
true if option named option is on. option may be a single character, in which case it is a single
letter option name. (See Specifying Options.)

When no option named option exists, and the POSIX_BUILTINS option hasn’t been set, return 3

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 51 of 616
:
with a warning. If that option is set, return 1 with no warning.

-p file
true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).

-r file
true if file exists and is readable by current process.

-s file
true if file exists and has size greater than zero.

-t fd
true if file descriptor number fd is open and associated with a terminal device. (note: fd is not
optional)

-u file
true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.

-v varname
true if shell variable varname is set.

-w file
-x file
-z string
true if length of string is zero.

-L file
true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

-O file
true if file exists and is owned by the effective user ID of this process.

-G file
true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID of this process.

-S file
true if file exists and is a socket.

-N file
true if file exists and its access time is not newer than its modification time.

file1 -nt file2


true if file1 exists and is newer than file2 .

file1 -ot file2


true if file1 exists and is older than file2 .
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 52 of 616
:
file1 -ef file2
true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.

string = pattern
string == pattern
true if string matches pattern . The two forms are exactly equivalent. The ‘=’ form is the
traditional shell syntax (and hence the only one generally used with the test and [ builtins); the ‘==’
form provides compatibility with other sorts of computer language.

string != pattern
true if string does not match pattern .

string =~ regexp
true if string matches the regular expression regexp . If the option RE_MATCH_PCRE is set regexp
is tested as a PCRE regular expression using the zsh/pcre module, else it is tested as a POSIX
extended regular expression using the zsh/regex module. Upon successful match, some variables
will be updated; no variables are changed if the matching fails.

If the option BASH_REMATCH is not set the scalar parameter MATCH is set to the substring that
matched the pattern and the integer parameters MBEGIN and MEND to the index of the start and
end, respectively, of the match in string , such that if string is contained in variable var the
expression ‘${var[$MBEGIN,$MEND]}’ is identical to ‘$MATCH’. The setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS
is respected. Likewise, the array match is set to the substrings that matched parenthesised
subexpressions and the arrays mbegin and mend to the indices of the start and end positions,
respectively, of the substrings within string . The arrays are not set if there were no parenthesised
subexpressions. For example, if the string ‘a short string’ is matched against the regular expression
‘s(...)t’, then (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set) MATCH, MBEGIN and MEND are ‘short’, 3
and 7, respectively, while match, mbegin and mend are single entry arrays containing the strings
‘hor’, ‘4’ and ‘6’, respectively.

If the option BASH_REMATCH is set the array BASH_REMATCH is set to the substring that matched
the pattern followed by the substrings that matched parenthesised subexpressions within the
pattern.

string1 < string2


true if string1 comes before string2 based on ASCII value of their characters.

string1 > string2


true if string1 comes after string2 based on ASCII value of their characters.

exp1 -eq exp2


true if exp1 is numerically equal to exp2 . Note that for purely numeric comparisons use of the
(( ... )) builtin described in Arithmetic Evaluation is more convenient than conditional expressions.

exp1 -ne exp2

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 53 of 616
:
true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2 .

exp1 -lt exp2


true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2 .

exp1 -gt exp2


true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2 .

exp1 -le exp2


true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2 .

exp1 -ge exp2


true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2 .

( exp )
true if exp is true.

! exp
true if exp is false.

exp1 && exp2


true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.

exp1 || exp2
true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.

For compatibility, if there is a single argument that is not syntactically significant, typically a variable,
the condition is treated as a test for whether the expression expands as a string of non-zero length.
In other words, [[ $var ]] is the same as [[ -n $var ]]. It is recommended that the second, explicit, form
be used where possible.

Normal shell expansion is performed on the file , string and pattern arguments, but the result
of each expansion is constrained to be a single word, similar to the effect of double quotes.

Filename generation is not performed on any form of argument to conditions. However, it can be
forced in any case where normal shell expansion is valid and when the option EXTENDED_GLOB is in
effect by using an explicit glob qualifier of the form (#q) at the end of the string. A normal glob
qualifier expression may appear between the ‘q’ and the closing parenthesis; if none appears the
expression has no effect beyond causing filename generation. The results of filename generation
are joined together to form a single word, as with the results of other forms of expansion.

This special use of filename generation is only available with the [[ syntax. If the condition occurs
within the [ or test builtin commands then globbing occurs instead as part of normal command line
expansion before the condition is evaluated. In this case it may generate multiple words which are
likely to confuse the syntax of the test command.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 54 of 616
:
For example,

[[ -n file*(#qN) ]]

produces status zero if and only if there is at least one file in the current directory beginning with the
string ‘file’. The globbing qualifier N ensures that the expression is empty if there is no matching file.

Pattern metacharacters are active for the pattern arguments; the patterns are the same as those
used for filename generation, see Filename Generation, but there is no special behaviour of ‘/’ nor
initial dots, and no glob qualifiers are allowed.

In each of the above expressions, if file is of the form ‘/dev/fd/ n ’, where n is an integer, then the
test applied to the open file whose descriptor number is n , even if the underlying system does not
support the /dev/fd directory.

In the forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions exp undergo arithmetic expansion as if
they were enclosed in $(( ... )).

For example, the following:

[[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.

tests if either file foo or file bar exists, and if so, if the value of the parameter report begins with ‘y’; if
the complete condition is true, the message ‘File exists.’ is printed.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 55 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

13 Prompt Expansion
13.1 Expansion of Prompt Sequences
13.2 Simple Prompt Escapes
13.2.1 Special characters
13.2.2 Login information
13.2.3 Shell state
13.2.4 Date and time
13.2.5 Visual effects
13.3 Conditional Substrings in Prompts

13 Prompt Expansion

13.1 Expansion of Prompt Sequences


Prompt sequences undergo a special form of expansion. This type of expansion is also available
using the -P option to the print builtin.

If the PROMPT_SUBST option is set, the prompt string is first subjected to parameter expansion,
command substitution and arithmetic expansion. See Expansion.

Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.

If the PROMPT_BANG option is set, a ‘!’ in the prompt is replaced by the current history event
number. A literal ‘!’ may then be represented as ‘!!’.

If the PROMPT_PERCENT option is set, certain escape sequences that start with ‘%’ are expanded.
Many escapes are followed by a single character, although some of these take an optional integer
argument that should appear between the ‘%’ and the next character of the sequence. More
complicated escape sequences are available to provide conditional expansion.

13.2 Simple Prompt Escapes

13.2.1 Special characters

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 56 of 616
:
%%
A ‘%’.

%)
A ‘)’.

13.2.2 Login information

%l
The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without ‘/dev/’ prefix. If the name starts with ‘/dev/tty’, that
prefix is stripped.

%M
The full machine hostname.

%m
The hostname up to the first ‘.’. An integer may follow the ‘%’ to specify how many components of
the hostname are desired. With a negative integer, trailing components of the hostname are shown.

%n
$USERNAME.

%y
The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without ‘/dev/’ prefix. This does not treat ‘/dev/tty’ names
specially.

13.2.3 Shell state

%#
A ‘#’ if the shell is running with privileges, a ‘%’ if not. Equivalent to ‘%(!.#.%%)’. The definition of
‘privileged’, for these purposes, is that either the effective user ID is zero, or, if POSIX.1e capabilities
are supported, that capability vectors.

%?
The return status of the last command executed just before the prompt.

%_
The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs (like ‘if’ and ‘for’) that have been started on the
command line. If given an integer number that many strings will be printed; zero or negative or no
integer means print as many as there are. This is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines
and PS4 for debugging with the XTRACE option; in the latter case it will also work non-interactively.

%^

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 57 of 616
:
The status of the parser in reverse. This is the same as ‘%_’ other than the order of strings. It is often
used in RPS2.

%d
%/
Current working directory. If an integer follows the ‘%’, it specifies a number of trailing components
of the current working directory to show; zero means the whole path. A negative integer specifies
leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the first component.

%~
As %d and %/, but if the current working directory starts with $HOME, that part is replaced by a ‘~’.
Furthermore, if it has a named directory as its prefix, that part is replaced by a ‘~’ followed by the
name of the directory, but only if the result is shorter than the full path; Filename Expansion.

%e
Evaluation depth of the current sourced file, shell function, or eval. This is incremented or
decremented every time the value of %N is set or reverted to a previous value, respectively. This is
most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.

%h
%!
Current history event number.

%i
The line number currently being executed in the script, sourced file, or shell function given by %N.
This is most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.

%I
The line number currently being executed in the file %x. This is similar to %i, but the line number is
always a line number in the file where the code was defined, even if the code is a shell function.

%j
The number of jobs.

%L
The current value of $SHLVL.

%N
The name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh is currently executing, whichever was
started most recently. If there is none, this is equivalent to the parameter $0. An integer may follow
the ‘%’ to specify a number of trailing path components to show; zero means the full path. A
negative integer specifies leading components.

%x
The name of the file containing the source code currently being executed. This behaves as %N
except that function and eval command names are not shown, instead the file where they were
defined.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 58 of 616
:
%c
%.
%C
Trailing component of the current working directory. An integer may follow the ‘%’ to get more than
one component. Unless ‘%C’ is used, tilde contraction is performed first. These are deprecated as %c
and %C are equivalent to %1~ and %1/, respectively, while explicit positive integers have the same
effect as for the latter two sequences.

13.2.4 Date and time

%D
The date in yy - mm - dd format.

%T
Current time of day, in 24-hour format.

%t
%@
Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

%*
Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.

%w
The date in day - dd format.

%W
The date in mm / dd / yy format.

%D{ string }
string is formatted using the strftime function. See strftime(3) for more details. Various zsh
extensions provide numbers with no leading zero or space if the number is a single digit:

%f
a day of the month

%K
the hour of the day on the 24-hour clock

%L
the hour of the day on the 12-hour clock

In addition, if the system supports the POSIX gettimeofday system call, %. provides decimal fractions
of a second since the epoch with leading zeroes. By default three decimal places are provided, but a
number of digits up to 9 may be given following the %; hence %6. outputs microseconds, and %9.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 59 of 616
:
outputs nanoseconds. (The latter requires a nanosecond-precision clock_gettime; systems lacking
this will return a value multiplied by the appropriate power of 10.) A typical example of this is the
format ‘%D{%H:%M:%S.%.}’.

The GNU extension %N is handled as a synonym for %9..

Additionally, the GNU extension that a ‘-’ between the % and the format character causes a leading
zero or space to be stripped is handled directly by the shell for the format characters d, f, H, k, l, m,
M, S and y; any other format characters are provided to the system’s strftime(3) with any leading ‘-’
present, so the handling is system dependent. Further GNU (or other) extensions are also passed to
strftime(3) and may work if the system supports them.

13.2.5 Visual effects

%B (%b)
Start (stop) boldface mode.

%E
Clear to end of line.

%U (%u)
Start (stop) underline mode.

%S (%s)
Start (stop) standout mode.

%F (%f)
Start (stop) using a different foreground colour, if supported by the terminal. The colour may be
specified two ways: either as a numeric argument, as normal, or by a sequence in braces following
the %F, for example %F{red}. In the latter case the values allowed are as described for the fg
zle_highlight attribute; Character Highlighting. This means that numeric colours are allowed in the
second format also.

%K (%k)
Start (stop) using a different bacKground colour. The syntax is identical to that for %F and %f.

%{...%}
Include a string as a literal escape sequence. The string within the braces should not change the
cursor position. Brace pairs can nest.

A positive numeric argument between the % and the { is treated as described for %G below.

%G
Within a %{...%} sequence, include a ‘glitch’: that is, assume that a single character width will be
output. This is useful when outputting characters that otherwise cannot be correctly handled by the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 60 of 616
:
shell, such as the alternate character set on some terminals. The characters in question can be
included within a %{...%} sequence together with the appropriate number of %G sequences to
indicate the correct width. An integer between the ‘%’ and ‘G’ indicates a character width other than
one. Hence %{ seq %2G%} outputs seq and assumes it takes up the width of two standard
characters.

Multiple uses of %G accumulate in the obvious fashion; the position of the %G is unimportant.
Negative integers are not handled.

Note that when prompt truncation is in use it is advisable to divide up output into single characters
within each %{...%} group so that the correct truncation point can be found.

13.3 Conditional Substrings in Prompts


%v

The value of the first element of the psvar array parameter. Following the ‘%’ with an integer gives
that element of the array. Negative integers count from the end of the array.

%( x . true-text . false-text )
Specifies a ternary expression. The character following the x is arbitrary; the same character is used
to separate the text for the ‘true’ result from that for the ‘false’ result. This separator may not appear
in the true-text , except as part of a %-escape sequence. A ‘)’ may appear in the false-text as ‘%)’.
true-text and false-text may both contain arbitrarily-nested escape sequences, including
further ternary expressions.

The left parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a positive integer n , which defaults to zero. A
negative integer will be multiplied by -1, except as noted below for ‘l’. The test character x may be
any of the following:

!
True if the shell is running with privileges.

True if the effective uid of the current process is n .

?
True if the exit status of the last command was n .

_
True if at least n shell constructs were started.

C
/

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 61 of 616
:
True if the current absolute path has at least n elements relative to the root directory, hence / is
counted as 0 elements.

c
.
~
True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at least n elements relative to the root
directory, hence / is counted as 0 elements.

D
True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).

d
True if the day of the month is equal to n .

e
True if the evaluation depth is at least n .

g
True if the effective gid of the current process is n .

j
True if the number of jobs is at least n .

L
True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n .

l
True if at least n characters have already been printed on the current line. When n is negative, true
if at least abs( n ) characters remain before the opposite margin (thus the left margin for RPROMPT).

S
True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n .

T
True if the time in hours is equal to n .

t
True if the time in minutes is equal to n .

v
True if the array psvar has at least n elements.

V
True if element n of the array psvar is set and non-empty.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 62 of 616
:
True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).

%< string <


%> string >
%[ xstring ]
Specifies truncation behaviour for the remainder of the prompt string. The third, deprecated, form is
equivalent to ‘% xstringx ’, i.e. x may be ‘<’ or ‘>’. The string will be displayed in place of the
truncated portion of any string; note this does not undergo prompt expansion.

The numeric argument, which in the third form may appear immediately after the ‘[’, specifies the
maximum permitted length of the various strings that can be displayed in the prompt. In the first
two forms, this numeric argument may be negative, in which case the truncation length is
determined by subtracting the absolute value of the numeric argument from the number of
character positions remaining on the current prompt line. If this results in a zero or negative length,
a length of 1 is used. In other words, a negative argument arranges that after truncation at least n
characters remain before the right margin (left margin for RPROMPT).

The forms with ‘<’ truncate at the left of the string, and the forms with ‘>’ truncate at the right of the
string. For example, if the current directory is ‘/home/pike’, the prompt ‘%8<..<%/’ will expand to
‘..e/pike’. In this string, the terminating character (‘<’, ‘>’ or ‘]’), or in fact any character, may be quoted
by a preceding ‘\’; note when using print -P, however, that this must be doubled as the string is also
subject to standard print processing, in addition to any backslashes removed by a double quoted
string: the worst case is therefore ‘print -P "%<\\\\<<..."’.

If the string is longer than the specified truncation length, it will appear in full, completely
replacing the truncated string.

The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of the string, or to the end of the next
enclosing group of the ‘%(’ construct, or to the next truncation encountered at the same grouping
level (i.e. truncations inside a ‘%(’ are separate), which ever comes first. In particular, a truncation
with argument zero (e.g., ‘%<<’) marks the end of the range of the string to be truncated while
turning off truncation from there on. For example, the prompt ‘%10<...<%~%<<%# ’ will print a
truncated representation of the current directory, followed by a ‘%’ or ‘#’, followed by a space.
Without the ‘%<<’, those two characters would be included in the string to be truncated. Note that
‘%-0<<’ is not equivalent to ‘%<<’ but specifies that the prompt is truncated at the right margin.

Truncation applies only within each individual line of the prompt, as delimited by embedded
newlines (if any). If the total length of any line of the prompt after truncation is greater than the
terminal width, or if the part to be truncated contains embedded newlines, truncation behavior is
undefined and may change in a future version of the shell. Use ‘%- n (l. true-text . false-text )’ to
remove parts of the prompt when the available space is less than n .

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 63 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

14 Expansion
14.1 History Expansion
14.1.1 Overview
14.1.2 Event Designators
14.1.3 Word Designators
14.1.4 Modifiers
14.2 Process Substitution
14.3 Parameter Expansion
14.3.1 Parameter Expansion Flags
14.3.2 Rules
14.3.3 Examples
14.4 Command Substitution
14.5 Arithmetic Expansion
14.6 Brace Expansion
14.7 Filename Expansion
14.7.1 Dynamic named directories
14.7.2 Static named directories
14.7.3 ‘=’ expansion
14.7.4 Notes
14.8 Filename Generation
14.8.1 Glob Operators
14.8.2 ksh-like Glob Operators
14.8.3 Precedence
14.8.4 Globbing Flags
14.8.5 Approximate Matching
14.8.6 Recursive Globbing
14.8.7 Glob Qualifiers

14 Expansion
The following types of expansions are performed in the indicated order in five steps:

History Expansion
This is performed only in interactive shells.

Alias Expansion
Aliases are expanded immediately before the command line is parsed as explained in Aliasing.

Process Substitution
Parameter Expansion
Command Substitution
Arithmetic Expansion

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 64 of 616
:
Brace Expansion
These five are performed in left-to-right fashion. On each argument, any of the five steps that are
needed are performed one after the other. Hence, for example, all the parts of parameter expansion
are completed before command substitution is started. After these expansions, all unquoted
occurrences of the characters ‘\’,‘’’ and ‘"’ are removed.

Filename Expansion
If the SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order of expansion is modified for compatibility with sh
and ksh. In that case filename expansion is performed immediately after alias expansion, preceding
the set of five expansions mentioned above.

Filename Generation
This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done last.

The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.

14.1 History Expansion


History expansion allows you to use words from previous command lines in the command line you
are typing. This simplifies spelling corrections and the repetition of complicated commands or
arguments.

Immediately before execution, each command is saved in the history list, the size of which is
controlled by the HISTSIZE parameter. The one most recent command is always retained in any case.
Each saved command in the history list is called a history event and is assigned a number, beginning
with 1 (one) when the shell starts up. The history number that you may see in your prompt (see
Prompt Expansion) is the number that is to be assigned to the next command.

14.1.1 Overview

A history expansion begins with the first character of the histchars parameter, which is ‘!’ by default,
and may occur anywhere on the command line, including inside double quotes (but not inside single
quotes ’...’ or C-style quotes $’...’ nor when escaped with a backslash).

The first character is followed by an optional event designator (Event Designators) and then an
optional word designator (Word Designators); if neither of these designators is present, no history
expansion occurs.

Input lines containing history expansions are echoed after being expanded, but before any other
expansions take place and before the command is executed. It is this expanded form that is
recorded as the history event for later references.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 65 of 616
:
History expansions do not nest.

By default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the same event as any preceding
history reference on that command line; if it is the only history reference in a command, it refers to
the previous command. However, if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY is set, then every history
reference with no event specification always refers to the previous command.

For example, ‘!’ is the event designator for the previous command, so ‘!!:1’ always refers to the first
word of the previous command, and ‘!!$’ always refers to the last word of the previous command.
With CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then ‘!:1’ and ‘!$’ function in the same manner as ‘!!:1’ and ‘!!$’,
respectively. Conversely, if CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY is unset, then ‘!:1’ and ‘!$’ refer to the first and last
words, respectively, of the same event referenced by the nearest other history reference preceding
them on the current command line, or to the previous command if there is no preceding reference.

The character sequence ‘^ foo ^ bar ’ (where ‘^’ is actually the second character of the histchars
parameter) repeats the last command, replacing the string foo with bar . More precisely, the
sequence ‘^ foo ^ bar ^’ is synonymous with ‘!!:s^ foo ^ bar ^’, hence other modifiers (see Modifiers)
may follow the final ‘^’. In particular, ‘^ foo ^ bar ^:G’ performs a global substitution.

If the shell encounters the character sequence ‘!"’ in the input, the history mechanism is temporarily
disabled until the current list (see Shell Grammar) is fully parsed. The ‘!"’ is removed from the input,
and any subsequent ‘!’ characters have no special significance.

A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history support is provided by the fc
builtin.

14.1.2 Event Designators

An event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in the history list. In the list below,
remember that the initial ‘!’ in each item may be changed to another character by setting the
histchars parameter.

!
Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, newline, ‘=’ or ‘(’. If followed immediately
by a word designator (Word Designators), this forms a history reference with no event designator
(Overview).

!!
Refer to the previous command. By itself, this expansion repeats the previous command.

!n
Refer to command-line n .

!- n

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 66 of 616
:
Refer to the current command-line minus n .

! str
Refer to the most recent command starting with str .

!? str [?]
Refer to the most recent command containing str . The trailing ‘?’ is necessary if this reference is to
be followed by a modifier or followed by any text that is not to be considered part of str .

!#
Refer to the current command line typed in so far. The line is treated as if it were complete up to
and including the word before the one with the ‘!#’ reference.

!{...}
Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if necessary).

14.1.3 Word Designators

A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line are to be included in a
history reference. A ‘:’ usually separates the event specification from the word designator. It may be
omitted only if the word designator begins with a ‘^’, ‘$’, ‘*’, ‘-’ or ‘%’. Word designators include:

0
The first input word (command).

n
The n th argument.

^
The first argument. That is, 1.

$
The last argument.

%
The word matched by (the most recent) ? str search.

x-y
A range of words; x defaults to 0.

*
All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.

x*
Abbreviates ‘ x -$’.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 67 of 616
:
x-
Like ‘ x *’ but omitting word $.

Note that a ‘%’ word designator works only when used in one of ‘!%’, ‘!:%’ or ‘!? str ?:%’, and only
when used after a !? expansion (possibly in an earlier command). Anything else results in an error,
although the error may not be the most obvious one.

14.1.4 Modifiers

After the optional word designator, you can add a sequence of one or more of the following
modifiers, each preceded by a ‘:’. These modifiers also work on the result of filename generation and
parameter expansion, except where noted.

a
Turn a file name into an absolute path: prepends the current directory, if necessary; remove ‘.’ path
segments; and remove ‘..’ path segments and the segments that immediately precede them.

This transformation is agnostic about what is in the filesystem, i.e. is on the logical, not the physical
directory. It takes place in the same manner as when changing directories when neither of the
options CHASE_DOTS or CHASE_LINKS is set. For example, ‘/before/here/../after’ is always
transformed to ‘/before/after’, regardless of whether ‘/before/here’ exists or what kind of object (dir,
file, symlink, etc.) it is.

A
Turn a file name into an absolute path as the ‘a’ modifier does, and then pass the result through the
realpath(3) library function to resolve symbolic links.

Note: on systems that do not have a realpath(3) library function, symbolic links are not resolved, so
on those systems ‘a’ and ‘A’ are equivalent.

Note: foo:A and realpath(foo) are different on some inputs. For realpath(foo) semantics, see the ‘P‘
modifier.

c
Resolve a command name into an absolute path by searching the command path given by the PATH
variable. This does not work for commands containing directory parts. Note also that this does not
usually work as a glob qualifier unless a file of the same name is found in the current directory.

e
Remove all but the part of the filename extension following the ‘.’; see the definition of the filename
extension in the description of the r modifier below. Note that according to that definition the result
will be empty if the string ends with a ‘.’.

h [ digits ]
Remove a trailing pathname component, shortening the path by one directory level: this is the ‘head’
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 68 of 616
:
of the pathname. This works like ‘dirname’. If the h is followed immediately (with no spaces or other
separator) by any number of decimal digits, and the value of the resulting number is non-zero, that
number of leading components is preserved instead of the final component being removed. In an
absolute path the leading ‘/’ is the first component, so, for example, if var=/my/path/to/something,
then ${var:h3} substitutes /my/path. Consecutive ‘/’s are treated the same as a single ‘/’. In
parameter substitution, digits may only be used if the expression is in braces, so for example the
short form substitution $var:h2 is treated as ${var:h}2, not as ${var:h2}. No restriction applies to the
use of digits in history substitution or globbing qualifiers. If more components are requested than
are present, the entire path is substituted (so this does not trigger a ‘failed modifier’ error in history
expansion).

l
Convert the words to all lowercase.

p
Print the new command but do not execute it. Only works with history expansion.

P
Turn a file name into an absolute path, like realpath(3). The resulting path will be absolute, will refer
to the same directory entry as the input filename, and none of its components will be symbolic links
or equal to ‘.’ or ‘..’.

Unlike realpath(3), non-existent trailing components are permitted and preserved.

q
Quote the substituted words, escaping further substitutions. Works with history expansion and
parameter expansion, though for parameters it is only useful if the resulting text is to be re-
evaluated such as by eval.

Q
Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.

r
Remove a filename extension leaving the root name. Strings with no filename extension are not
altered. A filename extension is a ‘.’ followed by any number of characters (including zero) that are
neither ‘.’ nor ‘/’ and that continue to the end of the string. For example, the extension of ‘foo.orig.c’
is ‘.c’, and ‘dir.c/foo’ has no extension.

s/ l / r [/]
Substitute r for l as described below. The substitution is done only for the first string that
matches l . For arrays and for filename generation, this applies to each word of the expanded text.
See below for further notes on substitutions.

The forms ‘gs/ l / r ’ and ‘s/ l / r /:G’ perform global substitution, i.e. substitute every occurrence of
r for l . Note that the g or :G must appear in exactly the position shown.

See further notes on this form of substitution below.


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 69 of 616
:
&
Repeat the previous s substitution. Like s, may be preceded immediately by a g. In parameter
expansion the & must appear inside braces, and in filename generation it must be quoted with a
backslash.

t [ digits ]
Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the final component (tail). This works like
‘basename’. Any trailing slashes are first removed. Decimal digits are handled as described above for
(h), but in this case that number of trailing components is preserved instead of the default 1; 0 is
treated the same as 1.

u
Convert the words to all uppercase.

x
Like q, but break into words at whitespace. Does not work with parameter expansion.

The s/ l / r / substitution works as follows. By default the left-hand side of substitutions are not
patterns, but character strings. Any character can be used as the delimiter in place of ‘/’. A backslash
quotes the delimiter character. The character ‘&’, in the right-hand-side r , is replaced by the text
from the left-hand-side l . The ‘&’ can be quoted with a backslash. A null l uses the previous string
either from the previous l or from the contextual scan string s from ‘!? s ’. You can omit the
rightmost delimiter if a newline immediately follows r ; the rightmost ‘?’ in a context scan can
similarly be omitted. Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across all forms of
expansion.

Note that if a ‘&’ is used within glob qualifiers an extra backslash is needed as a & is a special
character in this case.

Also note that the order of expansions affects the interpretation of l and r . When used in a
history expansion, which occurs before any other expansions, l and r are treated as literal strings
(except as explained for HIST_SUBST_PATTERN below). When used in parameter expansion, the
replacement of r into the parameter’s value is done first, and then any additional process,
parameter, command, arithmetic, or brace references are applied, which may evaluate those
substitutions and expansions more than once if l appears more than once in the starting value.
When used in a glob qualifier, any substitutions or expansions are performed once at the time the
qualifier is parsed, even before the ‘:s’ expression itself is divided into l and r sides.

If the option HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l is treated as a pattern of the usual form described in
Filename Generation. This can be used in all the places where modifiers are available; note,
however, that in globbing qualifiers parameter substitution has already taken place, so parameters
in the replacement string should be quoted to ensure they are replaced at the correct time. Note
also that complicated patterns used in globbing qualifiers may need the extended glob qualifier
notation (#q:s/ ... / ... /) in order for the shell to recognize the expression as a glob qualifier.
Further, note that bad patterns in the substitution are not subject to the NO_BAD_PATTERN option

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 70 of 616
:
so will cause an error.

When HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l may start with a # to indicate that the pattern must match at
the start of the string to be substituted, and a % may appear at the start or after an # to indicate that
the pattern must match at the end of the string to be substituted. The % or # may be quoted with
two backslashes.

For example, the following piece of filename generation code with the EXTENDED_GLOB option:

print -r -- *.c(#q:s/#%(#b)s(*).c/'S${match[1]}.C'/)

takes the expansion of *.c and applies the glob qualifiers in the (#q ... ) expression, which consists
of a substitution modifier anchored to the start and end of each word (#%). This turns on
backreferences ((#b)), so that the parenthesised subexpression is available in the replacement string
as ${match[1]}. The replacement string is quoted so that the parameter is not substituted before the
start of filename generation.

The following f, F, w and W modifiers work only with parameter expansion and filename generation.
They are listed here to provide a single point of reference for all modifiers.

f
Repeats the immediately (without a colon) following modifier until the resulting word doesn’t change
any more.

F: expr :
Like f, but repeats only n times if the expression expr evaluates to n . Any character can be used
instead of the ‘:’; if ‘(’, ‘[’, or ‘{’ is used as the opening delimiter, the closing delimiter should be ’)’, ‘]’, or
‘}’, respectively.

w
Makes the immediately following modifier work on each word in the string.

W: sep :
Like w but words are considered to be the parts of the string that are separated by sep . Any
character can be used instead of the ‘:’; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.

14.2 Process Substitution


Each part of a command argument that takes the form ‘<( list )’, ‘>( list )’ or ‘=( list )’ is subject to
process substitution. The expression may be preceded or followed by other strings except that, to
prevent clashes with commonly occurring strings and patterns, the last form must occur at the start
of a command argument, and the forms are only expanded when first parsing command or
assignment arguments. Process substitutions may be used following redirection operators; in this
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 71 of 616
:
case, the substitution must appear with no trailing string.

Note that ‘<<( list )’ is not a special syntax; it is equivalent to ‘< <( list )’, redirecting standard input
from the result of process substitution. Hence all the following documentation applies. The second
form (with the space) is recommended for clarity.

In the case of the < or > forms, the shell runs the commands in list as a subprocess of the job
executing the shell command line. If the system supports the /dev/fd mechanism, the command
argument is the name of the device file corresponding to a file descriptor; otherwise, if the system
supports named pipes (FIFOs), the command argument will be a named pipe. If the form with > is
selected then writing on this special file will provide input for list . If < is used, then the file passed
as an argument will be connected to the output of the list process. For example,

paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |


tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null

cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files file1 and file2 respectively, pastes the results together, and
sends it to the processes process1 and process2 .

If =( ... ) is used instead of <( ... ), then the file passed as an argument will be the name of a
temporary file containing the output of the list process. This may be used instead of the < form
for a program that expects to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the input file.

There is an optimisation for substitutions of the form =(<<< arg ), where arg is a single-word
argument to the here-string redirection <<<. This form produces a file name containing the value of
arg after any substitutions have been performed. This is handled entirely within the current shell.
This is effectively the reverse of the special form $(< arg ) which treats arg as a file name and
replaces it with the file’s contents.

The = form is useful as both the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementation of <( ... ) have
drawbacks. In the former case, some programmes may automatically close the file descriptor in
question before examining the file on the command line, particularly if this is necessary for security
reasons such as when the programme is running setuid. In the second case, if the programme does
not actually open the file, the subshell attempting to read from or write to the pipe will (in a typical
implementation, different operating systems may have different behaviour) block for ever and have
to be killed explicitly. In both cases, the shell actually supplies the information using a pipe, so that
programmes that expect to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the file will not work.

Also note that the previous example can be more compactly and efficiently written (provided the
MULTIOS option is set) as:

paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process1) > >(process2)

The shell uses pipes instead of FIFOs to implement the latter two process substitutions in the above
example.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 72 of 616
:
There is an additional problem with >( process ); when this is attached to an external command, the
parent shell does not wait for process to finish and hence an immediately following command
cannot rely on the results being complete. The problem and solution are the same as described in
the section MULTIOS in Redirection. Hence in a simplified version of the example above:

paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process)

(note that no MULTIOS are involved), process will be run asynchronously as far as the parent shell
is concerned. The workaround is:

{ paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) } > >(process)

The extra processes here are spawned from the parent shell which will wait for their completion.

Another problem arises any time a job with a substitution that requires a temporary file is disowned
by the shell, including the case where ‘&!’ or ‘&|’ appears at the end of a command containing a
substitution. In that case the temporary file will not be cleaned up as the shell no longer has any
memory of the job. A workaround is to use a subshell, for example,

(mycmd =(myoutput)) &!

as the forked subshell will wait for the command to finish then remove the temporary file.

A general workaround to ensure a process substitution endures for an appropriate length of time is
to pass it as a parameter to an anonymous shell function (a piece of shell code that is run
immediately with function scope). For example, this code:

() {
print File $1:
cat $1
} =(print This be the verse)

outputs something resembling the following

File /tmp/zsh6nU0kS:
This be the verse

The temporary file created by the process substitution will be deleted when the function exits.

14.3 Parameter Expansion


The character ‘$’ is used to introduce parameter expansions. See Parameters for a description of

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 73 of 616
:
parameters, including arrays, associative arrays, and subscript notation to access individual array
elements.

Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters are not automatically split on
whitespace unless the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set; see references to this option below for more
details. This is an important difference from other shells. However, as in other shells, null words are
elided from unquoted parameters’ expansions.

With default options, after the assignments:

array=("first word" "" "third word")


scalar="only word"

then $array substitutes two words, ‘first word’ and ‘third word’, and $scalar substitutes a single word
‘only word’. Note that second element of array was elided. Scalar parameters can be elided too if
their value is null (empty). To avoid elision, use quoting as follows: "$scalar" for scalars and
"${array[@]}" or "${(@)array}" for arrays. (The last two forms are equivalent.)

Parameter expansions can involve flags, as in ‘${(@kv)aliases}’, and other operators, such as
‘${PREFIX:-"/usr/local"}’. Parameter expansions can also be nested. These topics will be introduced
below. The full rules are complicated and are noted at the end.

In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of the pattern is the same as that
used for filename generation; see Filename Generation. Note that these patterns, along with the
replacement text of any substitutions, are themselves subject to parameter expansion, command
substitution, and arithmetic expansion. In addition to the following operations, the colon modifiers
described in Modifiers in History Expansion can be applied: for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs
string substitution on the expansion of parameter $i.

In the following descriptions, ‘ word ’ refers to a single word substituted on the command line, not
necessarily a space delimited word.

${ name }
The value, if any, of the parameter name is substituted. The braces are required if the expansion is
to be followed by a letter, digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted as part of name . In
addition, more complicated forms of substitution usually require the braces to be present;
exceptions, which only apply if the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set, are a single subscript or any colon
modifiers appearing after the name, or any of the characters ‘^’, ‘=’, ‘~’, ‘#’ or ‘+’ appearing before the
name, all of which work with or without braces.

If name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then the value of each
element of name is substituted, one element per word. Otherwise, the expansion results in one
word only; with KSH_ARRAYS, this is the first element of an array. No field splitting is done on the
result unless the SH_WORD_SPLIT option is set. See also the flags = and s: string :.

${+ name }

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 74 of 616
:
If name is the name of a set parameter ‘1’ is substituted, otherwise ‘0’ is substituted.

${ name - word }
${ name :- word }
If name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute its value; otherwise substitute word .
In the second form name may be omitted, in which case word is always substituted.

${ name + word }
${ name :+ word }
If name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute word ; otherwise substitute nothing.

${ name = word }
${ name := word }
${ name ::= word }
In the first form, if name is unset then set it to word ; in the second form, if name is unset or null
then set it to word ; and in the third form, unconditionally set name to word . In all forms, the value
of the parameter is then substituted.

${ name ? word }
${ name :? word }
In the first form, if name is set, or in the second form if name is both set and non-null, then
substitute its value; otherwise, print word and exit from the shell. Interactive shells instead return to
the prompt. If word is omitted, then a standard message is printed.

In any of the above expressions that test a variable and substitute an alternate word , note that you
can use standard shell quoting in the word value to selectively override the splitting done by the
SH_WORD_SPLIT option and the = flag, but not splitting by the s: string : flag.

In the following expressions, when name is an array and the substitution is not quoted, or if the ‘(@)’
flag or the name [@] syntax is used, matching and replacement is performed on each array element
separately.

${ name # pattern }
${ name ## pattern }
If the pattern matches the beginning of the value of name , then substitute the value of name with
the matched portion deleted; otherwise, just substitute the value of name . In the first form, the
smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second form, the largest matching pattern is
preferred.

${ name % pattern }
${ name %% pattern }
If the pattern matches the end of the value of name , then substitute the value of name with the
matched portion deleted; otherwise, just substitute the value of name . In the first form, the smallest
matching pattern is preferred; in the second form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 75 of 616
:
${ name :# pattern }
If the pattern matches the value of name , then substitute the empty string; otherwise, just
substitute the value of name . If name is an array the matching array elements are removed (use the
‘(M)’ flag to remove the non-matched elements).

${ name :| arrayname }
If arrayname is the name (N.B., not contents) of an array variable, then any elements contained in
arrayname are removed from the substitution of name . If the substitution is scalar, either because
name is a scalar variable or the expression is quoted, the elements of arrayname are instead tested
against the entire expression.

${ name :* arrayname }
Similar to the preceding substitution, but in the opposite sense, so that entries present in both the
original substitution and as elements of arrayname are retained and others removed.

${ name :^ arrayname }
${ name :^^ arrayname }
Zips two arrays, such that the output array is twice as long as the shortest (longest for ‘:^^’) of name
and arrayname, with the elements alternatingly being picked from them. For ‘:^’, if one of the input
arrays is longer, the output will stop when the end of the shorter array is reached. Thus,

a=(1 2 3 4); b=(a b); print ${a:^b}

will output ‘1 a 2 b’. For ‘:^^’, then the input is repeated until all of the longer array has been used up
and the above will output ‘1 a 2 b 3 a 4 b’.

Either or both inputs may be a scalar, they will be treated as an array of length 1 with the scalar as
the only element. If either array is empty, the other array is output with no extra elements inserted.

Currently the following code will output ‘a b’ and ‘1’ as two separate elements, which can be
unexpected. The second print provides a workaround which should continue to work if this is
changed.

a=(a b); b=(1 2); print -l "${a:^b}"; print -l "${${a:^b}}"

${ name : offset }
${ name : offset : length }
This syntax gives effects similar to parameter subscripting in the form $ name [ start , end ], but is
compatible with other shells; note that both offset and length are interpreted differently from
the components of a subscript.

If offset is non-negative, then if the variable name is a scalar substitute the contents starting
offset characters from the first character of the string, and if name is an array substitute elements
starting offset elements from the first element. If length is given, substitute that many characters

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 76 of 616
:
or elements, otherwise the entire rest of the scalar or array.

A positive offset is always treated as the offset of a character or element in name from the first
character or element of the array (this is different from native zsh subscript notation). Hence 0
refers to the first character or element regardless of the setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS.

A negative offset counts backwards from the end of the scalar or array, so that -1 corresponds to the
last character or element, and so on.

When positive, length counts from the offset position toward the end of the scalar or array.
When negative, length counts back from the end. If this results in a position smaller than offset ,
a diagnostic is printed and nothing is substituted.

The option MULTIBYTE is obeyed, i.e. the offset and length count multibyte characters where
appropriate.

offset and length undergo the same set of shell substitutions as for scalar assignment; in
addition, they are then subject to arithmetic evaluation. Hence, for example

print ${foo:3}
print ${foo: 1 + 2}
print ${foo:$(( 1 + 2))}
print ${foo:$(echo 1 + 2)}

all have the same effect, extracting the string starting at the fourth character of $foo if the
substitution would otherwise return a scalar, or the array starting at the fourth element if $foo
would return an array. Note that with the option KSH_ARRAYS $foo always returns a scalar
(regardless of the use of the offset syntax) and a form such as ${foo[*]:3} is required to extract
elements of an array named foo.

If offset is negative, the - may not appear immediately after the : as this indicates the ${ name :-
word } form of substitution. Instead, a space may be inserted before the -. Furthermore, neither
offset nor length may begin with an alphabetic character or & as these are used to indicate
history-style modifiers. To substitute a value from a variable, the recommended approach is to
precede it with a $ as this signifies the intention (parameter substitution can easily be rendered
unreadable); however, as arithmetic substitution is performed, the expression ${var: offs} does
work, retrieving the offset from $offs.

For further compatibility with other shells there is a special case for array offset 0. This usually
accesses the first element of the array. However, if the substitution refers to the positional
parameter array, e.g. $@ or $*, then offset 0 instead refers to $0, offset 1 refers to $1, and so on. In
other words, the positional parameter array is effectively extended by prepending $0. Hence ${*:0:1}
substitutes $0 and ${*:1:1} substitutes $1.

${ name / pattern / repl }


${ name // pattern / repl }

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 77 of 616
:
${ name :/ pattern / repl }
Replace the longest possible match of pattern in the expansion of parameter name by string repl .
The first form replaces just the first occurrence, the second form all occurrences, and the third form
replaces only if pattern matches the entire string. Both pattern and repl are subject to double-
quoted substitution, so that expressions like ${name/$opat/$npat} will work, but obey the usual rule
that pattern characters in $opat are not treated specially unless either the option GLOB_SUBST is
set, or $opat is instead substituted as ${~opat}.

The pattern may begin with a ‘#’, in which case the pattern must match at the start of the string,
or ‘%’, in which case it must match at the end of the string, or ‘#%’ in which case the pattern must
match the entire string. The repl may be an empty string, in which case the final ‘/’ may also be
omitted. To quote the final ‘/’ in other cases it should be preceded by a single backslash; this is not
necessary if the ‘/’ occurs inside a substituted parameter. Note also that the ‘#’, ‘%’ and ‘#% are not
active if they occur inside a substituted parameter, even at the start.

If, after quoting rules apply, ${ name } expands to an array, the replacements act on each element
individually. Note also the effect of the I and S parameter expansion flags below; however, the flags
M, R, B, E and N are not useful.

For example,

foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"


print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}

Here, the ‘~’ ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pattern rather than a plain string. In the first
case, the longest match for t*e is substituted and the result is ‘spy star’, while in the second case, the
shortest matches are taken and the result is ‘spy spy lispy star’.

${# spec }
If spec is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length in characters of the result instead of
the result itself. If spec is an array expression, substitute the number of elements of the result. This
has the side-effect that joining is skipped even in quoted forms, which may affect other sub-
expressions in spec . Note that ‘^’, ‘=’, and ‘~’, below, must appear to the left of ‘#’ when these forms
are combined.

If the option POSIX_IDENTIFIERS is not set, and spec is a simple name, then the braces are optional;
this is true even for special parameters so e.g. $#- and $#* take the length of the string $- and the
array $* respectively. If POSIX_IDENTIFIERS is set, then braces are required for the # to be treated in
this fashion.

${^ spec }
${^^ spec }

Turn on the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation of spec ; if the ‘^’ is doubled, turn it off.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 78 of 616
:
When this option is set, array expansions of the form foo ${ xx } bar , where the parameter xx is
set to ( a b c ), are substituted with ‘ fooabar foobbar foocbar ’ instead of the default ‘ fooa b
cbar ’. Note that an empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

Internally, each such expansion is converted into the equivalent list for brace expansion. E.g., ${^var}
becomes {$var[1],$var[2],...}, and is processed as described in Brace Expansion below: note,
however, the expansion happens immediately, with any explicit brace expansion happening later. If
word splitting is also in effect the $var[ N ] may themselves be split into different list elements.

${= spec }
${== spec }

Perform word splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT during the evaluation of spec , but
regardless of whether the parameter appears in double quotes; if the ‘=’ is doubled, turn it off. This
forces parameter expansions to be split into separate words before substitution, using IFS as a
delimiter. This is done by default in most other shells.

Note that splitting is applied to word in the assignment forms of spec before the assignment to
name is performed. This affects the result of array assignments with the A flag.

${~ spec }
${~~ spec }

Turn on the GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec ; if the ‘~’ is doubled, turn it off. When
this option is set, the string resulting from the expansion will be interpreted as a pattern anywhere
that is possible, such as in filename expansion and filename generation and pattern-matching
contexts like the right hand side of the ‘=’ and ‘!=’ operators in conditions.

In nested substitutions, note that the effect of the ~ applies to the result of the current level of
substitution. A surrounding pattern operation on the result may cancel it. Hence, for example, if the
parameter foo is set to *, ${~foo//\*/*.c} is substituted by the pattern *.c, which may be expanded
by filename generation, but ${${~foo}//\*/*.c} substitutes to the string *.c, which will not be further
expanded.

If a ${...} type parameter expression or a $(...) type command substitution is used in place of name
above, it is expanded first and the result is used as if it were the value of name . Thus it is possible to
perform nested operations: ${${foo#head}%tail} substitutes the value of $foo with both ‘head’ and
‘tail’ deleted. The form with $(...) is often useful in combination with the flags described next; see the
examples below. Each name or nested ${...} in a parameter expansion may also be followed by a
subscript expression as described in Array Parameters.

Note that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in which case only the part inside
is treated as quoted; for example, ${(f)"$(foo)"} quotes the result of $(foo), but the flag ‘(f)’ (see
below) is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions. Note further that quotes are themselves
nested in this context; for example, in "${(@f)"$(foo)"}", there are two sets of quotes, one

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 79 of 616
:
surrounding the whole expression, the other (redundant) surrounding the $(foo) as before.

14.3.1 Parameter Expansion Flags

If the opening brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis, the string up to the matching
closing parenthesis will be taken as a list of flags. In cases where repeating a flag is meaningful, the
repetitions need not be consecutive; for example, ‘(q%q%q)’ means the same thing as the more
readable ‘(%%qqq)’. The following flags are supported:

Evaluate the resulting words as numeric expressions and interpret these as character codes. Output
the corresponding characters. Note that this form is entirely distinct from use of the # without
parentheses.

If the MULTIBYTE option is set and the number is greater than 127 (i.e. not an ASCII character) it is
treated as a Unicode character.

%
Expand all % escapes in the resulting words in the same way as in prompts (see Prompt Expansion).
If this flag is given twice, full prompt expansion is done on the resulting words, depending on the
setting of the PROMPT_PERCENT, PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.

@
In double quotes, array elements are put into separate words. E.g., ‘"${(@)foo}"’ is equivalent to
‘"${foo[@]}"’ and ‘"${(@)foo[1,2]}"’ is the same as ‘"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]"’. This is distinct from field
splitting by the f, s or z flags, which still applies within each array element.

A
Convert the substitution into an array expression, even if it otherwise would be scalar. This has
lower precedence than subscripting, so one level of nested expansion is required in order that
subscripts apply to array elements. Thus ${${(A) name }[1]} yields the full value of name when name is
scalar.

This assigns an array parameter with ‘${...=...}’, ‘${...:=...}’ or ‘${...::=...}’. If this flag is repeated (as in
‘AA’), assigns an associative array parameter. Assignment is made before sorting or padding; if field
splitting is active, the word part is split before assignment. The name part may be a subscripted
range for ordinary arrays; when assigning an associative array, the word part must be converted to
an array, for example by using ‘${(AA)= name =...}’ to activate field splitting.

Surrounding context such as additional nesting or use of the value in a scalar assignment may cause
the array to be joined back into a single string again.

a
Sort in array index order; when combined with ‘O’ sort in reverse array index order. Note that ‘a’ is
therefore equivalent to the default but ‘Oa’ is useful for obtaining an array’s elements in reverse

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 80 of 616
:
order.

b
Quote with backslashes only characters that are special to pattern matching. This is useful when the
contents of the variable are to be tested using GLOB_SUBST, including the ${~ ... } switch.

Quoting using one of the q family of flags does not work for this purpose since quotes are not
stripped from non-pattern characters by GLOB_SUBST. In other words,

pattern=${(q)str}
[[ $str = ${~pattern} ]]

works if $str is ‘a*b’ but not if it is ‘a b’, whereas

pattern=${(b)str}
[[ $str = ${~pattern} ]]

is always true for any possible value of $str.

c
With ${# name }, count the total number of characters in an array, as if the elements were
concatenated with spaces between them. This is not a true join of the array, so other expressions
used with this flag may have an effect on the elements of the array before it is counted.

C
Capitalize the resulting words. ‘Words’ in this case refers to sequences of alphanumeric characters
separated by non-alphanumerics, not to words that result from field splitting.

D
Assume the string or array elements contain directories and attempt to substitute the leading part
of these by names. The remainder of the path (the whole of it if the leading part was not substituted)
is then quoted so that the whole string can be used as a shell argument. This is the reverse of ‘~’
substitution: see Filename Expansion.

e
Perform single word shell expansions, namely parameter expansion, command substitution and
arithmetic expansion, on the result. Such expansions can be nested but too deep recursion may have

f
Split the result of the expansion at newlines. This is a shorthand for ‘ps:\n:’.

F
Join the words of arrays together using newline as a separator. This is a shorthand for ‘pj:\n:’.

g: opts :
Process escape sequences like the echo builtin when no options are given (g::). With the o option,
octal escapes don’t take a leading zero. With the c option, sequences like ‘^X’ are also processed.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 81 of 616
:
With the e option, processes ‘\M-t’ and similar sequences like the print builtin. With both of the o and
e options, behaves like the print builtin except that in none of these modes is ‘\c’ interpreted.

i
Sort case-insensitively. May be combined with ‘n’ or ‘O’.

k
If name refers to an associative array, substitute the keys (element names) rather than the values of
the elements. Used with subscripts (including ordinary arrays), force indices or keys to be
substituted even if the subscript form refers to values. However, this flag may not be combined with
subscript ranges. With the KSH_ARRAYS option a subscript ‘[*]’ or ‘[@]’ is needed to operate on the
whole array, as usual.

L
Convert all letters in the result to lower case.

n
Sort decimal integers numerically; if the first differing characters of two test strings are not digits,
sorting is lexical. ‘+’ and ‘-’ are not treated specially; they are treated as any other non-digit. Integers
with more initial zeroes are sorted before those with fewer or none. Hence the array ‘foo+24 foo1
foo02 foo2 foo3 foo20 foo23’ is sorted into the order shown. May be combined with ‘i’ or ‘O’.

-
As n, but a leading minus sign indicates a negative decimal integer. A leading minus sign not
followed by an integer does not trigger numeric sorting. Note that ‘+’ signs are not handled specially
(this may change in the future).

o
Sort the resulting words in ascending order; if this appears on its own the sorting is lexical and case-
sensitive (unless the locale renders it case-insensitive). Sorting in ascending order is the default for
other forms of sorting, so this is ignored if combined with ‘a’, ‘i’, ‘n’ or ‘-’.

O
Sort the resulting words in descending order; ‘O’ without ‘a’, ‘i’, ‘n’ or ‘-’ sorts in reverse lexical order.
May be combined with ‘a’, ‘i’, ‘n’ or ‘-’ to reverse the order of sorting.

P
This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as a further parameter name, whose
value will be used where appropriate. Note that flags set with one of the typeset family of
commands (in particular case transformations) are not applied to the value of name used in this
fashion.

If used with a nested parameter or command substitution, the result of that will be taken as a
parameter name in the same way. For example, if you have ‘foo=bar’ and ‘bar=baz’, the strings
${(P)foo}, ${(P)${foo}}, and ${(P)$(echo bar)} will be expanded to ‘baz’.

Likewise, if the reference is itself nested, the expression with the flag is treated as if it were directly

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 82 of 616
:
replaced by the parameter name. It is an error if this nested substitution produces an array with
more than one word. For example, if ‘name=assoc’ where the parameter assoc is an associative
array, then ‘${${(P)name}[elt]}’ refers to the element of the associative subscripted ‘elt’.

q
Quote characters that are special to the shell in the resulting words with $’\ NNN ’ form, with separate
quotes for each octet.

If this flag is given twice, the resulting words are quoted in single quotes and if it is given three times,
the words are quoted in double characters is attempted. If the flag is given four times, the words are
quoted in single quotes preceded by a $. Note that in all three of these forms quoting is done
unconditionally, even if this does not change the way the resulting string would be interpreted by
the shell.

If a q- is given (only a single q may appear), a minimal form of single quoting is used that only quotes
the string if needed to protect special characters. Typically this form gives the most readable output.

If a q+ is given, an extended form of minimal quoting is used that This quoting is similar to that used
by the output of values by the typeset family of commands.

Q
Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.

t
Use a string describing the type of the parameter where the value of the parameter would usually
appear. This string consists of keywords separated by hyphens (‘-’). The first keyword in the string
describes the main type, it can be one of ‘scalar’, ‘array’, ‘integer’, ‘float’ or ‘association’. The other
keywords describe the type in more detail:

local
for local parameters

left
for left justified parameters

right_blanks
for right justified parameters with leading blanks

right_zeros
for right justified parameters with leading zeros

lower
for parameters whose value is converted to all lower case when it is expanded

upper
for parameters whose value is converted to all upper case when it is expanded

readonly

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 83 of 616
:
for readonly parameters

tag
for tagged parameters

tied
for parameters tied to another parameter in the manner of PATH (colon-separated list) and path
(array), whether these are special parameters or user-defined with ‘typeset -T’

export
for exported parameters

unique
for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of duplicated values

hide
for parameters with the ‘hide’ flag

hideval
for parameters with the ‘hideval’ flag

special
for special parameters defined by the shell

u
Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.

U
Convert all letters in the result to upper case.

v
Used with k, substitute (as two consecutive words) both the key and the value of each associative
array element. Used with subscripts, force values to be substituted even if the subscript form refers
to indices or keys.

V
Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.

w
With ${# name }, count words in arrays or strings; the s flag may be used to set a word delimiter.

W
Similar to w with the difference that empty words between repeated delimiters are also counted.

X
With this flag, parsing errors occurring with the Q, e and # flags or the pattern matching forms such
as ‘${ name # pattern }’ are reported. Without the flag, errors are silently ignored.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 84 of 616
:
z
Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing to find the words, i.e. taking into
account any quoting in the value. Comments are not treated specially but as ordinary strings, similar
to interactive shells with the INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option unset (however, see the Z flag below
for related options)

Note that this is done very late, even later than the ‘(s)’ flag. So to access single words in the result
use nested expansions as in ‘${${(z)foo}[2]}’. Likewise, to remove the quotes in the resulting words
use ‘${(Q)${(z)foo}}’.

0
Split the result of the expansion on null bytes. This is a shorthand for ‘ps:\0:’.

The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as shown. Any character, or
the matching pairs ‘(...)’, ‘{...}’, ‘[...]’, or ‘<...>’, may be used in place of a colon as delimiters, but note
that when a flag takes more than one argument, a matched pair of delimiters must surround each
argument.

p
Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in string arguments to any of the flags
described below that follow this argument.

Alternatively, with this option string arguments may be in the form $ var in which case the value of
the variable is substituted. Note this form is strict; the string argument does not undergo general
parameter expansion.

For example,

sep=:
val=a:b:c
print ${(ps.$sep.)val}

splits the variable on a :.

~
Strings inserted into the expansion by any of the flags below are to be treated as patterns. This
applies to the string arguments of flags that follow ~ within the same set of parentheses. Compare
with ~ outside parentheses, which forces the entire substituted string to be treated as a pattern.
Hence, for example,

[[ "?" = ${(~j.|.)array} ]]

treats ‘|’ as a pattern and succeeds if and only if $array contains the string ‘?’ as an element. The ~
may be repeated to toggle the behaviour; its effect only lasts to the end of the parenthesised group.

j: string :
Join the words of arrays together using string as a separator. Note that this occurs before field
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 85 of 616
:
splitting by the s: string : flag or the SH_WORD_SPLIT option.

l: expr :: string1 :: string2 :


Pad the resulting words on the left. Each word will be truncated if required and placed in a field
expr characters wide.

The arguments : string1 : and : string2 : are optional; neither, the first, or both may be given. Note
that the same pairs of delimiters must be used for each of the three arguments. The space to the
left will be filled with string1 (concatenated as often as needed) or spaces if string1 is not given.
If both string1 and string2 are given, string2 is inserted once directly to the left of each word,
truncated if necessary, before string1 is used to produce any remaining padding.

If either of string1 or string2 is present but empty, i.e. there are two delimiters together at that
point, the first character of $IFS is used instead.

If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, the flag m may also be given, in which case widths will be used
for the calculation of padding; otherwise individual multibyte characters are treated as occupying
one unit of width.

If the MULTIBYTE option is not in effect, each byte in the string is treated as occupying one unit of
width.

Control characters are always assumed to be one unit wide; this allows the mechanism to be used
for generating repetitions of control characters.

m
Only useful together with one of the flags l or r or with the # length operator when the MULTIBYTE
option is in effect. Use the character width reported by the system in calculating how much of the
string it occupies or the overall unit, however certain Asian character sets and certain special effects
use wider characters; combining characters have zero width. would actually be displayed will vary.

If the m is repeated, the character either counts zero (if it has effect of counting the number of
glyphs (visibly separate characters), except for the case where combining characters themselves
have non-zero width (true in certain alphabets).

r: expr :: string1 :: string2 :


As l, but pad the words on the right and insert string2 immediately to the right of the string to be
padded.

Left and right padding may be used together. In this case the strategy is to apply left padding to the
first half width of each of the resulting words, and right padding to the second half. If the string to be
padded has odd width the extra padding is applied on the left.

s: string :
Force field splitting at the separator string . Note that a string of two or more characters means
that all of them must match in sequence; this differs from the treatment of two or more characters

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 86 of 616
:
in the IFS parameter. See also the = flag and the SH_WORD_SPLIT option. An empty string may also
be given in which case every character will be a separate element.

For historical reasons, the usual behaviour that empty array elements are retained inside double
quotes is disabled for arrays generated by splitting; hence the following:

line="one::three"
print -l "${(s.:.)line}"

produces two lines of output for one and three and elides the empty field. To override this
behaviour, supply the ‘(@)’ flag as well, i.e. "${(@s.:.)line}".

Z: opts :
As z but takes a combination of option letters between a following pair of delimiter characters. With
no options the effect is identical to z. The following options are available:

(Z+c+)
causes comments to be parsed as a string and retained; any field in the resulting array beginning
with an unquoted comment character is a comment.

(Z+C+)
causes comments to be parsed and removed. The rule for comments is standard: anything between
a word starting with the third character of $HISTCHARS, default #, up to the next newline is a
comment.

(Z+n+)
causes unquoted newlines to be treated as ordinary whitespace, else they are treated as if they are
shell code delimiters and converted to semicolons.

Options are combined within the same set of delimiters, e.g. (Z+Cn+).

_: flags :
The underscore (_) flag is reserved for future use. As of this revision of zsh, there are no valid flags ;
anything following an underscore, other than an empty pair of delimiters, is treated as an error, and
the flag itself has no effect.

The following flags are meaningful with the ${...#...} or ${...%...} forms. The S, I, and * flags may also
be used with the ${.../...} forms.

S
With # or ##, search for the match that starts closest to the start of the string (a ‘substring match’).
Of all matches at a particular position, # selects the shortest and ## the longest:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 87 of 616
:
% str="aXbXc"
% echo ${(S)str#X*}
abXc
% echo ${(S)str##X*}
a
%

With % or %%, search for the match that starts closest to the end of the string:

% str="aXbXc"
% echo ${(S)str%X*}
aXbc
% echo ${(S)str%%X*}
aXb
%

(Note that % and %% don’t search for the match that ends closest to the end of the string, as one
might expect.)

With substitution via ${.../...} or ${...//...}, specifies non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead
of the longest match should be replaced:

% str="abab"
% echo ${str/*b/_}
_
% echo ${(S)str/*b/_}
_ab
%

I: expr :
Search the expr th match (where expr evaluates to a number). This only applies when searching
for substrings, either with the S flag, or with ${.../...} (only the expr th match is substituted) or
${...//...} (all matches from the expr th on are substituted). The default is to take the first match.

The expr th match is counted such that there is either one or zero matches from each starting
position in the string, although for global substitution matches overlapping previous replacements
are ignored. With the ${...%...} and ${...%%...} forms, the starting position for the match moves
backwards from the end as the index increases, while with the other forms it moves forward from
the start.

Hence with the string

which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?

substitutions of the form ${(SI: N :)string#w*ch} as N increases from 1 will match and remove
‘which’, ‘witch’, ‘witch’ and ‘wich’; the form using ‘##’ will match and remove ‘which switch is the right
switch for Ipswich’, ‘witch is the right switch for Ipswich’, ‘witch for Ipswich’ and ‘wich’. The form using

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 88 of 616
:
‘%’ will remove the same matches as for ‘#’, but in reverse order, and the form using ‘%%’ will remove
the same matches as for ‘##’ in reverse order.

Enable EXTENDED_GLOB for substitution via ${.../...} or ${...//...}. Note that ‘**’ does not disable
extendedglob.

B
Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.

E
Include the index one character past the end of the match in the result (note this is inconsistent with
other uses of parameter index).

M
Include the matched portion in the result.

N
Include the length of the match in the result.

R
Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).

14.3.2 Rules

Here is a summary of the rules for substitution; this assumes that braces are present around the
substitution, i.e. ${ ... }. Some particular examples are given below. Note that the Zsh Development
Group accepts no responsibility for any brain damage which may occur during the reading of the
following rules.

1. Nested substitution
If multiple nested ${ ... } forms are present, substitution is performed from the inside outwards. At
each level, the substitution takes account of whether the current value is a scalar or an array,
whether the whole substitution is in double quotes, and what flags are supplied to the current level
of substitution, just as if the nested substitution were the outermost. The flags are not propagated
up to enclosing substitutions; the nested substitution will return either a scalar or an array as
determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting. All the following steps take place where
applicable at all levels of substitution.

Note that, unless the ‘(P)’ flag is present, the flags and any subscripts apply directly to the value of
the nested substitution; for example, the expansion ${${foo}} behaves exactly the same as ${foo}.
When the ‘(P)’ flag is present in a nested substitution, the other substitution rules are applied to the
value before it is interpreted as a name, so ${${(P)foo}} may differ from ${(P)foo}.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 89 of 616
:
At each nested level of substitution, the substituted words undergo all forms of single-word
substitution (i.e. not filename generation), including command substitution, arithmetic expansion
and filename expansion (i.e. leading ~ and =). Thus, for example, ${${:-=cat}:h} expands to the
directory where the cat program resides. (Explanation: the internal substitution has no parameter
but a default value =cat, which is expanded by filename expansion to a full path; the outer
substitution then applies the modifier :h and takes the directory part of the path.)

2. Internal parameter flags


Any parameter flags set by one of the typeset family of commands, in particular the -L, -R, -Z, -u and -
l options for padding and capitalization, are applied directly to the parameter value. Note these flags
are options to the command, e.g. ‘typeset -Z’; they are not the same as the flags used within
parameter substitutions.

At the outermost level of substitution, the ‘(P)’ flag (rule 4.) ignores these transformations and uses
the unmodified value of the parameter as the name to be replaced. This is usually the desired
behavior because padding may make the value syntactically illegal as a parameter name, but if
capitalization changes are desired, use the ${${(P)foo}} form (rule 25.).

3. Parameter subscripting
If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such as ${ var [3]}, the effect of
subscripting is applied directly to the parameter. Subscripts are evaluated left to right; subsequent
subscripts apply to the scalar or array value yielded by the previous subscript. Thus if var is an array,
${var[1][2]} is the second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is the entire third word (the
second word of the range of words two through four of the original array). Any number of subscripts
may appear. Flags such as ‘(k)’ and ‘(v)’ which alter the result of subscripting are applied.

4. Parameter name replacement


At the outermost level of nesting only, the ‘(P)’ flag is applied. This treats the value so far as a
parameter name (which may include a subscript expression) and replaces that with the
corresponding value. This replacement occurs later if the ‘(P)’ flag appears in a nested substitution.

If the value so far names a parameter that has internal flags (rule 2.), those internal flags are applied
to the new value after replacement.

5. Double-quoted joining
If the value after this process is an array, and the substitution appears in double quotes, and neither
an ‘(@)’ flag nor a ‘#’ length operator is present at the current level, then words of the value are
joined with the first character of the parameter $IFS, by default a space, between each word (single
word arrays are not modified). If the ‘(j)’ flag is present, that is used for joining instead of $IFS.

6. Nested subscripting
Any remaining subscripts (i.e. of a nested substitution) are evaluated at this point, based on whether
the value is an array or a scalar. As with 3., multiple subscripts can appear. Note that ${foo[2,4][2]} is
thus equivalent to ${${foo[2,4]}[2]} and also to "${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substitution returns
an array in both cases), but not to "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substitution returns a scalar
because of the quotes).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 90 of 616
:
7. Modifiers
Any modifiers, as specified by a trailing ‘#’, ‘%’, ‘/’ (possibly doubled) or by a set of modifiers of the
form ‘:...’ (see Modifiers in History Expansion), are applied to the words of the value at this level.

8. Character evaluation
Any ‘(#)’ flag is applied, evaluating the result so far numerically as a character.

9. Length
Any initial ‘#’ modifier, i.e. in the form ${# var }, is used to evaluate the length of the expression so
far.

10. Forced joining


If the ‘(j)’ flag is present, or no ‘(j)’ flag is present but the string is to be split as given by rule 11., and
joining did not take place at rule 5., any words in the value are joined together using the given string
or the first character of $IFS if none. Note that the ‘(F)’ flag implicitly supplies a string for joining in
this manner.

11. Simple word splitting


If one of the ‘(s)’ or ‘(f)’ flags are present, or the ‘=’ specifier was present (e.g. ${= var }), the word is
split on occurrences of the specified string, or (for = with neither of the two flags present) any of the
characters in $IFS.

If no ‘(s)’, ‘(f)’ or ‘=’ was given, but the word is not quoted and the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set, the
word is split on occurrences of any of the characters in $IFS. Note this step, too, takes place at all
levels of a nested substitution.

12. Case modification


Any case modification from one of the flags ‘(L)’, ‘(U)’ or ‘(C)’ is applied.

13. Escape sequence replacement


First any replacements from the ‘(g)’ flag are performed, then any prompt-style formatting from the
‘(%)’ family of flags is applied.

14. Quote application


Any quoting or unquoting using ‘(q)’ and ‘(Q)’ and related flags is applied.

15. Directory naming


Any directory name substitution using ‘(D)’ flag is applied.

16. Visibility enhancement


Any modifications to make characters visible using the ‘(V)’ flag are applied.

17. Lexical word splitting


If the ’(z)’ flag or one of the forms of the ’(Z)’ flag is present, the word is split as if it were a shell
command line, so that quotation marks and other metacharacters are used to decide what
constitutes a word. Note this form of splitting is entirely distinct from that described by rule 11.: it
does not use $IFS, and does not cause forced joining.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 91 of 616
:
18. Uniqueness
If the result is an array and the ‘(u)’ flag was present, duplicate elements are removed from the
array.

19. Ordering
If the result is still an array and one of the ‘(o)’ or ‘(O)’ flags was present, the array is reordered.

20. RC_EXPAND_PARAM
At this point the decision is made whether any resulting array elements are to be combined element
by element with surrounding text, as given by either the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option or the ‘^’ flag.

21. Re-evaluation
Any ‘(e)’ flag is applied to the value, forcing it to be re-examined for new parameter substitutions, but
also for command and arithmetic substitutions.

22. Padding
Any padding of the value by the ‘(l. fill .)’ or ‘(r. fill .)’ flags is applied.

23. Semantic joining


In contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word to result, all words are rejoined with
the first character of IFS between. So in ‘${(P)${(f)lines}}’ the value of ${lines} is split at newlines, but
then must be joined again before the ‘(P)’ flag can be applied.

If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.

24. Empty argument removal


If the substitution does not appear in double quotes, any resulting zero-length argument, whether
from a scalar or an element of an array, is elided from the list of arguments inserted into the
command line.

Strictly speaking, the removal happens later as the same happens with other forms of substitution;
the point to note here is simply that it occurs after any of the above parameter operations.

25. Nested parameter name replacement


If the ‘(P)’ flag is present and rule 4. has not applied, the value so far is treated as a parameter name
(which may include a subscript expression) and replaced with the corresponding value, with internal
flags (rule 2.) applied to the new value.

14.3.3 Examples

The flag f is useful to split a double-quoted substitution line by line. For example, ${(f)"$(< file )"}
substitutes the contents of file divided so that each line is an element of the resulting array.
Compare this with the effect of $(< file ) alone, which divides the file up by words, or the same
inside double quotes, which makes the entire content of the file a single string.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 92 of 616
:
The following illustrates the rules for nested parameter expansions. Suppose that $foo contains the
array (bar baz):

"${(@)${foo}[1]}"
This produces the result b. First, the inner substitution "${foo}", which has no array (@) flag,
produces a single word result "bar baz". The outer substitution "${(@)...[1]}" detects that this is a
scalar, so that (despite the ‘(@)’ flag) the subscript picks the first character.

"${${(@)foo}[1]}"
This produces the result ‘bar’. In this case, the inner substitution "${(@)foo}" produces the array ‘(bar
baz)’. The outer substitution "${...[1]}" detects that this is an array and picks the first word. This is
similar to the simple case "${foo[1]}".

As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo contains the array ‘(ax1 bx1)’.
Then

${(s/x/)foo}
produces the words ‘a’, ‘1 b’ and ‘1’.

${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
produces ‘a’, ‘1’, ‘b’ and ‘1’.

${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
produces ‘a’ and ‘ b’ (note the extra space). As substitution occurs before either joining or splitting,
the operation first generates the modified array (ax bx), which is joined to give "ax bx", and then split
to give ‘a’, ‘ b’ and ‘’. The final empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.

14.4 Command Substitution


A command enclosed in parentheses preceded by a dollar sign, like ‘$(...)’, or quoted with grave
accents, like ‘‘...‘’, is replaced with its standard output, with any trailing newlines deleted. If the
substitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the output is broken into words using the IFS
parameter.

The substitution ‘$(cat foo )’ may be replaced by the faster ‘$(< foo )’. In this case foo undergoes
single word shell expansions (parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion),
but not filename generation.

If the option GLOB_SUBST is set, the result of any unquoted command substitution, including the
special form just mentioned, is eligible for filename generation.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 93 of 616
:
14.5 Arithmetic Expansion
A string of the form ‘$[ exp ]’ or ‘$(( exp ))’ is substituted with the value of the arithmetic expression
exp . exp is subjected to parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion before
it is evaluated. See Arithmetic Evaluation.

14.6 Brace Expansion


A string of the form ‘ foo { xx , yy , zz } bar ’ is expanded to the individual words ‘ fooxxbar ’,
‘ fooyybar ’ and ‘ foozzbar ’. Left-to-right order is preserved. This construct may be nested. Commas
may be quoted in order to include them literally in a word.

An expression of the form ‘{ n1 .. n2 }’, where n1 and n2 are integers, is expanded to every number
between n1 and n2 inclusive. If either number begins with a zero, all the resulting numbers will be
padded with leading zeroes to that minimum width, but for negative numbers the - character is also
included in the width. If the numbers are in decreasing order the resulting sequence will also be in
decreasing order.

An expression of the form ‘{ n1 .. n2 .. n3 }’, where n1 , n2 , and n3 are integers, is expanded as


above, but only every n3 th number starting from n1 is output. If n3 is negative the numbers are
output in reverse order, this is slightly different from simply swapping n1 and n2 in the case that
the step n3 doesn’t evenly divide the range. Zero padding can be specified in any of the three
numbers, specifying it in the third can be useful to pad for example ‘{-99..100..01}’ which is not
possible to specify by putting a 0 on either of the first two numbers (i.e. pad to two characters).

An expression of the form ‘{ c1 .. c2 }’, where c1 and c2 are single characters (which may be
multibyte characters), is expanded to every character in the range from c1 to c2 in whatever
character sequence is used internally. For characters with code points below 128 this is US ASCII
(this is the only case most users will need). If any intervening character is not If the character
sequence is reversed, the output is in reverse order, e.g. ‘{d..a}’ is substituted as ‘d c b a’.

If a brace expression matches none of the above forms, it is left unchanged, unless the option
BRACE_CCL (an abbreviation for ‘brace character class’) is set. In that case, it is expanded to a list of
the individual characters between the braces sorted into the order of the characters in the ASCII
character set (multibyte characters are not currently handled). The syntax is similar to a [...]
expression in filename generation: ‘-’ is treated specially to denote a range of characters, but ‘^’ or ‘!’
as the first character is treated normally. For example, ‘{abcdef0-9}’ expands to 16 words 0 1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 a b c d e f.

Note that brace expansion is not part of filename generation (globbing); an expression such as
*/{foo,bar} is split into two separate words */foo and */bar before filename generation takes place.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 94 of 616
:
In particular, note that this is liable to produce a ‘no match’ error if either of the two expressions
does not match; this is to be contrasted with */(foo|bar), which is treated as a single pattern but
otherwise has similar effects.

To combine brace expansion with array expansion, see the ${^ spec } form described in Parameter
Expansion above.

14.7 Filename Expansion


Each word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted ‘~’. If it does, then the word up to a ‘/’, or
the end of the word if there is no ‘/’, is checked to see if it can be substituted in one of the ways
described here. If so, then the ‘~’ and the checked portion are replaced with the appropriate
substitute value.

A ‘~’ by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME. A ‘~’ followed by a ‘+’ or a ‘-’ is replaced by current or
previous working directory, respectively.

A ‘~’ followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that position in the directory stack. ‘~0’ is
equivalent to ‘~+’, and ‘~1’ is the top of the stack. ‘~+’ followed by a number is replaced by the
directory at that position in the directory stack. ‘~+0’ is equivalent to ‘~+’, and ‘~+1’ is the top of the
stack. ‘~-’ followed by a number is replaced by the directory that many positions from the bottom of
the stack. ‘~-0’ is the bottom of the stack. The PUSHD_MINUS option exchanges the effects of ‘~+’ and
‘~-’ where they are followed by a number.

14.7.1 Dynamic named directories

If the function zsh_directory_name exists, or the shell variable zsh_directory_name_functions exists


and contains an array of function names, then the functions are used to implement dynamic
directory naming. The functions are tried in order until one returns status zero, so it is important
that functions test whether they can handle the case in question and return an appropriate status.

A ‘~’ followed by a string namstr in unquoted square brackets is treated specially as a dynamic
directory name. Note that the first unquoted closing square bracket always terminates namstr . The
shell function is passed two arguments: the string n (for name) and namstr . It should either set the
array reply to a single element which is the directory corresponding to the name and return status
zero (executing an assignment as the last statement is usually sufficient), or it should return status
non-zero. In the former case the element of reply is used as the directory; in the latter case the
substitution is deemed to have failed. If all functions fail and the option NOMATCH is set, an error
results.

The functions defined as above are also used to see if a directory can be turned into a name, for
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 95 of 616
:
example when printing the directory stack or when expanding %~ in prompts. In this case each
function is passed two arguments: the string d (for directory) and the candidate for dynamic naming.
The function should either return non-zero status, if the directory cannot be named by the function,
or it should set the array reply to consist of two elements: the first is the dynamic name for the
directory (as would appear within ‘~[ ... ]’), and the second is the prefix length of the directory to be
replaced. For example, if the trial directory is /home/myname/src/zsh and the dynamic name for
/home/myname/src (which has 16 characters) is s, then the function sets

reply=(s 16)

The directory name so returned is compared with possible static names for parts of the directory
path, as described below; it is used if the prefix length matched (16 in the example) is longer than
that matched by any static name.

It is not a requirement that a function implements both n and d calls; for example, it might be
appropriate for certain dynamic forms of expansion not to be contracted to names. In that case any
call with the first argument d should cause a non-zero status to be returned.

The completion system calls ‘zsh_directory_name c’ followed by equivalent calls to elements of the
array zsh_directory_name_functions, if it exists, in order to complete dynamic names for directories.
The code for this should be as for any other completion function as described in Completion System.

As a working example, here is a function that expands any dynamic names beginning with the string
p: to directories below /home/pws/perforce. In this simple case a static name for the directory would
be just as effective.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 96 of 616
:
zsh_directory_name() {
emulate -L zsh
setopt extendedglob
local -a match mbegin mend
if [[ $1 = d ]]; then
# turn the directory into a name
if [[ $2 = (#b)(/home/pws/perforce/)([^/]##)* ]]; then
typeset -ga reply
reply=(p:$match[2] $(( ${#match[1]} + ${#match[2]} )) )
else
return 1
fi
elif [[ $1 = n ]]; then
# turn the name into a directory
[[ $2 != (#b)p:(?*) ]] && return 1
typeset -ga reply
reply=(/home/pws/perforce/$match[1])
elif [[ $1 = c ]]; then
# complete names
local expl
local -a dirs
dirs=(/home/pws/perforce/*(/:t))
dirs=(p:${^dirs})
_wanted dynamic-dirs expl 'dynamic directory' compadd -S\] -a dirs
return
else
return 1
fi
return 0
}

14.7.2 Static named directories

A ‘~’ followed by anything not already covered consisting of any number of alphanumeric characters
or underscore (‘_’), hyphen (‘-’), or dot (‘.’) is looked up as a named directory, and replaced by the
value of that named directory if found. Named directories are typically home directories for users on
the system. They may also be defined if the text after the ‘~’ is the name of a string shell parameter
whose value begins with a ‘/’. Note that trailing slashes will be removed from the path to the
directory (though the original parameter is not modified).

It is also possible to define directory names using the -d option to the hash builtin.

When the shell prints a path (e.g. when expanding %~ in prompts or when printing the directory
stack), the path is checked to see if it has a named directory as its prefix. If so, then the prefix
portion is replaced with a ‘~’ followed by the name of the directory. The shorter of the two ways of
referring to the directory is used, i.e. either the directory name or the full path; the name is used if
they are the same length. The parameters $PWD and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in this
fashion.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 97 of 616
:
14.7.3 ‘=’ expansion

If a word begins with an unquoted ‘=’ and the EQUALS option is set, the remainder of the word is
taken as the name of a command. If a command exists by that name, the word is replaced by the full
pathname of the command.

14.7.4 Notes

Filename expansion is performed on the right hand side of a parameter assignment, including those
appearing after commands of the typeset family. In this case, the right hand side will be treated as a
colon-separated list in the manner of the PATH parameter, so that a ‘~’ or an ‘=’ following a ‘:’ is
eligible for expansion. All such behaviour can be disabled by quoting the ‘~’, the ‘=’, or the whole
expression (but not simply the colon); the EQUALS option is also respected.

If the option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument in the form
‘ identifier = expression ’ becomes eligible for file expansion as described in the previous
paragraph. Quoting the first ‘=’ also inhibits this.

14.8 Filename Generation


If a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the characters ‘*’, ‘(’, ‘|’, ‘<’, ‘[’, or ‘?’, it is regarded
as a pattern for filename generation, unless the GLOB option is unset. If the EXTENDED_GLOB
option is set, the ‘^’ and ‘#’ characters also denote a pattern; otherwise they are not treated specially
by the shell.

The word is replaced with a list of sorted filenames that match the pattern. If no matching pattern is
found, the shell gives an error message, unless the NULL_GLOB option is set, in which case the word
is deleted; or unless the NOMATCH option is unset, in which case the word is left unchanged.

In filename generation, the character ‘/’ must be matched explicitly; also, a ‘.’ must be matched
explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or after a ‘/’, unless the GLOB_DOTS option is set. No filename
generation pattern matches the files ‘.’ or ‘..’. In other instances of pattern matching, the ‘/’ and ‘.’ are
not treated specially.

14.8.1 Glob Operators

*
Matches any string, including the null string.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 98 of 616
:
?
Matches any character.

[...]
Matches any of the enclosed characters. Ranges of characters can be specified by separating two
characters by a ‘-’. A ‘-’ or ‘]’ may be matched by including it as the first character in the list. There are
also several named classes of characters, in the form ‘[: name :]’ with the following meanings. The first
set use the macros provided by the operating system to test for the given character combinations,
including any modifications due to local language settings, see ctype(3):

[:alnum:]
The character is alphanumeric

[:alpha:]
The character is alphabetic

[:ascii:]
The character is 7-bit, i.e. is a single-byte character without the top bit set.

[:blank:]
The character is a blank character

[:cntrl:]
The character is a control character

[:digit:]
The character is a decimal digit

[:graph:]
[:lower:]
The character is a lowercase letter

[:print:]
[:punct:]
[:space:]
The character is whitespace

[:upper:]
The character is an uppercase letter

[:xdigit:]
The character is a hexadecimal digit

Another set of named classes is handled internally by the shell and is not sensitive to the locale:

[:IDENT:]
The character is allowed to form part of a shell identifier, such as a parameter name; this test
respects the POSIX_IDENTIFIERS option

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 99 of 616
:
[:IFS:]
The character is used as an input field separator, i.e. is contained in the IFS parameter

[:IFSSPACE:]
The character is an IFS white space character; see the documentation for IFS in Parameters Used By
The Shell.

[:INCOMPLETE:]
Matches a byte that starts an incomplete multibyte character. Note that there may be a sequence of
more than one bytes that taken together form the prefix of a multibyte character. To test for a
potentially incomplete byte sequence, use the pattern ‘[[:INCOMPLETE:]]*’. This will never match a
sequence starting with a valid multibyte character.

[:INVALID:]
Matches a byte that does not start a valid multibyte character. Note this may be a continuation byte
of an incomplete multibyte character as any part of a multibyte string consisting of invalid and
incomplete multibyte characters is treated as single bytes.

[:WORD:]
The character is treated as part of a word; this test is sensitive to the value of the WORDCHARS
parameter

Note that the square brackets are additional to those enclosing the whole set of characters, so to
test for a single alphanumeric character you need ‘[[:alnum:]]’. Named character sets can be used
alongside other types, e.g. ‘[[:alpha:]0-9]’.

[^...]
[!...]
Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in the given set.

<[ x ]-[ y ]>


Matches any number in the range x to y , inclusive. Either of the numbers may be omitted to make
the range open-ended; hence ‘<->’ matches any number. To match individual digits, the [...] form is
more efficient.

Be careful when using other wildcards adjacent to patterns of this form; for example, <0-9>* will
actually match any number whatsoever at the start of the string, since the ‘<0-9>’ will match the first
digit, and the ‘*’ will match any others. This is a trap for the unwary, but is match always succeeds.
Expressions such as ‘<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*’ can be used instead.

(...)
Matches the enclosed pattern. This is used for grouping. If the KSH_GLOB option is set, then a ‘@’, ‘*’,
‘+’, ‘?’ or ‘!’ immediately preceding the ‘(’ is treated specially, as detailed below. The option SH_GLOB
prevents bare parentheses from being used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still
available.

Note that grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it is an error to have a ‘/’ within a group

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 100 of 616
:
(this only applies for patterns used in filename generation). There is one exception: a group of the
form ( pat /)# appearing as a complete path segment can match a sequence of directories. For
example, foo/(a*/)#bar matches foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.

x|y
Matches either x or y . This operator has lower precedence than any other. The ‘|’ character must
be within parentheses, to avoid interpretation as a pipeline. The alternatives are tried in order from
left to right.

^x
(Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.) Matches anything except the pattern x . This has a higher
precedence than ‘/’, so ‘^foo/bar’ will search directories in ‘.’ except ‘./foo’ for a file named ‘bar’.

x~y
(Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.) Match anything that matches the pattern x but does not
match y . This has lower precedence than any operator except ‘|’, so ‘*/*~foo/bar’ will search for all
files in all directories in ‘.’ and then exclude ‘foo/bar’ if there was such a match. Multiple patterns can
be excluded by ‘ foo ~ bar ~ baz ’. In the exclusion pattern ( y ), ‘/’ and ‘.’ are not treated specially the
way they usually are in globbing.

x#
(Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.) Matches zero or more occurrences of the pattern x . This
operator has high precedence; ‘12#’ is equivalent to ‘1(2#)’, rather than ‘(12)#’. It is an error for an
unquoted ‘#’ to follow something which cannot be repeated; this includes an empty string, a pattern
already followed by ‘##’, or parentheses when part of a KSH_GLOB pattern (for example, ‘!( foo )#’ is
invalid and must be replaced by ‘*(!( foo ))’).

x ##
(Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.) Matches one or more occurrences of the pattern x . This
operator has high precedence; ‘12##’ is equivalent to ‘1(2##)’, rather than ‘(12)##’. No more than two
active ‘#’ characters may appear together. (Note the potential clash with glob qualifiers in the form
‘1(2##)’ which should therefore be avoided.)

14.8.2 ksh-like Glob Operators

If the KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be modified by a preceding ‘@’, ‘*’, ‘+’, ‘?’
or ‘!’. This character need not be unquoted to have special effects, but the ‘(’ must be.

@(...)
Match the pattern in the parentheses. (Like ‘(...)’.)

*(...)
Match any number of occurrences. (Like ‘(...)#’, except that recursive directory searching is not

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 101 of 616
:
supported.)

+(...)
Match at least one occurrence. (Like ‘(...)##’, except that recursive directory searching is not
supported.)

?(...)
Match zero or one occurrence. (Like ‘(|...)’.)

!(...)
Match anything but the expression in parentheses. (Like ‘(^(...))’.)

14.8.3 Precedence

The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) ‘^’, ‘/’, ‘~’, ‘|’ (lowest); the remaining
operators are simply treated from left to right as part of a string, with ‘#’ and ‘##’ applying to the
shortest possible preceding unit (i.e. a character, ‘?’, ‘[...]’, ‘<...>’, or a parenthesised expression). As
mentioned above, a ‘/’ used as a directory separator may not appear inside parentheses, while a ‘|’
must do so; in patterns used in other contexts than filename generation (for example, in case
statements and tests within ‘[[...]]’), a ‘/’ is not special; and ‘/’ is also not special after a ‘~’ appearing
outside parentheses in a filename pattern.

14.8.4 Globbing Flags

There are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the end of the enclosing group or to
the end of the pattern; they require the EXTENDED_GLOB option. All take the form (# X ) where X
may have one of the following forms:

i
Case insensitive: upper or lower case characters in the pattern match upper or lower case
characters.

l
Lower case characters in the pattern match upper or lower case characters; upper case characters in
the pattern still only match upper case characters.

I
Case sensitive: locally negates the effect of i or l from that point on.

b
Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern; this does not work in filename
generation. When a pattern with a set of active parentheses is matched, the strings matched by the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 102 of 616
:
groups are stored in the array $match, the indices of the beginning of the matched parentheses in
the array $mbegin, and the indices of the end in the array $mend, with the first element of each
array corresponding to the first parenthesised group, and so on. These arrays are not otherwise
special to the shell. The indices use the same convention as does parameter substitution, so that
elements of $mend and $mbegin may be used in subscripts; the KSH_ARRAYS option is respected.
Sets of globbing flags are not considered parenthesised groups; only the first nine active
parentheses can be referenced.

For example,

foo="a_string_with_a_message"
if [[ $foo = (a|an)_(#b)(*) ]]; then
print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
fi

prints ‘string_with_a_message’. Note that the first set of parentheses is before the (#b) and does not
create a backreference.

Backreferences work with all forms of pattern matching other than filename generation, but note
that when performing matches on an entire array, such as ${ array # pattern }, or a global
substitution, such as ${ param // pat / repl }, only the data for the last match remains available. In
the case of global replacements this may still be useful. See the example for the m flag below.

The numbering of backreferences strictly follows the order of the opening parentheses from left to
right in the pattern string, although sets of parentheses may be nested. There are special rules for
parentheses followed by ‘#’ or ‘##’. Only the last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for
example, in ‘[[ abab = (#b)([ab])# ]]’, only the final ‘b’ is stored in match[1]. Thus extra parentheses
may be necessary to match the complete segment: for example, use ‘X((ab|cd)#)Y’ to match a whole
string of either ‘ab’ or ‘cd’ between ‘X’ and ‘Y’, using the value of $match[1] rather than $match[2].

If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some cases it may be necessary to initialise
them beforehand. If some of the backreferences fail to match — which happens if they are in an
alternate branch which fails to match, or if they are followed by # and matched zero times — then
the matched string is set to the empty string, and the start and end indices are set to -1.

Pattern matching with backreferences is slightly slower than without.

B
Deactivate backreferences, negating the effect of the b flag from that point on.

cN,M
The flag (#c N , M ) can be used anywhere that the # or ## operators can be used except in the
expressions ‘(*/)#’ and ‘(*/)##’ in filename generation, where ‘/’ has special meaning; it cannot be
combined with other globbing flags and a bad pattern error occurs if it is misplaced. It is equivalent
to the form { N , M } in regular expressions. The previous character or group is required to match
between N and M times, inclusive. The form (#c N ) requires exactly N matches; (#c, M ) is equivalent

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 103 of 616
:
to specifying N as 0; (#c N ,) specifies that there is no maximum limit on the number of matches.

m
Set references to the match data for the entire string matched; this is similar to backreferencing and
does not work in filename generation. The flag must be in effect at the end of the pattern, i.e. not
local to a group. The parameters $MATCH, $MBEGIN and $MEND will be set to the string matched
and to the indices of the beginning and end of the string, respectively. This is most useful in
parameter substitutions, as otherwise the string matched is obvious.

For example,

arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)


print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}

forces all the matches (i.e. all vowels) into uppercase, printing ‘vEldt jynx grImps wAqf zhO bUck’.

Unlike backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match references, other than the extra
substitutions required for the replacement strings in cases such as the example shown.

M
Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be created.

a num
Approximate matching: num errors are allowed in the string matched by the pattern. The rules for
this are described in the next subsection.

s, e
Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each must appear on its own: ‘(#s)’ and
‘(#e)’ are the only valid forms. The ‘(#s)’ flag succeeds only at the start of the test string, and the ‘(#e)’
flag succeeds only at the end of the test string; they correspond to ‘^’ and ‘$’ in standard regular
expressions. They are useful for matching path segments in patterns other than those in filename
generation (where path segments are in any case treated separately). For example, ‘*
((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*’ matches a path segment ‘test’ in any of the following strings: test, test/at/start,
at/end/test, in/test/middle.

Another use is in parameter substitution; for example ‘${array/(#s)A*Z(#e)}’ will remove only
elements of an array which match the complete pattern ‘A*Z’. There are other ways of performing
many operations of this type, however the combination of the substitution operations ‘/’ and ‘//’ with
the ‘(#s)’ and ‘(#e)’ flags provides a single simple and memorable method.

Note that assertions of the form ‘(^(#s))’ also work, i.e. match anywhere except at the start of the
string, although this actually means ‘anything except a zero-length portion at the start of the string’;
you need to use ‘(""~(#s))’ to match a zero-length portion of the string not at the start.

q
A ‘q’ and everything up to the closing parenthesis of the globbing flags are ignored by the pattern
matching code. This is intended to support the use of glob qualifiers, see below. The result is that
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 104 of 616
:
the pattern ‘(#b)(*).c(#q.)’ can be used both for globbing and for matching against a string. In the
former case, the ‘(#q.)’ will be treated as a glob qualifier and the ‘(#b)’ will not be useful, while in the
latter case the ‘(#b)’ is useful for backreferences and the ‘(#q.)’ will be ignored. Note that colon
modifiers in the glob qualifiers are also not applied in ordinary pattern matching.

u
Respect the current locale in determining the presence of multibyte characters in a pattern,
provided the shell was compiled with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT. This overrides the MULTIBYTE option;
the default behaviour is taken from the option. Compare U. (Mnemonic: typically multibyte
characters are from Unicode in the UTF-8 encoding, although any extension of ASCII supported by
the system library may be used.)

U
All characters are considered to be a single byte long. The opposite of u. This overrides the
MULTIBYTE option.

For example, the test string fooxx can be matched by the pattern (#i)FOOXX, but not by (#l)FOOXX,
(#i)FOO(#I)XX or ((#i)FOOX)X. The string (#ia2)readme specifies case-insensitive matching of readme
with up to two errors.

When using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and EXTENDED_GLOB must be set and the
left parenthesis should be preceded by @. Note also that the flags do not affect letters inside [...]
groups, in other words (#i)[a-z] still matches only lowercase letters. Finally, note that when
examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must be searched for all files which match,
so that a pattern of the form (#i)/foo/bar/... is potentially slow.

14.8.5 Approximate Matching

When matching approximately, the shell keeps a count of the errors found, which cannot exceed the
number specified in the (#a num ) flags. Four types of error are recognised:

1.
Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.

2.
Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.

3.
A character missing in the target string, as with the pattern road and target string rod.

4.
An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove and strove.

Thus, the pattern (#a3)abcd matches dcba, with the errors occurring by using the first rule twice and
the second once, grouping the string as [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 105 of 616
:
Non-literal parts of the pattern must match exactly, including characters in character ranges: hence
(#a1)??? matches strings of length four, by applying rule 4 to an empty part of the pattern, but not
strings of length two, since all the ? must match. Other characters which must match exactly are
initial dots in filenames (unless the GLOB_DOTS option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that
a/bc is two errors from ab/c (the slash cannot be transposed with another character). Similarly,
errors are counted separately for non-contiguous strings in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef is two
errors from aebf.

When using exclusion via the ~ operator, approximate matching is treated entirely separately for the
excluded part and must be activated separately. Thus, (#a1)README~READ_ME matches READ.ME
but not READ_ME, as the trailing READ_ME is matched without approximation. However,
(#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME does not match any pattern of the form READ ? ME as all such forms
are now excluded.

Apart from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however, the maximum errors allowed
may be altered locally, and this can be delimited by grouping. For example, (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox
allows one error in total, which may not occur in the dog section, and the pattern
(#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox is equivalent. Note that the point at which an error is first found is the
crucial one for establishing whether to use approximation; for example, (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz will not
match abcdxyz, because the error occurs at the ‘x’, where approximation is turned off.

Entire path segments may be matched approximately, so that ‘(#a1)/foo/d/is/available/at/the/bar’


allows one error in any path segment. This is much less efficient than without the (#a1), however,
since every directory in the path must be scanned for a possible approximate match. It is best to
place the (#a1) after any path segments which are known to be correct.

14.8.6 Recursive Globbing

A pathname component of the form ‘( foo /)#’ matches a path consisting of zero or more directories
matching the pattern foo .

As a shorthand, ‘**/’ is equivalent to ‘(*/)#’; note that this therefore matches files in the current
directory as well as subdirectories. Thus:

ls -ld -- (*/)#bar

or

ls -ld -- **/bar

does a recursive directory search for files named ‘bar’ (potentially including the file ‘bar’ in the
current directory). This form does not follow symbolic links; the alternative form ‘***/’ does, but is
otherwise identical. Neither of these can be combined with other forms of globbing within the same

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 106 of 616
:
path segment; in that case, the ‘*’ operators revert to their usual effect.

Even shorter forms are available when the option GLOB_STAR_SHORT is set. In that case if no /
immediately follows a ** or *** they are treated as if both a / plus a further * are present. Hence:

setopt GLOBSTARSHORT
ls -ld -- **.c

is equivalent to

ls -ld -- **/*.c

14.8.7 Glob Qualifiers

Patterns used for filename generation may end in a list of qualifiers enclosed in parentheses. The
qualifiers specify which filenames that otherwise match the given pattern will be inserted in the
argument list.

If the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses containing no ‘|’ or ‘(’
characters (or ‘~’ if it is special) is taken as a set of glob qualifiers. A glob subexpression that would
normally be taken as glob qualifiers, for example ‘(^x)’, can be forced to be treated as part of the
glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in this case producing ‘((^x))’.

If the option EXTENDED_GLOB is set, a different syntax for glob qualifiers is available, namely ‘(#q x )’
where x is any of the same glob qualifiers used in the other format. The qualifiers must still appear
at the end of the pattern. However, with this syntax multiple glob qualifiers may be chained
together. They are treated as a logical AND of the individual sets of flags. Also, as the syntax is
unambiguous, the expression will be treated as glob qualifiers just as long any parentheses
contained within it are balanced; appearance of ‘|’, ‘(’ or ‘~’ does not negate the effect. Note that
qualifiers will be recognised in this form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end of files if both
options are set; however, mixed syntax should probably be avoided for the sake of clarity. Note that
within conditions using the ‘[[’ form the presence of a parenthesised expression (#q ... ) at the end
of a string indicates that globbing should be performed; the expression may include glob qualifiers,
but it is also valid if it is simply (#q). This does not apply to the right hand side of pattern match
operators as the syntax already has special significance.

A qualifier may be any one of the following:

/
directories

F
‘full’ (i.e. non-empty) directories. Note that the opposite sense (^F) expands to empty directories and
all non-directories. Use (/^F) for empty directories.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 107 of 616
:
.
plain files

@
symbolic links

=
sockets

p
named pipes (FIFOs)

*
%
device files (character or block special)

%b
block special files

%c
character special files

r
owner-readable files (0400)

w
x
A
group-readable files (0040)

I
E
R
world-readable files (0004)

W
X
s
setuid files (04000)

S
setgid files (02000)

t
files with the sticky bit (01000)

f spec
files with access rights matching spec . This spec may be a octal number optionally preceded by a

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 108 of 616
:
‘=’, a ‘+’, or a ‘-’. If none of these characters is given, the behavior is the same as for ‘=’. The octal
number describes the mode bits to be expected, if combined with a ‘=’, the value given must match
the file-modes exactly, with a ‘+’, at least the bits in the given number must be set in the file-modes,
and with a ‘-’, the bits in the number must not be set. Giving a ‘?’ instead of a octal digit anywhere in
the number ensures that the corresponding bits in the file-modes are not checked, this is only useful
in combination with ‘=’.

If the qualifier ‘f’ is followed by any other character anything up to the next matching character (‘[’, ‘{’,
and ‘<’ match ‘]’, ‘}’, and ‘>’ respectively, any other character matches itself) is taken as a list of
comma-separated sub-spec s. Each sub-spec may be either an octal number as described above or
a list of any of the characters ‘u’, ‘g’, ‘o’, and ‘a’, followed by a ‘=’, a ‘+’, or a ‘-’, followed by a list of any
of the characters ‘r’, ‘w’, ‘x’, ‘s’, and ‘t’, or an octal digit. The first list of characters specify which access
rights are to be checked. If a ‘u’ is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a ‘g’ is given, those
of the group are checked, a ‘o’ means to test those of other users, and the ‘a’ says to test all three
groups. The ‘=’, ‘+’, and ‘-’ again says how the modes are to be checked and have the same meaning
as described for the first form above. The second list of characters finally says which access rights
are to be expected: ‘r’ for read access, ‘w’ for write access, ‘x’ for the right to execute the file (or to
search a directory), ‘s’ for the setuid and setgid bits, and ‘t’ for the sticky bit.

Thus, ‘*(f70?)’ gives the files for which the owner has read, write, and execute permission, and for
which other group members have no rights, independent of the permissions for other users. The
pattern ‘*(f-100)’ gives all files for which the owner does not have execute permission, and ‘*
(f:gu+w,o-rx:)’ gives the files for which the owner and the other members of the group have at least
write permission, and for which other users don’t have read or execute permission.

e string
+ cmd
The string will be executed as shell code. The filename will be included in the list if and only if the
code returns a zero status (usually the status of the last command).

In the first form, the first character after the ‘e’ will be used as a separator and anything up to the
next matching separator will be taken as the string ; ‘[’, ‘{’, and ‘<’ match ‘]’, ‘}’, and ‘>’, respectively,
while any other character matches itself. Note that expansions must be quoted in the string to
prevent them from being expanded before globbing is done. string is then executed as shell code.
The string globqual is appended to the array zsh_eval_context the duration of execution.

During the execution of string the filename currently being tested is available in the parameter
REPLY; the parameter may be altered to a string to be inserted into the list instead of the original
filename. In addition, the parameter reply may be set to an array or a string, which overrides the
value of REPLY. If set to an array, the latter is inserted into the command line word by word.

For example, suppose a directory contains a single file ‘lonely’. Then the expression ‘*(e:’reply=
(${REPLY}{1,2})’:)’ will cause the words ‘lonely1’ and ‘lonely2’ to be inserted into the command line.
Note the quoting of string .

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 109 of 616
:
The form + cmd has the same effect, but no delimiters appear around cmd . Instead, cmd is taken as
the longest sequence of characters following the + that are alphanumeric or underscore. Typically
cmd will be the name of a shell function that contains the appropriate test. For example,

nt() { [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] }


NTREF=reffile
ls -ld -- *(+nt)

lists all files in the directory that have been modified more recently than reffile.

d dev
files on the device dev

l[-|+] ct
files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+), or equal to ct

U
files owned by the effective user ID

G
files owned by the effective group ID

u id
files owned by user ID id if that is a number. Otherwise, id specifies a user name: the character
after the ‘u’ will be taken as a separator and the string between it and the next matching separator
will be taken as a user name. The starting separators ‘[’, ‘{’, and ‘<’ match the final separators ‘]’, ‘}’,
and ‘>’, respectively; any other character matches itself. The selected files are those owned by this
user. For example, ‘u:foo:’ or ‘u[foo]’ selects files owned by user ‘foo’.

g id
like u id but with group IDs or names

a[Mwhms][-|+] n
files accessed exactly n days ago. Files accessed within the last n days are selected using a negative
value for n (- n ). Files accessed more than n days ago are selected by a positive n value (+ n ).
Optional unit specifiers ‘M’, ‘w’, ‘h’, ‘m’ or ‘s’ (e.g. ‘ah5’) cause the check to be performed with months
(of 30 days), weeks, hours, minutes or seconds instead of days, respectively. An explicit ‘d’ for days is
also allowed.

Any fractional part of the difference between the access time and the current part in the appropriate
units is ignored in the comparison. For instance, ‘echo *(ah-5)’ would echo files accessed within the
last five hours, while ‘echo *(ah+5)’ would echo files accessed at least six hours ago, as times strictly
between five and six hours are treated as five hours.

m[Mwhms][-|+] n
like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file modification time.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 110 of 616
:
c[Mwhms][-|+] n
like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file inode change time.

L[+|-] n
files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n bytes in length.

If this flag is directly followed by a size specifier ‘k’ (‘K’), ‘m’ (‘M’), or ‘p’ (‘P’) (e.g. ‘Lk-50’) the check is
performed with kilobytes, megabytes, or blocks (of 512 bytes) instead. (On some systems additional
specifiers are available for gigabytes, ‘g’ or ‘G’, and terabytes, ‘t’ or ‘T’.) If a size specifier is used a file
is regarded as "exactly" the size if the file size rounded up to the next unit is equal to the test size.
Hence ‘*(Lm1)’ matches files from 1 byte up to 1 Megabyte inclusive. Note also that the set of files
"less than" the test size only includes files that would not match the equality test; hence ‘*(Lm-1)’
only matches files of zero size.

^
negates all qualifiers following it

-
toggles between making the qualifiers work on symbolic links (the default) and the files they point
to, if any; any symbolic link for whose target the ‘stat’ system call fails (whatever the cause of the
failure) is treated as a file in its own right

M
sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern

T
appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames, analogous to the LIST_TYPES option, for the
current pattern (overrides M)

N
sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern

D
sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern

n
sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern

Yn
enables short-circuit mode: the pattern will expand to at most n filenames. If more than n matches
exist, only the first n matches in directory traversal order will be considered.

Implies oN when no o c qualifier is used.

oc
specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. The following values of c sort in the following
ways:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 111 of 616
:
n
By name.

L
By the size (length) of the files.

l
By number of links.

a
By time of last access, youngest first.

m
By time of last modification, youngest first.

c
By time of last inode change, youngest first.

d
By directories: files in subdirectories appear before those in the current directory at each level of the
search — this is best combined with other criteria, for example ‘odon’ to sort on names for files
within the same directory.

N
No sorting is performed.

e string
+ cmd
Sort by shell code (see below).

Note that the modifiers ^ and - are used, so ‘*(^-oL)’ gives a list of all files sorted by file size in
descending order, following any symbolic links. Unless oN is used, multiple order specifiers may
occur to resolve ties.

The default sorting is n (by name) unless the Y glob qualifier is used, in which case it is N (unsorted).

oe and o+ are special cases; they are each followed by shell code, delimited as for the e glob
qualifier and the + glob qualifier respectively (see above). The code is executed for each matched file
with the parameter REPLY set to the name of the file on entry and globsort appended to
zsh_eval_context. The code should modify the parameter REPLY in some fashion. On return, the
value of the parameter is used instead of the file name as the string on which to sort. Unlike other
sort operators, oe and o+ may be repeated, but note that the maximum number of sort operators of
any kind that may appear in any glob expression is 12.

Oc
like ‘o’, but sorts in descending order; i.e. ‘*(^o c )’ is the same as ‘*(O c )’ and ‘*(^O c )’ is the same as
‘*(o c )’; ‘Od’ puts files in the current directory before those in subdirectories at each level of the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 112 of 616
:
search.

[ beg [, end ]]
specifies which of the matched filenames should be included in the returned list. The syntax is the
same as for array subscripts. beg and the optional end may be mathematical expressions. As in
parameter subscripting they may be negative to make them count from the last match backward.
E.g.: ‘*(-OL[1,3])’ gives a list of the names of the three largest files.

P string
The string will be prepended to each glob match as a separate word. string is delimited in the
same way as arguments to the e glob qualifier described above. The qualifier can be repeated; the
words are prepended separately so that the resulting command line contains the words in the same
order they were given in the list of glob qualifiers.

A typical use for this is to prepend an option before all occurrences of a file name; for example, the
pattern ‘*(P:-f:)’ produces the command line arguments ‘-f file1 -f file2 ...’

If the modifier ^ is active, then string will be appended instead of prepended. Prepending and
appending is done independently so both can be used on the same glob expression; for example by
writing ‘*(P:foo:^P:bar:^P:baz:)’ which produces the command line arguments ‘foo baz file1 bar ...’

More than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The whole list matches if at
least one of the sublists matches (they are ‘or’ed, the qualifiers in the sublists are ‘and’ed). Some
qualifiers, however, affect all matches generated, independent of the sublist in which they are given.
These are the qualifiers ‘M’, ‘T’, ‘N’, ‘D’, ‘n’, ‘o’, ‘O’ and the subscripts given in brackets (‘[ ... ]’).

If a ‘:’ appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression in parenthesis is interpreted as a
modifier (see Modifiers in History Expansion). Each modifier must be introduced by a separate ‘:’.
Note also that the result after modification does not have to be an existing file. The name of any
existing file can be followed by a modifier of the form ‘(: ... )’ even if no actual filename generation
is performed, although note that the presence of the parentheses causes the entire expression to be
subjected to any global pattern matching options such as NULL_GLOB. Thus:

ls -ld -- *(-/)

lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and

ls -ld -- *(-@)

lists all broken symbolic links, and

ls -ld -- *(%W)

ls -ld -- *(W,X)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 113 of 616
:
lists all files in the current directory that are

print -rC1 /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)

outputs the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the string ‘foo’ in /tmp, ignoring
symlinks, and

ls -ld -- *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)

lists all files having a link count of one whose names contain a dot (but not those starting with a dot,
since GLOB_DOTS is explicitly switched off) except for lex.c, lex.h, parse.c and parse.h.

print -rC1 b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)

demonstrates how colon modifiers and other qualifiers may be chained together. The ordinary
qualifier ‘.’ is applied first, then the colon modifiers in order from left to right. So if EXTENDED_GLOB
is set and the base pattern matches the regular file builtin.pro, the shell will print ‘shmiltin.shmo’.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 114 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

15 Parameters
15.1 Description
15.2 Array Parameters
15.2.1 Array Subscripts
15.2.2 Array Element Assignment
15.2.3 Subscript Flags
15.2.4 Subscript Parsing
15.3 Positional Parameters
15.4 Local Parameters
15.5 Parameters Set By The Shell
<S>
15.6 Parameters Used By The Shell

15 Parameters

15.1 Description
A parameter has a name, a value, and a number of attributes. A name may be any sequence of
alphanumeric characters and underscores, or the single characters ‘*’, ‘@’, ‘#’, ‘?’, ‘-’, ‘$’, or ‘!’. A
parameter whose name begins with an alphanumeric or underscore is also referred to as a variable.

The attributes of a parameter determine the type of its value, often referred to as the parameter
type or variable type, and also control other processing that may be applied to the value when it is
referenced. The value type may be a scalar (a string, an integer, or a floating point number), an array
(indexed numerically), or an associative array (an unordered set of name-value pairs, indexed by
name, also referred to as a hash).

Named scalar parameters may have the exported, -x, attribute, to copy them into the process
environment, which is then passed from the shell to any new processes that it starts. Exported
parameters are called environment variables. The shell also imports environment variables at startup
time and automatically marks the corresponding parameters as exported. Some environment
variables are not imported for reasons of security or because they would interfere with the correct
operation of other shell features.

Parameters may also be special, that is, they have a predetermined meaning to the shell. Special
parameters cannot have their type changed or their readonly attribute turned off, and if a special
parameter is unset, then later recreated, the special properties will be retained.

To declare the type of a parameter, or to assign a string or numeric value to a scalar parameter, use
the typeset builtin.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 115 of 616
:
The value of a scalar parameter may also be assigned by writing:

name = value

In scalar assignment, value is expanded as a single string, in which the elements of arrays are
joined together; filename expansion is not performed unless the option GLOB_ASSIGN is set.

When the integer attribute, -i, or a floating point attribute, -E or -F, is set for name , the value is
subject to arithmetic evaluation. Furthermore, by replacing ‘=’ with ‘+=’, a parameter can be
incremented or appended to. See Array Parameters and Arithmetic Evaluation for additional forms
of assignment.

Note that assignment may implicitly change the attributes of a parameter. For example, assigning a
number to a variable in arithmetic evaluation may change its type to integer or float, and with
GLOB_ASSIGN assigning a pattern to a variable may change its type to an array.

To reference the value of a parameter, write ‘$ name ’ or ‘${ name }’. See Parameter Expansion for
complete details. That section also explains the effect of the difference between scalar and array
assignment on parameter expansion.

15.2 Array Parameters


To assign an array value, write one of:

set -A name value ...

name =( value ...)

name =([ key ]= value ...)

If no parameter name exists, an ordinary array parameter is created. If the parameter name exists
and is a scalar, it is replaced by a new array.

In the third form, key is an expression that will be evaluated in arithmetic context (in its simplest
form, an integer) that gives the index of the element to be assigned with value . In this form any
elements not explicitly mentioned that come before the largest index to which a value is assigned

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 116 of 616
:
are assigned an empty string. The indices may be in any order. Note that this syntax is strict: [ and ]=
must not be quoted, and key may not consist of the unquoted string ]=, but is otherwise treated as
a simple string. The enhanced forms of subscript expression that may be used when directly
subscripting a variable name, described in the section ‘Array Subscripts’ below, are not available.

The syntaxes with and without the explicit key may be mixed. An implicit key is deduced by
incrementing the index from the previously assigned element. Note that it is not treated as an error
if latter assignments in this form overwrite earlier assignments.

For example, assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set, the following:

array=(one [3]=three four)

causes the array variable array to contain four elements one, an empty string, three and four, in that
order.

In the forms where only value is specified, full command line expansion is performed.

In the [ key ]= value form, both key and value undergo all forms of expansion allowed for single
word shell expansions (this does not include filename generation); these are as performed by the
parameter expansion flag (e) as described in Parameter Expansion. Nested parentheses may
surround value and are included as part of the value, which is joined into a plain string; this differs
from ksh which allows the values themselves to be arrays. A future version of zsh may support that.
To cause the brackets to be interpreted as a character class for filename generation, and therefore
to treat the resulting list of files as a set of values, quote the equal sign using any form of quoting.
Example:

name =([a-z]’=’*)

To append to an array without changing the existing values, use one of the following:

name +=( value ...)

name +=([ key ]= value ...)

In the second form key may specify an existing index as well as an index off the end of the old
array; any existing value is overwritten by value . Also, it is possible to use [ key ]+= value to
append to the existing value at that index.

Within the parentheses on the right hand side of either form of the assignment, newlines and
semicolons are treated the same as white space, separating individual value s. Any consecutive
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 117 of 616
:
sequence of such characters has the same effect.

Ordinary array parameters may also be explicitly declared with:

typeset -a name

Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:

typeset -A name

When name refers to an associative array, the list in an assignment is interpreted as alternating keys
and values:

set -A name key value ...

name =( key value ...)

name =([ key ]= value ...)

Note that only one of the two syntaxes above may be used in any given assignment; the forms may
not be mixed. This is unlike the case of numerically indexed arrays.

Every key must have a value in this case. Note that this assigns to the entire array, deleting any
elements that do not appear in the list. The append syntax may also be used with an associative
array:

name +=( key value ...)

name +=([ key ]= value ...)

This adds a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and replaces the value for the
existing key if it is. In the second form it is also possible to use [ key ]+= value to append to the
existing value at that key. Expansion is performed identically to the corresponding forms for normal
arrays, as described above.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 118 of 616
:
To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:

set -A name

name =()

15.2.1 Array Subscripts

Individual elements of an array may be selected using a subscript. A subscript of the form ‘[ exp ]’
selects the single element exp , where exp is an arithmetic expression which will be subject to
arithmetic expansion as if it were surrounded by ‘$((...))’. The elements are numbered beginning with
1, unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case they are numbered from zero.

Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name, thus ‘${foo[2]}’ is
equivalent to ‘$foo[2]’. If the KSH_ARRAYS option is set, the braced form is the only one that works,
as bracketed expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.

If the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then by default accesses to an array element with a subscript
that evaluates to zero return an empty string, while an attempt to write such an element is treated
as an error. For backward compatibility the KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT option can be set to cause
subscript values 0 and 1 to be equivalent; see the description of the option in Description of
Options.

The same subscripting syntax is used for associative arrays, except that no arithmetic expansion is
applied to exp . However, the parsing rules for arithmetic expressions still apply, which affects the
way that certain special characters must be protected from interpretation. See Subscript Parsing
below for details.

A subscript of the form ‘[*]’ or ‘[@]’ evaluates to all elements of an array; there is no difference
between the two except when they appear within double quotes. ‘"$foo[*]"’ evaluates to ‘"$foo[1]
$foo[2] ..."’, whereas ‘"$foo[@]"’ evaluates to ‘"$foo[1]" "$foo[2]" ...’. For associative arrays, ‘[*]’ or ‘[@]’
evaluate to all the values, in no particular order. Note that this does not substitute the keys; see the
documentation for the ‘k’ flag under Parameter Expansion for complete details. When an array
parameter is referenced as ‘$ name ’ (with no subscript) it evaluates to ‘$ name [*]’, unless the
KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case it evaluates to ‘${ name [0]}’ (for an associative array, this
means the value of the key ‘0’, which may not exist even if there are values for other keys).

A subscript of the form ‘[ exp1 , exp2 ]’ selects all elements in the range exp1 to exp2 , inclusive.
(Associative arrays are unordered, and so do not support ranges.) If one of the subscripts evaluates
to a negative number, say - n , then the n th element from the end of the array is used. Thus

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 119 of 616
:
‘$foo[-3]’ is the third element from the end of the array foo, and ‘$foo[1,-1]’ is the same as ‘$foo[*]’.

Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in which case the subscripts specify a
substring to be extracted. For example, if FOO is set to ‘foobar’, then ‘echo $FOO[2,5]’ prints ‘ooba’.
Note that some forms of subscripting described below perform pattern matching, and in that case
the substring extends from the start of the match of the first subscript to the end of the match of
the second subscript. For example,

string="abcdefghijklm"
print ${string[(r)d?,(r)h?]}

prints ‘defghi’. This is an obvious generalisation of the rule for single-character matches. For a single
subscript, only a single character is referenced (not the range of characters covered by the match).

Note that in substring operations the second subscript is handled differently by the r and R
subscript flags: the former takes the shortest match as the length and the latter the longest match.
Hence in the former case a * at the end is redundant while in the latter case it matches the whole
remainder of the string. This does not affect the result of the single subscript case as here the length
of the match is irrelevant.

15.2.2 Array Element Assignment

A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:

name [ exp ]= value

In this form of assignment the element or range specified by exp is replaced by the expression on
the right side. An array (but not an associative array) may be created by assignment to a range or
element. Arrays do not nest, so assigning a parenthesized list of values to an element or range
changes the number of elements in the array, shifting the other elements to accommodate the new
values. (This is not supported for associative arrays.)

This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:

typeset " name [ exp ]"= value

The value may not be a parenthesized list in this case; only single-element assignments may be
made with typeset. Note that quotes are necessary in this case to prevent the brackets from being
interpreted as filename generation operators. The noglob precommand modifier could be used
instead.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 120 of 616
:
To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign ‘()’ to that element. To delete an element of an
associative array, use the unset command:

unset " name [ exp ]"

15.2.3 Subscript Flags

If the opening bracket, or the comma in a range, in any subscript expression is directly followed by
an opening parenthesis, the string up to the matching closing one is considered to be a list of flags,
as in ‘ name [( flags ) exp ]’.

The flags s, n and b take an argument; the delimiter is shown below as ‘:’, but any character, or the
matching pairs ‘(...)’, ‘{...}’, ‘[...]’, or ‘<...>’, may be used, but note that ‘<...>’ can only be used if the
subscript is inside a double quoted expression or a parameter substitution enclosed in braces as
otherwise the expression is interpreted as a redirection.

The flags currently understood are:

w
If the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes subscripting work on words instead of
characters. The default word separator is whitespace. When combined with the i or I flag, the effect
is to produce the index of the first character of the first/last word which matches the given pattern;
note that a failed match in this case always yields 0.

s: string :
This gives the string that separates words (for use with the w flag). The delimiter character : is
arbitrary; see above.

p
Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in the string argument of a subsequent ‘s’
flag.

f
If the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes subscripting work on lines instead of
characters, i.e. with elements separated by newlines. This is a shorthand for ‘pws:\n:’.

r
Reverse subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as a pattern and the result is the first
matching array element, substring or word (if the parameter is an array, if it is a scalar, or if it is a
scalar and the ‘w’ flag is given, respectively). The subscript used is the number of the matching
element, so that pairs of subscripts such as ‘$foo[(r)??,3]’ and ‘$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]’ are possible if the
parameter is not an associative array. If the parameter is an associative array, only the value part of

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 121 of 616
:
each pair is compared to the pattern, and the result is that value.

If a search through an ordinary array failed, the search sets the subscript to one past the end of the
array, and hence ${array[(r) pattern ]} will substitute the empty string. Thus the success of a search
can be tested by using the (i) flag, for example (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not in effect):

[[ ${array[(i)pattern]} -le ${#array} ]]

If KSH_ARRAYS is in effect, the -le should be replaced by -lt.

R
Like ‘r’, but gives the last match. For associative arrays, gives all possible matches. May be used for
assigning to ordinary array elements, but not for assigning to associative arrays. On failure, for
normal arrays this has the effect of returning the element corresponding to subscript 0; this is
empty unless one of the options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is in effect.

Note that in subscripts with both ‘r’ and ‘R’ pattern characters are active even if they were
substituted for a parameter (regardless of the setting of GLOB_SUBST which controls this feature in
normal pattern matching). The flag ‘e’ can be added to inhibit pattern matching. As this flag does not
inhibit other forms of substitution, care is still required; using a parameter to hold the key has the
desired effect:

key2='original key'
print ${array[(Re)$key2]}

i
Like ‘r’, but gives the index of the match instead; this may not be combined with a second argument.
On the left side of an assignment, behaves like ‘r’. For associative arrays, the key part of each pair is
compared to the pattern, and the first matching key found is the result. On failure substitutes the
length of the array plus one, as discussed under the description of ‘r’, or the empty string for an
associative array.

Note: Although ‘i’ may be applied to a scalar substitution to find the offset of a substring, the results
are likely to be misleading when searching within substitutions that yield an empty string, or when
searching for the empty substring.

I
Like ‘i’, but gives the index of the last match, or all possible matching keys in an associative array. On
failure substitutes 0, or the empty string for an associative array. This flag is best when testing for
values or keys that do not exist.

Note: If the option KSH_ARRAYS is in effect and no match is found, the result is indistinguishable
from the case when the first element of the array matches.

k
If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes the keys to be interpreted as patterns,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 122 of 616
:
and returns the value for the first key found where exp is matched by the key. Note this could be
any such key as no ordering of associative arrays is defined. This flag does not work on the left side
of an assignment to an associative array element. If used on another type of parameter, this
behaves like ‘r’.

K
On an associative array this is like ‘k’ but returns all values where exp is matched by the keys. On
other types of parameters this has the same effect as ‘R’.

n: expr :
If combined with ‘r’, ‘R’, ‘i’ or ‘I’, makes them give the n th or n th last match (if expr evaluates to n ).
This flag is ignored when the array is associative. The delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

b: expr :
If combined with ‘r’, ‘R’, ‘i’ or ‘I’, makes them begin at the n th or n th last element, word, or character
(if expr evaluates to n ). This flag is ignored when the array is associative. The delimiter character :
is arbitrary; see above.

e
This flag causes any pattern matching that would be performed on the subscript to use plain string
matching instead. Hence ‘${array[(re)*]}’ matches only the array element whose value is *. Note that
other forms of substitution such as parameter substitution are not inhibited.

This flag can also be used to force * or @ to be interpreted as a single key rather than as a reference
to all values. It may be used for either purpose on the left side of an assignment.

See Parameter Expansion Flags (Parameter Expansion) for additional ways to manipulate the results
of array subscripting.

15.2.4 Subscript Parsing

This discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to patterns used for reverse
subscripting (the ‘r’, ‘R’, ‘i’, etc. flags), but it may also affect parameter substitutions that appear as
part of an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.

To avoid subscript parsing limitations in assignments to associative array elements, use the append
syntax:

aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')

The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is that all text between the opening
‘[’ and the closing ‘]’ is interpreted as if it were in double quotes (Quoting). However, unlike double
quotes which normally cannot nest, subscript expressions may appear inside double-quoted strings
or inside other subscript expressions (or both!), so the rules have two important differences.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 123 of 616
:
The first difference is that brackets (‘[’ and ‘]’) must appear as balanced pairs in a subscript
expression unless they are preceded by a backslash (‘\’). Therefore, within a subscript expression
(and unlike true double-quoting) the sequence ‘\[’ becomes ‘[’, and similarly ‘\]’ becomes ‘]’. This
applies even in cases where a backslash is not normally required; for example, the pattern ‘[^[]’ (to
match any character other than an open bracket) should be written ‘[^\[]’ in a reverse-subscript
pattern. However, note that ‘\[^\[\]’ and even ‘\[^[]’ mean the same thing, because backslashes are
always stripped when they appear before brackets!

The same rule applies to parentheses (‘(’ and ‘)’) and braces (‘{’ and ‘}’): they must appear either in
balanced pairs or preceded by a backslash, and backslashes that protect parentheses or braces are
removed during parsing. This is because parameter expansions may be surrounded by balanced
braces, and subscript flags are introduced by balanced parentheses.

The second difference is that a double-quote (‘"’) may appear as part of a subscript expression
without being preceded by a backslash, and therefore that the two characters ‘\"’ remain as two
characters in the subscript (in true double-quoting, ‘\"’ becomes ‘"’). However, because of the
standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that appear must occur in balanced pairs unless
preceded by a backslash. This makes it more difficult to write a subscript expression that contains
an odd number of double-quote characters, but the reason for this difference is so that when a
subscript expression appears inside true double-quotes, one can still write ‘\"’ (rather than ‘\\\"’) for
‘"’.

To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in an assignment, use the typeset builtin and an
enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to the value of that key, again use double quotes:

typeset -A aa
typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"

It is important to note that the quoting rules do not change when a parameter expansion with a
subscript is nested inside another subscript expression. That is, it is not necessary to use additional
backslashes within the inner subscript expression; they are removed only once, from the innermost
subscript outwards. Parameters are also expanded from the innermost subscript first, as each
expansion is encountered left to right in the outer expression.

A further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing is not different from double
quote parsing. As in true double-quoting, the sequences ‘\*’, and ‘\@’ remain as two characters when
they appear in a subscript expression. To use a literal ‘*’ or ‘@’ as an associative array key, the ‘e’ flag
must be used:

typeset -A aa
aa[(e)*]=star
print $aa[(e)*]

A last detail must be considered when reverse subscripting is performed. Parameters appearing in
the subscript expression are first expanded and then the complete expression is interpreted as a

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 124 of 616
:
pattern. This has two effects: first, parameters behave as if GLOB_SUBST were on (and it cannot be
turned off); second, backslashes are interpreted twice, once when parsing the array subscript and
again when parsing the pattern. In a reverse subscript, it’s necessary to use four backslashes to
cause a single backslash to match literally in the pattern. For complex patterns, it is often easiest to
assign the desired pattern to a parameter and then refer to that parameter in the subscript, because
then the backslashes, brackets, parentheses, etc., are seen only when the complete expression is
converted to a pattern. To match the value of a parameter literally in a reverse subscript, rather than
as a pattern, use ‘${(q) name }’ (Parameter Expansion) to quote the expanded value.

Note that the ‘k’ and ‘K’ flags are reverse subscripting for an ordinary array, but are not reverse
subscripting for an associative array! (For an associative array, the keys in the array itself are
interpreted as patterns by those flags; the subscript is a plain string in that case.)

One final note, not directly related to subscripting: the numeric names of positional parameters
(Positional Parameters) are parsed specially, so for example ‘$2foo’ is equivalent to ‘${2}foo’.
Therefore, to use subscript syntax to extract a substring from a positional parameter, the expansion
must be surrounded by braces; for example, ‘${2[3,5]}’ evaluates to the third through fifth characters
of the second positional parameter, but ‘$2[3,5]’ is the entire second parameter concatenated with
the filename generation pattern ‘[3,5]’.

15.3 Positional Parameters


The positional parameters provide access to the command-line arguments of a shell function, shell
script, or the shell itself; see Invocation, and also Functions. The parameter n , where n is a number,
is the n th positional parameter. The parameter ‘$0’ is a special case, see Parameters Set By The
Shell.

The parameters *, @ and argv are arrays containing all the positional parameters; thus ‘$argv[ n ]’,
etc., is equivalent to simply ‘$ n ’. Note that the options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT apply
to these arrays as well, so with either of those options set, ‘${argv[0]}’ is equivalent to ‘$1’ and so on.

Positional parameters may be changed after the shell or function starts by using the set builtin, by
assigning to the argv array, or by direct assignment of the form ‘ n = value ’ where n is the number
of the positional parameter to be changed. This also creates (with empty values) any of the positions
from 1 to n that do not already have values. Note that, because the positional parameters form an
array, an array assignment of the form ‘ n =( value ...)’ is allowed, and has the effect of shifting all the
values at positions greater than n by as many positions as necessary to accommodate the new
values.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 125 of 616
:
15.4 Local Parameters
Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters. (Parameters are dynamically scoped.)
The typeset builtin, and its alternative forms declare, integer, local and readonly (but not export), can
be used to declare a parameter as being local to the innermost scope.

When a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parameter of that name is used.
(That is, the local parameter hides any less-local parameter.) However, assigning to a non-existent
parameter, or declaring a new parameter with export, causes it to be created in the outermost
scope.

Local parameters disappear when their scope ends. unset can be used to delete a parameter while it
is still in scope; any outer parameter of the same name remains hidden.

Special parameters may also be made local; they retain their special attributes unless either the
existing or the newly-created parameter has the -h (hide) attribute. This may have unexpected
effects: there is no default value, so if there is no assignment at the point the variable is made local,
it will be set to an empty value (or zero in the case of integers). The following:

typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH

is valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes called from it to find the programs in
/new/directory inside a function.

Note that the restriction in older versions of zsh that local parameters were never exported has
been removed.

15.5 Parameters Set By The Shell


In the parameter lists that follow, the mark ‘<S>’ indicates that the parameter is special. ‘<Z>’
indicates that the parameter does not exist when the shell initializes in sh or ksh emulation mode.

The parameters ‘!’, ‘#’, ‘*’, ‘-’, ‘?’, ‘@’, ‘$’, ‘ARGC’, ‘HISTCMD’, ‘LINENO’, ‘PPID’, ‘status’, ‘TTYIDLE’,
‘zsh_eval_context’, ‘ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT’, and ‘ZSH_SUBSHELL’ are read-only and thus cannot be
restored by the user, so they are not output by ‘typeset -p’. This also applies to many read-only
parameters loaded from modules.

The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:

! <S>

The process ID of the last command started in the background with &, put into the background with
the bg builtin, or spawned with coproc.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 126 of 616
:
<S>
The number of positional parameters in decimal. Note that some confusion may occur with the
syntax $# param which substitutes the length of param . Use ${#} to resolve ambiguities. In
particular, the sequence ‘$#- ... ’ in an arithmetic expression is interpreted as the length of the
parameter -, q.v.

ARGC <S> <Z>

Same as #.

$ <S>

The process ID of this shell, set when the shell initializes. Processes forked from the shell without
executing a new program, such as command substitutions and commands grouped with ( ... ), are
subshells that duplicate the current shell, and thus substitute the same value for $$ as their parent
shell.

- <S>

Flags supplied to the shell on invocation or by the set or setopt commands.

* <S>

An array containing the positional parameters.

argv <S> <Z>

Same as *. Assigning to argv changes the local positional parameters, but argv is not itself a local
parameter. Deleting argv with unset in any function deletes it everywhere, although only the
innermost positional parameter array is deleted (so * and @ in other scopes are not affected).

@ <S>

Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.

? <S>

The exit status returned by the last command.

0 <S>

The name used to invoke the current shell, or as set by the -c command line option upon invocation.
If the FUNCTION_ARGZERO option is set, $0 is set upon entry to a shell function to the name of the
function, and upon entry to a sourced script to the name of the script, and reset to its previous value
when the function or script returns.

status <S> <Z>

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 127 of 616
:
Same as ?.

pipestatus <S> <Z>

An array containing the exit statuses returned by all commands in the last pipeline.

_ <S>

The last argument of the previous command. Also, this parameter is set in the environment of every
command executed to the full pathname of the command.

CPUTYPE

The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model), as determined at run time.

EGID <S>

The effective group ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges, you may change the
effective group ID of the shell process by assigning to this parameter. Also (assuming sufficient
privileges), you may start a single command with a different effective group ID by ‘(EGID= gid ;
command)’

If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set locally.

EUID <S>

The effective user ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges, you may change the
effective user ID of the shell process by assigning to this parameter. Also (assuming sufficient
privileges), you may start a single command with a different effective user ID by ‘(EUID= uid ;
command)’

If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set locally.

ERRNO <S>

The value of errno (see errno(3)) as set by the most recently failed system call. This value is system
dependent and is intended for debugging purposes. It is also useful with the zsh/system module
which allows the number to be turned into a name or message.

To use this parameter, it must first be assigned a value (typically 0 (zero)). It is initially unset for
scripting compatibility.

FUNCNEST <S>

Integer. If greater than or equal to zero, the maximum nesting depth of shell functions. When it is
exceeded, an error is raised at the point where a function is called. The default value is determined
when the shell is configured, but is typically 500. Increasing the value increases the danger of a
runaway function recursion causing the shell to crash. Setting a negative value turns off the check.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 128 of 616
:
GID <S>

The real group ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges, you may change the group ID
of the shell process by assigning to this parameter. Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may
start a single command under a different group ID by ‘(GID= gid ; command)’

If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set locally.

HISTCMD

The current history event number in an interactive shell, in other words the event number for the
command that caused $HISTCMD to be read. If the current history event modifies the history,
HISTCMD changes to the new maximum history event number.

HOST

The current hostname.

LINENO <S>

The line number of the current line within the current script, sourced file, or shell function being
executed, whichever was started most recently. Note that in the case of shell functions the line
number refers to the function as it appeared in the original definition, not necessarily as displayed
by the functions builtin.

LOGNAME

If the corresponding variable is not set in the environment of the shell, it is initialized to the login
name corresponding to the current login session. This parameter is exported by default but this can
be disabled using the typeset builtin. The value is set to the string returned by the getlogin(3) system
call if that is available.

MACHTYPE

The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model), as determined at compile time.

OLDPWD

The previous working directory. This is set when the shell initializes and whenever the directory
changes.

OPTARG <S>

The value of the last option argument processed by the getopts command.

OPTIND <S>

The index of the last option argument processed by the getopts command.

OSTYPE
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 129 of 616
:
The operating system, as determined at compile time.

PPID <S>

The process ID of the parent of the shell, set when the shell initializes. As with $$, the value does not
change in subshells created as a duplicate of the current shell.

PWD

The present working directory. This is set when the shell initializes and whenever the directory
changes.

RANDOM <S>

A pseudo-random integer from 0 to 32767, newly generated each time this parameter is referenced.
The random number generator can be seeded by assigning a numeric value to RANDOM.

sequence; subshells that reference RANDOM will result in identical pseudo-random values unless
the value of RANDOM is referenced or seeded in the parent shell in between subshell invocations.

SECONDS <S>

The number of seconds since shell invocation. If this parameter is assigned a value, then the value
returned upon reference will be the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds since the
assignment.

Unlike other special parameters, the type of the SECONDS parameter can be changed using the
typeset command. The type may be changed only to one of the floating point types or back to
integer. For example, ‘typeset -F SECONDS’ causes the value to be reported as a floating point
number. The value is available to microsecond accuracy, although the shell may show more or fewer
digits depending on the use of typeset. See the documentation for the builtin typeset in Shell Builtin
Commands for more details.

SHLVL <S>

Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.

signals

An array containing the names of the signals. Note that with the standard zsh numbering of array
indices, where the first element has index 1, the signals are offset by 1 from the signal number used
by the operating system. For example, on typical Unix-like systems HUP is signal number 1, but is
referred to as $signals[2]. This is because of EXIT at position 1 in the array, which is used internally
by zsh but is not known to the operating system.

TRY_BLOCK_ERROR <S>

In an always block, indicates whether the preceding list of code caused an error. The value is 1 to
indicate an error, 0 otherwise. It may be reset, clearing the error condition. See Complex Commands

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 130 of 616
:
TRY_BLOCK_INTERRUPT <S>

This variable works in a similar way to TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, but represents the status of an interrupt
from the signal SIGINT, which typically comes from the keyboard when the user types ^C. If set to 0,
any such interrupt will be reset; otherwise, the interrupt is propagated after the always block.

Note that it is possible that an interrupt arrives during the execution of the always block; this
interrupt is also propagated.

TTY

The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.

TTYIDLE <S>

The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or -1 if there is no such tty.

UID <S>

The real user ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges, you may change the user ID of
the shell by assigning to this parameter. Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single
command under a different user ID by ‘(UID= uid ; command)’

If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set locally.

USERNAME <S>

The username corresponding to the real user ID of the shell process. If you have sufficient privileges,
you may change the username (and also the user ID and group ID) of the shell by assigning to this
parameter. Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command under a different
username (and user ID and group ID) by ‘(USERNAME= username ; command)’

VENDOR

The vendor, as determined at compile time.

zsh_eval_context <S> <Z> (ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) indicating the context of shell code that is being run. Each time a
piece of shell code that is stored within the shell is executed a string is temporarily appended to the
array to indicate the type of operation that is being performed. Read in order the array gives an
indication of the stack of operations being performed with the most immediate context last.

Note that the variable does not give information on syntactic context such as pipelines or subshells.
Use $ZSH_SUBSHELL to detect subshells.

The context is one of the following:

cmdarg

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 131 of 616
:
Code specified by the -c option to the command line that invoked the shell.

cmdsubst
Command substitution using the ‘ ... ‘ or $( ... ) construct.

equalsubst
File substitution using the =( ... ) construct.

eval
Code executed by the eval builtin.

evalautofunc
Code executed with the KSH_AUTOLOAD mechanism in order to define an autoloaded function.

fc
Code from the shell history executed by the -e option to the fc builtin.

file
Lines of code being read directly from a file, for example by the source builtin.

filecode
Lines of code being read from a .zwc file instead of directly from the source file.

globqual
Code executed by the e or + glob qualifier.

globsort
Code executed to order files by the o glob qualifier.

insubst
File substitution using the <( ... ) construct.

loadautofunc
Code read directly from a file to define an autoloaded function.

outsubst
File substitution using the >( ... ) construct.

sched
Code executed by the sched builtin.

shfunc
A shell function.

stty
Code passed to stty by the STTY environment variable. Normally this is passed directly to the
system’s stty command, so this value is unlikely to be seen in practice.

style
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 132 of 616
:
Code executed as part of a style retrieved by the zstyle builtin from the zsh/zutil module.

toplevel
The highest execution level of a script or interactive shell.

trap
Code executed as a trap defined by the trap builtin. Traps defined as functions have the context
shfunc. As traps are asynchronous they may have a different hierarchy from other code.

zpty
Code executed by the zpty builtin from the zsh/zpty module.

zregexparse-guard
Code executed as a guard by the zregexparse command from the zsh/zutil module.

zregexparse-action
Code executed as an action by the zregexparse command from the zsh/zutil module.

ZSH_ARGZERO

If zsh was invoked to run a script, this is the name of the script. Otherwise, it is the name used to
invoke the current shell. This is the same as the value of $0 when the POSIX_ARGZERO option is set,
but is always available.

ZSH_EXECUTION_STRING

If the shell was started with the option -c, this contains the argument passed to the option.
Otherwise it is not set.

ZSH_NAME

Expands to the basename of the command used to invoke this instance of zsh.

ZSH_PATCHLEVEL

The output of ‘git describe –tags –long’ for the zsh repository used to build the shell. This is most
useful in order to keep track of versions of the shell during development between releases; hence
most users should not use it and should instead rely on $ZSH_VERSION.

zsh_scheduled_events

See The zsh/sched Module.

ZSH_SCRIPT

If zsh was invoked to run a script, this is the name of the script, otherwise it is unset.

ZSH_SUBSHELL

Readonly integer. Initially zero, incremented each time the shell forks to create a subshell for

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 133 of 616
:
executing code. Hence ‘(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)’ and ‘print $(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)’ output 1, while ‘(
(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL) )’ outputs 2.

ZSH_VERSION

The version number of the release of zsh.

15.6 Parameters Used By The Shell


The following parameters are used by the shell. Again, ‘<S>’ indicates that the parameter is special
and ‘<Z>’ indicates that the parameter does not exist when the shell initializes in sh or ksh emulation
mode.

In cases where there are two parameters with an upper- and lowercase form of the same name,
such as path and PATH, the lowercase form is an array and the uppercase form is a scalar with the
elements of the array joined together by colons. These are similar to tied parameters created via
‘typeset -T’. The normal use for the colon-separated form is for exporting to the environment, while
the array form is easier to manipulate within the shell. Note that unsetting either of the pair will
unset the other; they retain their special properties when recreated, and recreating one of the pair
will recreate the other.

ARGV0

If exported, its value is used as the argv[0] of external commands. Usually used in constructs like
‘ARGV0=emacs nethack’.

BAUD

The rate in bits per second at which data reaches the terminal. The line editor will use this value in
order to compensate for a slow terminal by delaying updates to the display until necessary. If the
parameter is unset or the value is zero the compensation mechanism is turned off. The parameter is
not set by default.

This parameter may be profitably set in some circumstances, e.g. for slow modems dialing into a
communications server, or on a slow wide area network. It should be set to the baud rate of the
slowest part of the link for best performance.

cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) of directories specifying the search path for the cd command.

COLUMNS <S>

The number of columns for this terminal session. Used for printing select lists and for the line editor.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 134 of 616
:
CORRECT_IGNORE

If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction. Any potential correction that matches the
pattern is ignored. For example, if the value is ‘_*’ then completion functions (which, by convention,
have names beginning with ‘_’) will never be offered as spelling corrections. The pattern does not
apply to the correction of file names, as applied by the CORRECT_ALL option (so with the example
just given files beginning with ‘_’ in the current directory would still be completed).

CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE

If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction of file names. Any file name that matches the
pattern is never offered as a correction. For example, if the value is ‘.*’ then dot file names will never
be offered as spelling corrections. This is useful with the CORRECT_ALL option.

DIRSTACKSIZE

The maximum size of the directory stack, by default there is no limit. If the stack gets larger than
this, it will be truncated automatically. This is useful with the AUTO_PUSHD option.

ENV

If the ENV environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as sh or ksh, $ENV is sourced after the
profile scripts. The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion, command substitution, and
arithmetic expansion before being interpreted as a pathname. Note that ENV is not used unless the
shell is interactive and zsh is emulating sh or ksh.

FCEDIT

The default editor for the fc builtin. If FCEDIT is not set, the parameter EDITOR is used; if that is not
set either, a builtin default, usually vi, is used.

fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)

An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files to be ignored during filename
completion. However, if completion only generates files with suffixes in this list, then these files are
completed anyway.

fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)

An array (colon separated list) of directories specifying the search path for function definitions. This
path is searched when a function file is found, then it is read and executed in the current
environment.

histchars <S>

Three characters used by the shell’s history and lexical analysis mechanism. The first character
signals the start of a history expansion (default ‘!’). The second character signals the start of a quick
history substitution (default ‘^’). The third character is the comment character (default ‘#’).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 135 of 616
:
The characters must be in the ASCII character set; any attempt to set histchars to characters with a
locale-dependent meaning will be rejected with an error message.

HISTCHARS <S> <Z>

Same as histchars. (Deprecated.)

HISTFILE

The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits. If unset, the history is not saved.

HISTORY_IGNORE

If set, is treated as a pattern at the time history files are written. Any potential history entry that
matches the pattern is skipped. For example, if the value is ‘fc *’ then commands that invoke the
interactive history editor are never written to the history file.

Note that HISTORY_IGNORE defines a single pattern: to specify alternatives use the
‘( first | second | ... )’ syntax.

Compare the HIST_NO_STORE option or the zshaddhistory hook, either of which would prevent such
commands from being added to the interactive history at all. If you wish to use HISTORY_IGNORE to
stop history being added in the first place, you can define the following hook:

zshaddhistory() {
emulate -L zsh
## uncomment if HISTORY_IGNORE
## should use EXTENDED_GLOB syntax
# setopt extendedglob
[[ $1 != ${~HISTORY_IGNORE} ]]
}

HISTSIZE <S>

The maximum number of events stored in the internal history list. If you use the
HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST option, setting this value larger than the SAVEHIST size will give you the
difference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.

If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set locally.

HOME <S>

The default argument for the cd command. This is not set automatically by the shell in sh, ksh or csh
emulation, but it is typically present in the environment anyway, and if it becomes set it has its usual
special behaviour.

IFS <S>

Internal field separators (by default space, tab, newline and NUL), that are used to separate words

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 136 of 616
:
which result from command or parameter expansion and words read by the read builtin. Any
characters from the set space, tab and newline that appear in the IFS are called IFS white space. One
or more IFS white space characters or one non-IFS white space character together with any adjacent
IFS white space character delimit a field. If an IFS white space character appears twice consecutively
in the IFS, this character is treated as if it were not an IFS white space character.

If the parameter is unset, the default is used. Note this has a different effect from setting the
parameter to an empty string.

KEYBOARD_HACK

This variable defines a character to be removed from the end of the command line before
interpreting it (interactive shells only). It is intended to fix the problem with keys placed annoyingly
close to return and replaces the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option which did this for backquotes only.
Should the chosen character be one of singlequote, doublequote or backquote, there must also be
an odd number of them on the command line for the last one to be removed.

For backward compatibility, if the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option is explicitly set, the value of
KEYBOARD_HACK reverts to backquote. If the option is explicitly unset, this variable is set to empty.

KEYTIMEOUT

The time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another key to be pressed when reading
bound multi-character sequences.

LANG <S>

This variable determines the locale category for any category not specifically selected via a variable
starting with ‘LC_’.

LC_ALL <S>

This variable overrides the value of the ‘LANG’ variable and the value of any of the other variables
starting with ‘LC_’.

LC_COLLATE <S>

This variable determines the locale category for character collation information within ranges in glob
brackets and for sorting.

LC_CTYPE <S>

This variable determines the locale category for character handling functions. If the MULTIBYTE
option is in effect this variable or LANG should contain a value that reflects the character set in use,
even if it is a single-byte character set, unless only the 7-bit subset (ASCII) is used. For example, if the
character set Linux distributions) or en_US.ISO8859-1 (MacOS).

LC_MESSAGES <S>

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 137 of 616
:
This variable determines the language in which messages should be written. Note that zsh does not
use message catalogs.

LC_NUMERIC <S>

This variable affects the decimal point character and thousands separator character for the
formatted input/output functions and string conversion functions. Note that zsh ignores this setting
when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.

LC_TIME <S>

This variable determines the locale category for date and time formatting in prompt escape
sequences.

LINES <S>

The number of lines for this terminal session. Used for printing select lists and for the line editor.

LISTMAX

In the line editor, the number of matches to list without asking first. If the value is negative, the list
will be shown if it spans at most as many lines as given by the absolute value. If set to zero, the shell
asks only if the top of the listing would scroll off the screen.

MAIL

If this parameter is set and mailpath is not set, the shell looks for mail in the specified file.

MAILCHECK

The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.

mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to check for new mail. Each filename can be followed by
a ‘?’ and a message that will be printed. The message will undergo parameter expansion, command
substitution and arithmetic expansion with the variable $_ defined as the name of the file that has
changed. The default message is ‘You have new mail’. If an element is a directory instead of a file the
shell will recursively check every file in every subdirectory of the element.

manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)

An array (colon-separated list) whose value is not used by the shell. The manpath array can be
useful, however, since setting it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.

match

mbegin

mend

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 138 of 616
:
Arrays set by the shell when the b globbing flag is used in pattern matches. See the subsection
Globbing flags in Filename Generation.

MATCH

MBEGIN

MEND

Set by the shell when the m globbing flag is used in pattern matches. See the subsection Globbing
flags in Filename Generation.

module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) of directories that zmodload searches for dynamically loadable
modules. This is initialized to a standard pathname, usually ‘/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION’. (The ‘/
usr/local/lib’ part varies from installation to installation.) For security reasons, any value set in the
environment when the shell is started will be ignored.

These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic module loading.

NULLCMD <S>

The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no command. Defaults to cat. For
sh/ksh behavior, change this to :. For csh-like behavior, unset this parameter; the shell will print an
error message if null commands are entered.

path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) of directories to search for commands. When this parameter is set,
each directory is scanned

POSTEDIT <S>

This string is output whenever the line editor exits. It usually contains termcap strings to reset the
terminal.

PROMPT <S> <Z>

PROMPT2 <S> <Z>

PROMPT3 <S> <Z>

PROMPT4 <S> <Z>

Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.

prompt <S> <Z>

Same as PS1.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 139 of 616
:
PROMPT_EOL_MARK

When the PROMPT_CR and PROMPT_SP options are set, the PROMPT_EOL_MARK parameter can be
used to customize how the end of partial lines are shown. This parameter undergoes prompt
expansion, with the PROMPT_PERCENT option set. If not set, the default behavior is equivalent to the
value ‘%B%S%#%s%b’.

PS1 <S>

The primary prompt string, printed before a command is read. It undergoes a special form of
expansion before being displayed; see Prompt Expansion. The default is ‘%m%# ’.

PS2 <S>

The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more information to complete a command. It
is expanded in the same way as PS1. The default is ‘%_> ’, which displays any shell constructs or
quotation marks which are currently being processed.

PS3 <S>

Selection prompt used within a select loop. It is expanded in the same way as PS1. The default is ‘?#
’.

PS4 <S>

The execution trace prompt. Default is ‘+%N:%i> ’, which displays the name of the current shell
structure and the line number within it. In sh or ksh emulation, the default is ‘+ ’.

psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) whose elements can be used in PROMPT strings. Setting psvar also
sets PSVAR, and vice versa.

READNULLCMD <S>

The command name to assume if a single input redirection is specified with no command. Defaults
to more.

REPORTMEMORY

If nonnegative, commands whose maximum resident set size (roughly speaking, main memory
usage) in kilobytes is greater than this value have timing statistics reported. The format used to
output statistics is the value of the TIMEFMT parameter, which is the same as for the REPORTTIME
variable and the time builtin; note that by default this does not output memory usage. Appending "
max RSS %M" to the value of TIMEFMT causes it to output the value that triggered the report. If
REPORTTIME is also in use, at most a single report is printed for both triggers. This feature requires
the getrusage() system call, commonly supported by modern Unix-like systems.

REPORTTIME

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 140 of 616
:
If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and system execution times (measured in
seconds) are greater than this value have timing statistics printed for them. Output is suppressed for
commands executed within the line editor, including completion; commands explicitly marked with
the time keyword still cause the summary to be printed in this case.

REPLY

This parameter is reserved by convention to pass string values between shell scripts and shell
builtins in situations where a function call or redirection are impossible or undesirable. The read
builtin and the select complex command may set REPLY, and filename generation both sets and
examines its value when evaluating certain expressions. Some modules also employ REPLY for
similar purposes.

reply

As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.

RPROMPT <S>

RPS1 <S>

This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen when the primary prompt is being
displayed on the left. This does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set. It is expanded in the
same way as PS1.

RPROMPT2 <S>

RPS2 <S>

This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen when the secondary prompt is being
displayed on the left. This does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set. It is expanded in the
same way as PS2.

SAVEHIST

The maximum number of history events to save in the history file.

If this is made local, it is not implicitly set to 0, but may be explicitly set locally.

SPROMPT <S>

The prompt used for spelling correction. The sequence ‘%R’ expands to the string which presumably
needs spelling correction, and ‘%r’ expands to the proposed correction. All other prompt escapes are
also allowed.

The actions available at the prompt are [nyae]:

n (‘no’) (default)
Discard the correction and run the command.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 141 of 616
:
y (‘yes’)
Make the correction and run the command.

a (‘abort’)
Discard the entire command line without running it.

e (‘edit’)
Resume editing the command line.

STTY

If this parameter is set in a command’s environment, the shell runs the stty command with the value
of this parameter as arguments in order to set up the terminal before executing the command. The
modes apply only to the command, and are reset when it finishes or is suspended. If the command
is suspended and continued later with the fg or wait builtins it will see the modes specified by STTY,
as if it were not suspended. This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is continued via ‘kill -
CONT’. STTY is ignored if the command is run in the background, or if it is in the environment of the
shell but not explicitly assigned to in the input line. This avoids running stty at every external
command by accidentally exporting it. Also note that STTY should not be used for window size
specifications; these will not be local to the command.

If the parameter is set and empty, all of the above applies except that stty is not run. This can be
useful as a way to freeze the tty around a single command, blocking its changes to tty settings,
similar to the ttyctl builtin.

TERM <S>

The type of terminal in use. This is used when looking up termcap sequences. An assignment to
TERM causes zsh to re-initialize the terminal, even if the value does not change (e.g., ‘TERM=$TERM’).
It is necessary to make such an assignment upon any change to the terminal definition database or
terminal type in order for the new settings to take effect.

TERMINFO <S>

A reference to your terminfo database, used by the ‘terminfo’ library when the system has it; see
terminfo(5). If set, this causes the shell to reinitialise the terminal, making the workaround
‘TERM=$TERM’ unnecessary.

TERMINFO_DIRS <S>

A colon-seprarated list of terminfo databases, used by the ‘terminfo’ library when the system has it;
see terminfo(5). This variable is only used by certain terminal libraries, in particular ncurses; see
terminfo(5) to check support on your system. If set, this causes the shell to reinitialise the terminal,
making the workaround ‘TERM=$TERM’ unnecessary. Note that unlike other colon-separated arrays
this is not tied to a zsh array.

TIMEFMT

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 142 of 616
:
The format of process time reports with the time keyword. The default is ‘%J %U user %S system %P
cpu %*E total’. Recognizes the following escape sequences, although not all may be available on all
systems, and some that are available may not be useful:

%%
A ‘%’.

%U
CPU seconds spent in user mode.

%S
CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.

%E
Elapsed time in seconds.

%P
The CPU percentage, computed as 100*(%U+%S)/%E.

%W
Number of times the process was swapped.

%X
The average amount in (shared) text space used in kilobytes.

%D
The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in kilobytes.

%K
The total space used (%X+%D) in kilobytes.

%M
The maximum memory the process had in use at any time in kilobytes.

%F
The number of major page faults (page needed to be brought from disk).

%R
The number of minor page faults.

%I
The number of input operations.

%O
The number of output operations.

%r
The number of socket messages received.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 143 of 616
:
%s
The number of socket messages sent.

%k
The number of signals received.

%w
Number of voluntary context switches (waits).

%c
Number of involuntary context switches.

%J
The name of this job.

A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags printing time (e.g., ‘%*E’); this causes the
time to be printed in ‘ hh : mm : ss . ttt ’ format (hours and minutes are only printed if they are not
zero). Alternatively, ‘m’ or ‘u’ may be used (e.g., ‘%mE’) to produce time output in milliseconds or
microseconds, respectively.

TMOUT

If this parameter is nonzero, the shell will receive an ALRM signal if a command is not entered within
the specified number of seconds after issuing a prompt. If there is a trap on SIGALRM, it will be
executed and a new alarm is scheduled using the value of the TMOUT parameter after executing the
trap. If no trap is set, and the idle time of the terminal is not less than the value of the TMOUT
parameter, zsh terminates. Otherwise a new alarm is scheduled to TMOUT seconds after the last
keypress.

TMPPREFIX

A pathname prefix which the shell will use for all temporary files. Note that this should include an
initial part for the file name as well as any directory names. The default is ‘/tmp/zsh’.

TMPSUFFIX

A filename suffix which the shell will use for temporary files created by process substitutions (e.g., ‘=
( list )’). Note that the value should include a leading dot ‘.’ if intended to be interpreted as a file
extension. The default is not to append any suffix, thus this parameter should be assigned only
when needed and then unset again.

WORDCHARS <S>

A list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word by the line editor.

ZBEEP

If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the same codes as the bindkey command as

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 144 of 616
:
described in The zsh/zle Module, that will be output to the terminal instead of beeping. This may
have a visible instead of an audible effect; for example, the string ‘\e[?5h\e[?5l’ on a vt100 or xterm
will have the effect of flashing reverse video on and off (if you usually use reverse video, you should
use the string ‘\e[?5l\e[?5h’ instead). This takes precedence over the NOBEEP option.

ZDOTDIR

The directory to search for shell startup files (.zshrc, etc), if not $HOME.

zle_bracketed_paste

Many terminal emulators have a feature that allows applications to identify when text is pasted into
the terminal rather than being typed normally. For ZLE, this means that special characters such as
tabs and newlines can be inserted instead of invoking editor commands. Furthermore, pasted text
forms a single undo event and if the region is active, pasted text will replace the region.

This two-element array contains the terminal escape sequences for enabling and disabling the
feature. These escape sequences are used to enable bracketed paste when ZLE is active and disable
it at other times. Unsetting the parameter has the effect of ensuring that bracketed paste remains
disabled.

zle_highlight

An array describing contexts in which ZLE should highlight the input text. See Character Highlighting.

ZLE_LINE_ABORTED

This parameter is set by the line editor when an error occurs. It contains the line that was being
edited at the point of the error. ‘print -zr – $ZLE_LINE_ABORTED’ can be used to recover the line.
Only the most recent line of this kind is remembered.

ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS

ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS

These parameters are used by the line editor. In certain circumstances suffixes (typically space or
slash) added by the completion system will be removed automatically, either because the next
editing command as requiring the suffix to be removed.

These variables can contain the sets of characters that will cause the suffix to be removed. If
ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters will cause the suffix to be removed; if
ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters will cause the suffix to be removed and replaced
by a space.

If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is not set, the default behaviour is equivalent to:

ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$' \t\n;&|'

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 145 of 616
:
If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set but is empty, no characters have this behaviour.
ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS takes precedence, so that the following:

ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$'&|'

causes the characters ‘&’ and ‘|’ to remove the suffix but to replace it with a space.

To illustrate the difference, suppose that the option AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH is in effect and the
directory DIR has just been completed, with an appended /, following which the user types ‘&’. The
default result is ‘DIR&’. With ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS set but without including ‘&’ the result is
‘DIR/&’. With ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS set to include ‘&’ the result is ‘DIR &’.

Note that certain completions may provide their own suffix removal or replacement behaviour
which overrides the values described here. See the completion system documentation in
Completion System.

ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT <S>

If set, used to give the indentation between the right hand side of the right prompt in the line editor
as given by RPS1 or RPROMPT and the right hand side of the screen. If not set, the value 1 is used.

Typically this will be used to set the value to 0 so that the prompt appears flush with the right hand
side of the screen. This is not the default as many terminals do not handle this correctly, in particular
when the prompt appears at the extreme bottom right of the screen. Recent virtual terminals are
more likely to handle this case correctly. Some experimentation is necessary.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 146 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

16 Options
16.1 Specifying Options
16.2 Description of Options
16.2.1 Changing Directories
16.2.2 Completion
16.2.3 Expansion and Globbing
16.2.4 History
16.2.5 Initialisation
16.2.6 Input/Output
16.2.7 Job Control
16.2.8 Prompting
16.2.9 Scripts and Functions
16.2.10 Shell Emulation
16.2.11 Shell State
16.2.12 Zle
16.3 Option Aliases
16.4 Single Letter Options
16.4.1 Default set
16.4.2 sh/ksh emulation set
16.4.3 Also note

16 Options

16.1 Specifying Options


Options are primarily referred to by name. These names are case insensitive and underscores are
ignored. For example, ‘allexport’ is equivalent to ‘A__lleXP_ort’.

The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with ‘no’, so ‘setopt No_Beep’ is
equivalent to ‘unsetopt beep’. This inversion can only be done once, so ‘nonobeep’ is not a synonym
for ‘beep’. Similarly, ‘tify’ is not a synonym for ‘nonotify’ (the inversion of ‘notify’).

Some options also have one or more single letter names. There are two sets of single letter options:
one used by default, and another used to emulate sh/ksh (used when the SH_OPTION_LETTERS
option is set). The single letter options can be used on the shell command line, or with the set,
setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options preceded by ‘-’.

The sense of the single letter options may be inverted by using ‘+’ instead of ‘-’. Some of the single
letter option names refer to an option being off, in which case the inversion of that name refers to

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 147 of 616
:
the option being on. For example, ‘+n’ is the short name of ‘exec’, and ‘-n’ is the short name of its
inversion, ‘noexec’.

In strings of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup, trailing whitespace will be ignored;
for example the string ‘-f ’ will be treated just as ‘-f’, but the string ‘-f i’ is an error. This is because
many systems which implement the ‘#!’ mechanism for calling scripts do not strip trailing
whitespace.

It is possible for options to be set within a function scope. See the description of the option
LOCAL_OPTIONS below.

16.2 Description of Options


In the following list, options set by default in all emulations are marked <D>; those set by default
only in csh, ksh, sh, or zsh emulations are marked <C>, <K>, <S>, <Z> as appropriate. When listing
options (by ‘setopt’, ‘unsetopt’, ‘set -o’ or ‘set +o’), those turned on by default appear in the list
prefixed with ‘no’. Hence (unless KSH_OPTION_PRINT is set), ‘setopt’ shows all options whose
settings are changed from the default.

16.2.1 Changing Directories

AUTO_CD (-J)

If a command is issued that can’t be executed as a normal command, and the command is the name
of a directory, perform the cd command to that directory. This option is only applicable if the option
SHIN_STDIN is set, i.e. if commands are being read from standard input. The option is designed for
interactive use; it is recommended that cd be used explicitly in scripts to avoid ambiguity.

AUTO_PUSHD (-N)

Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.

CDABLE_VARS (-T)

If the argument to a cd command (or an implied cd with the AUTO_CD option set) is not a directory,
and does not begin with a slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded by a ‘~’ (see
Filename Expansion).

CD_SILENT

Never print the working directory after a cd (whether explicit or implied with the AUTO_CD option
set). cd normally prints the working directory when the argument given to it was -, a stack entry, or

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 148 of 616
:
the name of a directory found under CDPATH. Note that this is distinct from pushd’s stack-printing
behaviour, which is controlled by PUSHD_SILENT. This option overrides the printing-related effects
of POSIX_CD.

CHASE_DOTS

When changing to a directory containing a path segment ‘..’ which would otherwise be treated as
canceling the previous segment in the path (in other words, ‘foo/..’ would be removed from the path,
or if ‘..’ is the first part of the path, the last part of the current working directory would be removed),
instead resolve the path to the physical directory. This option is overridden by CHASE_LINKS.

For example, suppose /foo/bar is a link to the directory /alt/rod. Without this option set, ‘cd
/foo/bar/..’ changes to /foo; with it set, it changes to /alt. The same applies if the current directory is
/foo/bar and ‘cd ..’ is used. Note that all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.

CHASE_LINKS (-w)

Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing directory. This also has the effect of
CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a ‘..’ path segment will be treated as referring to the physical parent, even if the
preceding path segment is a symbolic link.

POSIX_CD <K> <S>

Modifies the behaviour of cd, chdir and pushd commands to make them more compatible with the
POSIX standard. The behaviour with the option unset is described in the documentation for the cd
builtin in Shell Builtin Commands. If the option is set, the shell does not test for directories beneath
the local directory (‘.’) until after all directories in cdpath have been tested, and the cd and chdir
commands do not recognise arguments of the form ‘{+|-} n ’ as directory stack entries.

Also, if the option is set, the conditions under which the shell prints the new directory after changing
to it are modified. It is no longer restricted to interactive shells (although printing of the directory
stack with pushd is still limited to interactive shells); and any use of a component of CDPATH,
including a ‘.’ but excluding an empty component that is otherwise treated as ‘.’, causes the directory
to be printed.

PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS

Don’t push multiple copies of the same directory onto the directory stack.

PUSHD_MINUS

Exchanges the meanings of ‘+’ and ‘-’ when used with a number to specify a directory in the stack.

PUSHD_SILENT (-E)

Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.

PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 149 of 616
:
Have pushd with no arguments act like ‘pushd $HOME’.

16.2.2 Completion

ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>

If unset, key functions that list completions try to return to the last prompt if given a numeric
argument. If set these functions try to return to the last prompt if given no numeric argument.

ALWAYS_TO_END

If a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and a full completion is inserted, the
cursor is moved to the end of the word. That is, the cursor is moved to the end of the word if either
a single match is inserted or menu completion is performed.

AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>

Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.

AUTO_MENU <D>

Automatically use menu completion after the second consecutive request for completion, for
example by pressing the tab key repeatedly. This option is overridden by MENU_COMPLETE.

AUTO_NAME_DIRS

Any parameter that is set to the absolute name of a directory immediately becomes a name for that
directory, that will be used by the ‘%~’ and related prompt sequences, and will be available when
completion is performed on a word starting with ‘~’. (Otherwise, the parameter must be used in the
form ‘~ param ’ first.)

AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>

If a parameter name was completed and a following character (normally a space) automatically
inserted, and the next character typed is one of those that have to come directly after the name (like
‘}’, ‘:’, etc.), the automatically added character is deleted, so that the character typed comes
immediately after the parameter name. Completion in a brace expansion is affected similarly: the
added character is a ‘,’, which will be removed if ‘}’ is typed next.

AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>

If a parameter is completed whose content is the name of a directory, then add a trailing slash
instead of a space.

AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>

When the last character resulting from a completion is a slash and the next character typed is a
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 150 of 616
:
word delimiter, a slash, or a character that ends a command (such as a semicolon or an ampersand),
remove the slash.

BASH_AUTO_LIST

On an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when the completion function is called twice
in succession. This takes precedence over AUTO_LIST. The setting of LIST_AMBIGUOUS is respected.
If AUTO_MENU is set, the menu behaviour will then start with the third press. Note that this will not
work with MENU_COMPLETE, since repeated completion calls immediately cycle through the list in
that case.

COMPLETE_ALIASES

Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally substituted before completion is
attempted. The effect is to make the alias a distinct command for completion purposes.

COMPLETE_IN_WORD

If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion is started. Otherwise it stays there and
completion is done from both ends.

GLOB_COMPLETE

When the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all the words resulting from the expansion
but generate matches as for completion and cycle through them like MENU_COMPLETE. The
matches are generated as if a ‘*’ was added to the end of the word, or inserted at the cursor when
COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set. This actually uses pattern matching, not globbing, so it works not only
for files but for any completion, such as options, user names, etc.

Note that when the pattern matcher is used, matching control (for example, case-insensitive or
anchored matching) cannot be used. This limitation only applies when the current word contains a
pattern; simply turning on the GLOB_COMPLETE option does not have this effect.

HASH_LIST_ALL <D>

Whenever a command completion or spelling correction is attempted, make sure the entire
command path is hashed first. This makes the first completion slower but avoids false reports of
spelling errors.

LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>

This option works when AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also set. If there is an unambiguous prefix
to insert on the command line, that is done without a completion list being displayed; in other
words, auto-listing behaviour only takes place when nothing would be inserted. In the case of
BASH_AUTO_LIST, this means that the list will be delayed to the third call of the function.

LIST_BEEP <D>

Beep on an ambiguous completion. More accurately, this forces the completion widgets to return
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 151 of 616
:
status 1 on an ambiguous completion, which causes the shell to beep if the option BEEP is also set;
this may be modified if completion is called from a user-defined widget.

LIST_PACKED

Try to make the completion list smaller (occupying less lines) by printing the matches in columns
with different widths.

LIST_ROWS_FIRST

Lay out the matches in completion lists sorted horizontally, that is, the second match is to the right
of the first one, not under it as usual.

LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>

When listing files that are possible completions, show the type of each file with a trailing identifying
mark.

MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)

On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or beeping, insert the first match
immediately. Then when completion is requested again, remove the first match and insert the
second match, etc. When there are no more matches, go back to the first one again. reverse-menu-
complete may be used to loop through the list in the other direction. This option overrides
AUTO_MENU.

REC_EXACT (-S)

If the string on the command line exactly matches one of the possible completions, it is accepted,
even if there is another completion (i.e. that string with something else added) that also matches.

16.2.3 Expansion and Globbing

BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>

If a pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an error message. (If this option is unset,
the pattern will be left unchanged.)

BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>

In a glob pattern, treat a trailing set of parentheses as a qualifier list, if it contains no ‘|’, ‘(’ or (if
special) ‘~’ characters. See Filename Generation.

BRACE_CCL

Expand expressions in braces which would not otherwise undergo brace expansion to a lexically
ordered list of all the characters. See Brace Expansion.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 152 of 616
:
CASE_GLOB <D>

Make globbing (filename generation) sensitive to case. Note that other uses of patterns are always
sensitive to case. If the option is unset, the presence of any character which is special to filename
generation will cause case-insensitive matching. For example, cvs(/) can match the directory CVS
owing to the presence of the globbing flag (unless the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is unset).

CASE_MATCH <D>

Make regular expressions using the zsh/regex module (including matches with =~) sensitive to case.

CASE_PATHS

If CASE_PATHS is not set (the default), CASE_GLOB affects the interpretation of every path
component, whenever a special character appears in any component. When CASE_PATHS is set, file
path components that do not contain special filename generation characters are always sensitive to
case, thus restricting NO_CASE_GLOB to components that contain globbing characters.

Note that if the filesystem itself is not sensitive to case, then CASE_PATHS has no effect.

CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>

If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the pattern from the argument list; do
not report an error unless all the patterns in a command have no matches. Overrides NOMATCH.

EQUALS <Z>

Perform = filename expansion. (See Filename Expansion.)

EXTENDED_GLOB

Treat the ‘#’, ‘~’ and ‘^’ characters as part of patterns for filename generation, etc. (An initial
unquoted ‘~’ always produces named directory expansion.)

FORCE_FLOAT

Constants in arithmetic evaluation will be treated as floating point even without the use of a decimal
point; the values of integer variables will be converted to floating point when used in arithmetic
expressions. Integers in any base will be converted.

GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>

Perform filename generation (globbing). (See Filename Generation.)

GLOB_ASSIGN <C>

If this option is set, filename generation (globbing) is performed on the right hand side of scalar
parameter assignments of the form ‘ name = pattern (e.g. ‘foo=*’). If the result has more than one
word the parameter will become an array with those words as arguments. This option is provided

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 153 of 616
:
for backwards compatibility only: globbing is always performed on the right hand side of array
assignments of the form ‘ name =( value )’ (e.g. ‘foo=(*)’) and this form is recommended for clarity;
with this option set, it is not possible to predict whether the result will be an array or a scalar.

GLOB_DOTS (-4)

Do not require a leading ‘.’ in a filename to be matched explicitly.

GLOB_STAR_SHORT

When this option is set and the default zsh-style globbing is in effect, the pattern ‘**/*’ can be
abbreviated to ‘**’ and the pattern ‘***/*’ can be abbreviated to ***. Hence ‘**.c’ finds a file ending
in .c in any subdirectory, and ‘***.c’ does the same while also following symbolic links. A /
immediately after the ‘**’ or ‘***’ forces the pattern to be treated as the unabbreviated form.

GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>

Treat any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being eligible for filename expansion
and filename generation, and any characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible
for filename generation. Braces (and commas in between) do not become eligible for expansion.

HIST_SUBST_PATTERN

Substitutions using the :s and :& history modifiers are performed with pattern matching instead of
string matching. This occurs wherever history modifiers are valid, including glob qualifiers and
parameters. See Modifiers.

IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>

Do not perform brace expansion. For historical reasons this also includes the effect of the
IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option.

IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES

When neither this option nor IGNORE_BRACES is set, a sole close brace character ‘}’ is syntactically
significant at any point on a command line. This has the effect that no semicolon or newline is
necessary before the brace terminating a function or current shell construct. When either option is
set, a closing brace is syntactically significant only in command position. Unlike IGNORE_BRACES, this
option does not disable brace expansion.

For example, with both options unset a function may be defined in the following fashion:

args() { echo $# }

while if either option is set, this does not work and something equivalent to the following is
required:

args() { echo $#; }

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 154 of 616
:
KSH_GLOB <K>

In pattern matching, the interpretation of parentheses is affected by a preceding ‘@’, ‘*’, ‘+’, ‘?’ or ‘!’.
See Filename Generation.

MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST

All unquoted arguments of the form ‘ anything = expression ’ appearing after the command name
have filename expansion (that is, where expression has a leading ‘~’ or ‘=’) performed on
expression as if it were a parameter assignment. The argument is not otherwise treated specially; it
is passed to the command as a single argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment.
For example, in echo foo=~/bar:~/rod, both occurrences of ~ would be replaced. Note that this
happens anyway with typeset and similar statements.

This option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option. In other words, if both options are in
effect, arguments looking like assignments will not undergo word splitting.

MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)

Append a trailing ‘/’ to all directory names resulting from filename generation (globbing).

MULTIBYTE <D>

Respect multibyte characters when found in strings. When this option is set, strings are examined
using the system library to determine how many bytes form a character, depending on the current
locale. This affects the way characters are counted in pattern matching, parameter values and
various delimiters.

The option is on by default if the shell was compiled with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT; otherwise it is off by
default and has no effect if turned on.

If the option is off a single byte is always treated as a single character. This setting is designed purely
for examining strings known to contain raw bytes or other values that may not be characters in the
current locale. It is not necessary to unset the option merely because the character set for the
current locale does not contain multibyte characters.

The option does not affect the shell’s editor, which always uses the locale to determine multibyte
characters. This is because the character set displayed by the terminal emulator is independent of
shell settings.

NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>

If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, print an error, instead of leaving it unchanged
in the argument list. This also applies to file expansion of an initial ‘~’ or ‘=’.

NULL_GLOB (-G)

If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the pattern from the argument list
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 155 of 616
:
instead of reporting an error. Overrides NOMATCH.

NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT

If numeric filenames are matched by a filename generation pattern, sort the filenames numerically
rather than lexicographically.

RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)

Array expansions of the form ‘ foo ${ xx } bar ’, where the parameter xx is set to ( a b c ), are
substituted with ‘ fooabar foobbar foocbar ’ instead of the default ‘ fooa b cbar ’. Note that an
empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

REMATCH_PCRE

If set, regular expression matching with the =~ operator will use Perl-Compatible Regular
Expressions from the PCRE library. (The zsh/pcre module must be available.) If not set, regular
expressions will use the extended regexp syntax provided by the system libraries.

SH_GLOB <K> <S>

Disables the special meaning of ‘(’, ‘|’, ‘)’ and ’<’ for globbing the result of parameter and command
substitutions, and in some other places where the shell accepts patterns. If SH_GLOB is set but
KSH_GLOB is not, the shell allows the interpretation of subshell expressions enclosed in parentheses
in some cases where there is no space before the opening parenthesis, e.g. !(true) is interpreted as if
there were a space after the !. This option is set by default if zsh is invoked as sh or ksh.

UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>

Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting, and as if they were zero when
reading their values in arithmetic expansion and arithmetic commands. Otherwise they are treated
as an error.

WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL

Print a warning message when a global parameter is created in a function by an assignment or in


math context. This often indicates that a parameter has not been declared local when it should have
been. Parameters explicitly declared global from within a function using typeset -g do not cause a
warning. Note that there is no warning when a local parameter is assigned to in a nested function,
which may also indicate an error.

WARN_NESTED_VAR

Print a warning message when an existing parameter from an enclosing function scope, or global, is
set in a function by an assignment or in math context. Assignment to shell special parameters does
not cause a warning. This is the companion to WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL as in this case the warning is
only printed when a parameter is not created. Where possible, use of typeset -g to set the parameter
suppresses the error, but note that this needs to be used every time the parameter is set. To restrict

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 156 of 616
:
the effect of this option to a single function scope, use ‘functions -W’.

For example, the following code produces a warning for the assignment inside the function nested
as that overrides the value within toplevel

toplevel() {
local foo="in fn"
nested
}
nested() {
foo="in nested"
}
setopt warn_nested_var
toplevel

16.2.4 History

APPEND_HISTORY <D>

If this is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to the history file, rather than replace it. Thus,
multiple parallel zsh sessions will all have the new entries from their history lists added to the
history file, in the order that they exit. The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it when the
number of lines grows 20% beyond the value specified by $SAVEHIST (see also the
HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>

Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the character ‘!’ specially.

EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>

Save each command’s beginning timestamp (in seconds since the epoch) and the duration (in
seconds) to the history file. The format of this prefixed data is:

‘: <beginning time> : <elapsed seconds> ; <command> ’.

HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER

Add ‘|’ to output redirections in the history. This allows history references to clobber files even when
CLOBBER is unset.

HIST_BEEP <D>

Beep in ZLE when a widget attempts to access a history entry which isn’t there.

HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 157 of 616
:
If the internal history needs to be trimmed to add the current command line, setting this option will
cause the oldest history event that has a duplicate to be lost before losing a unique event from the
list. You should be sure to set the value of HISTSIZE to a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to
give you some room for the duplicated events, otherwise this option will behave just like
HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills up with unique events.

HIST_FCNTL_LOCK

When writing out the history file, by default zsh uses ad-hoc file locking to avoid known problems
with locking on some operating systems. With this option locking is done by means of the system’s
fcntl call, where this method is available. On recent operating systems this may provide better
performance, in particular avoiding history corruption when files are stored on NFS.

HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS

When searching for history entries in the line editor, do not display duplicates of a line previously
found, even if the duplicates are not contiguous.

HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS

If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates an older one, the older command is
removed from the list (even if it is not the previous event).

HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)

Do not enter command lines into the history list if they are duplicates of the previous event.

HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)

Remove command lines from the history list when the first character on the line is a space, or when
one of the expanded aliases contains a leading space. Only normal aliases (not global or suffix
aliases) have this behaviour. Note that the command lingers in the internal history until the next
command is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line. If you want to
make it vanish right away without entering another command, type a space and press return.

HIST_LEX_WORDS

By default, shell history that is read in from files is split into words on all white space. This means
that arguments with quoted whitespace are not correctly handled, with the consequence that
references to words in history lines that have been read from a file may be inaccurate. When this
option is set, words read in from a history file are divided up in a similar fashion to normal shell
command line handling. Although this produces more accurately delimited words, if the size of the
history file is large this can be slow. Trial and error is necessary to decide.

HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS

Remove function definitions from the history list. Note that the function lingers in the internal
history until the next command is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 158 of 616
:
the definition.

HIST_NO_STORE

Remove the history (fc -l) command from the history list when invoked. Note that the command
lingers in the internal history until the next command is entered before it vanishes, allowing you to
briefly reuse or edit the line.

HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS

Remove superfluous blanks from each command line being added to the history list.

HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY <D>

When the history file is re-written, we normally write out a copy of the file named $HISTFILE.new and
then rename it over the old one. However, if this option is unset, we instead truncate the old history
file and write out the new version in-place. If one of the history-appending options is enabled, this
option only has an effect when the enlarged history file needs to be re-written to trim it down to
size. Disable this only if you have special needs, as doing so makes it possible to lose history entries
if zsh gets interrupted during the save.

When writing out a copy of the history file, zsh preserves the old file’s permissions and group
information, but will refuse to write out a new file if it would change the history file’s owner.

HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS

When writing out the history file, older commands that duplicate newer ones are omitted.

HIST_VERIFY

Whenever the user enters a line with history expansion, don’t execute the line directly; instead,
perform history expansion and reload the line into the editing buffer.

INC_APPEND_HISTORY

This option works like APPEND_HISTORY except that new history lines are added to the $HISTFILE
incrementally (as soon as they are entered), rather than waiting until the shell exits. The file will still
be periodically re-written to trim it when the number of lines grows 20% beyond the value specified
by $SAVEHIST (see also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME

This option is a variant of INC_APPEND_HISTORY in which, where possible, the history entry is
written out to the file after the command is finished, so that the time taken by the command is
recorded correctly in the history file in EXTENDED_HISTORY format. This means that the history
entry will not be available immediately from other instances of the shell that are using the same
history file.

This option is only useful if INC_APPEND_HISTORY and SHARE_HISTORY are turned off. The three

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 159 of 616
:
options should be considered mutually exclusive.

SHARE_HISTORY <K>

This option both imports new commands from the history file, and also causes your typed
commands to be appended to the history file (the latter is like specifying INC_APPEND_HISTORY,
which should be turned off if this option is in effect). The history lines are also output with
timestamps ala EXTENDED_HISTORY (which makes it easier to find the spot where we left off reading
the file after it gets re-written).

By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as the local lines, but you
can toggle this on and off with the set-local-history zle binding. It is also possible to create a zle
widget that will make some commands ignore imported commands, and some include them.

If you find that you want more control over when commands get imported, you may wish to turn
SHARE_HISTORY off, INC_APPEND_HISTORY or INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME (see above) on, and then
manually import commands whenever you need them using ‘fc -RI’.

16.2.5 Initialisation

ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)

All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.

GLOBAL_EXPORT <Z>

If this option is set, passing the -x flag to the builtins declare, float, integer, readonly and typeset (but
not local) will also set the -g flag; hence parameters exported to the environment will not be made
local to the enclosing function, unless they were already or the flag +g is given explicitly. If the option
is unset, exported parameters will be made local in just the same way as any other parameter.

This option is set by default for backward compatibility; it is not recommended that its behaviour be
relied upon. Note that the builtin export always sets both the -x and -g flags, and hence its effect
extends beyond the scope of the enclosing function; this is the

GLOBAL_RCS (+d) <D>

If this option is unset, the startup files /etc/zprofile, /etc/zshrc, /etc/zlogin and /etc/zlogout will not be
run. It can be disabled and re-enabled at any time, including inside local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).

RCS (+f) <D>

After /etc/zshenv is sourced on startup, source the .zshenv, /etc/zprofile, .zprofile, /etc/zshrc, .zshrc,
/etc/zlogin, .zlogin, and .zlogout files, as described in Files. If this option is unset, the /etc/zshenv file
is still sourced, but any of the others will not be; it can be set at any time to prevent the remaining
startup files after the currently executing one from being sourced.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 160 of 616
:
16.2.6 Input/Output

ALIASES <D>

Expand aliases.

CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>

Allows ‘>’ redirection to truncate existing files. Otherwise ‘>!’ or ‘>|’ must be used to truncate a file.

If the option is not set, and the option APPEND_CREATE is also not set, ‘>>!’ or ‘>>|’ must be used to
create a file. If either option is set, ‘>>’ may be used.

CLOBBER_EMPTY

This option is only used if the option CLOBBER is not set: note that it is set by default.

If this option is set, then regular files of zero length may be ovewritten (‘clobbered’). Note that it is
possible another process has written to the file between this test and use of the file by the current
process. This option should therefore not be used in cases where files to be clobbered may be
written to asynchronously.

CORRECT (-0)

Try to correct the spelling of commands. Note that, when the HASH_LIST_ALL option is not set or
when some directories in the path are not readable, this may falsely report spelling errors the first
time some commands are used.

The shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE may be set to a pattern to match words that will never be
offered as corrections.

CORRECT_ALL (-O)

Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.

The shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE may be set to a pattern to match file names that will never
be offered as corrections.

DVORAK

Use the Dvorak keyboard instead of the standard qwerty keyboard as a basis for examining spelling
mistakes for the CORRECT and CORRECT_ALL options and the spell-word editor command.

FLOW_CONTROL <D>

If this option is unset, output flow control via start/stop characters (usually assigned to ^S/^Q) is
disabled in the shell’s editor.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 161 of 616
:
IGNORE_EOF (-7)

Do not exit on end-of-file. Require the use of exit or logout instead. However, ten consecutive EOFs
will cause the shell to exit anyway, to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.

Also, if this option is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used, widgets implemented by shell functions can
be bound to EOF (normally Control-D) without printing the normal warning message. This works
only for normal widgets, not for completion widgets.

INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>

Allow comments even in interactive shells.

HASH_CMDS <D>

Note the location of each command the first time it is executed. Subsequent invocations of the same
command will use the saved location, avoiding a path search. If this option is unset, no path hashing
is done at all. However, when CORRECT is set, commands whose names do not appear in reporting
them as spelling errors.

HASH_DIRS <D>

Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing it, as well as all directories that
occur earlier in the path. Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor CORRECT is set.

HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY

When hashing commands because of HASH_CMDS, check that the is unset by default as if the path
contains a large number of commands, or consists of many remote files, the additional tests can
take a long time. Trial and error is needed to show if this option is beneficial.

MAIL_WARNING (-U)

Print a warning message if a mail file has been accessed since the shell last checked.

PATH_DIRS (-Q)

Perform a path search even on command names with slashes in them. Thus if ‘/usr/local/bin’ is in
the user’s path, and he or she types ‘X11/xinit’, the command ‘/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit’ will be
executed (assuming it exists). Commands explicitly beginning with ‘/’, ‘./’ or ‘../’ are not subject to the
path search. This also applies to the ‘.’ and source builtins.

Note that subdirectories of the current directory are always searched for indicated by this option,
and regardless of whether ‘.’ or the current directory appear in the command search path.

PATH_SCRIPT <K> <S>

If this option is not set, a script passed as the first non-option argument to the shell must contain
the name of the file to open. If this option is set, and the script does not specify a directory path, the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 162 of 616
:
script is looked for first in the current directory, then in the command path. See Invocation.

PRINT_EIGHT_BIT

Print eight bit characters literally in completion lists, etc. This option is not necessary if your system
correctly returns the printability of eight bit characters (see ctype(3)).

PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)

Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status. This is only available at the command line
in interactive shells.

RC_QUOTES

Allow the character sequence ‘’’’ to signify a single quote within singly quoted strings. Note this does
not apply in quoted strings using the format $’ ... ’, where a backslashed single quote can be used.

RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>

Do not query the user before executing ‘rm *’ or ‘rm path/*’.

RM_STAR_WAIT

If querying the user before executing ‘rm *’ or ‘rm path/*’, first wait ten seconds and ignore anything
typed in that time. This avoids the problem of reflexively answering ‘yes’ to the query when one
didn’t really mean it. The wait and query can always be avoided by expanding the ‘*’ in ZLE (with tab).

SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>

Allow the short forms of for, repeat, select, if, and function constructs.

SHORT_REPEAT

Allow the short form repeat as SHORT_LOOPS but without enabling it for the other constructs.

SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)

If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number of backquotes on the line, ignore the
trailing backquote. This is useful on some keyboards where the return key is too small, and the
backquote key lies annoyingly close to it. As an alternative the variable KEYBOARD_HACK lets you
choose the character to be removed.

16.2.7 Job Control

AUTO_CONTINUE

with the disown builtin command are automatically sent a CONT signal to make them running.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 163 of 616
:
AUTO_RESUME (-W)

Treat single word simple commands without redirection as candidates for resumption of an existing
job.

BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>

Run all background jobs at a lower priority. This option is set by default.

CHECK_JOBS <Z>

Report the status of background and suspended jobs before exiting a shell with job control; a
second attempt to exit the shell will succeed. NO_CHECK_JOBS is best used only in combination with
NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.

The check is omitted if the commands run from the previous command line included a ‘jobs’
command, since it is assumed the user is aware that there are background or suspended jobs. A
‘jobs’ command run from one of the hook functions defined in the section ‘Special Functions’ in
Functions is not counted for this purpose.

CHECK_RUNNING_JOBS <Z>

Check for both running and suspended jobs when CHECK_JOBS is enabled. When this option is
disabled, zsh checks only for suspended jobs, which matches the default behavior of bash.

This option has no effect unless CHECK_JOBS is set.

HUP <Z>

Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.

LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)

Print job notifications in the long format by default.

MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)

Allow job control. Set by default in interactive shells.

NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>

Report the status of background jobs immediately, rather than waiting until just before printing a
prompt.

POSIX_JOBS <K> <S>

This option makes job control more compliant with the POSIX standard.

When the option is not set, the MONITOR option is unset on entry to subshells, so that job control is
no longer active. When the option is set, the MONITOR option and job control remain active in the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 164 of 616
:
subshell, but note that the subshell has no access to jobs in the parent shell.

When the option is not set, jobs put in the background or foreground with bg or fg are displayed
with the same information that would be reported by jobs. When the option is set, only the text is
printed. The output from jobs itself is not affected by the option.

When the option is not set, job information from the parent shell is saved for output within a
subshell (for example, within a pipeline). When the option is set, the output of jobs is empty until a
job is started within the subshell.

In previous versions of the shell, it was necessary to enable POSIX_JOBS in order for the builtin
command wait to return the status of background jobs that had already exited. This is no longer the
case.

16.2.8 Prompting

PROMPT_BANG <K>

If set, ‘!’ is treated specially in prompt expansion. See Prompt Expansion.

PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>

Print a carriage return just before printing a prompt in the line editor. This is on by default as multi-
line editing is only possible if the editor knows where the start of the line appears.

PROMPT_SP <D>

Attempt to preserve a partial line (i.e. a line that did not end with a newline) that would otherwise be
covered up by the command prompt due to the PROMPT_CR option. This works by outputting some
cursor-control characters, including a series of spaces, that should make the terminal wrap to the
next line when a partial line is present (note that this is only successful if your terminal has
automatic margins, which is typical).

When a partial line is preserved, by default you will see an inverse+bold character at the end of the
partial line: a ‘%’ for a normal user or a ‘#’ for root. If set, the shell parameter PROMPT_EOL_MARK
can be used to customize how the end of partial lines are shown.

NOTE: if the PROMPT_CR option is not set, enabling this option will have no effect. This option is on
by default.

PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>

If set, ‘%’ is treated specially in prompt expansion. See Prompt Expansion.

PROMPT_SUBST <K> <S>

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 165 of 616
:
If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion are performed in
prompts. Substitutions within prompts do not affect the command status.

TRANSIENT_RPROMPT

Remove any right prompt from display when accepting a command line. This may be useful with
terminals with other cut/paste methods.

16.2.9 Scripts and Functions

ALIAS_FUNC_DEF <S>

By default, zsh does not allow the definition of functions using the ‘ name ()’ syntax if name was
expanded as an alias: this causes an error. This is usually the desired behaviour, as otherwise the
combination of an alias and a function based on the same definition can easily cause problems.

When this option is set, aliases can be used for defining functions.

For example, consider the following definitions as they might occur in a startup file.

alias foo=bar
foo() {
print This probably does not do what you expect.
}

Here, foo is expanded as an alias to bar before the () is encountered, so the function defined would
be named bar. By default this is instead an error in native mode. Note that quoting any part of the
function name, or using the keyword function, avoids the problem, so is recommended when the
function name can also be an alias.

C_BASES

Output hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example ‘0xFF’ instead of the usual
‘16#FF’. If the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by default), octal numbers will be treated
similarly and hence appear as ‘077’ instead of ‘8#77’. This option has no effect on the choice of the
output base, nor on the output of bases other than hexadecimal and octal. Note that these formats
will be understood on input irrespective of the setting of C_BASES.

C_PRECEDENCES

This alters the precedence of arithmetic operators to be more like C and other programming
languages; Arithmetic Evaluation has an explicit list.

DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD <D>

Run the DEBUG trap before each command; otherwise it is run after each command. Setting this

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 166 of 616
:
option mimics the behaviour of ksh 93; with the option unset the behaviour is that of ksh 88.

ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)

If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR trap, if set, and exit. This is disabled while
running initialization scripts.

The behaviour is also disabled inside DEBUG traps. In this case the option is handled specially: it is
unset on entry to the trap. If the option DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set, as it is by default, and the
option ERR_EXIT is found to have been set on exit, then the command for which the DEBUG trap is
being executed is skipped. The option is restored after the trap exits.

Non-zero status in a command list containing && or || is ignored for commands not at the end of
the list. Hence

false && true

does not trigger exit.

Exiting due to ERR_EXIT has certain interactions with asynchronous jobs noted in Jobs & Signals.

ERR_RETURN

If a command has a non-zero exit status, return immediately from the enclosing function. The logic
is similar to that for ERR_EXIT, except that an implicit return statement is executed instead of an exit.
This will trigger an exit at the outermost level of a non-interactive script.

Normally this option inherits the behaviour of ERR_EXIT that code followed by ‘&&’ ‘||’ does not
trigger a return. Hence in the following:

summit || true

no return is forced as the combined effect always has a zero return status.

Note. however, that if summit in the above example is itself a function, code inside it is considered
separately: it may force a return from summit (assuming the option remains set within summit), but
not from the enclosing context. This behaviour is different from ERR_EXIT which is unaffected by
function scope.

EVAL_LINENO <Z>

If set, line numbers of expressions evaluated using the builtin eval are tracked separately of the
enclosing environment. This applies both to the parameter LINENO and the line number output by
the prompt escape %i. If the option is set, the prompt escape %N will output the string ‘(eval)’
instead of the script or function name as an indication. (The two prompt escapes are typically used
in the parameter PS4 to be output when the option XTRACE is set.) If EVAL_LINENO is unset, the line
number of the surrounding script or function is retained during the evaluation.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 167 of 616
:
EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>

Do execute commands. Without this option, commands are read and checked for syntax errors, but
not executed. This option cannot be turned off in an interactive shell, except when ‘-n’ is supplied to
the shell at startup.

FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>

When executing a shell function or sourcing a script, set $0 temporarily to the name of the
function/script. Note that toggling FUNCTION_ARGZERO from on to off (or off to on) does not change
the current value of $0. Only the state upon entry to the function or script has an effect. Compare
POSIX_ARGZERO.

LOCAL_LOOPS

When this option is not set, the effect of break and continue commands may propagate outside
function scope, affecting loops in calling functions. When the option is set in a calling function, a
break or a continue that is not caught within a called function (regardless of the setting of the option
within that function) produces a warning and the effect is cancelled.

LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>

If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function, most options (including this one)
which were in force upon entry to the function are restored; options that are not restored are
PRIVILEGED and RESTRICTED. Otherwise, only this option, and the LOCAL_LOOPS, XTRACE and
PRINT_EXIT_VALUE options are restored. Hence if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the other
options in force at the point of return will remain so. A shell function can also guarantee itself a
known shell configuration with a formulation like ‘emulate -L zsh’; the -L activates LOCAL_OPTIONS.

LOCAL_PATTERNS

If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function, the state of pattern disables, as set
with the builtin command ‘disable -p’, is restored to what it was when the function was entered. The
behaviour of this option is similar to the effect of LOCAL_OPTIONS on options; hence ‘emulate -L sh’
(or indeed any other emulation with the -L option) activates LOCAL_PATTERNS.

LOCAL_TRAPS <K>

If this option is set when a signal trap is set inside a function, then the previous status of the trap for
that signal will be restored when the function exits. Note that this option must be set prior to
altering the trap behaviour in a function; unlike LOCAL_OPTIONS, the value on exit from the function
is irrelevant. However, it does not need to be set before any global trap for that to be correctly
restored by a function. For example,

unsetopt localtraps
trap - INT
fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 168 of 616
:
will restore normal handling of SIGINT after the function exits.

MULTI_FUNC_DEF <Z>

Allow definitions of multiple functions at once in the form ‘fn1 fn2 ... ()’; if the option is not set, this
causes a parse error. Definition of multiple functions with the function keyword is always allowed.
Multiple function definitions are not often used and can cause obscure errors.

MULTIOS <Z>

Perform implicit tees or cats when multiple redirections are attempted (see Redirection).

OCTAL_ZEROES <S>

Interpret any integer constant beginning with a 0 as octal, per IEEE Std 1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-
2:1993). This is not enabled by default as it causes problems with parsing of, for example, date and
time strings with leading zeroes.

Sequences of digits indicating a numeric base such as the ‘08’ component in ‘08#77’ are always
interpreted as decimal, regardless of leading zeroes.

PIPE_FAIL

By default, when a pipeline exits the exit status recorded by the shell and returned by the shell
variable $? reflects that of the rightmost element of a pipeline. If this option is set, the exit status
instead reflects the status of the rightmost element of the pipeline that was non-zero, or zero if all
elements exited with zero status.

SOURCE_TRACE

If set, zsh will print an informational message announcing the name of each file it loads. The format
of the output is similar to that for the XTRACE option, with the message <sourcetrace>. A file may be
loaded by the shell itself when it starts up and shuts down (Startup/Shutdown Files) or by the use of
the ‘source’ and ‘dot’ builtin commands.

TYPESET_SILENT

If this is unset, executing any of the ‘typeset’ family of commands with no options and a list of
parameters that have no values to be assigned but already exist will display the value of the
parameter. If the option is set, they will only be shown when parameters are selected with the ‘-m’
option. The option ‘-p’ is available whether or not the option is set.

TYPESET_TO_UNSET <K> <S>

When declaring a new parameter with any of the ‘typeset’ family of related commands, the
parameter remains unset unless and until a value is explicity assigned to it, either in the ‘typeset’
command itself or as a later assignment statement.

VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 169 of 616
:
Print shell input lines as they are read.

XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)

Print commands and their arguments as they are executed. The output is preceded by the value of
$PS4, formatted as described in Prompt Expansion.

16.2.10 Shell Emulation

APPEND_CREATE <K> <S>

This option only applies when NO_CLOBBER (-C) is in effect.

If this option is not set, the shell will report an error when a append redirection (>>) is used on a file
that does not already exists (the traditional zsh behaviour of NO_CLOBBER). If the option is set, no
error is reported (POSIX behaviour).

BASH_REMATCH

When set, matches performed with the =~ operator will set the BASH_REMATCH array variable,
instead of the default MATCH and match variables. The first element of the BASH_REMATCH array
will contain the entire matched text and subsequent elements will contain extracted substrings. This
option makes more sense when KSH_ARRAYS is also set, so that the entire matched portion is stored
at index 0 and the first substring is at index 1. Without this option, the MATCH variable contains the
entire matched text and the match array variable contains substrings.

BSD_ECHO <S>

Make the echo builtin compatible with the BSD echo(1) command. This disables backslashed escape
sequences in echo strings unless the -e option is specified.

CONTINUE_ON_ERROR

If a fatal error is encountered (see Errors), and the code is running in a script, the shell will resume
execution at the next statement in the script at the top level, in other words outside all functions or
shell constructs such as loops and conditions. This mimics the behaviour of interactive shells, where
the shell returns to the line editor to read a new command; it was the normal behaviour in versions
of zsh before 5.0.1.

CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>

A history reference without an event specifier will always refer to the previous command. Without
this option, such a history reference refers to the same event as the previous history reference on
the current command line, defaulting to the previous command.

CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 170 of 616
:
Allow loop bodies to take the form ‘ list ; end’ instead of ‘do list ; done’.

CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>

Changes the rules for single- and double-quoted text to match that of csh. These require that
embedded newlines be preceded by a backslash; unescaped newlines will cause an error message.
In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to escape ‘$’, ‘‘’ or ‘"’ (and ‘\’ itself no longer needs
escaping). Command substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.

CSH_NULLCMD <C>

Do not use the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when running redirections with no
command. This make such redirections fail (see Redirection).

KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>

Emulate ksh array handling as closely as possible. If this option is set, array elements are numbered
from zero, an array parameter without subscript refers to the first element instead of the whole
array, and braces are required to delimit a subscript (‘${path[2]}’ rather than just ‘$path[2]’) or to
apply modifiers to any parameter (‘${PWD:h}’ rather than ‘$PWD:h’).

KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>

Emulate ksh function autoloading. This means that when a function is autoloaded, the
corresponding file is merely executed, and must define the function itself. (By default, the function is
defined to the contents of the file. However, the most common ksh-style case - of the file containing
only a simple definition of the function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible manner.)

KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>

Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate lists of set and unset options, all
options are shown, marked ‘on’ if they are in the non-default state, ‘off’ otherwise.

KSH_TYPESET

This option is now obsolete: a better appropximation to the behaviour of other shells is obtained
with the reserved word interface to declare, export, float, integer, local, readonly and typeset. Note
that the option is only applied when the reserved word interface is not in use.

Alters the way arguments to the typeset family of commands, including declare, export, float,
integer, local and readonly, are processed. Without this option, zsh will perform normal word
splitting after command and parameter expansion in arguments of an assignment; with it, word
splitting does not take place in those cases.

KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT

Treat use of a subscript of value zero in array or string expressions as a reference to the first
element, i.e. the element that usually has the subscript 1. Ignored if KSH_ARRAYS is also set.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 171 of 616
:
If neither this option nor KSH_ARRAYS is set, accesses to an element of an array or string with
subscript zero return an empty element or string, while attempts to set element zero of an array or
string are treated as an error. However, attempts to set an otherwise valid subscript range that
includes zero will succeed. For example, if KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is not set,

array[0]=(element)

is an error, while

array[0,1]=(element)

is not and will replace the first element of the array.

This option is for compatibility with older versions of the shell and is not recommended in new code.

POSIX_ALIASES <K> <S>

When this option is set, reserved words are not candidates for alias expansion: it is still possible to
declare any of them as an alias, but the alias will never be expanded. Reserved words are described
in Reserved Words.

Alias expansion takes place while text is being read; hence when this option is set it does not take
effect until the end of any function or other piece of shell code parsed as one unit. Note this may
cause differences from other shells even when the option is in effect. For example, when running a
command with ‘zsh -c’, or even ‘zsh -o posixaliases -c’, the entire command argument is parsed as
one unit, so aliases defined within the argument are not available even in later lines. If in doubt,
avoid use of aliases in non-interactive code.

POSIX_ARGZERO

This option may be used to temporarily disable FUNCTION_ARGZERO and thereby restore the value
of $0 to the name used to invoke the shell (or as set by the -c command line option). For
compatibility with previous versions of the shell, emulations use NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO instead
of POSIX_ARGZERO, which may result in unexpected scoping of $0 if the emulation mode is changed
inside a function or script. To avoid this, explicitly enable POSIX_ARGZERO in the emulate command:

emulate sh -o POSIX_ARGZERO

Note that NO_POSIX_ARGZERO has no effect unless FUNCTION_ARGZERO was already enabled upon
entry to the function or script.

POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>

When this option is set the command builtin can be used to execute shell builtin commands.
Parameter assignments specified before shell functions and special builtins are kept after the
command completes unless the special builtin is prefixed with the command builtin. Special builtins

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 172 of 616
:
are ., :, break, continue, declare, eval, exit, export, integer, local, readonly, return, set, shift, source,
times, trap and unset.

In addition, various error conditions associated with the above builtins or exec cause a non-
interactive shell to exit and an interactive shell to return to its top-level processing.

Furthermore, functions and shell builtins are not executed after an exec prefix; the command to be
executed must be an external command found in the path.

Furthermore, the getopts builtin behaves in a POSIX-compatible fashion in that the associated
variable OPTIND is not made local to functions, and its value is calculated differently to match other
shells.

Moreover, the warning and special exit code from [[ -o non_existent_option ]] are suppressed.

POSIX_IDENTIFIERS <K> <S>

When this option is set, only the ASCII characters a to z, A to Z, 0 to 9 and _ may be used in identifiers
(names of shell parameters and modules).

In addition, setting this option limits the effect of parameter substitution with no braces, so that the
expression $# is treated as the parameter $# even if followed by a valid parameter name. When it is
unset, zsh allows expressions of the form $# name to refer to the length of $ name , even for special
variables, for example in expressions such as $#- and $#*.

Another difference is that with the option set assignment to an unset variable in arithmetic context
causes the variable to be created as a scalar rather than a numeric type. So after ‘unset t; (( t = 3 ))’.
without POSIX_IDENTIFIERS set t has integer type, while with it set it has scalar type.

When the option is unset and multibyte character support is enabled (i.e. it is compiled in and the
option MULTIBYTE is set), then additionally any alphanumeric characters in the local character set
may be used in identifiers. Note that scripts and functions written with this feature are or function is
parsed; setting them during execution is not sufficient as the syntax variable = value has already
been parsed as a command rather than an assignment.

If multibyte character support is not compiled into the shell this option is ignored; all octets with the
top bit set may be used in identifiers. This is non-standard but is the traditional zsh behaviour.

POSIX_STRINGS <K> <S>

This option affects processing of quoted strings. Currently it only affects the behaviour of null
characters, i.e. character 0 in the

When this option is not set, null characters embedded within strings of the form $’ ... ’ are treated
as ordinary characters. The entire string is maintained within the shell and output to files where
necessary, although owing to restrictions of the library interface the string is truncated at the null
character in file names, environment variables, or in arguments to external programs.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 173 of 616
:
When this option is set, the $’ ... ’ expression is truncated at the null character. Note that remaining
parts of the same string beyond the termination of the quotes are not truncated.

For example, the command line argument a$’b\0c’d is treated with the option off as the characters a,
b, null, c, d, and with the option on as the characters a, b, d.

POSIX_TRAPS <K> <S>

When this option is set, the usual zsh behaviour of executing traps for EXIT on exit from shell
functions is suppressed. In that case, manipulating EXIT traps always alters the global trap for exiting
the shell; the LOCAL_TRAPS option is ignored for the EXIT trap.

Also, a return statement executed in a trap with no argument passes back from the function the
value from the surrounding context, not from code executed within the trap.

Furthermore, if a trap is set to be ignored, this state persists when a subshell is entered. Without the
option, the trap would be reset to its default state at this point.

SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>

Perform filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter expansion, command substitution,
arithmetic expansion and brace expansion. If this option is unset, it is performed after brace
expansion, so things like ‘~$USERNAME’ and ‘~{pfalstad,rc}’ will work.

SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>

Do not use the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when doing redirections, use ‘:’ instead (see
Redirection).

SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>

If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter options (which are used with set and
setopt) like ksh does. This also affects the value of the - special parameter.

SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>

Causes field splitting to be performed on unquoted parameter expansions. Note that this option has
nothing to do with word splitting. (See Parameter Expansion.)

TRAPS_ASYNC

While waiting for a program to exit, handle signals and run traps immediately. Otherwise the trap is
run after a child process has exited. Note this does not affect the point at which traps are run for
any case other than when the shell is waiting for a child process.

16.2.11 Shell State

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 174 of 616
:
INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)

This is an interactive shell. This option is set upon initialisation if the standard input is a tty and
commands are being read from standard input. (See the discussion of SHIN_STDIN.) This heuristic
may be overridden by specifying a state for this option on the command line. The value of this
option can only be changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell. It cannot be changed once
zsh is running.

LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)

This is a login shell. If this option is not explicitly set, the shell becomes a login shell if the first
character of the argv[0] passed to the shell is a ‘-’.

PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)

Turn on privileged mode. Typically this is used when script is to be run with elevated privileges. This
should be done as follows directly with the -p option to zsh so that it takes effect during startup.

#!/bin/zsh -p

The option is enabled automatically on startup if the effective user (group) ID is not equal to the real
user (group) ID. In this case, turning the option off causes the effective user and group IDs to be set
to the real user and group IDs. Be aware that if that fails the shell may be running with different IDs
than was intended so a script should check for failure and act accordingly, for example:

unsetopt privileged || exit

The PRIVILEGED option disables sourcing user startup files. If zsh is invoked as ‘sh’ or ‘ksh’ with this
option set, /etc/suid_profile is sourced (after /etc/profile on interactive shells). Sourcing ~/.profile is
disabled and the contents of the ENV variable is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the -
m option of setopt and unsetopt, and changing it inside a function always changes it globally
regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.

RESTRICTED (-r)

Enables restricted mode. This option cannot be changed using unsetopt, and setting it inside a
function always changes it globally regardless of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option. See Restricted Shell.

SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)

Commands are being read from the standard input. Commands are read from standard input if no
command is specified with -c and no file of commands is specified. If SHIN_STDIN is set explicitly on
the command line, any argument that would otherwise have been taken as a file to run will instead
be treated as a normal positional parameter. Note that setting or unsetting this option on the
command line does not necessarily affect the state the option will have while the shell is running -
that is purely an indicator of whether or not commands are actually being read from standard input.
The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell. It cannot be
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 175 of 616
:
changed once zsh is running.

SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)

If the shell is reading from standard input, it exits after a single command has been executed. This
also makes the shell non-interactive, unless the INTERACTIVE option is explicitly set on the command
line. The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell. It
cannot be changed once zsh is running.

16.2.12 Zle

BEEP (+B) <D>

Beep on error in ZLE.

COMBINING_CHARS

Assume that the terminal displays combining characters correctly. Specifically, if a base
alphanumeric character is followed by one or more zero-width punctuation characters, assume that
the zero-width characters will be displayed as modifications to the base character within the same
width. Not all terminals handle this. If this option is not set, zero-width characters are displayed
separately with special mark-up.

If this option is set, the pattern test [[:WORD:]] matches a zero-width punctuation character on the
assumption that it will be used as part of a word in combination with a word character. Otherwise
the base shell does not handle combining characters specially.

EMACS

If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect of ‘bindkey -e’. In addition, the VI
option is unset. Turning it off has no effect. The option setting is not guaranteed to reflect the
current keymap. This option is provided for compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

OVERSTRIKE

Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.

SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>

Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.

Note that although this is on by default in ksh emulation it only provides superficial compatibility
with the ksh line editor and reduces the effectiveness of the zsh line editor. As it has no effect on
shell syntax, many users may wish to disable this option when using ksh emulation interactively.

VI

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 176 of 616
:
If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect of ‘bindkey -v’. In addition, the
EMACS option is unset. Turning it off has no effect. The option setting is not guaranteed to reflect
the current keymap. This option is provided for compatibility; bindkey is the recommended
interface.

ZLE (-Z)

Use the zsh line editor. Set by default in interactive shells connected to a terminal.

16.3 Option Aliases


Some options have alternative names. These aliases are never used for output, but can be used just
like normal option names when specifying options to the shell.

BRACE_EXPAND

*NO_*IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)

DOT_GLOB

GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)

HASH_ALL

HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)

HIST_APPEND

APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)

HIST_EXPAND

BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)

LOG

*NO_*HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)

MAIL_WARN

MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)

ONE_CMD

SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)

PHYSICAL

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 177 of 616
:
CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)

PROMPT_VARS

PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)

STDIN

SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)

TRACK_ALL

HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)

16.4 Single Letter Options

16.4.1 Default set

-0
CORRECT

-1
PRINT_EXIT_VALUE

-2
*NO_*BAD_PATTERN

-3
*NO_*NOMATCH

-4
GLOB_DOTS

-5
NOTIFY

-6
BG_NICE

-7
IGNORE_EOF

-8

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 178 of 616
:
MARK_DIRS

-9
AUTO_LIST

-B
*NO_*BEEP

-C
*NO_*CLOBBER

-D
PUSHD_TO_HOME

-E
PUSHD_SILENT

-F
*NO_*GLOB

-G
NULL_GLOB

-H
RM_STAR_SILENT

-I
IGNORE_BRACES

-J
AUTO_CD

-K
*NO_*BANG_HIST

-L
SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK

-M
SINGLE_LINE_ZLE

-N
AUTO_PUSHD

-O
CORRECT_ALL

-P
RC_EXPAND_PARAM

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 179 of 616
:
-Q
PATH_DIRS

-R
LONG_LIST_JOBS

-S
REC_EXACT

-T
CDABLE_VARS

-U
MAIL_WARNING

-V
*NO_*PROMPT_CR

-W
AUTO_RESUME

-X
LIST_TYPES

-Y
MENU_COMPLETE

-Z
ZLE

-a
ALL_EXPORT

-e
ERR_EXIT

-f
*NO_*RCS

-g
HIST_IGNORE_SPACE

-h
HIST_IGNORE_DUPS

-i
INTERACTIVE

-k

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 180 of 616
:
INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS

-l
LOGIN

-m
MONITOR

-n
*NO_*EXEC

-p
PRIVILEGED

-r
RESTRICTED

-s
SHIN_STDIN

-t
SINGLE_COMMAND

-u
*NO_*UNSET

-v
VERBOSE

-w
CHASE_LINKS

-x
XTRACE

-y
SH_WORD_SPLIT

16.4.2 sh/ksh emulation set

-C
*NO_*CLOBBER

-T
TRAPS_ASYNC

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 181 of 616
:
-X
MARK_DIRS

-a
ALL_EXPORT

-b
NOTIFY

-e
ERR_EXIT

-f
*NO_*GLOB

-i
INTERACTIVE

-l
LOGIN

-m
MONITOR

-n
*NO_*EXEC

-p
PRIVILEGED

-r
RESTRICTED

-s
SHIN_STDIN

-t
SINGLE_COMMAND

-u
*NO_*UNSET

-v
VERBOSE

-x
XTRACE

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 182 of 616
:
16.4.3 Also note

-A
Used by set for setting arrays

-b
Used on the command line to specify end of option processing

-c
Used on the command line to specify a single command

-m
Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting

-o
Used in all places to allow use of long option names

-s
Used by set to sort positional parameters

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 183 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

17 Shell Builtin Commands

17 Shell Builtin Commands


Some shell builtin commands take options as described in individual entries; these are often
referred to in the list below as ‘flags’ to avoid confusion with shell options, which may also have an
effect on the behaviour of builtin commands. In this introductory section, ‘option’ always has the
meaning of an option to a command that should be familiar to most command line users.

Typically, options are single letters preceded by a hyphen (-). Options that take an argument accept
it either immediately following the option letter or after white space, for example ‘print -C3 {1..9}’ or
‘print -C 3 {1..9}’ are equivalent. Arguments to options are not the same as arguments to the
command; the documentation indicates which is which. Options that do not take an argument may
be combined in a single word, for example ‘print -rca – *’ and ‘print -r -c -a – *’ are equivalent.

Some shell builtin commands also take options that begin with ‘+’ instead of ‘-’. The list below makes
clear which commands these are.

Options (together with their individual arguments, if any) must appear in a group before any non-
option arguments; once the first non-option argument has been found, option processing is
terminated.

All builtin commands other than ‘echo’ and precommand modifiers, even those that have no
options, can be given the argument ‘--’ to terminate option processing. This indicates that the
following words are non-option arguments, but is otherwise ignored. This is useful in cases where
arguments to the command may begin with ‘-’. For historical reasons, most builtin commands
(including ‘echo’) also recognize a single ‘-’ in a separate word for this purpose; note that this is less
standard and use of ‘--’ is recommended.

- simple command
See Precommand Modifiers.

. file [ arg ... ]


Read commands from file and execute them in the current shell environment.

If file does not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS is set, the shell looks in the components of $path
to find the directory containing file . Files in the current directory are not read unless ‘.’ appears
somewhere in $path. If a file named ‘ file .zwc’ is found, is newer than file , and is the compiled
form (created with the zcompile builtin) of file , then commands are read from that file instead of
file .

If any arguments arg are given, they become the positional parameters; the old positional
parameters are restored when the file is done executing. However, if no arguments are given, the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 184 of 616
:
positional parameters remain those of the calling context, and no restoring is done.

If file was not found the return status is 127; if file was found but contained a syntax error the
return status is 126; else the return status is the exit status of the last command executed.

: [ arg ... ]
This command does nothing, although normal argument expansions is performed which may have
effects on shell parameters. A zero exit status is returned.

alias [ {+|-}gmrsL ] [ name [= value ] ... ]


For each name with a corresponding value , define an alias with that value. A trailing space in
value causes the next word to be checked for alias expansion. If the -g flag is present, define a
global alias; global aliases are expanded even if they do not occur in command position:

% perldoc --help 2>&1 | grep 'built-in functions'


-f Search Perl built-in functions
% alias -g HG='--help 2>&1 | grep'
% perldoc HG 'built-in functions'
-f Search Perl built-in functions

If the -s flag is present, define a suffix alias: if the command word on a command line is in the form
‘ text . name ’, where text is any non-empty string, it is replaced by the text ‘ value text . name ’.
Note that name is treated as a literal string, not a pattern. A trailing space in value is not special in
this case. For example,

alias -s ps='gv --'

will cause the command ‘*.ps’ to be expanded to ‘gv – *.ps’. As alias expansion is carried out earlier
than globbing, the ‘*.ps’ will then be expanded. Suffix aliases constitute a different name space from
other aliases (so in the above example it is still possible to create an alias for the command ps) and
the two sets are never listed together.

For each name with no value , print the value of name , if any. With no arguments, print all currently
defined aliases other than suffix aliases. If the -m flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
(they should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob patterns), and the aliases
matching these patterns are printed. When printing aliases and one of the -g, -r or -s flags is present,
restrict the printing to global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular alias is one which is
neither a global nor a suffix alias. Using ‘+’ instead of ‘-’, or ending the option list with a single ‘+’,
prevents the values of the aliases from being printed.

If the -L flag is present, then print each status is nonzero if a name (with no value ) is given for which
no alias has been defined.

For more on aliases, include common problems, see Aliasing.

autoload [ {+|-}RTUXdkmrtWz ] [ -w ] [ name ... ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 185 of 616
:
See the section ‘Autoloading Functions’ in Functions for full details. The fpath parameter will be
searched to find the function definition when the function is first referenced.

If name consists of an absolute path, the function is defined to load from the file given (searching as
usual for dump files in the given location). The name of the function is the basename (non-directory
part) of the file. It is normally an error if the function is not found in the given location; however, if
the option -d is given, searching for the function defaults to $fpath. If a function is loaded by
absolute path, any functions loaded from it that are marked for autoload without an absolute path
have the load path of the parent function temporarily prepended to $fpath.

If the option -r or -R is given, the function is searched for immediately and the location is recorded
internally for use when the function is executed; a relative path is expanded using the value of
$PWD. This protects against a change to $fpath after the call to autoload. With -r, if the function is
not found, it is silently left unresolved until execution; with -R, an error message is printed and
command processing aborted immediately the search fails, i.e. at the autoload command rather
than at function execution..

The flag -X may be used only inside a shell function. It causes the calling function to be marked for
autoloading and then immediately loaded and executed, with the current array of positional
parameters as arguments. This replaces the previous definition of the function. If no function
definition is found, an error is printed and the function remains undefined and marked for
autoloading. If an argument is given, it is used as a directory (i.e. it does not include the name of the
function) in which the function is to be found; this may be combined with the -d option to allow the
function search to default to $fpath if it is not in the given location.

The flag +X attempts to load each name as an autoloaded function, but does not execute it. The exit
status is zero (success) if the function was not previously defined and a definition for it was found.
This does not replace any existing definition of the function. The exit status is nonzero (failure) if the
function was already defined or when no definition was found. In the latter case the function
remains undefined and marked for autoloading. If ksh-style autoloading is enabled, the function
created will contain the contents of the file plus a call to the function itself appended to it, thus
giving normal ksh autoloading behaviour on the first call to the function. If the -m flag is also given
each name is treated as a pattern and all functions already marked for autoload that match the
pattern are loaded.

With the -t flag, turn on execution tracing; with -T, turn on execution tracing only for the current
function, turning it off on entry to any called functions that do not also have tracing enabled.

With the -U flag, alias expansion is suppressed when the function is loaded.

With the -w flag, the name s are taken as names of files compiled with the zcompile builtin, and all
functions defined in them are marked for autoloading.

The flags -z and -k mark the function to be autoloaded using the zsh or ksh style, as if the option
KSH_AUTOLOAD were unset or were set, respectively. The flags override the setting of the option at
the time the function is loaded.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 186 of 616
:
Note that the autoload command makes no attempt to ensure the shell options set during the
loading or execution of the file have any particular value. For this, the emulate command can be
used:

emulate zsh -c 'autoload -Uz func'

arranges that when func is loaded the shell is in native zsh emulation, and this emulation is also
applied when func is run.

Some of the functions of autoload are also provided by functions -u or functions -U, but autoload is
a more comprehensive interface.

bg [ job ... ]
job ... &
Put each specified job in the background, or the current job if none is specified.

bindkey
See Zle Builtins.

break [ n ]
Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop. If an arithmetic expression n is
specified, then break n levels instead of just one.

builtin name [ args ... ]


Executes the builtin name , with the given args .

bye
Same as exit.

cap
See The zsh/cap Module.

cd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
cd [ -qsLP ] old new
cd [ -qsLP ] {+|-} n
Change the current directory. In the first form, change the current directory to arg , or to the value
of $HOME if arg is not specified. If arg is ‘-’, change to the previous directory.

Otherwise, if arg begins with a slash, attempt to change to the directory given by arg .

If arg does not begin with a slash, the behaviour depends on whether the current directory ‘.’
occurs in the list of directories contained in the shell parameter cdpath. If it does not, first attempt to
change to the directory arg under the current directory, and if that fails but cdpath is set and
contains at least one element attempt to change to the directory arg under each component of
cdpath in turn until successful. If ‘.’ occurs in cdpath, then cdpath is searched strictly in order so that

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 187 of 616
:
‘.’ is only tried at the appropriate point.

The order of testing cdpath is modified if the option POSIX_CD is set, as described in the
documentation for the option.

If no directory is found, the option CDABLE_VARS is set, and a parameter named arg exists whose
value begins with a slash, treat its value as the directory. In that case, the parameter is added to the
named

The second form of cd substitutes the string new for the string old in the name of the current
directory, and tries to change to this new directory.

The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory stack, and changes to that directory. An
argument of the form ‘+ n ’ identifies a stack entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the
dirs command, starting with zero. An argument of the form ‘- n ’ counts from the right. If the
PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings of ‘+’ and ‘-’ in this context are swapped. If the POSIX_CD
option is set, this form of cd is not recognised and will be interpreted as the first form.

If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in the array
chpwd_functions are not called. This is useful for calls to cd that do not change the environment
seen by an interactive user.

If the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current directory if the given pathname
contains symlinks. If the -P option is given or the CHASE_LINKS option is set, symbolic links are
resolved to their true values. If the -L option is given symbolic links are retained in the directory (and
not resolved) regardless of the state of the CHASE_LINKS option.

chdir
Same as cd.

clone
See The zsh/clone Module.

command [ -pvV ] simple command


The simple command argument is taken as an external command instead of a function or builtin
and is executed. If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also be executed but certain special
properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag causes a default path to be searched instead of that
in $path. With the -v flag, command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent to whence -v.

See also Precommand Modifiers.

comparguments
See The zsh/computil Module.

compcall
See The zsh/compctl Module.

compctl
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 188 of 616
:
See The zsh/compctl Module.

compdescribe
See The zsh/computil Module.

compfiles
See The zsh/computil Module.

compgroups
See The zsh/computil Module.

compquote
See The zsh/computil Module.

comptags
See The zsh/computil Module.

comptry
See The zsh/computil Module.

compvalues
See The zsh/computil Module.

continue [ n ]
Resume the next iteration of the enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop. If an arithmetic
expression n is specified, break out of n -1 loops and resume at the n th enclosing loop.

declare
Same as typeset.

dirs [ -c ] [ arg ... ]


dirs [ -lpv ]
With no arguments, print the contents of the directory stack. Directories are added to this stack with
the pushd command, and removed with the cd or popd commands. If arguments are specified, load
them onto the directory stack, replacing anything that was there, and push the current directory
onto the stack.

-c
clear the directory stack.

-l
print directory names in full instead of using of using ~ expressions (Filename Expansion).

-p
print directory entries one per line.

-v
number the directories in the stack when printing.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 189 of 616
:
disable [ -afmprs ] name ...
’?’
The pattern character ? wherever it occurs, including when preceding a parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.

’*’
The pattern character * wherever it occurs, including recursive globbing and when preceding a
parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.

’[’
Character classes.

’<’ (NO_SH_GLOB)
Numeric ranges.

’|’ (NO_SH_GLOB)
Alternation in grouped patterns, case statements, or KSH_GLOB parenthesised expressions.

’(’ (NO_SH_GLOB)
Grouping using single parentheses. Disabling this does not disable the use of parentheses for
KSH_GLOB where they are introduced by a special character, nor for glob qualifiers (use ‘setopt
NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL’ to disable glob qualifiers that use parentheses only).

’~’ (EXTENDED_GLOB)
Exclusion in the form A ~ B .

’^’ (EXTENDED_GLOB)
Exclusion in the form A ^ B .

’#’ (EXTENDED_GLOB)
The pattern character # wherever it occurs, both for repetition of a previous pattern and for
indicating globbing flags.

’?(’ (KSH_GLOB)
The grouping form ?( ... ). Note this is also disabled if ’?’ is disabled.

’*(’ (KSH_GLOB)
The grouping form *( ... ). Note this is also disabled if ’*’ is disabled.

’+(’ (KSH_GLOB)
The grouping form +( ... ).

’!(’ (KSH_GLOB)
The grouping form !( ... ).

’@(’ (KSH_GLOB)
The grouping form @( ... ).

disown [ job ... ]


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 190 of 616
:
job ... &|

job ... &!

no longer report their status, and will not complain if you try to exit an interactive shell with them
running or stopped. If no job is specified, disown the current job.

If the job s are currently stopped and the AUTO_CONTINUE option is not set, a warning is printed
containing information about how to make them running after they have been disowned. If one of
the latter two forms is used, the job s will automatically be made running, independent of the
setting of the AUTO_CONTINUE option.

echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]

Write each arg on the standard output, with a space separating each one. If the -n flag is not
present, print a newline at the end. echo recognizes the following escape sequences:

\a
bell character

\b
backspace

\c
suppress subsequent characters and final newline

\e
escape

\f
form feed

\n
linefeed (newline)

\r
carriage return

\t
horizontal tab

\v
vertical tab

\\
backslash

\0 NNN
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 191 of 616
:
character code in octal

\x NN
character code in hexadecimal

\u NNNN
unicode character code in hexadecimal

\U NNNNNNNN
unicode character code in hexadecimal

The -E flag, or the BSD_ECHO option, can be used to disable these escape sequences. In the latter
case, -e flag can be used to enable them.

Note that for standards compliance a double dash does not terminate option processing; instead, it
is printed directly. However, a single dash does terminate option processing, so the first dash,
possibly following options, is not printed, but everything following it is printed as an argument. The
single dash behaviour is different printf, and for a more controllable way of printing text within zsh,
see print.

echotc

See The zsh/termcap Module.

echoti

See The zsh/terminfo Module.

emulate [ -lLR ] [ {zsh|sh|ksh|csh} [ flags ... ] ]

Without any argument print current emulation mode.

With single argument set up zsh options to emulate the specified shell as much as possible. csh will
never be fully emulated. If the argument is not one of the shells listed above, zsh will be used as a
default; more precisely, the tests performed on the argument are the same as those used to
determine the emulation at startup based on the shell name, see Compatibility . In addition to
setting shell options, the command also restores the pristine state of pattern enables, as if all
patterns had been enabled using enable -p.

If the emulate command occurs inside a function that has been marked for execution tracing with
functions -t then the xtrace option will be turned on regardless of emulation mode or other options.
Note that code executed inside the function by the ., source, or eval commands is not considered to
be running directly from the function, hence does not provoke this behaviour.

are reset to their default value corresponding to the specified emulation mode, except for certain
options describing the interactive environment; otherwise, only those options likely to cause
portability problems in scripts and functions are altered. If the -L switch is given, the options
LOCAL_OPTIONS, LOCAL_PATTERNS and LOCAL_TRAPS will be set as well, causing the effects of the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 192 of 616
:
emulate command and any setopt, disable -p or enable -p, and trap commands to be local to the
immediately surrounding shell function, if any; normally these options are turned off in all emulation
modes except ksh. The -L switch is mutually exclusive with the use of -c in flags .

If there is a single argument and the -l switch is given, the options that would be set or unset (the
latter indicated with the prefix ‘no’) are listed. -l can be combined with -L or -R and the list will be
modified in the appropriate way. Note the list does not depend on the current setting of options, i.e.
it includes all options that may in principle change, not just those that would actually change.

The flags may be any of the invocation-time flags described in Invocation, except that ‘-o EMACS’
and ‘-o VI’ may not be used. Flags such as ‘+r’/‘+o RESTRICTED’ may be prohibited in some
circumstances.

If -c arg appears in flags , arg is evaluated while the requested emulation is temporarily in effect.
In this case the emulation mode and all options are restored to their previous values before emulate
returns. The -R switch may precede the name of the shell to emulate; note this has a meaning
distinct from including -R in flags .

Use of -c enables ‘sticky’ emulation mode for functions defined within the evaluated expression: the
emulation mode is associated thereafter with the function so that whenever the function is executed
the emulation (respecting the -R switch, if present) and all options are set (and pattern disables
cleared) before entry to the function, and the state is restored after exit. If the function is called
when the sticky emulation is already in effect, either within an ‘emulate shell -c’ expression or
within another function with the same sticky emulation, entry and exit from the function do not
cause options to be altered (except due to standard processing such as the LOCAL_OPTIONS option).
This also applies to functions marked for autoload within the sticky emulation; the appropriate set of
options will be applied at the point the function is loaded as well as when it is run.

For example:

emulate sh -c 'fni() { setopt cshnullglob; }


fno() { fni; }'
fno

The two functions fni and fno are defined with sticky sh emulation. fno is then executed, causing
options associated with emulations to be set to their values in sh. fno then calls fni; because fni is
also marked for sticky sh emulation, no option changes take place on entry to or exit from it. Hence
the option cshnullglob, turned off by sh emulation, will be turned on within fni and remain on return
to fno. On exit from fno, the emulation mode and all options will be restored to the state they were
in before entry to the temporary emulation.

The documentation above is typically sufficient for the intended environment. More detailed rules
follow.

1.
The sticky emulation environment provided by ‘emulate shell -c’ is identical to that provided by

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 193 of 616
:
entry to a function marked for sticky emulation as a consequence of being defined in such an
environment. Hence, for example, the sticky emulation is inherited by subfunctions defined within
functions with sticky emulation.

2.
No change of options takes place on entry to or exit from functions that are not marked for sticky
emulation, other than those that would normally take place, even if those functions are called within
sticky emulation.

3.
No special handling is provided for functions marked for autoload nor for functions present in
wordcode created by the zcompile command.

4.
The presence or absence of the -R switch to emulate corresponds to different sticky emulation
modes, so for example ‘emulate sh -c’, ‘emulate -R sh -c’ and ‘emulate csh -c’ are treated as three
distinct sticky emulations.

5.
Difference in shell options supplied in addition to the basic emulation also mean the sticky
emulations are different, so for example ‘emulate zsh -c’ and ‘emulate zsh -o cbases -c’ are treated as
distinct sticky emulations.

enable [ -afmprs ] name ...

earlier with disable. The default is to enable builtin commands. The -a option causes enable to act on
regular or global aliases. The -s option causes enable to act on suffix aliases. The -f option causes
enable to act on shell functions. The -r option causes enable to act on reserved words. Without
arguments printed. With the -m flag the arguments are taken as patterns disabled with the disable
builtin command.

enable -p reenables patterns disabled with disable -p. Note that it does not override globbing
options; for example, ‘enable -p "~"’ does not cause the pattern character ~ to be active unless the
EXTENDED_GLOB option is also set. To enable all possible patterns (so that they may be individually
disabled with disable -p), use ‘setopt EXTENDED_GLOB KSH_GLOB NO_SH_GLOB’.

eval [ arg ... ]

Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the resulting command(s) in the current shell
process. The return status is the same as if the commands had been executed directly by the shell; if
there are no args or they contain no commands (i.e. are an empty string or whitespace) the return
status is zero.

exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ] [ command [ arg ... ] ]

Replace the current shell with command rather than forking. If command is a shell builtin command or
a shell function, the shell executes it, and exits when the command is complete.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 194 of 616
:
With -c clear the environment; with -l prepend - to the argv[0] string of the command executed (to
simulate a login shell); with -a argv0 set the argv[0] string of the command executed. See
Precommand Modifiers.

If the option POSIX_BUILTINS is set, command is never interpreted as a shell builtin command or shell
function. This means further precommand modifiers such as builtin and noglob are also not
interpreted within the shell. Hence command is always found by searching the command path.

If command is omitted but any redirections are specified, then the redirections will take effect in the
current shell.

exit [ n ]

Exit the shell with the exit status specified by an arithmetic expression n ; if none is specified, use
the exit status from the last command executed. An EOF condition will also cause the shell to exit,
unless the IGNORE_EOF option is set.

See notes at the end of Jobs & Signals for some possibly unexpected interactions of the exit
command with jobs.

export [ name [= value ] ... ]

The specified name s are marked for automatic export to the environment of subsequently executed
commands. Equivalent to typeset -gx. If a parameter specified does not already exist, it is created in
the global scope.

false [ arg ... ]

Do nothing and return an exit status of 1.

fc [ -e ename ] [ -s ] [ -LI ] [ -m match ] [ old = new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]

fc -l [ -LI ] [ -nrdfEiD ] [ -t timefmt ] [ -m match ]

[ old = new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]

fc -p [ -a ] [ filename [ histsize [ savehistsize ] ] ]

fc -P

fc -ARWI [ filename ]

The fc command controls the interactive history mechanism. Note that reading and writing of
history options is only performed if the shell is interactive. Usually this is detected automatically, but
it can be forced by setting the interactive option when starting the shell.

The first two forms of this command select a range of events from first to last from the history
list. The arguments first and last may be specified as a number or as a string. A negative

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 195 of 616
:
number is used as an offset to the current history event number. A string specifies the most recent
event beginning with the given string. All substitutions old = new , if any, are then performed on the
text of the events.

The range of events selected by numbers can be narrowed further by the following flags.

-I
restricts to only internal events (not from $HISTFILE)

-L
restricts to only local events (not from other shells, see SHARE_HISTORY in Description of Options –
note that $HISTFILE is considered local when read at startup)

-m
takes the first argument as a pattern (which should be quoted) and only the history events matching
this pattern are considered

If first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent event), or to -16 if the -l flag is given. If
last is not specified, it will be set to first , or to -1 if the -l flag is given. However, if the current
event has added entries to the history with ‘print -s’ or ‘fc -R’, then the default last for -l includes all
new history entries since the current event began.

When the -l flag is given, the resulting events are listed on standard output. Otherwise the editor
program specified by -e ename is invoked on a file containing these history events. If -e is not given,
the value of the parameter FCEDIT is used; if that is not set the value of the parameter EDITOR is
used; if that is not set a builtin default, usually ‘vi’ is used. If ename is ‘-’, no editor is invoked. When
editing is complete, the edited command is executed.

The flag ‘-s’ is equivalent to ‘-e -’. The flag -r reverses the order of the events and the flag -n
suppresses event numbers when listing.

Also when listing,

-d
prints timestamps for each event

-f
prints full time-date stamps in the US ‘ MM / DD / YY hh : mm ’ format

-E
prints full time-date stamps in the European ‘ dd . mm . yyyy hh : mm ’ format

-i
prints full time-date stamps in ISO8601 ‘ yyyy - mm - dd hh : mm ’ format

-t fmt
prints time and date stamps in the given format; fmt is formatted with the strftime function with

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 196 of 616
:
the zsh extensions described for the %D{ string } prompt format in Prompt Expansion. The
resulting formatted string must be no more than 256 characters or will not be printed

-D
prints elapsed times; may be combined with one of the options above

‘fc -p’ pushes the current history list onto a stack and switches to a new history list. If the -a option is
also specified, this history list will be automatically popped when the current function scope is
exited, which is a much better solution than creating a trap function to call ‘fc -P’ manually. If no
arguments are specified, the history list is left empty, $HISTFILE is unset, and $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST
are set to their default values. If one argument is given, $HISTFILE is set to that filename, $HISTSIZE
& $SAVEHIST are left unchanged, and the history file is read in (if it exists) to initialize the new list. If
a second argument is specified, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are instead set to the single specified
numeric value. Finally, if a third argument is specified, $SAVEHIST is set to a separate value from
$HISTSIZE. You are free to change these environment values for the new history list however you
desire in order to manipulate the new history list.

‘fc -P’ pops the history list back to an older list saved by ‘fc -p’. The current list is saved to its
$HISTFILE before it is destroyed (assuming that $HISTFILE and $SAVEHIST are set appropriately, of
course). The values of $HISTFILE, $HISTSIZE, and $SAVEHIST are restored to the values they had
when ‘fc -p’ was called. Note that this restoration can conflict with making these variables "local", so
your best bet is to avoid local declarations for these variables in functions that use ‘fc -p’. The one
other guaranteed-safe combination is declaring these variables to be local at the top of your
function and using the automatic option (-a) with ‘fc -p’. Finally, note that it is legal to manually pop a
push marked for automatic popping if you need to do so before the function exits.

‘fc -R’ reads the history from the given file, ‘fc -W’ writes the history out to the given file, and ‘fc -A’
appends the history out to the given file. If no filename is specified, the $HISTFILE is assumed. If the -
I option is added to -R, only those events that are not already contained within the internal history
list are added. If the -I option is added to -A or -W, only those events that are new since last
incremental append/write to the history file are appended/written. In any case, the created file will
have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.

fg [ job ... ]

job ...

Bring each specified job in turn to the foreground. If no job is specified, resume the current job.

float [ {+|-}Hghlprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZ [ n ] ] [ name [= value ] ... ]

Equivalent to typeset -E, except that options irrelevant to floating point numbers are not permitted.

functions [ {+|-}UkmtTuWz ] [ -x num ] [ name ... ]

functions -c oldfn newfn

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 197 of 616
:
functions -M [-s] mathfn [ min [ max [ shellfn ] ] ]

functions -M [ -m pattern ... ]

functions +M [ -m ] mathfn ...

Equivalent to typeset -f, with the exception of the -c, -x, -M and -W options. For functions -u and
functions -U, see autoload, which provides additional options. For functions -t and functions -T, see
typeset -f.

The -x option indicates that any functions output will have each leading tab for indentation, added
by the shell to show syntactic structure, expanded to the given number num of spaces. num can also
be 0 to suppress all indentation.

The -W option turns on the option WARN_NESTED_VAR for the named function or functions only.
The option is turned off at the start of nested functions (apart from anonoymous functions) unless
the called function also has the -W attribute.

The -c option causes oldfn to be copied to newfn . The copy is efficiently handled internally by
reference counting. If oldfn was marked for autoload it is first loaded and if this fails the copy fails.
Either function may subsequently be redefined without affecting the other. A typical idiom is that
oldfn is the name of a library shell function which is then redefined to call newfn, thereby installing
a modified version of the function.

The -M and +M flags

Use of the -M option may not be combined with any of the options handled by typeset -f.

functions -M mathfn defines mathfn as the name of a mathematical function recognised in all
forms of arithmetical expressions; see Arithmetic Evaluation. By default mathfn may take any
number of comma-separated arguments. If min is given, it must have exactly min args; if min and
max are both given, it must have at least min and at most max args. max may be -1 to indicate that
there is no upper limit.

By default the function is implemented by a shell function of the same name; if shellfn is specified
it gives the name of the corresponding shell function while mathfn remains the name used in
arithmetical expressions. The name of the function in $0 is mathfn (not shellfn as would usually
be the case), provided the option FUNCTION_ARGZERO is in effect. The positional parameters in the
shell function correspond to the arguments of the mathematical function call.

The result of the last arithmetical expression evaluated inside the shell function gives the result of
the mathematical function. This is not limited to arithmetic substitutions of the form $(( ... )), but
also includes arithmetical expressions evaluated in any other way, including by the let builtin, by
(( ... )) statements, and even by the return builtin and by array subscripts. Therefore, care must be
taken not to use syntactical constructs that perform arithmetic evaluation after evaluating what is to
be the result of the function. For example:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 198 of 616
:
# WRONG
zmath_cube() {
(( $1 * $1 * $1 ))
return 0
}
functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
print $(( cube(3) ))

This will print ‘0’ because of the return.

Commenting the return out would lead to a different problem: the (( ... )) statement would become
the last statement in the function, so the return status ($?) of the function would be non-zero
(indicating failure) whenever the arithmetic result of the function would happen to be zero
(numerically):

# WRONG
zmath_cube() {
(( $1 * $1 * $1 ))
}
functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
print $(( cube(0) ))

Instead, the true builtin can be used:

# RIGHT
zmath_cube() {
(( $1 * $1 * $1 ))
true
}
functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
print $(( cube(3) ))

If the additional option -s is given to functions -M, the argument to the function is a single string:
anything between the opening and matching closing parenthesis is passed to the function as a
single argument, even if it includes commas or white space. The minimum and maximum argument
specifiers must therefore be 1 if given. An empty argument list is passed as a zero-length string.
Thus, the following string function takes a single argument, including the commas, and prints 11:

stringfn() { (( $#1 )); true }


functions -Ms stringfn
print $(( stringfn(foo,bar,rod) ))

functions -M with no arguments lists all such user-defined functions in the same form as a
definition. With the additional option -m and a list of arguments, all functions whose mathfn
matches one of the pattern arguments are listed.

function +M removes the list of mathematical functions; with the additional option -m the
arguments are treated as patterns and all functions whose mathfn matches the pattern are

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 199 of 616
:
removed. Note that the shell function implementing the behaviour is not removed (regardless of
whether its name coincides with mathfn ).

getcap

See The zsh/cap Module.

getln [ -AclneE ] name ...

Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell parameter name . Equivalent to read -
zr.

getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]

Checks the arg s for legal options. If the arg s are omitted, use the positional parameters. A valid
option argument begins with a ‘+’ or a ‘-’. An argument not beginning with a ‘+’ or a ‘-’, or the
argument ‘--’, ends the options. Note that a single ‘-’ is not considered a valid option argument.
optstring contains the letters that getopts recognizes. If a letter is followed by a ‘:’, that option
requires an argument. The options can be separated from the argument by blanks.

Each time it is invoked, getopts places the option letter it finds in the shell parameter name ,
prepended with a ‘+’ when arg begins with a ‘+’. The index of the next arg is stored in OPTIND. The
option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.

The first option to be examined may be changed by explicitly assigning to OPTIND. OPTIND has an
initial value of 1, and is normally set to 1 upon entry to a shell function and restored upon exit. (The
POSIX_BUILTINS option disables this, and also changes the way the value is calculated to match
other shells.) OPTARG is not reset and retains its value from the most recent call to getopts. If either
of OPTIND or OPTARG is explicitly unset, it remains unset, and the index or option argument is not
stored. The option itself is still stored in name in this case.

A leading ‘:’ in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of any invalid option in OPTARG, and to
set name to ‘?’ for an unknown option and to ‘:’ when a required argument is missing. Otherwise,
getopts sets name to ‘?’ and prints an error message when an option is invalid. The exit status is
nonzero when there are no more options.

hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name [= value ] ] ...

hash can be used to directly modify the contents of the command

A command name starting with a / is never hashed, whether by explicit use of the hash command or
otherwise. Such a command is always found by direct look up in the file system.

Given no arguments, and neither the -r or -f options,

It will be subsequently rebuilt in the normal fashion. all the absolute directories in the PATH, These
two options cannot be used with any arguments.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 200 of 616
:
The -m option causes the arguments to be taken as patterns matching those patterns are printed.
This is the only way to display

For each name with a corresponding value , put ‘ name ’ in whenever ‘ name ’ is used as a command
argument, the shell will try to execute the file given by ‘ value ’. that ‘ value ’ may be referred to as
‘~ name ’.

For each name with no checking what the appropriate value is in the normal manner for

added by explicit specification. If has no effect if used with -f.

the form of a call to hash.

history

Same as fc -l.

integer [ {+|-}Hghlprtux ] [ {+|-}LRZi [ n ] ] [ name [= value ] ... ]

Equivalent to typeset -i, except that options irrelevant to integers are not permitted.

jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]

jobs -Z string

Lists information about each given job, or all jobs if job is omitted. The -l flag lists process IDs, and
the -p flag lists process groups. If the -r flag is specified only running jobs will be listed and if the -s
flag is given only stopped jobs are shown. If the -d flag is given, the directory from which the job was
started (which may not be the current directory of the job) will also be shown.

The -Z option replaces the shell’s argument and environment space with the given string, truncated
if necessary to fit. This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1)) listings. This feature is typically used by
daemons, to indicate their state.

Full job control is only available in the top-level interactive shell, not in commands run in the left
hand side of pipelines or within the ( ... ) construct. However, a snapshot of the job state at that
point is taken, so it is still possible to use the jobs builtin, or any parameter providing job
information. This gives information about the state of jobs at the point the subshell was created. If
background processes are created within the subshell, then instead information about those
processes is provided.

For example,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 201 of 616
:
sleep 10 & # Job in background
( # Shell forks
jobs # Shows information about "sleep 10 &"
sleep 5 & # Process in background (no job control)
jobs # Shows information about "sleep 5 &"
)

kill [ -s signal_name | -n signal_number | - sig ] job ...

kill -l [ sig ... ]

Sends either SIGTERM or the specified signal to the given jobs or processes. Signals are given by
number or by names, with or without the ‘SIG’ prefix. If the signal being sent is not ‘KILL’ or ‘CONT’,
then the job will be sent a ‘CONT’ signal if it is stopped. The argument job can be the process ID of a
job not in the job list. In the second form, kill -l, if sig is not specified the signal names are listed.
Otherwise, for each sig that is a name, the corresponding signal number is listed. For each sig
that is a signal number or a number representing the exit status of a process which was terminated
or stopped by a signal the name of the signal is printed.

On some systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a few signals. Typical examples are
SIGCHLD and SIGCLD or SIGPOLL and SIGIO, assuming they correspond to the same signal number.
kill -l will only list the preferred form, however kill -l alt will show if the alternative form
corresponds to a signal number. For example, under Linux kill -l IO and kill -l POLL both output 29,
hence kill -IO and kill -POLL have the same effect.

Many systems will allow process IDs to be negative to kill a process group or zero to kill the current
process group.

let arg ...

Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression. See Arithmetic Evaluation for a description of
arithmetic expressions. The exit status is 0 if the value of the last expression is nonzero, 1 if it is zero,
and 2 if an error occurred.

limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...

Set or display resource limits. Unless the -s flag is given, the limit applies only the children of the
shell. If -s is given without other arguments, the resource limits of the current shell is set to the
previously set resource limits of the children.

If limit is not specified, print the current limit placed on resource , otherwise set the limit to the
specified value. If the -h flag is given, use hard limits instead of soft limits. If no resource is given,
print all limits.

When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort immediately if it detects a badly formed
argument. However, if it fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue trying to set the
remaining limits.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 202 of 616
:
resource can be one of:

addressspace
Maximum amount of address space used.

aiomemorylocked
Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM for AIO operations.

aiooperations
Maximum number of AIO operations.

cachedthreads
Maximum number of cached threads.

coredumpsize
Maximum size of a core dump.

cputime
Maximum CPU seconds per process.

datasize
Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.

descriptors
Maximum value for a file descriptor.

filesize
Largest single file allowed.

kqueues
Maximum number of kqueues allocated.

maxproc
Maximum number of processes.

maxpthreads
Maximum number of threads per process.

memorylocked
Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.

memoryuse
Maximum resident set size.

msgqueue
Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.

posixlocks
Maximum number of POSIX locks per user.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 203 of 616
:
pseudoterminals
Maximum number of pseudo-terminals.

resident
Maximum resident set size.

sigpending
Maximum number of pending signals.

sockbufsize
Maximum size of all socket buffers.

stacksize
Maximum stack size for each process.

swapsize
Maximum amount of swap used.

vmemorysize
Maximum amount of virtual memory.

Which of these resource limits are available depends on the system. resource can be abbreviated
to any unambiguous prefix. It can also be an integer, which corresponds to the integer defined for
the resource by the operating system.

If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of the resources configured into the
shell, the shell will try to read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if this fails. As the
shell does not store such resources internally, an attempt to set the limit will fail unless the -s option
is present.

limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:

nh
hours

nk
kilobytes (default)

nm
megabytes or minutes

ng
gigabytes

[ mm :] ss
minutes and seconds

The limit command is not made available by default when the shell starts in a mode emulating

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 204 of 616
:
another shell. It can be made available with the command ‘zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:limit’.

local [ {+|-}AHUahlprtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZi [ n ] ] [ name [= value ] ... ]

Same as typeset, except that the options -g, and -f are not permitted. In this case the -x option does
not force the use of -g, i.e. exported variables will be local to functions.

logout [ n ]

Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.

noglob simple command

See Precommand Modifiers.

popd [ -q ] [ {+|-} n ]

Remove an entry from the directory stack, and perform a cd to the new top directory. With no
argument, the current top entry is removed. An argument of the form ‘+ n ’ identifies a stack entry by
counting from the left of the list shown by the dirs command, starting with zero. An argument of the
form - n counts from the right. If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings of ‘+’ and ‘-’ in this
context are swapped.

If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in the array
$chpwd_functions are not called, and the new directory stack is not printed. This is useful for calls to
popd that do not change the environment seen by an interactive user.

print [ -abcDilmnNoOpPrsSz ] [ -u n ] [ -f format ] [ -C cols ]

[ -v name ] [ -xX tabstop ] [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]

With the ‘-f’ option the arguments are printed as described by printf. With no flags or with the flag ‘-’,
the arguments are printed on the standard output as described by echo, with the following
differences: the escape sequence ‘\M- x ’ (or ‘\M x ’) metafies the character x (sets the highest bit),
‘\C- x ’ (or ‘\C x ’) produces a control character (‘\C-@’ and ‘\C-?’ give the characters NULL and delete), a
character code in octal is represented by ‘\ NNN ’ (instead of ‘\0 NNN ’), and ‘\E’ is a synonym for ‘\e’.
Finally, if not in an escape sequence, ‘\’ escapes the following character and is not printed.

-a
Print arguments with the column incrementing first. Only useful with the -c and -C options.

-b
Recognize all the escape sequences defined for the bindkey command, see Zle Builtins.

-c
Print the arguments in columns. Unless -a is also given, arguments are printed with the row
incrementing first.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 205 of 616
:
-C cols
Print the arguments in cols columns. Unless -a is also given, arguments are printed with the row
incrementing first.

-D
Treat the arguments as paths, replacing directory prefixes with ~ expressions corresponding to
directory names, as appropriate.

-i
If given together with -o or -O, sorting is performed case-independently.

-l
Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spaces. Note: if the list of arguments is empty,
print -l will still output one empty line. To print a possibly-empty list of arguments one per line, use
print -C1, as in ‘print -rC1 – "$list[@]"’.

-m
Take the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted), and remove it from the argument list
together with subsequent arguments that do not match this pattern.

-n
Do not add a newline to the output.

-N
Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls. Again, print -rNC1 – "$list[@]" is a canonical
way to print an arbitrary list as null-delimited records.

-o
Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.

-O
Print the arguments sorted in descending order.

-p
Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.

-P
Perform prompt expansion (see Prompt Expansion). In combination with ‘-f’, prompt escape
sequences are parsed only within interpolated arguments, not within the format string.

-r
Ignore the escape conventions of echo.

-R
Emulate the BSD echo command, which does not process escape sequences unless the -e flag is
given. The -n flag suppresses the trailing newline. Only the -e and -n flags are recognized after -R; all
other arguments and options are printed.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 206 of 616
:
-s
Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output. Each argument to the print
command is treated as a single word in the history, regardless of its content.

-S
Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output. In this case only a single
argument is allowed; it will be split into words as if it were a full shell command line. The effect is
similar to reading the line from a history file with the HIST_LEX_WORDS option active.

-u n
Print the arguments to file descriptor n .

-v name
Store the printed arguments as the value of the parameter name .

-x tab-stop
Expand leading tabs on each line of output in the printed string assuming a tab stop every tab-stop
characters. This is appropriate for formatting code that may be indented with tabs. Note that leading
tabs of any argument to print, not just the first, are expanded, even if print is using spaces to
separate arguments (the column count is maintained across arguments but may be incorrect on
output owing to previous unexpanded tabs).

The start of the output of each print command is assumed to be aligned with a tab stop. Widths of
multibyte characters are handled if the option MULTIBYTE is in effect. This option is ignored if other
formatting options are in effect, namely column alignment or printf style, or if output is to a special
location such as shell history or the command line editor.

-X tab-stop
This is similar to -x, except that all tabs in the printed string are expanded. This is appropriate if tabs
in the arguments are

-z
Push the arguments onto the editing buffer stack, separated by spaces.

If any of ‘-m’, ‘-o’ or ‘-O’ are used in combination with ‘-f’ and there are no arguments (after the
removal process in the case of ‘-m’) then nothing is printed.

printf [ -v name ] format [ arg ... ]

Print the arguments according to the format specification. Formatting rules are the same as used in
C. The same escape sequences as for echo are recognised in the format. All C conversion
specifications ending in one of csdiouxXeEfgGn are handled. In addition to this, ‘%b’ can be used
instead of ‘%s’ to cause escape sequences in the argument to be recognised and ‘%q’ can be used to
quote the argument in such a way that allows it to be reused as shell input. With the numeric format
specifiers, if the corresponding argument starts with a quote character, the numeric value of the
following character is used as the number to print; otherwise the argument is evaluated as an

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 207 of 616
:
arithmetic expression. See Arithmetic Evaluation for a description of arithmetic expressions. With
‘%n’, the corresponding argument is taken as an identifier which is created as an integer parameter.

Normally, conversion specifications are applied to each argument in order but they can explicitly
specify the n th argument is to be used by replacing ‘%’ by ‘% n $’ and ‘*’ by ‘* n $’. It is recommended
that you do not mix references of this explicit style with the normal style and the handling of such
mixed styles may be subject to future change.

If arguments remain unused after formatting, the format string is reused until all arguments have
been consumed. With the print builtin, this can be suppressed by using the -r option. If more
arguments are required by the format than have been specified, the behaviour is as if zero or an
empty string had been specified as the argument.

The -v option causes the output to be stored as the value of the parameter name , instead of printed.
If name is an array and the format string is reused when consuming arguments then one array
element will be used for each use of the format string.

pushd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]

pushd [ -qsLP ] old new

pushd [ -qsLP ] {+|-} n

Change the current directory, and push the old current directory onto the directory stack. In the first
form, change the current directory to arg . If arg is not specified, change to the second directory on
the stack (that is, exchange the top two entries), or change to $HOME if the PUSHD_TO_HOME
option is set or if there is only one entry on the stack. Otherwise, arg is interpreted as it would be
by cd. The meaning of old and new in the second form is also the same as for cd.

The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the directory list. An argument of the form
‘+ n ’ identifies a stack entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the dirs command, starting
with zero. An argument of the form ‘- n ’ counts from the right. If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the
meanings of ‘+’ and ‘-’ in this context are swapped.

If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in the array
$chpwd_functions are not called, and the new directory stack is not printed. This is useful for calls to
pushd that do not change the environment seen by an interactive user.

If the option -q is not specified and the shell option PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the directory stack will
be printed after a pushd is performed.

The options -s, -L and -P have the same meanings as for the cd builtin.

pushln [ arg ... ]

Equivalent to print -nz.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 208 of 616
:
pwd [ -rLP ]

Print the absolute pathname of the current working directory. If the -r or the -P flag is specified, or
the CHASE_LINKS option is set and the -L flag is not given, the printed path will not contain symbolic
links.

Same as fc -e -.

read [ -rszpqAclneE ] [ -t [ num ] ] [ -k [ num ] ] [ -d delim ]

[ -u n ] [ [ name ][? prompt ] ] [ name ... ]

Read one line and break it into fields using the characters in $IFS as separators, except as noted
below. The first field is assigned to the first name , the second field to the second name , etc., with
leftover fields assigned to the last name . If name is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply
for arrays.

-r
Raw mode: a ‘\’ at the end of a line does not signify line continuation and backslashes in the line
don’t quote the following character and are not removed.

-s
Don’t echo back characters if reading from the terminal.

-q
Read only one character from the terminal and set name to ‘y’ if this character was ‘y’ or ‘Y’ and to ‘n’
otherwise. With this flag set the return status is zero only if the character was ‘y’ or ‘Y’. This option
may be used with a timeout (see -t); if the read times out, or encounters end of file, status 2 is
returned. Input is read from the terminal unless one of -u or -p is present. This option may also be
used within zle widgets.

-k [ num ]
Read only one (or num ) characters. All are assigned to the first name , without word splitting. This
flag is ignored when -q is present. Input is read from the terminal unless one of -u or -p is present.
This option may also be used within zle widgets.

Note that despite the mnemonic ‘key’ this option does read full characters, which may consist of
multiple bytes if the option MULTIBYTE is set.

-z
Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it to the first name , without word splitting.
Text is pushed onto the stack with ‘print -z’ or with push-line from the line editor (see Zsh Line
Editor). This flag is ignored when the -k or -q flags are present.

-e

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 209 of 616
:
-E
The input read is printed (echoed) to the standard output. If the -e flag is used, no input is assigned
to the parameters.

-A
The first name is taken as the name of an array and all words are assigned to it.

-c
-l
These flags are allowed only if called inside a function used for completion (specified with the -K flag
to compctl). If the -c flag is given, the words of the current command are read. If the -l flag is given,
the whole line is assigned as a scalar. If both flags are present, -l is used and -c is ignored.

-n
Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on is read. With -l, the index of the character
the cursor is on is read. Note that the command name is word number 1, not word 0, and that when
the cursor is at the end of the line, its character index is the length of the line plus one.

-u n
Input is read from file descriptor n .

-p
Input is read from the coprocess.

-d delim
Input is terminated by the first character of delim instead of by newline.

-t [ num ]
Test if input is available before attempting to read. If num is present, it must begin with a digit and
will be evaluated to give a number of seconds, which may be a floating point number; in this case
the read times out if input is not available within this time. If num is not present, it is taken to be
zero, so that read returns immediately if no input is available. If no input is available, return status 1
and do not set any variables.

This option is not available when reading from the editor buffer with -z, when called from within
completion with -c or -l, with -q which clears the input queue before reading, or within zle where
other mechanisms should be used to test for input.

Note that read does not attempt to alter the input processing mode. The default mode is canonical
input, in which an entire line is read at a time, so usually ‘read -t’ will not read anything until an
entire line has been typed. However, when reading from the terminal with -k input is processed one
key at a time; in this case, only availability of the first character is tested, so that e.g. ‘read -t -k 2’ can
still block on the second character. Use two instances of ‘read -t -k’ if this is not what is wanted.

If the first argument contains a ‘?’, the remainder of this word is used as a prompt on standard error
when the shell is interactive.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 210 of 616
:
The value (exit status) of read is 1 when an end-of-file is encountered, or when -c or -l is present and
the command is not called from a compctl function, or as described for -q. Otherwise the value is 0.

The behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u and -z flags is undefined. Presently -q cancels
all the others, -p cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z cancels both -p and -u.

The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.

readonly

Same as typeset -r. With the POSIX_BUILTINS option set, same as typeset -gr.

rehash

Same as hash -r.

return [ n ]

Causes a shell function or ‘.’ script to return to the invoking script with the return status specified by
an arithmetic expression n . For example, the following prints ‘42’:

() { integer foo=40; return "foo + 2" }


echo $?

If n is omitted, the return status is that of the last command executed.

If return was executed from a trap in a TRAP NAL function, the effect is different for zero and non-
zero return status. With zero status (or after an implicit return at the end of the trap), the shell will
return to whatever it was previously processing; with a non-zero status, the shell will behave as
interrupted except that the return status of the trap is retained. Note that the numeric value of the
signal which caused the trap is passed as the first argument, so the statement ‘return "128+$1"’ will
return the same status as if the signal had not been trapped.

sched

See The zsh/sched Module.

set [ {+|-} options | {+|-}o [ option_name ] ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ]

[ arg ... ]

Set the options for the shell and/or set the positional parameters, or declare and set an array. If the -
s option is given, it causes the specified arguments to be sorted before assigning them to the
positional parameters (or to the array name if -A is used). With +s sort arguments in descending
order. For the meaning of the other flags, see Options. Flags may be specified by name using the -o
option. If no option name is supplied with -o, the current option states are printed: see the
description of setopt below for more information on the format. With +o they are printed in a form
that can be used as input to the shell.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 211 of 616
:
If the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array containing the given arg s; if no name is specified,
all arrays are printed together with their values.

If +A is used and name is an array, the given arguments will replace the initial elements of that array;
if no name is specified, all arrays are printed without their values.

The behaviour of arguments after -A name or +A name depends on whether the option KSH_ARRAYS
is set. If it is not set, all arguments following name are treated as values for the array, regardless of
their form. If the option is set, normal option processing continues at that point; only regular
arguments are treated as values for the array. This means that

set -A array -x -- foo

sets array to ‘-x -- foo’ if KSH_ARRAYS is not set, but sets the array to foo and turns on the option ‘-x’
if it is set.

If the -A flag is not present, but there are arguments beyond the options, the positional parameters
are set. If the option list (if any) is terminated by ‘--’, and there are no further arguments, the
positional parameters will be unset.

If no arguments and no ‘--’ are given, then the names and values of all parameters are printed on the
standard output. If the only argument is ‘+’, the names of all parameters are printed.

For historical reasons, ‘set -’ is treated as ‘set +xv’ and ‘set - args ’ as ‘set +xv – args ’ when in any
other emulation mode than zsh’s native mode.

setcap

See The zsh/cap Module.

setopt [ {+|-} options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ -m ] [ name ... ]

Set the options for the shell. All options specified either with flags or by name are set.

If no arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently set are printed. The form is chosen
so as to minimize the differences from the default options for the current emulation (the default
emulation being native zsh, shown as <Z> in Description of Options). Options that are on by default
for the emulation are shown with the prefix no only if they are off, while other options are shown
without the prefix no and only if they are on. In addition to options changed from the default state
by the user, any options activated automatically by the shell (for example, SHIN_STDIN or
INTERACTIVE) will be shown in the list. The format is further modified by the option
KSH_OPTION_PRINT, however the rationale for choosing options with or without the no prefix
remains the same in this case.

If the -m flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which should be quoted to protect them
from filename expansion), and all options with names matching these patterns are set.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 212 of 616
:
Note that a bad option name does not cause execution of subsequent shell code to be aborted; this
is behaviour is different from that of ‘set -o’. This is because set is regarded as a special builtin by the
POSIX standard, but setopt is not.

shift [ -p ] [ n ] [ name ... ]

The positional parameters ${ n +1} ... are renamed to $1 ..., where n is an arithmetic expression that
defaults to 1. If any name s are given then the arrays with these names are shifted instead of the
positional parameters.

If the option -p is given arguments are instead removed (popped) from the end rather than the start
of the array.

source file [ arg ... ]

Same as ‘.’, except that the current directory is always searched and is always searched first, before
directories in $path.

stat

See The zsh/stat Module.

suspend [ -f ]

Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until it receives a SIGCONT. Unless the -f
option is given, this will refuse to suspend a login shell.

test [ arg ... ]

[ [ arg ... ] ]

Like the system version of test. Added for compatibility; use conditional expressions instead (see
Conditional Expressions). The main differences between the conditional expression syntax and the
test and [ builtins are: these commands are not handled syntactically, so for example an empty
variable expansion may cause an argument to be omitted; syntax errors cause status 2 to be
returned instead of a shell error; and arithmetic operators expect integer arguments rather than
arithmetic expressions.

The command attempts to implement POSIX and its extensions where these are specified.
Unfortunately there are intrinsic ambiguities in the syntax; in particular there is no distinction
between test operators and strings that resemble them. The standard attempts to resolve these for
small numbers of arguments (up to four); for five or more arguments compatibility cannot be relied
on. Users are urged wherever possible to use the ‘[[’ test syntax which does not have these
ambiguities.

times

Print the accumulated user and system times for the shell and for processes run from the shell.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 213 of 616
:
trap [ arg ] [ sig ... ]

arg is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect it from immediate evaluation by the shell) to
be read and executed when the shell receives any of the signals specified by one or more sig args.
Each sig can be given as a number, or as the name of a signal either with or without the string SIG
in front (e.g. 1, HUP, and SIGHUP are all the same signal).

If arg is ‘-’, then the specified signals are reset to their defaults, or, if no sig args are present, all
traps are reset.

If arg is an empty string, then the specified signals are ignored by the shell (and by the commands
it invokes).

If arg is omitted but one or more sig args are provided (i.e. the first argument is a valid signal
number or name), the effect is the same as if arg had been specified as ‘-’.

The trap command with no arguments prints a list of commands associated with each signal.

If sig is ZERR then arg will be executed after each command with a nonzero exit status. ERR is an
alias for ZERR on systems that have no SIGERR signal (this is the usual case).

If sig is DEBUG then arg will be executed before each command if the option
DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), else after each command. Here, a ‘command’ is what
is described as a ‘sublist’ in the shell grammar, see Simple Commands & Pipelines. If
DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set various additional features are available. First, it is possible to skip the
next command by setting the option ERR_EXIT; see the description of the ERR_EXIT option in
Description of Options. Also, the shell parameter ZSH_DEBUG_CMD is set to the string
corresponding to the command to be executed following the trap. Note that this string is
reconstructed from the internal format and may not be formatted the same way as the original text.
The parameter is unset after the trap is executed.

If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement is executed inside the body of a function, then the
command arg is executed after the function completes. The value of $? at the start of execution is
the exit status of the shell or the return status of the function exiting. If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap
statement is not executed inside the body of a function, then the command arg is executed when
the shell terminates; the trap runs before any zshexit hook functions.

ZERR, DEBUG, and EXIT traps are not executed inside other traps. ZERR and DEBUG traps are kept
within subshells, while other traps are reset.

Note that traps defined with the trap builtin are slightly different from those defined as ‘TRAP NAL ()
{ ... }’, as the latter have their own function environment (line numbers, local variables, etc.) while the
former use the environment of the command in which they were called. For example,

trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 214 of 616
:
will print the line number of a command executed after it has run, while

TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }

will always print the number zero.

Alternative signal names are allowed as described under kill above. Defining a trap under either
name causes any trap under an alternative name to be removed. However, it is recommended that
for consistency users stick exclusively to one name or another.

true [ arg ... ]

Do nothing and return an exit status of 0.

ttyctl [ -fu ]

The -f option freezes the tty (i.e. terminal or terminal emulator), and -u unfreezes it. When the tty is
frozen, no changes made to the tty settings by external programs will be honored by the shell,
except for changes in the size of the screen; the shell will simply reset the settings to their previous
values as soon as each command exits or is suspended. Thus, stty and similar programs have no
effect when the tty is frozen. Freezing the tty does not cause the current state to be remembered:
instead, it causes future changes to the state to be blocked.

Without options it reports whether the terminal is frozen or not.

Note that, regardless of whether the tty is frozen or not, the shell needs to change the settings when
the line editor starts, so unfreezing the tty does not guarantee settings made on the command line
are preserved. Strings of commands run between editing the command line will see a consistent tty
state. See also the shell variable STTY for a means of initialising the tty before running external
commands and/or freezing the tty around a single command.

type [ -wfpamsS ] name ...

Equivalent to whence -v.

typeset [ {+|-}AHUaghlmrtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZip [ n ] ]

[ + ] [ name [= value ] ... ]

typeset -T [ {+|-}Uglrux ] [ {+|-}LRZp [ n ] ]

[ + | SCALAR [= value ] array [=( value ...)] [ sep ] ]

typeset -f [ {+|-}TUkmtuz ] [ + ] [ name ... ]

Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.

Except as noted below for control flags that change the behavior, a parameter is created for each

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 215 of 616
:
name that does not already refer to one. When inside a function, a new parameter is created for
every name (even those that already exist), and is unset again when the function completes. See
Local Parameters. The same rules apply to special shell parameters, which retain their special
attributes when made local.

For each name = value assignment, the parameter name is set to value . If the assignment is
omitted and name does not refer to an existing parameter, a new parameter is intialized to empty
string, zero, or empty array (as appropriate), unless the shell option TYPESET_TO_UNSET is set. When
that option is set, the parameter attributes are recorded but the parameter remains unset.

If the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not set, for each remaining name that refers to a parameter
that is already set, the name and value of the parameter are printed in the form of an assignment.
Nothing is printed for newly-created parameters, or when any attribute flags listed below are given
along with the name . Using ‘+’ instead of minus to introduce an attribute turns it off.

If no name is present, the names and values of all parameters are printed. In this case the attribute
flags restrict the display to only those parameters that have the specified attributes, and using ‘+’
rather than ‘-’ to introduce the flag suppresses printing of the values of parameters when there is no
parameter name.

All forms of the command handle scalar assignment. Array assignment is possible if any of the
reserved words declare, export, float, integer, local, readonly or typeset is matched when the line is
parsed (N.B. not when it is executed). In this case the arguments are parsed as assignments, except
that the ‘+=’ syntax and the GLOB_ASSIGN option are not supported, and scalar values after = are not
split further into words, even if expanded (regardless of the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option; this
option is obsolete).

Examples of the differences between command and reserved word parsing:

# Reserved word parsing


typeset svar=$(echo one word) avar=(several words)

The above creates a scalar parameter svar and an array parameter avar as if the assignments had
been

svar="one word"
avar=(several words)

On the other hand:

# Normal builtin interface


builtin typeset svar=$(echo two words)

The builtin keyword causes the above to use the standard builtin interface to typeset in which
argument parsing is performed in the same way as for other commands. This example creates a

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 216 of 616
:
scalar svar containing the value two and another scalar parameter words with no value. An array
value in this case would either cause an error or be treated as an obscure set of glob qualifiers.

Arbitrary arguments are allowed if they take the form of assignments after command line
expansion; however, these only perform scalar assignment:

var='svar=val'
typeset $var

The above sets the scalar parameter svar to the value val. Parentheses around the value within var
would not cause array assignment as they will be treated as ordinary characters when $var is
substituted. Any non-trivial expansion in the name part of the assignment causes the argument to
be treated in this fashion:

typeset {var1,var2,var3}=name

The above syntax is valid, and has the expected effect of setting the three parameters to the same
value, but the command line is parsed as a set of three normal command line arguments to typeset
after expansion. Hence it is not possible to assign to multiple arrays by this means.

Note that each interface to any of the commands may be disabled separately. For example, ‘disable -
r typeset’ disables the reserved word interface to typeset, exposing the builtin interface, while
‘disable typeset’ disables the builtin. Note that disabling the reserved word interface for typeset may
cause problems with the output of ‘typeset -p’, which assumes the reserved word interface is
available in order to restore array and associative array values.

Unlike parameter assignment statements, typeset’s exit status on an assignment that involves a
command substitution does not reflect the exit status of the command substitution. Therefore, to
test for an error in a command substitution, separate the declaration of the parameter from its
initialization:

# WRONG
typeset var1=$(exit 1) || echo "Trouble with var1"

# RIGHT
typeset var1 && var1=$(exit 1) || echo "Trouble with var1"

To initialize a parameter param to a command output and mark it readonly, use typeset -r param or
readonly param after the parameter assignment statement.

If no attribute flags are given, and either no name arguments are present or the flag +m is used,
then each parameter name printed is preceded by a list of the attributes of that parameter (array,
association, exported, float, integer, readonly, or undefined for autoloaded parameters not yet
loaded). If +m is used with attribute flags, and all those flags are introduced with +, the matching
parameter names are printed but their values are not.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 217 of 616
:
The following control flags change the behavior of typeset:

+
If ‘+’ appears by itself in a separate word as the last option, then the names of all parameters
(functions with -f) are printed, but the values (function bodies) are not. No name arguments may
appear, and it is an error for any other options to follow ‘+’. The effect of ‘+’ is as if all attribute flags
which precede it were given with a ‘+’ prefix. For example, ‘typeset -U +’ is equivalent to ‘typeset +U’
and displays the names of all arrays having the uniqueness attribute, whereas ‘typeset -f -U +’
displays the names of all autoloadable functions. If + is the only option, then type information (array,
readonly, etc.) is also printed for each parameter, in the same manner as ‘typeset +m "*"’.

-g
The -g (global) means that any resulting parameter will not be restricted to local scope. Note that
this does not necessarily mean that the parameter will be global, as the flag will apply to any existing
parameter (even if unset) from an enclosing function. This flag does not affect the parameter after
creation, hence it has no effect when listing existing parameters, nor does the flag +g have any effect
except in combination with -m (see below).

-m
If the -m flag is given the name arguments are taken as patterns (use quoting to prevent these from
being interpreted as file patterns). With no attribute flags, all parameters (or functions with the -f
flag) with matching names are printed (the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not used in this case).

If the +g flag is combined with -m, a new local parameter is created for every matching parameter
that is not already local. Otherwise -m applies all other flags or assignments to the existing
parameters.

Except when assignments are made with name = value , using +m forces the matching parameters
and their attributes to be printed, even inside a function. Note that -m is ignored if no patterns are
given, so ‘typeset -m’ displays attributes but ‘typeset -a +m’ does not.

-p [ n ]
If the -p option is given, parameters and values are printed in the form of a typeset command with
an assignment, regardless of other flags and options. Note that the -H flag on parameters is
respected; no value will be shown for these parameters.

-p may be followed by an optional integer argument. Currently only the value 1 is supported. In this
case arrays and associative arrays are printed with newlines between indented elements for
readability.

-T [ scalar [= value ] array [=( value ...)] [ sep ] ]


This flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see below. Otherwise the -T option requires
zero, two, or three arguments to be present. With no arguments, the list of parameters created in
this fashion is shown. With two or three arguments, the first two are the name of a scalar and of an
array parameter (in that order) that will be tied together in the manner of $PATH and $path. The
optional third argument is a single-character separator which will be used to join the elements of the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 218 of 616
:
array to form the scalar; if absent, a colon is used, as with $PATH. Only the first character of the
separator is significant; any remaining characters are ignored. Multibyte characters are not yet
supported.

Only one of the scalar and array parameters may be assigned an initial value (the restrictions on
assignment forms described above also apply).

Both the scalar and the array may be manipulated as normal. If one is unset, the other will
automatically be unset too. There is no way of untying the variables without unsetting them, nor of
converting the type of one of them with another typeset command; +T does not work, assigning an
array to scalar is an error, and assigning a scalar to array sets it to be a single-element array.

Note that both ‘typeset -xT ...’ and ‘export -T ...’ work, but only the scalar will be marked for export.
Setting the value using the scalar version causes a split on all separators (which cannot be quoted). It
is possible to apply -T to two previously tied variables but with a different separator character, in
which case the variables remain joined as before but the separator is changed.

When an existing scalar is tied to a new array, the value of the scalar is preserved but no attribute
other than export will be preserved.

Attribute flags that transform the final value (-L, -R, -Z, -l, -u) are only applied to the expanded value
at the point of a parameter expansion expression using ‘$’. They are not applied when a parameter
is retrieved internally by the shell for any purpose.

The following attribute flags may be specified:

-A
The names refer to associative array parameters; see Array Parameters.

-L [ n ]
Left justify and remove leading blanks from the value when the parameter is expanded. If n is
nonzero, it defines the width of the field. If n is zero, the width is determined by the width of the
value of the first assignment. In the case of numeric parameters, the length of the complete value
assigned to the parameter is used to determine the width, not the value that would be output.

The width is the count of characters, which may be multibyte characters if the MULTIBYTE option is
in effect. Note that the screen width of the character is not taken into account; if this is required, use
padding with parameter expansion flags ${(ml ... ) ... } as described in ‘Parameter Expansion Flags’
in Parameter Expansion.

When the parameter is expanded, it is filled on the right with blanks or truncated if necessary to fit
the field. Note truncation can lead to unexpected results with numeric parameters. Leading zeros
are removed if the -Z flag is also set.

-R [ n ]
Similar to -L, except that right justification is used; when the parameter is expanded, the field is left
filled with blanks or truncated from the end. May not be combined with the -Z flag.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 219 of 616
:
-U
For arrays (but not for associative arrays), keep only the first occurrence of each duplicated value.
This may also be set for tied parameters (see -T) or colon-separated special parameters like PATH or
FIGNORE, etc. Note the flag takes effect on assignment, and the type of the variable being assigned
to is determinative; for variables with shared values it is therefore recommended to set the flag for
all interfaces, e.g. ‘typeset -U PATH path’.

This flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see below.

-Z [ n ]
Specially handled if set along with the -L flag. Otherwise, similar to -R, except that leading zeros are
used for padding instead of blanks if the first non-blank character is a digit. Numeric parameters are
specially handled: they are always eligible for padding with zeroes, and the zeroes are inserted at an
appropriate place in the output.

-a
The names refer to array parameters. An array parameter may be created this way, but it may be
assigned to in the typeset statement only if the reserved word form of typeset is enabled (as it is by
default). When displaying, both normal and associative arrays are shown.

-f
The names refer to functions rather than parameters. No assignments can be made, and the only
other valid flags are -t, -T, -k, -u, -U and -z. The flag -t turns on execution tracing for this function; the
flag -T does the same, but turns off tracing for any named (not anonymous) function called from the
present one, unless that function also has the -t or -T flag. The -u and -U flags cause the function to
be marked for autoloading; -U also causes alias expansion to be suppressed when the function is
loaded. See the description of the ‘autoload’ builtin for details.

Note that the builtin functions provides the same basic capabilities as typeset -f but gives access to a
few extra options; autoload gives further additional options for the case typeset -fu and typeset -fU.

-h
-H
Hide value: specifies that typeset will not display the value of the parameter when listing
parameters; the display for such parameters is always as if the ‘+’ flag had been given. Use of the
parameter is in other respects normal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is specified by
name, or by pattern with the -m option. This is on by default for the parameters in the
zsh/parameter and zsh/mapfile modules. Note, however, that unlike the -h flag this is also useful for
non-special parameters.

-i [ n ]
Use an internal integer representation. If n is nonzero it defines the output arithmetic base,
otherwise it is determined by the first assignment. Bases from 2 to 36 inclusive are allowed.

-E [ n ]
Use an internal double-precision floating point representation. On output the variable will be

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 220 of 616
:
converted to scientific notation. If n is nonzero it defines the number of significant figures to
display; the default is ten.

-F [ n ]
Use an internal double-precision floating point representation. On output the variable will be
converted to fixed-point decimal notation. If n is nonzero it defines the number of digits to display
after the decimal point; the default is ten.

-l
Convert the result to lower case whenever the parameter is expanded. The value is not converted
when assigned.

-r
The given name s are marked readonly. Note that if name is a special parameter, the readonly
attribute can be turned on, but cannot then be turned off.

If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, the readonly attribute is more restrictive: unset variables can be
marked readonly and cannot then be set; furthermore, the readonly attribute cannot be removed
from any variable.

It is still possible to change other attributes of the variable though, some of which like -U or -Z would
affect the value. More generally, the readonly attribute should not be relied on as a security
mechanism.

Note that in zsh (like in pdksh but unlike most other shells) it is still possible to create a local variable
of the same name as this is considered a different variable (though this variable, too, can be marked
readonly). Special variables that have been made readonly retain their value and readonly attribute
when made local.

-t
Tags the named parameters. Tags have no special meaning to the shell. This flag has a different
meaning when used with -f; see above.

-u
Convert the result to upper case whenever the parameter is expanded. The value is not converted
when assigned. This flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see above.

-x
Mark for automatic export to the environment of subsequently executed commands. If the option
GLOBAL_EXPORT is set, this implies the option -g, unless +g is also explicitly given; in other words the
parameter is not made local to the enclosing function. This is for compatibility with previous
versions of zsh.

ulimit [ -HSa ] [ { -bcdfiklmnpqrsTtvwx | -N resource } [ limit ] ... ]

Set or display resource limits of the shell and the processes started by the shell. The value of limit
can be a number in the unit specified below or one of the values ‘unlimited’, which removes the limit

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 221 of 616
:
on the resource, or ‘hard’, which uses the current value of the hard limit on the resource.

By default, only soft limits are manipulated. If the -H flag is given use hard limits instead of soft
limits. If the -S flag is given together with the -H flag set both hard and soft limits.

If no options are used, the file size limit (-f) is assumed.

If limit is omitted the current value of the specified resources are printed. When more than one
resource value is printed, the limit name and unit is printed before each value.

When looping over multiple resources, the shell will abort immediately if it detects a badly formed
argument. However, if it fails to set a limit for some other reason it will continue trying to set the
remaining limits.

Not all the following resources are supported on all systems. Running ulimit -a will show which are
supported.

-a
Lists all of the current resource limits.

-b
Socket buffer size in bytes (N.B. not kilobytes)

-c
512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.

-d
Kilobytes on the size of the data segment.

-f
512-byte blocks on the size of files written.

-i
The number of pending signals.

-k
The number of kqueues allocated.

-l
Kilobytes on the size of locked-in memory.

-m
Kilobytes on the size of physical memory.

-n
open file descriptors.

-p
The number of pseudo-terminals.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 222 of 616
:
-q
Bytes in POSIX message queues.

-r
Maximum real time priority. On some systems where this is not available, such as NetBSD, this has
the same effect as -T for compatibility with sh.

-s
Kilobytes on the size of the stack.

-T
The number of simultaneous threads available to the user.

-t
CPU seconds to be used.

-u
The number of processes available to the user.

-v
Kilobytes on the size of virtual memory. On some systems this refers to the limit called ‘address
space’.

-w
Kilobytes on the size of swapped out memory.

-x
The number of locks on files.

A resource may also be specified by integer in the form ‘-N resource ’, where resource corresponds
to the integer defined for the resource by the operating system. This may be used to set the limits
for resources known to the shell which do not correspond to option letters. Such limits will be
shown by number in the output of ‘ulimit -a’.

The number may alternatively be out of the range of limits compiled into the shell. The shell will try
to read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if this fails.

umask [ -S ] [ mask ]

The umask is set to mask . mask can be either an octal number or a symbolic value as described in
the chmod(1) man page. If mask is omitted, the current value is printed. The -S option causes the
mask to be printed as a symbolic value. Otherwise, the mask is printed as an octal number. Note
that in the symbolic form the permissions you specify are those which are to be allowed (not denied)
to the users specified.

unalias [ -ams ] name ...

Removes aliases. This command works the same as unhash -a, except that the -a option removes all

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 223 of 616
:
regular or global aliases, or with -s all suffix aliases: in this case no name arguments may appear.
The options -m (remove by pattern) and -s without -a (remove listed suffix aliases) behave as for
unhash -a. Note that the meaning of -a is different between unalias and unhash.

unfunction

Same as unhash -f.

unhash [ -adfms ] name ...

option causes unhash to remove regular or global aliases; note when removing a global aliases that
the argument must be quoted to prevent it from being expanded before being passed to the
command. The -s option causes unhash to remove suffix aliases. The -f option causes unhash to
remove shell functions. The -d options causes unhash to remove named directories. If the -m flag is
given the arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all elements

unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...

The resource limit for each resource is set to the hard limit. If the -h flag is given and the shell has
appropriate privileges, the hard resource limit for each resource is removed. The resources of the
shell process are only changed if the -s flag is given.

The unlimit command is not made available by default when the shell starts in a mode emulating
another shell. It can be made available with the command ‘zmodload -F zsh/rlimits b:unlimit’.

unset [ -fmv ] name ...

Each named parameter is unset. Local parameters remain local even if unset; they appear unset
within scope, but the previous value will still reappear when the scope ends.

Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset by using subscript syntax on
name , which should be quoted (or the entire command prefixed with noglob) to protect the
subscript from filename generation.

If the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all parameters
with matching names are unset. Note that this cannot be used when unsetting associative array
elements, as the subscript will be treated as part of the pattern.

The -v flag specifies that name refers to parameters. This is the default behaviour.

unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.

unsetopt [ {+|-} options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]

Unset the options for the shell. All options specified either with flags or by name are unset. If no
arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently unset are printed. If the -m flag is given
the arguments are taken as patterns (which should be quoted to preserve them from being
interpreted as glob patterns), and all options with names matching these patterns are unset.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 224 of 616
:
vared

See Zle Builtins.

wait [ job ... ]

Wait for the specified jobs or processes. If job is not given then all currently active child processes
are waited for. Each job can be either a job specification or the process ID The exit status from this
command is that of the job waited for. If job represents an unknown job or process ID, a warning is
printed (unless the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set) and the exit status is 127.

It is possible to wait for recent processes (specified by process ID, not by job) that were running in
the background even if the process has exited. Typically the process ID will be recorded by capturing
the value of the variable $! immediately after the process has been started. There is a limit on the
number of process IDs remembered by the shell; this is given by the value of the system
configuration parameter CHILD_MAX. When this limit is reached, older process IDs are discarded,
least recently started processes first.

Note there is no protection against the process ID wrapping, i.e. if the wait is not executed soon
enough there is a chance the process waited for is the wrong one. A conflict implies both process IDs
have been generated by the shell, as other processes are not recorded, and that the user is
potentially interested in both, so this problem is intrinsic to process IDs.

whence [ -vcwfpamsS ] [ -x num ] name ...

For each name , indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a command name.

If name is not an alias, built-in command, external command, shell function, hashed command, or a
reserved word, the exit status shall be non-zero, and — if -v, -c, or -w was passed — a message will
be written to standard output. (This is different from other shells that write that message to
standard error.)

whence is most useful when name is only the last path component of a command, i.e. does not
include a ‘/’; in particular, pattern matching only succeeds if just the non-directory component of the
command is passed.

-v
Produce a more verbose report.

-c
Print the results in a csh-like format. This takes precedence over -v.

-w
For each name , print ‘ name : word ’ where word is one of alias, builtin, command, function, hashed,
reserved or none, according as name corresponds to an alias, a built-in command, an external
command, a shell function, a command defined with the hash builtin, a reserved word, or is not
recognised. This takes precedence over -v and -c.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 225 of 616
:
-f
Causes the contents of a shell function to be displayed, which would otherwise not happen unless
the -c flag were used.

-p
Do a path search for name even if it is an alias, reserved word, shell function or builtin.

-a
Do a search for all occurrences of name throughout the command path. Normally only the first
occurrence is printed.

-m
The arguments are taken as patterns (pattern characters should be quoted), and the information is
displayed for each command matching one of these patterns.

-s
If a pathname contains symlinks, print the symlink-free pathname as well.

-S
As -s, but if the pathname had to be resolved by following multiple symlinks, the intermediate steps
are printed, too. The symlink resolved at each step might be anywhere in the path.

-x num
Expand tabs when outputting shell functions using the -c option. This has the same effect as the -x
option to the functions builtin.

where [ -wpmsS ] [ -x num ] name ...

Equivalent to whence -ca.

which [ -wpamsS ] [ -x num ] name ...

Equivalent to whence -c.

zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]

zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]

zcompile -t file [ name ... ]

This builtin command can be used to compile functions or scripts, storing the compiled form in a
file, and to examine files containing the compiled form. This allows faster autoloading of functions
and sourcing of scripts by avoiding parsing of the text when the files are read.

The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a compiled file. If only the file argument is
given, the output file has the name ‘ file .zwc’ and will be placed in the same directory as the file .
The shell will load the compiled file instead of the normal function file when the function is
autoloaded; see Functions for a description of how autoloaded functions are searched. The
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 226 of 616
:
extension .zwc stands for ‘zsh word code’.

If there is at least one name argument, all the named files are compiled into the output file given
as the first argument. If file does not end in .zwc, this extension is automatically appended. Files
containing multiple compiled functions are called ‘digest’ files, and are intended to be used as
elements of the FPATH/fpath special array.

The second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the compiled definitions for all the named
functions into file . For -c, the names must be functions currently defined in the shell, not those
marked for autoloading. Undefined functions that are marked for autoloading may be written by
using the -a option, in which case the fpath is searched and the contents of the definition files for
those functions, if found, are compiled into file . If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined
functions and functions marked for autoloading may be given. In either case, the functions in files
written with the -c or -a option will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option were unset.

The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with different options is that some
definition files for autoloading define multiple functions, including the function with the same name
as the file, and, at the end, call that function. In such cases the output of ‘zcompile -c’ does not
include the additional functions defined in the file, and any other initialization code in the file is lost.
Using ‘zcompile -a’ captures all this extra information.

If the -m option is combined with -c or -a, the name s are used as patterns and all functions whose
names match one of these patterns will be written. If no name is given, the definitions of all
functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded will be written.

Note the second form cannot be used for compiling functions that include redirections as part of the
definition rather than within the body of the function; for example

fn1() { { ... } >~/logfile }

can be compiled but

fn1() { ... } >~/logfile

cannot. It is possible to use the first form of zcompile to compile autoloadable functions that include
the full function definition instead of just the body of the function.

The third form, with the -t option, examines an existing compiled file. Without further arguments,
the names of the original files compiled into it are listed. The first line of output shows the version of
the shell which compiled the file and how the file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by
mapping it into memory). With arguments, nothing is output and the return status is set to zero if
definitions for all name s were found in the compiled file, and non-zero if the definition for at least
one name was not found.

Other options:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 227 of 616
:
-U
Aliases are not expanded when compiling the name d files.

-R
When the compiled file is read, its contents are copied into the shell’s memory, rather than memory-
mapped (see -M). This happens automatically on systems that do not support memory mapping.

When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions, it is often desirable to use this option;
otherwise the whole file, including the code to define functions which have already been defined,
will remain mapped, consequently wasting memory.

-M
The compiled file is mapped into the shell’s memory when read. This is done in such a way that
multiple instances of the shell running on the same host will share this mapped file. If neither -R nor
-M is given, the zcompile builtin decides what to do based on the size of the compiled file.

-k
-z
These options are used when the compiled file contains functions which are to be autoloaded. If -z is
given, the function will be autoloaded as if the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is not set, even if it is set at
the time the compiled file is read, while if the -k is given, the function will be loaded as if
KSH_AUTOLOAD is set. These options also take precedence over any -k or -z options specified to the
autoload builtin. If neither of these options is given, the function will be loaded as determined by the
setting of the KSH_AUTOLOAD option at the time the compiled file is read.

These options may also appear as many times as necessary between the listed name s to specify the
loading style of all following functions, up to the next -k or -z.

The created file always contains two versions of the compiled format, one for big-endian machines
and one for small-endian machines. The upshot of this is that the compiled file is machine
independent and if it is read or mapped, only one half of the file is actually used (and mapped).

zformat

See The zsh/zutil Module.

zftp

See The zsh/zftp Module.

zle

See Zle Builtins.

zmodload [ -dL ] [ -s ] [ ... ]

zmodload -F [ -alLme -P param ] module [ [+-] feature ... ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 228 of 616
:
zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]

zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...

zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...

zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias [= module ] ... ]

zmodload -R modalias ...

Performs operations relating to zsh’s loadable modules. Loading of modules while the shell is
running (‘dynamical loading’) is not available on all operating systems, or on all installations on a
particular operating system, although the zmodload command itself is always available and can be
used to manipulate modules built into versions of the

Without arguments the names of all currently loaded binary modules are printed. The -L option
causes this list to be in the form of a series of zmodload commands. Forms with arguments are:

zmodload [ -is ] name ...


zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
In the simplest case, zmodload loads a binary module. The module must be in a file with a name
consisting of the specified name followed by a standard suffix, usually ‘.so’ (‘.sl’ on HPUX). If the
module to be loaded is already loaded the duplicate module is ignored. If zmodload detects an
inconsistency, such as an invalid module name or circular dependency list, the current code block is
aborted. If it is available, the module is loaded if necessary, while if it is not available, non-zero status
is silently returned. The option -i is accepted for compatibility but has no effect.

The name d module is searched for in the same way a command is, using $module_path instead of
$path. However, the path search is performed even when the module name contains a ‘/’, which it
usually does. There is no way to prevent the path search.

If the module supports features (see below), zmodload tries to enable all features when loading a
module. If the module was successfully loaded but not all features could be enabled, zmodload
returns status 2.

If the option -s is given, no error is printed if the module was not available (though other errors
indicating a problem with the module are printed). The return status indicates if the module was
loaded. This is appropriate if the caller considers the module optional.

With -u, zmodload unloads modules. The same name must be given that was given when the
module was loaded, but it is not necessary for the module to exist in the file system. The -i option
suppresses the error if the module is already unloaded (or was never loaded).

Each module has a boot and a cleanup function. The module will not be loaded if its boot function
fails. Similarly a module can only be unloaded if its cleanup function runs successfully.

zmodload -F [ -almLe -P param ] module [ [+-] feature ... ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 229 of 616
:
zmodload -F allows more selective control over the features provided by modules. With no options
apart from -F, the module named module is loaded, if it was not already loaded, and the list of
feature s is set to the required state. If no feature s are specified, the module is loaded, if it was
not already loaded, but the state of features is unchanged. Each feature may be preceded by a + to
turn the feature on, or - to turn it off; the + is assumed if neither character is present. Any feature
not explicitly mentioned is left in its current state; if the module was not previously loaded this
means any such features will remain disabled. The return status is zero if all features were set, 1 if
the module failed to load, and 2 if some features could not be set (for example, a parameter couldn’t
be added because there was a different parameter of the same name) but the module was loaded.

The standard features are builtins, conditions, parameters and math functions; these are indicated
by the prefix ‘b:’, ‘c:’ (‘C:’ for an infix condition), ‘p:’ and ‘f:’, respectively, followed by the name that the
corresponding feature would have in the shell. For example, ‘b:strftime’ indicates a builtin named
strftime and p:EPOCHSECONDS indicates a parameter named EPOCHSECONDS. The module may
provide other (‘abstract’) features of its own as indicated by its documentation; these have no prefix.

With -l or -L, features provided by the module are listed. With -l alone, a list of features together with
their states is shown, one feature per line. With -L alone, a zmodload -F command that would cause
enabled features of the module to be turned on is shown. With -lL, a zmodload -F command that
would cause all the features to be set to their current state is shown. If one of these combinations is
given with the option -P param then the parameter param is set to an array of features, either
features together with their state or (if -L alone is given) enabled features.

With the option -L the module name may be omitted; then a list of all enabled features for all
modules providing features is printed in the form of zmodload -F commands. If -l is also given, the
state of both enabled and disabled features is output in that form.

A set of features may be provided together with -l or -L and a module name; in that case only the
state of those features is considered. Each feature may be preceded by + or - but the character has
no effect. If no set of features is provided, all features are considered.

With -e, the command first tests that the module is loaded; if it is not, status 1 is returned. If the
module is loaded, the list of features given as an argument is examined. Any feature given with no
prefix is simply tested to see if the module provides it; any feature given with a prefix + or - is tested
to see if is provided and in the given state. If the tests on all features in the list succeed, status 0 is
returned, else status 1.

With -m, each entry in the given list of features is taken as a pattern to be matched against the list of
features provided by the module. An initial + or - must be given explicitly. This may not be combined
with the -a option as autoloads must be specified explicitly.

With -a, the given list of features is marked for autoload from the specified module, which may not
yet be loaded. An optional + may appear before the feature name. If the feature is prefixed with -,
any existing autoload is removed. The options -l and -L may be used to list autoloads. Autoloading is
specific to individual features; when the module is loaded only the requested feature is enabled.
Autoload requests are preserved if the module is subsequently unloaded until an explicit ‘zmodload

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 230 of 616
:
-Fa module - feature ’ is issued. It is not an error to request an autoload for a feature of a module
that is already loaded.

When the module is loaded each autoload is checked against the features actually provided by the
module; if the feature is not provided the autoload request is deleted. A warning message is output;
if the module is being loaded to provide a different feature, and that autoload is successful, there is
no effect on the status of the current command. If the module is already loaded at the time when
zmodload -Fa is run, an error message is printed and status 1 returned.

zmodload -Fa can be used with the -l, -L, -e and -P options for listing and testing the existence of
autoloadable features. In this case -l is ignored if -L is specified. zmodload -FaL with no module
name lists autoloads for all modules.

Note that only standard features as described above can be autoloaded; other features require the
module to be loaded before enabling.

zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
zmodload -d name dep ...
zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies. The modules named in the second and
subsequent arguments will be loaded before the module named in the first argument.

With -d and one argument, all dependencies for that module are listed. With -d and no arguments,
all module dependencies are listed. This listing is by default in a Makefile-like format. The -L option
changes this format to a list of zmodload -d commands.

If -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed. If only one argument is given, all
dependencies for that module are removed.

zmodload -ab [ -L ]
zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
The -ab option defines autoloaded builtins. It defines the specified builtin s. When any of those
builtins is called, the module specified in the first argument is loaded and all its features are enabled
(for selective control of features use ‘zmodload -F -a’ as described above). If only the name is given,
one builtin is defined, with the same name as the module. -i suppresses the error if the builtin is
already defined or autoloaded, but not if another builtin of the same name is already defined.

With -ab and no arguments, all autoloaded builtins are listed, with the module name (if different)
shown in parentheses after the builtin name. The -L option changes this format to a list of zmodload
-a commands.

If -b is used together with the -u option, it removes builtins previously defined with -ab. This is only
possible if the builtin is not yet loaded. -i suppresses the error if the builtin is already removed (or
never existed).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 231 of 616
:
Autoload requests are retained if the module is subsequently unloaded until an explicit ‘zmodload -
ub builtin ’ is issued.

zmodload -ac [ -IL ]


zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
The -ac option is used to define autoloaded condition codes. The cond strings give the names of the
conditions defined by the module. The optional -I option is used to define infix condition names.
Without this option prefix condition names are defined.

If given no condition names, all defined names are listed (as a series of zmodload commands if the -
L option is given).

The -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded conditions.

zmodload -ap [ -L ]
zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
The -p option is like the -b and -c options, but makes zmodload work on autoloaded parameters
instead.

zmodload -af [ -L ]
zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
The -f option is like the -b, -p, and -c options, but makes zmodload work on autoloaded math
functions instead.

zmodload -a [ -L ]
zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
Equivalent to -ab and -ub.

zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]


The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules; if the -A option is also given, module
aliases corresponding to loaded modules are also shown. If arguments are provided, nothing is
printed; the return status is set to zero if all string s given as arguments are names of loaded
modules and to one if at least on string is not the name of a loaded module. This can be used to
test for the availability of things implemented by modules. In this case, any aliases are automatically
resolved and the -A flag is not used.

zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias [= module ] ... ]


For each argument, if both modalias and module are given, define modalias to be an alias for the
module module . If the module modalias is ever subsequently requested, either via a call to
zmodload or implicitly, the shell will attempt to load module instead. If module is not given, show
the definition of modalias . If no arguments are given, list all defined module aliases. When listing, if

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 232 of 616
:
the -L flag was also given, list the definition as a zmodload command to recreate the alias.

The existence of aliases for modules is completely independent of whether the name resolved is
actually loaded as a module: while the alias exists, loading and unloading the module under any
alias has exactly the same effect as using the resolved name, and does not affect the connection
between the alias and the resolved name which can be removed either by zmodload -R or by
redefining the alias. Chains of aliases (i.e. where the first resolved name is itself an alias) are valid so
long as these are not circular. As the aliases take the same format as module names, they may
include path separators: in this case, there is no requirement for any part of the path named to exist
as the alias will be resolved first. For example, ‘any/old/alias’ is always a valid alias.

Dependencies added to aliased modules are actually added to the resolved module; these remain if
the alias is removed. It is valid to create an alias whose name is one of the standard shell modules
and which resolves to a different module. However, if a module has dependencies, it will not be
possible to use the module name as an alias as the module will already be marked as a loadable
module in its own right.

Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload command anywhere module names are
required. However, aliases will not be shown in lists of loaded modules with a bare ‘zmodload’.

zmodload -R modalias ...


For each modalias argument that was previously defined as a module alias via zmodload -A, delete
the alias. If any was not defined, an error is caused and the remainder of the line is ignored.

Note that zsh makes no distinction between modules that were linked into the shell and modules
that are loaded dynamically. In both cases this builtin command has to be used to make available
the builtins and other things defined by modules (unless the module is autoloaded on these
definitions). This is true even for systems that don’t support dynamic loading of modules.

zparseopts

See The zsh/zutil Module.

zprof

See The zsh/zprof Module.

zpty

See The zsh/zpty Module.

zregexparse

See The zsh/zutil Module.

zsocket

See The zsh/net/socket Module.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 233 of 616
:
zstyle

See The zsh/zutil Module.

ztcp

See The zsh/net/tcp Module.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 234 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

18 Zsh Line Editor


18.1 Description
18.2 Keymaps
18.2.1 Reading Commands
18.2.2 Local Keymaps
18.3 Zle Builtins
18.4 Zle Widgets
18.5 User-Defined Widgets
18.5.1 Special Widgets
18.6 Standard Widgets
18.6.1 Movement
18.6.2 History Control
18.6.3 Modifying Text
18.6.4 Arguments
18.6.5 Completion
18.6.6 Miscellaneous
18.6.7 Text Objects
18.7 Character Highlighting

18 Zsh Line Editor

18.1 Description
If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in interactive shells) and the shell input is attached to
the terminal, the user is able to edit command lines.

There are two display modes. The first, multiline mode, is the default. It only works if the TERM
parameter is set to a valid terminal type that can move the cursor up. The second, single line mode,
is used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is
set. This mode is similar to ksh, and uses no termcap sequences. If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option
will be unset by default.

The parameters BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line editor. See Parameters Used
By The Shell.

The parameter zle_highlight is also used by the line editor; see Character Highlighting. Highlighting
of special characters and the region between the cursor and the mark (as set with set-mark-
command in Emacs mode, or by visual-mode in Vi mode) is enabled by default; consult this
reference for more information. Irascible conservatives will wish to know that all highlighting may be

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 235 of 616
:
disabled by the following setting:

zle_highlight=(none)

In many places, references are made to the numeric argument. This can by default be entered in
emacs mode by holding the alt key and typing a number, or pressing escape before each digit, and
in vi command mode by typing the number before entering a command. Generally the numeric
argument causes the next command entered to be repeated the specified number of times, unless
otherwise noted below; this is implemented by the digit-argument widget. See also Argumentsfor
some other ways the numeric argument can be modified.

18.2 Keymaps
A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between key sequences and ZLE commands. The empty
key sequence cannot be bound.

There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one or more names. If all of
a keymap’s names are deleted, it disappears. bindkey can be used to manipulate keymap names.

Initially, there are eight keymaps:

emacs
EMACS emulation

viins
vi emulation - insert mode

vicmd
vi emulation - command mode

viopp
vi emulation - operator pending

visual
vi emulation - selection active

isearch
incremental search mode

command
read a command name

.safe
fallback keymap

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 236 of 616
:
The ‘.safe’ keymap is special. It can never be altered, and the name can never be removed. However,
it can be linked to other names, which can be removed. In the future other special keymaps may be
added; users should avoid using names beginning with ‘.’ for their own keymaps.

In addition to these names, either ‘emacs’ or ‘viins’ is also linked to the name ‘main’. If one of the
VISUAL or EDITOR environment variables contain the string ‘vi’ when the shell starts up then it will be
‘viins’, otherwise it will be ‘emacs’. bindkey’s -e and -v options provide a convenient way to override
this default choice.

When the editor starts up, it will select the ‘main’ keymap. If that keymap doesn’t exist, it will use
‘.safe’ instead.

In the ‘.safe’ keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert, except for ^J (line feed) and ^M (return)
which are bound to accept-line. This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it means
you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.

18.2.1 Reading Commands

When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence that is bound to some
command and is also a prefix of a longer bound string. In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see
if more characters are typed, and if not (or they don’t match any longer string) it will execute the
binding. This timeout is defined by the KEYTIMEOUT parameter; its default is 0.4 sec. There is no
timeout if the prefix string is not itself bound to a command.

The key timeout is also applied when ZLE is reading the bytes from a multibyte character string
when it is in the appropriate mode. (This requires that the shell was compiled with multibyte mode
enabled; typically also the locale has characters with the UTF-8 encoding, although any multibyte
encoding known to the operating system is supported.) If the second or a subsequent byte is not
read within the timeout period, the shell acts as if ? were typed and resets the input state.

As well as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings, by using ‘bindkey -s’. When
such a sequence is read, the replacement string is pushed back as input, and the command reading
process starts again using these fake keystrokes. This input can itself invoke further replacement
strings, but in order to detect loops the process will be stopped if there are twenty such
replacements without a real command being read.

A key sequence typed by the user can be turned into a command name for use in user-defined
widgets with the read-command widget, described in Miscellaneous below.

18.2.2 Local Keymaps

While for normal editing a single keymap is used exclusively, in many modes a local keymap allows

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 237 of 616
:
for some keys to be customised. For example, in an incremental search mode, a binding in the
isearch keymap will override a binding in the main keymap but all keys that are not overridden can
still be used.

If a key sequence is defined in a local keymap, it will hide a key sequence in the global keymap that is
a prefix of that sequence. An example of this occurs with the binding of iw in viopp as this hides the
binding of i in vicmd. However, a longer sequence in the global keymap that shares the same prefix
can still apply so for example the binding of ^Xa in the global keymap will be unaffected by the
binding of ^Xb in the local keymap.

18.3 Zle Builtins


The ZLE module contains three related builtin commands. The bindkey command manipulates
keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes ZLE on the value of a shell parameter; and
the zle command manipulates editing widgets and allows command line access to ZLE commands
from within shell functions.

bindkey [ options ] -l [ -L ] [ keymap ... ]

bindkey [ options ] -d

bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...

bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap

bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]

bindkey [ options ] -m

bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...

bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...

bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...

bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]

bindkey’s options can be divided into three categories: keymap selection for the current command,
operation selection, and others. The keymap selection options are:

-e
Selects keymap ‘emacs’ for any operations by the current command, and also links ‘emacs’ to ‘main’
so that it is selected by default the next time the editor starts.

-v
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 238 of 616
:
Selects keymap ‘viins’ for any operations by the current command, and also links ‘viins’ to ‘main’ so
that it is selected by default the next time the editor starts.

-a
Selects keymap ‘vicmd’ for any operations by the current command.

-M keymap
The keymap specifies a keymap name that is selected for any operations by the current command.

If a keymap selection is required and none of the options above are used, the ‘main’ keymap is used.
Some operations do not permit a keymap to be selected, namely:

-l
List all existing keymap names; if any arguments are given, list just those keymaps.

If the -L option is also used, list in the form of bindkey commands to create or link the keymaps.
‘bindkey -lL main’ shows which keymap is linked to ‘main’, if any, and hence if the standard emacs or
vi emulation is in effect. This option does not show the .safe keymap because it cannot be created in
that fashion; however, neither is ‘bindkey -lL .safe’ reported as an error, it simply outputs nothing.

-d
Delete all existing keymaps and reset to the default state.

-D keymap ...
Delete the named keymap s.

-A old-keymap new-keymap
Make the new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap , so that both names refer to the same
keymap. The names have equal standing; if either is deleted, the other remains. If there is already a
keymap with the new-keymap name, it is deleted.

-N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
Create a new keymap, named new-keymap . If a keymap already has that name, it is deleted. If an
old-keymap name is given, the new keymap is initialized to be a duplicate of it, otherwise the new
keymap will be empty.

To use a newly created keymap, it should be linked to main. Hence the sequence of commands to
create and use a new keymap ‘mymap’ initialized from the emacs keymap (which remains
unchanged) is:

bindkey -N mymap emacs


bindkey -A mymap main

Note that while ‘bindkey -A newmap main’ will work when newmap is emacs or viins, it will not work
for vicmd, as switching from vi insert to command mode becomes impossible.

The following operations act on the ‘main’ keymap if no keymap selection option was given:
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 239 of 616
:
-m
Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected keymap. Only keys that are unbound or
bound to self-insert are affected.

-r in-string ...
Unbind the specified in-string s in the selected keymap. This is exactly equivalent to binding the
strings to undefined-key.

When -R is also used, interpret the in-string s as ranges.

When -p is also used, the in-string s specify prefixes. Any binding that has the given in-string as
a prefix, not including the binding for the in-string itself, if any, will be removed. For example,

bindkey -rpM viins '^['

will remove all bindings in the vi-insert keymap beginning with an escape character (probably cursor
keys), but leave the binding for the escape character itself (probably vi-cmd-mode). This is
incompatible with the option -R.

-s in-string out-string ...


Bind each in-string to each out-string . When in-string is typed, out-string will be pushed
back and treated as input to the line editor. When -R is also used, interpret the in-string s as
ranges.

Note that both in-string and out-string are subject to the same form of interpretation, as
described below.

in-string command ...


Bind each in-string to each command . When -R is used, interpret the in-string s as ranges.

[ in-string ]
List key bindings. If an in-string is specified, the binding of that string in the selected keymap is
displayed. Otherwise, all key bindings in the selected keymap are displayed. (As a special case, if the
-e or -v option is used alone, the keymap is not displayed - the implicit linking of keymaps is the only
thing that happens.)

When the option -p is used, the in-string must be present. The listing shows all bindings which
have the given key sequence as a prefix, not including any bindings for the key sequence itself.

When the -L option is used, the list is in the form of bindkey commands to create the key bindings.

When the -R option is used as noted above, a valid range consists of two characters, with an optional
‘-’ between them. All characters between the two specified, inclusive, are bound as specified.

For either in-string or out-string , the following escape sequences are recognised:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 240 of 616
:
\a
bell character

\b
backspace

\e, \E
escape

\f
form feed

\n
linefeed (newline)

\r
carriage return

\t
horizontal tab

\v
vertical tab

\ NNN
character code in octal

\x NN
character code in hexadecimal

\u NNNN
unicode character code in hexadecimal

\U NNNNNNNN
unicode character code in hexadecimal

\M[-] X
character with meta bit set

\C[-] X
control character

^X
control character

In all other cases, ‘\’ escapes the following character. Delete is written as ‘^?’. Note that ‘\M^?’ and
‘^\M?’ are not the same, and that (unlike emacs), the bindings ‘\M- X ’ and ‘\e X ’ are entirely distinct,
although they are initialized to the same bindings by ‘bindkey -m’.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 241 of 616
:
vared [ -Aacghe ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ]

[ -M main-keymap ] [ -m vicmd-keymap ]

[ -i init-widget ] [ -f finish-widget ]

[ -t tty ] name

The value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit buffer, and the line editor is invoked. When
the editor exits, name is set to the string value returned by the editor. When the -c flag is given, the
parameter is created if it doesn’t already exist. The -a flag may be given with -c to create an array
parameter, or the -A flag to create an associative array. If the type of an existing parameter does not
match the type to be created, the parameter is unset and recreated. The -g flag may be given to
suppress warnings from the WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL and WARN_NESTED_VAR options.

If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters as defined in $IFS will be shown
quoted with a backslash, as will backslashes themselves. Conversely, when the edited text is split
into an array, a backslash quotes an immediately following separator character or backslash; no
other special handling of backslashes, or any handling of quotes, is performed.

Individual elements of existing array or associative array parameters may be edited by using
subscript syntax on name . New elements are created automatically, even without -c.

If the -p flag is given, the following string will be taken as the prompt to display at the left. If the -r
flag is given, the following string gives the prompt to display at the right. If the -h flag is specified, the
history can be accessed from ZLE. If the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an empty line
causes vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.

The -M option gives a keymap to link to the main keymap during editing, and the -m option gives a
keymap to link to the vicmd keymap during editing. For vi-style editing, this allows a pair of keymaps
to override viins and vicmd. For emacs-style editing, only -M is normally needed but the -m option
may still be used. On exit, the previous keymaps will be restored.

Vared calls the usual ‘zle-line-init’ and ‘zle-line-finish’ hooks before and after it takes control. Using
the -i and -f options, it is possible to replace these with other custom widgets.

If ‘-t tty ’ is given, tty is the name of a terminal device to be used instead of the default /dev/tty. If
tty does not refer to a terminal an error is reported.

zle

zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]

zle -D widget ...

zle -A old-widget new-widget

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 242 of 616
:
zle -N widget [ function ]

zle -f flag [ flag ... ]

zle -C widget completion-widget function

zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]

zle -M string

zle -U string

zle -K keymap

zle -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]

zle -I

zle -T [ tc function | -r tc | -L ]

zle widget [ -n num ] [ -f flag ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...

The zle builtin performs a number of different actions concerning ZLE.

With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be set. It is zero if ZLE is currently
active and widgets could be invoked using this builtin command and non-zero otherwise. Note that
even if non-zero status is returned, zle may still be active as part of the completion system; this does
not allow direct calls to ZLE widgets.

Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:

-l [ -L | -a ] [ string ]
List all existing user-defined widgets. If the -L option is used, list in the form of zle commands to
create the widgets.

When combined with the -a option, all widget names are listed, including the builtin ones. In this
case the -L option is ignored.

If at least one string is given, and -a is present or -L is not used, nothing will be printed. The return
status will be zero if all string s are names of existing widgets and non-zero if at least one string
is not a name of a defined widget. If -a is also present, all widget names are used for the comparison
including builtin widgets, else only user-defined widgets are used.

If at least one string is present and the -L option is used, user-defined widgets matching any
string are listed in the form of zle commands to create the widgets.

-D widget ...
Delete the named widget s.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 243 of 616
:
-A old-widget new-widget
Make the new-widget name an alias for old-widget , so that both names refer to the same widget.
The names have equal standing; if either is deleted, the other remains. If there is already a widget
with the new-widget name, it is deleted.

-N widget [ function ]
Create a user-defined widget. If there is already a widget with the specified name, it is overwritten.
When the new widget is invoked from within the editor, the specified shell function is called. If no
function name is specified, it defaults to the same name as the widget. For further information, see
Zle Widgets.

-f flag [ flag ... ]


Set various flags on the running widget. Possible values for flag are:

yank for indicating that the widget has yanked text into the buffer. If the widget is wrapping an
existing internal widget, no further action is necessary, but if it has inserted the text manually, then it
should also take care to set YANK_START and YANK_END correctly. yankbefore does the same but is
used when the yanked text appears after the cursor.

kill for indicating that text has been killed into the cutbuffer. When repeatedly invoking a kill widget,
text is appended to the cutbuffer instead of replacing it, but when wrapping such widgets, it is
necessary to call ‘zle -f kill’ to retain this effect.

vichange for indicating that the widget represents a vi change that can be repeated as a whole with
‘vi-repeat-change’. The flag should be set early in the function before inspecting the value of
NUMERIC or invoking other widgets. This has no effect for a widget invoked from insert mode. If
insert mode is active when the widget finishes, the change extends until next returning to command
mode.

-C widget completion-widget function


Create a user-defined completion widget named widget . The completion widget will behave like the
built-in completion-widget whose name is given as completion-widget . To generate the
completions, the shell function function will be called. For further information, see Completion
Widgets.

-R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]


Redisplay the command line. If a display-string is given and not empty, this is shown in the status
line (immediately below the line being edited).

If the optional string s are given they are listed below the prompt in the same way as completion
lists are printed. If no string s are given but the -c option is used such a list is cleared.

Note that immediately after returning from running widgets, the command line will be redisplayed
and the strings displayed will be erased. Therefore, this option is only useful for widgets that do not
exit immediately after using it.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 244 of 616
:
This command can safely be called outside user defined widgets; if zle is active, the display will be
refreshed, while if zle is not active, the command has no effect. In this case there will usually be no
other arguments.

The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

-M string
As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below the command line; unlike the -R option,
the string will not be put into the status line but will instead be printed normally below the prompt.
This means that the string will still be displayed after the widget returns (until it is overwritten by
subsequent commands).

-U string
This pushes the characters in the string onto the input stack of ZLE. After the widget currently
executed finishes ZLE will behave as if the characters in the string were typed by the user.

As ZLE uses a stack, if this option is used repeatedly the last string pushed onto the stack will be
processed first. However, the characters in each string will be processed in the order in which they
appear in the string.

-K keymap
Selects the keymap named keymap . An error message will be displayed if there is no such keymap.

This keymap selection affects the interpretation of following keystrokes within this invocation of ZLE.
Any following invocation (e.g., the next command line) will start as usual with the ‘main’ keymap
selected.

-F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
Only available if your system supports one of the ‘poll’ or ‘select’ system calls; most modern systems
do.

Installs handler (the name of a shell function) to handle input from file descriptor fd . Installing a
handler for an fd which is already handled causes the existing handler to be replaced. Any number
of handlers for any number of readable file descriptors may be installed. Note that zle makes no
attempt to check whether this fd is actually readable when installing the handler. The user must
make their own arrangements for handling the file descriptor when zle is not active.

When zle is attempting to read data, it will examine both the terminal and the list of handled fd ’s. If
data becomes available on a handled fd , zle calls handler with the fd which is ready for reading as
the first argument. Under normal circumstances this is the only argument, but if an error was
detected, a second argument provides details: ‘hup’ for a disconnect, ‘nval’ for a closed or otherwise
invalid descriptor, or ‘err’ for any other condition. Systems that support only the ‘select’ system call
always use ‘err’.

If the option -w is also given, the handler is instead a line editor widget, typically a shell function
made into a widget using ‘zle -N’. In that case handler can use all the facilities of zle to update the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 245 of 616
:
current editing line. Note, however, that as handling fd takes place at a low level changes to the
display will not automatically appear; the widget should call ‘zle -R’ to force redisplay. As of this
writing, widget handlers only support a single argument and thus are never passed a string for error
state, so widgets must be prepared to test the descriptor themselves.

If either type of handler produces output to the terminal, it should call ‘zle -I’ before doing so (see
below). Handlers should not attempt to read from the terminal.

If no handler is given, but an fd is present, any handler for that fd is removed. If there is none, an
error message is printed and status 1 is returned.

If no arguments are given, or the -L option is supplied, a list of handlers is printed in a form which
can be stored for later execution.

An fd (but not a handler ) may optionally be given with the -L option; in this case, the function will
list the handler if any, else silently return status 1.

Note that this feature should be used with care. Activity on one of the fd ’s which is not properly
handled can cause the terminal to become unusable. Removing an fd handler from within a signal
trap may cause

Here is a simple example of using this feature. A connection to a remote TCP port is created using
the ztcp command; see The zsh/net/tcp Module. Then a handler is installed which simply prints out
any data which arrives on this connection. Note that ‘select’ will indicate that the file descriptor
needs handling if the remote side has closed the connection; we handle that by testing for a failed
read.

if ztcp pwspc 2811; then


tcpfd=$REPLY
handler() {
zle -I
local line
if ! read -r line <&$1; then
# select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
# so handle this specially.
print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
zle -F $1
return 1
fi
print -r - $line
}
zle -F $tcpfd handler
fi

-I
Unusually, this option is most useful outside ordinary widget functions, though it may be used
within if normal output to the terminal is required. It invalidates the current zle display in
preparation for output; typically this will be from a trap function. It has no effect if zle is not active.
When a trap exits, the shell checks to see if the display needs restoring, hence the following will print
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 246 of 616
:
output in such a way as not to disturb the line being edited:

TRAPUSR1() {
# Invalidate zle display
[[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
# Show output
print Hello
}

In general, the trap function may need to test whether zle is active before using this method (as
shown in the example), since the zsh/zle module may not even be loaded; if it is not, the command
can be skipped.

It is possible to call ‘zle -I’ several times before control is returned to the editor; the display will only
be invalidated the first time to minimise disruption.

Note that there are normally better ways of manipulating the display from within zle widgets; see,
for example, ‘zle -R’ above.

The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated, even though this may have been by a previous call
to ‘zle -I’ or by a system notification. To test if a zle widget may be called at this point, execute zle
with no arguments and examine the return status.

-T
This is used to add, list or remove internal transformations on the processing performed by the line
editor. It is typically used only for debugging or testing and is therefore of little interest to the
general user.

‘zle -T transformation func ’ specifies that the given transformation (see below) is effected by
shell function func .

‘zle -Tr transformation ’ removes the given transformation if it was present (it is not an error if
none was).

‘zle -TL’ can be used to list all transformations currently in operation.

Currently the only transformation is tc. This is used instead of outputting termcap codes to the
terminal. When the transformation is in operation the shell function is passed the termcap code that
would be output as its first argument; if the operation required a numeric argument, that is passed
as a second argument. The function should set the shell variable REPLY to the transformed termcap
code. Typically this is used to produce some simply formatted version of the code and optional
argument for debugging or testing. Note that this transformation is not applied to other non-
printing characters such as carriage returns and newlines.

widget [ -n num ] [ -f flag ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...


Invoke the specified widget . This can only be done when ZLE is active; normally this will be within a
user-defined widget.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 247 of 616
:
With the options -n and -N, the current numeric argument will be saved and then restored after the
call to widget ; ‘-n num ’ sets the numeric argument temporarily to num , while ‘-N’ sets it to the
default, i.e. as if there were none.

With the option -K, keymap will be used as the current keymap during the execution of the widget.
The previous keymap will be restored when the widget exits.

Normally, calling a widget in this way does not set the special parameter WIDGET and related
parameters, so that the environment appears as if the top-level widget called by the user were still
active. With the option -w, WIDGET and related parameters are set to reflect the widget being
executed by the zle call.

Normally, when widget returns the special parameter LASTWIDGET will point to it. This can be
inhibited by passing the option -f nolast.

Any further arguments will be passed to the widget; note that as standard argument handling is
performed, any general argument list should be preceded by --. If it is a shell function, these are
passed down as positional parameters; for builtin widgets it is up to the widget in question what it
does with them. Currently arguments are only handled by the incremental-search commands, the
history-search-forward and -backward and the corresponding functions prefixed by vi-, and by
universal-argument. No error is flagged if the command does not use the arguments, or only uses
some of them.

The return status reflects the success or failure of the operation carried out by the widget, or if it is a
user-defined widget the return status of the shell function.

A non-zero return status causes the shell to beep when the widget exits, unless the BEEP options
was unset or the widget was called via the zle command. Thus if a user defined widget requires an
immediate beep, it should call the beep widget directly.

18.4 Zle Widgets


All actions in the editor are performed by ‘widgets’. A widget’s job is simply to perform some small
action. The ZLE commands that key sequences in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets. Widgets
can be user-defined or built in.

The standard widgets built into ZLE are listed in Standard Widgets. Other built-in widgets can be
defined by other modules (see Zsh Modules). Each built-in widget has two names: its normal
canonical name, and the same name preceded by a ‘.’. The ‘.’ name is special: it can’t be rebound to a
different widget. This makes the widget available even when its usual name has been redefined.

User-defined widgets are defined using ‘zle -N’, and implemented as shell functions. When the
widget is executed, the corresponding shell function is executed, and can perform editing (or other)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 248 of 616
:
actions. It is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names starting with ‘.’.

18.5 User-Defined Widgets


User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions, can execute any normal shell
command. They can also run other widgets (whether built-in or user-defined) using the zle builtin
command. The standard input of the function is redirected from /dev/null to prevent external
commands from unintentionally blocking ZLE by reading from the terminal, but read -k or read -q
can be used to read characters. Finally, they can examine and edit the ZLE buffer being edited by
reading and setting the special parameters described below.

These special parameters are always available in widget functions, but are not in any way special
outside ZLE. If they have some normal value outside ZLE, that value is temporarily inaccessible, but
will return when the widget function exits. These special parameters in fact have local scope, like
parameters created in a function using local.

Inside completion widgets and traps called while ZLE is active, these parameters are available read-
only.

Note that the parameters appear as local to any ZLE widget in which they appear. Hence if it is
desired to override them this needs to be done within a nested function:

widget-function() {
# $WIDGET here refers to the special variable
# that is local inside widget-function
() {
# This anonymous nested function allows WIDGET
# to be used as a local variable. The -h
# removes the special status of the variable.
local -h WIDGET
}
}

BUFFER (scalar)

The entire contents of the edit buffer. If it is written to, the cursor remains at the same offset, unless
that would put it outside the buffer.

BUFFERLINES (integer)

The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer currently displayed on screen (i.e. without any
changes to the preceding parameters done after the last redisplay); read-only.

CONTEXT (scalar)

The context in which zle was called to read a line; read-only. One of the values:
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 249 of 616
:
start
The start of a command line (at prompt PS1).

cont
A continuation to a command line (at prompt PS2).

select
In a select loop (at prompt PS3).

vared
Editing a variable in vared.

CURSOR (integer)

The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer. This is in the range 0 to $#BUFFER, and is by
definition equal to $#LBUFFER. Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer will result in the
cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the buffer.

CUTBUFFER (scalar)

The last item cut using one of the ‘kill-’ commands; the string which the next yank would insert in the
line. Later entries in the kill ring are in the array killring. Note that the command ‘zle copy-region-as-
kill string ’ can be used to set the text of the cut buffer from a shell function and cycle the kill ring in
the same way as interactively killing text.

HISTNO (integer)

The current history number. Setting this has the same effect as moving up or down in the history to
the corresponding history line. An attempt to set it is ignored if the line is not stored in the history.
Note this is not the same as the parameter HISTCMD, which always gives the number of the history
line being added to the main shell’s history. HISTNO refers to the line being retrieved within zle.

ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE (integer)

ISEARCHMATCH_START (integer)

ISEARCHMATCH_END (integer)

ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE indicates whether a part of the BUFFER is currently matched by an


incremental search pattern. ISEARCHMATCH_START and ISEARCHMATCH_END give the location of
the matched part and are in the same units as CURSOR. They are only valid for reading when
ISEARCHMATCH_ACTIVE is non-zero.

All parameters are read-only.

KEYMAP (scalar)

The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 250 of 616
:
KEYS (scalar)

The keys typed to invoke this widget, as a literal string; read-only.

KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT (integer)

The number of bytes pushed back to the input queue and therefore available for reading
immediately before any I/O is done; read-only. See also PENDING; the two values are distinct.

killring (array)

The array of previously killed items, with the most recently killed first. This gives the items that
would be retrieved by a yank-pop in the same order. Note, however, that the most recently killed
item is in $CUTBUFFER; $killring shows the array of previous entries.

The default size for the kill ring is eight, however the length may be changed by normal array
operations. Any empty string in the kill ring is ignored by the yank-pop command, hence the size of
the array effectively sets the maximum length of the kill ring, while the number of non-zero strings
gives the current length, both as seen by the user at the command line.

LASTABORTEDSEARCH (scalar)

The last search string used by an interactive search that was aborted by the user (status 3 returned
by the search widget).

LASTSEARCH (scalar)

The last search string used by an interactive search; read-only. This is set even if the search failed
(status 0, 1 or 2 returned by the search widget), but not if it was aborted by the user.

LASTWIDGET (scalar)

The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.

LBUFFER (scalar)

The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor position. If it is assigned to, only that part of
the buffer is replaced, and the cursor remains between the new $LBUFFER and the old $RBUFFER.

MARK (integer)

Like CURSOR, but for the mark. With vi-mode operators that wait for a movement command to
select a region of text, setting MARK allows the selection to extend in both directions from the initial
cursor position.

NUMERIC (integer)

The numeric argument. If no numeric argument was given, this parameter is unset. When this is set
inside a widget function, builtin widgets called with the zle builtin command will use the value
assigned. If it is unset inside a widget function, builtin widgets called behave as if no numeric
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 251 of 616
:
argument was given.

PENDING (integer)

The number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes which have already been typed and
can immediately be read. On systems where the shell is not able to get this information, this
parameter will always have a value of zero. Read-only. See also KEYS_QUEUED_COUNT; the two
values are distinct.

PREBUFFER (scalar)

In a multi-line input at the secondary prompt, this read-only parameter contains the contents of the
lines before the one the cursor is currently in.

PREDISPLAY (scalar)

does not have to be a complete line; to display a complete line, a newline must be appended
explicitly. The text is reset on each new invocation (but not recursive invocation) of zle.

POSTDISPLAY (scalar)

does not have to be a complete line; to display a complete line, a newline must be prepended
explicitly. The text is reset on each new invocation (but not recursive invocation) of zle.

RBUFFER (scalar)

The part of the buffer that lies to the right of the cursor position. If it is assigned to, only that part of
the buffer is replaced, and the cursor remains between the old $LBUFFER and the new $RBUFFER.

REGION_ACTIVE (integer)

Indicates if the region is currently active. It can be assigned 0 or 1 to deactivate and activate the
region respectively. A value of 2 activates the region in line-wise mode with the highlighted text
extending for whole lines only; see Character Highlighting.

region_highlight (array)

Each element of this array may be set to a string that describes highlighting for an arbitrary region of
the command line that will take effect the next time the command line is redisplayed. Highlighting
and POSTDISPLAY are possible, but note that the P flag is needed for character indexing to include
PREDISPLAY.

Each string consists of the following whitespace-separated parts:

Optionally, a ‘P’ to signify that the start and end offset that follow include any string set by the
PREDISPLAY special parameter; this is needed if the predisplay string itself is to be highlighted.
Whitespace between the ‘P’ and the start offset is optional.

A start offset in the same units as CURSOR.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 252 of 616
:
An end offset in the same units as CURSOR.

A highlight specification in the same format as used for contexts in the parameter zle_highlight,
see Character Highlighting; for example, standout or fg=red,bold.

Optionally, a string of the form ‘memo= token ’. The token consists of everything between the
‘=’ and the next whitespace, comma, NUL, or the end of the string. The token is preserved
verbatim but not parsed in any way.

Plugins may use this to identify array elements they have added: for example, a plugin might
set token to its (the plugin’s) name and then use ‘region_highlight=(
${region_highlight:#*memo= token } )’ in order to remove array elements it have added.

(This example uses the ‘${ name :# pattern }’ array-grepping syntax described in Parameter
Expansion.)

For example,

region_highlight=("P0 20 bold memo=foobar")

specifies that the first twenty characters of the text including any predisplay string should be
highlighted in bold.

Note that the effect of region_highlight is not saved and disappears as soon as the line is accepted.

Note that zsh 5.8 and older do not support the ‘memo= token ’ field and may misparse the third
(highlight specification) field when a memo is given.

The final highlighting on the command line depends on both region_highlight and zle_highlight; see
Character Highlighting for details.

registers (associative array)

The contents of each of the vi register buffers. These are typically set using vi-set-buffer followed by
a delete, change or yank command.

SUFFIX_ACTIVE (integer)

SUFFIX_START (integer)

SUFFIX_END (integer)

SUFFIX_ACTIVE indicates whether an auto-removable completion suffix is currently active.


SUFFIX_START and SUFFIX_END give the location of the suffix and are in the same units as CURSOR.
They are only valid for reading when SUFFIX_ACTIVE is non-zero.

All parameters are read-only.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 253 of 616
:
UNDO_CHANGE_NO (integer)

A number representing the state of the undo history. The only use of this is passing as an argument
to the undo widget in order to undo back to the recorded point. Read-only.

UNDO_LIMIT_NO (integer)

A number corresponding to an existing change in the undo history; compare UNDO_CHANGE_NO. If


this is set to a value greater than zero, the undo command will not allow the line to be undone
beyond the given change number. It is still possible to use ‘zle undo change ’ in a widget to undo
beyond that point; in that case, it will not be possible to undo at all until UNDO_LIMIT_NO is reduced.
Set to 0 to disable the limit.

A typical use of this variable in a widget function is as follows (note the additional function scope is
required):

() {
local UNDO_LIMIT_NO=$UNDO_CHANGE_NO
# Perform some form of recursive edit.
}

WIDGET (scalar)

The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.

WIDGETFUNC (scalar)

The name of the shell function that implements a widget defined with either zle -N or zle -C. In the
former case, this is the second argument to the zle -N command that defined the widget, or the first
argument if there was no second argument. In the latter case this is the third argument to the zle -C
command that defined the widget. Read-only.

WIDGETSTYLE (scalar)

Describes the implementation behind the completion widget currently being executed; the second
argument that followed zle -C when the widget was defined. This is the name of a builtin completion
widget. For widgets defined with zle -N this is set to the empty string. Read-only.

YANK_ACTIVE (integer)

YANK_START (integer)

YANK_END (integer)

YANK_ACTIVE indicates whether text has just been yanked (pasted) into the buffer. YANK_START and
YANK_END give the location of the pasted text and are in the same units as CURSOR. They are only
valid for reading when YANK_ACTIVE is non-zero. They can also be assigned by widgets that insert
text in a yank-like fashion, for example wrappers of bracketed-paste. See also zle -f.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 254 of 616
:
YANK_ACTIVE is read-only.

ZLE_RECURSIVE (integer)

Usually zero, but incremented inside any instance of recursive-edit. Hence indicates the current
recursion level.

ZLE_RECURSIVE is read-only.

ZLE_STATE (scalar)

Contains a set of space-separated words that describe the current zle state.

Currently, the states shown are the insert mode as set by the overwrite-mode or vi-replace widgets
and whether history commands will visit imported entries as controlled by the set-local-history
widget. The string contains ‘insert’ if characters to be inserted on the command line move existing
characters to the right or ‘overwrite’ if characters to be inserted overwrite existing characters. It
contains ‘localhistory’ if only local history commands will be visited or ‘globalhistory’ if imported
history commands will also be visited.

The substrings are sorted in alphabetical order so that if you want to test for two specific substrings
in a future-proof way, you can do match by doing:

if [[ $ZLE_STATE == *globalhistory*insert* ]]; then ...; fi

18.5.1 Special Widgets

There are a few user-defined widgets which are special to the shell. If they do not exist, no special
action is taken. The environment provided is identical to that for any other editing widget.

zle-isearch-exit

Executed at the end of incremental search at the point where the isearch prompt is removed from
the display. See zle-isearch-update for an example.

zle-isearch-update

Executed within incremental search when the display is about to be redrawn. Additional output
below the incremental search prompt can be generated by using ‘zle -M’ within the widget. For
example,

zle-isearch-update() { zle -M "Line $HISTNO"; }


zle -N zle-isearch-update

Note the line output by ‘zle -M’ is not deleted on exit from incremental search. This can be done

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 255 of 616
:
from a zle-isearch-exit widget:

zle-isearch-exit() { zle -M ""; }


zle -N zle-isearch-exit

zle-line-pre-redraw

Executed whenever the input line is about to be redrawn, providing an opportunity to update the
region_highlight array.

zle-line-init

Executed every time the line editor is started to read a new line of input. The following example puts
the line editor into vi command mode when it starts up.

zle-line-init() { zle -K vicmd; }


zle -N zle-line-init

(The command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is equivalent to zle vi-cmd-mode.)

zle-line-finish

This is similar to zle-line-init but is executed every time the line editor has finished reading a line of
input.

zle-history-line-set

Executed when the history line changes.

zle-keymap-select

Executed every time the keymap changes, i.e. the special parameter KEYMAP is set to a different
value, while the line editor is active. Initialising the keymap when the line editor starts does not
cause the widget to be called.

The value $KEYMAP within the function reflects the new keymap. The old keymap is passed as the
sole argument.

This can be used for detecting switches between the vi command (vicmd) and insert (usually main)
keymaps.

18.6 Standard Widgets


The following is a list of all the standard widgets, and their default bindings in emacs mode, vi
command mode and vi insert mode (the ‘emacs’, ‘vicmd’ and ‘viins’ keymaps, respectively).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 256 of 616
:
Note that cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three keymaps; the shell assumes that the
cursor keys send the key sequences reported by the terminal-handling library (termcap or terminfo).
The key sequences shown in the list are those based on the VT100, common on many modern
terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound. In the case of the viins keymap, the initial
escape character of the sequences serves also to return to the vicmd keymap: whether this happens
is determined by the KEYTIMEOUT parameter, see Parameters.

18.6.1 Movement

vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)

Move backward one word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.

vi-backward-blank-word-end (unbound) (gE) (unbound)

Move to the end of the previous word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.

backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)

Move backward one character.

vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)

Move backward one character, without changing lines.

backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)

Move to the beginning of the previous word.

emacs-backward-word

Move to the beginning of the previous word.

vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)

Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.

vi-backward-word-end (unbound) (ge) (unbound)

Move to the end of the previous word, vi-style.

beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)

Move to the beginning of the line. If already at the beginning of the line, move to the beginning of
the previous line, if any.

vi-beginning-of-line

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 257 of 616
:
Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.

down-line (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)

Move down a line in the buffer.

end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)

Move to the end of the line. If already at the end of the line, move to the end of the next line, if any.

vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)

Move to the end of the line. If an argument is given to this command, the cursor will be moved to
the end of the line (argument - 1) lines down.

vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)

Move forward one word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.

vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)

Move to the end of the current word, or, if at the end of the current word, to the end of the next
word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.

forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)

Move forward one character.

vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)

Move forward one character.

vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)

Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the next occurrence of it in the line.

vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)

Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the position just before the next occurrence of it
in the line.

vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)

Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the previous occurrence of it in the line.

vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)

Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the position just after the previous occurrence of
it in the line.

vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 258 of 616
:
Move to the first non-blank character in the line.

vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)

Move forward one word, vi-style.

forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)

Move to the beginning of the next word. The editor’s idea of a word is specified with the
WORDCHARS parameter.

emacs-forward-word

Move to the end of the next word.

vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)

Move to the end of the next word.

vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)

Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.

vi-goto-mark (unbound) (‘) (unbound)

Move to the specified mark.

vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (’) (unbound)

Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.

vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)

Repeat the last vi-find command.

vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)

Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.

up-line (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)

Move up a line in the buffer.

18.6.2 History Control

beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (gg) (unbound)

Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already there, move to the first event in the history list.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 259 of 616
:
beginning-of-line-hist

Move to the beginning of the line. If already at the beginning of the buffer, move to the previous
history line.

beginning-of-history

Move to the first event in the history list.

down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)

Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, move to the next event in the history
list.

vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)

Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, move to the next event in the history
list. Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.

down-line-or-search

Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, search forward in the history for a
line beginning with the first word in the buffer.

If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is taken as the
string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)

Move to the next event in the history list.

history-beginning-search-backward

Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the current line up to the cursor. This leaves
the cursor in its original position.

end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)

Move to the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to the last event in the history list.

end-of-line-hist

Move to the end of the line. If already at the end of the buffer, move to the next history line.

end-of-history

Move to the last event in the history list.

vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)

Fetch the history line specified by the numeric argument. This defaults to the current history line (i.e.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 260 of 616
:
the one that isn’t history yet).

history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)

Search backward incrementally for a specified string. The search is case-insensitive if the search
string does not have uppercase letters and no numeric argument was given. The string may begin
with ‘^’ to anchor the search to the beginning of the line. When called from a user-defined function
returns the following statuses: 0, if the search succeeded; 1, if the search failed; 2, if the search term
was a bad pattern; 3, if the search was aborted by the send-break command.

A restricted set of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer. Keys are looked up in the special
isearch keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap (note that by default the isearch keymap
is empty). An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting, will stop the search and go back to the
original line. An undefined key will have the same effect. Note that the following always perform the
same task within incremental searches and cannot be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the
set of functions be extended. The supported functions are:

accept-and-hold
accept-and-infer-next-history
accept-line
accept-line-and-down-history
Perform the usual function after exiting incremental search. The command line displayed is
executed.

backward-delete-char
vi-backward-delete-char
Back up one place in the search history. If the search has been repeated this does not immediately
erase a character in the minibuffer.

accept-search
Exit incremental search, retaining the command line but performing no further action. Note that this
function is not bound by default and has no effect outside incremental search.

backward-delete-word
backward-kill-word
vi-backward-kill-word
Back up one character in the minibuffer; if multiple searches have been performed since the
character was inserted the search history is rewound to the point just before the character was
entered. Hence this has the effect of repeating backward-delete-char.

clear-screen
Clear the screen, remaining in incremental search mode.

history-incremental-search-backward
Find the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buffer. If the mini-buffer is empty, the most
recent previously used search string is reinstated.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 261 of 616
:
history-incremental-search-forward
Invert the sense of the search.

magic-space
Inserts a non-magical space.

quoted-insert
vi-quoted-insert
Quote the character to insert into the minibuffer.

redisplay
Redisplay the command line, remaining in incremental search mode.

vi-cmd-mode
Select the ‘vicmd’ keymap; the ‘main’ keymap (insert mode) will be selected initially.

In addition, the modifications that were made while in vi insert mode are merged to form a single
undo event.

vi-repeat-search
vi-rev-repeat-search
Repeat the search. The direction of the search is indicated in the mini-buffer.

Any character that is not bound to one of the above functions, or self-insert or self-insert-unmeta,
will cause the mode to be exited. The character is then looked up and executed in the keymap in
effect at that point.

When called from a widget function by the zle command, the incremental search commands can
take a string argument. This will be treated as a string of keys, as for arguments to the bindkey
command, and used as initial input for the command. Any characters in the string which are unused
by the incremental search will be silently ignored. For example,

zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps

will search backwards for forceps, leaving the minibuffer containing the string ‘forceps’.

history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)

Search forward incrementally for a specified string. The search is case-insensitive if the search string
does not have uppercase letters and no numeric argument was given. The string may begin with ‘^’
to anchor the search to the beginning of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are the
same as for history-incremental-search-backward.

history-incremental-pattern-search-backward

history-incremental-pattern-search-forward

These widgets behave similarly to the corresponding widgets with no -pattern, but the search string

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 262 of 616
:
typed by the user is treated as a pattern, respecting the current settings of the various options
affecting pattern matching. See Filename Generation for a description of patterns. If no numeric
argument was given lowercase letters in the search string may match uppercase letters in the
history. The string may begin with ‘^’ to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.

The prompt changes to indicate an invalid pattern; this may simply indicate the pattern is not yet
complete.

Note that only non-overlapping matches are reported, so an expression with wildcards may return
fewer matches on a line than are visible by inspection.

history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)

Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buffer.

If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is taken as the
string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)

Search backward in the history for a specified string. The string may begin with ‘^’ to anchor the
search to the beginning of the line.

A restricted set of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer. An interrupt signal, as defined by
the stty setting, will stop the search. The functions available in the mini-buffer are: accept-line,
backward-delete-char, vi-backward-delete-char, backward-kill-word, vi-backward-kill-word, clear-
screen, redisplay, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.

vi-cmd-mode is treated the same as accept-line, and magic-space is treated as a space. Any other
character that is not bound to self-insert or self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. If the
function is called from vi command mode, the bindings of the current insert mode will be used.

If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is taken as the
string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)

Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buffer.

If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is taken as the
string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)

Search forward in the history for a specified string. The string may begin with ‘^’ to anchor the search
to the beginning of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are the same as for vi-history-
search-backward. Argument handling is also the same as for that command.

infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 263 of 616
:
Search in the history list for a line matching the current one and fetch the event following it.

insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)

Insert the last word from the previous history event at the cursor position. If a positive numeric
argument is given, insert that word from the end of the previous history event. If the argument is
zero or negative insert that word from the left (zero inserts the previous command word). Repeating
this command replaces the word just inserted with the last word from the history event prior to the
one just used; numeric arguments can be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.

When called from a shell function invoked from a user-defined widget, the command can take one
to three arguments. The first argument specifies a history offset which applies to successive calls to
this widget: if it is -1, the default behaviour is used, while if it is 1, successive calls will move forwards
through the history. The value 0 can be used to indicate that the history line examined by the
previous execution of the command will be reexamined. Note that negative numbers should be
preceded by a ‘--’ argument to avoid confusing them with options.

If two arguments are given, the second specifies the word on the command line in normal array
index notation (as a more natural alternative to the numeric argument). Hence 1 is the first word,
and -1 (the default) is the last word.

If a third argument is given, its value is ignored, but it is used to signify that the history offset is
relative to the current history line, rather than the one remembered after the previous invocations
of insert-last-word.

For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to

zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1

while the command

zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -

always copies the first word of the line in the history immediately before the line being edited. This
has the side effect that later invocations of the widget will be relative to that line.

vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)

Repeat the last vi history search.

vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)

Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.

up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)

Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, move to the previous event in the history
list.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 264 of 616
:
vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)

Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, move to the previous event in the history
list. Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.

up-line-or-search

Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, search backward in the history for a line
beginning with the first word in the buffer.

If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is taken as the
string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)

Move to the previous event in the history list.

history-beginning-search-forward

Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the current line up to the cursor. This leaves
the cursor in its original position.

set-local-history

By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as the local lines. This
widget lets you toggle this on and off, or set it with the numeric argument. Zero for both local and
imported lines and nonzero for only local lines.

18.6.3 Modifying Text

vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)

Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)

Enter insert mode after the current cursor position, without changing lines.

backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)

Delete the character behind the cursor.

vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)

Delete the character behind the cursor, without changing lines. If in insert mode, this won’t delete
past the point where insert mode was last entered.

backward-delete-word
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 265 of 616
:
Delete the word behind the cursor.

backward-kill-line

Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.

backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)

Kill the word behind the cursor.

vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)

Kill the word behind the cursor, without going past the point where insert mode was last entered.

capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)

Capitalize the current word and move past it.

vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)

Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill from the cursor position to the endpoint of
the movement. Then enter insert mode. If the command is vi-change, change the current line.

For compatibility with vi, if the command is vi-forward-word or vi-forward-blank-word, the


whitespace after the word is not included. If you prefer the more consistent behaviour with the
whitespace included use the following key binding:

bindkey -a -s cw dwi

vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)

Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)

Kill the current line and enter insert mode.

copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)

Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.

If called from a ZLE widget function in the form ‘zle copy-region-as-kill string ’ then string will be
taken as the text to copy to the kill buffer. The cursor, the mark and the text on the command line
are not used in this case.

copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)

Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.

copy-prev-shell-word

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 266 of 616
:
Like copy-prev-word, but the word is found by using shell parsing, whereas copy-prev-word looks for
blanks. This makes a difference when the word is quoted and contains spaces.

vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)

Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill from the cursor position to the endpoint of
the movement. If the command is vi-delete, kill the current line.

delete-char

Delete the character under the cursor.

vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)

Delete the character under the cursor, without going past the end of the line.

delete-word

Delete the current word.

down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)

Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.

vi-down-case (unbound) (gu) (unbound)

Read a movement command from the keyboard, and convert all characters from the cursor position
to the endpoint of the movement to lowercase. If the movement command is vi-down-case, swap
the case of all characters on the current line.

kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)

Kill the current word.

gosmacs-transpose-chars

Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.

vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)

Indent a number of lines.

vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)

Enter insert mode.

vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)

Move to the first non-blank character on the line and enter insert mode.

vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 267 of 616
:
Join the current line with the next one.

kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)

Kill from the cursor to the end of the line. If already on the end of the line, kill the newline character.

vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)

Kill from the cursor back to wherever insert mode was last entered.

vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)

Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.

kill-region

Kill from the cursor to the mark.

kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)

Kill the entire buffer.

kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)

Kill the current line.

vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)

Move to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches the one under the cursor. If the cursor
is not on a bracket character, move forward without going past the end of the line to find one, and
then go to the matching bracket.

vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)

Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.

vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)

Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.

vi-oper-swap-case (unbound) (g~) (unbound)

Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case of all characters from the cursor
position to the endpoint of the movement. If the movement command is vi-oper-swap-case, swap
the case of all characters on the current line.

overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)

Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.

vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 268 of 616
:
Insert the contents of the kill buffer before the cursor. If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines
(as opposed to characters), paste it above the current line.

vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)

Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor. If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as
opposed to characters), paste it below the current line.

put-replace-selection (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)

Replace the contents of the current region or selection with the contents of the kill buffer. If the kill
buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters), the current line will be split by the
pasted lines.

quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)

Insert the next character typed into the buffer literally. An interrupt character will not be inserted.

vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)

Display a ‘^’ at the cursor position, and insert the next character typed into the buffer literally. An
interrupt character will not be inserted.

quote-line (ESC-’) (unbound) (unbound)

Quote the current line; that is, put a ‘’’ character at the beginning and the end, and convert all ‘’’
characters to ‘’\’’’.

quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)

Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.

vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)

Enter overwrite mode.

vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)

Repeat the last vi mode text modification. If a count was used with the modification, it is
remembered. If a count is given to this command, it overrides the remembered count, and is
remembered for future uses of this command. The cut buffer specification is similarly remembered.

vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)

Replace the character under the cursor with a character read from the keyboard.

Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.

self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 269 of 616
:
Insert a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit and converting ^M to ^J.

vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)

Substitute the next character(s).

vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)

Swap the case of the character under the cursor and move past it.

transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)

Exchange the two characters to the left of the cursor if at end of line, else exchange the character
under the cursor with the character to the left.

transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)

Exchange the current word with the one before it.

With a positive numeric argument N, the word around the cursor, or following it if the cursor is
between words, is transposed with the preceding N words. The cursor is put at the end of the
resulting group of words.

With a negative numeric argument -N, the effect is the same as using a positive argument N except
that the original cursor position is retained, regardless of how the words are rearranged.

vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)

Unindent a number of lines.

vi-up-case (unbound) (gU) (unbound)

Read a movement command from the keyboard, and convert all characters from the cursor position
to the endpoint of the movement to lowercase. If the movement command is vi-up-case, swap the
case of all characters on the current line.

up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)

Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.

yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)

Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.

yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)

Remove the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring (the history of previously killed text) and yank the
new top. Only works following yank, vi-put-before, vi-put-after or yank-pop.

vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 270 of 616
:
Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy the region from the cursor position to
the endpoint of the movement into the kill buffer. If the command is vi-yank, copy the current line.

vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)

Copy the current line into the kill buffer.

vi-yank-eol

Copy the region from the cursor position to the end of the line into the kill buffer. Arguably, this is
what Y should do in vi, but it isn’t what it actually does.

18.6.4 Arguments

digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)

Start a new numeric argument, or add to the current one. See also vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line. This
only works if bound to a key sequence ending in a decimal digit.

Inside a widget function, a call to this function treats the last key of the key sequence which called
the widget as the digit.

neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)

Changes the sign of the following argument.

universal-argument

Multiply the argument of the next command by 4. Alternatively, if this command is followed by an
integer (positive or negative), use that as the argument for the next command. Thus digits cannot be
repeated using this command. For example, if this command occurs twice, followed immediately by
forward-char, move forward sixteen spaces; if instead it is followed by -2, then forward-char, move
backward two spaces.

Inside a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. ‘zle universal-argument num ’, the numeric
argument will be set to num ; this is equivalent to ‘NUMERIC= num ’.

argument-base

Use the existing numeric argument as a numeric base, which must be in the range 2 to 36 inclusive.
Subsequent use of digit-argument and universal-argument will input a new numeric argument in the
given base. The usual hexadecimal convention is used: the letter a or A corresponds to 10, and so
on. Arguments in bases requiring digits from 10 upwards are more conveniently input with
universal-argument, since ESC-a etc. are not usually bound to digit-argument.

The function can be used with a command argument inside a user-defined widget. The following

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 271 of 616
:
code sets the base to 16 and lets the user input a hexadecimal argument until a key out of the digit
range is typed:

zle argument-base 16
zle universal-argument

18.6.5 Completion

accept-and-menu-complete

In a menu completion, insert the current completion into the buffer, and advance to the next
possible completion.

complete-word

Attempt completion on the current word.

delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)

Delete the character under the cursor. If the cursor is at the end of the line, list possible completions
for the current word.

expand-cmd-path

Expand the current command to its full pathname.

expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)

Attempt shell expansion on the current word. If that fails, attempt completion.

expand-or-complete-prefix

Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.

expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)

Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.

expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)

Attempt shell expansion on the current word.

list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)

List possible completions for the current word.

list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 272 of 616
:
List the expansion of the current word.

magic-space

Perform history expansion and insert a space into the buffer. This is intended to be bound to space.

menu-complete

Like complete-word, except that menu completion is used. See the MENU_COMPLETE option.

menu-expand-or-complete

Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.

reverse-menu-complete

Perform menu completion, like menu-complete, except that if a menu completion is already in
progress, move to the previous completion rather than the next.

end-of-list

When a previous completion displayed a list below the prompt, this widget can be used to move the
prompt below the list.

18.6.6 Miscellaneous

accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)

Push the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and execute it.

accept-and-infer-next-history

Execute the contents of the buffer. Then search the history list for a line matching the current one
and push the event following onto the buffer stack.

accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)

Finish editing the buffer. Normally this causes the buffer to be executed as a shell command.

accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)

Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the buffer stack.

auto-suffix-remove

If the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on the command line, remove it.
Otherwise do nothing. Removing the suffix ends any active menu completion or menu selection.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 273 of 616
:
This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce a desired suffix-removal
behavior.

auto-suffix-retain

If the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on the command line, force it to
be preserved. Otherwise do nothing. Retaining the suffix ends any active menu completion or menu
selection.

This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce a desired suffix-
preservation behavior.

beep

Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.

bracketed-paste (^[[200~) (^[[200~) (^[[200~)

This widget is invoked when text is pasted to the terminal emulator. It is not intended to be bound
to actual keys but instead to the special sequence generated by the terminal emulator when text is
pasted.

When invoked interactively, the pasted text is inserted to the buffer and placed in the cutbuffer. If a
numeric argument is given, shell quoting will be applied to the pasted text before it is inserted.

When a named buffer is specified with vi-set-buffer ("x), the pasted text is stored in that named
buffer but not inserted.

When called from a widget function as ‘bracketed-paste name ‘, the pasted text is assigned to the
variable name and no other processing is done.

See also the zle_bracketed_paste parameter.

vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)

Enter command mode; that is, select the ‘vicmd’ keymap. Yes, this is bound by default in emacs
mode.

vi-caps-lock-panic

Hang until any lowercase key is pressed. This is for vi users without the mental capacity to keep
track of their caps lock key (like the author).

clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)

Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.

deactivate-region

Make the current region inactive. This disables vim-style visual selection mode if it is active.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 274 of 616
:
describe-key-briefly

Reads a key sequence, then prints the function bound to that sequence.

exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)

Exchange the cursor position (point) with the position of the mark. Unless a negative numeric
argument is given, the region between point and mark is activated so that it can be highlighted. If a
zero numeric argument is given, the region is activated but point and mark are not swapped.

execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (:) (unbound)

Read the name of an editor command and execute it. Aliasing this widget with ‘zle -A’ or replacing it
with ‘zle -N’ has no effect when interpreting key bindings, but ‘zle execute-named-cmd’ will invoke
such an alias or replacement.

A restricted set of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer. Keys are looked up in the special
command keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap. An interrupt signal, as defined by the
stty setting, will abort the function. Note that the following always perform the same task within the
executed-named-cmd environment and cannot be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set
of functions be extended. The allowed functions are: backward-delete-char, vi-backward-delete-char,
clear-screen, redisplay, quoted-insert, vi-quoted-insert, backward-kill-word, vi-backward-kill-word,
kill-whole-line, vi-kill-line, backward-kill-line, list-choices, delete-char-or-list, complete-word, accept-
line, expand-or-complete and expand-or-complete-prefix.

kill-region kills the last word, and vi-cmd-mode is treated the same as accept-line. The space and tab
characters, if not bound to one of these functions, will complete the name and then list the
possibilities if the AUTO_LIST option is set. Any other character that is not bound to self-insert or
self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. The bindings of the current insert mode will be used.

Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)

Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.

Like execute-named-cmd, this command may not be redefined, but it may be called by name.

get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)

Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the cursor position.

pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)

If there is no # character at the beginning of the buffer, add one to the beginning of each line. If
there is one, remove a # from each line that has one. In either case, accept the current line. The
INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for this to have any usefulness.

vi-pound-insert

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 275 of 616
:
If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line, add one. If there is one, remove it. The
INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for this to have any usefulness.

push-input

Push the entire current multiline construct onto the buffer stack and return to the top-level (PS1)
prompt. If the current parser construct is only a single line, this is exactly like push-line. Next time
the editor starts up or is popped with get-line, the construct will be popped off the top of the buffer
stack and loaded into the editing buffer.

push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)

Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buffer. Next time the editor starts up, the
buffer will be popped off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing buffer.

push-line-or-edit

At the top-level (PS1) prompt, equivalent to push-line. At a secondary (PS2) prompt, move the entire
current multiline construct into the editor buffer. The latter is equivalent to push-input followed by
get-line.

read-command

Only useful from a user-defined widget. A keystroke is read just as in normal operation, but instead
of the command being executed the name of the command that would be executed is stored in the
shell parameter REPLY. This can be used as the argument of a future zle command. If the key
sequence is not bound, status 1 is returned; typically, however, REPLY is set to undefined-key to
indicate a useless key sequence.

recursive-edit

Only useful from a user-defined widget. At this point in the function, the editor regains control until
one of the standard widgets which would normally cause zle to exit (typically an accept-line caused
by hitting the return key) is executed. Instead, control returns to the user-defined widget. The status
returned is non-zero if the return was caused by an error, but the function still continues executing
and hence may tidy up. This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to alter the command line or
key bindings temporarily.

The following widget, caps-lock, serves as an example.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 276 of 616
:
self-insert-ucase() {
LBUFFER+=${(U)KEYS[-1]}
}

integer stat

zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase


zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
zle -A accept-line caps-lock

zle recursive-edit
stat=$?

zle -A .self-insert self-insert


zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
zle -D save-caps-lock

(( stat )) && zle send-break

return $stat

This causes typed letters to be inserted capitalised until either accept-line (i.e. typically the return
key) is typed or the caps-lock widget is invoked again; the later is handled by saving the old definition
of caps-lock as save-caps-lock and then rebinding it to invoke accept-line. Note that an error from
the recursive edit is detected as a non-zero return status and propagated by using the send-break
widget.

redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)

Redisplays the edit buffer.

reset-prompt (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)

Force the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be re-expanded, then redisplay the edit
buffer. This reflects changes both to the prompt variables themselves and changes in the expansion
of the values (for example, changes in time or directory, or changes to the value of variables referred
to by the prompt).

Otherwise, the prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and when the display has been
interrupted by output from another part of the shell (such as a job notification) which causes the
command line to be reprinted.

reset-prompt doesn’t alter the special parameter LASTWIDGET.

send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)

Abort the current editor function, e.g. execute-named-command, or the editor itself, e.g. if you are in
vared. Otherwise abort the parsing of the current line; in this case the aborted line is available in the
shell variable ZLE_LINE_ABORTED. If the editor is aborted from within vared, the variable
ZLE_VARED_ABORTED is set.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 277 of 616
:
run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)

Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command ‘run-help cmd ’, where cmd is the
current command. run-help is normally aliased to man.

vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)

Specify a buffer to be used in the following command. There are 37 buffers that can be specified: the
26 ‘named’ buffers "a to "z, the ‘yank’ buffer "0, the nine ‘queued’ buffers "1 to "9 and the ‘black hole’
buffer "_. The named buffers can also be specified as "A to "Z.

When a buffer is specified for a cut, change or yank command, the text concerned replaces the
previous contents of the specified buffer. If a named buffer is specified using a capital, the newly cut
text is appended to the buffer instead of overwriting it. When using the "_ buffer, nothing happens.
This can be useful for deleting text without affecting any buffers.

If no buffer is specified for a cut or change command, "1 is used, and the contents of "1 to "8 are
each shifted along one buffer; the contents of "9 is lost. If no buffer is specified for a yank command,
"0 is used. Finally, a paste command without a specified buffer will paste the text from the most
recent command regardless of any buffer that might have been used with that command.

When called from a widget function by the zle command, the buffer can optionally be specified with
an argument. For example,

zle vi-set-buffer A

vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)

Set the specified mark at the cursor position.

set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)

Set the mark at the cursor position. If called with a negative numeric argument, do not set the mark
but deactivate the region so that it is no longer highlighted (it is still usable for other purposes).
Otherwise the region is marked as active.

spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)

Attempt spelling correction on the current word.

split-undo

Breaks the undo sequence at the current change. This is useful in vi mode as changes made in insert
mode are coalesced on entering command mode. Similarly, undo will normally revert as one all the
changes made by a user-defined widget.

undefined-key

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 278 of 616
:
This command is executed when a key sequence that is not bound to any command is typed. By
default it beeps.

undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (u) (unbound)

Incrementally undo the last text modification. When called from a user-defined widget, takes an
optional argument indicating a previous state of the undo history as returned by the
UNDO_CHANGE_NO variable; modifications are undone until that state is reached, subject to any
limit imposed by the UNDO_LIMIT_NO variable.

Note that when invoked from vi command mode, the full prior change made in insert mode is
reverted, the changes having been merged when command mode was selected.

redo (unbound) (^R) (unbound)

Incrementally redo undone text modifications.

vi-undo-change (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)

Undo the last text modification. If repeated, redo the modification.

visual-mode (unbound) (v) (unbound)

Toggle vim-style visual selection mode. If line-wise visual mode is currently enabled then it is
changed to being character-wise. If used following an operator, it forces the subsequent movement
command to be treated as a character-wise movement.

visual-line-mode (unbound) (V) (unbound)

Toggle vim-style line-wise visual selection mode. If character-wise visual mode is currently enabled
then it is changed to being line-wise. If used following an operator, it forces the subsequent
movement command to be treated as a line-wise movement.

what-cursor-position (^X=) (ga) (unbound)

Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, decimal and hexadecimal number, the
current cursor position within the buffer and the column of the cursor in the current line.

where-is

Read the name of an editor command and print the listing of key sequences that invoke the
specified command. A restricted set of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer. Keys are
looked up in the special command keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap.

which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)

Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command ‘which-command cmd ’. where cmd
is the current command. which-command is normally aliased to whence.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 279 of 616
:
vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)

If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument, continue the argument. Otherwise,
execute vi-beginning-of-line.

18.6.7 Text Objects

Text objects are commands that can be used to select a block of text according to some criteria.
They are a feature of the vim text editor and so are primarily intended for use with vi operators or
from visual selection mode. However, they can also be used from vi-insert or emacs mode. Key
bindings listed below apply to the viopp and visual keymaps.

select-a-blank-word (aW)

Select a word including adjacent blanks, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.
With a numeric argument, multiple words will be selected.

select-a-shell-word (aa)

Select the current command argument applying the normal rules for quoting.

select-a-word (aw)

Select a word including adjacent blanks, using the normal vi-style word definition. With a numeric
argument, multiple words will be selected.

select-in-blank-word (iW)

Select a word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters. With a numeric
argument, multiple words will be selected.

select-in-shell-word (ia)

Select the current command argument applying the normal rules for quoting. If the argument
begins and ends with matching quote characters, these are not included in the selection.

select-in-word (iw)

Select a word, using the normal vi-style word definition. With a numeric argument, multiple words
will be selected.

18.7 Character Highlighting

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 280 of 616
:
The line editor has the ability to highlight characters or regions of the line that have a particular
significance. This is controlled by the array parameter zle_highlight, if it has been set by the user.

If the parameter contains the single entry none all highlighting is turned off. Note the parameter is
still expected to be an array.

Otherwise each entry of the array should consist of a word indicating a context for highlighting, then
a colon, then a comma-separated list of the types of highlighting to apply in that context.

The contexts available for highlighting are the following:

default

Any text within the command line not affected by any other highlighting.

isearch

When one of the incremental history search widgets is active, the area of the command line
matched by the search string or pattern.

region

The currently selected text. In emacs terminology, this is referred to as the region and is bounded by
the cursor (point) and the mark. The region is only highlighted if it is active, which is the case after
the mark is modified with set-mark-command or exchange-point-and-mark. Note that whether or
not the region is active has no effect on its use within emacs style widgets, it simply determines
whether it is highlighted. In vi mode, the region corresponds to selected text in visual mode.

special

representation but are shown in a special manner by the line editor. These characters are described
below.

suffix

This context is used in completion for characters that are marked as suffixes that will be removed if
the completion ends at that point, the most obvious example being a slash (/) after a directory
name. Note that suffix removal is configurable; the circumstances under which the suffix will be
removed may differ for different completions.

paste

Following a command to paste text, the characters that were inserted.

When region_highlight is set, the contexts that describe a region — isearch, region, suffix, and paste
— are applied first, then region_highlight is applied, then the remaining zle_highlight contexts are
applied. If a particular character is affected by multiple specifications, the last specification wins.

zle_highlight may contain additional fields for controlling how terminal sequences to change colours

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 281 of 616
:
are output. Each of the following is followed by a colon and a string in the same form as for key
bindings. This will not be necessary for the vast majority of terminals as the defaults shown in
parentheses are widely used.

fg_start_code (\e[3)

The start of the escape sequence for the foreground colour. This is followed by one to three ASCII
digits representing the colour. Only used for palette colors, i.e. not 24-bit colors specified via a color
triplet.

fg_default_code (9)

The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default foreground colour.

fg_end_code (m)

The end of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.

bg_start_code (\e[4)

The start of the escape sequence for the background colour. See fg_start_code above.

bg_default_code (9)

The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default background colour.

bg_end_code (m)

The end of the escape sequence for the background colour.

The available types of highlighting are the following. Note that not all types of highlighting are
available on all terminals:

none
No highlighting is applied to the given context. It is not useful for this to appear with other types of
highlighting; it is used to override a default.

fg= colour
The foreground colour should be set to colour , a decimal integer, the name of one of the eight
most widely-supported colours or as a ‘#’ followed by an RGB triplet in hexadecimal format.

Not all terminals support this and, of those that do, not all provide facilities to test the support,
hence the user should decide based on the terminal type. Most terminals support the colours black,
red, green, yellow, blue, magenta, cyan and white, which can be set by name. In addition. default
may be used to set the terminal’s default foreground colour. Abbreviations are allowed; b or bl
selects black. Some terminals may generate additional colours if the bold attribute is also present.

On recent terminals and on systems with an up-to-date terminal database the number of colours
supported may be tested by the command ‘echotc Co’; if this succeeds, it indicates a limit on the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 282 of 616
:
number of colours which will be enforced by the line editor. The number of colours is in any case
limited to 256 (i.e. the range 0 to 255).

Some modern terminal emulators have support for 24-bit true colour (16 million colours). In this
case, the hex triplet format can be used. This consists of a ‘#’ followed by either a three or six digit
hexadecimal number describing the red, green and blue components of the colour. Hex triplets can
also be used with 88 and 256 colour terminals via the zsh/nearcolor module (see The zsh/nearcolor
Module).

Colour is also known as color.

bg= colour
The background colour should be set to colour . This works similarly to the foreground colour,
except the background is not usually affected by the bold attribute.

bold
The characters in the given context are shown in a bold font. Not all terminals distinguish bold fonts.

standout
The characters in the given context are shown in the terminal’s standout mode. The actual effect is
specific to the terminal; on many terminals it is inverse video. On some such terminals, where the
cursor does not blink it appears with standout mode negated, making it less than clear where the
cursor actually is. On such terminals one of the other effects may be preferable for highlighting the
region and matched search string.

underline
The characters in the given context are shown underlined. Some terminals show the foreground in a
different colour instead; in this case whitespace will not be highlighted.

The characters described above as ‘special’ are as follows. The formatting described here is used
irrespective of whether the characters are highlighted:

ASCII control characters


Control characters in the ASCII range are shown as ‘^’ followed by the base character.

This item applies to control characters not in the ASCII range, plus other characters as follows. If the
MULTIBYTE option is in effect, multibyte characters not in the ASCII character set that are reported
as having zero width are treated as combining characters when the option COMBINING_CHARS is
on. If the option is off, or if a character appears where a combining character is not valid, the
character

angle brackets. The number is the code point of the character in the wide character set; this may or
may not be Unicode, depending on the operating system.

Invalid multibyte characters


If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, any sequence of one or more bytes that does not form a valid
character in the current character set is treated as a series of bytes each shown as a special

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 283 of 616
:
character. as the bytes are represented as two hexadecimal digits between angle brackets, as
distinct from the four or eight digits that are used for character set.

Not all systems support this: for it to work, the system’s representation of wide characters must be
code values from the Universal Character Set, as defined by IS0 10646 (also known as Unicode).

Wrapped double-width characters


When a double-width character appears in the final column of a line, it is instead shown on the next
line. The empty space left in the original position is highlighted as a special character.

If zle_highlight is not set or no value applies to a particular context, the defaults applied are
equivalent to

zle_highlight=(region:standout special:standout
suffix:bold isearch:underline paste:standout)

i.e. both the region and special characters are shown in standout mode.

Within widgets, arbitrary regions may be highlighted by setting the special array parameter
region_highlight; see Zle Widgets.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 284 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

19 Completion Widgets
19.1 Description
19.2 Completion Special Parameters
19.3 Completion Builtin Commands
-
19.4 Completion Condition Codes
19.5 Completion Matching Control
19.6 Completion Widget Example

19 Completion Widgets

19.1 Description
The shell’s programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in two ways; here the low-
level features supporting the newer, function-based mechanism are defined. A complete set of shell
functions based on these features is described in the next chapter, Completion System, and users
with no interest in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing their own — see dictionary entry for
‘hubris’) should skip the current section. The older system based on the compctl builtin command is
described in Completion Using compctl.

Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin command provided by the zsh/zle
module (see The zsh/zle Module). For example,

zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer

defines a widget named ‘complete’. The second argument is the name of any of the builtin widgets
that handle completions: complete-word, expand-or-complete, expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-
complete, menu-expand-or-complete, reverse-menu-complete, list-choices, or delete-char-or-list.
Note that this will still work even if the widget in question has been re-bound.

When this newly defined widget is bound to a key using the bindkey builtin command defined in the
zsh/zle module (Zsh Line Editor), typing that key will call the shell function ‘completer’. This function
is responsible for generating completion matches using the builtins described below. As with other
ZLE widgets, the function is called with its standard input closed.

Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control again and treats the matches in
the same manner as the specified builtin widget, in this case expand-or-complete.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 285 of 616
:
19.2 Completion Special Parameters
The parameters ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS and ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS are used by the
completion mechanism, but are not special. See Parameters Used By The Shell.

Inside completion widgets, and any functions called from them, some parameters have special
meaning; outside these functions they are not special to the shell in any way. These parameters are
used to pass information between the completion code and the completion widget. Some of the
builtin commands and the condition codes use or change the current values of these parameters.
Any existing values will be hidden during execution of completion widgets; except for compstate, the
parameters are reset on each function exit (including nested function calls from within the
completion widget) to the values they had when the function was entered.

CURRENT

This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor is currently on in the words array.
Note that this value is only correct if the ksharrays option is not set.

IPREFIX

Initially this will be set to the empty string. This parameter functions like PREFIX; it contains a string
which precedes the one in PREFIX and is not considered part of the list of matches. Typically, a string
is transferred from the beginning of PREFIX to the end of IPREFIX, for example:

IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}

causes the part of the prefix up to and including the first equal sign not to be treated as part of a
matched string. This can be done automatically by the compset builtin, see below.

ISUFFIX

As IPREFIX, but for a suffix that should not be considered part of the matches; note that the ISUFFIX
string follows the SUFFIX string.

PREFIX

Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from the beginning of the word up to the
position of the cursor; it may be altered to give a common prefix for all matches.

QIPREFIX

This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up to the word being completed. E.g.
when completing ‘"foo’, this parameter contains the double quote. If the -q option of compset is
used (see below), and the original string was ‘"foo bar’ with the cursor on the ‘bar’, this parameter
contains ‘"foo ’.

QISUFFIX
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 286 of 616
:
Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.

SUFFIX

Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from the cursor position to the end; it may be
altered to give a common suffix for all matches. It is most useful when the option
COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on the command line is treated as a
prefix.

compstate

This is an associative array with various keys and values that the completion code uses to exchange
information with the completion widget. The keys are:

all_quotes

The -q option of the compset builtin command (see below) allows a quoted string to be broken into
separate words; if the cursor is on one of those words, that word will be completed, possibly
invoking ‘compset -q’ recursively. With this key it is possible to test the types of quoted strings which
are currently broken into parts in this fashion. Its value contains one character for each quoting
level. The characters are a single quote or a double quote for strings quoted with these characters, a
dollars sign for strings quoted with $’ ... ’ and a backslash for strings not starting with a quote
character. The first character in the value always corresponds to the innermost quoting level.

context

This will be set by the completion code to the overall context in which completion is attempted.
Possible values are:

array_value
when completing inside the value of an array parameter assignment; in this case the words array
contains the words inside the parentheses.

brace_parameter
when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter expansion beginning with ${. This context
will also be set when completing parameter flags following ${(; the full command line argument is
presented and the handler must test the value to be completed to ascertain that this is the case.

assign_parameter
when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter assignment.

command
when completing for a normal command (either in command position or for an argument of the
command).

condition
when completing inside a ‘[[...]]’ conditional expression; in this case the words array contains only
the words inside the conditional expression.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 287 of 616
:
math
when completing in a mathematical environment such as a ‘((...))’ construct.

parameter
when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter expansion beginning with $ but not ${.

redirect
when completing after a redirection operator.

subscript
when completing inside a parameter subscript.

value
when completing the value of a parameter assignment.

exact

Controls the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is set. It will be set to accept if an exact match
would be accepted, and will be unset otherwise.

If it was set when at least one match equal to the string on the line was generated, the match is
accepted.

exact_string

The string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise unset.

ignored

The number of completions that were ignored because they matched one of the patterns given with
the -F option to the compadd builtin command.

insert

This controls the manner in which a match is inserted into the command line. On entry to the widget
function, if it is unset the command line is not to be changed; if set to unambiguous, any prefix
common to all matches is to be inserted; if set to automenu-unambiguous, the common prefix is to
be inserted and the next invocation of the completion code may start menu completion (due to the
AUTO_MENU option being set); if set to menu or automenu menu completion will be started for the
matches currently generated (in the latter case this will happen because the AUTO_MENU is set). The
value may also contain the string ‘tab’ when the completion code would normally not really do
completion, but only insert the TAB character.

On exit it may be set to any of the values above (where setting it to the empty string is the same as
unsetting it), or to a number, in which case the match whose number is given will be inserted into
the command line. Negative numbers count backward from the last match (with ‘-1’ selecting the last
match) and out-of-range values are wrapped around, so that a value of zero selects the last match
and a value one more than the maximum selects the first. Unless the value of this key ends in a

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 288 of 616
:
space, the match is inserted as in a menu completion, i.e. without automatically appending a space.

Both menu and automenu may also specify the number of the match to insert, given after a colon.
For example, ‘menu:2’ says to start menu completion, beginning with the second match.

Note that a value containing the substring ‘tab’ makes the matches generated be ignored and only
the TAB be inserted.

Finally, it may also be set to all, which makes all matches generated be inserted into the line.

insert_positions

When the completion system inserts an unambiguous string into the line, there may be multiple
places where characters are missing or where the character inserted differs from at least one match.
The value of this key contains a colon separated list of all these positions, as indexes into the
command line.

last_prompt

If this is set to a non-empty string for every match added, the completion code will move the cursor
back to the previous prompt after the list of completions has been displayed. Initially this is set or
unset according to the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

list

This controls whether or how the list of matches will be displayed. If it is unset or empty they will
never be listed; if its value begins with list, they will always be listed; if it begins with autolist or
ambiguous, they will be listed when the AUTO_LIST or LIST_AMBIGUOUS options respectively would
normally cause them to be.

If the substring force appears in the value, this makes the list be shown even if there is only one
match. Normally, the list would be shown only if there are at least two matches.

The value contains the substring packed if the LIST_PACKED option is set. If this substring is given for
all matches added to a group, this group will show the LIST_PACKED behavior. The same is done for
the LIST_ROWS_FIRST option with the substring rows.

Finally, if the value contains the string explanations, only the explanation strings, if any, will be listed
and if it contains messages, only the messages (added with the -x option of compadd) will be listed.
If it contains both explanations and messages both kinds of explanation strings will be listed. It will
be set appropriately on entry to a completion widget and may be changed there.

list_lines

This gives the number of lines that are needed to display the full list of completions. Note that to
calculate the total number of lines to display you need to add the number of lines needed for the
command line to this value, this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special parameter.

list_max
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 289 of 616
:
Initially this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parameter. It may be set to any other value; when the
widget exits this value will be used in the same way as the value of LISTMAX.

nmatches

The number of matches added by the completion code so far.

old_insert

On entry to the widget this will be set to the number of the match of an old list of completions that is
currently inserted into the command line. If no match has been inserted, this is unset.

As with old_list, the value of this key will only be used if it is the string keep. If it was set to this value
by the widget and there was an old match inserted into the command line, this match will be kept
and if the value of the insert key specifies that another match should be inserted, this will be
inserted after the old one.

old_list

This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of completions from a previous completion at the time the
widget is invoked. This will usually be the case if and only if the previous editing operation was a
completion widget or one of the builtin completion functions. If there is a valid list and it is also
currently shown on the screen, the value of this key is shown.

After the widget has exited the value of this key is only used if it was set to keep. In this case the
completion code will continue to use this old list. If the widget generated new matches, they will not
be used.

parameter

The name of the parameter when completing in a subscript or in the value of a parameter
assignment.

pattern_insert

Normally this is set to menu, which specifies that menu completion will be used whenever a set of
matches was generated using pattern_match (see below). If it is set to any other non-empty string by
the user and menu completion is not selected by other option settings, the code will instead insert
any common prefix for the generated matches as with normal completion.

pattern_match

Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE option. Initially it is set to ‘*’ if and only
if the option is set. The completion widget may set it to this value, to an empty string (which has the
same effect as unsetting it), or to any other non-empty string. If it is non-empty, unquoted
metacharacters on the command line will be treated as patterns; if it is ‘*’, then additionally a
wildcard ‘*’ is assumed at the cursor position; if it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated
literally.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 290 of 616
:
Note that the match specifications given to the compadd builtin command are not used if this is set
to a non-empty string.

quote

When completing inside quotes, this contains the quotation character (i.e. either a single quote, a
double quote, or a backtick). Otherwise it is unset.

quoting

When completing inside single quotes, this is set to the string single; inside double quotes, the string
double; inside backticks, the string backtick. Otherwise it is unset.

redirect

The redirection operator when completing in a redirection position, i.e. one of <, >, etc.

restore

This is set to auto before a function is entered, which forces the special parameters mentioned
above (words, CURRENT, PREFIX, IPREFIX, SUFFIX, and ISUFFIX) to be restored to their previous
values when the function exits. If a function unsets it or sets it to any other string, they will not be
restored.

to_end

Specifies the occasions on which the cursor is moved to the end of a string when a match is inserted.
On entry to a widget function, it may be single if this will happen when a single unambiguous match
was inserted or match if it will happen any time a match is inserted (for example, by menu
completion; this is likely to be the effect of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).

On exit, it may be set to single as above. It may also be set to always, or to the empty string or unset;
in those cases the cursor will be moved to the end of the string always or never respectively. Any
other string is treated as match.

unambiguous

This key is read-only and will always be set to the common (unambiguous) prefix the completion
code has generated for all matches added so far.

unambiguous_cursor

This gives the position the cursor would be placed at if the common prefix in the unambiguous key
were inserted, relative to the value of that key. The cursor would be placed before the character
whose index is given by this key.

unambiguous_positions

This contains all positions where characters in the unambiguous string are missing or where the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 291 of 616
:
character inserted differs from at least one of the matches. The positions are given as indexes into
the string given by the value of the unambiguous key.

vared

If completion is called while editing a line using the vared builtin, the value of this key is set to the
name of the parameter given as an argument to vared. This key is only set while a vared command
is active.

words

This array contains the words present on the command line currently being edited.

19.3 Completion Builtin Commands


compadd [ -akqQfenUl12C ] [ -F array ]

[-P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]

[-p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]

[-i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]

[-W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]

[-J group-name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]

[-V group-name ] [ -o [ order ] ]

[-r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]

[-D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]

[-E number ]

[-M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ completions ... ]

This builtin command can be used to add matches directly and control all the information the
completion code stores with each possible completion. The return status is zero if at least one
match was added and non-zero if no matches were added.

The completion code breaks each match into seven fields in the order:

<ipre><apre><hpre><body><hsuf><asuf><isuf>

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 292 of 616
:
The first field is an ignored prefix taken from the command line, the contents of the IPREFIX
parameter plus the string given with the -i option. With the -U option, only the string from the -i
option is used. The field <apre> is an optional prefix string given with the -P option. The <hpre>
field is a string that is considered part of the match but that should not be shown when listing
completions, given with the -p option; for example, functions that do filename generation might
specify a common path prefix this way. <body> is the part of the match that should appear in the
list of matches shown to the user. The suffixes <hsuf> , <asuf> and <isuf> correspond to the
prefixes <hpre> , <apre> and <ipre> and are given by the options -s, -S and -I, respectively.

The supported flags are:

-P prefix
This gives a string to be inserted before each match. The string given is not considered as part of the
match and any shell metacharacters in it will not be quoted when the string is inserted.

-S suffix
Like -P, but gives a string to be inserted after each match.

-p hidden-prefix
This gives a string that should be inserted before each match but that should not appear in the list
of matches. Unless the -U option is given, this string must be matched as part of the string on the
command line.

-s hidden-suffix
Like ‘-p’, but gives a string to insert after each match.

-i ignored-prefix
This gives a string to insert just before any string given with the ‘-P’ option. Without ‘-P’ the string is
inserted before the string given with ‘-p’ or directly before each match.

-I ignored-suffix
Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.

-a
With this flag the completions are taken as names of arrays and the actual completions are their
values. If only some elements of the arrays are needed, the completions may also contain
subscripts, as in ‘foo[2,-1]’.

-k
With this flag the completions are taken as names of associative arrays and the actual completions
are their keys. As for -a, the words may also contain subscripts, as in ‘foo[(R)*bar*]’.

-d array
This adds per-completion display strings. The array should contain one element per completion
given. The completion code will then display the first element instead of the first completion , and
so on. The array may be given as the name of an array parameter or directly as a space-separated
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 293 of 616
:
list of words in parentheses.

If there are fewer display strings than completions , the leftover completions will be displayed
unchanged and if there are more display strings than completions , the leftover display strings will
be silently ignored.

-l
This option only has an effect if used together with the -d option. If it is given, the display strings are
listed one per line, not arrayed in columns.

-o [ order ]
This controls the order in which matches are sorted. order is a comma-separated list comprising
the following possible values. These values can be abbreviated to their initial two or three
characters. Note that the order forms part of the group name space so matches with different
orderings will not be in the same group.

match
If given, the order of the output is determined by the match strings; otherwise it is determined by
the display strings (i.e. the strings given by the -d option). This is the default if ‘-o’ is specified but the
order argument is omitted.

nosort
This specifies that the completions are pre-sorted and their order should be preserved. This value
only makes sense alone and cannot be combined with any others.

numeric
If the matches include numbers, sort them numerically rather than lexicographically.

reverse
Arrange the matches backwards by reversing the sort ordering.

-J group-name
Gives the name of the group that the matches should be stored in.

-V group-name
Like -J but naming an unsorted group. This option is identical to the combination of -J and -o nosort.

-1
If given together with the -V option, makes only consecutive duplicates in the group be removed. If
combined with the -J option, this has no visible effect. Note that groups with and without this flag are
in different name spaces.

-2
If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates be kept. Again, groups with and
without this flag are in different name spaces.

-X explanation

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 294 of 616
:
The explanation string will be printed with the list of matches, above the group currently selected.

Within the explanation , the following sequences may be used to specify output attributes (see
Prompt Expansion): ‘%B’, ‘%S’, ‘%U’, ‘%F’, ‘%K’ and their lower case counterparts, as well as ‘%{...%}’.
‘%F’, ‘%K’ and ‘%{...%}’ take arguments in the same form as prompt expansion. (Note that the
sequence ‘%G’ is not available; an argument to ‘%{’ should be used instead.) The sequence ‘%%’
produces a literal ‘%’.

These sequences are most often employed by users when customising the format style (see
Completion System), but they must also be taken into account when writing completion functions, as
passing descriptions with unescaped ‘%’ characters to utility functions such as _arguments and
_message may produce unexpected results. If arbitrary text is to be passed in a description, it can be
escaped using e.g. ${my_str//\%/%%}.

-x message
Like -X, but the message will be printed even if there are no matches in the group.

-q
The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if the next character typed is a blank or does
not insert anything, or if the suffix consists of only one character and the next character typed is the
same character.

-r remove-chars
This is a more versatile form of the -q option. The suffix given with -S or the slash automatically
added after completing directories will be automatically removed if the next character typed inserts
one of the characters given in the remove-chars . This string is parsed as a characters class and
understands the backslash sequences used by the print command. For example, ‘-r "a-z\t"’ removes
the suffix if the next character typed inserts a lower case character or a TAB, and ‘-r "^0-9"’ removes
the suffix if the next character typed inserts anything but a digit. One extra backslash sequence is
understood in this string: ‘\-’ stands for all characters that insert nothing. Thus ‘-S "=" -q’ is the same
as ‘-S "=" -r "= \t\n\-"’.

This option may also be used without the -S option; then any automatically added space will be
removed when one of the characters in the list is typed.

-R remove-func
This is another form of the -r option. When a match has been accepted and a suffix has been
inserted, the function remove-func will be called after the next character typed. It is passed the
length of the suffix as an argument and can use the special parameters available in ordinary (non-
completion) zle widgets (see Zsh Line Editor) to analyse and modify the command line.

-f
If this flag is given, all of the matches built from the completions are marked as being the names of
files. They are not required to be actual filenames, but if they are, and the option LIST_TYPES is set,
the characters describing the types of the files in the completion lists will be shown. This also forces
a slash to be added when the name of a directory is completed.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 295 of 616
:
-e
This flag can be used to tell the completion code that the matches added are parameter names for a
parameter expansion. This will make the AUTO_PARAM_SLASH and AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be
used for the matches.

-W file-prefix
This string is a pathname that will be prepended to each match together with any prefix specified by
the -p option to form a complete filename for testing. Hence it is only useful if combined with the -f
flag, as the tests will not otherwise be performed.

-F array
Specifies an array containing patterns. completions that match one of these patterns are ignored,
that is, not considered to be matches.

The array may be the name of an array parameter or a list of literal patterns enclosed in
parentheses and quoted, as in ‘-F "(*?.o *?.h)"’. If the name of an array is given, the elements of the
array are taken as the patterns.

-Q
This flag instructs the completion code not to quote any metacharacters in the matches when
inserting them into the command line.

-M match-spec
This gives local match specifications as described below in Completion Matching Control. This option
may be given more than once. In this case all match-spec s given are concatenated with spaces
between them to form the specification string to use. Note that they will only be used if the -U
option is not given.

-n
Specifies that matching completions are to be added to the set of matches, but are not to be listed
to the user.

-U
If this flag is given, all completions are added to the set of matches and no matching will be done
by the completion code. Normally this is used in functions that do the matching themselves.

-O array
If this option is given, the completions are not added to the set of matches. Instead, matching is
done as usual and all of the completions that match will be stored in the array parameter whose
name is given as array .

-A array
As the -O option, except that instead of those of the completions which match being stored in
array , the strings generated internally by the completion code are stored. For example, with a
match specification of ‘-M "L:|no="’, a current word of ‘nof’ and completions of ‘foo’, this option

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 296 of 616
:
stores the string ‘nofoo’ in the array, whereas the -O option stores the ‘foo’ originally given.

-D array
As with -O, the completions are not added to the set of matches. Instead, whenever the n th
completion does not match, the n th element of the array is removed. Elements for which the
corresponding completion matches are retained. This option can be used more than once to
remove elements from multiple arrays.

-C
This option adds a special match which expands to all other matches when inserted into the line,
even those that are added after this option is used. Together with the -d option it is possible to
specify a string that should be displayed in the list for this special match. If no string is given, it will
be shown as a string containing the strings that would be inserted for the other matches, truncated
to the width of the screen.

-E number
This option adds number empty matches after matching completions have been added. An empty
match takes up space in completion listings but will never be inserted in the line and can’t be
selected with menu completion or menu selection. This makes empty matches only useful to format
completion lists and to make explanatory string be shown in completion lists (since empty matches
can be given display strings with the -d option). And because all but one empty string would
otherwise be removed, this option implies the -V and -2 options (even if an explicit -J option is given).
This can be important to note as it affects the name space into which matches are added.

-
This flag ends the list of flags and options. All arguments after it will be taken as the completions
even if they begin with hyphens.

Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than once, the first one (and its argument)
will be used.

compset -p number

compset -P [ number ] pattern

compset -s number

compset -S [ number ] pattern

compset -n begin [ end ]

compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 297 of 616
:
compset -q

This command simplifies modification of the special parameters, while its return status allows tests
on them to be carried out.

The options are:

-p number
If the value of the PREFIX parameter is at least number characters long, the first number characters
are removed from it and appended to the contents of the IPREFIX parameter.

-P [ number ] pattern
If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything that matches the pattern , the matched
portion is removed from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.

Without the optional number , the longest match is taken, but if number is given, anything up to the
number th match is moved. If the number is negative, the number th longest match is moved. For
example, if PREFIX contains the string ‘a=b=c’, then compset -P ’*\=’ will move the string ‘a=b=’ into
the IPREFIX parameter, but compset -P 1 ’*\=’ will move only the string ‘a=’.

-s number
As -p, but transfer the last number characters from the value of SUFFIX to the front of the value of
ISUFFIX.

-S [ number ] pattern
As -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and transfer the matched portion to the front of the value
of ISUFFIX.

-n begin [ end ]
If the current word position as specified by the parameter CURRENT is greater than or equal to
begin , anything up to the begin th word is removed from the words array and the value of the
parameter CURRENT is decremented by begin .

If the optional end is given, the modification is done only if the current word position is also less
than or equal to end . In this case, the words from position end onwards are also removed from the
words array.

Both begin and end may be negative to count backwards from the last element of the words array.

-N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
If one of the elements of the words array before the one at the index given by the value of the
parameter CURRENT matches the pattern beg-pat , all elements up to and including the matching
one are removed from the words array and the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the same
word in the changed array.

If the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and there is an element in the words array matching

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 298 of 616
:
this pattern, the parameters are modified only if the index of this word is higher than the one given
by the CURRENT parameter (so that the matching word has to be after the cursor). In this case, the
words starting with the one matching end-pat are also removed from the words array. If words
contains no word matching end-pat , the testing and modification is performed as if it were not
given.

-q
The word currently being completed is split on spaces into separate words, respecting the usual
shell quoting conventions. The resulting words are stored in the words array, and CURRENT, PREFIX,
SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and QISUFFIX are modified to reflect the word part that is completed.

In all the above cases the return status is zero if the test succeeded and the parameters were
modified and non-zero otherwise. This allows one to use this builtin in tests such as:

if compset -P '*\='; then ...

This forces anything up to and including the last equal sign to be ignored by the completion code.

compcall [ -TD ]

This allows the use of completions defined with the compctl builtin from within completion widgets.
The list of matches will be generated as if one of the non-widget completion functions (complete-
word, etc.) had been called, except that only compctls given for specific commands are used. To
force the code to try completions defined with the -T option of compctl and/or the default
completion (whether defined by compctl -D or the builtin default) in the appropriate places, the -T
and/or -D flags can be passed to compcall.

The return status can be used to test if a matching compctl definition was found. It is non-zero if a
compctl was found and zero otherwise.

Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.

19.4 Completion Condition Codes


The following additional condition codes for use within the [[ ... ]] construct are available in
completion widgets. These work on the special parameters. All of these tests can also be performed
by the compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the contents of the special parameters
are not modified.

-prefix [ number ] pattern


true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.

-suffix [ number ] pattern

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 299 of 616
:
true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.

-after beg-pat
true if the test of the -N option with only the beg-pat given would succeed.

-between beg-pat end-pat


true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would succeed.

19.5 Completion Matching Control


When the user invokes completion, the current word on the command line (that is, the word the
cursor is currently on) is used to generate a match pattern. Only those completions that match the
pattern are offered to the user as matches.

The default match pattern is generated from the current word by either

appending a ‘*’ (matching any number of characters in a completion) or,


if the shell option COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, inserting a ‘*’ at the cursor position.

This narrow pattern can be broadened selectively by passing a match specification to the compadd
builtin command through its -M option (see Completion Builtin Commands). A match specification
consists of one or more matchers separated by whitespace. Matchers in a match specification are
applied one at a time, from left to right. Once all matchers have been applied, completions are
compared to the final match pattern and non-matching ones are discarded.

Note that the -M option is ignored if the current word contains a glob pattern and the shell
option GLOB_COMPLETE is set or if the pattern_match key of the special associative array
compstate is set to a non-empty value (see Completion Special Parameters).
Users of the Completion System should generally not use the -M option directly, but rather use
the matcher-list and matcher styles (see the subsection Standard Styles in Completion System
Configuration).

Each matcher consists of

a case-sensitive letter
a ‘:’,
one or more patterns separated by pipes (‘|’),
an equals sign (‘=’), and
another pattern.

The patterns before the ‘=’ are used to match substrings of the current word. For each matched
substring, the corresponding part of the match pattern is broadened with the pattern after the ‘=’, by
means of a logical OR.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 300 of 616
:
Each pattern in a matcher cosists of either

the empty string or


a sequence of
literal characters (which may be quoted with a ‘\’),
question marks (‘?’),
bracket expressions (‘[...]’; see the subsection Glob Operators in Filename Generation),
and/or
brace expressions (see below).

Other shell patterns are not allowed.

A brace expression, like a bracket expression, consists of a list of

literal characters,
ranges (‘0-9’), and/or
character classes (‘[: name :]’).

However, they differ from each other as follows:

A brace expression is delimited by a pair of braces (‘{...}’).


Brace expressions do not support negations. That is, an initial ‘!’ or ‘^’ has no special meaning
and will be interpreted as a literal character.
When a character in the current word matches the n th pattern in a brace expression, the
corresponding part of the match pattern is broadened only with the n th pattern of the brace
expression on the other side of the ‘=’, if there is one; if there is no brace expression on the
other side, then this pattern is the empty string. However, if either brace expression has more
elements than the other, then the excess entries are simply ignored. When comparing indexes,
each literal character or character class counts as one element, but each range is instead
expanded to the full list of literal characters it represents. Additionally, if on both sides of the
‘=’, the n th pattern is ‘[:upper:]’ or ‘[:lower:]’, then these are expanded as ranges, too.

Note that, although the matching system does not yet handle multibyte characters, this is likely to be
a future extension. Hence, using ‘[:upper:]’ and ‘[:lower:]’ is recommended over ‘A-Z’ and ‘a-z’.

Below are the different forms of matchers supported. Each uppercase form behaves exactly like its
lowercase counterpart, but adds an additional step after the match pattern has filtered out non-
matching completions: Each of a match’s substrings that was matched by a subpattern from an
uppercase matcher is replaced with the corresponding substring of the current word. However,
patterns from lowercase matchers have higher weight: If a substring of the current word was
matched by patterns from both a lowercase and an uppercase matcher, then the lowercase
matcher’s pattern wins and the corresponding part of the match is not modified.

Unless indicated otherwise, each example listed assumes COMPLETE_IN_WORD to be unset (as it is
by default).

m: word-pat = match-pat
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 301 of 616
:
M: word-pat = match-pat
For each substring of the current word that matches word-pat , broaden the corresponding part of
the match pattern to additionally match match-pat .

Examples:
m:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]} lets any lower case character in the current word be completed to itself or
its uppercase counterpart. So, the completions ‘foo’, ‘FOO’ and ‘Foo’ will are be considered matches
for the word ‘fo’.

M:_= inserts every underscore from the current word into each match, in the same relative position,
determined by matching the substrings around it. So, given a completion ‘foo’, the word ‘f_o’ will be
completed to the match ‘f_oo’, even though the latter was not present as a completion.

b: word-pat = match-pat
B: word-pat = match-pat
e: word-pat = match-pat
E: word-pat = match-pat
For each consecutive substring at the b:eginning or e:nd of the current word that matches word-
pat , broaden the corresponding part of the match pattern to additionally match match-pat .

Examples:
‘b:-=+’ lets any number of minuses at the start of the current word be completed to a minus or a
plus.

‘B:0=’ adds all zeroes at the beginning of the current word to the beginning of each match.

l:| word-pat = match-pat


L:| word-pat = match-pat
R: word-pat |= match-pat
r: word-pat |= match-pat
If there is a substring at the l:eft or r:ight edge of the current word that matches word-pat , then
broaden the corresponding part of the match pattern to additionally match match-pat .

For each l:, L:, r: and R: matcher (including the ones below), the pattern match-pat may also be a ‘*’.
This matches any number of characters in a completion.

Examples:
‘r:|=*’ appends a ‘*’ to the match pattern, even when COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set and the cursor is
not at the end of the current word.

If the current word starts with a minus, then ‘L:|-=’ will prepend it to each match.

l: anchor | word-pat = match-pat


L: anchor | word-pat = match-pat
r: word-pat | anchor = match-pat

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 302 of 616
:
R: word-pat | anchor = match-pat
For each substring of the current word that matches word-pat and has on its l:eft or r:ight another
substring matching anchor , broaden the corresponding part of the match pattern to additionally
match match-pat .

Note that these matchers (and the ones below) modify only what is matched by word-pat ; they do
not change the matching behavior of what is matched by anchor (or coanchor ; see the matchers
below). Thus, unless its corresponding part of the match pattern has been modified, the anchor in
the current word has to match literally in each completion, just like any other substring of the
current word.

If a matcher includes at least one anchor (which includes the matchers with two anchors, below),
then match-pat may also be ‘*’ or ‘**’. ‘*’ can match any part of a completion that does not contain
any substrings matching anchor , whereas a ‘**’ can match any part of a completion, period. (Note
that this is different from the behavior of ‘*’ in the anchorless forms of ‘l:’ and ‘r:’ and and also
different from ‘*’ and ‘**’ in glob expressions.)

Examples:
‘r:|.=*’ makes the completion ‘comp.sources.unix’ a match for the word ‘..u’ — but not for the word
‘.u’.

Given a completion ‘--foo’, the matcher ‘L:–|no-=’ will complete the word ‘--no-’ to the match ‘--no-
foo’.

l: anchor || coanchor = match-pat


L: anchor || coanchor = match-pat
r: coanchor || anchor = match-pat
R: coanchor || anchor = match-pat
For any two consecutive substrings of the current word that match anchor and coanchor , in the
order given, insert the pattern match-pat between their corresponding parts in the match pattern.

Note that, unlike anchor , the pattern coanchor does not change what ‘*’ can match.

Examples:
‘r:?||[[:upper:]]=*’ will complete the current word ‘fB’ to ‘fooBar’, but it will not complete it to
‘fooHooBar’ (because ‘*’ here cannot match anything that includes a match for ‘[[:upper:]]), nor will it
complete ‘B’ to ‘fooBar’ (because there is no character in the current word to match coanchor ).

Given the current word ‘pass.n’ and a completion ‘pass.byname’, the matcher ‘L:.||[[:alpha:]]=by’ will
produce the match ‘pass.name’.

x:
Ignore this matcher and all matchers to its right.

This matcher is used to mark the end of a match specification. In a single standalone list of
matchers, this has no use, but where match specifications are concatenated, as is often the case
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 303 of 616
:
when using the Completion System, it can allow one match specification to override another.

19.6 Completion Widget Example


The first step is to define the widget:

zle -C complete complete-word complete-files

Then the widget can be bound to a key using the bindkey builtin command:

bindkey '^X\t' complete

After that the shell function complete-files will be invoked after typing control-X and TAB. The
function should then generate the matches, e.g.:

complete-files () { compadd - * }

This function will complete files in the current directory matching the current word.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 304 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

20 Completion System
20.1 Description
20.2 Initialization
20.2.1 Use of compinit
20.2.2 Autoloaded files
20.2.3 Functions
20.3 Completion System Configuration
20.3.1 Overview
20.3.2 Standard Tags
20.3.3 Standard Styles
20.4 Control Functions
20.5 Bindable Commands
20.6 Utility Functions
20.7 Completion System Variables
20.8 Completion Directories

20 Completion System

20.1 Description
This describes the shell code for the ‘new’ completion system, referred to as compsys. It is written in
shell functions based on the features described in the previous chapter, Completion Widgets.

The features are contextual, sensitive to the point at which completion is started. Many completions
are already provided. For this reason, a user can perform a great many tasks without knowing any
details beyond how to initialize the system, which is described in Initialization.

The context that decides what completion is to be performed may be

an argument or option position: these describe the position on the command line at which
completion is requested. For example ‘first argument to rmdir, the word being completed
names a directory’;
a special context, denoting an element in the shell’s syntax. For example ‘a word in command
position’ or ‘an array subscript’.

A full context specification contains other elements, as we shall describe.

Besides commands names and contexts, the system employs two more concepts, styles and tags.
These provide ways for the user to configure the system’s behaviour.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 305 of 616
:
Tags play a dual role. They serve as a classification system for the matches, typically indicating a
class of object that the user may need to distinguish. For example, when completing arguments of
the ls command the user may prefer to try files before directories, so both of these are tags. They
also appear as the rightmost element in a context specification.

Styles modify various operations of the completion system, such as output formatting, but also what
kinds of completers are used (and in what order), or which tags are examined. Styles may accept
arguments and are manipulated using the zstyle command described in The zsh/zutil Module.

In summary, tags describe what the completion objects are, and style how they are to be completed.
At various points of execution, the completion system checks what styles and/or tags are defined for
the current context, and uses that to modify its behavior. The full description of context handling,
which determines how tags and other elements of the context influence the behaviour of styles, is
described in Completion System Configuration.

When a completion is requested, a dispatcher function is called; see the description of


_main_complete in the list of control functions below. This dispatcher decides which function should
be called to produce the completions, and calls it. The result is passed to one or more completers,
functions that implement individual completion strategies: simple completion, error correction,
completion with error correction, menu selection, etc.

More generally, the shell functions contained in the completion system are of two types:

those beginning ‘comp’ are to be called directly; there are only a few of these;
those beginning ‘_’ are called by the completion code. The shell functions of this set, which
implement completion behaviour and may be bound to keystrokes, are referred to as ‘widgets’.
These proliferate as new completions are required.

20.2 Initialization
If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to call the shell function compinit from
your initialization file; see the next section. However, the function compinstall can be run by a user
to configure various aspects of the completion system.

Usually, compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if file’s location. Note that it is up to you to
make sure that the lines added to .zshrc are actually run; you may, for example, need to move them
to an earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early. So long as you keep them all together
(including the comment lines at the start and finish), you can rerun compinstall and it will correctly
locate and modify these lines. Note, however, that any code you add to this section by hand is likely
to be lost if you rerun compinstall, although lines using the command ‘zstyle’ should be gracefully
handled.

The new code will take effect next time you start the shell, or run .zshrc by hand; there is also an

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 306 of 616
:
option to make them take effect immediately. However, if compinstall has removed definitions, you
will need to restart the shell to see the changes.

To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory mentioned in your fpath parameter,
which should already be the case if zsh was properly configured as long as your startup files do not
remove the appropriate directories from fpath. Then it must be autoloaded (‘autoload -U
compinstall’ is recommended). You can abort the installation any time you are being prompted for
information, and your .zshrc will not be altered at all; changes only take place right at the end, where
you are specifically asked for confirmation.

20.2.1 Use of compinit

This section describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for the current session when
called directly; if you have run compinstall it will be called automatically from your .zshrc.

To initialize the system, the function compinit should be in a directory mentioned in the fpath
parameter, and should be autoloaded (‘autoload -U compinit’ is recommended), and then run simply
as ‘compinit’. This will define a few utility functions, arrange for all the necessary shell functions to be
autoloaded, and will then re-define all widgets that do completion to use the new system. If you use
the menu-select widget, which is part of the zsh/complist module, you should make sure that that
module is loaded before the call to compinit so that that widget is also re-defined. If completion
styles (see below) are set up to perform expansion as well as completion by default, and the TAB key
is bound to expand-or-complete, compinit will rebind it to complete-word; this is necessary to use
the correct form of expansion.

Should you need to use the original completion commands, you can still bind keys to the old widgets
by putting a ‘.’ in front of the widget name, e.g. ‘.expand-or-complete’.

To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped configuration that will be
read in on future invocations; this is the default, but can be turned off by calling compinit with the
option -D. The dumped file is .zcompdump in the same directory as the startup files (i.e. $ZDOTDIR
or $HOME); alternatively, an explicit file name can be given by ‘compinit -d dumpfile ’. The next
invocation of compinit will read the dumped file instead of performing a full initialization.

If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this and produce a new dump file.
However, if the name of a function or the arguments in the first line of a #compdef function (as
described below) change, it is easiest to delete the dump file by hand so that compinit will re-create
it the next time it is run. The check performed to see if there are new functions can be omitted by
giving the option -C. In this case the dump file will only be created if there isn’t one already.

The dumping is actually done by another function, compdump, but you will only need to run this
yourself if you change the configuration (e.g. using compdef) and then want to dump the new one.
The name of the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 307 of 616
:
If the parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where completion functions can be
found; this is only necessary if they are not already in the function search path.

For security reasons compinit also checks if the completion system would use files not owned by
root or by the current user, or files in root or by the current user. If such files or directories are
found, compinit will ask if the completion system should really be used. To avoid these tests and
make all files found be used without asking, use the option -u, and to make compinit silently ignore
all insecure files and directories use the option -i. This security check is skipped entirely when the -C
option is given, provided the dumpfile exists.

The security check can be retried at any time by running the function compaudit. This is the same
check used by compinit, but when it is executed directly any changes to fpath are made local to the
function so they do not persist. The directories to be checked may be passed as arguments; if none
are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find completion system directories, adding missing
ones to fpath as necessary. To force a check of exactly the directories currently named in fpath, set
_compdir to an empty string before calling compaudit or compinit.

The function bashcompinit provides compatibility with bash’s programmable completion system.
When run it will define the functions, compgen and complete which correspond to the bash builtins
with the same names. It will then be possible to use completion specifications and functions written
for bash.

20.2.2 Autoloaded files

The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is that they start with an underscore;
as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parameter must contain the directory in which they are
stored. If zsh was properly installed on your system, then fpath/FPATH automatically contains the
required directories for the standard functions.

For incomplete installations, if compinit does not find enough files beginning with an underscore
(fewer than twenty) in the search path, it will try to find more by adding the directory _compdir to
the search path. If that directory has a subdirectory named Base, all subdirectories will be added to
the path. Furthermore, if the subdirectory Base has a subdirectory named Core, compinit will add all
subdirectories of the subdirectories to the path: this allows the functions to be in the same format
as in the zsh source distribution.

When compinit is run, it searches all such files accessible via fpath/FPATH and reads the first line of
each of them. This line should contain one of the tags described below. Files whose first line does
not start with one of these tags are not considered to be part of the completion system and will not
be treated specially.

The tags are:

#compdef name ... [ -{p|P} pattern ... [ -N name ... ] ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 308 of 616
:
The file will be made autoloadable and the function defined in it will be called when completing
name s, each of which is either the name of a command whose arguments are to be completed or
one of a number of special contexts in the form - context - described below.

Each name may also be of the form ‘ cmd = service ’. When completing the command cmd , the
function typically behaves as if the command (or special context) service was being completed
instead. This provides a way of altering the behaviour of functions that can perform many different
completions. It is implemented by setting the parameter $service when calling the function; the
function may choose to interpret this how it wishes, and simpler functions will probably ignore it.

If the #compdef line contains one of the options -p or -P, the words following are taken to be
patterns. The function will be called when completion is attempted for a command or context that
matches one of the patterns. The options -p and -P are used to specify patterns to be tried before or
after other completions respectively. Hence -P may be used to specify default actions.

The option -N is used after a list following -p or -P; it specifies that remaining words no longer define
patterns. It is possible to toggle between the three options as many times as necessary.

#compdef -k style key-sequence ...


This option creates a widget behaving like the builtin widget style and binds it to the given key-
sequence s, if any. The style must be one of the builtin widgets that perform completion, namely
complete-word, delete-char-or-list, expand-or-complete, expand-or-complete-prefix, list-choices,
menu-complete, menu-expand-or-complete, or reverse-menu-complete. If the zsh/complist module
is loaded (see The zsh/complist Module) the widget menu-select is also available.

When one of the key-sequence s is typed, the function in the file will be invoked to generate the
matches. Note that a key will not be re-bound if it already was (that is, was bound to something
other than undefined-key). The widget created has the same name as the file and can be bound to
any other keys using bindkey as usual.

#compdef -K widget-name style key-sequence [ name style seq ... ]


This is similar to -k except that only one key-sequence argument may be given for each widget-
name style pair. However, the entire set of three arguments may be repeated with a different set
of arguments. Note in particular that the widget-name must be distinct in each set. If it does not
begin with ‘_’ this will be added. The widget-name should not clash with the name of any existing
widget: names based on the name of the function are most useful. For example,

#compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \


_foo_list list-choices "^X^D"

(all on one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion, bound to ‘^X^C’, and a widget
_foo_list for listing, bound to ‘^X^D’.

#autoload [ options ]
Functions with the #autoload tag are marked for autoloading but are not otherwise treated

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 309 of 616
:
specially. Typically they are to be called from within one of the completion functions. Any options
supplied will be passed to the autoload builtin; a typical use is +X to force the function to be loaded
immediately. Note that the -U and -z flags are always added implicitly.

The # is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed after it. The #compdef tags use the
compdef function described below; the main difference is that the name of the function is supplied
implicitly.

The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:

-array-value-

The right hand side of an array-assignment (‘ name =( ... )’)

-assign-parameter-

The name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left hand side of an ‘=’

-brace-parameter-

The name of a parameter expansion within braces (‘${ ... }’)

-command-

A word in command position

-condition-

A word inside a condition (‘[[ ... ]]’)

-default-

Any word for which no other completion is defined

-equal-

A word beginning with an equals sign

-first-

This is tried before any other completion function. The function called may set the _compskip
parameter to one of various values: all: no further completion is attempted; a string containing the
substring patterns: no pattern completion functions will be called; a string containing default: the
function for the ‘-default-’ context will not be called, but functions defined for commands will be.

-math-

Inside mathematical contexts, such as ‘(( ... ))’

-parameter-

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 310 of 616
:
The name of a parameter expansion (‘$ ... ’)

-redirect-

The word after a redirection operator.

-subscript-

The contents of a parameter subscript.

-tilde-

After an initial tilde (‘~’), but before the first slash in the word.

-value-

On the right hand side of an assignment.

Default implementations are supplied for each of these contexts. In most cases the context -
context - is implemented by a corresponding function _ context , for example the context ‘-tilde-’
and the function ‘_tilde’).

The contexts -redirect- and -value- allow extra context-specific information. (Internally, this is
handled by the functions for each context calling the function _dispatch.) The extra information is
added separated by commas.

For the -redirect- context, the extra information is in the form ‘-redirect-, op , command ’, where op is
the redirection operator and command is the name of the command on the line. If there is no
command on the line yet, the command field will be empty.

For the -value- context, the form is ‘-value-, name , command ’, where name is the name of the
parameter on the left hand side of the assignment. In the case of elements of an associative array,
for example ‘assoc=(key <TAB>’, name is expanded to ‘ name - key ’. In certain special contexts, such
as completing after ‘make CFLAGS=’, the command part gives the name of the command, here make;
otherwise it is empty.

It is not necessary to define fully specific completions as the functions provided will try to generate
completions by progressively replacing the elements with ‘-default-’. For example, when completing
after ‘foo=<TAB>’, _value will try the names ‘-value-,foo,’ (note the empty command part), ‘-value-,foo,-
default-’ and‘-value-,-default-,-default-’, in that order, until it finds a function to handle the context.

As an example:

compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'

completes files matching ‘*.log’ after ‘2> <TAB>’ for any command with no more specific handler
defined.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 311 of 616
:
Also:

compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-

specifies that _foo provides completions for the values of parameters for which no special function
has been defined. This is usually handled by the function _value itself.

The same lookup rules are used when looking up styles (as described below); for example

zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'

is another way to make completion after ‘2> <TAB>’ complete files matching ‘*.log’.

20.2.3 Functions

The following function is defined by compinit and may be called directly.

compdef [ -ane ] function name ... [ -{p|P} pattern ... [ -N name ...]]
compdef -d name ...
compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequence [ key-sequence ... ]
compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-seq [ name style seq ... ]
The first form defines the function to call for completion in the given contexts as described for the
#compdef tag above.

Alternatively, all the arguments may have the form ‘ cmd = service ’. Here service should already
have been defined by ‘ cmd1 = service ’ lines in #compdef files, as described above. The argument
for cmd will be completed in the same way as service .

The function argument may alternatively be a string containing almost any shell code. If the string
contains an equal sign, the above will take precedence. The option -e may be used to specify the first
argument is to be evaluated as shell code even if it contains an equal sign. The string will be
executed using the eval builtin command to generate completions. This provides a way of avoiding
having to define a new completion function. For example, to complete files ending in ‘.h’ as
arguments to the command foo:

compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo

The option -n prevents any completions already defined for the command or context from being
overwritten.

The option -d deletes any completion defined for the command or contexts listed.

The name s may also contain -p, -P and -N options as described for the #compdef tag. The effect on

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 312 of 616
:
the argument list is identical, switching between definitions of patterns tried initially, patterns tried
finally, and normal commands and contexts.

The parameter $_compskip may be set by any function defined for a pattern context. If it is set to a
value containing the substring ‘patterns’ none of the pattern-functions will be called; if it is set to a
value containing the substring ‘all’, no other function will be called. Setting $_compskip in this
manner is of particular utility when using the -p option, as otherwise the dispatcher will move on to
additional functions (likely the default one) after calling the pattern-context one, which can mangle
the display of completion possibilities if not handled properly.

The form with -k defines a widget with the same name as the function that will be called for each
of the key-sequence s; this is like the #compdef -k tag. The function should generate the
completions needed and will otherwise behave like the builtin widget whose name is given as the
style argument. The widgets usable for this are: complete-word, delete-char-or-list, expand-or-
complete, expand-or-complete-prefix, list-choices, menu-complete, menu-expand-or-complete, and
reverse-menu-complete, as well as menu-select if the zsh/complist module is loaded. The option -n
prevents the key being bound if it is already to bound to something other than undefined-key.

The form with -K is similar and defines multiple widgets based on the same function , each of which
requires the set of three arguments name , style and key-seq uence, where the latter two are as
for -k and the first must be a unique widget name beginning with an underscore.

Wherever applicable, the -a option makes the function autoloadable, equivalent to autoload -U
function .

The function compdef can be used to associate existing completion functions with new commands.
For example,

compdef _pids foo

uses the function _pids to complete process IDs for the command foo.

Note also the _gnu_generic function described below, which can be used to complete options for
commands that understand the ‘--help’ option.

20.3 Completion System Configuration


This section gives a short overview of how the completion system works, and then more detail on
how users can configure how and when matches are generated.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 313 of 616
:
20.3.1 Overview

When completion is attempted somewhere on the command line the completion system begins
building the context. The context represents everything that the shell knows about the meaning of
the command line and the significance of the cursor position. This takes account of a number of
things including the command word (such as ‘grep’ or ‘zsh’) and options to which the current word
may be an argument (such as the ‘-o’ option to zsh which takes a shell option as an argument).

The context starts out very generic ("we are beginning a completion") and becomes more specific as
more is learned ("the current word is in a position that is usually a command name" or "the current
word might be a variable name" and so on). Therefore the context will vary during the same call to
the completion system.

This context information is condensed into a string consisting of multiple fields separated by colons,
referred to simply as ‘the context’ in the remainder of the documentation. Note that a user of the
completion system rarely needs to compose a context string, unless for example a new function is
being written to perform completion for a new command. What a user may need to do is compose a
style pattern, which is matched against a context when needed to look up context-sensitive options
that configure the completion system.

The next few paragraphs explain how a context is composed within the completion function suite.
Following that is discussion of how styles are defined. Styles determine such things as how the
matches are generated, similarly to shell options but with much more control. They are defined with
the zstyle builtin command (The zsh/zutil Module).

The context string always consists of a fixed set of fields, separated by colons and with a leading
colon before the first. Fields which are not yet known are left empty, but the surrounding colons
appear anyway. The fields are always in the order
:completion: function : completer : command : argument : tag . These have the following meaning:

The literal string completion, saying that this style is used by the completion system. This
distinguishes the context from those used by, for example, zle widgets and ZFTP functions.
The function , if completion is called from a named widget rather than through the normal
completion system. Typically this is blank, but it is set by special widgets such as predict-on and
the various functions in the Widget directory of the distribution to the name of that function,
often in an abbreviated form.
The completer currently active, the name of the function without the leading underscore and
with other underscores converted to hyphens. A ‘completer’ is in overall control of how
completion is to be performed; ‘complete’ is the simplest, but other completers exist to
perform related tasks such as correction, or to modify the behaviour of a later completer. See
Control Functions for more information.
The command or a special - context -, just at it appears following the #compdef tag or the
compdef function. Completion functions for commands that have sub-commands usually
modify this field to contain the name of the command followed by a minus sign and the sub-
command. For example, the completion function for the cvs command sets this field to cvs-add

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 314 of 616
:
when completing arguments to the add subcommand.
The argument ; this indicates which command line or option argument we are completing. For
command arguments this generally takes the form argument- n , where n is the number of the
argument, and for arguments to options the form option- opt - n where n is the number of
the argument to option opt . However, this is only the case if the command line is parsed with
standard UNIX-style options and arguments, so many completions do not set this.
The tag . As described previously, tags are used to discriminate between the types of matches
a completion function can generate in a certain context. Any completion function may use any
tag name it likes, but a list of the more common ones is given below.

The context is gradually put together as the functions are executed, starting with the main entry
point, which adds :completion: and the function element if necessary. The completer then adds
the completer element. The contextual completion adds the command and argument options.
Finally, the tag is added when the types of completion are known. For example, the context name

:completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files

says that normal completion was attempted as the first argument to the option -o of the command
dvips:

dvips -o ...

and the completion function will generate filenames.

Usually completion will be tried for all possible tags in an order given by the completion function.
However, this can be altered by using the tag-order style. Completion is then restricted to the list of
given tags in the given order.

The _complete_help bindable command shows all the contexts and tags available for completion at
a particular point. This provides an easy way of finding information for tag-order and other styles. It
is described in Bindable Commands.

When looking up styles the completion system uses full context names, including the tag. Looking up
the value of a style therefore consists of two things: the context, which is matched to the most
specific (best fitting) pattern, and the name of the style itself, which must be matched exactly. The
following examples demonstrate that patterns may be loosely defined for styles that apply broadly,
or as tightly defined as desired for styles that apply in narrower circumstances.

For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple and a verbose form and
use the verbose style to decide which form should be used. To make all such functions use the
verbose form, put

zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes

in a startup file (probably .zshrc). This gives the verbose style the value yes in every context inside
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 315 of 616
:
the completion system, unless that context has a more specific definition. It is best to avoid giving
the pattern as ‘*’ in case the style has some meaning outside the completion system.

Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using the compinstall function.

A more specific example of the use of the verbose style is by the completion for the kill builtin. If the
style is set, the builtin lists full job texts and process command lines; otherwise it shows the bare job
numbers and PIDs. To turn the style off for this use only:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:*' verbose no

For even more control, the style can use one of the tags ‘jobs’ or ‘processes’. To turn off verbose
display only for jobs:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no

The -e option to zstyle even allows completion function code to appear as the argument to a style;
this requires some understanding of the internals of completion functions (see Completion
Widgets)). For example,

zstyle -e ':completion:*' hosts 'reply=($myhosts)'

This forces the value of the hosts style to be read from the variable myhosts each time a host name
is needed; this is useful if the value of myhosts can change dynamically. For another useful example,
see the example in the description of the file-list style below. This form can be slow and should be
avoided for commonly examined styles such as menu and list-rows-first.

Note that the order in which styles are defined does not matter; the style mechanism uses the most
specific possible match for a particular style to determine the set of values. Strings are preferred
over patterns (for example, ‘:completion::complete:::foo’ is more specific than
‘:completion::complete:::*’), and longer patterns are preferred over the pattern ‘*’. See The zsh/zutil
Module for details.

Context patterns that use something other than a wildcard (*) to match the middle parts of the
context — the completer , command , and argument in
:completion: function : completer : command : argument : tag — should include all six colons (:)
explicitly. Without this, a pattern such as :completion:*:foo:* could match foo against a component
other than the intended one (for example, against completer when a match against command was
intended).

Style names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the completion function. However, the
following two sections list some of the most common tags and styles.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 316 of 616
:
20.3.2 Standard Tags

Some of the following are only used when looking up particular styles and do not refer to a type of
match.

accounts

used to look up the users-hosts style

all-expansions

used by the _expand completer when adding the single string containing all possible expansions

all-files

for the names of all files (as distinct from a particular subset, see the globbed-files tag).

arguments

for arguments to a command

arrays

for names of array parameters

association-keys

for keys of associative arrays; used when completing inside a subscript to a parameter of this type

bookmarks

when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the zftp function suite)

builtins

for names of builtin commands

characters

for single characters in arguments of commands such as stty. Also used when completing character
classes after an opening bracket

colormapids

for X colormap ids

colors

for color names

commands

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 317 of 616
:
for names of external commands. Also used by complex commands such as cvs when completing
names subcommands.

contexts

for contexts in arguments to the zstyle builtin command

corrections

used by the _approximate and _correct completers for possible corrections

cursors

for cursor names used by X programs

default

used in some contexts to provide a way of supplying a default when more specific tags are also
valid. Note that this tag is used when only the function field of the context name is set

descriptions

used when looking up the value of the format style to generate descriptions for types of matches

devices

for names of device special files

directories

for names of directories — local-directories is used instead when completing arguments of cd and
related builtin commands when the cdpath array is set

directory-stack

for entries in the directory stack

displays

for X display names

domains

for network domains

email- plugin

for email addresses from the ‘_email- plugin ’ backend of _email_addresses

expansions

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 318 of 616
:
used by the _expand completer for individual words (as opposed to the complete set of expansions)
resulting from the expansion of a word on the command line

extensions

for X server extensions

file-descriptors

for numbers of open file descriptors

files

the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing filenames

fonts

for X font names

fstypes

for file system types (e.g. for the mount command)

functions

names of functions — normally shell functions, although certain commands may understand other
kinds of function

globbed-files

for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern matching

groups

for names of user groups

history-words

for words from the history

hosts

for hostnames

indexes

for array indexes

interfaces

for network interfaces

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 319 of 616
:
jobs

for jobs (as listed by the ‘jobs’ builtin)

keymaps

for names of zsh keymaps

keysyms

for names of X keysyms

libraries

for names of system libraries

limits

for system limits

local-directories

for names of directories that are subdirectories of the current working directory when completing
arguments of cd and related builtin commands (compare path-directories) — when the cdpath array
is unset, directories is used instead

mailboxes

for e-mail folders

manuals

for names of manual pages

maps

for map names (e.g. NIS maps)

messages

used to look up the format style for messages

modifiers

for names of X modifiers

modules

for modules (e.g. zsh modules)

my-accounts

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 320 of 616
:
used to look up the users-hosts style

named-directories

for named directories (you wouldn’t have guessed that, would you?)

names

for all kinds of names

newsgroups

for USENET groups

nicknames

for nicknames of NIS maps

options

for command options

original

used by the _approximate, _correct and _expand completers when offering the original string as a
match

other-accounts

used to look up the users-hosts style

packages

for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)

parameters

for names of parameters

path-directories

for names of directories found by searching the cdpath array when completing arguments of cd and
related builtin commands (compare local-directories)

paths

used to look up the values of the expand, ambiguous and special-dirs styles

pods

for perl pods (documentation files)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 321 of 616
:
ports

for communication ports

prefixes

for prefixes (like those of a URL)

printers

for print queue names

processes

for process identifiers

processes-names

used to look up the command style when generating the names of processes for killall

sequences

for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)

sessions

for sessions in the zftp function suite

signals

for signal names

strings

for strings (e.g. the replacement strings for the cd builtin command)

styles

for styles used by the zstyle builtin command

suffixes

for filename extensions

tags

for tags (e.g. rpm tags)

targets

for makefile targets

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 322 of 616
:
time-zones

for time zones (e.g. when setting the TZ parameter)

types

for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)

urls

used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs

users

for usernames

values

for one of a set of values in certain lists

variant

used by _pick_variant to look up the command to run when determining what program is installed
for a particular command name.

visuals

for X visuals

warnings

used to look up the format style for warnings

widgets

for zsh widget names

windows

for IDs of X windows

zsh-options

for shell options

20.3.3 Standard Styles

Note that the values of several of these styles represent boolean values. Any of the strings ‘true’, ‘on’,
‘yes’, and ‘1’ can be used for the value ‘true’ and any of the strings ‘false’, ‘off’, ‘no’, and ‘0’ for the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 323 of 616
:
value ‘false’. The behavior for any other value is undefined except where explicitly mentioned. The
default value may be either ‘true’ or ‘false’ if the style is not set.

Some of these styles are tested first for every possible tag corresponding to a type of match, and if
no style was found, for the list-colors and styles controlling completion listing such as list-packed
and last-prompt. When tested for the default tag, only the function field of the context will be set
so that a style using the default tag will normally be defined along the lines of:

zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...

accept-exact

This is tested for the default tag in addition to the tags valid for the current context. If it is set to
‘true’ and any of the trial matches is the same as the string on the command line, this match will
immediately be accepted (even if it would otherwise be considered ambiguous).

When completing pathnames (where the tag used is ‘paths’) this style accepts any number of
patterns as the value in addition to the boolean values. Pathnames matching one of these patterns
will be accepted immediately even if the command line contains some more partially typed
pathname components and these match no file under the directory accepted.

This style is also used by the _expand completer to decide if words beginning with a tilde or
parameter expansion should be expanded. For example, if there are parameters foo and foobar, the
string ‘$foo’ will only be expanded if accept-exact is set to ‘true’; otherwise the completion system
will be allowed to complete $foo to $foobar. If the style is set to ‘continue’, _expand will add the
expansion as a match and the completion system will also be allowed to continue.

accept-exact-dirs

This is used by filename completion. Unlike accept-exact it is a boolean. By default, filename


completion examines all components of a path to see if there are completions of that component,
even if the component matches an existing directory. For example, when completion after /usr/bin/,
the function examines possible completions to /usr.

When this style is ‘true’, any prefix of a path that matches an existing directory is accepted without
any attempt to complete it further. Hence, in the given example, the path /usr/bin/ is accepted
immediately and completion tried in that directory.

This style is also useful when completing after directories that magically appear when referenced,
such as ZFS .zfs directories or NetApp .snapshot directories. When the style is set the shell does not
check for the existence of the directory within the parent directory.

If you wish to inhibit this behaviour entirely, set the path-completion style (see below) to ‘false’.

add-space

This style is used by the _expand completer. If it is ‘true’ (the default), a space will be inserted after all

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 324 of 616
:
words resulting from the expansion, or a slash in the case of directory names. If the value is ‘file’, the
completer will only add a space to names of existing files. Either a boolean ‘true’ or the value ‘file’
may be combined with ‘subst’, in which case the completer will not add a space to words generated
from the expansion of a substitution of the form ‘$( ... )’ or ‘${ ... }’.

The _prefix completer uses this style as a simple boolean value to decide if a space should be
inserted before the suffix.

ambiguous

This applies when completing non-final components of filename paths, in other words those with a
trailing slash. If it is set, the cursor is left after the first ambiguous component, even if menu
completion is in use. The style is always tested with the paths tag.

assign-list

When completing after an equals sign that is being treated as an assignment, the completion system
normally completes only one filename. In some cases the value may be a list of filenames separated
by colons, as with PATH and similar parameters. This style can be set to a list of patterns matching
the names of such parameters.

The default is to complete lists when the word on the line already contains a colon.

auto-description

If set, this style’s value will be used as the description for options that are not described by the
completion functions, but that have exactly one argument. The sequence ‘%d’ in the value will be
replaced by the description for this argument. Depending on personal preferences, it may be useful
to set this style to something like ‘specify: %d’. Note that this may not work for some commands.

avoid-completer

This is used by the _all_matches completer to decide if the string consisting of all matches should be
added to the list currently being generated. Its value is a list of names of completers. If any of these
is the name of the completer that generated the matches in this completion, the string will not be
added.

The default value for this style is ‘_expand _old_list _correct _approximate’, i.e. it contains the
completers for which a string with all matches will almost never be wanted.

cache-path

This style defines the path where any cache files containing dumped completion data are stored. It
defaults to ‘$ZDOTDIR/.zcompcache’, or ‘$HOME/.zcompcache’ if $ZDOTDIR is not defined. The
completion cache will not be used unless the use-cache style is set.

cache-policy

This style defines the function that will be used to determine whether a cache needs rebuilding. See
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 325 of 616
:
the section on the _cache_invalid function below.

call-command

This style is used in the function for commands such as make and ant where calling the command
directly to generate matches suffers problems such as being slow or, as in the case of make can
potentially cause actions in the makefile to be executed. If it is set to ‘true’ the command is called to
generate matches. The default value of this style is ‘false’.

command

In many places, completion functions need to call external commands to generate the list of
completions. This style can be used to override the command that is called in some such cases. The
elements of the value are joined with spaces to form a command line to execute. The value can also
start with a hyphen, in which case the usual command will be added to the end; this is most useful
for putting ‘builtin’ or ‘command’ in front to make sure the appropriate version of a command is
called, for example to avoid calling a shell function with the same name as an external command.

As an example, the completion function for process IDs uses this style with the processes tag to
generate the IDs to complete and the list of processes to display (if the verbose style is ‘true’). The list
produced by the command should look like the output of the ps command. The first line is not
displayed, but is searched for the string ‘PID’ (or ‘pid’) to find the position of the process IDs in the
following lines. If the line does not contain ‘PID’, the first numbers in each of the other lines are
taken as the process IDs to complete.

Note that the completion function generally has to call the specified command for each attempt to
generate the completion list. Hence care should be taken to specify only commands that take a
short time to run, and in particular to avoid any that may never terminate.

command-path

This is a list of directories to search for commands to complete. The default for this style is the value
of the special parameter path.

commands

This is used by the function completing sub-commands for the system initialisation scripts (residing
in /etc/init.d or somewhere not too far away from that). Its values give the default commands to
complete for those commands for which the completion function isn’t able to find them out
automatically. The default for this style are the two strings ‘start’ and ‘stop’.

complete

This is used by the _expand_alias function when invoked as a bindable command. If set to ‘true’ and
the word on the command line is not the name of an alias, matching alias names will be completed.

complete-options

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 326 of 616
:
This is used by the completer for cd, chdir and pushd. For these commands a - is used to introduce a
directory stack entry and completion of these is far more common than completing options. Hence
unless the value of this style is ‘true’ options will not be completed, even after an initial -. If it is ‘true’,
options will be completed after an initial - unless there is a preceding -- on the command line.

completer

The strings given as the value of this style provide the names of the completer functions to use. The
available completer functions are described in Control Functions.

Each string may be either the name of a completer function or a string of the form ‘ function : name ’.
In the first case the completer field of the context will contain the name of the completer without
the leading underscore and with all other underscores replaced by hyphens. In the second case the
function is the name of the completer to call, but the context will contain the user-defined name in
the completer field of the context. If the name starts with a hyphen, the string for the context will
be build from the name of the completer function as in the first case with the name appended to it.
For example:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo

Here, completion will call the _complete completer twice, once using ‘complete’ and once using
‘complete-foo’ in the completer field of the context. Normally, using the same completer more than
once only makes sense when used with the ‘ functions : name ’ form, because otherwise the context
name will be the same in all calls to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are the _ignored
and _prefix completers.

The default value for this style is ‘_complete _ignored’: only completion will be done, first using the
ignored-patterns style and the $fignore array and then without ignoring matches.

condition

This style is used by the _list completer function to decide if insertion of matches should be delayed
unconditionally. The default is ‘true’.

delimiters

This style is used when adding a delimiter for use with history modifiers or glob qualifiers that have
delimited arguments. It is an array of preferred delimiters to add. Non-special characters are
preferred as the completion system may otherwise become confused. The default list is :, +, /, -, %.
The list may be empty to force a delimiter to be typed.

disabled

If this is set to ‘true’, the _expand_alias completer and bindable command will try to expand disabled
aliases, too. The default is ‘false’.

domains
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 327 of 616
:
A list of names of network domains for completion. If this is not set, domain names will be taken
from the file /etc/resolv.conf.

environ

The environ style is used when completing for ‘sudo’. It is set to an array of ‘ VAR = value ’
assignments to be exported into the local environment before the completion for the target
command is invoked.

zstyle ':completion:*:sudo::' environ \


PATH="/sbin:/usr/sbin:$PATH" HOME="/root"

expand

This style is used when completing strings consisting of multiple parts, such as path names.

If one of its values is the string ‘prefix’, the partially typed word from the line will be expanded as far
as possible even if trailing parts cannot be completed.

If one of its values is the string ‘suffix’, matching names for components after the first ambiguous
one will also be added. This means that the resulting string is the longest unambiguous string
possible. However, menu completion can be used to cycle through all matches.

extra-verbose

If set, the completion listing is more verbose at the cost of a probable decrease in completion speed.
Completion performance will suffer if this style is set to ‘true’.

fake

This style may be set for any completion context. It specifies additional strings that will always be
completed in that context. The form of each string is ‘ value : description ’; the colon and
description may be omitted, but any literal colons in value must be quoted with a backslash. Any
description provided is shown alongside the value in completion listings.

It is important to use a sufficiently restrictive context when specifying fake strings. Note that the
styles fake-files and fake-parameters provide additional features when completing files or
parameters.

fake-always

This works identically to the fake style except that the ignored-patterns style is not applied to it. This
makes it possible to override a set of matches completely by setting the ignored patterns to ‘*’.

The following shows a way of supplementing any tag with arbitrary data, but having it behave for
display purposes like a separate tag. In this example we use the features of the tag-order style to
divide the named-directories tag into two when performing completion with the standard completer
complete for arguments of cd. The tag named-directories-normal behaves as normal, but the tag

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 328 of 616
:
named-directories-mine contains a fixed set of directories. This has the effect of adding the match
group ‘extra directories’ with the given completions.

zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*' tag-order \


'named-directories:-mine:extra\ directories
named-directories:-normal:named\ directories *'
zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
fake-always mydir1 mydir2
zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
ignored-patterns '*'

fake-files

This style is used when completing files and looked up without a tag. Its values are of the form
‘ dir : names... ’. This will add the names (strings separated by spaces) as possible matches when
completing in the directory dir , even if no such files really exist. The dir may be a pattern; pattern
characters or colons in dir should be quoted with a backslash to be treated literally.

This can be useful on systems that support special file systems whose top-level pathnames can not
be listed or generated with glob patterns (but see accept-exact-dirs for a more general way of
dealing with this problem). It can also be used for directories for which one does not have read
permission.

The pattern form can be used to add a certain ‘magic’ entry to all directories on a particular file
system.

fake-parameters

This is used by the completion function for parameter names. Its values are names of parameters
that might not yet be set but should be completed nonetheless. Each name may also be followed by
a colon and a string specifying the type of the parameter (like ‘scalar’, ‘array’ or ‘integer’). If the type is
given, the name will only be completed if parameters of that type are required in the particular
context. Names for which no type is specified will always be completed.

file-list

This style controls whether files completed using the standard builtin mechanism are to be listed
with a long list similar to ls -l. Note that this feature uses the shell module zsh/stat for file
information; this loads the builtin stat this the following code can be included in an initialization file:

zmodload -i zsh/stat
disable stat

The style may either be set to a ‘true’ value (or ‘all’), or one of the values ‘insert’ or ‘list’, indicating that
files are to be listed in long format in all circumstances, or when attempting to insert a file name, or
when listing file names without attempting to insert one.

More generally, the value may be an array of any of the above values, optionally followed by = num .
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 329 of 616
:
If num is present it gives the maximum number of matches for which long listing style will be used.
For example,

zstyle ':completion:*' file-list list=20 insert=10

specifies that long format will be used when listing up to 20 files or inserting a file with up to 10
matches (assuming a listing is to be shown at all, for example on an ambiguous completion), else
short format will be used.

zstyle -e ':completion:*' file-list \


'(( ${+NUMERIC} )) && reply=(true)'

specifies that long format will be used any time a numeric argument is supplied, else short format.

file-patterns

This is used by the standard function for completing filenames, _files. If the style is unset up to three
tags are offered, ‘globbed-files’,‘directories’ and ‘all-files’, depending on the types of files expected by
the caller of _files. The first two (‘globbed-files’ and ‘directories’) are normally offered together to
make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.

The file-patterns style provides alternatives to the default tags, which are not used. Its value consists
of elements of the form ‘ pattern : tag ’; each string may contain any number of such specifications
separated by spaces.

The pattern is a pattern that is to be used to generate filenames. Any occurrence of the sequence
‘%p’ is replaced by any pattern(s) passed by the function calling _files. Colons in the pattern must be
preceded by a backslash to make them distinguishable from the colon before the tag . If more than
one pattern is needed, the patterns can be given inside braces, separated by commas.

The tag s of all strings in the value will be offered by _files and used when looking up other styles.
Any tag s in the same word will be offered at the same time and before later words. If no ‘: tag ’ is
given the ‘files’ tag will be used.

The tag may also be followed by an optional second colon and a description, which will be used for
the ‘%d’ in the value of the format style (if that is set) instead of the default description supplied by
the completion function. The inclusion of a description also gives precedence to associated options
such as for completion grouping so it can be used where files should be separated.

For example, to make the rm command first complete only names of object files and then the
names of all files if there is no matching object file:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*:*' file-patterns \


'*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'

To alter the default behaviour of file completion — offer files matching a pattern and directories on

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 330 of 616
:
the first attempt, then all files — to offer only matching files on the first attempt, then directories,
and finally all files:

zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \


'%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'

This works even where there is no special pattern: _files matches all files using the pattern ‘*’ at the
first step and stops when it sees this pattern. Note also it will never try a pattern more than once for
a single completion attempt.

To separate directories into a separate group from the files but still complete them at the first
attempt, a description needs to be given. Note that directories need to be explicitly excluded from
the globbed-files because ‘*’ will match directories. For grouping, it is also necessary to set the
group-name style.

zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \


'%p(^-/):globbed-files *(-/):directories:location'

During the execution of completion functions, the EXTENDED_GLOB option is in effect, so the
characters ‘#’, ‘~’ and ‘^’ have special meanings in the patterns.

file-sort

The standard filename completion function uses this style without a tag to determine in which order
the names should be listed; menu completion will cycle through them in the same order. The
possible values are: ‘size’ to sort by the size of the file; ‘links’ to sort by the number of links to the file;
‘modification’ (or ‘time’ or ‘date’) to sort by the last modification time; ‘access’ to sort by the last
access time; and ‘inode’ (or ‘change’) to sort by the last inode change time. If the style is set to any
other value, or is unset, files will be sorted alphabetically by name. If the value contains the string
‘reverse’, sorting is done in the opposite order. If the value contains the string ‘follow’, timestamps
are associated with the targets of symbolic links; the default is to use the timestamps of the links
themselves.

file-split-chars

A set of characters that will cause all file completions for the given context to be split at the point
where any of the characters occurs. A typical use is to set the style to :; then everything up to and
including the last : in the string so far is ignored when completing files. As this is quite heavy-
handed, it is usually preferable to update completion functions for contexts where this behaviour is
useful.

filter

The ldap plugin of email address completion (see _email_addresses) uses this style to specify the
attributes to match against when filtering entries. So for example, if the style is set to ‘sn’, matching
is done against surnames. Standard LDAP filtering is used so normal completion matching is
bypassed. If this style is not set, the LDAP plugin is skipped. You may also need to set the command
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 331 of 616
:
style to specify how to connect to your LDAP server.

force-list

This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where listing is done, even in cases where
the list would usually be suppressed. For example, normally the list is only shown if there are at least
two different matches. By setting this style to ‘always’, the list will always be shown, even if there is
only a single match that will immediately be accepted. The style may also be set to a number. In this
case the list will be shown if there are at least that many matches, even if they would all insert the
same string.

This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag valid for the current completion. Hence
the listing can be forced only for certain types of match.

format

If this is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as a string to display above matches in
completion lists. The sequence ‘%d’ in this string will be replaced with a short description of what
these matches are. This string may also contain the output attribute sequences understood by
compadd -X (see Completion Widgets).

The style is tested with each tag valid for the current completion before it is tested for the
descriptions tag. Hence different format strings can be defined for different types of match.

Note also that some completer functions define additional ‘%’-sequences. These are described for
the completer functions that make use of them.

Some completion functions display messages that may be customised by setting this style for the
messages tag. Here, the ‘%d’ is replaced with a message given by the completion function.

Finally, the format string is looked up with the warnings tag, for use when no matches could be
generated at all. In this case the ‘%d’ is replaced with the descriptions for the matches that were
expected separated by spaces. The sequence ‘%D’ is replaced with the same descriptions separated
by newlines.

It is possible to use printf-style field width specifiers with ‘%d’ and similar escape sequences. This is
handled by the zformat builtin command from the zsh/zutil module, see The zsh/zutil Module.

gain-privileges

If set to true, this style enables the use of commands like sudo or doas to gain extra privileges when
retrieving information for completion. This is only done when a command such as sudo appears on
the command-line. To force the use of, e.g. sudo or to override any prefix that might be added due
to gain-privileges, the command style can be used with a value that begins with a hyphen.

glob

This is used by the _expand completer. If it is set to ‘true’ (the default), globbing will be attempted on

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 332 of 616
:
the words resulting from a previous substitution (see the substitute style) or else the original string
from the line.

global

If this is set to ‘true’ (the default), the _expand_alias completer and bindable command will try to
expand global aliases.

group-name

The completion system can group different types of matches, which appear in separate lists. This
style can be used to give the names of groups for particular tags. For example, in command position
the completion system generates names of builtin and external commands, names of aliases, shell
functions and parameters and reserved words as possible completions. To have the external
commands and shell functions listed separately:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' \
group-name commands
zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' \
group-name functions

As a consequence, any match with the same tag will be displayed in the same group.

If the name given is the empty string the name of the tag for the matches will be used as the name
of the group. So, to have all different types of matches displayed separately, one can just set:

zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''

All matches for which no group name is defined will be put in a group named -default-.

To display the group name in the output, see the format style (q.v.) under the descriptions tag.

group-order

This style is additional to the group-name style to specify the order for display of the groups defined
by that style (compare tag-order, which determines which completions appear at all). The groups
named are shown in the given order; any other groups are shown in the order defined by the
completion function.

For example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions and external commands appear in
that order when completing in command position:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' group-order \


builtins functions commands

groups

A list of names of UNIX groups. If this is not set, group names are taken from the YP database or the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 333 of 616
:
file ‘/etc/group’.

hidden

If this is set to ‘true’, matches for the given context will not be listed, although any description for the
matches set with the format style will be shown. If it is set to ‘all’, not even the description will be
displayed.

Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not shown in the list. To avoid having
matches considered as possible completions at all, the tag-order style can be modified as described
below.

hosts

A list of names of hosts that should be completed. If this is not set, hostnames are taken from the
file ‘/etc/hosts’.

hosts-ports

This style is used by commands that need or accept hostnames and network ports. The strings in
the value should be of the form ‘ host : port ’. Valid ports are determined by the presence of
hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.

ignore-line

This is tested for each tag valid for the current completion. If it is set to ‘true’, none of the words that
are already on the line will be considered as possible completions. If it is set to ‘current’, the word
the cursor is on will not be considered as a possible completion. The value ‘current-shown’ is similar
but only applies if the list of completions is currently shown on the screen. Finally, if the style is set
to ‘other’, all words on the line except for the current one will be excluded from the possible
completions.

The values ‘current’ and ‘current-shown’ are a bit like the opposite of the accept-exact style: only
strings with missing characters will be completed.

Note that you almost certainly don’t want to set this to ‘true’ or ‘other’ for a general context such as
‘:completion:*’. This is because it would disallow completion of, for example, options multiple times
even if the command in question accepts the option more than once.

ignore-parents

The style is tested without a tag by the function completing pathnames in order to determine
whether to ignore the names of directories already mentioned in the current word, or the name of
the current working directory. The value must include one or both of the following strings:

parent
The name of any directory whose path is already contained in the word on the line is ignored. For
example, when completing after foo/../, the directory foo will not be considered a valid completion.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 334 of 616
:
pwd
The name of the current working directory will not be completed; hence, for example, completion
after ../ will not use the name of the current directory.

In addition, the value may include one or both of:

..
Ignore the specified directories only when the word on the line contains the substring ‘../’.

directory
Ignore the specified directories only when names of directories are completed, not when completing
names of files.

Excluded values act in a similar fashion to values of the ignored-patterns style, so they can be
restored to consideration by the _ignored completer.

ignored-patterns

A list of patterns; any trial completion matching one of the patterns will be excluded from
consideration. The _ignored completer can appear in the list of completers to restore the ignored
matches. This is a more configurable version of the shell parameter $fignore.

Note that the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set during the execution of completion functions, so the
characters ‘#’, ‘~’ and ‘^’ have special meanings in the patterns.

insert

This style is used by the _all_matches completer to decide whether to insert the list of all matches
unconditionally instead of adding the list as another match.

insert-ids

When completing process IDs, for example as arguments to the kill and wait builtins the name of a
command may be converted to the appropriate process ID. A problem arises when the process
name typed is not unique. By default (or if this style is set explicitly to ‘menu’) the name will be
converted immediately to a set of possible IDs, and menu completion will be started to cycle
through them.

If the value of the style is ‘single’, the shell will wait until the user has typed enough to make the
command unique before converting the name to an ID; attempts at completion will be unsuccessful
until that point. If the value is any other string, menu completion will be started when the string
typed by the user is longer than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.

insert-sections

This style is used with tags of the form ‘manuals. X ’ when completing names of manual pages. If set
and the X in the tag name matches the section number of the page being completed, the section
number is inserted along with the page name. For example, given

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 335 of 616
:
zstyle ':completion:*:manuals.*' insert-sections true

man ssh_<TAB> may be completed to man 5 ssh_config.

The value may also be set to one of ‘prepend’, or ‘suffix’. ‘prepend’ behaves the same as ‘true’ as in
the above example, while ‘suffix’ would complete man ssh_<TAB> as man ssh_config.5.

This is especially useful in conjunction with separate-sections, as it ensures that the page requested
of man corresponds to the one displayed in the completion listing when there are multiple pages
with the same name (e.g., printf(1) and printf(3)).

The default for this style is ‘false’.

insert-tab

If this is set to ‘true’, the completion system will insert a TAB character (assuming that was used to
start completion) instead of performing completion when there is no non-blank character to the left
of the cursor. If it is set to ‘false’, completion will be done even there.

The value may also contain the substrings ‘pending’ or ‘pending= val ’. In this case, the typed
character will be inserted instead of starting completion when there is unprocessed input pending. If
a val is given, completion will not be done if there are at least that many characters of unprocessed
input. This is often useful when pasting characters into a terminal. Note however, that it relies on the
$PENDING special parameter from the zsh/zle module being set properly which is not guaranteed
on all platforms.

The default value of this style is ‘true’ except for completion within vared builtin command where it
is ‘false’.

insert-unambiguous

This is used by the _match and _approximate completers. These completers are often used with
menu completion since the word typed may bear little resemblance to the final completion.
However, if this style is ‘true’, the completer will start menu completion only if it could find no
unambiguous initial string at least as long as the original string typed by the user.

In the case of the _approximate completer, the completer field in the context will already have been
set to one of correct- num or approximate- num , where num is the number of errors that were
accepted.

In the case of the _match completer, the style may also be set to the string ‘pattern’. Then the
pattern on the line is left unchanged if it does not match unambiguously.

keep-prefix

This style is used by the _expand completer. If it is ‘true’, the completer will try to keep a prefix
containing a tilde or parameter expansion. Hence, for example, the string ‘~/f*’ would be expanded

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 336 of 616
:
to ‘~/foo’ instead of ‘/home/user/foo’. If the style is set to ‘changed’ (the default), the prefix will only
be left unchanged if there were other changes between the expanded words and the original word
from the command line. Any other value forces the prefix to be expanded unconditionally.

The behaviour of _expand when this style is ‘true’ is to cause _expand to give up when a single
expansion with the restored prefix is the same as the original; hence any remaining completers may
be called.

known-hosts-files

This style should contain a list of files to search for host names and (if the use-ip style is set) IP
addresses in a format compatible with ssh known_hosts files. If it is not set, the files
/etc/ssh/ssh_known_hosts and ~/.ssh/known_hosts are used.

last-prompt

This is a more flexible form of the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option. If it is ‘true’, the completion
system will try to return the cursor to the previous command line after displaying a completion list.
It is tested for all tags valid for the current completion, then the default tag. The cursor will be
moved back to the previous line if this style is ‘true’ for all types of match. Note that unlike the
ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option this is independent of the numeric argument.

list

This style is used by the _history_complete_word bindable command. If it is set to ‘true’ it has no
effect. If it is set to ‘false’ matches will not be listed. This overrides the setting of the options
controlling listing behaviour, in particular AUTO_LIST. The context always starts with
‘:completion:history-words’.

list-colors

If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to set color specifications. This
mechanism replaces the use of the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters described in The
zsh/complist Module, but the syntax is the same.

If this style is set for the default tag, the strings in the value are taken as specifications that are to be
used everywhere. If it is set for other tags, the specifications are used only for matches of the type
described by the tag. For this to work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty string.

In addition to setting styles for specific tags, it is also possible to use group names specified explicitly
by the group-name tag together with the ‘(group)’ syntax allowed by the ZLS_COLORS and
ZLS_COLOURS parameters and simply using the default tag.

It is possible to use any color specifications already set up for the GNU version of the ls command:

zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors \


${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 337 of 616
:
The default colors are the same as for the GNU ls command and can be obtained by setting the style
to an empty string (i.e. ’’).

list-dirs-first

This is used by file completion and corresponds to a particular setting of the file-patterns style. If set,
the default directories to be completed are listed separately from and before completion for other
files.

list-grouped

If this style is ‘true’ (the default), the completion system will try to make certain completion listings
more compact by grouping matches. For example, options for commands that have the same
description (shown when the verbose style is set to ‘true’) will appear as a single entry. However,
menu selection can be used to cycle through all the matches.

list-packed

This is tested for each tag valid in the current context as well as the default tag. If it is set to ‘true’,
the corresponding matches appear in listings as if the LIST_PACKED option were set. If it is set to
‘false’, they are listed normally.

list-prompt

If this style is set for the default tag, completion lists that don’t fit on the screen can be scrolled (see
The zsh/complist Module). The value, if not the empty string, will be displayed after every screenful
and the shell will prompt for a key press; if the style is set to the empty string, a default prompt will
be used.

The value may contain the escape sequences: ‘%l’ or ‘%L’, which will be replaced by the number of
the last line displayed and the total number of lines; ‘%m’ or ‘%M’, the number of the last match
shown and the total number of matches; and ‘%p’ and ‘%P’, ‘Top’ when at the beginning of the list,
‘Bottom’ when at the end and the position shown as a percentage of the total length otherwise. In
each case the form with the uppercase letter will be replaced by a string of fixed width, padded to
the right with spaces, while the lowercase form will be replaced by a variable width string. As in
other prompt strings, the escape sequences ‘%S’, ‘%s’, ‘%B’, ‘%b’, ‘%U’, ‘%u’ for entering and leaving
the display modes standout, bold and underline, and ‘%F’, ‘%f’, ‘%K’, ‘%k’ for changing the foreground
background colour, are also available, as is the form ‘%{...%}’ for enclosing escape sequences which
display with zero (or, with a numeric argument, some other) width.

After deleting this prompt the variable LISTPROMPT should be unset for the removal to take effect.

list-rows-first

This style is tested in the same way as the list-packed style and determines whether matches are to
be listed in a rows-first fashion as if the LIST_ROWS_FIRST option were set.

list-separator

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 338 of 616
:
The value of this style is used in completion listing to separate the string to complete from a
description when possible (e.g. when completing options). It defaults to ‘--’ (two hyphens).

list-suffixes

This style is used by the function that completes filenames. If it is ‘true’, and completion is attempted
on a string containing multiple partially typed pathname components, all ambiguous components
will be shown. Otherwise, completion stops at the first ambiguous component.

local

This is for use with functions that complete URLs for which the corresponding files are available
directly from the file system. Its value should consist of three strings: a hostname, the path to the
default web pages for the server, and the directory name used by a user placing web pages within
their home area.

For example:

zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \


/var/http/public/toast public_html

Completion after ‘http://toast/stuff/’ will look for files in the directory /var/http/public/toast/stuff,
while completion after ‘http://toast/~yousir/’ will look for files in the directory ~yousir/public_html.

mail-directory

If set, zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found in the directory specified. It defaults to ‘~/Mail’.

match-original

This is used by the _match completer. If it is set to only, _match will try to generate matches without
inserting a ‘*’ at the cursor position. If set to any other non-empty value, it will first try to generate
matches without inserting the ‘*’ and if that yields no matches, it will try again with the ‘*’ inserted. If
it is unset or set to the empty string, matching will only be performed with the ‘*’ inserted.

matcher

This style is tested separately for each tag valid in the current context. Its value is placed before any
match specifications given by the matcher-list style so can override them via the use of an x:
specification. The value should be in the form described in Completion Matching Control. For
examples of this, see the description of the tag-order style.

For notes comparing the use of this and the matcher-list style, see under the description of the tag-
order style.

matcher-list

This style can be set to a list of match specifications that are to be applied everywhere. Match

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 339 of 616
:
specifications are described in Completion Matching Control. The completion system will try them
one after another for each completer selected. For example, to try first simple completion and, if
that generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:

zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

By default each specification replaces the previous one; however, if a specification is prefixed with +,
it is added to the existing list. Hence it is possible to create increasingly general specifications
without repetition:

zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list \


'' '+m:{a-z}={A-Z}' '+m:{A-Z}={a-z}'

It is possible to create match specifications valid for particular completers by using the third field of
the context. This applies only to completers that override the global matcher-list, which as of this
writing includes only _prefix and _ignored. For example, to use the completers _complete and _prefix
but allow case-insensitive completion only with _complete:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix


zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
'' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

User-defined names, as explained for the completer style, are available. This makes it possible to try
the same completer more than once with different match specifications each time. For example, to
try normal completion without a match specification, then normal completion with case-insensitive
matching, then correction, and finally partial-word completion:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer \


_complete _correct _complete:foo
zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*:*:*' matcher-list \
'' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*:*:*' matcher-list \
'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'

If the style is unset in any context no match specification is applied. Note also that some completers
such as _correct and _approximate do not use the match specifications at all, though these
completers will only ever be called once even if the matcher-list contains more than one element.

Where multiple specifications are useful, note that the entire completion is done for each element of
matcher-list, which can quickly reduce the shell’s performance. As a rough rule of thumb, hand,
putting multiple space-separated values into the same string does not have an appreciable impact
on performance.

If there is no current matcher or it is empty, and the option NO_CASE_GLOB is in effect, the matching
for files is performed case-insensitively in any case. However, any matcher must explicitly specify
case-insensitive matching if that is required.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 340 of 616
:
For notes comparing the use of this and the matcher style, see under the description of the tag-
order style.

max-errors

This is used by the _approximate and _correct completer functions to determine the maximum
number of errors to allow. The completer will try to generate completions by first allowing one error,
then two errors, and so on, until either a match or matches were found or the maximum number of
errors given by this style has been reached.

If the value for this style contains the string ‘numeric’, the completer function will take any numeric
argument as the maximum number of errors allowed. For example, with

zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric

two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with a numeric argument of six (as in
‘ESC-6 TAB’), up to six errors are accepted. Hence with a value of ‘0 numeric’, no correcting
completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument is given.

If the value contains the string ‘not-numeric’, the completer will not try to generate corrected
completions when given a numeric argument, so in this case the number given should be greater
than zero. For example, ‘2 not-numeric’ specifies that correcting completion with two errors will
usually be performed, but if a numeric argument is given, correcting completion will not be
performed.

The default value for this style is ‘2 numeric’.

max-matches-width

This style is used to determine the trade off between the width of the display used for matches and
the width used for their descriptions when the verbose style is in effect. The value gives the number
of display columns to reserve for the matches. The default is half the width of the screen.

This has the most impact when several matches have the same description and so will be grouped
together. Increasing the style will allow more matches to be grouped together; decreasing it will
allow more of the description to be visible.

menu

If this is ‘true’ in the context of any of the tags defined for the current completion menu completion
will be used. The value for a specific tag will take precedence over that for the ‘default’ tag.

If none of the values found in this way is ‘true’ but at least one is set to ‘auto’, the shell behaves as if
the AUTO_MENU option is set.

If one of the values is explicitly set to ‘false’, menu completion will be explicitly turned off, overriding
the MENU_COMPLETE option and other settings.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 341 of 616
:
In the form ‘yes= num ’, where ‘yes’ may be any of the ‘true’ values (‘yes’, ‘true’, ‘on’ and ‘1’), menu
completion will be turned on if there are at least num matches. In the form ‘yes=long’, menu
completion will be turned on if the list does not fit on the screen. This does not activate menu
completion if the widget normally only lists completions, but menu completion can be activated in
that case with the value ‘yes=long-list’ (Typically, the value ‘select=long-list’ described later is more
useful as it provides control over scrolling.)

Similarly, with any of the ‘false’ values (as in ‘no=10’), menu completion will not be used if there are
num or more matches.

The value of this widget also controls menu selection, as implemented by the zsh/complist module.
The following values may appear either alongside or instead of the values above.

If the value contains the string ‘select’, menu selection will be started unconditionally.

In the form ‘select= num ’, menu selection will only be started if there are at least num matches. If the
values for more than one tag provide a number, the smallest number is taken.

Menu selection can be turned off explicitly by defining a value containing the string‘no-select’.

It is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of matches does not fit on the screen by
using the value ‘select=long’. To start menu selection even if the current widget only performs listing,
use the value ‘select=long-list’.

To turn on menu completion or menu selection when there are a certain number of matches or the
list of matches does not fit on the screen, both of ‘yes=’ and ‘select=’ may be given twice, once with a
number and once with ‘long’ or ‘long-list’.

Finally, it is possible to activate two special modes of menu selection. The word ‘interactive’ in the
value causes interactive mode to be entered immediately when menu selection is started; see The
zsh/complist Module for a description of interactive mode. Including the string ‘search’ does the
same for incremental search mode. To select backward incremental search, include the string
‘search-backward’.

muttrc

If set, gives the location of the mutt configuration file. It defaults to ‘~/.muttrc’.

numbers

This is used with the jobs tag. If it is ‘true’, the shell will complete job numbers instead of the shortest
unambiguous prefix of the job command text. If the value is a number, job numbers will only be
used if that many words from the job descriptions are required to resolve ambiguities. For example,
if the value is ‘1’, strings will only be used if all jobs differ in the first word on their command lines.

old-list

This is used by the _oldlist completer. If it is set to ‘always’, then standard widgets which perform

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 342 of 616
:
listing will retain the current list of matches, however they were generated; this can be turned off
explicitly with the value ‘never’, giving the behaviour without the _oldlist completer. If the style is
unset, or any other value, then the existing list of completions is displayed if it is not already;
otherwise, the standard completion list is generated; this is the default behaviour of _oldlist.
However, if there is an old list and this style contains the name of the completer function that
generated the list, then the old list will be used even if it was generated by a widget which does not
do listing.

For example, suppose you type ^Xc to use the _correct_word widget, which generates a list of
corrections for the word under the cursor. Usually, typing ^D would generate a standard list of
completions for the word on the command line, and show that. With _oldlist, it will instead show the
list of corrections already generated.

As another example consider the _match completer: with the insert-unambiguous style set to ‘true’ it
inserts only a common prefix string, if there is any. However, this may remove parts of the original
pattern, so that further completion could produce more matches than on the first attempt. By using
the _oldlist completer and setting this style to _match, the list of matches generated on the first
attempt will be used again.

old-matches

This is used by the _all_matches completer to decide if an old list of matches should be used if one
exists. This is selected by one of the ‘true’ values or by the string ‘only’. If the value is ‘only’,
_all_matches will only use an old list and won’t have any effect on the list of matches currently being
generated.

If this style is set it is generally unwise to call the _all_matches completer unconditionally. One
possible use is for either this style or the completer style to be defined with the -e option to zstyle to
make the style conditional.

old-menu

This is used by the _oldlist completer. It controls how menu completion behaves when a completion
has already been inserted and the user types a standard completion key such as TAB. The default
behaviour of _oldlist is that menu completion always continues with the existing list of completions.
If this style is set to ‘false’, however, a new completion is started if the old list was generated by a
different completion command; this is the behaviour without the _oldlist completer.

For example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a list of corrections, and menu completion is started
in one of the usual ways. Usually, or with this style set to ‘false’, typing TAB at this point would start
trying to complete the line as it now appears. With _oldlist, it instead continues to cycle through the
list of corrections.

original

This is used by the _approximate and _correct completers to decide if the original string should be
added as a possible completion. Normally, this is done only if there are at least two possible

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 343 of 616
:
corrections, but if this style is set to ‘true’, it is always added. Note that the style will be examined
with the completer field in the context name set to correct- num or approximate- num , where num is
the number of errors that were accepted.

packageset

This style is used when completing arguments of the Debian ‘dpkg’ program. It contains an override
for the default package set for a given context. For example,

zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
packageset avail

causes available packages, rather than only installed packages, to be completed for ‘dpkg --status’.

path

The function that completes color names uses this style with the colors tag. The value should be the
pathname of a file containing color names in the format of an X11 rgb.txt file. If the style is not set
but this file is found in one of various standard locations it will be used as the default.

path-completion

This is used by filename completion. By default, filename completion examines all components of a
path to see if there are completions of that component. For example, /u/b/z can be completed to
/usr/bin/zsh. Explicitly setting this style to ‘false’ inhibits this behaviour for path components up to
the / before the cursor; this overrides the setting of accept-exact-dirs.

Even with the style set to ‘false’, it is still possible to complete multiple paths by setting the option
COMPLETE_IN_WORD and moving the cursor back to the first component in the path to be
completed. For example, /u/b/z can be completed to /usr/bin/zsh if the cursor is after the /u.

pine-directory

If set, specifies the directory containing PINE mailbox files. There is no default, since recursively
searching this directory is inconvenient for anyone who doesn’t use PINE.

ports

A list of Internet service names (network ports) to complete. If this is not set, service names are
taken from the file ‘/etc/services’.

prefix-hidden

This is used for certain completions which share a common prefix, for example command options
beginning with dashes. If it is ‘true’, the prefix will not be shown in the list of matches.

The default value for this style is ‘false’.

prefix-needed
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 344 of 616
:
This style is also relevant for matches with a common prefix. If it is set to ‘true’ this common prefix
must be typed by the user to generate the matches.

The style is applicable to the options, signals, jobs, functions, and parameters completion tags.

For command options, this means that the initial ‘-’, ‘+’, or ‘--’ must be typed explicitly before option
names will be completed.

For signals, an initial ‘-’ is required before signal names will be completed.

For jobs, an initial ‘%’ is required before job names will be completed.

For function and parameter names, an initial ‘_’ or ‘.’ is required before function or parameter names
starting with those characters will be completed.

The default value for this style is ‘false’ for function and parameter completions, and ‘true’ otherwise.

preserve-prefix

This style is used when completing path names. Its value should be a pattern matching an initial
prefix of the word to complete that should be left unchanged under all circumstances. For example,
on some Unices an initial ‘//’ (double slash) has a special meaning; setting this style to the string ‘//’
will preserve it. As another example, setting this style to ‘?:/’ under Cygwin would allow completion
after ‘a:/...’ and so on.

range

This is used by the _history completer and the _history_complete_word bindable command to decide
which words should be completed.

If it is a single number, only the last N words from the history will be completed.

If it is a range of the form ‘ max : slice ’, the last slice words will be completed; then if that yields
no matches, the slice words before those will be tried and so on. This process stops either when
at least one match has been found, or max words have been tried.

The default is to complete all words from the history at once.

recursive-files

If this style is set, its value is an array of patterns to be tested against ‘$PWD/’: note the trailing slash,
which allows directories in the pattern to be delimited unambiguously by including slashes on both
sides. If an ordinary file completion fails and the word on the command line does not yet have a
directory part to its name, the style is retrieved using the same tag as for the completion just
attempted, then the elements tested against $PWD/ in turn. If one matches, then the shell
reattempts completion by prepending the word on the command line with each directory in the
expansion of **/*(/) in turn. Typically the elements of the style will be set to restrict the number of
directories beneath the current one to a manageable number, for example ‘*/.git/*’.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 345 of 616
:
For example,

zstyle ':completion:*' recursive-files '*/zsh/*'

If the current directory is /home/pws/zsh/Src, then zle_tr<TAB> can be completed to Zle/zle_tricky.c.

regular

This style is used by the _expand_alias completer and bindable command. If set to ‘true’ (the
default), regular aliases will be expanded but only in command position. If it is set to ‘false’, regular
aliases will never be expanded. If it is set to ‘always’, regular aliases will be expanded even if not in
command position.

rehash

If this is set when completing external commands, the internal list (hash) of commands will be
updated for each search by issuing the rehash command. There is a speed penalty for this which is
only likely to be noticeable when directories in the path have slow file access.

remote-access

If set to ‘false’, certain commands will be prevented from making Internet connections to retrieve
remote information. This includes the completion for the CVS command.

It is not always possible to know if connections are in fact to a remote site, so some may be
prevented unnecessarily.

remove-all-dups

The _history_complete_word bindable command and the _history completer use this to decide if all
duplicate matches should be removed, rather than just consecutive duplicates.

select-prompt

If this is set for the default tag, its value will be displayed during menu selection (see the menu style
above) when the completion list does not fit on the screen as a whole. The same escapes as for the
list-prompt style are understood, except that the numbers refer to the match or line the mark is on.
A default prompt is used when the value is the empty string.

select-scroll

This style is tested for the default tag and determines how a completion list is scrolled during a
menu selection (see the menu style above) when the completion list does not fit on the screen as a
whole. If the value is ‘0’ (zero), the list is scrolled by half-screenfuls; if it is a positive integer, the list is
scrolled by the given number of lines; if it is a negative number, the list is scrolled by a screenful
minus the absolute value of the given number of lines. The default is to scroll by single lines.

separate-sections

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 346 of 616
:
This style is used with the manuals tag when completing names of manual pages. If it is ‘true’, entries
for different sections are added separately using tag names of the form ‘manuals. X ’, where X is the
section number. When the group-name style is also in effect, pages from different sections will
appear separately. This style is also used similarly with the words style when completing words for
the dict command. It allows words from different dictionary databases to be added separately. See
also insert-sections.

The default for this style is ‘false’.

show-ambiguity

If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to highlight the first ambiguous
character in completion lists. The value is either a color indication such as those supported by the
list-colors style or, with a value of ‘true’, a default of underlining is selected. The highlighting is only
applied if the completion display strings correspond to the actual matches.

show-completer

Tested whenever a new completer is tried. If it is ‘true’, the completion system outputs a progress
message in the listing area showing what completer is being tried. The message will be overwritten
by any output when completions are found and is removed after completion is finished.

single-ignored

This is used by the _ignored completer when there is only one match. If its value is ‘show’, the single
match will be displayed but not inserted. If the value is ‘menu’, then the single match and the original
string are both added as matches and menu completion is started, making it easy to select either of
them.

sort

This allows the standard ordering of matches to be overridden.

If its value is ‘true’ or ‘false’, sorting is enabled or disabled. Additionally the values associated with the
‘-o’ option to compadd can also be listed: match, nosort, numeric, reverse. If it is not set for the
context, the standard behaviour of the calling widget is used.

The style is tested first against the full context including the tag, and if that fails to produce a value
against the context without the tag.

In many cases where a calling widget explicitly selects a particular ordering in lieu of the default, a
value of ‘true’ is not honoured. An example of where this is not the case is for command history
where the default of sorting matches chronologically may be overridden by setting the style to ‘true’.

In the _expand completer, if it is set to ‘true’, the expansions generated will always be sorted. If it is
set to ‘menu’, then the expansions are only sorted when they are offered as single strings but not in
the string containing all possible expansions.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 347 of 616
:
special-dirs

Normally, the completion code will not produce the directory names ‘.’ and ‘..’ as possible
completions. If this style is set to ‘true’, it will add both ‘.’ and ‘..’ as possible completions; if it is set to
‘..’, only ‘..’ will be added.

The following example sets special-dirs to ‘..’ when the current prefix is empty, is a single ‘.’, or
consists only of a path beginning with ‘../’. Otherwise the value is ‘false’.

zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \


'[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'

squeeze-slashes

If set to ‘true’, sequences of slashes in filename paths (for example in ‘foo//bar’) will be treated as a
single slash. This is the usual behaviour of UNIX paths. However, by default the file completion
function behaves as if there were a ‘*’ between the slashes.

stop

If set to ‘true’, the _history_complete_word bindable command will stop once when reaching the
beginning or end of the history. Invoking _history_complete_word will then wrap around to the
opposite end of the history. If this style is set to ‘false’ (the default), _history_complete_word will loop
immediately as in a menu completion.

strip-comments

If set to ‘true’, this style causes non-essential comment text to be removed from completion
matches. Currently it is only used when completing e-mail addresses where it removes any display
name from the addresses, cutting them down to plain user@host form.

subst-globs-only

This is used by the _expand completer. If it is set to ‘true’, the expansion will only be used if it
resulted from globbing; hence, if expansions resulted from the use of the substitute style described
below, but these were not further changed by globbing, the expansions will be rejected.

The default for this style is ‘false’.

substitute

This boolean style controls whether the _expand completer will first try to expand all substitutions in
the string (such as ‘$( ... )’ and ‘${ ... }’).

The default is ‘true’.

suffix

This is used by the _expand completer if the word starts with a tilde or contains a parameter
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 348 of 616
:
expansion. If it is set to ‘true’, the word will only be expanded if it doesn’t have a suffix, i.e. if it is
something like ‘~foo’ or ‘$foo’ rather than ‘~foo/’ or ‘$foo/bar’, unless that suffix itself contains
characters eligible for expansion. The default for this style is ‘true’.

tag-order

This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available in a particular context will be used.

The values for the style are sets of space-separated lists of tags. The tags in each value will be tried
at the same time; if no match is found, the next value is used. (See the file-patterns style for an
exception to this behavior.)

For example:

zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*:*' tag-order \


'commands functions'

specifies that completion in command position first offers external commands and shell functions.
Remaining tags will be tried if no completions are found.

In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take one of the following forms:

-
If any value consists of only a hyphen, then only the tags specified in the other values are generated.
Normally all tags not explicitly selected are tried last if the specified tags fail to generate any
matches. This means that a single value consisting only of a single hyphen turns off completion.

! tags ...
A string starting with an exclamation mark specifies names of tags that are not to be used. The effect
is the same as if all other possible tags for the context had been listed.

tag : label ...


Here, tag is one of the standard tags and label is an arbitrary name. Matches are generated as
normal but the name label is used in contexts instead of tag . This is not useful in words starting
with !.

If the label starts with a hyphen, the tag is prepended to the label to form the name used for
lookup. This can be used to make the completion system try a certain tag more than once, supplying
different style settings for each attempt; see below for an example.

tag : label : description


As before, but description will replace the ‘%d’ in the value of the format style instead of the default
description supplied by the completion function. Spaces in the description must be quoted with a
backslash. A ‘%d’ appearing in description is replaced with the description given by the completion
function.

In any of the forms above the tag may be a pattern or several patterns in the form

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 349 of 616
:
‘{ pat1 , pat2... }’. In this case all matching tags will be used except for any given explicitly in the
same string.

One use of these features is to try one tag more than once, setting other styles differently on each
attempt, but still to use all the other tags without having to repeat them all. For example, to make
completion of function names in command position ignore all the completion functions starting with
an underscore the first time completion is tried:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:*' tag-order \


'functions:-non-comp *' functions
zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' \
ignored-patterns '_*'

On the first attempt, all tags will be offered but the functions tag will be replaced by functions-non-
comp. The ignored-patterns style is set for this tag to exclude functions starting with an underscore.
If there are no matches, the second value of the tag-order style is used which completes functions
using the default tag, this time presumably including all function names.

The matches for one tag can be split into different groups. For example:

zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \


'options:-long:long\ options
options:-short:short\ options
options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'
zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' \
ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' \
ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' \
ignored-patterns '???*'

With the group-names style set, options beginning with ‘--’, options beginning with a single ‘-’ or ‘+’
but containing multiple characters, and single-letter options will be displayed in separate groups
with different descriptions.

Another use of patterns is to try multiple match specifications one after another. The matcher-list
style offers something similar, but it is tested very early in the completion system and hence can’t be
set for single commands nor for more specific contexts. Here is how to try normal completion
without any match specification and, if that generates no matches, try again with case-insensitive
matching, restricting the effect to arguments of the command foo:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'


zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'

First, all the tags offered when completing after foo are tried using the normal tag name. If that
generates no matches, the second value of tag-order is used, which tries all tags again except that
this time each has -case appended to its name for lookup of styles. Hence this time the value for the
matcher style from the second call to zstyle in the example is used to make completion case-
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 350 of 616
:
insensitive.

It is possible to use the -e option of the zstyle builtin command to specify conditions for the use of
particular tags. For example:

zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '


if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
reply=( )
else
reply=( - )
fi'

Completion in command position will be attempted only if the string typed so far is not empty. This
is tested using the PREFIX special parameter; see Completion Widgets for a description of
parameters which are special inside completion widgets. Setting reply to an empty array provides
the default behaviour of trying all tags at once; setting it to an array containing only a hyphen
disables the use of all tags and hence of all completions.

If no tag-order style has been defined for a context, the strings ‘(|*-)argument-* (|*-)option-* values’
and ‘options’ plus all tags offered by the completion function will be used to provide a sensible
default behavior that causes arguments (whether normal command arguments or arguments of
options) to be completed before option names for most commands.

urls

This is used together with the urls tag by functions completing URLs.

If the value consists of more than one string, or if the only string does not name a file or directory,
the strings are used as the URLs to complete.

If the value contains only one string which is the name of a normal file the URLs are taken from that
file (where the URLs may be separated by white space or newlines).

Finally, if the only string in the value names a directory, the directory hierarchy rooted at this
directory gives the completions. The top level directory should be the file access method, such as
‘http’, ‘ftp’, ‘bookmark’ and so on. In many cases the next level of directories will be a filename. The
directory hierarchy can descend as deep as necessary.

For example,

zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls


mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub

allows completion of all the components of the URL ‘netscape’ or ‘lynx’. Note, however, that access
methods and files are completed separately, so if the hosts style is set hosts can be completed
without reference to the urls style.

See the description in the function _urls itself for more information (e.g. ‘more $^fpath/_urls(N)’).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 351 of 616
:
use-cache

If this is set, the completion caching layer is activated for any completions which use it (via the
_store_cache, _retrieve_cache, and _cache_invalid functions). The directory containing the cache files
can be changed with the cache-path style.

use-compctl

If this style is set to a string not equal to false, 0, no, and off, the completion system may use any
completion specifications defined with the compctl builtin command. If the style is unset, this is
done only if the zsh/compctl module is loaded. The string may also contain the substring ‘first’ to use
completions defined with ‘compctl -T’, and the substring ‘default’ to use the completion defined with
‘compctl -D’.

Note that this is only intended to smooth the transition from compctl to the new completion system
and may disappear in the future.

Note also that the definitions from compctl will only be used if there is no specific completion
function for the command in question. For example, if there is a function _foo to complete
arguments to the command foo, compctl will never be invoked for foo. However, the compctl
version will be tried if foo only uses default completion.

use-ip

By default, the function _hosts that completes host names strips IP addresses from entries read
from host databases such as NIS and ssh files. If this style is ‘true’, the corresponding IP addresses
can be completed as well. This style is not use in any context where the hosts style is set; note also it
must be set before the cache of host names is generated (typically the first completion attempt).

users

This may be set to a list of usernames to be completed. If it is not set all usernames will be
completed. Note that if it is set only that list of users will be completed; this is because on some
systems querying all users can take a prohibitive amount of time.

users-hosts

The values of this style should be of the form ‘ user @ host ’ or ‘ user : host ’. It is used for commands
that need pairs of user- and hostnames. These commands will complete usernames from this style
(only), and will restrict subsequent hostname completion to hosts paired with that user in one of the
values of the style.

It is possible to group values for sets of commands which allow a remote login, such as rlogin and
ssh, by using the my-accounts tag. Similarly, values for sets of commands which usually refer to the
accounts of other people, such as talk and finger, can be grouped by using the other-accounts tag.
More ambivalent commands may use the accounts tag.

users-hosts-ports

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 352 of 616
:
Like users-hosts but used for commands like telnet and containing strings of the form
‘ user @ host : port ’.

verbose

If set, as it is by default, the completion listing is more verbose. In particular many commands show
descriptions for options if this style is ‘true’.

word

This is used by the _list completer, which prevents the insertion of completions until a second
completion attempt when the line has not changed. The normal way of finding out if the line has
changed is to compare its entire contents between the two occasions. If this style is ‘true’, the
comparison is instead performed only on the current word. Hence if completion is performed on
another word with the same contents, completion will not be delayed.

20.4 Control Functions


The initialization script compinit redefines all the widgets which perform completion to call the
supplied widget function _main_complete. This function acts as a wrapper calling the so-called
‘completer’ functions that generate matches. If _main_complete is called with arguments, these are
taken as the names of completer functions to be called in the order given. If no arguments are given,
the set of functions to try is taken from the completer style. For example, to use normal completion
and correction if that doesn’t generate any matches:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct

after calling compinit. The default value for this style is ‘_complete _ignored’, i.e. normally only
ordinary completion is tried, first with the effect of the ignored-patterns style and then without it.
The _main_complete function uses the return status of the completer functions to decide if other
completers should be called. If the return status is zero, no other completers are tried and the
_main_complete function returns.

If the first argument to _main_complete is a single hyphen, the arguments will not be taken as
names of completers. Instead, the second argument gives a name to use in the completer field of
the context and the other arguments give a command name and arguments to call to generate the
matches.

The following completer functions are contained in the distribution, although users may write their
own. Note that in contexts the leading underscore is stripped, for example basic completion is
performed in the context ‘:completion::complete: ... ’.

_all_matches

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 353 of 616
:
This completer can be used to add a string consisting of all other matches. As it influences later
completers it must appear as the first completer in the list. The list of all matches is affected by the
avoid-completer and old-matches styles described above.

It may be useful to use the _generic function described below to bind _all_matches to its own
keystroke, for example:

zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic


bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches

Note that this does not generate completions by itself: first use any of the standard ways of
generating a list of completions, then use ^Xa to show all matches. It is possible instead to add a
standard completer to the list and request that the list of all matches should be directly inserted:

zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer \


_all_matches _complete
zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' insert true

In this case the old-matches style should not be set.

_approximate

This is similar to the basic _complete completer but allows the completions to undergo corrections.
The maximum number of errors can be specified by the max-errors style; see the description of
approximate matching in Filename Generation for how errors are counted. Normally this completer
will only be tried after the normal _complete completer:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate

This will give correcting completion if and only if normal completion yields no possible completions.
When corrected completions are found, the completer will normally start menu completion allowing
you to cycle through these strings.

This completer uses the tags corrections and original when generating the possible corrections and
the original string. The format style for the former may contain the additional sequences ‘%e’ and
‘%o’ which will be replaced by the number of errors accepted to generate the corrections and the
original string, respectively.

The completer progressively increases the number of errors allowed up to the limit by the max-
errors style, hence if a completion is found with one error, no completions with two errors will be
shown, and so on. It modifies the completer name in the context to indicate the number of errors
being tried: on the first try the completer field contains ‘approximate-1’, on the second try
‘approximate-2’, and so on.

When _approximate is called from another function, the number of errors to accept may be passed

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 354 of 616
:
with the -a option. The argument is in the same format as the max-errors style, all in one string.

Note that this completer (and the _correct completer mentioned below) can be quite expensive to
call, especially when a large number of errors are allowed. One way to avoid this is to set up the
completer style using the -e option to zstyle so that some completers are only used when
completion is attempted a second time on the same string, e.g.:

zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '


if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
_last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
else
reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
fi'

This uses the HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special parameters that are available
inside zle and completion widgets to find out if the command line hasn’t changed since the last time
completion was tried. Only then are the _ignored, _correct and _approximate completers called.

_canonical_paths [ -A var ] [ -N ] [ -MJV12nfX ] tag descr [ paths ... ]

This completion function completes all paths given to it, and also tries to offer completions which
point to the same file as one of the paths given (relative path when an absolute path is given, and
vice versa; when ..’s are present in the word to be completed; and some paths got from symlinks).

-A, if specified, takes the paths from the array variable specified. Paths can also be specified on the
command line as shown above. -N, if specified, prevents canonicalizing the paths given before using
them for completion, in case they are already so. The options -M, -J, -V, -1, -2, -n, -F, -X are passed to
compadd.

See _description for a description of tag and descr .

_cmdambivalent

Completes the remaining positional arguments as an external command. The external command
and its arguments are completed as separate arguments (in a manner appropriate for completing
/usr/bin/env) if there are two or more remaining positional arguments on the command line, and as
a quoted command string (in the manner of system(...)) otherwise. See also _cmdstring and
_precommand.

This function takes no arguments.

_cmdstring

Completes an external command as a single argument, as for system(...).

_complete

This completer generates all possible completions in a context-sensitive manner, i.e. using the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 355 of 616
:
settings defined with the compdef function explained above and the current settings of all special
parameters. This gives the normal completion behaviour.

To complete arguments of commands, _complete uses the utility function _normal, which is in turn
responsible for finding the particular function; it is described below. Various contexts of the form -
context - are handled specifically. These are all mentioned above as possible arguments to the
#compdef tag.

Before trying to find a function for a specific context, _complete checks if the parameter
‘compcontext’ is set. Setting ‘compcontext’ allows the usual completion dispatching to be overridden
which is useful in places such as a function that uses vared for input. If it is set to an array, the
elements are taken to be the possible matches which will be completed using the tag ‘values’ and
the description ‘value’. If it is set to an associative array, the keys are used as the possible
completions and the values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions for the matches. If ‘compcontext’
is set to a string containing colons, it should be of the form ‘ tag : descr : action ’. In this case the
tag and descr give the tag and description to use and the action indicates what should be
completed in one of the forms accepted by the _arguments utility function described below.

Finally, if ‘compcontext’ is set to a string without colons, the value is taken as the name of the
context to use and the function defined for that context will be called. For this purpose, there is a
special context named -command-line- that completes whole command lines (commands and their
arguments). This is not used by the completion system itself but is nonetheless handled when
explicitly called.

_correct

Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word; this is similar to _approximate but
will not allow any number of extra characters at the cursor as that completer does. The effect is
similar to spell-checking. It is based on _approximate, but the completer field in the context name is
correct.

For example, with:

zstyle ':completion:::::' completer \


_complete _correct _approximate
zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric

correction will accept up to two errors. If a numeric argument is given, correction will not be
performed, but correcting completion will be, and will accept as many errors as given by the numeric
argument. Without a numeric argument, first correction and then correcting completion will be tried,
with the first one accepting two errors and the second one accepting three errors.

When _correct is called as a function, the number of errors to accept may be given following the -a
option. The argument is in the same form a values to the accept style, all in one string.

This completer function is intended to be used without the _approximate completer or, as in the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 356 of 616
:
example, just before it. Using it after the _approximate completer is useless since _approximate will
at least generate the corrected strings generated by the _correct completer — and probably more.

_expand

This completer function does not really perform completion, but instead checks if the word on the
command line is eligible for expansion and, if it is, gives detailed control over how this expansion is
done. For this to happen, the completion system needs to be invoked with complete-word, not
expand-or-complete (the default binding for TAB), as otherwise the string will be expanded by the
shell’s internal mechanism before the completion system is started. Note also this completer should
be called before the _complete completer function.

The tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions for the string containing all possible
expansions, expansions when adding the possible expansions as single matches and original when
adding the original string from the line. The order in which these strings are generated, if at all, can
be controlled by the group-order and tag-order styles, as usual.

The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may contain the sequence ‘%o’ which will be
replaced by the original string from the line.

The kind of expansion to be tried is controlled by the substitute, glob and subst-globs-only styles.

It is also possible to call _expand as a function, in which case the different modes may be selected
with options: -s for substitute, -g for glob and -o for subst-globs-only.

_expand_alias

If the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and no other completers are called. The types
of aliases which are to be expanded can be controlled with the styles regular, global and disabled.

This function is also a bindable command, see Bindable Commands.

_extensions

If the cursor follows the string ‘*.’, filename extensions are completed. The extensions are taken
from files in current directory or a directory specified at the beginning of the current word. For exact
matches, completion continues to allow other completers such as _expand to expand the pattern.
The standard add-space and prefix-hidden styles are observed.

_external_pwds

Completes current directories of other zsh processes belonging to the current user.

This is intended to be used via _generic, bound to a custom key combination. Note that pattern
matching is enabled so matching is performed similar to how it works with the _match completer.

_history

Complete words from the shell’s command history. This completer can be controlled by the remove-

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 357 of 616
:
all-dups, and sort styles as for the _history_complete_word bindable command, see Bindable
Commands and Completion System Configuration.

_ignored

The ignored-patterns style can be set to a list of patterns which are compared against possible
completions; matching ones are removed. With this completer those matches can be reinstated, as
if no ignored-patterns style were set. The completer actually generates its own list of matches; which
completers are invoked is determined in the same way as for the _prefix completer. The single-
ignored style is also available as described above.

_list

This completer allows the insertion of matches to be delayed until completion is attempted a second
time without the word on the line being changed. On the first attempt, only the list of matches will
be shown. It is affected by the styles condition and word, see Completion System Configuration.

_match

This completer is intended to be used after the _complete completer. It behaves similarly but the
string on the command line may be a pattern to match against trial completions. This gives the
effect of the GLOB_COMPLETE option.

Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from the line, inserting a ‘*’ at the
cursor position and comparing the resulting pattern with the possible completions generated. This
can be modified with the match-original style described above.

The generated matches will be offered in a menu completion unless the insert-unambiguous style is
set to ‘true’; see the description above for other options for this style.

Note that matcher specifications defined globally or used by the completion functions (the styles
matcher-list and matcher) will not be used.

_menu

This completer was written as simple example function to show how menu effect of disabling menu
selection which can be useful with _generic based widgets. It should be used as the first completer in
the list. Note that this is independent of the setting of the MENU_COMPLETE option and does not
work with the other menu completion widgets such as reverse-menu-complete, or accept-and-
menu-complete.

_oldlist

This completer controls how the standard completion widgets behave when there is an existing list
of completions which may have been generated by a special completion (i.e. a separately-bound
completion command). It allows the ordinary completion keys to continue to use the list of
completions thus generated, instead of producing a new list of ordinary contextual completions. It
should appear in the list of completers before any of the widgets which generate matches. It uses

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 358 of 616
:
two styles: old-list and old-menu, see Completion System Configuration.

_precommand

Complete an external command in word-separated arguments, as for exec and /usr/bin/env.

_prefix

This completer can be used to try completion with the suffix (everything after the cursor) ignored. In
other words, the suffix will not be considered to be part of the word to complete. The effect is
similar to the expand-or-complete-prefix command.

The completer style is used to decide which other completers are to be called to generate matches.
If this style is unset, the list of completers set for the current context is used — except, of course, the
_prefix completer itself. Furthermore, if this completer appears more than once in the list of
completers only those completers not already tried by the last invocation of _prefix will be called.

For example, consider this global completer style:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer \


_complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo

Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring the suffix. If that doesn’t generate
any matches, and neither does the call to the _correct completer after it, _prefix will be called a
second time and, now only trying correction with the suffix ignored. On the second invocation the
completer part of the context appears as ‘foo’.

To use _prefix as the last resort and try only normal completion when it is invoked:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix


zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete

The add-space style is also respected. If it is set to ‘true’ then _prefix will insert a space between the
matches generated (if any) and the suffix.

Note that this completer is only useful if the COMPLETE_IN_WORD option is set; otherwise, the
cursor will be moved to the end of the current word before the completion code is called and hence
there will be no suffix.

_user_expand

This completer behaves similarly to the _expand completer but instead performs expansions
defined by users. The styles add-space and sort styles specific to the _expand completer are usable
with _user_expand in addition to other styles handled more generally by the completion system. The
tag all-expansions is also available.

The expansion depends on the array style user-expand being defined for the current context;
remember that the context for completers is less specific than that for contextual completion as the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 359 of 616
:
full context has not yet been determined. Elements of the array may have one of the following
forms:

$ hash
hash is the name of an associative array. Note this is not a full parameter expression, merely a $,
suitably quoted to prevent immediate expansion, followed by the name of an associative array. If
the trial expansion word matches a key in hash , the resulting expansion is the corresponding value.

_func
_func is the name of a shell function whose name must begin with _ but is not otherwise special to
the completion system. The function is called with the trial word as an argument. If the word is to be
expanded, the function should set the array reply to a list of expansions. Optionally, it can set REPLY
to a word that will be used as a description for the set of expansions. The return status of the
function is irrelevant.

20.5 Bindable Commands


In addition to the context-dependent completions provided, which are expected to work in an
intuitively obvious way, there are a few widgets implementing special behaviour which can be bound
separately to keys. The following is a list of these and their default bindings.

_bash_completions

This function is used by two widgets, _bash_complete-word and _bash_list-choices. It exists to


provide compatibility with completion bindings in bash. The last character of the binding determines
what is completed: ‘!’, command names; ‘$’, environment variables; ‘@’, host names; ‘/’, file names; ‘~’
user names. In bash, the binding preceded by ‘\e’ gives completion, and preceded by ‘^X’ lists
options. As some of these bindings clash with standard zsh bindings, only ‘\e~’ and ‘^X~’ are bound
by default. To add the rest, the following should be added to .zshrc after compinit has been run:

for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do


bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
done

This includes the bindings for ‘~’ in case they were already bound to something else; the completion
code does not override user bindings.

_correct_filename (^XC)

Correct the filename path at the cursor position. Allows up to six errors in the name. Can also be
called with an argument to correct a filename path, independently of zle; the correction is printed on
standard output.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 360 of 616
:
_correct_word (^Xc)

Performs correction of the current argument using the usual contextual completions as possible
choices. This stores the string ‘correct-word’ in the function field of the context name and then
calls the _correct completer.

_expand_alias (^Xa)

This function can be used as a completer and as a bindable command. It expands the word the
cursor is on if it is an alias. The types of alias expanded can be controlled with the styles regular,
global and disabled.

When used as a bindable command there is one additional feature that can be selected by setting
the complete style to ‘true’. In this case, if the word is not the name of an alias, _expand_alias tries to
complete the word to a full alias name without expanding it. It leaves the cursor directly after the
completed word so that invoking _expand_alias once more will expand the now-complete alias
name.

_expand_word (^Xe)

Performs expansion on the current word: equivalent to the standard expand-word command, but
using the _expand completer. Before calling it, the function field of the context is set to ‘expand-
word’.

_generic

This function is not defined as a widget and not bound by default. However, it can be used to define
a widget and will then store the name of the widget in the function field of the context and call the
completion system. This allows custom completion widgets with their own set of style settings to be
defined easily. For example, to define a widget that performs normal completion and starts menu
selection:

zle -C foo complete-word _generic


bindkey '...' foo
zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1

Note in particular that the completer style may be set for the context in order to change the set of
functions used to generate possible matches. If _generic is called with arguments, those are passed
through to _main_complete as the list of completers in place of those defined by the completer style.

_history_complete_word (\e/)

Complete words from the shell’s command history. This uses the list, remove-all-dups, sort, and stop
styles.

_most_recent_file (^Xm)

Complete the name of the most recently modified file matching the pattern on the command line

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 361 of 616
:
(which may be blank). If given a numeric argument N , complete the N th most recently modified file.
Note the completion, if any, is always unique.

_next_tags (^Xn)

This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next tag, or set of tags, either as given
by the tag-order style or as set by default; these matches would otherwise not be available.
Successive invocations of the command cycle through all possible sets of tags.

_read_comp (^X^R)

Prompt the user for a string, and use that to perform completion on the current word. There are two
possibilities for the string. First, it can be a set of words beginning ‘_’, for example ‘_files -/’, in which
case the function with any arguments will be called to generate the completions. Unambiguous
parts of the function name will be completed automatically (normal completion is not available at
this point) until a space is typed.

Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to compadd and should hence be an
expression specifying what should be completed.

A very restricted set of editing commands is available when reading the string: ‘DEL’ and ‘^H’ delete
the last character; ‘^U’ deletes the line, and ‘^C’ and ‘^G’ abort the function, while ‘RET’ accepts the
completion. Note the string is used verbatim as a command line, so arguments must be quoted in
accordance with standard shell rules.

Once a string has been read, the next call to _read_comp will use the existing string instead of
reading a new one. To force a new string to be read, call _read_comp with a numeric argument.

_complete_debug (^X?)

This widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a temporary file a trace of the shell
commands executed by the completion system. Each completion attempt gets its own file. A
command to view each of these files is pushed onto the editor buffer stack.

_complete_help (^Xh)

This widget displays information about the context names, the tags, and the completion functions
used when completing at the current cursor position. If given a numeric argument other than 1 (as
in ‘ESC-2 ^Xh’), then the styles used and the contexts for which they are used will be shown, too.

Note that the information about styles may be incomplete; it depends on the information available
from the completion functions called, which in turn is determined by the user’s own styles and other
settings.

_complete_help_generic

Unlike other commands listed here, this must be created as a normal ZLE widget rather than a
completion widget (i.e. with zle -N). It is used for generating help with a widget bound to the _generic

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 362 of 616
:
widget that is described above.

If this widget is created using the name of the function, as it is by default, then when executed it will
read a key sequence. This is expected to be bound to a call to a completion function that uses the
_generic widget. That widget will be executed, and information provided in the same format that the
_complete_help widget displays for contextual completion.

If the widget’s name contains debug, for example if it is created as ‘zle -N _complete_debug_generic
_complete_help_generic’, it will read and execute the keystring for a generic widget as before, but
then generate debugging information as done by _complete_debug for contextual completion.

If the widget’s name contains noread, it will not read a keystring but instead arrange that the next
use of a generic widget run in the same shell will have the effect as described above.

The widget works by setting the shell parameter ZSH_TRACE_GENERIC_WIDGET which is read by
_generic. Unsetting the parameter cancels any pending effect of the noread form.

For example, after executing the following:

zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic


bindkey '^x:' _complete_debug_generic

typing ‘C-x :’ followed by the key sequence for a generic widget will cause trace output for that
widget to be saved to a file.

_complete_tag (^Xt)

This widget completes symbol tags created by the etags or ctags programmes (note there is no
connection with the completion system’s tags) stored in a file TAGS, in the format used by etags, or
tags, in the format created by ctags. It will look back up the path hierarchy for the first occurrence of
either file; if both exist, the file TAGS is preferred. You can specify the full path to a TAGS or tags file
by setting the parameter $TAGSFILE or $tagsfile respectively. The corresponding completion tags
used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.

20.6 Utility Functions


Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writing completion functions. If
functions are installed in subdirectories, most of these reside in the Base subdirectory. Like the
example functions for commands in the distribution, the utility functions generating matches all
follow the convention of returning status zero if they generated completions and non-zero if no
matching completions could be added.

_absolute_command_paths

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 363 of 616
:
This function completes external commands as absolute paths (unlike _command_names -e which
completes their basenames). It takes no arguments.

_all_labels [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command arg ... ]

This is a convenient interface to the _next_label function below, implementing the loop shown in the
_next_label example. The command and its arguments are called to generate the matches. The
options stored in the parameter name will automatically be inserted into the arg s passed to the
command . Normally, they are put directly after the command , but if one of the arg s is a single
hyphen, they are inserted directly before that. If the hyphen is the last argument, it will be removed
from the argument list before the command is called. This allows _all_labels to be used in almost all
cases where the matches can be generated by a single call to the compadd builtin command or by a
call to one of the utility functions.

For example:

local expl
...
if _requested foo; then
...
_all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
fi

Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using compadd with additional options
which will take precedence over those generated by _all_labels.

_alternative [ -O name ] [ -C name ] spec ...

This function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags are available. Essentially it implements a
loop like the one described for the _tags function below.

The tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is requested are described using the spec s which
are of the form: ‘ tag : descr : action ’. The tag s are offered using _tags and if the tag is requested,
the action is executed with the given description descr . The action s are those accepted by the
_arguments function (described below), with the following exceptions:

The ‘-> state ’ and ‘= ... ’ forms are not supported.


The ‘((a\:bar b\:baz))’ form does not need the colon to be escaped, since the spec s have no
colon-separated fields after the action .

For example, the action may be a simple function call:

_alternative \
'users:user:_users' \
'hosts:host:_hosts'

offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches, generated by the _users and _hosts
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 364 of 616
:
functions respectively.

Like _arguments, this function uses _all_labels to execute the actions, which will loop over all sets of
tags. Special handling is only required if there is an additional valid tag, for example inside a function
called from _alternative.

The option ‘-O name ’ is used in the same way as by the _arguments function. In other words, the
elements of the name array will be passed to compadd when executing an action.

Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give a different name for the argument context
field.

_arguments [ -nswWCRS ] [ -A pat ] [ -O name ] [ -M matchspec ]

[ : ] spec ...

_arguments [ opt ... ] -- [ -l ] [ -i pats ] [ -s pair ]

[ helpspec ...]

This function can be used to give a complete specification for completion for a command whose
arguments follow standard UNIX option and argument conventions.

Options Overview

Options to _arguments itself must be in separate words, i.e. -s -w, not -sw. The options are followed
by spec s that describe options and arguments of the analyzed command. To avoid ambiguity, all
options to _arguments itself may be separated from the spec forms by a single colon.

The ‘--’ form is used to intuit spec forms from the help output of the command being analyzed, and
is described in detail below. The opts for the ‘--’ form are otherwise the same options as the first
form. Note that ‘-s’ following ‘--’ has a distinct meaning from ‘-s’ preceding ‘--’, and both may appear.

The option switches -s, -S, -A, -w, and -W affect how _arguments parses the analyzed command line’s
options. These switches are useful for commands with standard argument parsing.

The options of _arguments have the following meanings:

-n
With this option, _arguments sets the parameter NORMARG to the position of the first normal
argument in the $words array, i.e. the position after the end of the options. If that argument has not
been reached, NORMARG is set to -1. The caller should declare ‘integer NORMARG’ if the -n option is
passed; otherwise the parameter is not used.

-s
Enable option stacking for single-letter options, whereby multiple single-letter options may be
combined into a single word. For example, the two options ‘-x’ and ‘-y’ may be combined into a single
word ‘-xy’. By default, every word corresponds to a single option name (‘-xy’ is a single option named
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 365 of 616
:
‘xy’).

Options beginning with a single hyphen or plus sign are eligible for stacking; words beginning with
two hyphens are not.

Note that -s after -- has a different meaning, which is documented in the segment entitled ‘Deriving
spec forms from the help output’.

-w
In combination with -s, allow option stacking even if one or more of the options take arguments. For
example, if -x takes an argument, with no -s, ‘-xy’ is considered as a single (unhandled) option; with -
s, -xy is an option with the argument ‘y’; with both -s and -w, -xy is the option -x and the option -y
with arguments to -x (and to -y, if it takes arguments) still to come in subsequent words.

-W
This option takes -w a stage further: it is possible to complete single-letter options even after an
argument that occurs in the same word. However, it depends on the action performed whether
options will really be completed at this point. For more control, use a utility function like _guard as
part of the action.

-C
Modify the curcontext parameter for an action of the form ‘-> state ’. This is discussed in detail
below.

-R
Return status 300 instead of zero when a $state is to be handled, in the ‘-> string ’ syntax.

-S
Do not complete options after a ‘--’ appearing on the line, and ignore the ‘--’. For example, with -S, in
the line

foobar -x -- -y

the ‘-x’ is considered an option, the ‘-y’ is considered an argument, and the ‘--’ is considered to be
neither.

-A pat
Do not complete options after the first non-option argument on the line. pat is a pattern matching
all strings which are not to be taken as arguments. For example, to make _arguments stop
completing options after the first normal argument, but ignoring all strings starting with a hyphen
even if they are not described by one of the optspec s, the form is ‘-A "-*"’.

-O name
Pass the elements of the array name as arguments to functions called to execute action s. This is
discussed in detail below.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 366 of 616
:
-M matchspec
Use the match specification matchspec for completing option names and values. The default
matchspec allows partial word completion after ‘_’ and ‘-’, such as completing ‘-f-b’ to ‘-foo-bar’. The
default matchspec is:

r:|[_-]=* r:|=*

-0
When populating values of the ‘opt_args’ associative array, don’t backslash-escape colons and
backslashes and use NUL rather than colon for joining multiple values. This option is described in
more detail below, under the heading spec s: actions.

spec s: overview

Each of the following forms is a spec describing individual sets of options or arguments on the
command line being analyzed.

n : message : action
n :: message : action
This describes the n ’th normal argument. The message will be printed above the matches
generated and the action indicates what can be completed in this position (see below). If there are
two colons before the message the argument is optional. If the message contains only white space,
nothing will be printed above the matches unless the action adds an explanation string itself.

: message : action
:: message : action
Similar, but describes the next argument, whatever number that happens to be. If all arguments are
specified in this form in the correct order the numbers are unnecessary.

*: message : action
*:: message : action
*::: message : action
This describes how arguments (usually non-option arguments, those not beginning with - or +) are
to be completed when neither of the first two forms was provided. Any number of arguments can be
completed in this fashion.

With two colons before the message , the words special array and the CURRENT special parameter
are modified to refer only to the normal arguments when the action is executed or evaluated. With
three colons before the message they are modified to refer only to the normal arguments covered
by this description.

optspec
optspec : ...
This describes an option. The colon indicates handling for one or more arguments to the option; if it

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 367 of 616
:
is not present, the option is assumed to take no arguments.

The following forms are available for the initial optspec , whether or not the option has arguments.

* optspec
Here optspec is one of the remaining forms below. This indicates the following optspec may be
repeated. Otherwise if the corresponding option is already present on the command line to the left
of the cursor it will not be offered again.

- optname
+ optname
In the simplest form the optspec is just the option name beginning with a minus or a plus sign,
such as ‘-foo’. The first argument for the option (if any) must follow as a separate word directly after
the option.

Either of ‘-+ optname ’ and ‘+- optname ’ can be used to specify that - optname and + optname are both
valid.

In all the remaining forms, the leading ‘-’ may be replaced by or paired with ‘+’ in this way.

- optname -
The first argument of the option must come directly after the option name in the same word. For
example, ‘-foo-: ... ’ specifies that the completed option and argument will look like ‘-foo arg ’.

- optname +
The first argument may appear immediately after optname in the same word, or may appear as a
separate word after the option. For example, ‘-foo+: ... ’ specifies that the completed option and
argument will look like either ‘-foo arg ’ or ‘-foo arg ’.

- optname =
The argument may appear as the next word, or in same word as the option name provided that it is
separated from it by an equals sign, for example ‘-foo= arg ’ or ‘-foo arg ’.

- optname =-
The argument to the option must appear after an equals sign in the same word, and may not be
given in the next argument.

optspec [ explanation ]
An explanation string may be appended to any of the preceding forms of optspec by enclosing it in
brackets, as in ‘-q[query operation]’.

The verbose style is used to decide whether the explanation strings are displayed with the option in
a completion listing.

If no bracketed explanation string is given but the auto-description style is set and only one
argument is described for this optspec , the value of the style is displayed, with any appearance of

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 368 of 616
:
the sequence ‘%d’ in it replaced by the message of the first optarg that follows the optspec ; see
below.

It is possible for options with a literal ‘+’ or ‘=’ to appear, but that character must be quoted, for
example ‘-\+’.

Each optarg following an optspec must take one of the following forms:

: message : action
:: message : action
An argument to the option; message and action are treated as for ordinary arguments. In the first
form, the argument is mandatory, and in the second form it is optional.

This group may be repeated for options which take multiple arguments. In other words,
: message1 : action1 : message2 : action2 specifies that the option takes two arguments.

:* pattern : message : action


:* pattern :: message : action
:* pattern ::: message : action
This describes multiple arguments. Only the last optarg for an option taking multiple arguments
may be given in this form. If the pattern is empty (i.e. :*:), all the remaining words on the line are to
be completed as described by the action ; otherwise, all the words up to and including a word
matching the pattern are to be completed using the action .

Multiple colons are treated as for the ‘*: ... ’ forms for ordinary arguments: when the message is
preceded by two colons, the words special array and the CURRENT special parameter are modified
during the execution or evaluation of the action to refer only to the words after the option. When
preceded by three colons, they are modified to refer only to the words covered by this description.

Any literal colon in an optname , message , or action must be preceded by a backslash, ‘\:’.

Each of the forms above may be preceded by a list in parentheses of option names and argument
numbers. If the given option is on the command line, the options and arguments indicated in
parentheses will not be offered. For example, ‘(-two -three 1)-one: ... ’ completes the option ‘-one’; if
this appears on the command line, the options -two and -three and the first ordinary argument will
not be completed after it. ‘(-foo): ... ’ specifies an ordinary argument completion; -foo will not be
completed if that argument is already present.

Other items may appear in the list of excluded options to indicate various other items that should
not be applied when the current specification is matched: a single star (*) for the rest arguments (i.e.
a specification of the form ‘*: ... ’); a colon (:) for all normal (non-option-) arguments; and a hyphen
(-) for all options. For example, if ‘(*)’ appears before an option and the option appears on the
command line, the list of remaining arguments completed.

To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any of the forms above with ‘!’; then the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 369 of 616
:
form will no longer be completed, although if the option or argument appears on the command line
they will be skipped as normal. The main use for this is when the arguments are given by an array,
and _arguments is called repeatedly for more specific contexts: on the first call ‘_arguments
$global_options’ is used, and on subsequent calls ‘_arguments !$^global_options’.

spec s: actions

In each of the forms above the action determines how completions should be generated. Except
for the ‘-> string ’ form below, the action will be executed by calling the _all_labels function to
process all tag labels. No special handling of tags is needed unless a function call introduces a new
one.

The functions called to execute action s will be called with the elements of the array named by the ‘-
O name ’ option as arguments. This can be used, for example, to pass the same set of options for the
compadd builtin to all action s.

The forms for action are as follows.

(single unquoted space)


This is useful where an argument is required but it is not possible or desirable to generate matches
for it. The message will be displayed but no completions listed. Note that even in this case the colon
at the end of the message is needed; it may only be omitted when neither a message nor an
action is given.

( item1 item2 ... )


One of a list of possible matches, for example:

:foo:(foo bar baz)

(( item1 \: desc1 ... ))


Similar to the above, but with descriptions for each possible match. Note the backslash before the
colon. For example,

:foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))

The matches will be listed together with their descriptions if the description style is set with the
values tag in the context.

-> string

In this form, _arguments processes the arguments and options and then returns control to the
calling function with parameters set to indicate the state of processing; the calling function then
makes its own arrangements for generating completions. For example, functions that implement a
state machine can use this type of action.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 370 of 616
:
Where _arguments encounters action in the ‘-> string ’ format, it will strip all leading and trailing
whitespace from string and set the array state to the set of all string s for which an action is to
be performed. The elements of the array state_descr are assigned the corresponding message field
from each optarg containing such an action .

By default and in common with all other well behaved completion functions, _arguments returns
status zero if it was able to add matches and non-zero otherwise. However, if the -R option is given,
_arguments will instead return a status of 300 to indicate that $state is to be handled.

In addition to $state and $state_descr, _arguments also sets the global parameters ‘context’, ‘line’
and ‘opt_args’ as described below, and does not reset any changes made to the special parameters
such as PREFIX and words. This gives the calling function the choice of resetting these parameters or
propagating changes in them.

A function calling _arguments with at least one action containing a ‘-> string ’ must therefore
declare appropriate local parameters:

local context state state_descr line


typeset -A opt_args

to prevent _arguments from altering the global environment.

{ eval-string }

A string in braces is evaluated as shell code to generate matches. If the eval-string itself does not
begin with an opening parenthesis or brace it is split into separate words before execution.

= action
If the action starts with ‘= ’ (an equals sign followed by a space), _arguments will insert the contents
of the argument field of the current context as the new first element in the words special array and
increment the value of the CURRENT special parameter. This has the effect of inserting a dummy
word onto the completion command line while not changing the point at which completion is taking
place.

This is most useful with one of the specifiers that restrict the words on the command line on which
the action is to operate (the two- and three-colon forms above). One particular use is when an
action itself causes _arguments on a restricted range; it is necessary to use this trick to insert an
appropriate command name into the range for the second call to _arguments to be able to parse
the line.

word...
word...
This covers all forms other than those above. If the action starts with a space, the remaining list of
words will be invoked unchanged.

Otherwise it will be invoked with some extra strings placed after the first word; these are to be
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 371 of 616
:
passed down as options to the compadd builtin. They ensure that the state specified by _arguments,
in particular the descriptions of options and arguments, is correctly passed to the completion
command. These additional arguments are taken from the array parameter ‘expl’; this will be set up
before executing the action and hence may be referred to inside it, typically in an expansion of the
form ‘$expl[@]’ which preserves empty elements of the array.

During the performance of the action the array ‘line’ will be set to the normal arguments from the
command line, i.e. the words from the command line after the command name excluding all options
and their arguments. Options are stored in the associative array ‘opt_args’ with option names as
keys and their arguments as the values. By default, all colons and backslashes in the value are
escaped with backslashes, and if an option has multiple arguments (for example, when using an
optspec of the form ‘* optspec ’), they are joined with (unescaped) colons. However, if the -0 option
was passed, no backslash escaping is performed, and multiple values are joined with NUL bytes. For
example, after ‘zsh -o foo:foo -o bar:bar -o <TAB>’, the contents of ‘opt_args’ would be

typeset -A opt_args=( [-o]='foo\:foo:bar\:bar:' )

by default, and

typeset -A opt_args=( [-o]=$'foo:foo\x00bar:bar\x00' )

if _arguments had been called with the -0 option.

The parameter ‘context’ is set when returning to the calling function to perform an action of the
form ‘-> string ’. It is set to an array of elements corresponding to the elements of $state. Each
string of the form ‘option -opt - n ’ for the n ’th argument of the option -opt , or a string of the form
‘argument- n ’ for the n ’th argument. For ‘rest’ arguments, that is those in the list at the end not
handled by position, n is the string ‘rest’. For example, when completing the argument of the -o
option, the name is ‘option-o-1’, while for the second normal (non-option-) argument it is ‘argument-
2’.

Furthermore, during the evaluation of the action the context name in the curcontext parameter is
altered to append the same string that is stored in the context parameter.

The option -C tells _arguments to modify the curcontext parameter for an action of the form ‘-
> state ’. This is the standard parameter used to keep track of the current context. Here it (and not
the context array) should be made local to the calling function to avoid passing back the modified
value and should be initialised to the current value at the start of the function:

local curcontext="$curcontext"

This is useful where it is not possible for multiple states to be valid together.

Grouping Options

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 372 of 616
:
Options can be grouped to simplify exclusion lists. A group is introduced with ‘+’ followed by a name
for the group in the subsequent word. Whole groups can then be referenced in an exclusion list or a
group name can be used to disambiguate between two forms of the same option. For example:

_arguments \
'(group2--x)-a' \
+ group1 \
-m \
'(group2)-n' \
+ group2 \
-x -y

If the name of a group is specified in the form ‘( name )’ then only one value from that group will ever
be completed; more formally, all specifications are mutually exclusive to all other specifications in
that group. This is useful for defining options that are aliases for each other. For example:

_arguments \
-a -b \
+ '(operation)' \
{-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
{-d,--decompress}'[decompress]' \
{-l,--list}'[list]'

If an option in a group appears on the command line, it is stored in the associative array ‘opt_args’
with ’ group - option ’ as a key. In the example above, a key ‘operation–c’ is used if the option ‘-c’ is
present on the command line.

Specifying Multiple Sets of Arguments

It is possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments with the sets separated by single
hyphens. This differs from groups in that sets are considered to be mutually exclusive of each other.

Specifications before the first set and from any group are common to all sets. For example:

_arguments \
-a \
- set1 \
-c \
- set2 \
-d \
':arg:(x2 y2)'

This defines two sets. When the command line contains the option ‘-c’, the ‘-d’ option and the
argument will not be considered possible completions. When it contains ‘-d’ or an argument, the
option ‘-c’ will not be considered. However, after ‘-a’ both sets will still be considered valid.

As for groups, the name of a set may appear in exclusion lists, either alone or preceding a normal
option or argument specification.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 373 of 616
:
The completion code has to parse the command line separately for each set. This can be slow so
sets should only be used when necessary. A useful alternative is often an option specification with
rest-arguments (as in ‘-foo:*:...’); here the option -foo swallows up all remaining arguments as
described by the optarg definitions.

Deriving spec forms from the help output

The option ‘--’ allows _arguments to work out the names of long options that support the ‘--help’
option which is standard in many GNU commands. The command word is called with the argument
‘--help’ and the output examined for option names. Clearly, it can be dangerous to pass this to
commands which may not support this option as the behaviour of the command is unspecified.

In addition to options, ‘_arguments --’ will try to deduce the types of arguments available for options
when the form ‘-- opt = val ’ is valid. It is also possible to provide hints by examining the help text of
the command and adding helpspec of the form ‘ pattern : message : action ’; note that other
_arguments spec forms are not used. The pattern is matched against the help text for an option,
and if it matches the message and action are used as for other argument specifiers. The special
case of ‘*:’ means both message and action are empty, which has the effect of causing options
having no description in the help output to be ordered in listings ahead of options that have a
description.

For example:

_arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \


'*=FILE*:file:_files' \
'*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
'*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'

Here, ‘yes’ and ‘no’ will be completed as the argument of options whose description ends in a star;
file names will be completed for options that contain the substring ‘=FILE’ in the description; and
directories will be completed for options whose description contains ‘=DIR’ or ‘=PATH’. The last three
are in fact the default and so need not be given explicitly, although it is possible to override the use
of these patterns. A typical help text which uses this feature is:

-C, --directory=DIR change to directory DIR

so that the above specifications will cause directories to be completed after ‘--directory’, though not
after ‘-C’.

Note also that _arguments tries to find out automatically if the argument for an option is optional.
This can be specified explicitly by doubling the colon before the message .

If the pattern ends in ‘(-)’, this will be removed from the pattern and the action will be used only
directly after the ‘=’, not in the next word. This is the behaviour of a normal specification defined with
the form ‘=-’.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 374 of 616
:
By default, the command (with the option ‘–help’) is run after resetting all the locale categories
(except for LC_CTYPE) to ‘C’. If the localized help output is known to work, the option ‘-l’ can be
specified after the ‘_arguments --’ so that the command is run in the current locale.

The ‘_arguments --’ can be followed by the option ‘-i patterns ’ to give patterns for options which are
not to be completed. The patterns can be given as the name of an array parameter or as a literal list
in parentheses. For example,

_arguments -- -i \
"(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"

will cause completion to ignore the options ‘--enable-FEATURE’ and ‘--disable-FEATURE’ (this example
is useful with GNU configure).

The ‘_arguments --’ form can also be followed by the option ‘-s pair ’ to describe option aliases. The
pair consists of a list of alternating patterns and corresponding replacements, enclosed in parens
and quoted so that it forms a single argument word in the _arguments call.

For example, some configure-script help output describes options only as ‘--enable-foo’, but the
script also accepts the negated form ‘--disable-foo’. To allow completion of the second form:

_arguments -- -s "((#s)--enable- --disable-)"

Miscellaneous notes

Finally, note that _arguments generally expects to be the primary function handling any completion
for which it is used. It may have side effects which change the treatment of any matches added by
other functions called after it. To combine _arguments with other functions, those functions should
be called either before _arguments, as an action within a spec , or in handlers for ‘-> state ’
actions.

Here is a more general example of the use of _arguments:

_arguments '-l+:left border:' \


'-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
'*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
'*:page number:'

This describes three options: ‘-l’, ‘-format’, and ‘-copy’. The first takes one argument described as
‘ left border ’ for which no completion will be offered because of the empty action. Its argument
may come directly after the ‘-l’ or it may be given as the next word on the line.

The ‘-format’ option takes one argument in the next word, described as ‘ paper size ’ for which only
the strings ‘letter’ and ‘A4’ will be completed.

The ‘-copy’ option may appear more than once on the command line and takes two arguments. The
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 375 of 616
:
first is mandatory and will be completed as a filename. The second is optional (because of the
second colon before the description ‘ resolution ’) and will be completed from the strings ‘300’ and
‘600’.

The last two descriptions say what should be completed as arguments. The first describes the first
argument as a ‘ postscript file ’ and makes files ending in ‘ps’ or ‘eps’ be completed. The last
description gives all other arguments the description ‘ page number ’ but does not offer completions.

_cache_invalid cache_identifier

This function returns status zero if the completions cache corresponding to the given cache
identifier needs rebuilding. It determines this by looking up the cache-policy style for the current
context. This should provide a function name which is run with the full path to the relevant cache file
as the only argument.

Example:

_example_caching_policy () {
# rebuild if cache is more than a week old
local -a oldp
oldp=( "$1"(Nm+7) )
(( $#oldp ))
}

_call_function return name [ arg ... ]

If a function name exists, it is called with the arguments arg s. The return argument gives the
name of a parameter in which the return status from the function name should be stored; if return
is empty or a single hyphen it is ignored.

The return status of _call_function itself is zero if the function name exists and was called and non-
zero otherwise.

_call_program [ -l ] [ -p ] tag string ...

This function provides a mechanism for the user to override the use of an external command. It
looks up the command style with the supplied tag . If the style is set, its value is used as the
command to execute. The string s from the call to _call_program, or from the style if set, are
concatenated with spaces between them and the resulting string is evaluated. The return status is
the return status of the command called.

By default, the command is run in an environment where all the locale categories (except for
LC_CTYPE) are reset to ‘C’ by calling the utility function _comp_locale (see below). If the option ‘-l’ is
given, the command is run with the current locale.

If the option ‘-p’ is supplied it indicates that the command output is influenced by the permissions it
is run with. If the gain-privileges style is set to true, _call_program will make use of commands such

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 376 of 616
:
as sudo, if present on the command-line, to match the permissions to whatever the final command
is likely to run under. When looking up the gain-privileges and command styles, the command
component of the zstyle context will end with a slash (‘/’) followed by the command that would be
used to gain privileges.

_combination [ -s pattern ] tag style spec ... field opts ...

This function is used to complete combinations of values, for example pairs of hostnames and
usernames. The style argument gives the style which defines the pairs; it is looked up in a context
with the tag specified.

The style name consists of field names separated by hyphens, for example ‘users-hosts-ports’. For
each field for a value is already known, a spec of the form ‘ field = pattern ’ is given. For example,
if the command line so far specifies a user ‘pws’, the argument ‘users=pws’ should appear.

The next argument with no equals sign is taken as the name of the field for which completions
should be generated (presumably not one of the field s for which the value is known).

The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style. These should contain the possible
values for the combinations in the appropriate order (users, hosts, ports in the example above). The
values for the different fields are separated by colons. This can be altered with the option -s to
_combination which specifies a pattern. Typically this is a character class, as for example ‘-s "[:@]"’ in
the case of the users-hosts style. Each ‘ field = pattern ’ specification restricts the completions
which apply to elements of the style with appropriately matching fields.

If no style with the given name is defined for the given tag, or if none of the strings in style’s value
match, but a function name of the required field preceded by an underscore is defined, that function
will be called to generate the matches. For example, if there is no ‘users-hosts-ports’ or no matching
hostname when a host is required, the function ‘_hosts’ will automatically be called.

If the same name is used for more than one field, in both the ‘ field = pattern ’ and the argument
that gives the name of the field to be completed, the number of the field (starting with one) may be
given after the fieldname, separated from it by a colon.

All arguments after the required field name are passed to compadd when generating matches from
the style value, or to the functions for the fields if they are called.

_command_names [ -e | - ]

This function completes words that are valid at command position: names of aliases, builtins,
hashed commands, functions, and so on. With the -e flag, only hashed commands are completed.
The - flag is ignored.

_comp_locale

This function resets all the locale categories other than LC_CTYPE to ‘C’ so that the output from
external commands can be easily analyzed by the completion system. LC_CTYPE retains the current

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 377 of 616
:
value (taking LC_ALL and LANG into account), ensuring that non-ASCII characters in file names are
still handled properly.

This function should normally be run only in a subshell, because the new locale is exported to the
environment. Typical usage would be ‘$(_comp_locale; command ...)’.

_completers [ -p ]

This function completes names of completers.

-p
Include the leading underscore (‘_’) in the matches.

_default

This function corresponds to the -default- special context which is applied where no completion is
defined. It is useful to call it under certain error conditions such as completion after an unrecognised
subcommand. This applies the concept of graceful degradation to the completion system, allowing it
to fallback on basic completion of commonly useful things like filenames.

_describe [-12JVx] [ -oO | -t tag ] descr name1 [ name2 ] [ opt ... ]

[ -- name1 [ name2 ] [ opt ... ] ... ]

This function associates completions with descriptions. Multiple groups separated by -- can be
supplied, potentially with different completion options opt s.

The descr is taken as a string to display above the matches if the format style for the descriptions
tag is set. This is followed by one or two names of arrays followed by options to pass to compadd.
The array name1 contains the possible completions with their descriptions in the form
‘ completion : description ’. Any literal colons in completion must be quoted with a backslash. If a
name2 is given, it should have the same number of elements as name1 ; in this case the
corresponding elements are added as possible completions instead of the completion strings from
name1 . The completion list will retain the descriptions from name1 . Finally, a set of completion
options can appear.

If the option ‘-o’ appears before the first argument, the matches added will be treated as names of
command options (N.B. not shell options), typically following a ‘-’, ‘--’ or ‘+’ on the command line. In
this case _describe uses the prefix-hidden, prefix-needed and verbose styles to find out if the strings
should be added as completions and if the descriptions should be shown. Without the ‘-o’ option,
only the verbose style is used to decide how descriptions are shown. If ‘-O’ is used instead of ‘-o’,
command options are completed as above but _describe will not handle the prefix-needed style.

With the -t option a tag can be specified. The default is ‘values’ or, if the -o option is given, ‘options’.

The options -1, -2, -J, -V, -x are passed to _next_label.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 378 of 616
:
If selected by the list-grouped style, strings with the same description will appear together in the list.

_describe uses the _all_labels function to generate the matches, so it does not need to appear inside
a loop over tag labels.

_description [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ spec ... ]

This function is not to be confused with the previous one; it is used as a helper function for creating
options to compadd. It is buried inside many of the higher level completion functions and so often
does not need to be called directly.

The styles listed below are tested in the current context using the given tag . The resulting options
for compadd are put into the array named name (this is traditionally ‘expl’, but this convention is not
enforced). The description for the corresponding set of matches is passed to the function in descr .

The styles tested are: format, hidden, matcher, ignore-line, ignored-patterns, group-name and sort.
The format style is first tested for the given tag and then for the descriptions tag if no value was
found, while the remainder are only tested for the tag given as the first argument. The function also
calls _setup which tests some more styles.

The string returned by the format style (if any) will be modified so that the sequence ‘%d’ is replaced
by the descr given as the third argument without any leading or trailing white space. If, after
removing the white space, the descr is the empty string, the format style will not be used and the
options put into the name array will not contain an explanation string to be displayed above the
matches.

If _description is called with more than three arguments, the additional spec s should be of the form
‘ char : str ’. These supply escape sequence replacements for the format style: every appearance of
‘% char ’ will be replaced by string . If no additional spec s are given but the description in descr
conforms to a common form then further escape sequences are set for elements of that
description. These elements correspond to a default (‘%r’) and the remaining initial part of the
description (‘%h’). The form the description takes consists of specifying the units and range in
parentheses and the default value in square brackets, for example:

_description times expl 'timeout (seconds) (0-60) [20]'

It is possible to use zformat conditional expressions when styling these elements. So, for example, to
add ‘default:’ as a tag but only when there is a default value to show, the format style might include
‘%(o.default: %o.)’.

If the -x option is given, the description will be passed to compadd using the -x option instead of the
default -X. This means that the description will be displayed even if there are no corresponding
matches.

The options placed in the array name take account of the group-name style, so matches are placed
in a separate group where necessary. The group normally has its elements sorted (by passing the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 379 of 616
:
option -J to compadd), but if an option starting with ‘-V’, ‘-J’, ‘-1’, or ‘-2’ is passed to _description, that
option will be included in the array. Hence it is possible for the completion group to be unsorted by
giving the option ‘-V’, ‘-1V’, or ‘-2V’.

In most cases, the function will be used like this:

local expl
_description files expl file
compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"

Note the use of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list of matches. Almost all calls to compadd
within the completion system use a similar format; this ensures that user-specified styles are
correctly passed down to the builtins which implement the internals of completion.

_dir_list [ -s sep ] [ -S ]

Complete a list of directory names separated by colons (the same format as $PATH).

-s sep
Use sep as separator between items. sep defaults to a colon (‘:’).

-S
Add sep instead of slash (‘/’) as an autoremoveable suffix.

_dispatch context string ...

This sets the current context to context and looks for completion functions to handle this context
by hunting through the list of command names or special contexts (as described above for compdef)
given as string s. The first completion function to be defined for one of the contexts in the list is
used to generate matches. Typically, the last string is -default- to cause the function for default
completion to be used as a fallback.

The function sets the parameter $service to the string being tried, and sets the context/command
field (the fourth) of the $curcontext parameter to the context given as the first argument.

_email_addresses [ -c ] [ -n plugin ]

Complete email addresses. Addresses are provided by plugins.

-c
Complete bare [email protected] addresses, without a name part or a comment. Without this
option, RFC822 ‘ Firstname Lastname < address >’ strings are completed.

-n plugin
Complete aliases from plugin .

The following plugins are available by default: _email-ldap (see the filter style), _email-local

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 380 of 616
:
(completes user @ hostname Unix addresses), _email-mail (completes aliases from ~/.mailrc),
_email-mush, _email-mutt, and _email-pine.

Addresses from the _email- foo plugin are added under the tag ‘email- foo ’.

Writing plugins

Plugins are written as separate functions with names starting with ‘_email-’. They are invoked with
the -c option and compadd options. They should either do their own completion or set the $reply
array to a list of ‘ alias : address ’ elements and return 300. New plugins will be picked up and run
automatically.

_files

The function _files is a wrapper around _path_files. It supports all of the same functionality, with
some enhancements — notably, it respects the list-dirs-first style, and it allows users to override the
behaviour of the -g and -/ options with the file-patterns style. _files should therefore be preferred
over _path_files in most cases.

This function accepts the full set of options allowed by _path_files, described below.

_gnu_generic

This function is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function described above. It can be used
to determine automatically the long options understood by commands that produce a list when
passed the option ‘--help’. It is intended to be used as a top-level completion function in its own
right. For example, to enable option completion for the commands foo and bar, use

compdef _gnu_generic foo bar

after the call to compinit.

The completion system as supplied is conservative in its use of this function, since it is important to
be sure the command understands the option ‘--help’.

_guard [ options ] pattern descr

This function displays descr if pattern matches the string to be completed. It is intended to be
used in the action for the specifications passed to _arguments and similar functions.

The return status is zero if the message was displayed and the word to complete is not empty, and
non-zero otherwise.

The pattern may be preceded by any of the options understood by compadd that are passed down
from _description, namely -M, -J, -V, -1, -2, -n, -F and -X. All of these options will be ignored. This fits in
conveniently with the argument-passing conventions of actions for _arguments.

As an example, consider a command taking the options -n and -none, where -n must be followed by
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 381 of 616
:
a numeric value in the same word. By using:

_arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'

_arguments can be made to both display the message ‘numeric value’ and complete options after ‘-
n<TAB>’. If the ‘-n’ is already followed by one or more digits (the pattern passed to _guard) only the
message will be displayed; if the ‘-n’ is followed by another character, only options are completed.

_message [ -r12 ] [ -VJ group ] descr

_message -e [ tag ] descr

The descr is used in the same way as the third argument to the _description function, except that
the resulting string will always be shown whether or not matches were generated. This is useful for
displaying a help message in places where no completions can be generated.

The format style is examined with the messages tag to find a message; the usual tag, descriptions, is
used only if the style is not set with the former.

If the -r option is given, no style is used; the descr is taken literally as the string to display. This is
most useful when the descr comes from a pre-processed argument list which already contains an
expanded description. Note that this option does not disable the ‘%’-sequence parsing done by
compadd.

The -12VJ options and the group are passed to compadd and hence determine the group the
message string is added to.

The second -e form gives a description for completions with the tag tag to be shown even if there
are no matches for that tag. This form is called by _arguments in the event that there is no action for
an option specification. The tag can be omitted and if so the tag is taken from the parameter
$curtag; this is maintained by the completion system and so is usually correct. Note that if there are
no matches at the time this function is called, compstate[insert] is cleared, so additional matches
generated later are not inserted on the command line.

_multi_parts [ -i ] sep array

The argument sep is a separator character. The array may be either the name of an array
parameter or a literal array in the form ‘(foo bar)’, a parenthesised list of words separated by
whitespace. The possible completions are the strings from the array. However, each chunk delimited
by sep will be completed separately. For example, the _tar function uses ‘_multi_parts / patharray ’
to complete partial file paths from the given array of complete file paths.

The -i option causes _multi_parts to insert a unique match even if that requires multiple separators
to be inserted. This is not usually the expected behaviour with filenames, but certain other types of
completion, for example those with a fixed set of possibilities, may be more suited to this form.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 382 of 616
:
Like other utility functions, this function accepts the ‘-V’, ‘-J’, ‘-1’, ‘-2’, ‘-n’, ‘-f’, ‘-X’, ‘-M’, ‘-P’, ‘-S’, ‘-r’, ‘-R’, and
‘-q’ options and passes them to the compadd builtin.

_next_label [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ option ... ]

This function is used to implement the loop over different tag labels for a particular tag as described
above for the tag-order style. On each call it checks to see if there are any more tag labels; if there is
it returns status zero, otherwise non-zero. As this function requires a current tag to be set, it must
always follow a call to _tags or _requested.

The -x12VJ options and the first three arguments are passed to the _description function. Where
appropriate the tag will be replaced by a tag label in this call. Any description given in the tag-order
style is preferred to the descr passed to _next_label.

The option s given after the descr are set in the parameter given by name , and hence are to be
passed to compadd or whatever function is called to add the matches.

Here is a typical use of this function for the tag foo. The call to _requested determines if tag foo is
required at all; the loop over _next_label handles any labels defined for the tag in the tag-order style.

local expl ret=1


...
if _requested foo; then
...
while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
done
...
fi
return ret

_normal [ -P | -p precommand ]

This is the standard function called to handle completion outside any special - context -. It is called
both to complete the command word and also the arguments for a command. In the second case,
_normal looks for a special completion for that command, and if there is none it uses the completion
for the -default- context.

A second use is to reexamine the command line specified by the $words array and the $CURRENT
parameter after those have been modified. For example, the function _precommand, which
completes after precommand specifiers such as nohup, removes the first word from the words
array, decrements the CURRENT parameter, then calls ‘_normal -p $service’. The effect is that ‘nohup
cmd ... ’ is treated in the same way as ‘ cmd ... ’.

-P
Reset the list of precommands. This option should be used if completing a command line which
allows internal commands (e.g. builtins and functions) regardless of prior precommands (e.g. ‘zsh -
c’).
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 383 of 616
:
-p precommand
Append precommand to the list of precommands. This option should be used in nearly all cases in
which -P is not applicable.

If the command name matches one of the patterns given by one of the options -p or -P to compdef,
the corresponding completion function is called and then the parameter _compskip is checked. If it
is set completion is terminated at that point even if no matches have been found. This is the same
effect as in the -first- context.

_numbers [ option ... ] [ description ] [ suffix ... ]

This can be used where a number is followed by a suffix to indicate the units. The unit suffixes are
completed and can also be included in the description used when completion is invoked for the
preceding number.

In addition to common compadd options, _numbers accepts the following options:

-t tag
Specify a tag to use instead of the default of numbers.

-u units
Indicate the default units for the number, e.g. bytes.

-l min
Specify the lowest possible value for the number.

-m max
Specify the highest possible value for the number.

-d default
Specify the default value.

-N
Allow negative numbers. This is implied if the range includes a negative.

-f
Allow decimal numbers.

Where a particular suffix represents the default units for a number, it should be prefixed with a
colon. Additionally, suffixes can be followed by a colon and a description. So for example, the
following allows the age of something to be specified, either in seconds or with an optional suffix
with a longer unit of time:

_numbers -u seconds age :s:seconds m:minutes h:hours d:days

It is typically helpful for units to be presented in order of magnitude when completed. To facilitate
this, the order in which they are given is preserved.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 384 of 616
:
When the format style is looked up with the descriptions tag or the tag specified with -t, the list of
suffixes is available as a ‘%x’ escape sequence. This is in addition to the usual sequences
documented under the format style. The form this list takes can also be configured. To this end, the
format style is first looked up with the tag unit-suffixes. The retrieved format is applied to each suffix
in turn and the results are then concatenated to form the completed list. For the unit-suffixes
format, ‘%x’ expands to the individual suffix and ‘%X’ to its description. %d’ indicates a default suffix
and can be used in a condition. The index and reverse index are set in ‘%i’ and ‘%r’ respectively and
are useful for text included only with the first and last suffixes in the list. So for example, the
following joins the suffixes together as a comma-separated list:

zstyle ':completion:*:unit-suffixes' format '%x%(r::,)'

_options

This can be used to complete the names of shell options. It provides a matcher specification that
ignores a leading ‘no’, ignores underscores and allows upper-case letters to match their lower-case
counterparts (for example, ‘glob’, ‘noglob’, ‘NO_GLOB’ are all completed). Any arguments are
propagated to the compadd builtin.

_options_set and _options_unset

These functions complete only set or unset options, with the same matching specification used in
the _options function.

Note that you need to uncomment a few lines in the _main_complete function for these functions to
work properly. The lines in question are used to store the option settings in effect before the
completion widget locally sets the options it needs. Hence these functions are not generally used by
the completion system.

_parameters

This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.

The option ‘-g pattern ’ limits the completion to parameters whose type matches the pattern . The
type of a parameter is that shown by ‘print ${(t) param }’, hence judicious use of ‘*’ in pattern is
probably necessary.

All other arguments are passed to the compadd builtin.

_path_files

This function is used throughout the completion system to complete filenames. It allows completion
of partial paths. For example, the string ‘/u/i/s/sig’ may be completed to ‘/usr/include/sys/signal.h’.

The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:

-f

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 385 of 616
:
Complete all filenames. This is the default.

-/
Specifies that only directories should be completed.

-g pattern
Specifies that only files matching the pattern should be completed.

-W paths
Specifies path prefixes that are to be prepended to the string from the command line to generate
the filenames but that should not be inserted as completions nor shown in completion listings. Here,
paths may be the name of an array parameter, a literal list of paths enclosed in parentheses or an
absolute pathname.

-F ignored-files
This behaves as for the corresponding option to the compadd builtin. It gives direct control over
which filenames should be ignored. If the option is not present, the ignored-patterns style is used.

Both _path_files and _files also accept the following options which are passed to compadd: ‘-J’, ‘-V’,
‘-1’, ‘-2’, ‘-n’, ‘-X’, ‘-M’, ‘-P’, ‘-S’, ‘-q’, ‘-r’, and ‘-R’.

Finally, the _path_files function uses the styles expand, ambiguous, special-dirs, list-suffixes and file-
sort described above.

_pick_variant [ -b builtin-label ] [ -c command ] [ -r name ]

label = pattern ... label [ arg ... ]

This function is used to resolve situations where a single command name requires more than one
type of handling, either because it has more than one variant or because there is a name clash
between two different commands.

The command to run is taken from the first element of the array words unless this is overridden by
the option -c. This command is run and its output is compared with a series of patterns. Arguments
to be passed to the command can be specified at the end after all the other arguments. The
patterns to try in order are given by the arguments label = pattern ; if the output of ‘ command arg
...’ contains pattern , then label is selected as the label for the command variant. If none of the
patterns match, the final command label is selected and status 1 is returned.

If the ‘-b builtin-label ’ is given, the command is tested to see if it is provided as a shell builtin,
possibly autoloaded; if so, the label builtin-label is selected as the label for the variant.

If the ‘-r name ’ is given, the label picked is stored in the parameter named name .

The results are also cached in the _cmd_variant associative array indexed by the name of the
command run.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 386 of 616
:
_regex_arguments name spec ...

This function generates a completion function name which matches the specifications spec s, a set
of regular expressions as described below. After running _regex_arguments, the function name
should be called as a normal completion function. The pattern to be matched is given by the
contents of the words array up to the current cursor position joined together with null characters;
no quotation is applied.

The arguments are grouped as sets of alternatives separated by ‘|’, which are tried one after the
other until one matches. Each alternative consists of a one or more specifications which are tried left
to right, with each pattern matched being stripped in turn from the command line being tested, until
all of the group succeeds or until one fails; in the latter case, the next alternative is tried. This
structure can be repeated to arbitrary depth by using parentheses; matching proceeds from inside
to outside.

A special procedure is applied if no test succeeds but the remaining command line string contains
no null character (implying the remaining word is the one for which completions are to be
generated). The completion target is restricted to the remaining word and any action s for the
corresponding patterns are executed. In this case, nothing is stripped from the command line string.
The order of evaluation of the action s can be determined by the tag-order style; the various
formats supported by _alternative can be used in action . The descr is used for setting up the
array parameter expl.

Specification arguments take one of following forms, in which metacharacters such as ‘(’, ‘)’, ‘#’ and ‘|’
should be quoted.

/ pattern / [% lookahead %] [- guard ] [: tag : descr : action ]


This is a single primitive component. The function tests whether the combined pattern ‘(#b)
((#B) pattern ) lookahead *’ matches the command line string. If so, ‘ guard ’ is evaluated and its
return status is examined to determine if the test has succeeded. The pattern string ‘[]’ is
guaranteed never to match. The lookahead is not stripped from the command line before the next
pattern is examined.

The argument starting with : is used in the same manner as an argument to _alternative.

A component is used as follows: pattern is tested to see if the component already exists on the
command line. If it does, any following specifications are examined to find something to complete. If
a component is reached but no such pattern exists yet on the command line, the string containing
the action is used to generate matches to insert at that point.

/ pattern /+ [% lookahead %] [- guard ] [: tag : descr : action ]


This is similar to ‘/ pattern / ...’ but the left part of the command line string (i.e. the part already
matched by previous patterns) is also considered part of the completion target.

/ pattern /- [% lookahead %] [- guard ] [: tag : descr : action ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 387 of 616
:
This is similar to ‘/ pattern / ...’ but the action s of the current and previously matched patterns are
ignored even if the following ‘ pattern ’ matches the empty string.

( spec )
Parentheses may be used to groups spec s; note each parenthesis is a single argument to
_regex_arguments.

spec #
This allows any number of repetitions of spec .

spec spec
The two spec s are to be matched one after the other as described above.

spec | spec
Either of the two spec s can be matched.

The function _regex_words can be used as a helper function to generate matches for a set of
alternative words possibly with their own arguments as a command line argument.

Examples:

_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \


/$'[^\0]#\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

This generates a function _tst that completes aaa as its only argument. The tag and description
for the action have been omitted for brevity (this works but is not recommended in normal use). The
first component matches the command word, which is arbitrary; the second matches any argument.
As the argument is also arbitrary, any following component would not depend on aaa being present.

_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \


/$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

This is a more typical use; it is similar, but any following patterns would only match if aaa was
present as the first argument.

_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \( \


/$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \
/$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

In this example, an indefinite number of command arguments may be completed. Odd arguments
are completed as aaa and even arguments as bbb. Completion fails unless the set of aaa and bbb
arguments before the current one is matched correctly.

_regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \


\( /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \| \
/$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 388 of 616
:
This is similar, but either aaa or bbb may be completed for any argument. In this case _regex_words
could be used to generate

_regex_words tag description spec ...

This function can be used to generate arguments for the _regex_arguments command which may be
inserted at any point where a set of rules is expected. The tag and description give a standard
tag and description pertaining to the current context. Each spec contains two or three arguments
separated by a colon: note that there is no leading colon in this case.

Each spec gives one of a set of words that may be completed at this point, together with
arguments. It is thus roughly equivalent to the _arguments function when used in normal (non-
regex) completion.

The part of the spec before the first colon is the word to be completed. This may contain a *; the
entire word, before and after the * is completed, but only the text before the * is required for the
context to be matched, so that further arguments may be completed after the abbreviated form.

The second part of spec is a description for the word being completed.

The optional third part of the spec describes how words following the one being completed are
themselves to be completed. It will be evaluated in order to avoid problems with quoting. This
means that typically it contains a reference to an array containing previously generated regex
arguments.

The option -t term specifies a terminator for the word instead of the usual space. This is handled as
an auto-removable suffix in the manner of the option -s sep to _values.

The result of the processing by _regex_words is placed in the array reply, which should be made
local to the calling function. If the set of words and arguments may be matched repeatedly, a #
should be appended to the generated array at that point.

For example:

local -a reply
_regex_words mydb-commands 'mydb commands' \
'add:add an entry to mydb:$mydb_add_cmds' \
'show:show entries in mydb'
_regex_arguments _mydb "$reply[@]"
_mydb "$@"

This shows a completion function for a command mydb which takes two command arguments, add
and show. show takes no arguments, while the arguments for add have already been prepared in an
array mydb_add_cmds, quite possibly by a previous call to _regex_words.

_requested [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command [ arg ... ] ]

This function is called to decide whether a tag already registered by a call to _tags (see below) has
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 389 of 616
:
been requested by the user and hence completion should be performed for it. It returns status zero
if the tag is requested and non-zero otherwise. The function is typically used as part of a loop over
different tags as follows:

_tags foo bar baz


while _tags; do
if _requested foo; then
... # perform completion for foo
fi
... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
... # exit loop if matches were generated
done

Note that the test for whether matches were generated is not performed until the end of the _tags
loop. This is so that the user can set the tag-order style to specify a set of tags to be completed at
the same time.

If name and descr are given, _requested calls the _description function with these arguments
together with the options passed to _requested.

If command is given, the _all_labels function will be called immediately with the same arguments. In
simple cases this makes it possible to perform the test for the tag and the matching in one go. For
example:

local expl ret=1


_tags foo bar baz
while _tags; do
_requested foo expl 'description' \
compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
...
(( ret )) || break
done

If the command is not compadd, it must nevertheless be prepared to handle the same options.

_retrieve_cache cache_identifier

This function retrieves completion information from the file given by cache_identifier , stored in a
directory specified by the cache-path style which defaults to ~/.zcompcache. The return status is
zero if retrieval was successful. It will only attempt retrieval if the use-cache style is set, so you can
call this function without worrying about whether the user wanted to use the caching layer.

See _store_cache below for more details.

_sep_parts

This function is passed alternating arrays and separators as arguments. The arrays specify
completions for parts of strings to be separated by the separators. The arrays may be the names of
array parameters or a quoted list of words in parentheses. For example, with the array ‘hosts=(ftp
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 390 of 616
:
news)’ the call ‘_sep_parts ’(foo bar)’ @ hosts’ will complete the string ‘f’ to ‘foo’ and the string ‘b@n’ to
‘bar@news’.

This function accepts the compadd options ‘-V’, ‘-J’, ‘-1’, ‘-2’, ‘-n’, ‘-X’, ‘-M’, ‘-P’, ‘-S’, ‘-r’, ‘-R’, and ‘-q’ and
passes them on to the compadd builtin used to add the matches.

_sequence [ -s sep ] [ -n max ] [ -d ] function [ - ] ...

This function is a wrapper to other functions for completing items in a separated list. The same
function is used to complete each item in the list. The separator is specified with the -s option. If -s is
omitted it will use ‘,’. Duplicate values are not matched unless -d is specified. If there is a fixed or
maximum number of items in the list, this can be specified with the -n option.

Common compadd options are passed on to the function. It is possible to use compadd directly with
_sequence, though _values may be more appropriate in this situation.

_setup tag [ group ]

This function sets up the special parameters used by the completion system appropriately for the
tag given as the first argument. It uses the styles list-colors, list-packed, list-rows-first, last-prompt,
accept-exact, menu and force-list.

The optional group supplies the name of the group in which the matches will be placed. If it is not
given, the tag is used as the group name.

This function is called automatically from _description and hence is not normally called explicitly.

_store_cache cache_identifier param ...

This function, together with _retrieve_cache and _cache_invalid, implements a caching layer which
can be used in any completion function. Data obtained by costly operations are stored in
parameters; this function then dumps the values of those parameters to a file. The data can then be
retrieved quickly from that file via _retrieve_cache, even in different instances of the shell.

The cache_identifier specifies the file which the data should be dumped to. The file is stored in a
directory specified by the cache-path style which defaults to ~/.zcompcache. The remaining param s
arguments are the parameters to dump to the file.

The return status is zero if storage was successful. The function will only attempt storage if the use-
cache style is set, so you can call this function without worrying about whether the user wanted to
use the caching layer.

The completion function may avoid calling _retrieve_cache when it already has the completion data
available as parameters. However, in that case it should call _cache_invalid to check whether the
data in the parameters and in the cache are still valid.

See the _perl_modules completion function for a simple example of the usage of the caching layer.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 391 of 616
:
_tags [ [ -C name ] tag ... ]

If called with arguments, these are taken to be the names of tags valid for completions in the current
context. These tags are stored internally and sorted by using the tag-order style.

Next, _tags is called repeatedly without arguments from the same completion function. This
successively selects the first, second, etc. set of tags requested by the user. The return status is zero
if at least one of the tags is requested and non-zero otherwise. To test if a particular tag is to be
tried, the _requested function should be called (see above).

If ‘-C name ’ is given, name is temporarily stored in the argument field (the fifth) of the context in the
curcontext parameter during the call to _tags; the field is restored on exit. This allows _tags to use a
more specific context without having to change and reset the curcontext parameter (which has the
same effect).

_tilde_files

Like _files, but resolve leading tildes according to the rules of filename expansion, so the suggested
completions don’t start with a ‘~’ even if the filename on the command-line does.

_values [ -O name ] [ -s sep ] [ -S sep ] [ -wC ] desc spec ...

This is used to complete arbitrary keywords (values) and their arguments, or lists of such
combinations.

If the first argument is the option ‘-O name ’, it will be used in the same way as by the _arguments
function. In other words, the elements of the name array will be passed to compadd when executing
an action.

If the first argument (or the first argument after ‘-O name ’) is ‘-s’, the next argument is used as the
character that separates multiple values. This character is automatically added after each value in an
auto-removable fashion (see below); all values completed by ‘_values -s’ appear in the same word on
the command line, unlike completion using _arguments. If this option is not present, only a single
value will be completed per word.

Normally, _values will only use the current word to determine which values are already present on
the command line and hence are not to be completed again. If the -w option is given, other
arguments are examined as well.

The first non-option argument, desc , is used as a string to print as a description before listing the
values.

All other arguments describe the possible values and their arguments in the same format used for
the description of options by the _arguments function (see above). The only differences are that no
minus or plus sign is required at the beginning, values can have only one argument, and the forms
of action beginning with an equal sign are not supported.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 392 of 616
:
The character separating a value from its argument can be set using the option -S (like -s, followed
by the character to use as the separator in the next argument). By default the equals sign will be
used as the separator between values and arguments.

Example:

_values -s , 'description' \
'*foo[bar]' \
'(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'

This describes three possible values: ‘foo’, ‘one’, and ‘two’. The first is described as ‘bar’, takes no
argument and may appear more than once. The second is described as ‘number’, may appear more
than once, and takes one mandatory argument described as ‘first count’; no action is specified, so it
will not be completed. The ‘(two)’ at the beginning says that if the value ‘one’ is on the line, the value
‘two’ will no longer be considered a possible completion. Finally, the last value (‘two’) is described as
‘another number’ and takes an optional argument described as ‘second count’ for which the
completions (to appear after an ‘=’) are ‘1’, ‘2’, and ‘3’. The _values function will complete lists of these
values separated by commas.

Like _arguments, this function temporarily adds another context name component to the arguments
element (the fifth) of the current context while executing the action . Here this name is just the
name of the value for which the argument is completed.

The style verbose is used to decide if the descriptions for the values (but not those for the
arguments) should be printed.

The associative array val_args is used to report values and their arguments; this works similarly to
the opt_args associative array used by _arguments. Hence the function calling _values should
declare the local parameters state, state_descr, line, context and val_args:

local context state state_descr line


typeset -A val_args

when using an action of the form ‘-> string ’. With this function the context parameter will be set to
the name of the value whose argument is to be completed. Note that for _values, the state and
state_descr are scalars rather than arrays. Only a single matching state is returned.

Note also that _values normally adds the character used as the separator between values as an
auto-removable suffix (similar to a ‘/’ after a directory). However, this is not possible for a ‘-> string ’
action as the matches for the argument are generated by the calling function. To get the usual
behaviour, the calling function can add the separator x as a suffix by passing the options ‘-qS x ’
either directly or indirectly to compadd.

The option -C is treated in the same way as it is by _arguments. In that case the parameter
curcontext should be made local instead of context (as described above).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 393 of 616
:
_wanted [ -x ] [ -C name ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command [ arg ...]

In many contexts, completion can only generate one particular set of matches, usually
corresponding to a single tag. However, it is still necessary to decide whether the user requires
matches of this type. This function is useful in such a case.

The arguments to _wanted are the same as those to _requested, i.e. arguments to be passed to
_description. However, in this case the command is not optional; all the processing of tags, including
the loop over both tags and tag labels and the generation of matches, is carried out automatically by
_wanted.

Hence to offer only one tag and immediately add the corresponding matches with the given
description:

local expl
_wanted tag expl 'description' \
compadd -- match1 match2...

See also the use of _wanted in the example function in Dynamic named directories.

Note that, as for _requested, the command must be able to accept options to be passed down to
compadd.

Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give a different name for the argument context
field. The -x option has the same meaning as for _description.

_widgets [ -g pattern ]

This function completes names of zle widgets (see Zle Widgets). The pattern , if present, is matched
against values of the $widgets special parameter, documented in The zsh/zleparameter Module.

20.7 Completion System Variables


There are some standard variables, initialised by the _main_complete function and then used from
other functions.

The standard variables are:

_comp_caller_options
The completion system uses setopt to set a number of options. This allows functions to be written
without concern for compatibility with every possible combination of user options. However,
sometimes completion needs to know what the user’s option preferences are. These are saved in
the _comp_caller_options associative array. Option names, spelled in lowercase without
underscores, are mapped to one or other of the strings ‘on’ and ‘off’.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 394 of 616
:
_comp_priv_prefix
Completion functions such as _sudo can set the _comp_priv_prefix array to a command prefix that
may then be used by _call_program to match the privileges when calling programs to generate
matches.

Two more features are offered by the _main_complete function. The arrays compprefuncs and
comppostfuncs may contain names of functions that are to be called immediately before or after
completion has been tried. A function will only be called once unless it explicitly reinserts itself into
the array.

20.8 Completion Directories


In the source distribution, the files are contained in various subdirectories of the Completion
directory. They may have been installed in the same structure, or into one single function directory.
The following is a description of the files found in the original directory structure. If you wish to alter
an installed file, you will need to copy it to some directory which appears earlier in your fpath than
the standard directory where it appears.

Base
The core functions and special completion widgets automatically bound to keys. You will certainly
need most of these, though will probably not need to alter them. Many of these are documented
above.

Zsh
Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and utility functions for this. Some of
these are also used by functions from the Unix directory.

Unix
Functions for completing arguments of external commands and suites of commands. They may
need modifying for your system, although in many cases some attempt is made to decide which
version of a command is present. For example, completion for the mount command tries to
determine the system it is running on, while completion for many other utilities try to decide
whether the GNU version of the command is in use, and hence whether the --help option is
supported.

X, AIX, BSD, ...


Completion and utility function for commands available only on some systems. These are not
arranged hierarchically, so, for example, both the Linux and Debian directories, as well as the X
directory, may be useful on your system.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 395 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

21 Completion Using compctl


21.1 Types of completion
21.2 Description
21.3 Command Flags
21.4 Option Flags
21.4.1 Simple Flags
21.4.2 Flags with Arguments
21.4.3 Control Flags
21.5 Alternative Completion
21.6 Extended Completion
21.7 Example

21 Completion Using compctl

21.1 Types of completion


This version of zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on the command line. New
users of the shell may prefer to use the newer and more powerful system based on shell functions;
this is described in Completion System, and the basic shell mechanisms which support it are
described in Completion Widgets. This chapter describes the older compctl command.

21.2 Description
compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]

compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]

[ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

compctl -M match-specs ...

compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]

compctl + command ...

Control the editor’s completion behavior according to the supplied set of options . Various editing
commands, notably expand-or-complete-word, usually bound to tab, will attempt to complete a

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 396 of 616
:
word typed by the user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually bound to ^D in EMACS
editing mode, list the possibilities; compctl controls what those possibilities are. They may for
example be filenames (the most common case, and hence the default), shell variables, or words
from a user-specified list.

21.3 Command Flags


Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each command or may use the
default. The behavior when completing the command word itself may also be separately specified.
These correspond to the following flags and arguments, all of which (except for -L) may be combined
with any combination of the options described subsequently in Option Flags:

command ...
controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed last on the command line. If
completion is attempted for a command with a pathname containing slashes and no completion
definition is found, the search is retried with the last pathname component. If the command starts
with a =, completion is tried with the pathname of the command.

Any of the command strings may be patterns of the form normally used for filename generation.
These should be quoted to protect them from immediate expansion; for example the command
string ’foo*’ arranges for completion of the words of any command beginning with foo. When
completion is attempted, all pattern completions are tried in the reverse order of their definition
until one matches. By default, completion then proceeds as normal, i.e. the shell will try to generate
more matches for the specific command on the command line; this can be overridden by including -
tn in the flags for the pattern completion.

Note that aliases are expanded before the command name is determined unless the
COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set. Commands may not be combined with the -C, -D or -T flags.

-C
controls completion when the command word itself is being completed. If no compctl -C command
has been issued, the names of any as aliases or functions) are completed.

-D
controls default completion behavior for the arguments of commands not assigned any special
behavior. If no compctl -D command has been issued, filenames are completed.

-T
supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing is done, even before processing
for compctls defined for specific commands. This is especially useful when combined with extended
completion (the -x flag, see Extended Completion below). Using this flag you can define default
behavior which will apply to all commands without exception, or you can alter the standard behavior
for all commands. For example, if your access to the user database is too slow and/or it contains too

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 397 of 616
:
many users (so that completion after ‘~’ is too slow to be usable), you can use

compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn

to complete the strings in the array friends after a ‘~’. The C[ ... ] argument is necessary so that this
form of ~-completion is not tried after the directory name is finished.

-L
no argument
If no argument is given, compctl lists all defined completions in an abbreviated form; with a list of
options , all completions with those flags set (not counting extended completion) are listed.

If the + flag is alone and followed immediately by the command list, the completion behavior for all
the commands in the list is reset to the default. In other words, completion will subsequently use the
options specified by the -D flag.

The form with -M as the first and only option defines global matching specifications (see Completion
Matching Control). The match specifications given will be used for every completion attempt (only
when using compctl, not with the new completion system) and are tried in the order in which they
are defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:

compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

This will first try completion without any global match specifications (the empty string) and, if that
generates no matches, will try case insensitive completion.

21.4 Option Flags


[ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]

[ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]

[ -K function ]

[ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]

[ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]

[ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]

[ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]

[ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 398 of 616
:
[ -M match-spec ]

The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for during completion. Any
combination of these flags may be specified; the result is a sorted list of all the possibilities. The
options are as follows.

21.4.1 Simple Flags

These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:

-f
Filenames and file system paths.

-/
Just file system paths.

-c
Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins and reserved words.

-F
Function names.

-B
Names of builtin commands.

-m
Names of external commands.

-w
Reserved words.

-a
Alias names.

-R
Names of regular (non-global) aliases.

-G
Names of global aliases.

-d
This can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names of disabled functions, builtins,
reserved words or aliases.

-e
This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default, but may be combined with -d; -de in

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 399 of 616
:
combination with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G will complete names of functions, builtins, reserved words
or aliases whether or not they are disabled.

-o
Names of shell options (see Options).

-v
Names of any variable defined in the shell.

-N
Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.

-A
Array names.

-I
Names of integer variables.

-O
Names of read-only variables.

-p
Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parameters).

-Z
Names of shell special parameters.

-E
Names of environment variables.

-n
Named directories.

-b
Key binding names.

-j
Job names: the first word of the job leader’s command line. This is useful with the kill builtin.

-r
Names of running jobs.

-z
Names of suspended jobs.

-u
User names.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 400 of 616
:
21.4.2 Flags with Arguments

These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of completions is to be made up:

-k array
Names taken from the elements of $ array (note that the ‘$’ does not appear on the command line).
Alternatively, the argument array itself may be a set of space- or comma-separated values in
parentheses, in which any delimiter may be escaped with a backslash; in this case the argument
should be quoted. For example,

compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize


coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit

-g globstring
The globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be quoted to protect it from
immediate expansion. The resulting filenames are taken as the possible completions. Use ‘*(/)’
instead of ‘*/’ for directories. The fignore special parameter is not applied to the resulting files. More
than one pattern may be given separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is not part of
globbing. Use the syntax ‘(either|or)’ to match alternatives.)

-s subststring
The subststring is split into words and these words are than expanded using all shell expansion
mechanisms (see Expansion). The resulting words are taken as possible completions. The fignore
special parameter is not applied to the resulting files. Note that -g is faster for filenames.

-K function

Call the given function to get the completions. Unless the name starts with an underscore, the
function is passed two arguments: the prefix and the suffix of the word on which completion is to be
attempted, in other words those characters before the cursor position, and those from the cursor
position onwards. The whole command line can be accessed with the -c and -l flags of the read
builtin. The function should set the variable reply to an array containing the completions (one
completion per element); note that reply should not be made local to the function. From such a
function the command line can be accessed with the -c and -l flags to the read builtin. For example,

function whoson { reply=(`users`); }


compctl -K whoson talk

completes only logged-on users after ‘talk’. Note that ‘whoson’ must return an array, so ‘reply=‘users‘’
would be incorrect.

-H num pattern
The possible completions are taken from the last num history lines. Only words matching pattern
are taken. If num is zero or negative the whole history is searched and if pattern is the empty string
all words are taken (as with ‘*’). A typical use is

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 401 of 616
:
compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''

which forces completion to look back in the history list for a word if no filename matches.

21.4.3 Control Flags

These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but manipulate the options that do:

-Q
This instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in the possible completions. Normally the
results of a completion are inserted into the command line with any metacharacters quoted so that
they are interpreted as normal characters. This is appropriate for filenames and ordinary strings.
However, for special effects, such as inserting a backquoted expression from a completion array (-k)
so that the expression will not be evaluated until the complete line is executed, this option must be
used.

-P prefix
The prefix is inserted just before the completed string; any initial part already typed will be
completed and the whole prefix ignored for completion purposes. For example,

compctl -j -P "%" kill

inserts a ‘%’ after the kill command and then completes job names.

-S suffix
When a completion is found the suffix is inserted after the completed string. In the case of menu
completion the suffix is inserted immediately, but it is still possible to cycle through the list of
completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.

-W file-prefix
With directory file-prefix : for command, file, directory and globbing completion (options -c, -f, -/, -
g), the file prefix is implicitly added in front of the completion. For example,

compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs

completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the directory ~/Mail, although that prefix does
not appear on the command line. The file-prefix may also be of the form accepted by the -k flag,
i.e. the name of an array or a literal list in parenthesis. In this case all the directories in the list will be
searched for possible completions.

-q
If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes the suffix to be removed if the next
character typed is a blank or does not insert anything or if the suffix consists of only one character
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 402 of 616
:
and the next character typed is the same character; this the same rule used for the
AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH option. The option is most useful for list separators (comma, colon, etc.).

-l cmd
This option restricts the range of command line words that are considered to be arguments. If
combined with one of the extended completion patterns ‘p[...]’, ‘r[...]’, or ‘R[...]’ (see Extended
Completion below) the range is restricted to the range of arguments specified in the brackets.
Completion is then performed as if these had been given as arguments to the cmd supplied with the
option. If the cmd string is empty the first word in the range is instead taken as the command name,
and command name completion performed on the first word in the range. For example,

compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find

completes arguments between ‘-exec’ and the following ‘;’ (or the end of the command line if there is
no such string) as if they were a separate command line.

-h cmd
Normally zsh completes quoted strings as a whole. With this option, completion can be done
separately on different parts of such strings. It works like the -l option but makes the completion
code work on the parts of the current word that are separated by spaces. These parts are completed
as if they were arguments to the given cmd . If cmd is the empty string, the first part is completed as
a command name, as with -l.

-U
Use the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they actually match the word on the
command line. The word typed so far will be deleted. This is most useful with a function (given by
the -K option) which can examine the word components passed to it (or via the read builtin’s -c and -l
flags) and use its own criteria to decide what matches. If there is no completion, the original word is
retained. Since the produced possible completions seldom have interesting common prefixes and
suffixes, menu completion is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is set and this flag is used.

-y func-or-var

The list provided by func-or-var is displayed instead of the list of completions whenever a listing is
required; the actual completions to be inserted are not affected. It can be provided in two ways.
Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a $ it defines a variable, or if it begins with a left parenthesis a
literal array, which contains the list. A variable may have been set by a call to a function using the -K
option. Otherwise it contains the name of a function which will be executed to create the list. The
function will be passed as an argument list all matching completions, including prefixes and suffixes
expanded in full, and should set the array reply to the result. In both cases, the display list will only
be retrieved after a complete list of matches has been created.

Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in length, to the original set of
matches, and may be passed as a scalar instead of an array. No special formatting of characters is
performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines are printed literally and if they appear

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 403 of 616
:
output in columns is suppressed.

-X explanation
Print explanation when trying completion on the current set of options. A ‘%n’ in this string is
replaced by the number of matches that were added for this explanation string. The explanation
only appears if completion was tried and there was no unique match, or when listing completions.
Explanation strings will be listed together with the matches of the group specified together with the -
X option (using the -J or -V option). If the same explanation string is given to multiple -X options, the
string appears only once (for each group) and the number of matches shown for the ‘%n’ is the total
number of all matches for each of these uses. In any case, the explanation string will only be shown
if there was at least one match added for the explanation string.

The sequences %B, %b, %S, %s, %U, and %u specify output attributes (bold, standout, and
underline), %F, %f, %K, %k specify foreground and background colours, and %{ ... %} can be used
to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.

-Y explanation
Identical to -X, except that the explanation first undergoes expansion following the usual rules for
strings in double quotes. The expansion will be carried out after any functions are called for the -K
or -y options, allowing them to set variables.

-t continue
The continue -string contains a character that specifies which set of completion flags should be
used next. It is useful:

(i) With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when compctl would usually continue with
ordinary processing after finding matches; this can be suppressed with ‘-tn’.

(ii) With a list of alternatives separated by +, when compctl would normally stop when one of the
alternatives generates matches. It can be forced to consider the next set of completions by adding ‘-
t+’ to the flags of the alternative before the ‘+’.

(iii) In an extended completion list (see below), when compctl would normally continue until a set of
conditions succeeded, then use only the immediately following flags. With ‘-t-’, compctl will continue
trying extended completions after the next ‘-’; with ‘-tx’ it will attempt completion with the default
flags, in other words those before the ‘-x’.

-J name
This gives the name of the group the matches should be placed in. Groups are listed and sorted
separately; likewise, menu completion will offer the matches in the groups in the order in which the
groups were defined. If no group name is explicitly given, the matches are stored in a group named
default. The first time a group name is encountered, a group with that name is created. After that all
matches with the same group name are stored in that group.

This can be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions. For example, in

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 404 of 616
:
compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo

both files and variables are possible completions, as the -t+ forces both sets of alternatives before
and after the + to be considered at once. Because of the -J options, however, all files are listed
before all variables.

-V name
Like -J, but matches within the group will not be sorted in listings nor in menu completion. These
unsorted groups are in a different name space from the sorted ones, so groups defined as -J files
and -V files are distinct.

-1
If given together with the -V option, makes only consecutive duplicates in the group be removed.
Note that groups with and without this flag are in different name spaces.

-2
If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates be kept. Again, groups with and
without this flag are in different name spaces.

-M match-spec
This defines additional matching control specifications that should be used only when testing words
for the list of flags this flag appears in. The format of the match-spec string is described in
Completion Matching Control.

21.5 Alternative Completion


compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...

The form with ‘+’ specifies alternative options. Completion is tried with the options before the first
‘+’. If this produces no matches completion is tried with the flags after the ‘+’ and so on. If there are
no flags after the last ‘+’ and a match has not been found up to that point, default completion is
tried. If the list of flags contains a -t with a + character, the next list of flags is used even if the current
list produced matches.

Additional options are available that restrict completion to some part of the command line; this is
referred to as ‘extended completion’.

21.6 Extended Completion


compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 405 of 616
:
[ command ... ]

compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]

[ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

The form with ‘-x’ specifies extended completion for the commands given; as shown, it may be
combined with alternative completion using ‘+’. Each pattern is examined in turn; when a match is
found, the corresponding options , as described in Option Flags above, are used to generate
possible completions. If no pattern matches, the options given before the -x are used.

Note that each pattern should be supplied as a single argument and should be quoted to prevent
expansion of metacharacters by the shell.

A pattern is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it matches if at least one of these sub-
patterns matches (they are ‘or’ed). These sub-patterns are in turn composed of other sub-patterns
separated by white spaces which match if all of the sub-patterns match (they are ‘and’ed). An
element of the sub-patterns is of the form ‘ c [...][...]’, where the pairs of brackets may be repeated as
often as necessary, and matches if any of the sets of brackets match (an ‘or’). The example below
makes this clearer.

The elements may be any of the following:

s[ string ]...
Matches if the current word on the command line starts with one of the strings given in brackets.
The string is not removed and is not part of the completion.

S[ string ]...
Like s[ string ] except that the string is part of the completion.

p[ from , to ]...
Matches if the number of the current word is between one of the from and to pairs inclusive. The
comma and to are optional; to defaults to the same value as from . The numbers may be
negative: - n refers to the n ’th last word on the line.

c[ offset , string ]...


Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the current word position. Usually
offset will be negative.

C[ offset , pattern ]...


Like c but using pattern matching instead.

w[ index , string ]...


Matches if the word in position index is equal to the corresponding string . Note that the word
count is made after any alias expansion.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 406 of 616
:
W[ index , pattern ]...
Like w but using pattern matching instead.

n[ index , string ]...


Matches if the current word contains string . Anything up to and including the index th occurrence
of this string will not be considered part of the completion, but the rest will. index may be negative
to count from the end: in most cases, index will be 1 or -1. For example,

compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk

will usually complete usernames, but if you insert an @ after the name, names from the array
hosts (assumed to contain hostnames, though you must make the array yourself) will be
completed. Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.

N[ index , string ]...


Like n except that the string will be taken as a character class. Anything up to and including the
index th occurrence of any of the characters in string will not be considered part of the
completion.

m[ min , max ]...


Matches if the total number of words lies between min and max inclusive.

r[ str1 , str2 ]...


Matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix str1 . If there is also a word with prefix str2 on the
command line after the one matched by str1 it matches only if the cursor is before this word. If the
comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix str1 .

R[ str1 , str2 ]...


Like r but using pattern matching instead.

q[ str ]...
Matches the word currently being completed is in single quotes and the str begins with the letter
‘s’, or if completion is done in double quotes and str starts with the letter ‘d’, or if completion is
done in backticks and str starts with a ‘b’.

21.7 Example

compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \


-g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail

This is to be interpreted as follows:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 407 of 616
:
If the current command is mail, then

if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f) or (the current word begins with
-f+)), then complete the non-directory part (the ‘:t’ glob modifier) of files in the directory ~/Mail;
else

if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then complete any file; else

complete user names.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 408 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

22 Zsh Modules
22.1 Description
22.2 The zsh/attr Module
22.3 The zsh/cap Module
22.4 The zsh/clone Module
22.5 The zsh/compctl Module
22.6 The zsh/complete Module
22.7 The zsh/complist Module
22.7.1 Colored completion listings
22.7.2 Scrolling in completion listings
22.7.3 Menu selection
22.8 The zsh/computil Module
22.9 The zsh/curses Module
22.9.1 Builtin
22.9.2 Parameters
22.10 The zsh/datetime Module
22.11 The zsh/db/gdbm Module
22.12 The zsh/deltochar Module
22.13 The zsh/example Module
22.14 The zsh/files Module
22.15 The zsh/langinfo Module
22.16 The zsh/mapfile Module
22.16.1 Limitations
22.17 The zsh/mathfunc Module
22.18 The zsh/nearcolor Module
22.19 The zsh/newuser Module
22.20 The zsh/parameter Module
22.21 The zsh/pcre Module
22.22 The zsh/param/private Module
22.23 The zsh/regex Module
22.24 The zsh/sched Module
22.25 The zsh/net/socket Module
22.25.1 Outbound Connections
22.25.2 Inbound Connections
22.26 The zsh/stat Module
22.27 The zsh/system Module
22.27.1 Builtins
22.27.2 Math Functions
22.27.3 Parameters
22.28 The zsh/net/tcp Module
22.28.1 Outbound Connections
22.28.2 Inbound Connections

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 409 of 616
:
22.28.3 Closing Connections
22.28.4 Example
22.29 The zsh/termcap Module
22.30 The zsh/terminfo Module
22.31 The zsh/watch Module
22.32 The zsh/zftp Module
22.32.1 Subcommands
22.32.2 Parameters
22.32.3 Functions
22.32.4 Problems
22.33 The zsh/zle Module
22.34 The zsh/zleparameter Module
22.35 The zsh/zprof Module
22.36 The zsh/zpty Module
22.37 The zsh/zselect Module
22.38 The zsh/zutil Module

22 Zsh Modules

22.1 Description
Some optional parts of zsh are in modules, separate from the core of the shell. Each of these
modules may be linked in to the shell at build time, or can be dynamically linked while the shell is
running if the installation supports this feature. Modules are linked at runtime with the zmodload
command, see Shell Builtin Commands.

The modules that are bundled with the zsh distribution are:

zsh/attr
Builtins for manipulating extended attributes (xattr).

zsh/cap
Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability (privilege) sets.

zsh/clone
A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.

zsh/compctl
The compctl builtin for controlling completion.

zsh/complete
The basic completion code.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 410 of 616
:
zsh/complist
Completion listing extensions.

zsh/computil
A module with utility builtins needed for the shell function based completion system.

zsh/curses
curses windowing commands

zsh/datetime
Some date/time commands and parameters.

zsh/db/gdbm
Builtins for managing associative array parameters tied to GDBM databases.

zsh/deltochar
A ZLE function duplicating EMACS’ zap-to-char.

zsh/example
An example of how to write a module.

zsh/files
Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.

zsh/langinfo
Interface to locale information.

zsh/mapfile
Access to external files via a special associative array.

zsh/mathfunc
Standard scientific functions for use in mathematical evaluations.

zsh/nearcolor
Map colours to the nearest colour in the available palette.

zsh/newuser
Arrange for files for new users to be installed.

zsh/parameter
zsh/pcre
Interface to the PCRE library.

zsh/param/private
Builtins for managing private-scoped parameters in function context.

zsh/regex
Interface to the POSIX regex library.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 411 of 616
:
zsh/sched
A builtin that provides a timed execution facility within the shell.

zsh/net/socket
Manipulation of Unix domain sockets

zsh/stat
A builtin command interface to the stat system call.

zsh/system
A builtin interface to various low-level system features.

zsh/net/tcp
Manipulation of TCP sockets

zsh/termcap
Interface to the termcap database.

zsh/terminfo
Interface to the terminfo database.

zsh/watch
Reporting of login and logout events.

zsh/zftp
A builtin FTP client.

zsh/zle
The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.

zsh/zleparameter
Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.

zsh/zprof
A module allowing profiling for shell functions.

zsh/zpty
A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.

zsh/zselect
Block and return when file descriptors are ready.

zsh/zutil
Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration via styles.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 412 of 616
:
22.2 The zsh/attr Module
The zsh/attr module is used for manipulating extended attributes. The -h option causes all
commands to operate on symbolic links instead of their targets. The builtins in this module are:

zgetattr [ -h ] filename attribute [ parameter ]

Get the extended attribute attribute from the specified filename . If the optional argument
parameter is given, the attribute is set on that parameter instead of being printed to stdout.

zsetattr [ -h ] filename attribute value

Set the extended attribute attribute on the specified filename to value .

zdelattr [ -h ] filename attribute

Remove the extended attribute attribute from the specified filename .

zlistattr [ -h ] filename [ parameter ]

List the extended attributes currently set on the specified filename . If the optional argument
parameter is given, the list of attributes is set on that parameter instead of being printed to stdout.

zgetattr and zlistattr allocate memory dynamically. If the attribute or list of attributes grows between
the allocation and the call to get them, they return 2. On all other errors, 1 is returned. This allows
the calling function to check for this case and retry.

22.3 The zsh/cap Module


The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability sets. If the operating
system does not support this interface, the builtins defined by this module will do nothing. The
builtins in this module are:

cap [ capabilities ]

Change the shell’s process capability sets to the specified capabilities , otherwise display the
shell’s current capabilities.

getcap filename ...

This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility. It displays the capability sets on each
specified filename .

setcap capabilities filename ...

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 413 of 616
:
This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility. It sets the capability sets on each
specified filename to the specified capabilities .

22.4 The zsh/clone Module


The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:

clone tty

Creates a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the specified tty . In the new shell, the
PID, PPID and TTY special parameters are changed appropriately. $! is set to zero in the new shell,
and to the new shell’s PID in the original shell.

The return status of the builtin is zero in both shells if successful, and non-zero on error.

The target of clone should be an unused terminal, such as an unused virtual console or a virtual
terminal created by

xterm -e sh -c 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty;


while :; do sleep 100000000; done'

Some words of explanation are warranted about this long xterm command line: when doing clone
on a pseudo-terminal, some other session ("session" meant as a unix session group, or SID) is
already owning the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh cannot acquire the pseudo-terminal as a
controlling tty. That means two things:

the job control signals will go to the sh-started-by-xterm process group (that’s why we disable
INT QUIT and TSTP with trap; otherwise the while loop could get suspended or killed)
the cloned shell will have job control disabled, and the job control keys (control-C, control-\ and
control-Z) will not work.

This does not apply when cloning to an unused vc.

Cloning to a used (and unprepared) terminal will result in two processes reading simultaneously
from the same terminal, with input bytes going randomly to either process.

clone is mostly useful as a shell built-in replacement for openvt.

22.5 The zsh/compctl Module


The zsh/compctl module makes available two builtin commands. compctl, is the old, deprecated way

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 414 of 616
:
to control completions for ZLE. See Completion Using compctl. The other builtin command, compcall
can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see Completion Widgets.

22.6 The zsh/complete Module


The zsh/complete module makes available several builtin commands which can be used in user-
defined completion widgets, see Completion Widgets.

22.7 The zsh/complist Module


The zsh/complist module offers three extensions to completion listings: the ability to highlight
matches in such a list, the ability to scroll through long lists and a different style of menu
completion.

22.7.1 Colored completion listings

Whenever one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the zsh/complist module
is loaded or linked into the shell, completion lists will be colored. Note, however, that complist will
not automatically be loaded if it is not linked in: on systems with dynamic loading, ‘zmodload
zsh/complist’ is required.

The parameters ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS describe how matches are highlighted. To turn on
highlighting an empty value suffices, in which case all the default values given below will be used.
The format of the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU version of the ls
command: a colon-separated list of specifications of the form ‘ name = value ’. The name may be one
of the following strings, most of which specify file types for which the value will be used. The strings
and their default values are:

no 0
for normal text (i.e. when displaying something other than a matched file)

fi0
for regular files

di 32
for directories

ln 36

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 415 of 616
:
for symbolic links. If this has the special value target, symbolic links are dereferenced and the target
file used to determine the display format.

pi 31
for named pipes (FIFOs)

so 33
for sockets

bd 44;37
for block devices

cd 44;37
for character devices

or none
for a symlink to nonexistent file (default is the value defined for ln)

mi none
for a non-existent file (default is the value defined for fi); this code is currently not used

su 37;41
for files with setuid bit set

sg 30;43
for files with setgid bit set

tw 30;42
ow 34;43
sa none
for files with an associated suffix alias; this is only tested after specific suffixes, as described below

st 37;44
ex 35
lc \e[
for the left code (see below)

rc m
for the right code

tc 0
for the character indicating the file type printed after filenames if the LIST_TYPES option is set

sp 0
for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column

ec none
for the end code

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 416 of 616
:
Apart from these strings, the name may also be an asterisk (‘*’) followed by any string. The value
given for such a string will be used for all files whose name ends with the string. The name may also
be an equals sign (‘=’) followed by a pattern; the EXTENDED_GLOB option will be turned on for
evaluation of the pattern. The value given for this pattern will be used for all matches (not just
filenames) whose display string are matched by the pattern. Definitions for the form with the
leading equal sign take precedence over the values defined for file types, which in turn take
precedence over the form with the leading asterisk (file extensions).

The leading-equals form also allows different parts of the displayed strings to be colored differently.
For this, the pattern has to use the ‘(#b)’ globbing flag and pairs of parentheses surrounding the
parts of the strings that are to be colored differently. In this case the value may consist of more
than one color code separated by equal signs. The first code will be used for all parts for which no
explicit code is specified and the following codes will be used for the parts matched by the sub-
patterns in parentheses. For example, the specification ‘=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7’ will be used for all
matches which are at least two characters long and will use the code ‘3’ for the first character, ‘7’ for
the last character and ‘0’ for the rest.

All three forms of name may be preceded by a pattern in parentheses. If this is given, the value will
be used only for matches in groups whose names are matched by the pattern given in the
parentheses. For example, ‘(g*)m*=43’ highlights all matches beginning with ‘m’ in groups whose
names begin with ‘g’ using the color code ‘43’. In case of the ‘lc’, ‘rc’, and ‘ec’ codes, the group pattern
is ignored.

Note also that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear in the parameter value until
the first one matches which is then used. Patterns may be matched against completions,
descriptions (possibly with spaces appended for padding), or lines consisting of a completion
followed by a description. For consistent coloring it may be necessary to use more than one pattern
or a pattern with backreferences.

When printing a match, the code prints the value of lc, the value for the file-type or the last matching
specification with a ‘*’, the value of rc, the string to display for the match itself, and then the value of
ec if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and rc if ec is not defined.

The default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and can be used on vt100 compatible terminals
such as xterms. On monochrome terminals the default values will have no visible effect. The colors
function from the contribution can be used to get associative arrays containing the codes for ANSI
terminals (see Other Functions). For example, after loading colors, one could use ‘$color[red]’ to get
the code for foreground color red and ‘$color[bg-green]’ for the code for background color green.

If the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these parameters should not be set directly
because the system controls them itself. Instead, the list-colors style should be used (see
Completion System Configuration).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 417 of 616
:
22.7.2 Scrolling in completion listings

To enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter must be set. Its value will
be used as the prompt; if it is the empty string, a default prompt will be used. The value may contain
escapes of the form ‘%x’. It supports the escapes ‘%B’, ‘%b’, ‘%S’, ‘%s’, ‘%U’, ‘%u’, ‘%F’, ‘%f’, ‘%K’, ‘%k’ and
‘%{ ... %}’ used also in shell prompts as well as three pairs of additional sequences: a ‘%l’ or ‘%L’ is
replaced by the number of the last line shown and the total number of lines in the form
‘ number / total ’; a ‘%m’ or ‘%M’ is replaced with the number of the last match shown and the total
number of matches; and ‘%p’ or ‘%P’ is replaced with ‘Top’, ‘Bottom’ or the position of the first line
shown in percent of the total number of lines, respectively. In each of these cases the form with the
uppercase letter will be replaced with a string of fixed width, padded to the right with spaces, while
the lowercase form will not be padded.

If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if the list should be shown.
Instead it immediately starts displaying the list, stopping after the first screenful, showing the
prompt at the bottom, waiting for a keypress after temporarily switching to the listscroll keymap.
Some of the zle functions have a special meaning while scrolling lists:

send-break
stops listing discarding the key pressed

accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history


down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
scrolls forward one line

complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete


expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
scrolls forward one screenful

accept-search
stop listing but take no other action

Every other character stops listing and immediately processes the key as usual. Any key that is not
bound in the listscroll keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is looked up in the keymap
currently selected.

As for the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not be set directly when
using the shell function based completion system. Instead, the list-prompt style should be used.

22.7.3 Menu selection

The zsh/complist module also offers an alternative style of selecting matches from a list, called
menu selection, which can be used if the shell is set up to return to the last prompt after showing a
completion list (see the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option in Options).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 418 of 616
:
Menu selection can be invoked directly by the widget menu-select defined by this module. This is a
standard ZLE widget that can be bound to a key in the usual way as described in Zsh Line Editor.

Alternatively, the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which gives the minimum
number of matches that must be present before menu selection is automatically turned on. This
second method requires that menu completion be started, either directly from a widget such as
menu-complete, or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or AUTO_MENU being set. If
MENUSELECT is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection will always be started during an ambiguous
menu completion.

When using the completion system based on shell functions, the MENUSELECT parameter should
not be used (like the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters described above). Instead, the
menu style should be used with the select= ... keyword.

After menu selection is started, the matches will be listed. If there are more matches than fit on the
screen, only the first screenful is shown. The matches to insert into the command line can be
selected from this list. In the list one match is highlighted using the value for ma from the
ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter. The default value for this is ‘7’ which forces the selected
match to be highlighted using standout mode on a vt100-compatible terminal. If neither
ZLS_COLORS nor ZLS_COLOURS is set, the same terminal control sequence as for the ‘%S’ escape in
prompts is used.

If there are more matches than fit on the screen and the parameter MENUPROMPT is set, its value
will be shown below the matches. It supports the same escape sequences as LISTPROMPT, but the
number of the match or line shown will be that of the one where the mark is placed. If its value is
the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

The MENUSCROLL parameter can be used to specify how the list is scrolled. If the parameter is
unset, this is done line by line, if it is set to ‘0’ (zero), the list will scroll half the number of lines of the
screen. If the value is positive, it gives the number of lines to scroll and if it is negative, the list will be
scrolled the number of lines of the screen minus the (absolute) value.

As for the ZLS_COLORS, ZLS_COLOURS and LISTPROMPT parameters, neither MENUPROMPT nor
MENUSCROLL should be set directly when using the shell function based completion system.
Instead, the select-prompt and select-scroll styles should be used.

The completion code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in the list. These hidden
matches are either matches for which the completion function which added them explicitly
requested that they not appear in the list (using the -n option of the compadd builtin command) or
they are matches which duplicate a string already in the list (because they differ only in things like
prefixes or suffixes that are not displayed). In the list used for menu selection, however, even these
matches are shown so that it is possible to select them. To highlight such matches the hi and du
capabilities in the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters are supported for hidden matches of
the first and second kind, respectively.

Selecting matches is done by moving the mark around using the zle movement functions. When not

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 419 of 616
:
all matches can be shown on the screen at the same time, the list will scroll up and down when
crossing the top or bottom line. The following zle functions have special meaning during menu
selection. Note that the following always perform the same task within the menu selection map and
cannot be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended:

accept-line, accept-search
accept the current match and leave menu selection (but do not cause the command line to be
accepted)

send-break
leaves menu selection and restores the previous contents of the command line

redisplay, clear-screen
execute their normal function without leaving menu selection

accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
accept the currently inserted match and continue selection allowing to select the next match to
insert into the line

accept-and-infer-next-history
accepts the current match and then tries completion with menu selection again; in the case of files
this allows one to select a directory and immediately attempt to complete files in it; if there are no
matches, a message is shown and one can use undo to go back to completion on the previous level,
every other key leaves menu selection (including the other zle functions which are otherwise special
during menu selection)

undo
removes matches inserted during the menu selection by one of the three functions before

down-history, down-line-or-history
vi-down-line-or-history, down-line-or-search
moves the mark one line down

up-history, up-line-or-history
vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
moves the mark one line up

forward-char, vi-forward-char
moves the mark one column right

backward-char, vi-backward-char
moves the mark one column left

forward-word, vi-forward-word
vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
moves the mark one screenful down

backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 420 of 616
:
moves the mark one screenful up

vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches

vi-backward-blank-word
moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches

beginning-of-history
moves the mark to the first line

end-of-history
moves the mark to the last line

beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
moves the mark to the leftmost column

end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
moves the mark to the rightmost column

complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete


expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
moves the mark to the next match

reverse-menu-complete
moves the mark to the previous match

vi-insert
this toggles between normal and interactive mode; in interactive mode the keys bound to self-insert
and self-insert-unmeta insert into the command line as in normal editing mode but without leaving
menu selection; after each character completion is tried again and the list changes to contain only
the new matches; the completion widgets make the longest unambiguous string be inserted in the
command line and undo and backward-delete-char go back to the previous set of matches

history-incremental-search-forward
history-incremental-search-backward
this starts incremental searches in the list of completions displayed; in this mode, accept-line only
leaves incremental search, going back to the normal menu selection mode

All movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function not listed leaves menu
selection and executes that function. It is possible to make widgets in the above list do the same by
using the form of the widget with a ‘.’ in front. For example, the widget ‘.accept-line’ has the effect of
leaving menu selection and accepting the entire command line.

During this selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect. Any key that is not defined in this
keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is looked up in the keymap currently selected. This is
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 421 of 616
:
used to ensure that the most important keys used during selection (namely the cursor keys, return,
and TAB) have sensible defaults. However, keys in the menuselect keymap can be modified directly
using the bindkey builtin command (see The zsh/zle Module). For example, to make the return key
leave menu selection without accepting the match currently selected one could call

bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break

after loading the zsh/complist module.

22.8 The zsh/computil Module


The zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used by some of the completion
functions in the completion system based on shell functions (see Completion System ). Except for
compquote these builtin commands are very specialised and thus not very interesting when writing
your own completion functions. In summary, these builtin commands are:

comparguments

This is used by the _arguments function to do the argument and command line parsing. Like
compdescribe it has an option -i to do the parsing and initialize some internal state and various
options to access the state information to decide what should be completed.

compdescribe

This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for the matches and to get the strings to
add as matches with their options. On the first call one of the options -i or -I should be supplied as
the first argument. In the first case, display strings without the descriptions will be generated, in the
second case, the string used to separate the matches from their descriptions must be given as the
second argument and the descriptions (if any) will be shown. All other arguments are like the
definition arguments to _describe itself.

Once compdescribe has been called with either the -i or the -I option, it can be repeatedly called with
the -g option and the names of four parameters as its arguments. This will step through the
different sets of matches and store the value of compstate[list] in the first scalar, the options for
compadd in the second array, the matches in the third array, and the strings to be displayed in the
completion listing in the fourth array. The arrays may then be directly given to compadd to register
the matches with the completion code.

compfiles

Used by the _path_files function to optimize complex recursive filename generation (globbing). It
does three things. With the -p and -P options it builds the glob patterns to use, including the paths
already handled and trying to optimize the patterns with respect to the prefix and suffix from the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 422 of 616
:
line and the match specification currently used. The -i option does the directory tests for the ignore-
parents style and the -r option tests if a component for some of the matches are equal to the string
on the line and removes all other matches if that is true.

compgroups

Used by the _tags function to implement the internals of the group-order style. This only takes its
arguments as names of completion groups and creates the groups for it (all six types: sorted and
unsorted, both without removing duplicates, with removing all duplicates and with removing
consecutive duplicates).

compquote [ -p ] names ...

There may be reasons to write completion functions that have to add the matches using the -Q
option to compadd and perform quoting themselves. Instead of interpreting the first character of
the all_quotes key of the compstate special association and using the q flag for parameter
expansions, one can use this builtin command. The arguments are the names of scalar or array
parameters and the values of these parameters are quoted as needed for the innermost quoting
level. If the -p option is given, quoting is done as if there is some prefix before the values of the
parameters, so that a leading equal sign will not be quoted.

The return status is non-zero in case of an error and zero otherwise.

comptags

comptry

These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.

compvalues

Like comparguments, but for the _values function.

22.9 The zsh/curses Module


The zsh/curses module makes available one builtin command and various parameters.

22.9.1 Builtin

zcurses init

zcurses end

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 423 of 616
:
zcurses addwin targetwin nlines ncols begin_y begin_x [ parentwin ]

zcurses delwin targetwin

zcurses refresh [ targetwin ... ]

zcurses touch targetwin ...

zcurses move targetwin new_y new_x

zcurses clear targetwin [ redraw | eol | bot ]

zcurses position targetwin array

zcurses char targetwin character

zcurses string targetwin string

zcurses border targetwin border

zcurses attr targetwin [ [+|-] attribute | fg_col / bg_col ] [...]

zcurses bg targetwin [ [+|-] attribute | fg_col / bg_col | @ char ] [...]

zcurses scroll targetwin [ on | off | [+|-] lines ]

zcurses input targetwin [ param [ kparam [ mparam ] ] ]

zcurses mouse [ delay num | [+|-]motion ]

zcurses timeout targetwin intval

zcurses querychar targetwin [ param ]

zcurses resize height width [ endwin | nosave | endwin_nosave ]

Manipulate curses windows. All uses of this command should be bracketed by ‘zcurses init’ to
initialise use of curses, and ‘zcurses end’ to end it; omitting ‘zcurses end’ can cause the terminal to be
in an unwanted state.

The subcommand addwin creates a window with nlines lines and ncols columns. Its upper left
corner will be placed at row begin_y and column begin_x of the screen. targetwin is a string and
refers to the name of a window that is not currently assigned. Note in particular the curses
convention that vertical values appear before horizontal values.

If addwin is given an existing window as the final argument, the new window is created as a
subwindow of parentwin . This differs from an ordinary new window in that the memory of the
window contents is shared with the parent’s memory. Subwindows must be deleted before their

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 424 of 616
:
parent. Note that the coordinates of subwindows are relative to the screen, not the parent, as with
other windows.

Use the subcommand delwin to delete a window created with addwin. Note that end does not
implicitly delete windows, and that delwin does not erase the screen image of the window.

The window corresponding to the full visible screen is called stdscr; it always exists after ‘zcurses init’
and cannot be delete with delwin.

The subcommand refresh will refresh window targetwin ; this is necessary to make any pending
changes (such as characters you have prepared for output with char) visible on the screen. refresh
without an argument causes the screen to be cleared and redrawn. If multiple windows are given,
the screen is updated once at the end.

The subcommand touch marks the targetwin s listed as changed. This is necessary before
refreshing windows if a window that was in front of another window (which may be stdscr) is
deleted.

The subcommand move moves the cursor position in targetwin to new coordinates new_y and
new_x . Note that the subcommand string (but not the subcommand char) advances the cursor
position over the characters added.

The subcommand clear erases the contents of targetwin . One (and no more than one) of three
options may be specified. With the option redraw, in addition the next refresh of targetwin will
cause the screen to be cleared and repainted. With the option eol, targetwin is only cleared to the
end of the current cursor line. With the option bot, targetwin is cleared to the end of the window,
i.e everything to the right and below the cursor is cleared.

The subcommand position writes various positions associated with targetwin into the array named
array . These are, in order:

-
The y and x coordinates of the cursor relative to the top left of targetwin

-
The y and x coordinates of the top left of targetwin on the screen

-
The size of targetwin in y and x dimensions.

Outputting characters and strings are achieved by char and string respectively.

To draw a border around window targetwin , use border. Note that the border is not subsequently
handled specially: in other words, the border is simply a set of characters output at the edge of the
window. Hence it can be overwritten, can scroll off the window, etc.

The subcommand attr will set targetwin ’s attributes or foreground/background color pair for any
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 425 of 616
:
successive character output. Each attribute given on the line may be prepended by a + to set or a -
to unset that attribute; + is assumed if absent. The attributes supported are blink, bold, dim, reverse,
standout, and underline.

Each fg_col / bg_col attribute (to be read as ‘ fg_col on bg_col ’) sets the foreground and
background color for character output. The color default is sometimes available (in particular if the
library is ncurses), specifying the foreground or background color with which the terminal started.
The color pair default/default is always available. To use more than the 8 named colors (red, green,
etc.) construct the fg_col / bg_col pairs where fg_col and bg_col are decimal integers, e.g
128/200. The maximum color value is 254 if the terminal supports 256 colors.

bg overrides the color and other attributes of all characters in the window. Its usual use is to set the
background initially, but it will overwrite the attributes of any characters at the time when it is called.
In addition to the arguments allowed with attr, an argument @ char specifies a character to be
shown in otherwise blank areas of the window. Owing to limitations of curses this cannot be a
multibyte character (use of ASCII characters only is recommended). As the specified set of attributes
override the existing background, turning attributes off in the arguments is not useful, though this
does not cause an error.

The subcommand scroll can be used with on or off to enabled or disable scrolling of a window when
the cursor would otherwise move below the window due to typing or output. It can also be used
with a positive or negative integer to scroll the window up or down the given number of lines
without changing the current cursor position (which therefore appears to move in the opposite
direction relative to the window). In the second case, if scrolling is off it is temporarily turned on to
allow the window to be scrolled.

The subcommand input reads a single character from the window without echoing it back. If param
is supplied the character is assigned to the parameter param , else it is assigned to the parameter
REPLY.

If both param and kparam are supplied, the key is read in ‘keypad’ mode. In this mode special keys
such as function keys and arrow keys return the name of the key in the parameter kparam . The key
names are the macros defined in the curses.h or ncurses.h with the prefix ‘KEY_’ removed; see also
the description of the parameter zcurses_keycodes below. Other keys cause a value to be set in
param as before. On a successful return only one of param or kparam contains a non-empty string;
the other is set to an empty string.

If mparam is also supplied, input attempts to handle mouse input. This is only available with the
ncurses library; mouse handling can be detected by checking for the exit status of ‘zcurses mouse’
with no arguments. If a mouse button is clicked (or double- or triple-clicked, or pressed or released
with a configurable delay from being clicked) then kparam is set to the string MOUSE, and mparam is
set to an array consisting of the following elements:

-
An identifier to discriminate different input devices; this is only rarely useful.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 426 of 616
:
-
The x, y and z coordinates of the mouse click relative to the full screen, as three elements in that
order (i.e. the y coordinate is, unusually, after the x coordinate). The z coordinate is only available for
a few unusual input devices and is otherwise set to zero.

-
Any events that occurred as separate items; usually there will be just one. An event consists of
PRESSED, RELEASED, CLICKED, DOUBLE_CLICKED or TRIPLE_CLICKED followed immediately (in the
same element) by the number of the button.

-
If the shift key was pressed, the string SHIFT.

-
If the control key was pressed, the string CTRL.

-
If the alt key was pressed, the string ALT.

Not all mouse events may be passed through to the terminal window; most terminal emulators
handle some mouse events themselves. Note that the ncurses manual implies that using input both
with and without mouse handling may cause the mouse cursor to appear and disappear.

The subcommand mouse can be used to configure the use of the mouse. There is no window
argument; mouse options are global. ‘zcurses mouse’ with no arguments returns status 0 if mouse
handling is possible, else status 1. Otherwise, the possible arguments (which may be combined on
the same command line) are as follows. delay num sets the maximum delay in milliseconds between
press and release events to be considered as a click; the value 0 disables click resolution, and the
default is one sixth of a second. motion proceeded by an optional ‘+’ (the default) or - turns on or off
reporting of mouse motion in addition to clicks, presses and releases, which are always reported.
However, it appears reports for mouse motion are not currently implemented.

The subcommand timeout specifies a timeout value for input from targetwin . If intval is
negative, ‘zcurses input’ waits indefinitely for a character to be typed; this is the default. If intval is
zero, ‘zcurses input’ returns immediately; if there is typeahead it is returned, else no input is done
and status 1 is returned. If intval is positive, ‘zcurses input’ waits intval milliseconds for input
and if there is none at the end of that period returns status 1.

The subcommand querychar queries the character at the current cursor position. The return values
are stored in the array named param if supplied, else in the array reply. The first value is the
character (which may be a multibyte character if the system supports them); the second is the color
pair in the usual fg_col / bg_col notation, or 0 if color is not supported. Any attributes other than
color that apply to the character, as set with the subcommand attr, appear as additional elements.

The subcommand resize resizes stdscr and all windows to given dimensions (windows that stick out
from the new dimensions are resized down). The underlying curses extension (resize_term call) can

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 427 of 616
:
be unavailable. To verify, zeroes can be used for height and width . If the result of the
subcommand is 0, resize_term is available (2 otherwise). Tests show that resizing can be normally
accomplished by calling zcurses end and zcurses refresh. The resize subcommand is provided for
versatility. Multiple system configurations have been checked and zcurses end and zcurses refresh
are still needed for correct terminal state after resize. To invoke them with resize, use endwin
argument. Using nosave argument will cause new terminal state to not be saved internally by
zcurses. This is also provided for versatility and should normally be not needed.

22.9.2 Parameters

ZCURSES_COLORS

Readonly integer. The maximum number of colors the terminal supports. This value is initialised by
the curses library and is not available until the first time zcurses init is run.

ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS

Readonly integer. The maximum number of color pairs fg_col / bg_col that may be defined in
‘zcurses attr’ commands; note this limit applies to all color pairs that have been used whether or not
they are currently active. This value is initialised by the curses library and is not available until the
first time zcurses init is run.

zcurses_attrs

Readonly array. The attributes supported by zsh/curses; available as soon as the module is loaded.

zcurses_colors

Readonly array. The colors supported by zsh/curses; available as soon as the module is loaded.

zcurses_keycodes

Readonly array. The values that may be returned in the second parameter supplied to ‘zcurses input’
in the order in which they are defined internally by curses. Not all function keys are listed, only F0;
curses reserves space for F0 up to F63.

zcurses_windows

Readonly array. The current list of windows, i.e. all windows that have been created with ‘zcurses
addwin’ and not removed with ‘zcurses delwin’.

22.10 The zsh/datetime Module


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 428 of 616
:
The zsh/datetime module makes available one builtin command:

strftime [ -s scalar | -n ] format [ epochtime [ nanoseconds ] ]

strftime -r [ -q ] [ -s scalar | -n ] format timestring

Output the date in the format specified. With no epochtime , the current system date/time is used;
optionally, epochtime may be used to specify the number of seconds since the epoch, and
nanoseconds may additionally be used to specify the number of nanoseconds past the second
(otherwise that number is assumed to be 0). See strftime(3) for details. The zsh extensions described
in Prompt Expansion are also available.

-n
Suppress printing a newline after the formatted string.

-q
Run quietly; suppress printing of all error messages described below. Errors for invalid epochtime
values are always printed.

-r
With the option -r (reverse), use format to parse the input string timestring and output the
number of seconds since the epoch at which the time occurred. The parsing is implemented by the
system function strptime; see strptime(3). This means that zsh format extensions are not available,
but for reverse lookup they are not required.

In most implementations of strftime any timezone in the timestring is ignored and the local
timezone declared by the TZ environment variable is used; other parameters are set to zero if not
present.

If timestring does not match format the command returns status 1 and prints an error message.
If timestring matches format but not all characters in timestring were used, the conversion
succeeds but also prints an error message.

If either of the system functions strptime or mktime is not available, status 2 is returned and an
error message is printed.

-s scalar
Assign the date string (or epoch time in seconds if -r is given) to scalar instead of printing it.

Note that depending on the system’s declared integral time type, strftime may produce incorrect
results for epoch times greater than 2147483647 which corresponds to 2038-01-19 03:14:07 +0000.

The zsh/datetime module makes available several parameters; all are readonly:

EPOCHREALTIME

A floating point value representing the number of seconds since the epoch. The notional accuracy is

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 429 of 616
:
to nanoseconds if the clock_gettime call is available and to microseconds otherwise, but in practice
the range of double precision floating point and shell scheduling latencies may be significant effects.

EPOCHSECONDS

An integer value representing the number of seconds since the epoch.

epochtime

An array value containing the number of seconds since the epoch in the first element and the
remainder of the time since the epoch in nanoseconds in the second element. To ensure the two
elements are consistent the array should be copied or otherwise referenced as a single substitution
before the values are used. The following idiom may be used:

for secs nsecs in $epochtime; do


...
done

22.11 The zsh/db/gdbm Module


The zsh/db/gdbm module is used to create "tied" associative arrays that interface to database files.
If the GDBM interface is not available, the builtins defined by this module will report an error. This
module is also intended as a prototype for creating additional database interfaces, so the ztie builtin
may move to a more generic module in the future.

The builtins in this module are:

ztie -d db/gdbm -f filename [ -r ] arrayname

Open the GDBM database identified by filename and, if successful, create the associative array
arrayname linked to the file. To create a local tied array, the parameter must first be declared, so
commands similar to the following would be executed inside a function scope:

local -A sampledb
ztie -d db/gdbm -f sample.gdbm sampledb

The -r option opens the database file for reading only, creating a parameter with the readonly
attribute. Without this option, using ‘ztie’ on a file for which the user does not have write permission
is changed in arrayname are immediately written to filename .

Changes to the file modes filename after it has been opened do not alter the state of arrayname ,
but ‘typeset -r arrayname ’ works as expected.

zuntie [ -u ] arrayname ...


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 430 of 616
:
Close the GDBM database associated with each arrayname and then unset the parameter. The -u
option forces an unset of parameters made readonly with ‘ztie -r’.

This happens automatically if the parameter is explicitly unset or its local scope (function) ends. Note
that a readonly parameter may not be explicitly unset, so the only way to unset a global parameter
created with ‘ztie -r’ is to use ‘zuntie -u’.

zgdbmpath parametername

Put path to database file assigned to parametername into REPLY scalar.

zgdbm_tied

Array holding names of all tied parameters.

The fields of an associative array tied to GDBM are neither cached nor otherwise stored in memory,
they are read from or written to the database on each reference. Thus, for example, the values in a
readonly array may be changed by a second writer of the same database file.

22.12 The zsh/deltochar Module


The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:

delete-to-char

Read a character from the keyboard, and delete from the cursor position up to and including the
next (or, with repeat count n , the n th) instance of that character. Negative repeat counts mean
delete backwards.

zap-to-char

This behaves like delete-to-char, except that the final occurrence of the character itself is not
deleted.

22.13 The zsh/example Module


The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:

example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]

Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 431 of 616
:
The purpose of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a module.

22.14 The zsh/files Module


The zsh/files module makes available some common commands for file manipulation as builtins;
these commands are probably not needed for many normal situations but can be useful in
emergency recovery situations with constrained resources. The commands do not implement all
features now required by relevant standards committees.

For all commands, a variant beginning zf_ is also available and loaded automatically. Using the
features capability of zmodload will let you load only those names you want. Note that it’s possible
to load only the builtins with zsh-specific names using the following command:

zmodload -m -F zsh/files b:zf_\*

The commands loaded by default are:

chgrp [ -hRs ] group filename ...

Changes group of files specified. This is equivalent to chown with a user-spec argument of
‘: group ’.

chmod [ -Rs ] mode filename ...

Changes mode of files specified.

The specified mode must be in octal.

The -R option causes chmod to recursively descend into directories, changing the mode of all files in
the directory after changing the mode of the directory itself.

The -s option is a zsh extension to chmod functionality. It enables paranoid behaviour, intended to
avoid security problems involving a chmod being tricked into affecting files other than the ones
intended. It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example) ‘‘chmod 600 /tmp/foo/passwd’’
can’t accidentally chmod /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc. It will also check where
it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive chmod of a deep directory tree can’t end up
recursively chmoding /usr as a result of directories being moved up the tree.

chown [ -hRs ] user-spec filename ...

Changes ownership and group of files specified.

The user-spec can be in four forms:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 432 of 616
:
user
change owner to user ; do not change group

user ::
change owner to user ; do not change group

user :
change owner to user ; change group to user ’s primary group

user : group
change owner to user ; change group to group

: group
do not change owner; change group to group

In each case, the ‘:’ may instead be a ‘.’. The rule is that if there is a ‘:’ then the separator is ‘:’,
otherwise if there is a ‘.’ then the separator is ‘.’, otherwise there is no separator.

Each of user and group may be either a username (or group name, as appropriate) or a decimal
user ID (group ID). Interpretation as a name takes precedence, if there is an all-numeric username
(or group name).

If the target is a symbolic link, the -h option causes chown to set the ownership of the link instead of
its target.

The -R option causes chown to recursively descend into directories, changing the ownership of all
files in the directory after changing the ownership of the directory itself.

The -s option is a zsh extension to chown functionality. It enables paranoid behaviour, intended to
avoid security problems involving a chown being tricked into affecting files other than the ones
intended. It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example) ‘‘chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd’’
can’t accidentally chown /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc. It will also check where
it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive chown of a deep directory tree can’t end up
recursively chowning /usr as a result of directories being moved up the tree.

ln [ -dfhins ] filename dest

ln [ -dfhins ] filename ... dir

Creates hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links. In the first form, the specified dest ination is created, as a
link to the specified filename . In the second form, each of the filename s is taken in turn, and
linked to a pathname in the specified dir ectory that has the same last pathname component.

Normally, ln will not attempt to create hard links to directories. This check can be overridden using
the -d option. Typically only the super-user can actually succeed in creating hard links to directories.
This does not apply to symbolic links in any case.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 433 of 616
:
By default, existing files cannot be replaced by links. The -i option causes the user to be queried
about replacing existing files. The -f option causes existing files to be silently deleted, without
querying. -f takes precedence.

The -h and -n options are identical and both exist for compatibility; either one indicates that if the
target is a symlink then it should not be dereferenced. Typically this is used in combination with -sf
so that if an existing link points to a directory then it will be removed, instead of followed. If this
option is used with multiple filenames and the target is a symbolic link pointing to a directory then
the result is an error.

mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...

Creates directories. With the -p option, non-existing parent directories are first created if necessary,
and there will be no complaint if the directory already exists. The -m option can be used to specify
(in octal) a set of file permissions for the created directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the
current umask (see umask(2)) is used.

mv [ -fi ] filename dest

mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir

Moves files. In the first form, the specified filename is moved to the specified dest ination. In the
second form, each of the filename s is taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the specified
dir ectory that has the same last pathname component.

By default, the user will be queried before replacing any file removed. The -i option causes the user
to be queried about replacing any existing files. The -f option causes any existing files to be silently
deleted, without querying. -f takes precedence.

Note that this mv will not move files across devices. Historical versions of mv, when actual renaming
is impossible, fall back on copying and removing files; if this behaviour is desired, use cp and rm
manually. This may change in a future version.

rm [ -dfiRrs ] filename ...

Removes files and directories specified.

Normally, rm will not remove directories (except with the -R or -r options). The -d option causes rm
to try removing directories with unlink (see unlink(2)), the same method used for files. Typically only
the super-user can actually succeed in unlinking directories in this way. -d takes precedence over -R
and -r.

By default, the user will be queried before removing any file removed. The -i option causes the user
to be queried about removing any files. The -f option causes files to be silently deleted, without
querying, and suppresses all error indications. -f takes precedence.

The -R and -r options cause rm to recursively descend into directories, deleting all files in the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 434 of 616
:
directory before removing the directory with the rmdir system call (see rmdir(2)).

The -s option is a zsh extension to rm functionality. It enables paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid
common security problems involving a root-run rm being tricked into removing files other than the
ones intended. It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example) ‘‘rm /tmp/foo/passwd’’
can’t accidentally remove /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc. It will also check
where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive removal of a deep directory tree can’t end up
recursively removing /usr as a result of directories being moved up the tree.

rmdir dir ...

Removes empty directories specified.

sync

Calls the system call of the same name (see sync(2)), which flushes dirty buffers to disk. It might
return before the I/O has actually been completed.

22.15 The zsh/langinfo Module


The zsh/langinfo module makes available one parameter:

langinfo

An associative array that maps langinfo elements to their values.

Your implementation may support a number of the following keys:

CODESET, D_T_FMT, D_FMT, T_FMT, RADIXCHAR, THOUSEP, YESEXPR, NOEXPR, CRNCYSTR,


ABDAY_{1..7}, DAY_{1..7}, ABMON_{1..12}, MON_{1..12}, T_FMT_AMPM, AM_STR, PM_STR, ERA,
ERA_D_FMT, ERA_D_T_FMT, ERA_T_FMT, ALT_DIGITS

22.16 The zsh/mapfile Module


The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter of the same name.

mapfile

This associative array takes as keys the names of files; the resulting value is the content of the file.
The value is treated identically to any other text coming from a parameter. The value may also be
assigned to, in which case the file in question is written (whether or not it originally existed); or an
element may be unset, which will delete the file in question. For example, ‘vared ’mapfile[myfile]’’

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 435 of 616
:
works as expected, editing the file ‘myfile’.

When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of files in the current directory, and
the values are empty (to save a huge overhead in memory). Thus ${(k)mapfile} has the same effect
as the glob operator *(D), since files beginning with a dot are not special. Care must be taken with
expressions such as rm ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the current directory without the
usual ‘rm *’ test.

The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files referenced may not be written or
deleted.

A file may conveniently be read into an array as one line per element with the form ‘ array =
("${(f@)mapfile[ filename ]}")’. The double quotes and the ‘@’ are necessary to prevent empty lines
from being removed. Note that if the file ends with a newline, the shell will split on the final newline,
generating an additional empty field; this can be suppressed by using ‘ array =
("${(f@)${mapfile[ filename ]%$’\n’}}")’.

22.16.1 Limitations

Although reading and writing of the file in question is efficiently handled, zsh’s internal memory
management may be arbitrarily baroque; however, mapfile is usually very much more efficient than
anything involving a loop. Note in particular that the whole contents of the file will always reside
physically in memory when accessed (possibly multiple times, due to standard parameter
substitution operations). In particular, this means handling of sufficiently long files (greater than the
machine’s swap space, or than the range of the pointer type) will be incorrect.

No errors are printed or flagged for non-existent, unreadable, or execution hierarchy to make this
convenient.

It is unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet allow the user to specify the
name of the shell parameter to be given the special behaviour.

22.17 The zsh/mathfunc Module


The zsh/mathfunc module provides standard mathematical functions for use when evaluating
mathematical formulae. The syntax agrees with normal C and FORTRAN conventions, for example,

(( f = sin(0.3) ))

assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 436 of 616
:
Most functions take floating point arguments and return a floating point value. However, any
necessary conversions from or to integer type will be performed automatically by the shell. Apart
from atan with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all functions behave as noted
in the manual page for the corresponding C function, except that any arguments out of range for the
function in question will be detected by the shell and an error reported.

The following functions take a single floating point argument: acos, acosh, asin, asinh, atan, atanh,
cbrt, ceil, cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp, expm1, fabs, floor, gamma, j0, j1, lgamma, log, log10, log1p, log2,
logb, sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1. The atan function can optionally take a second argument, in
which case it behaves like the C function atan2. The ilogb function takes a single floating point
argument, but returns an integer.

The function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which is the C variable of the
same name, as described in gamma(3). Note that it is therefore only useful immediately after a call
to gamma or lgamma. Note also that ‘signgam()’ and ‘signgam’ are distinct expressions.

The functions min, max, and sum are defined not in this module but in the zmathfunc autoloadable
function, described in Mathematical Functions.

The following functions take two floating point arguments: copysign, fmod, hypot, nextafter.

The following take an integer first argument and a floating point second argument: jn, yn.

The following take a floating point first argument and an integer second argument: ldexp, scalb.

The function abs does not convert the type of its single argument; it returns the absolute value of
either a floating point number or an integer. The functions float and int convert their arguments into
a floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.

Note that the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation as the ‘**’ operator and is not
provided here.

The function rand48 is available if your system’s mathematical library has the function erand48(3). It
returns a pseudo-random floating point number between 0 and 1. It takes a single string optional
argument.

If the argument is not present, the random number seed is initialised by three calls to the rand(3)
function — this produces the same random numbers as the next three values of $RANDOM.

If the argument is present, it gives the name of a scalar parameter where the current random
number seed will be stored. On the first call, the value must contain at least twelve hexadecimal
digits (the remainder of the string is ignored), or the seed will be initialised in the same manner as
for a call to rand48 with no argument. Subsequent calls to rand48( param ) will then maintain the
seed in the parameter param as a string of twelve hexadecimal digits, with no base signifier. The
random number sequences for different parameters are completely independent, and are also
independent from that used by calls to rand48 with no argument.

For example, consider


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 437 of 616
:
print $(( rand48(seed) ))
print $(( rand48() ))
print $(( rand48(seed) ))

Assuming $seed does not exist, it will be initialised by the first call. In the second call, the default
seed is initialised; note, however, that because of the properties of rand() there is a correlation
between the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for more secure uses, you should generate
your own 12-byte seed. The third call returns to the same sequence of random numbers used in the
first call, unaffected by the intervening rand48().

22.18 The zsh/nearcolor Module


The zsh/nearcolor module replaces colours specified as hex triplets with the nearest colour in the 88
or 256 colour palettes that are widely used by terminal emulators. By default, 24-bit true colour
escape codes are generated when colours are specified using hex triplets. These are not supported
by all terminals. The purpose of this module is to make it easier to define colour preferences in a
form that can work across a range of terminal emulators.

Aside from the default colour, the ANSI standard for terminal escape codes provides for eight
colours. The bright attribute brings this to sixteen. These basic colours are commonly used in
terminal applications due to being widely supported. Expanded 88 and 256 colour palettes are also
common and, while the first sixteen colours vary somewhat between terminals and configurations,
these add a generally consistent and

In order to use the zsh/nearcolor module, it only needs to be loaded. Thereafter, whenever a colour
is specified using a hex triplet, it will be compared against each of the available colours and the
closest will be selected. The first sixteen colours are never matched in

It isn’t possible to reliably detect support for true colour in the terminal emulator. It is therefore
recommended to be selective in loading the zsh/nearcolor module. For example, the following
checks the COLORTERM environment variable:

[[ $COLORTERM = *(24bit|truecolor)* ]] || zmodload zsh/nearcolor

Note that some terminals accept the true color escape codes but map them internally to a more
limited palette in a similar manner to the zsh/nearcolor module.

22.19 The zsh/newuser Module

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 438 of 616
:
The zsh/newuser module is loaded at boot if it is available, the RCS option is set, and the PRIVILEGED
option is not set (all three are true by default). This takes place immediately after commands in the
global zshenv file (typically /etc/zshenv), if any, have been executed. If the module is not available it
is silently ignored by the shell; the module may safely be removed from $MODULE_PATH by the
administrator if it is not required.

On loading, the module tests if any of the start-up files .zshenv, .zprofile, .zshrc or .zlogin exist in the
directory given by the environment variable ZDOTDIR, or the user’s home directory if that is not set.
The test is not performed and the module halts processing if the shell was in an emulation mode
(i.e. had been invoked as some other shell than zsh).

If none of the start-up files were found, the module then looks for the file newuser first in a sitewide
directory, usually the parent directory of the site-functions directory, and if that is not found the
module searches in a version-specific directory, usually the parent of the functions directory
containing version-specific functions. (These directories can be configured when zsh is built using
the –enable-site-scriptdir= dir and –enable-scriptdir= dir flags to configure, respectively; the
defaults are prefix /share/zsh and prefix /share/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION where the default prefix is
/usr/local.)

If the file newuser is found, it is then sourced in the same manner as a start-up file. The file is
expected to contain code to install start-up files for the user, however any valid shell code will be
executed.

The zsh/newuser module is then unconditionally unloaded.

Note that it is possible to achieve exactly the same effect as the zsh/newuser module by adding code
to /etc/zshenv. The module exists simply to allow the shell to make arrangements for new users
without the need for intervention by package maintainers and system administrators.

The script supplied with the module invokes the shell function zsh-newuser-install. This may be
invoked directly by the user even if the zsh/newuser module is disabled. Note, however, that if the
module is not installed the function will not be installed either. The function is documented in User
Configuration Functions.

22.20 The zsh/parameter Module


The zsh/parameter module gives access to some of the internal hash

options

The keys for this associative array are the names of the options that can be set and unset using the
setopt and unsetopt builtins. The value of each key is either the string on if the option is currently
set, or the string off if the option is unset. Setting a key to one of these strings is like setting or
unsetting the option, respectively. Unsetting a key in this array is like setting it to the value off.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 439 of 616
:
commands

names of external commands, the values are the pathnames of the files that would be executed
when the command would be invoked. Setting a with the hash builtin. Unsetting a key as in ‘unset
"commands[foo]"’ removes the entry for the given key from the command

functions

This associative array maps names of enabled functions to their definitions. Setting a key in it is like
defining a function with the name given by the key and the body given by the value. Unsetting a key
removes the definition for the function named by the key.

dis_functions

Like functions but for disabled functions.

functions_source

This readonly associative array maps names of enabled functions to the name of the file containing
the source of the function.

For an autoloaded function that has already been loaded, or marked for autoload with an absolute
path, or that has had its path resolved with ‘functions -r’, this is the file found for autoloading,
resolved to an absolute path.

For a function defined within the body of a script or sourced file, this is the name of that file. In this
case, this is the exact path originally used to that file, which may be a relative path.

For any other function, including any defined at an interactive prompt or an autoload function
whose path has not yet been resolved, this is the empty string. However, the hash element is
reported as defined just so long as the function is present: the keys to this hash are the same as
those to $functions.

dis_functions_source

Like functions_source but for disabled functions.

builtins

This associative array gives information about the builtin commands currently enabled. The keys are
the names of the builtin commands and the values are either ‘undefined’ for builtin commands that
will automatically be loaded from a module if invoked or ‘defined’ for builtin commands that are
already loaded.

dis_builtins

Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.

reswords

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 440 of 616
:
This array contains the enabled reserved words.

dis_reswords

Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.

patchars

This array contains the enabled pattern characters.

dis_patchars

Like patchars but for disabled pattern characters.

aliases

This maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to their expansions.

dis_aliases

Like aliases but for disabled regular aliases.

galiases

Like aliases, but for global aliases.

dis_galiases

Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.

saliases

Like raliases, but for suffix aliases.

dis_saliases

Like saliases but for disabled suffix aliases.

parameters

The keys in this associative array are the names of the parameters currently defined. The values are
strings describing the type of the parameter, in the same format used by the t parameter flag, see
Parameter Expansion . Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

modules

An associative array giving information about modules. The keys are the names of the modules
loaded, registered to be autoloaded, or aliased. The value says which state the named module is in
and is one of the strings ‘loaded’, ‘autoloaded’, or ‘alias: name ’, where name is the name the module
is aliased to.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 441 of 616
:
Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

dirstack

A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note that the output of the dirs builtin
command includes one more directory, the current working directory.

history

This associative array maps history event numbers to the full history lines. Although it is presented
as an associative array, the array of all values (${history[@]}) is guaranteed to be returned in order
from most recent to oldest history event, that is, by decreasing history event number.

historywords

A special array containing the words stored in the history. These also appear in most to least recent
order.

jobdirs

This associative array maps job numbers to the directories from which the job was started (which
may not be the current directory of the job).

The keys of the associative arrays are usually valid job numbers, and these are the values output
with, for example, ${(k)jobdirs}. Non-numeric job references may be used when looking up a value;
for example, ${jobdirs[%+]} refers to the current job.

See the jobs builtin for how job information is provided in a subshell.

jobtexts

This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the command lines that were used to start
the jobs.

Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for jobdirs above.

See the jobs builtin for how job information is provided in a subshell.

jobstates

This associative array gives information about the states of the jobs currently known. The keys are
the job numbers and the values are strings of the form ‘ job-state : mark : pid = state ...’. The job-
state gives the state the whole job is currently in, one of ‘running’, ‘suspended’, or ‘done’. The mark
is ‘+’ for the current job, ‘-’ for the previous job and empty otherwise. This is followed by one
‘: pid = state ’ for every process in the job. The pid s are, of course, the process IDs and the state
describes the state of that process.

Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for jobdirs above.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 442 of 616
:
See the jobs builtin for how job information is provided in a subshell.

nameddirs

This associative array maps the names of named directories to the pathnames they stand for.

userdirs

This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their home directories.

usergroups

This associative array maps names of system groups of which the current user is a member to the
corresponding group identifiers. The contents are the same as the groups output by the id
command.

funcfiletrace

This array contains the absolute line numbers and corresponding file names for the point where the
current function, sourced file, or (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval command was called. The array is of
the same length as funcsourcetrace and functrace, but differs from funcsourcetrace in that the line
and file are the point of call, not the point of definition, and differs from functrace in that all values
are absolute line numbers in files, rather than relative to the start of a function, if any.

funcsourcetrace

This array contains the file names and line numbers of the points where the functions, sourced files,
and (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval commands currently being executed were defined. The line number
is the line where the ‘function name ’ or ‘ name ()’ started. In the case of an autoloaded function the
line number is reported as zero. The format of each element is filename : lineno .

For functions autoloaded from a file in native zsh format, where only the body of the function occurs
in the file, or for files that have been executed by the source or ‘.’ builtins, the trace information is
shown as filename : 0 , since the entire file is the definition. The source file name is resolved to an
absolute path when the function is loaded or the path to it otherwise resolved.

Most users will be interested in the information in the funcfiletrace array instead.

funcstack

This array contains the names of the functions, sourced files, and (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval
commands. currently being executed. The first element is the name of the function using the
parameter.

The standard shell array zsh_eval_context can be used to determine the type of shell construct being
executed at each depth: note, however, that is in the opposite order, with the most recent item last,
and it is more detailed, for example including an entry for toplevel, the main shell code being
executed either interactively or from a script, which is not present in $funcstack.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 443 of 616
:
functrace

This array contains the names and line numbers of the callers corresponding to the functions
currently being executed. The format of each element is name : lineno . Callers are also shown for
sourced files; the caller is the point where the source or ‘.’ command was executed.

22.21 The zsh/pcre Module


The zsh/pcre module makes some commands available as builtins:

pcre_compile [ -aimxs ] PCRE

Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.

Option -a will force the pattern to be anchored. Option -i will compile a case-insensitive pattern.
Option -m will compile a multi-line pattern; that is, ^ and $ will match newlines within the pattern.
Option -x will compile an extended pattern, wherein whitespace and # comments are ignored.
Option -s makes the dot metacharacter match all characters, including those that indicate newline.

pcre_study

Studies the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in faster matching.

pcre_match [ -v var ] [ -a arr ] [ -n offset ] [ -b ] string

Returns successfully if string matches the previously-compiled PCRE.

Upon successful match, if the expression captures substrings within parentheses, pcre_match will
set the array match to those substrings, unless the -a option is given, in which case it will set the
array arr . Similarly, the variable MATCH will be set to the entire matched portion of the string,
unless the -v option is given, in which case the variable var will be set. No variables are altered if
there is no successful match. A -n option starts searching for a match from the byte offset position
in string . If the -b option is given, the variable ZPCRE_OP will be set to an offset pair string,
representing the byte offset positions of the entire matched portion within the string . For
example, a ZPCRE_OP set to "32 45" indicates that the matched portion began on byte offset 32 and
ended on byte offset 44. Here, byte offset position 45 is the position directly after the matched
portion. Keep in mind that the byte position isn’t necessarily the same as the character position
when UTF-8 characters are involved. Consequently, the byte offset positions are only to be relied on
in the context of using them for subsequent searches on string , using an offset position as an
argument to the -n option. This is mostly used to implement the "find all non-overlapping matches"
functionality.

A simple example of "find all non-overlapping matches":

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 444 of 616
:
string="The following zip codes: 78884 90210 99513"
pcre_compile -m "\d{5}"
accum=()
pcre_match -b -- $string
while [[ $? -eq 0 ]] do
b=($=ZPCRE_OP)
accum+=$MATCH
pcre_match -b -n $b[2] -- $string
done
print -l $accum

The zsh/pcre module makes available the following test condition:

expr -pcre-match pcre

Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.

For example,

[[ "$text" -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] &&


print text variable contains only "d's".

If the REMATCH_PCRE option is set, the =~ operator is equivalent to -pcre-match, and the
NO_CASE_MATCH option may be used. Note that NO_CASE_MATCH never applies to the pcre_match
builtin, instead use the -i switch of pcre_compile.

22.22 The zsh/param/private Module


The zsh/param/private module is used to create parameters whose scope is limited to the current
function body, and not to other functions called by the current function.

This module provides a single autoloaded builtin:

private [ {+|-}AHUahlmrtux ] [ {+|-}EFLRZi [ n ] ] [ name [= value ] ... ]

The private builtin accepts all the same options and arguments as local (Shell Builtin Commands)
except for the ‘-T’ option. Tied parameters may not be made private.

The ‘-p’ option is presently a no-op because the state of private parameters cannot reliably be
reloaded. This also applies to printing private parameters with ‘typeset -p’.

If used at the top level (outside a function scope), private creates a normal parameter in the same
manner as declare or typeset. A warning about this is printed if WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL is set
(Options). Used inside a function scope, private creates a local parameter similar to one declared
with local, except having special properties noted below.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 445 of 616
:
Special parameters which expose or manipulate internal shell state, such as ARGC, argv, COLUMNS,
LINES, UID, EUID, IFS, PROMPT, RANDOM, SECONDS, etc., cannot be made private unless the ‘-h’
option is used to hide the special meaning of the parameter. This may change in the future.

As with other typeset equivalents, private is both a builtin and a reserved word, so arrays may be
assigned with parenthesized word list name =( value ...) syntax. However, the reserved word ‘private’
is not available until zsh/param/private is loaded, so care must be taken with order of execution and
parsing for function definitions which use private. To compensate for this, the module also adds the
option ‘-P’ to the ‘local’ builtin to declare private parameters.

For example, this construction fails if zsh/param/private has not yet been loaded when
‘bad_declaration’ is defined:

bad_declaration() {
zmodload zsh/param/private
private array=( one two three )
}

This construction works because local is already a keyword, and the module is loaded before the
statement is executed:

good_declaration() {
zmodload zsh/param/private
local -P array=( one two three )
}

The following is usable in scripts but may have trouble with autoload:

zmodload zsh/param/private
iffy_declaration() {
private array=( one two three )
}

The private builtin may always be used with scalar assignments and for declarations without
assignments.

Parameters declared with private have the following properties:

Within the function body where it is declared, the parameter behaves as a local, except as
noted above for tied or special parameters.
The type of a parameter declared private cannot be changed in the scope where it was
declared, even if the parameter is unset. Thus an array cannot be assigned to a private scalar,
etc.
Within any other function called by the declaring function, the private parameter does NOT
hide other parameters of the same name, so for example a global parameter of the same
name is visible and may be assigned or unset. This includes calls to anonymous functions,
although that may also change in the future. However, the private name may not be created

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 446 of 616
:
outside the local scope when it was not previously declared.
An exported private remains in the environment of inner scopes but appears unset for the
current shell in those scopes. Generally, exporting private parameters should be avoided.

Note that this differs from the static scope defined by compiled languages derived from C, in that
the a new call to the same function creates a new scope, i.e., the parameter is still associated with
the call stack rather than with the function definition. It differs from ksh ‘typeset -S’ because the
syntax used to define the function has no bearing on whether the parameter scope is respected.

22.23 The zsh/regex Module


The zsh/regex module makes available the following test condition:

expr -regex-match regex

Matches a string against a POSIX extended regular expression. On successful match, matched
portion of the string will normally be placed in the MATCH variable. If there are any capturing
parentheses within the regex, then the match array variable will contain those. If the match is not
successful, then the variables will not be altered.

For example,

[[ alphabetical -regex-match ^a([^a]+)a([^a]+)a ]] &&


print -l $MATCH X $match

If the option REMATCH_PCRE is not set, then the =~ operator will automatically load this module as
needed and will invoke the -regex-match operator.

If BASH_REMATCH is set, then the array BASH_REMATCH will be set instead of MATCH and match.

Note that the zsh/regex module logic relies on the host system. The same expr and regex pair
could produce different results on different platforms if a regex with non-standard syntax is given.

For example, no syntax for matching a word boundary is defined in the POSIX extended regular
expression standard. GNU libc and BSD libc both provide such syntaxes as extensions (\b and [[:
<:]]/[[:>:]] respectively), but neither of these syntaxes is supported by both of these
implementations.

Refer to the regcomp(3) and re_format(7) manual pages on your system for locally-supported
syntax.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 447 of 616
:
22.24 The zsh/sched Module
The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command and one parameter.

sched [-o] [+] hh : mm [: ss ] command ...

sched [-o] [+] seconds command ...

sched [ - item ]

Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute. The time may be specified in either
absolute or relative time, and either as hours, minutes and (optionally) seconds separated by a
colon, or seconds alone. An absolute number of seconds indicates the time since the epoch
(1970/01/01 00:00); this is useful in combination with the features in the zsh/datetime module, see
The zsh/datetime Module.

With no arguments, prints the list of scheduled commands. If the scheduled command has the -o
flag set, this is shown at the start of the command.

With the argument ‘- item ’, removes the given item from the list. The numbering of the list is
continuous and entries are in time order, so the numbering can change when entries are added or
deleted.

Commands are executed either immediately before a prompt, or while the shell’s line editor is
waiting for input. In the latter case it is useful to be able to produce output that does not interfere
with the line being edited. Providing the option -o causes the shell to clear the command line before
the event and redraw it afterwards. This should be used with any scheduled event that produces
visible output to the terminal; it is not needed, for example, with output that updates a terminal
emulator’s title bar.

To effect changes to the editor buffer when an event executes, use the ‘zle’ command with no
arguments to test whether the editor is active, and if it is, then use ‘zle widget ’ to access the editor
via the named widget .

The sched builtin is not made available by default when the shell starts in a mode emulating another
shell. It can be made available with the command ‘zmodload -F zsh/sched b:sched’.

zsh_scheduled_events

A readonly array corresponding to the events scheduled by the sched builtin. The indices of the
array correspond to the numbers shown when sched is run with no arguments (provided that the
KSH_ARRAYS option is not set). The value of the array consists of the scheduled time in seconds
since the epoch (see The zsh/datetime Module for facilities for using this number), followed by a
colon, followed by any options (which may be empty but will be preceded by a ‘-’ otherwise),
followed by a colon, followed by the command to be executed.

The sched builtin should be used for manipulating the events. Note that this will have an immediate

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 448 of 616
:
effect on the contents of the array, so that indices may become invalid.

22.25 The zsh/net/socket Module


The zsh/net/socket module makes available one builtin command:

zsocket [ -altv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]

zsocket is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line editing, file I/O, and job
control mechanisms.

22.25.1 Outbound Connections

zsocket [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
Open a new Unix domain connection to filename . The shell parameter REPLY will be set to the file
descriptor associated with that connection. Currently, only stream connections are supported.

If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for the connection.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

File descriptors can be closed with normal shell syntax when no longer needed, for example:

exec {REPLY}>&-

22.25.2 Inbound Connections

zsocket -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
zsocket -l will open a socket listening on filename . The shell parameter REPLY will be set to the file
descriptor associated with that listener. The file descriptor remains open in subshells

If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for the connection.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

zsocket -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd


zsocket -a will accept an incoming connection to the socket associated with listenfd . The shell
parameter REPLY will be set to the file descriptor associated with the inbound connection. The file
descriptor remains open in subshells

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 449 of 616
:
If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for the connection.

If -t is specified, zsocket will return if no incoming connection is pending. Otherwise it will wait for
one.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

22.26 The zsh/stat Module


The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command under two possible names:

zstat [ -gnNolLtTrs ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F fmt ]

[ + element ] [ file ... ]

stat ...

The command acts as a front end to the stat system call (see stat(2)). The same command is
provided with two names; as the name stat is often used by an external command it is
recommended that only the zstat form of the command is used. This can be arranged by loading the
module with the command ‘zmodload -F zsh/stat b:zstat’.

If the stat call fails, the appropriate system error message printed and status 1 is returned. The fields
of struct stat give information about the files provided as arguments to the command. In addition to
those available from the stat call, an extra element ‘link’ is provided. These elements are:

device
The number of the device on which the file resides.

inode
The unique number of the file on this device (‘inode’ number).

mode
The mode of the file; that is, the file’s type and access permissions. With the -s option, this will be
returned as a string corresponding to the first column in the display of the ls -l command.

nlink
The number of hard links to the file.

uid
The user ID of the owner of the file. With the -s option, this is displayed as a user name.

gid
The group ID of the file. With the -s option, this is displayed as a group name.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 450 of 616
:
rdev
The raw device number. This is only useful for special devices.

size
The size of the file in bytes.

atime
mtime
ctime
The last access, modification and inode change times of the file, respectively, as the number of
seconds since midnight GMT on 1st January, 1970. With the -s option, these are printed as strings for
the local time zone; the format can be altered with the -F option, and with the -g option the times are
in GMT.

blksize
The number of bytes in one allocation block on the device on which the file resides.

block
The number of disk blocks used by the file.

link
If the file is a link and the -L option is in effect, this contains the name of the file linked to, otherwise
it is empty. Note that if this element is selected (‘‘zstat +link’’) then the -L option is automatically
used.

A particular element may be selected by including its name preceded by a ‘+’ in the option list; only
one element is allowed. The element may be shortened to any unique set of leading characters.
Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.

Options:

-A array
Instead of displaying the results on standard output, assign them to an array , one struct stat
element per array element for each file in order. In this case neither the name of the element nor
the name of the files appears in array unless the -t or -n options were given, respectively. If -t is
given, the element name appears as a prefix to the appropriate array element; if -n is given, the file
name appears as a separate array element preceding all the others. Other formatting options are
respected.

-H hash
Similar to -A, but instead assign the values to hash . The keys are the elements listed above. If the -n
option is provided then the name of the file is included in the hash with key name.

-f fd
Use the file on file descriptor fd instead of named files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.

-F fmt
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 451 of 616
:
Supplies a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the formatting of the time elements. The format string
supports all of the zsh extensions described in Prompt Expansion. In particular, -F %s.%N can be
used to show timestamps with nanosecond precision if supported by the system. The -s option is
implied.

-g
Show the time elements in the GMT time zone. The -s option is implied.

-l
List the names of the type elements (to standard output or an array as appropriate) and return
immediately; arguments, and options other than -A, are ignored.

-L
Perform an lstat (see lstat(2)) rather than a stat system call. In this case, if the file is a link,
information about the link itself rather than the target file is returned. This option is required to
make the link element useful. It’s important to note that this is the exact opposite from ls(1), etc.

-n
Always show the names of files. Usually these are only shown when output is to standard output
and there is more than one file in the list.

-N
Never show the names of files.

-o
If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is more useful for human consumption than the
default of decimal. A leading zero will be printed in this case. Note that this does not affect whether
a raw or formatted file mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s options, nor whether a
mode is shown at all.

-r
Print raw data (the default format) alongside string data (the -s format); the string data appears in
parentheses after the raw data.

-s
Print mode, uid, gid and the three time elements as strings instead of numbers. In each case the
format is like that of ls -l.

-t
Always show the type names for the elements of struct stat. Usually these are only shown when
output is to standard output and no individual element has been selected.

-T
Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 452 of 616
:
22.27 The zsh/system Module
The zsh/system module makes available various builtin commands and parameters.

22.27.1 Builtins

syserror [ -e errvar ] [ -p prefix ] [ errno | errname ]

This command prints out the error message associated with errno , a system error number,
followed by a newline to standard error.

Instead of the error number, a name errname , for example ENOENT, may be used. The set of
names is the same as the contents of the array errnos, see below.

If the string prefix is given, it is printed in front of the error message, with no intervening space.

If errvar is supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is assigned to the parameter names
errvar and nothing is output.

A return status of 0 indicates the message was successfully printed (although it may not be useful if
the error number was out of the system’s range), a return status of 1 indicates an error in the
parameters, and a return status of 2 indicates the error name was not recognised (no message is
printed for this).

sysopen [ -arw ] [ -m permissions ] [ -o options ]

-u fd file

This command opens a file. The -r, -w and -a flags indicate whether the file should be opened for
reading, writing and appending, respectively. The -m option allows the initial permissions to use
when creating a file to be specified in octal form. The file descriptor is specified with -u. Either an
explicit file descriptor in the range 0 to 9 can be specified or a variable name can be given to which
the file descriptor number will be assigned.

The -o option allows various system specific options to be specified as a comma-separated list. The
following is a list of possible options. Note that, depending on the system, some may not be
available.

cloexec
mark file to be closed when other programs are executed (else the file descriptor remains open in
subshells and forked external

create
creat
create file if it does not exist
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 453 of 616
:
excl
create file, error if it already exists

noatime
suppress updating of the file atime

nofollow
fail if file is a symbolic link

nonblock
the file is opened in nonblocking mode

sync
request that writes wait until data has been physically written

truncate
trunc
truncate file to size 0

To close the file, use one of the following:

exec {fd}<&-
exec {fd}>&-

sysread [ -c countvar ] [ -i infd ] [ -o outfd ]

[ -s bufsize ] [ -t timeout ] [ param ]

Perform a single system read from file descriptor infd , or zero if that is not given. The result of the
read is stored in param or REPLY if that is not given. If countvar is given, the number of bytes read
is assigned to the parameter named by countvar .

The maximum number of bytes read is bufsize or 8192 if that is not given, however the command
returns as soon as any number of bytes was successfully read.

If timeout is given, it specifies a timeout in seconds, which may be zero to poll the file descriptor.
This is handled by the poll system call if available, otherwise the select system call if available.

If outfd is given, an attempt is made to write all the bytes just read to the file descriptor outfd . If
this fails, because of a system error other than EINTR or because of an internal zsh error during an
interrupt, the bytes read but not written are stored in the parameter named by param if supplied
(no default is used in this case), and the number of bytes read but not written is stored in the
parameter named by countvar if that is supplied. If it was successful, countvar contains the full
number of bytes transferred, as usual, and param is not set.

The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally so that shell interrupts are
transparent to the caller. Any other error causes a return.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 454 of 616
:
The possible return statuses are

0
At least one byte of data was successfully read and, if appropriate, written.

1
There was an error in the parameters to the command. This is the only error for which a message is
printed to standard error.

2
There was an error on the read, or on polling the input file descriptor for a timeout. The parameter
ERRNO gives the error.

3
Data were successfully read, but there was an error writing them to outfd . The parameter ERRNO
gives the error.

4
The attempt to read timed out. Note this does not set ERRNO as this is not a system error.

5
No system error occurred, but zero bytes were read. This usually indicates end of file. The
parameters are set according to the usual rules; no write to outfd is attempted.

sysseek [ -u fd ] [ -w start|end|current ] offset

The current file position at which future reads and writes will take place is adjusted to the specified
byte offset. The offset is evaluated as a math expression. The -u option allows the file descriptor to
be specified. By default the offset is specified relative to the start or the file but, with the -w option, it
is possible to specify that the offset should be relative to the current position or the end of the file.

syswrite [ -c countvar ] [ -o outfd ] data

The data (a single string of bytes) are written to the file descriptor outfd , or 1 if that is not given,
using the write system call. Multiple write operations may be used if the first does not write all the
data.

If countvar is given, the number of byte written is stored in the parameter named by countvar ;
this may not be the full length of data if an error occurred.

The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally by retrying; otherwise an error causes
the command to return. For example, if the file descriptor is set to non-blocking output, an error
EAGAIN (on some systems, EWOULDBLOCK) may result in the command returning early.

The return status may be 0 for success, 1 for an error in the parameters to the command, or 2 for an
error on the write; no error message is printed in the last case, but the parameter ERRNO will reflect
the error that occurred.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 455 of 616
:
zsystem flock [ -t timeout ] [ -i interval ] [ -f var ] [-er] file

zsystem flock -u fd_expr

The builtin zsystem’s subcommand flock performs advisory file locking (via the fcntl(2) system call)
over the entire contents of the given file. This form of locking requires the processes accessing the
file to cooperate; its most obvious use is between two instances of the shell itself.

In the first form the named file , which must already exist, is locked by opening a file descriptor to
the file and applying a lock to the file descriptor. The lock terminates when the shell process that
created the lock exits; it is therefore often convenient to create file locks within subshells, since the
lock is automatically released when the subshell exits. Note that use of the print builtin with the -u
option will, as a side effect, release the lock, as will redirection to the file in the shell holding the lock.
To work around this use a subshell, e.g. ‘(print message) >> file ’. Status 0 is returned if the lock
succeeds, else status 1.

In the second form the file descriptor given by the arithmetic expression fd_expr is closed,
releasing a lock. The file descriptor can be queried by using the ‘-f var ’ form during the lock; on a
successful lock, the shell variable var is set to the file descriptor used for locking. The lock will be
released if the file descriptor is closed by any other means, for example using ‘exec { var }>&-’;
however, the form described here performs a safety check that the file descriptor is in use for file
locking.

By default the shell waits indefinitely for the lock to succeed. The option -t timeout specifies a
timeout for the lock in seconds; fractional seconds are allowed. During this period, the shell will
attempt to lock the file every interval seconds if the -i interval option is given, otherwise once a
second. (This interval is shortened before the last attempt if needed, so that the shell waits only
until the timeout and not longer.) If the attempt times out, status 2 is returned.

(Note: timeout is limited to 2^30-1 seconds (about 34 years), and interval to 0.999 * LONG_MAX
microseconds (only about 35 minutes on 32-bit systems).)

If the option -e is given, the file descriptor for the lock is preserved when the shell uses exec to start
a new process; otherwise it is closed at that point and the lock released.

If the option -r is given, the lock is only for reading, otherwise it is for reading and writing. The file
descriptor is opened accordingly.

zsystem supports subcommand

The builtin zsystem’s subcommand supports tests whether a given subcommand is supported. It
returns status 0 if so, else status 1. It operates silently unless there was a syntax error (i.e. the wrong
number of arguments), in which case status 255 is returned. Status 1 can indicate one of two things:
subcommand is known but not supported by the current operating system, or subcommand is not
known (possibly because this is an older version of the shell before it was implemented).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 456 of 616
:
22.27.2 Math Functions

systell( fd )
The systell math function returns the current file position for the file descriptor passed as an
argument.

22.27.3 Parameters

errnos

A readonly array of the names of errors defined on the system. These are typically macros defined in
C by including the system header file errno.h. The index of each name (assuming the option
KSH_ARRAYS is unset) corresponds to the error number. Error numbers num before the last known
error which have no name are given the name E num in the array.

Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical name is used.

sysparams

A readonly associative array. The keys are:

pid

Returns the process ID of the current process, even in subshells. Compare $$, which returns the
process ID of the main shell process.

ppid

Returns the current process ID of the parent of the current process, even in subshells. Compare
$PPID, which returns the process ID of the initial parent of the main shell process.

procsubstpid
Returns the process ID of the last process started for process substitution, i.e. the <( ... ) and >
( ... ) expansions.

22.28 The zsh/net/tcp Module


The zsh/net/tcp module makes available one builtin command:

ztcp [ -acflLtv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]

ztcp is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line editing, file I/O, and job

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 457 of 616
:
control mechanisms.

If ztcp is run with no options, it will output

If it is run with only the option -L, it will output the contents of is ignored if given with a command to
open or close a session. The output consists of a set of lines, one per session, each containing the
following elements separated by spaces:

File descriptor
The file descriptor in use for the connection. For normal inbound (I) and outbound (O) connections
this may be read and written by the usual shell mechanisms. However, it should only be close with
‘ztcp -c’.

Connection type
A letter indicating how the session was created:

Z
A session created with the zftp command.

L
A connection opened for listening with ‘ztcp -l’.

I
An inbound connection accepted with ‘ztcp -a’.

O
An outbound connection created with ‘ztcp host ... ’.

The local host


This is usually set to an all-zero IP address as the address of the localhost is irrelevant.

The local port


This is likely to be zero unless the connection is for listening.

The remote host


This is the fully qualified domain name of the peer, if available, else an IP address. It is an all-zero IP
address for a session opened for listening.

The remote port


This is zero for a connection opened for listening.

22.28.1 Outbound Connections

ztcp [ -v ] [ -d fd ] host [ port ]


Open a new TCP connection to host . If the port is omitted, it will default to port 23. The
connection will REPLY will be set to the file descriptor associated with that connection.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 458 of 616
:
If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for the connection.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

22.28.2 Inbound Connections

ztcp -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] port
ztcp -l will open a socket listening on TCP port . The socket will be added to the will be set to the file
descriptor associated with that listener.

If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for the connection.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

ztcp -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd


ztcp -a will accept an incoming connection to the port associated with listenfd . The connection will
be added to the session be set to the file descriptor associated with the inbound connection.

If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for the connection.

If -t is specified, ztcp will return if no incoming connection is pending. Otherwise it will wait for one.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

22.28.3 Closing Connections

ztcp -cf [ -v ] [ fd ]
ztcp -c [ -v ] [ fd ]
ztcp -c will close the socket associated with fd . The socket will be removed from the

Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see The zsh/zftp Module ) cannot be closed this way. In order to
force such a socket closed, use -f.

In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

22.28.4 Example

Here is how to create a TCP connection between two instances of zsh. We need to pick an
unassigned port; here we use the randomly chosen 5123.

On host1,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 459 of 616
:
zmodload zsh/net/tcp
ztcp -l 5123
listenfd=$REPLY
ztcp -a $listenfd
fd=$REPLY

The second from last command blocks until there is an incoming connection.

Now create a connection from host2 (which may, of course, be the same machine):

zmodload zsh/net/tcp
ztcp host1 5123
fd=$REPLY

Now on each host, $fd contains a file descriptor for talking to the other. For example, on host1:

print This is a message >&$fd

and on host2:

read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line

prints ‘This is a message’.

To tidy up, on host1:

ztcp -c $listenfd
ztcp -c $fd

and on host2

ztcp -c $fd

22.29 The zsh/termcap Module


The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:

echotc cap [ arg ... ]

Output the termcap value corresponding to the capability cap , with optional arguments.

The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:

termcap
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 460 of 616
:
An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their values.

22.30 The zsh/terminfo Module


The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:

echoti cap [ arg ]

Output the terminfo value corresponding to the capability cap , instantiated with arg if applicable.

The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:

terminfo

An associative array that maps terminfo capability names to their values.

22.31 The zsh/watch Module


The zsh/watch module can be used to report when specific users log in or out. This is controlled via
the following parameters.

LOGCHECK

The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity using the watch parameter.

watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)

An array (colon-separated list) of login/logout events to report.

If it contains the single word ‘all’, then all login/logout events are reported. If it contains the single
word ‘notme’, then all events are reported as with ‘all’ except $USERNAME.

An entry in this list may consist of a username, an ‘@’ followed by a remote hostname, and a ‘%’
followed by a line (tty). Any of these may be a pattern (be sure to quote this during the assignment
to watch so that it does not immediately perform file generation); the setting of the
EXTENDED_GLOB option is respected. Any or all of these components may be present in an entry; if
a login/logout event matches all of them, it is reported.

For example, with the EXTENDED_GLOB option set, the following:

watch=('^(pws|barts)')

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 461 of 616
:
causes reports for activity associated with any user other than pws or barts.

WATCHFMT

The format of login/logout reports if the watch parameter is set. Default is ‘%n has %a %l from %m’.
Recognizes the following escape sequences:

%n
The name of the user that logged in/out.

%a
The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".

%l
The line (tty) the user is logged in on.

%M
The full hostname of the remote host.

%m
The hostname up to the first ‘.’. If only the IP address is available or the utmp field contains the name
of an X-windows display, the whole name is printed.

NOTE: The ‘%m’ and ‘%M’ escapes will work only if there is a host name field in the utmp on your
machine. Otherwise they are treated as ordinary strings.

%F{ color } (%f)


Start (stop) using a different foreground color.

%K{ color } (%k)


Start (stop) using a different background color.

%S (%s)
Start (stop) standout mode.

%U (%u)
Start (stop) underline mode.

%B (%b)
Start (stop) boldface mode.

%t
%@
The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

%T
The time, in 24-hour format.

%w
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 462 of 616
:
The date in ‘ day - dd ’ format.

%W
The date in ‘ mm / dd / yy ’ format.

%D
The date in ‘ yy - mm - dd ’ format.

%D{ string }
The date formatted as string using the strftime function, with zsh extensions as described by
Prompt Expansion.

%( x : true-text : false-text )
Specifies a ternary expression. The character following the x is arbitrary; the same character is used
to separate the text for the "true" result from that for the "false" result. Both the separator and the
right parenthesis may be escaped with a backslash. Ternary expressions may be nested.

The test character x may be any one of ‘l’, ‘n’, ‘m’ or ‘M’, which indicate a ‘true’ result if the
corresponding escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may be ‘a’, which indicates a
‘true’ result if the watched user has logged in, or ‘false’ if he has logged out. Other characters
evaluate to neither true nor false; the entire expression is omitted in this case.

If the result is ‘true’, then the true-text is formatted according to the rules above and printed, and
the false-text is skipped. If ‘false’, the true-text is skipped and the false-text is formatted and
printed. Either or both of the branches may be empty, but both separators must be present in any
case.

Furthermore, the zsh/watch module makes available one builtin command:

log

List all users currently logged in who are affected by the current setting of the watch parameter.

22.32 The zsh/zftp Module


The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:

zftp subcommand [ args ]

The zsh/zftp module is a client for FTP (file transfer protocol). It is implemented as a builtin to allow
full use of shell command line editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms. Often, users will access
it via shell functions providing a more powerful interface; a set is provided with the zsh distribution
and is described in Zftp Function System. However, the zftp command is entirely usable in its own
right.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 463 of 616
:
All commands consist of the command name zftp followed by the name of a subcommand. These
are listed below. The return status of each subcommand is supposed to reflect the success or failure
of the remote operation. See a description of the variable ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on
how responses from the server may be printed.

22.32.1 Subcommands

open host [: port ] [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]

Open a new FTP session to host , which may be the name of a TCP/IP connected host or an IP
number in the standard dot notation. If the argument is in the form host : port , open a connection
to TCP port port instead of the standard FTP port 21. This may be the name of a TCP service or a
number: see the description of ZFTP_PORT below for more information.

If IPv6 addresses in colon format are used, the host should be surrounded by quoted square
brackets to distinguish it from the port , for example ’[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]’. For consistency
this is allowed with all forms of host .

Remaining arguments are passed to the login subcommand. Note that if no arguments beyond
host are supplied, open will not automatically call login. If no arguments at all are supplied, open
will use the parameters set by the params subcommand.

After a successful open, the shell variables ZFTP_HOST, ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP and ZFTP_SYSTEM are
available; see ‘Variables’ below.

login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]

user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]

Login the user name with parameters password and account . Any of the parameters can be
omitted, and will be read from standard input if needed ( name is always needed). If standard input
is a terminal, a prompt for each one will be printed on standard error and password will not be
echoed. If any of the parameters are not used, a warning message is printed.

After a successful login, the shell variables ZFTP_USER, ZFTP_ACCOUNT and ZFTP_PWD are available;
see ‘Variables’ below.

This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in, and the server will first be
reinitialized for a new user.

params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]

params -

Store the given parameters for a later open command with no arguments. Only those given on the
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 464 of 616
:
command line will be remembered. If no arguments are given, the parameters currently set are
printed, although the password will appear as a line of stars; the return status is one if no
parameters were set, zero otherwise.

Any of the parameters may be specified as a ‘?’, which may need to be quoted to protect it from shell
expansion. In this case, the appropriate parameter will be read from stdin as with the login
subcommand, including special handling of password . If the ‘?’ is followed by a string, that is used as
the prompt for reading the parameter instead of the default message (any necessary punctuation
and whitespace should be included at the end of the prompt). The first letter of the parameter (only)
may be quoted with a ‘\’; hence an argument "\\$word" guarantees that the string from the shell
parameter $word will be treated literally, whether or not it begins with a ‘?’.

If instead a single ‘-’ is given, the existing parameters, if any, are deleted. In that case, calling open
with no arguments will cause an error.

The list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however it will be deleted if the zsh/zftp module is
unloaded.

For example,

zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '

will store the host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then prompt the user for the
corresponding password with the given prompt.

test

Test the connection; if the server has reported that it has closed the connection (maybe due to a
timeout), return status 2; if no connection was open anyway, return status 1; else return status 0.
The test subcommand is silent, apart from messages printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or
error messages if the connection closes. There is no network overhead for this test.

The test is only supported on systems with either the select(2) or poll(2) system calls; otherwise the
message ‘not supported on this system’ is printed instead.

The test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of any other subcommand for the
current session when a connection is open.

cd directory

Change the remote directory to directory . Also alters the shell variable ZFTP_PWD.

cdup

Change the remote directory to the one higher in the directory tree. Note that cd .. will also work
correctly on non-UNIX systems.

dir [ arg ... ]


https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 465 of 616
:
Give a (verbose) listing of the remote directory. The arg s are passed directly to the server. The
command’s behaviour is implementation dependent, but a UNIX server will typically interpret arg s
as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments return the result of ‘ls -l’. The directory is
listed to standard output.

ls [ arg ... ]

Give a (short) listing of the remote directory. With no arg , produces a raw list of the files in the
directory, one per line. Otherwise, up to vagaries of the server implementation, behaves similar to
dir.

type [ type ]

Change the type for the transfer to type , or print the current type if type is absent. The allowed
values are ‘A’ (ASCII), ‘I’ (Image, i.e. binary), or ‘B’ (a synonym for ‘I’).

The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII. However, if zftp finds that the remote host is a UNIX machine
with 8-bit byes, it will automatically switch to using binary for file transfers upon open. This can
subsequently be overridden.

The transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a data connection is established; this
command involves no network overhead.

ascii

The same as type A.

binary

The same as type I.

mode [ S | B ]

Set the mode type to stream (S) or block (B). Stream mode is the default; block mode is not widely
supported.

remote file ...

local [ file ... ]

Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local files. If there is more than one item
on the list, the name of the file is printed first. The first number is the file size, the second is the last
modification time of the file in the format CCYYMMDDhhmmSS consisting of year, month, date,
hour, minutes and seconds in GMT. Note that this format, including the length, is guaranteed, so
that time strings can be directly compared via the [[ builtin’s < and > operators, even if they are too
long to be represented as integers.

Not all servers support the commands for retrieving this information. In that case, the remote

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 466 of 616
:
command will print nothing and return status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.

The local command (but not remote) may be used with no arguments, in which case the information
comes from examining file descriptor zero. This is the same file as seen by a put command with no
further redirection.

get file ...

Retrieve all file s from the server, concatenating them and sending them to standard output.

put file ...

For each file , read a file from standard input and send that to the remote host with the given
name.

append file ...

As put, but if the remote file already exists, data is appended to it instead of overwriting it.

getat file point

putat file point

appendat file point

Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at the given point in the remote file .
This is useful for appending to an incomplete local file. However, note that this ability is not
universally supported by servers (and is not quite the behaviour specified by the standard).

delete file ...

Delete the list of files on the server.

mkdir directory

Create a new directory directory on the server.

rmdir directory

Delete the directory directory on the server.

rename old-name new-name

Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.

site arg ...

Send a host-specific command to the server. You will probably only need this if instructed by the
server to use it.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 467 of 616
:
quote arg ...

Send the raw FTP command sequence to the server. You should be familiar with the FTP command
set as defined in RFC959 before doing this. Useful commands may include STAT and HELP. Note also
the mechanism for returning messages as described for the variable ZFTP_VERBOSE below, in
particular that all messages from the control connection are sent to standard error.

close

quit

Close the current data connection. This unsets the shell parameters ZFTP_HOST, ZFTP_PORT,
ZFTP_IP, ZFTP_SYSTEM, ZFTP_USER, ZFTP_ACCOUNT, ZFTP_PWD, ZFTP_TYPE and ZFTP_MODE.

session [ sessname ]

Allows multiple FTP sessions to be used at once. The name of the session is an arbitrary string of
characters; the default session is called ‘default’. If this command is called without an argument, it
will list all the current sessions; with an argument, it will either switch to the existing session called
sessname , or create a new session of that name.

Each session remembers the status of the connection, the set of connection-specific shell
parameters (the same set as are unset when a connection closes, as given in the description of
close), and any user parameters specified with the params subcommand. Changing to a previous
session restores those values; changing to a new session initialises them in the same way as if zftp
had just been loaded. The name of the current session is given by the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.

rmsession [ sessname ]

Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is deleted. If the current session is
deleted, the earliest existing session becomes the new current session, otherwise the current
session is not changed. If the session being deleted is the only one, a new session called ‘default’ is
created and becomes the current session; note that this is a new session even if the session being
deleted is also called ‘default’. It is recommended that sessions not be deleted while background
commands which use zftp are still active.

22.32.2 Parameters

The following shell parameters are used by zftp. Currently none of them are special.

ZFTP_TMOUT

Integer. The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to complete before returning an error.
If this is not set when the module is loaded, it will be given the default value 60. A value of zero turns
off timeouts. If a timeout occurs on the control connection it will be closed. Use a larger value if this

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 468 of 616
:
occurs too frequently.

ZFTP_IP

Readonly. The IP address of the current connection in dot notation.

ZFTP_HOST

Readonly. The hostname of the current remote server. If the host was opened as an IP number,
ZFTP_HOST contains that instead; this saves the overhead for a name lookup, as IP numbers are
most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.

ZFTP_PORT

Readonly. The number of the remote TCP port to which the connection is open (even if the port was
originally specified as a named service). Usually this is the standard FTP port, 21.

In the unlikely event that your system does not have the appropriate conversion functions, this
appears in network byte order. If your system is little-endian, the port then consists of two swapped
bytes and the standard port will be reported as 5376. In that case, numeric ports passed to zftp
open will also need to be in this format.

ZFTP_SYSTEM

Readonly. The system type string returned by the server in response to an FTP SYST request. The
most interesting case is a string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which ensures maximum compatibility
with a local UNIX host.

ZFTP_TYPE

Readonly. The type to be used for data transfers , either ‘A’ or ‘I’. Use the type subcommand to
change this.

ZFTP_USER

Readonly. The username currently logged in, if any.

ZFTP_ACCOUNT

Readonly. The account name of the current user, if any. Most servers do not require an account
name.

ZFTP_PWD

Readonly. The current directory on the server.

ZFTP_CODE

Readonly. The three digit code of the last FTP reply from the server as a string. This can still be read
after the connection is closed, and is not changed when the current session changes.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 469 of 616
:
ZFTP_REPLY

Readonly. The last line of the last reply sent by the server. This can still be read after the connection
is closed, and is not changed when the current session changes.

ZFTP_SESSION

Readonly. The name of the current FTP session; see the description of the session subcommand.

ZFTP_PREFS

A string of preferences for altering aspects of zftp’s behaviour. Each preference is a single character.
The following are defined:

P
Passive: attempt to make the remote server initiate data transfers. This is slightly more efficient than
sendport mode. If the letter S occurs later in the string, zftp will use sendport mode if passive mode
is not available.

S
Sendport: initiate transfers by the FTP PORT command. If this occurs before any P in the string,
passive mode will never be attempted.

D
Dumb: use only the bare minimum of FTP commands. This prevents the variables ZFTP_SYSTEM and
ZFTP_PWD from being set, and will mean all connections default to ASCII type. It may prevent
ZFTP_SIZE from being set during a transfer if the server does not send it anyway (many servers do).

If ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to a default of ‘PS’, i.e. use passive mode if
available, otherwise fall back to sendport mode.

ZFTP_VERBOSE

A string of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which responses from the server should be
printed. All responses go to standard error. If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear in the string, raw
responses from the server with reply codes beginning with that digit will be printed to standard
error. The first digit of the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to correspond to:

1.
A positive preliminary reply.

2.
A positive completion reply.

3.
A positive intermediate reply.

4.
A transient negative completion reply.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 470 of 616
:
5.
A permanent negative completion reply.

It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply ‘Service not available’, which forces
termination of a connection, is classified as 421, i.e. ‘transient negative’, an interesting interpretation
of the word ‘transient’.

The code 0 is special: it indicates that all but the last line of multiline replies read from the server will
be printed to standard error in a processed format. By convention, servers use this mechanism for
sending information for the user to read. The appropriate reply code, if it matches the same
response, takes priority.

If ZFTP_VERBOSE is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to the default value 450, i.e., messages
destined for the user and all errors will be printed. A null string is valid and specifies that no
messages should be printed.

22.32.3 Functions

zftp_chpwd

If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the directory changes on the server, including
when a user is logged in, or when a connection is closed. In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD will be unset;
otherwise it will reflect the new directory.

zftp_progress

If this function is set by the user, it will be called during a get, put or append operation each time
sufficient data has been received from the host. During a get, the data is sent to standard output, so
it is vital that this function should write to standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard
output.

When it is called with a transfer in progress, the following additional shell parameters are set:

ZFTP_FILE

The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.

ZFTP_TRANSFER

A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.

ZFTP_SIZE

The total size of the complete file being transferred: the same as the first value provided by the
remote and local subcommands for a particular file. If the server cannot supply this value for a
remote file being retrieved, it will not be set. If input is from a pipe the value may be incorrect and

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 471 of 616
:
correspond simply to a full pipe buffer.

ZFTP_COUNT

The amount of data so far transferred; a number between zero and $ZFTP_SIZE, if that is set. This
number is always available.

The function is initially called with ZFTP_TRANSFER set appropriately and ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.
After the transfer is finished, the function will be called one more time with ZFTP_TRANSFER set to
GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy up. It is otherwise never called twice with the same value of
ZFTP_COUNT.

Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption. It is up to the user to decide whether the
function should be defined and to use unfunction when necessary.

22.32.4 Problems

A connection may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as this occurs in a subshell and the
file information is not updated in the main shell. In the case of type or mode changes or closing the
connection in a subshell, the information is returned but variables are not updated until the next call
to zftp. Other status changes in subshells will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but
should be otherwise harmless).

Deleting sessions while a zftp command is active in the background can have unexpected effects,
even if it does not use the session being deleted. This is because all shell subprocesses share
information on the state of all connections, and deleting a session changes the ordering of that
information.

On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after a fork(), so that operations in
subshells, on the left hand side of a pipeline, or in the background are not possible, as they should
be. This is presumably a bug in the operating system.

22.33 The zsh/zle Module


The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor. See Zsh Line Editor.

22.34 The zsh/zleparameter Module


The zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that can be used to access internal
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 472 of 616
:
information of the Zsh Line Editor (see Zsh Line Editor).

keymaps

This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.

widgets

This associative array contains one entry per widget. The name of the widget is the key and the value
gives information about the widget. It is either the string ‘builtin’ for builtin widgets, a string of the
form ‘user: name ’ for user-defined widgets, where name is the name of the shell function
implementing the widget, a string of the form ‘completion: type : name ’ for completion widgets, or a
null value if the widget is not yet fully defined. In the penultimate case, type is the name of the
builtin widget the completion widget imitates in its behavior and name is the name of the shell
function implementing the completion widget.

22.35 The zsh/zprof Module


When loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled. The profiling results can be
obtained with the zprof builtin command made available by this module. There is no way to turn
profiling off other than unloading the module.

zprof [ -c ]

Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard output. The format is comparable to
that of commands like gprof.

At the top there is a summary listing all functions that were called at least once. This summary is
sorted in decreasing order of the amount of time spent in each. The lines contain the number of the
function in order, which is used in other parts of the list in suffixes of the form ‘[ num ]’, then the
number of calls made to the function. The next three columns list the time in milliseconds spent in
the function and its descendants, the average time in milliseconds spent in the function and its
descendants per call and the percentage of time spent in all shell functions used in this function and
its descendants. The following three columns give the same information, but counting only the time
spent in the function itself. The final column shows the name of the function.

After the summary, detailed information about every function that was invoked is listed, sorted in
decreasing order of the amount of time spent in each function and its descendants. Each of these
entries consists of descriptions for the functions that called the function described, the function
itself, and the functions that were called from it. The description for the function itself has the same
format as in the summary (and shows the same information). The other lines don’t show the
number of the function at the beginning and have their function named indented to make it easier
to distinguish the line showing the function described in the section from the surrounding lines.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 473 of 616
:
The information shown in this case is almost the same as in the summary, but only refers to the call
hierarchy being displayed. For example, for a calling function the column showing the total running
time lists the time spent in the described function and its descendants only for the times when it
was called from that particular calling function. Likewise, for a called function, this columns lists the
total time spent in the called function and its descendants only for the times when it was called from
the function described.

Also in this case, the column showing the number of calls to a function also shows a slash and then
the total number of invocations made to the called function.

As long as the zsh/zprof module is loaded, profiling will be done and multiple invocations of the
zprof builtin command will show the times and numbers of calls since the module was loaded. With
the -c option, the zprof builtin command will reset its internal counters and will not show the listing.

22.36 The zsh/zpty Module


The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:

zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]

The arguments following name are concatenated with spaces between, then executed as a
command, as if passed to the eval builtin. The command runs under a newly assigned pseudo-
terminal; this is useful for running commands non-interactively which expect an interactive
environment. The name is not part of the command, but is used to refer to this command in later
calls to zpty.

With the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up so that input characters are echoed.

With the -b option, input to and output from the pseudo-terminal are made non-blocking.

The shell parameter REPLY is set to the file descriptor assigned to the master side of the pseudo-
terminal. This allows the terminal to be monitored with ZLE descriptor handlers (see Zle Builtins) or
manipulated with sysread and syswrite (see The zsh/system Module). Warning: Use of sysread and
syswrite is not recommended; use zpty -r and zpty -w unless you know exactly what you are doing.

zpty -d [ name ... ]

The second form, with the -d option, is used to delete commands previously started, by supplying a
list of their name s. If no name is given, all commands are deleted. Deleting a command causes the
HUP signal to be sent to the corresponding process.

zpty -w [ -n ] name [ string ... ]

The -w option can be used to send the to command name the given string s as input (separated by

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 474 of 616
:
spaces). If the -n option is not given, a newline is added at the end.

If no string is provided, the standard input is copied to the pseudo-terminal; this may stop before
copying the full input if the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking. The exact input is always copied: the -n
option is not applied.

Note that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees this input as if it were typed, so beware
when sending special tty driver characters such as word-erase, line-kill, and end-of-file.

zpty -r [ -mt ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]

The -r option can be used to read the output of the command name . With only a name argument,
the output read is copied to the standard output. Unless the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking,
copying continues until the command under the pseudo-terminal exits; when non-blocking, only as
much output as is immediately available is copied. The return status is zero if any output is copied.

When also given a param argument, at most one line is read and stored in the parameter named
param . Less than a full line may be read if the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking. The return status is
zero if at least one character is stored in param .

If a pattern is given as well, output is read until the whole string read matches the pattern , even
in the non-blocking case. The return status is zero if the string read matches the pattern, or if the
command has exited but at least one character could still be read. If the option -m is present, the
return status is zero only if the pattern matches. As of this writing, a maximum of one megabyte of
output can be consumed this way; if a full megabyte is read without matching the pattern, the return
status is non-zero.

In all cases, the return status is non-zero if nothing could be read, and is 2 if this is because the
command has finished.

If the -r option is combined with the -t option, zpty tests whether output is available before trying to
read. If no output is available, zpty immediately returns the status 1. When used with a pattern , the
behaviour on a failed poll is similar to when the command has exited: the return value is zero if at
least one character could still be read even if the pattern failed to match.

zpty -t name

The -t option without the -r option can be used to test whether the command name is still running. It
returns a zero status if the command is running and a non-zero value otherwise.

zpty [ -L ]

The last form, without any arguments, is used to list the commands currently defined. If the -L
option is given, this is done in the form of calls to the zpty builtin.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 475 of 616
:
22.37 The zsh/zselect Module
The zsh/zselect module makes available one builtin command:

zselect [ -rwe ] [ -t timeout ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] [ fd ... ]

The zselect builtin is a front-end to the ‘select’ system call, which blocks until a file descriptor is ready
for reading or writing, or has an error condition, with an optional timeout. If this is not available on
your system, the command prints an error message and returns status 2 (normal errors return
status 1). For more information, see your system’s documentation for select(3). Note there is no
connection with the shell builtin of the same name.

Arguments and options may be intermingled in any order. Non-option arguments are file
descriptors, which must be decimal integers. By default, file descriptors are to be tested for reading,
i.e. zselect will return when data is available to be read from the file descriptor, or more precisely,
when a read operation from the file descriptor will not block. After a -r, -w and -e, the given file
descriptors are to be tested for reading, writing, or error conditions. These options and an arbitrary
list of file descriptors may be given in any order.

(The presence of an ‘error condition’ is not well defined in the documentation for many
implementations of the select system call. According to recent versions of the POSIX specification, it
is really an exception condition, of which the only standard example is out-of-band data received on
a socket. So zsh users are unlikely to find the -e option useful.)

The option ‘-t timeout ’ specifies a timeout in hundredths of a second. This may be zero, in which
case the file descriptors will simply be polled and zselect will return immediately. It is possible to call
zselect with no file descriptors and a non-zero timeout for use as a finer-grained replacement for
‘sleep’; note, however, the return status is always 1 for a timeout.

The option ‘-a array ’ indicates that array should be set to indicate the file descriptor(s) which are
ready. If the option is not given, the array reply will be used for this purpose. The array will contain a
string similar to the arguments for zselect. For example,

zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1

might return immediately with status 0 and $reply containing ‘-r 0 -w 1’ to show that both file
descriptors are ready for the requested operations.

The option ‘-A assoc ’ indicates that the associative array assoc should be set to indicate the file
descriptor(s) which are ready. This option overrides the option -a, nor will reply be modified. The
keys of assoc are the file descriptors, and the corresponding values are any of the characters ‘rwe’ to
indicate the condition.

The command returns status 0 if some file descriptors are ready for reading. If the operation timed
out, or a timeout of 0 was given and no file descriptors were ready, or there was an error, it returns
status 1 and the array will not be set (nor modified in any way). If there was an error in the select
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 476 of 616
:
operation the appropriate error message is printed.

22.38 The zsh/zutil Module


The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:

zstyle [ -L [ metapattern [ style ] ] ]

zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style string ...

zstyle -d [ pattern [ style ... ] ]

zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]

zstyle -{a|b|s} context style name [ sep ]

zstyle -{T|t} context style [ string ... ]

zstyle -m context style pattern

This builtin command is used to define and lookup styles. Styles are pairs of names and values,
where the values consist of any number of strings. They are stored together with patterns and
lookup is done by giving a string, called the ‘context’, which is matched against the patterns. The
definition stored for the most specific pattern that matches will be returned.

A pattern is considered to be more specific than another if it contains more components (substrings
separated by colons) or if the patterns for the components are more specific, where simple strings
are considered to be more specific than patterns and complex patterns are considered to be more
specific than the pattern ‘*’. A ‘*’ in the pattern will match zero or more characters in the context;
colons are not treated specially in this regard. If two patterns are equally specific, the tie is broken in
favour of the pattern that was defined first.

Example

For example, a fictional ‘weather’ plugin might state in its documentation that it looks up the
preferred-precipitation style under the ‘:weather: continent : day-of-the-week : phase-of-the-moon ’
context. According to this, you might set the following in your zshrc:

zstyle ':weather:europe:*' preferred-precipitation rain


zstyle ':weather:*:Sunday:*' preferred-precipitation snow

Then the plugin would run under the hood a command such as

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 477 of 616
:
zstyle -s ":weather:${continent}:${day_of_week}:${moon_phase}" preferred-precipitation
REPLY

in order to retrieve your preference into the scalar variable $REPLY. On Sundays $REPLY would be
set to ‘snow’; in Europe it would be set to ‘rain’; and on Sundays in Europe it would be set to ‘snow’
again, because the patterns ‘:weather:europe:*’ and ‘:weather:*:Sunday:*’ both match the context
argument to zstyle -s, are equally specific, and the latter is more specific (because it has more colon-
separated components).

Usage

The forms that operate on patterns are the following.

zstyle [ -L [ metapattern [ style ] ] ]


Without arguments, lists style definitions. Styles are shown in alphabetic order and patterns are
shown in the order zstyle will test them.

If the -L option is given, listing is done in the form of calls to zstyle. The optional first argument,
metapattern , is a pattern which will be matched against the string supplied as pattern when the
style was defined. Note: this means, for example, ‘zstyle -L ":completion:*"’ will match any supplied
pattern beginning ‘:completion:’, not just ":completion:*": use ’:completion:\*’ to match that. The
optional second argument limits the output to a specific style (not a pattern). -L is not compatible
with any other options.

zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style string ...

Defines the given style for the pattern with the string s as the value. If the -e option is given, the
string s will be concatenated (separated by spaces) and the resulting string will be evaluated (in the
same way as it is done by the eval builtin command) when the style is looked up. In this case the
parameter ‘reply’ must be assigned to set the strings returned after the evaluation. Before
evaluating the value, reply is unset, and if it is still unset after the evaluation, the style is treated as if
it were not set.

zstyle -d [ pattern [ style ... ] ]


Delete style definitions. Without arguments all definitions are deleted, with a pattern all definitions
for that pattern are deleted and if any style s are given, then only those styles are deleted for the
pattern .

zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]


Retrieve a style definition. The name is used as the name of an array in which the results are stored.
Without any further arguments, all patterns defined are returned. With a pattern the styles defined
for that pattern are returned and with both a pattern and a style , the value strings of that
combination is returned.

The other forms can be used to look up or test styles for a given context.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 478 of 616
:
zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
The parameter name is set to the value of the style interpreted as a string. If the value contains
several strings they are concatenated with spaces (or with the sep string if that is given) between
them.

Return 0 if the style is set, 1 otherwise.

zstyle -b context style name


The value is stored in name as a boolean, i.e. as the string ‘yes’ if the value has only one string and
that string is equal to one of ‘yes’, ‘true’, ‘on’, or ‘1’. If the value is any other string or has more than
one string, the parameter is set to ‘no’.

Return 0 if name is set to ‘yes’, 1 otherwise.

zstyle -a context style name


The value is stored in name as an array. If name is declared as an associative array, the first, third,
etc. strings are used as the keys and the other strings are used as the values.

Return 0 if the style is set, 1 otherwise.

zstyle -t context style [ string ... ]


zstyle -T context style [ string ... ]
Test the value of a style, i.e. the -t option only returns a status (sets $?). Without any string the
return status is zero if the style is defined for at least one matching pattern, has only one string in its
value, and that is equal to one of ‘true’, ‘yes’, ‘on’ or ‘1’. If any string s are given the status is zero if
and only if at least one of the string s is equal to at least one of the strings in the value. If the style
is defined but doesn’t match, the return status is 1. If the style is not defined, the status is 2.

The -T option tests the values of the style like -t, but it returns status zero (rather than 2) if the style
is not defined for any matching pattern.

zstyle -m context style pattern


Match a value. Returns status zero if the pattern matches at least one of the strings in the value.

zformat -f param format spec ...

zformat -F param format spec ...

zformat -a array sep spec ...

This builtin provides different forms of formatting. The first form is selected with the -f option. In this
case the format string will be modified by replacing sequences starting with a percent sign in it with
strings from the spec s. Each spec should be of the form ‘ char : string ’ which will cause every
appearance of the sequence ‘% char ’ in format to be replaced by the string . The ‘%’ sequence
may also contain optional minimum and maximum field width specifications between the ‘%’ and
the ‘ char ’ in the form ‘% min . max c’, i.e. the minimum field width is given first and if the maximum

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 479 of 616
:
field width is used, it has to be preceded by a dot. Specifying a minimum field width makes the result
be padded with spaces to the right if the string is shorter than the requested width. Padding to the
left can be achieved by giving a negative minimum field width. If a maximum field width is specified,
the string will be truncated after that many characters. After all ‘%’ sequences for the given spec s
have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the parameter param .

The %-escapes also understand ternary expressions in the form used by prompts. The % is followed
by a ‘(’ and then an ordinary format specifier character as described above. There may be a set of
digits either before or after the ‘(’; these specify a test number, which defaults to zero. Negative
numbers are also allowed. An arbitrary delimiter character follows the format specifier, which is
followed by a piece of ‘true’ text, the delimiter character again, a piece of ‘false’ text, and a closing
parenthesis. The complete expression (without the digits) thus looks like ‘%( X . text1 . text2 )’,
except that the ‘.’ character is arbitrary. The value given for the format specifier in the char : string
expressions is evaluated as a mathematical expression, and compared with the test number. If they
are the same, text1 is output, else text2 is output. A parenthesis may be escaped in text2 as %).
Either of text1 or text2 may contain nested %-escapes.

For example:

zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3

outputs "The answer is ’yes’." to REPLY since the value for the format specifier c is 3, agreeing with
the digit argument to the ternary expression.

With -F instead of -f, ternary expressions choose between the ‘true’ or ‘false’ text on the basis of
whether the format specifier is present and non-empty. A test number indicates a minimum width
for the value given in the format specifier. Negative numbers reverse this, so the test is for whether
the value exceeds a maximum width.

The form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning strings. Here, the spec s are of the form
‘ left : right ’ where ‘ left ’ and ‘ right ’ are arbitrary strings. These strings are modified by
replacing the colons by the sep string and padding the left strings with spaces to the right so that
the sep strings in the result (and hence the right strings after them) are all aligned if the strings
are printed below each other. All strings without a colon are left unchanged and all strings with an
empty right string have the trailing colon removed. In both cases the lengths of the strings are not
used to determine how the other strings are to be aligned. A colon in the left string can be
escaped with a backslash. The resulting strings are stored in the array .

zregexparse

This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.

zparseopts [ -D -E -F -K -M ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] [ - ] spec ...

This builtin simplifies the parsing of options in positional parameters, i.e. the set of arguments given

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 480 of 616
:
by $*. Each spec describes one option and must be of the form ‘ opt [= array ]’. If an option
described by opt is found in the positional parameters it is copied into the array specified with the
-a option; if the optional ‘= array ’ is given, it is instead copied into that array, which should be
declared as a normal array and never as an associative array.

Note that it is an error to give any spec without an ‘= array ’ unless one of the -a or -A options is
used.

Unless the -E option is given, parsing stops at the first string that isn’t described by one of the
spec s. Even with -E, parsing always stops at a positional parameter equal to ‘-’ or ‘--’. See also -F.

The opt description must be one of the following. Any of the special characters can appear in the
option name provided it is preceded by a backslash.

name
name +
The name is the name of the option without the leading ‘-’. To specify a GNU-style long option, one of
the usual two leading ‘-’ must be included in name ; for example, a ‘--file’ option is represented by a
name of ‘-file’.

If a ‘+’ appears after name , the option is appended to array each time it is found in the positional
parameters; without the ‘+’ only the last occurrence of the option is preserved.

If one of these forms is used, the option takes no argument, so parsing stops if the next positional
parameter does not also begin with ‘-’ (unless the -E option is used).

name :
name :-
name ::
If one or two colons are given, the option takes an argument; with one colon, the argument is
mandatory and with two colons it is optional. The argument is appended to the array after the
option itself.

An optional argument is put into the same array element as the option name (note that this makes
empty strings as arguments indistinguishable). A mandatory argument is added as a separate
element unless the ‘:-’ form is used, in which case the argument is put into the same element.

A ‘+’ as described above may appear between the name and the first colon.

In all cases, option-arguments must appear either immediately following the option in the same
positional parameter or in the next one. Even an optional argument may appear in the next
parameter, unless it begins with a ‘-’. There is no special handling of ‘=’ as with GNU-style argument
parsers; given the spec ‘-foo:’, the positional parameter ‘--foo=bar’ is parsed as ‘--foo’ with an
argument of ‘=bar’.

When the names of two options that take no arguments overlap, the longest one wins, so that

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 481 of 616
:
parsing for the spec s ‘-foo -foobar’ (for example) is unambiguous. However, due to the
aforementioned handling of option-arguments, ambiguities may arise when at least one overlapping
spec takes an argument, as in ‘-foo: -foobar’. In that case, the last matching spec wins.

The options of zparseopts itself cannot be stacked because, for example, the stack ‘-DEK’ is
indistinguishable from a spec for the GNU-style long option ‘--DEK’. The options of zparseopts itself
are:

-a array
As described above, this names the default array in which to store the recognised options.

-A assoc
If this is given, the options and their values are also put into an associative array with the option
names as keys and the arguments (if any) as the values.

-D
If this option is given, all options found are removed from the positional parameters of the calling
shell or shell function, up to but not including any not described by the spec s. If the first such
parameter is ‘-’ or ‘--’, it is removed as well. This is similar to using the shift builtin.

-E
This changes the parsing rules to not stop at the first string that isn’t described by one of the spec s.
It can be used to test for or (if used together with -D) extract options and their arguments, ignoring
all other options and arguments that may be in the positional parameters. As indicated above,
parsing still stops at the first ‘-’ or ‘--’ not described by a spec , but it is not removed when used with -
D.

-F
If this option is given, zparseopts immediately stops at the first option-like parameter not described
by one of the spec s, prints an error message, and returns status 1. Removal (-D) and extraction (-E)
are not performed, and option arrays are not updated. This provides basic validation for the given
options.

Note that the appearance in the positional parameters of an option without its required argument
always aborts parsing and returns an error as described above regardless of whether this option is
used.

-K
With this option, the arrays specified with the -a option and with the ‘= array ’ forms are kept
unchanged when none of the spec s for them is used. Otherwise the entire array is replaced when
any of the spec s is used. Individual elements of associative arrays specified with the -A option are
preserved by -K. This allows assignment of default values to arrays before calling zparseopts.

-M
This changes the assignment rules to implement a map among equivalent option names. If any
spec uses the ‘= array ’ form, the string array is interpreted as the name of another spec , which

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 482 of 616
:
is used to choose where to store the values. If no other spec is found, the values are stored as
usual. This changes only the way the values are stored, not the way $* is parsed, so results may be

For example,

set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend


zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar

will have the effect of

foo=(-a)
bar=(-b x -c y -c z)

The arguments from ‘baz’ on will not be used.

As an example for the -E option, consider:

set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2


zparseopts -E -D b:=bar

will have the effect of

bar=(-b y)
set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2

I.e., the option -b and its arguments are taken from the positional parameters and put into the array
bar.

The -M option can be used like this:

set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend


zparseopts -A bar -M a=foo b+: c:=b

to have the effect of

foo=(-a)
bar=(-a '' -b xyz)

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 483 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

23 Calendar Function System


23.1 Description
23.2 File and Date Formats
23.2.1 Calendar File Format
23.2.2 Date Format
23.2.3 Relative Time Format
23.2.4 Example
23.3 User Functions
23.3.1 Calendar system functions
23.3.2 Glob qualifiers
23.4 Styles
23.5 Utility functions
23.6 Bugs

23 Calendar Function System

23.1 Description
The shell is supplied with a series of functions to replace and enhance the traditional Unix calendar
programme, which warns the user of imminent or future events, details of which are stored in a text
file (typically calendar in the user’s home directory). The version provided here includes a
mechanism for alerting the user when an event is due.

In addition functions age, before and after are provided that can be used in a glob qualifier; they
allow files to be selected based on their modification times.

The format of the calendar file and the dates used there in and in the age function are described
first, then the functions that can be called to examine and modify the calendar file.

The functions here depend on the availability of the zsh/datetime module which is usually installed
with the shell. The library function strptime() must be available; it is present on most recent
operating systems.

23.2 File and Date Formats

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 484 of 616
:
23.2.1 Calendar File Format

The calendar file is by default ~/calendar. This can be configured by the calendar-file style, see
Styles. The basic format consists of a series of separate lines, with no indentation, each including a
date and time specification followed by a description of the event.

Various enhancements to this format are supported, based on the syntax of Emacs calendar mode.
An indented line indicates a continuation line that continues the description of the event from the
preceding line (note the date may not be continued in this way). An initial ampersand (&) is ignored
for compatibility.

An indented line on which the first non-whitespace character is # is not displayed with the calendar
entry, but is still scanned for information. This can be used to hide information useful to the
calendar system but not to the user, such as the unique identifier used by calendar_add.

The Emacs extension that a date with no description may refer to a number of succeeding events at
different times is not supported.

Unless the done-file style has been altered, any events which have been processed are appended to
the file with the same name as the calendar file with the suffix .done, hence ~/calendar.done by
default.

An example is shown below.

23.2.2 Date Format

The format of the date and time is designed to allow flexibility without admitting ambiguity. (The
words ‘date’ and ‘time’ are both used in the documentation below; except where specifically noted
this implies a string that may include both a date and a time specification.) Note that there is no
localization support; month and day names must be in English and separator characters are fixed.
Matching is case insensitive, and only the first three letters of the names are significant, although as
a special case a form beginning "month" does not match "Monday". Furthermore, time zones are
not handled; all times are assumed to be local.

It is recommended that, rather than exploring the intricacies of the system, users find a date format
that is natural to them and stick to it. This will avoid unexpected effects. Various key facts should be
noted.

In particular, note the confusion between month / day / year and day / month / year when the
month is numeric; these formats should be avoided if at all possible. Many alternatives are
available.
The year must be given in full to avoid confusion, and only years from 1900 to 2099 inclusive
are matched.

The following give some obvious examples; users finding here a format they like and not subject to
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 485 of 616
:
vagaries of style may skip the full description. As dates and times are matched separately (even
though the time may be embedded in the date), any date format may be mixed with any format for
the time of day provide the separators are clear (whitespace, colons, commas).

2007/04/03 13:13
2007/04/03:13:13
2007/04/03 1:13 pm
3rd April 2007, 13:13
April 3rd 2007 1:13 p.m.
Apr 3, 2007 13:13
Tue Apr 03 13:13:00 2007
13:13 2007/apr/3

More detailed rules follow.

Times are parsed and extracted before dates. They must use colons to separate hours and minutes,
though a dot is allowed before seconds if they are present. This limits time formats to the following:

HH : MM [: SS [. FFFFF ]] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]
HH : MM . SS [. FFFFF ] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

Here, square brackets indicate optional elements, possibly with alternatives. Fractions of a second
are recognised but ignored. For absolute times (the normal format require by the calendar file and
the age, before and after functions) a date is mandatory but a time of day is not; the time returned is
at the start of the date. One variation is allowed: if a.m. or p.m. or one of their variants is present, an
hour without a minute is allowed, e.g. 3 p.m..

Time zones are not handled, though if one is matched following a time specification it will be
removed to allow a surrounding date to be parsed. This only happens if the format of the timezone
is not too unusual. The following are examples of forms that are understood:

+0100
GMT
GMT-7
CET+1CDT

Any part of the timezone that is not numeric must have exactly three capital letters in the name.

Dates suffer from the ambiguity between DD / MM / YYYY and MM / DD / YYYY . It is recommended this
form is avoided with purely numeric dates, but use of ordinals, eg. 3rd/04/2007, will resolve the
ambiguity as the ordinal is always parsed as the day of the month. Years must be four digits (and the
first two must be 19 or 20); 03/04/08 is not recognised. Other numbers may have leading zeroes, but
they are not required. The following are handled:

YYYY / MM / DD
YYYY - MM - DD
YYYY / MNM / DD

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 486 of 616
:
YYYY - MNM - DD
DD [th|st|rd] MNM [,] [ YYYY ]
MNM DD [th|st|rd][,] [ YYYY ]
DD [th|st|rd]/ MM [,] YYYY
DD [th|st|rd]/ MM / YYYY
MM / DD [th|st|rd][,] YYYY
MM / DD [th|st|rd]/ YYYY

Here, MNM is at least the first three letters of a month name, matched case-insensitively. The
remainder of the month name may appear but its contents are irrelevant, so janissary, febrile,
martial, apricot, maybe, junta, etc. are happily handled.

Where the year is shown as optional, the current year is assumed. There are only two such cases,
the form Jun 20 or 14 September (the only two commonly occurring forms, apart from a "the" in
some forms of English, which isn’t currently supported). Such dates will of course become
ambiguous in the future, so should ideally be avoided.

Times may follow dates with a colon, e.g. 1965/07/12:09:45; this is in order to provide a format with
no whitespace. A comma and whitespace are allowed, e.g. 1965/07/12, 09:45. Currently the order of
these separators is not checked, so illogical formats such as 1965/07/12, : ,09:45 will also be
matched. For simplicity such variations are not shown in the list above. Otherwise, a time is only
recognised as being associated with a date if there is only whitespace in between, or if the time was
embedded in the date.

Days of the week are not normally scanned, but will be ignored if they occur at the start of the date
pattern only. However, in contexts where it is useful to specify dates relative to today, days of the
week with no other date specification may be given. The day is assumed to be either today or within
the past week. Likewise, the words yesterday, today and tomorrow are handled. All matches are
case-insensitive. Hence if today is Monday, then Sunday is equivalent to yesterday, Monday is
equivalent to today, but Tuesday gives a date six days ago. This is not generally useful within the
calendar file. Dates in this format may be combined with a time specification; for example
Tomorrow, 8 p.m..

For example, the standard date format:

Fri Aug 18 17:00:48 BST 2006

is handled by matching HH : MM : SS and removing it together with the matched (but unused) time
zone. This leaves the following:

Fri Aug 18 2006

Fri is ignored and the rest is matched according to the standard rules.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 487 of 616
:
23.2.3 Relative Time Format

In certain places relative times are handled. Here, a date is not allowed; instead a combination of
various supported periods are allowed, together with an optional time. The periods must be in order
from most to least significant.

In some cases, a more accurate calculation is possible when there is an anchor date: offsets of
months or years pick the correct day, rather than being rounded, and it is possible to pick a
particular day in a month as ‘(1st Friday)’, etc., as described in more detail below.

Anchors are available in the following cases. If one or two times are passed to the function calendar,
the start time acts an anchor for the end time when the end time is relative (even if the start time is
implicit). When examining calendar files, the scheduled event being examined anchors the warning
time when it is given explicitly by means of the WARN keyword; likewise, the scheduled event
anchors a repetition period when given by the RPT keyword, so that specifications such as RPT 2
months, 3rd Thursday are handled properly. Finally, the -R argument to calendar_scandate directly
provides an anchor for relative calculations.

The periods handled, with possible abbreviations are:

Years
years, yrs, ys, year, yr, y, yearly. A year is 365.25 days unless there is an anchor.

Months
months, mons, mnths, mths, month, mon, mnth, mth, monthly. Note that m, ms, mn, mns are
ambiguous and are not handled. A month is a period of 30 days rather than a calendar month unless
there is an anchor.

Weeks
weeks, wks, ws, week, wk, w, weekly

Days
days, dys, ds, day, dy, d, daily

Hours
hours, hrs, hs, hour, hr, h, hourly

Minutes
minutes, mins, minute, min, but not m, ms, mn or mns

Seconds
seconds, secs, ss, second, sec, s

Spaces between the numbers are optional, but are required between items, although a comma may
be used (with or without spaces).

The forms yearly to hourly allow the number to be omitted; it is assumed to be 1. For example, 1 d
and daily are equivalent. Note that using those forms with plurals is confusing; 2 yearly is the same
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 488 of 616
:
as 2 years, not twice yearly, so it is recommended they only be used without numbers.

When an anchor time is present, there is an extension to handle regular events in the form of the
n th some day of the month. Such a specification must occur immediately after any year and month
specification, but before any time of day, and must be in the form n (th|st|rd) day , for example 1st
Tuesday or 3rd Monday. As in other places, days are matched case insensitively, must be in English,
and only the first three letters are significant except that a form beginning ‘month’ does not match
‘Monday’. No attempt is made to sanitize the resulting date; attempts to squeeze too many
occurrences into a month will push the day into the next month (but in the obvious fashion,
retaining the correct day of the week).

Here are some examples:

30 years 3 months 4 days 3:42:41


14 days 5 hours
Monthly, 3rd Thursday
4d,10hr

23.2.4 Example

Here is an example calendar file. It uses a consistent date format, as recommended above.

Feb 1, 2006 14:30 Pointless bureaucratic meeting


Mar 27, 2006 11:00 Mutual recrimination and finger pointing
Bring water pistol and waterproofs
Mar 31, 2006 14:00 Very serious managerial pontification
# UID 12C7878A9A50
Apr 10, 2006 13:30 Even more pointless blame assignment exercise WARN 30 mins
May 18, 2006 16:00 Regular moaning session RPT monthly, 3rd Thursday

The second entry has a continuation line. The third entry has a continuation line that will not be
shown when the entry is displayed, but the unique identifier will be used by the calendar_add
function when updating the event. The fourth entry will produce a warning 30 minutes before the
event (to allow you to equip yourself appropriately). The fifth entry repeats after a month on the 3rd
Thursday, i.e. June 15, 2006, at the same time.

23.3 User Functions


This section describes functions that are designed to be called directly by the user. The first part
describes those functions associated with the user’s calendar; the second part describes the use in
glob qualifiers.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 489 of 616
:
23.3.1 Calendar system functions

calendar [ -abdDsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ]

[ [ start ] end ]

calendar -r [ -abdDrsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ]

[ start ]

Show events in the calendar.

With no arguments, show events from the start of today until the end of the next working day after
today. In other words, if today is Friday, Saturday, or Sunday, show up to the end of the following
Monday, otherwise show today and tomorrow.

If end is given, show events from the start of today up to the time and date given, which is in the
format described in the previous section. Note that if this is a date the time is assumed to be
midnight at the start of the date, so that effectively this shows all events before the given date.

end may start with a +, in which case the remainder of the specification is a relative time format as
described in the previous section indicating the range of time from the start time that is to be
included.

If start is also given, show events starting from that time and date. The word now can be used to
indicate the current time.

To implement an alert when events are due, include calendar -s in your ~/.zshrc file.

Options:

-a
Show all items in the calendar, regardless of the start and end.

-b
Brief: don’t display continuation lines (i.e. indented lines following the line with the date/time), just
the first line.

-B lines
Brief: display at most the first lines lines of the calendar entry. ‘-B 1’ is equivalent to ‘-b’.

-C calfile
Explicitly specify a calendar file instead of the value of the calendar-file style or the default
~/calendar.

-d
Move any events that have passed from the calendar file to the "done" file, as given by the done-file
style or the default which is the calendar file with .done appended. This option is implied by the -s
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 490 of 616
:
option.

-D
Turns off the option -d, even if the -s option is also present.

-n num , - num
Show at least num events, if present in the calendar file, regardless of the start and end.

-r
Show all the remaining options in the calendar, ignoring the given end time. The start time is
respected; any argument given is treated as a start time.

-s
Use the shell’s sched command to schedule a timed event that will warn the user when an event is
due. Note that the sched command only runs if the shell is at an interactive prompt; a foreground
task blocks the scheduled task from running until it is finished.

The timed event usually runs the programme calendar_show to show the event, as described in
Utility functions.

By default, a warning of the event is shown five minutes before it is due. The warning period can be
configured by the style warn-time or for a single calendar entry by including WARN reltime in the
first line of the entry, where reltime is one of the usual relative time formats.

A repeated event may be indicated by including RPT reldate in the first line of the entry. After the
scheduled event has been displayed it will be re-entered into the calendar file at a time reldate
after the existing event. Note that this is currently the only use made of the repeat count, so that it is
not possible to query the schedule for a recurrence of an event in the calendar until the previous
event has passed.

If RPT is used, it is also possible to specify that certain recurrences of an event are rescheduled or
cancelled. This is done with the OCCURRENCE keyword, followed by whitespace and the date and
time of the occurrence in the regular sequence, followed by whitespace and either the date and time
of the rescheduled event or the exact string CANCELLED. In this case the date and time must be in
exactly the "date with local time" format used by the text/calendar MIME type (RFC 2445), <YYYY>
<MM><DD> T <hh><mm><ss> (note the presence of the literal character T). The first word (the regular
recurrence) may be something other than a proper date/time to indicate that the event is additional
to the normal sequence; a convention that retains the formatting appearance is XXXXXXXXTXXXXXX.

Furthermore, it is useful to record the next regular recurrence (as then the displayed date may be
for a rescheduled event so cannot be used for calculating the regular sequence). This is specified by
RECURRENCE and a time or date in the same format. calendar_add adds such an indication when it
encounters a recurring event that does not include one, based on the headline date/time.

If calendar_add is used to update occurrences the UID keyword described there should be present
in both the existing entry and the added occurrence in order to identify recurring event sequences.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 491 of 616
:
For example,

Thu May 6, 2010 11:00 Informal chat RPT 1 week


# RECURRENCE 20100506T110000
# OCCURRENCE 20100513T110000 20100513T120000
# OCCURRENCE 20100520T110000 CANCELLED

The event that occurs at 11:00 on 13th May 2010 is rescheduled an hour later. The event that occurs
a week later is cancelled. The occurrences are given on a continuation line starting with a #
character so will not usually be displayed as part of the event. As elsewhere, no account of time
zones is taken with the times. After the next event occurs the headline date/time will be ‘Thu May 13,
2010 12:00’ while the RECURRENCE date/time will be ‘20100513T110000’ (note that cancelled and
moved events are not taken account of in the RECURRENCE, which records what the next regular
recurrence is, but they are accounted for in the headline date/time).

It is safe to run calendar -s to reschedule an existing event (if the calendar file has changed, for
example), and also to have it running in multiples instances of the shell since the calendar file is
locked when in use.

By default, expired events are moved to the "done" file; see the -d option. Use -D to prevent this.

-S showprog
Explicitly specify a programme to be used for showing events instead of the value of the show-prog
style or the default calendar_show.

-v
Verbose: show more information about stages of processing. This is useful for confirming that the
function has successfully parsed the dates in the calendar file.

calendar_add [ -BL ] event ...

Adds a single event to the calendar in the appropriate location. The event can contain multiple lines,
as described in File and Date Formats. Using this function ensures that the calendar file is sorted in
date and time order. It also makes special arrangements for locking the file while it is altered. The
old calendar is left in a file with the suffix .old.

The option -B indicates that backing up the calendar file will be handled by the caller and should not
be performed by calendar_add. The option -L indicates that calendar_add does not need to lock the
calendar file as it is already locked. These options will not usually be needed by users.

If the style reformat-date is true, the date and time of the new entry will be rewritten into the
standard date format: see the descriptions of this style and the style date-format.

The function can use a unique identifier stored with each event to ensure that updates to existing
events are treated correctly. The entry should contain the word UID, followed by whitespace,
followed by a word consisting entirely of hexadecimal digits of arbitrary length (all digits are
significant, including leading zeroes). As the UID is not directly useful to the user, it is convenient to

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 492 of 616
:
hide it on an indented continuation line starting with a #, for example:

Aug 31, 2007 09:30 Celebrate the end of the holidays


# UID 045B78A0

The second line will not be shown by the calendar function.

It is possible to specify the RPT keyword followed by CANCELLED instead of a relative time. This
causes any matched event or series of events to be cancelled (the original event does not have to be
marked as recurring in order to be cancelled by this method). A UID is required in order to match an
existing event in the calendar.

calendar_add will attempt to manage recurrences and occurrences of repeating events as described
for event scheduling by calendar -s above. To reschedule or cancel a single event calendar_add
should be called with an entry that includes the correct UID but does not include the RPT keyword as
this is taken to mean the entry applies to a series of repeating events and hence replaces all existing
information. Each rescheduled or cancelled occurrence must have an OCCURRENCE keyword in the
entry passed to calendar_add which will be merged into the calendar file. Any existing reference to
the occurrence is replaced. An occurrence that does not refer to a valid existing event is added as a
one-off occurrence to the same calendar entry.

calendar_edit

This calls the user’s editor to edit the calendar file. If there are arguments, they are taken as the
editor to use (the file name is appended to the commands); otherwise, the editor is given by the
variable VISUAL, if set, else the variable EDITOR.

If the calendar scheduler was running, then after editing the file calendar -s is called to update it.

This function locks out the calendar system during the edit. Hence it should be used to edit the
calendar file if there is any possibility of a calendar event occurring meanwhile. Note this can lead to
another shell with calendar functions enabled hanging waiting for a lock, so it is necessary to quit
the editor as soon as possible.

calendar_parse calendar-entry

This is the internal function that analyses the parts of a calendar entry, which is passed as the only
argument. The function returns status 1 if the argument could not be parsed as a calendar entry and
status 2 if the wrong number of arguments were passed; it also sets the parameter reply to an
empty associative array. Otherwise, it returns status 0 and sets elements of the associative array
reply as follows:

time
The time as a string of digits in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS

schedtime
The regularly scheduled time. This may differ from the actual event time time if this is a recurring

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 493 of 616
:
event and the next occurrence has been rescheduled. Then time gives the actual time and
schedtime the time of the regular recurrence before modification.

text1
The text from the line not including the date and time of the event, but including any WARN or RPT
keywords and values.

warntime
Any warning time given by the WARN keyword as a string of digits containing the time at which to
warn in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS. (Note this is an absolute time, not the relative time
passed down.) Not set no WARN keyword and value were matched.

warnstr
The raw string matched after the WARN keyword, else unset.

rpttime
Any recurrence time given by the RPT keyword as a string of digits containing the time of the
recurrence in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS. (Note this is an absolute time.) Not set if no RPT
keyword and value were matched.

schedrpttime
The next regularly scheduled occurrence of a recurring event before modification. This may differ
from rpttime, which is the actual time of the event that may have been rescheduled from the regular
time.

rptstr
The raw string matched after the RPT keyword, else unset.

text2
The text from the line after removal of the date and any keywords and values.

calendar_showdate [ -r ] [ -f fmt ] date-spec ...

The given date-spec is interpreted and the corresponding date and time printed. If the initial date-
spec begins with a + or - it is treated as relative to the current time; date-spec s after the first are
treated as relative to the date calculated so far and a leading + is optional in that case. This allows
one to use the system as a date calculator. For example, calendar_showdate ’+1 month, 1st Friday’
shows the date of the first Friday of next month.

With the option -r nothing is printed but the value of the date and time in seconds since the epoch is
stored in the parameter REPLY.

With the option -f fmt the given date/time conversion format is passed to strftime; see notes on the
date-format style below.

In order to avoid ambiguity with negative relative date specifications, options must occur in separate
words; in other words, -r and -f should not be combined in the same word.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 494 of 616
:
calendar_sort

Sorts the calendar file into date and time order. The old calendar is left in a file with the suffix .old.

23.3.2 Glob qualifiers

age

The function age can be autoloaded and use separately from the calendar system, although it uses
the function calendar_scandate for date formatting. It requires the zsh/stat builtin, but uses only the
builtin zstat.

age selects files having a given modification time for use as a glob qualifier. The format of the date is
the same as that understood by the calendar system, described in File and Date Formats.

The function can take one or two arguments, which can be supplied either directly as command or
arguments, or separately as shell parameters.

print *(e:age 2006/10/04 2006/10/09:)

The example above matches all files modified between the start of those dates. The second
argument may alternatively be a relative time introduced by a +:

print *(e:age 2006/10/04 +5d:)

The example above is equivalent to the previous example.

In addition to the special use of days of the week, today and yesterday, times with no date may be
specified; these apply to today. Obviously such uses become problematic around midnight.

print *(e-age 12:00 13:30-)

The example above shows files modified between 12:00 and 13:00 today.

print *(e:age 2006/10/04:)

The example above matches all files modified on that date. If the second argument is omitted it is
taken to be exactly 24 hours after the first argument (even if the first argument contains a time).

print *(e-age 2006/10/04:10:15 2006/10/04:10:45-)

The example above supplies times. Note that whitespace within the time and date specification
must be quoted to ensure age receives the correct arguments, hence the use of the additional colon
to separate the date and time.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 495 of 616
:
AGEREF=2006/10/04:10:15
AGEREF2=2006/10/04:10:45
print *(+age)

This shows the same example before using another form of argument passing. The dates and times
in the parameters AGEREF and AGEREF2 stay in effect until unset, but will be overridden if any
argument is passed as an explicit argument to age. Any explicit argument causes both parameters
to be ignored.

Instead of an explicit date and time, it’s possible to use the modification time of a file as the date and
time for either argument by introducing the file name with a colon:

print *(e-age :file1-)

matches all files created on the same day (24 hours starting from midnight) as file1.

print *(e-age :file1 :file2-)

matches all files modified no earlier than file1 and no later than file2; precision here is to the nearest
second.

after
before

The functions after and before are simpler versions of age that take just one argument. The
argument is parsed similarly to an argument of age; if it is not given the variable AGEREF is
consulted. As the names of the functions suggest, a file matches if its modification time is after or
before the time and date specified. If a time only is given the date is today.

The two following examples are therefore equivalent:

print *(e-after 12:00-)


print *(e-after today:12:00-)

23.4 Styles
The zsh style mechanism using the zstyle command is describe in The zsh/zutil Module. This is the
same mechanism used in the completion system.

The styles below are all examined in the context :datetime: function :, for example
:datetime:calendar:.

calendar-file

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 496 of 616
:
The location of the main calendar. The default is ~/calendar.

date-format

A strftime format string (see strftime(3)) with the zsh extensions providing various numbers with no
leading zero or space if the number is a single digit as described for the %D{ string } prompt format
in Prompt Expansion.

This is used for outputting dates in calendar, both to support the -v option and when adding
recurring events back to the calendar file, and in calendar_showdate as the final output format.

If the style is not set, the default used is similar the standard system format as output by the date
command (also known as ‘ctime format’): ‘%a %b %d %H:%M:%S %Z %Y’.

done-file

The location of the file to which events which have passed are appended. The default is the calendar
file location with the suffix .done. The style may be set to an empty string in which case a "done" file
will not be maintained.

reformat-date

Boolean, used by calendar_add. If it is true, the date and time of new entries added to the calendar
will be reformatted to the format given by the style date-format or its default. Only the date and
time of the event itself is reformatted; any subsidiary dates and times such as those associated with
repeat and warning times are left alone.

show-prog

The programme run by calendar for showing events. It will be passed the start time and stop time of
the events requested in seconds since the epoch followed by the event text. Note that calendar -s
uses a start time and stop time equal to one another to indicate alerts for specific events.

The default is the function calendar_show.

warn-time

The time before an event at which a warning will be displayed, if the first line of the event does not
include the text EVENT reltime . The default is 5 minutes.

23.5 Utility functions


calendar_lockfiles

Attempt to lock the files given in the argument. To prevent problems with network file locking this is

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 497 of 616
:
done in an ad hoc fashion by attempting to create a symbolic link to the file with the name
file .lockfile. No other system level functions are used for locking, i.e. the file can be accessed and
modified by any utility that does not use this mechanism. In particular, the user is not prevented
from editing the calendar file at the same time unless calendar_edit is used.

Three attempts are made to lock the file before giving up. If the module zsh/zselect is available, the
times of the attempts are jittered so that multiple instances of the calling function are unlikely to
retry at the same time.

The files locked are appended to the array lockfiles, which should be local to the caller.

If all files were successfully locked, status zero is returned, else status one.

This function may be used as a general file locking function, although this will only work if only this
mechanism is used to lock files.

calendar_read

This is a backend used by various other functions to parse the calendar file, which is passed as the
only argument. The array calendar_entries is set to the list of events in the file; no pruning is done
except that ampersands are removed from the start of the line. Each entry may contain multiple
lines.

calendar_scandate

This is a generic function to parse dates and times that may be used separately from the calendar
system. The argument is a date or time specification as described in File and Date Formats. The
parameter REPLY is set to the number of seconds since the epoch corresponding to that date or
time. By default, the date and time may occur anywhere within the given argument.

Returns status zero if the date and time were successfully parsed, else one.

Options:

-a
The date and time are anchored to the start of the argument; they will not be matched if there is
preceding text.

-A
The date and time are anchored to both the start and end of the argument; they will not be matched
if the is any other text in the argument.

-d
Enable additional debugging output.

-m
Minus. When -R anchor_time is also given the relative time is calculated backwards from
anchor_time .

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 498 of 616
:
-r
The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time.

-R anchor_time
The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time. The time is relative to anchor_time , a time
in seconds since the epoch, and the returned value is the absolute time corresponding to advancing
anchor_time by the relative time given. This allows lengths of months to be correctly taken into
account. If the final day does not exist in the given month, the last day of the final month is given.
For example, if the anchor time is during 31st January 2007 and the relative time is 1 month, the final
time is the same time of day during 28th February 2007.

-s
In addition to setting REPLY, set REPLY2 to the remainder of the argument after the date and time
have been stripped. This is empty if the option -A was given.

-t
Allow a time with no date specification. The date is assumed to be today. The behaviour is
unspecified if the iron tongue of midnight is tolling twelve.

calendar_show

The function used by default to display events. It accepts a start time and end time for events, both
in epoch seconds, and an event description.

The event is always printed to standard output. If the command line editor is active (which will
usually be the case) the command line will be redisplayed after the output.

If the parameter DISPLAY is set and the start and end times are the same (indicating a scheduled
event), the function uses the command xmessage to display a window with the event details.

23.6 Bugs
As the system is based entirely on shell functions (with a little support from the zsh/datetime
module) the mechanisms used are not as robust as those provided by a dedicated calendar utility.
Consequently the user should not rely on the shell for vital alerts.

There is no calendar_delete function.

There is no localization support for dates and times, nor any support for the use of time zones.

Relative periods of months and years do not take into account the variable number of days.

The calendar_show function is currently hardwired to use xmessage for displaying alerts on X
Window System displays. This should be configurable and ideally integrate better with the desktop.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 499 of 616
:
calendar_lockfiles hangs the shell while waiting for a lock on a file. If called from a scheduled task, it
should instead reschedule the event that caused it.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 500 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

24 TCP Function System


24.1 Description
24.2 TCP User Functions
24.2.1 Basic I/O
24.2.2 Session Management
24.2.3 Advanced I/O
24.2.4 ‘One-shot’ file transfer
24.3 TCP User-defined Functions
24.4 TCP Utility Functions
24.5 TCP User Parameters
24.6 TCP User-defined Parameters
24.7 TCP Utility Parameters
24.8 TCP Examples
24.9 TCP Bugs

24 TCP Function System

24.1 Description
A module zsh/net/tcp is provided to provide network I/O over TCP/IP from within the shell; see its
description in Zsh Modules. This manual page describes a function suite based on the module. If the
module is installed, the functions are usually installed at the same time, in which case they will be
available for autoloading in the default function search path. In addition to the zsh/net/tcp module,
the zsh/zselect module is used to implement timeouts on read operations. For troubleshooting tips,
consult the corresponding advice for the zftp functions described in Zftp Function System.

There are functions corresponding to the basic I/O operations open, close, read and send, named
tcp_open etc., as well as a function tcp_expect for pattern match analysis of data read as input. The
system makes it easy to receive data from and send data to multiple named sessions at once. In
addition, it can be linked with the shell’s line editor in such a way that input data is automatically
shown at the terminal. Other facilities available including logging, filtering and configurable output
prompts.

To use the system where it is available, it should be enough to ‘autoload -U tcp_open’ and run
tcp_open as documented below to start a session. The tcp_open function will autoload the
remaining functions.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 501 of 616
:
24.2 TCP User Functions

24.2.1 Basic I/O

tcp_open [ -qz ] host port [ sess ]

tcp_open [ -qz ] [ -s sess | -l sess [,...] ] ...

tcp_open [ -qz ] [ -a fd | -f fd ] [ sess ]

Open a new session. In the first and simplest form, open a TCP connection to host host at port
port ; numeric and symbolic forms are understood for both.

If sess is given, this becomes the name of the session which can be used to refer to multiple
different TCP connections. If sess is not given, the function will invent a numeric name value (note
this is not the same as the file descriptor to which the session is attached). It is recommended that
session names not include ‘funny’ characters, where funny characters are not well-defined but
certainly do not include alphanumerics or underscores, and certainly do include whitespace.

In the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given by name. A single session name is
given after -s and a comma-separated list after -l; both options may be repeated as many times as
necessary. A failure to open any session causes tcp_open to abort. The host and port are read from
the file .ztcp_sessions in the same directory as the user’s zsh initialisation files, i.e. usually the home
directory, but $ZDOTDIR if that is set. The file consists of lines each giving a session name and the
corresponding host and port, in that order (note the session name comes first, not last), separated
by whitespace.

The third form allows passive and fake TCP connections. If the option -a is used, its argument is a file
descriptor open for listening for connections. No function front-end is provided to open such a file
descriptor, but a call to ‘ztcp -l port ’ will create one with the file descriptor stored in the parameter
$REPLY. The listening port can be closed with ‘ztcp -c fd ’. A call to ‘tcp_open -a fd ’ will block until a
remote TCP connection is made to port on the local machine. At this point, a session is created in
the usual way and is largely indistinguishable from an active connection created with one of the first
two forms.

If the option -f is used, its argument is a file descriptor which is used directly as if it were a TCP
session. How well the remainder of the TCP function system copes with this depends on what
actually underlies this file descriptor. A regular file is likely to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of some sort
will work better, but note that it is not a good idea for two different sessions to attempt to read from
the same FIFO at once.

If the option -q is given with any of the three forms, tcp_open will not print informational messages,
although it will in any case exit with an appropriate status.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 502 of 616
:
If the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the case if the shell is interactive, tcp_open installs a
handler inside zle which will check for new data at the same time as it checks for keyboard input.
This is convenient as the shell consumes no CPU time while waiting; the test is performed by the
operating system. Giving the option -z to any of the forms of tcp_open prevents the handler from
being installed, so data must be read explicitly. Note, however, this is not necessary for executing
complete sets of send and read commands from a function, as zle is not active at this point.
Generally speaking, the handler is only active when the shell is waiting for input at a command
prompt or in the vared builtin. The option has no effect if zle is not active; ‘[[ -o zle]]’ will test for this.

The first session to be opened becomes the current session and subsequent calls to tcp_open do
not change it. The current session is stored in the parameter $TCP_SESS; see below for more detail
about the parameters used by the system.

The function tcp_on_open, if defined, is called when a session is opened. See the description below.

tcp_close [ -qn ] [ -a | -l sess [,...] | sess ... ]

Close the named sessions, or the current session if none is given, or all open sessions if -a is given.
The options -l and -s are both handled for consistency with tcp_open, although the latter is
redundant.

If the session being closed is the current one, $TCP_SESS is unset, leaving no current session, even if
there are other sessions still open.

If the session was opened with tcp_open -f, the file descriptor is closed so long as it is in the range 0
to 9 accessible directly from the command line. If the option -n is given, no attempt will be made to
close file descriptors in this case. The -n option is not used for genuine ztcp session; the file
descriptors are always closed with the session.

If the option -q is given, no informational messages will be printed.

tcp_read [ -bdq ] [ -t TO ] [ -T TO ]

[ -a | -u fd [,...] | -l sess [,...] | -s sess ... ]

Perform a read operation on the current session, or on a list of sessions if any are given with -u, -l or
-s, or all open sessions if the option -a is given. Any of the -u, -l or -s options may be repeated or
mixed together. The -u option specifies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this system
are useful), the other two specify sessions as described for tcp_open above.

The function checks for new data available on all the sessions listed. Unless the -b option is given, it
will not block waiting for new data. Any one line of data from any of the available sessions will be
read, stored in the parameter $TCP_LINE, and displayed to standard output unless $TCP_SILENT
contains a non-empty string. When printed to standard output the string $TCP_PROMPT will be
shown at the start of the line; the default form for this includes the name of the session being read.
See below for more information on these parameters. In this mode, tcp_read can be called
repeatedly until it returns status 2 which indicates all pending input from all specified sessions has

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 503 of 616
:
been handled.

With the option -b, equivalent to an infinite timeout, the function will block until a line is available to
read from one of the specified sessions. However, only a single line is returned.

The option -d indicates that all pending input should be drained. In this case tcp_read may process
multiple lines in the manner given above; only the last is stored in $TCP_LINE, but the complete set is
stored in the array $tcp_lines. This is cleared at the start of each call to tcp_read.

The options -t and -T specify a timeout in seconds, which may be a floating point number for
increased accuracy. With -t the timeout is applied before each line read. With -T, the timeout applies
to the overall operation, possibly including multiple read operations if the option -d is present;
without this option, there is no distinction between -t and -T.

The function does not print informational messages, but if the option -q is given, no error message
is printed for a non-existent session.

A return status of 2 indicates a timeout or no data to read. Any other non-zero return status
indicates some error condition.

See tcp_log for how to control where data is sent by tcp_read.

tcp_send [ -cnq ] [ -s sess | -l sess [,...] ] data ...

tcp_send [ -cnq ] -a data ...

Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions in turn. The underlying operation differs
little from a ‘print -r’ to the session’s file descriptor, although it attempts to prevent the shell from
dying owing to a SIGPIPE caused by an attempt to write to a defunct session.

The option -c causes tcp_send to behave like cat. It reads lines from standard input until end of input
and sends them in turn to the specified session(s) exactly as if they were given as data arguments
to individual tcp_send commands.

The option -n prevents tcp_send from putting a newline at the end of the data strings.

The remaining options all behave as for tcp_read.

The data arguments are not further processed once they have been passed to tcp_send; they are
simply passed down to print -r.

If the parameter $TCP_OUTPUT is a non-empty string and logging is enabled then the data sent to
each session will be echoed to the log file(s) with $TCP_OUTPUT in front where appropriate, much in
the manner of $TCP_PROMPT.

24.2.2 Session Management

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 504 of 616
:
tcp_alias [ -q ] alias = sess ...

tcp_alias [ -q ] [ alias ... ]

tcp_alias -d [ -q ] alias ...

This function is not particularly well tested.

The first form creates an alias for a session name; alias can then be used to refer to the existing
session sess . As many aliases may be listed as required.

The second form lists any aliases specified, or all aliases if none.

The third form deletes all the aliases listed. The underlying sessions are not affected.

The option -q suppresses an inconsistently chosen subset of error messages.

tcp_log [ -asc ] [ -n | -N ] [ logfile ]

With an argument logfile , all future input from tcp_read will be logged to the named file. Unless -a
(append) is given, this file will first be truncated or created empty. With no arguments, show the
current status of logging.

With the option -s, per-session logging is enabled. Input from tcp_read is output to the file
logfile . sess . As the session is automatically discriminated by the filename, the contents are raw
(no $TCP_PROMPT). The option -a applies as above. Per-session logging and logging of all data in one
file are not mutually exclusive.

The option -c closes all logging, both complete and per-session logs.

The options -n and -N respectively turn off or restore output of data read by tcp_read to standard
output; hence ‘tcp_log -cn’ turns off all output by tcp_read.

The function is purely a convenient front end to setting the parameters $TCP_LOG, $TCP_LOG_SESS,
$TCP_SILENT, which are described below.

tcp_rename old new

Rename session old to session new . The old name becomes invalid.

tcp_sess [ sess [ command [ arg ... ] ] ]

With no arguments, list all the open sessions and associated file descriptors. The current session is
marked with a star. For use in functions, direct access to the parameters $tcp_by_name, $tcp_by_fd
and $TCP_SESS is probably more convenient; see below.

With a sess argument, set the current session to sess . This is equivalent to changing $TCP_SESS
directly.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 505 of 616
:
With additional arguments, temporarily set the current session while executing ‘ command arg ...’.
command is re-evaluated so as to expand aliases etc., but the remaining arg s are passed through as
that appear to tcp_sess. The original session is restored when tcp_sess exits.

24.2.3 Advanced I/O

tcp_command send-option ... send-argument ...

This is a convenient front-end to tcp_send. All arguments are passed to tcp_send, then the function
pauses waiting for data. While data is arriving at least every $TCP_TIMEOUT (default 0.3) seconds,
data is handled and printed out according to the current settings. Status 0 is always returned.

This is generally only useful for interactive use, to prevent the display becoming fragmented by
output returned from the connection. Within a programme or function it is generally better to
handle reading data by a more explicit method.

tcp_expect [ -q ] [ -p var | -P var ] [ -t TO | -T TO ]

[ -a | -s sess | -l sess [,...] ] pattern ...

Wait for input matching any of the given pattern s from any of the specified sessions. Input is
ignored until an input line matches one of the given patterns; at this point status zero is returned,
the matching line is stored in $TCP_LINE, and the full set of lines read during the call to tcp_expect is
stored in the array $tcp_expect_lines.

Sessions are specified in the same way as tcp_read: the default is to use the current session,
otherwise the sessions specified by -a, -s, or -l are used.

Each pattern is a standard zsh extended-globbing pattern; note that it needs to be quoted to avoid
it being expanded immediately by filename generation. It must match the full line, so to match a
substring there must be a ‘*’ at the start and end. The line matched against includes the
$TCP_PROMPT added by tcp_read. It is possible to include the globbing flags ‘#b’ or ‘#m’ in the
patterns to make backreferences available in the parameters $MATCH, $match, etc., as described in
the base zsh documentation on pattern matching.

Unlike tcp_read, the default behaviour of tcp_expect is to block indefinitely until the required input is
found. This can be modified by specifying a timeout with -t or -T; these function as in tcp_read,
specifying a per-read or overall timeout, respectively, in seconds, as an integer or floating-point
number. As tcp_read, the function returns status 2 if a timeout occurs.

The function returns as soon as any one of the patterns given match. If the caller needs to know
which of the patterns matched, the option -p var can be used; on return, $var is set to the number
of the pattern using ordinary zsh indexing, i.e. the first is 1, and so on. Note the absence of a ‘$’ in
front of var . To avoid clashes, the parameter cannot begin with ‘_expect’. The index -1 is used if

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 506 of 616
:
there is a timeout and 0 if there is no match.

The option -P var works similarly to -p, but instead of numerical indexes the regular arguments
must begin with a prefix followed by a colon: that prefix is then used as a tag to which var is set
when the argument matches. The tag timeout is used if there is a timeout and the empty string if
there is no match. Note it is matches do not need to be distinguished.

The option -q is passed directly down to tcp_read.

As all input is done via tcp_read, all the usual rules about output of lines read apply. One exception
is that the parameter $tcp_lines will only reflect the line actually matched by tcp_expect; use
$tcp_expect_lines for the full set of lines read during the function call.

tcp_proxy

This is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection and execute a command with I/O
redirected to the connection. Extreme caution should be taken as there is no security whatsoever
and this can leave your computer open to the world. Ideally, it should only be used behind a firewall.

The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will listen.

The remaining arguments give a command and its arguments to execute with standard input,
standard output and standard error redirected to the file descriptor on which the TCP session has
been accepted. If no command is given, a new zsh is started. This gives everyone on your network
direct access to your account, which in many cases will be a bad thing.

The command is run in the background, so tcp_proxy can then accept new connections. It continues
to accept new connections until interrupted.

tcp_spam [ -ertv ] [ -a | -s sess | -l sess [,...] ] cmd [ arg ... ]

Execute ‘ cmd [ arg ... ]’ for each session in turn. Note this executes the command and arguments; it
does not send the command line as data unless the -t (transmit) option is given.

The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard -a, -s or -l options, or may be chosen
implicitly. If none of the three options is given the rules are: first, if the array $tcp_spam_list is set,
this is taken as the list of sessions, otherwise all sessions are taken. Second, any sessions given in
the array $tcp_no_spam_list are removed from the list of sessions.

Normally, any sessions added by the ‘-a’ flag or when all sessions are chosen implicitly are spammed
in alphabetic order; sessions given by the $tcp_spam_list array or on the command line are
spammed in the order given. The -r flag reverses the order however it was arrived it.

The -v flag specifies that a $TCP_PROMPT will be output before each session. This is output after any
modification to TCP_SESS by the user-defined tcp_on_spam function described below. (Obviously
that function is able to generate its own output.)

If the option -e is present, the line given as ‘ cmd [ arg ... ]’ is executed using eval, otherwise it is

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 507 of 616
:
executed without any further processing.

tcp_talk

This is a fairly simple-minded attempt to force input to the line editor to go straight to the default
TCP_SESS.

An escape string, $TCP_TALK_ESCAPE, default ‘:’, is used to allow access to normal shell operation. If
it is on its own at the start of the line, or followed only by whitespace, the line editor returns to
normal operation. Otherwise, the string and any following whitespace are skipped and the
remainder of the line executed as shell input without any change of the line editor’s operating mode.

The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of use of the command history. For this
reason, many users will prefer to use some form of alternative approach for sending data easily to
the current session. One simple approach is to alias some special character (such as ‘%’) to
‘tcp_command --’.

tcp_wait

The sole argument is an integer or floating point number which gives the seconds to delay. The shell
will do nothing for that period except wait for input on all TCP sessions by calling tcp_read -a. This is
similar to the interactive behaviour at the command prompt when zle handlers are installed.

24.2.4 ‘One-shot’ file transfer

tcp_point port
tcp_shoot host port
This pair of functions provide a simple way to transfer a file between two hosts within the shell.
Note, however, that bulk data transfer is currently done using cat. tcp_point reads any data arriving
at port and sends it to standard output; tcp_shoot connects to port on host and sends its
standard input. Any unused port may be used; the standard mechanism for picking a port is to
think of a random four-digit number above 1024 until one works.

To transfer a file from host woodcock to host springes, on springes:

tcp_point 8091 >output_file

and on woodcock:

tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file

As these two functions do not require tcp_open to set up a TCP connection first, they may need to
be autoloaded separately.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 508 of 616
:
24.3 TCP User-defined Functions
Certain functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the function system in certain contexts.
This facility depends on the module zsh/parameter, which is usually available in interactive shells as
the completion system depends on it. None of the functions need be defined; they simply provide
convenient hooks when necessary.

Typically, these are called after the requested action has been taken, so that the various parameters
will reflect the new state.

tcp_on_alias alias fd

When an alias is defined, this function will be called with two arguments: the name of the alias, and
the file descriptor of the corresponding session.

tcp_on_awol sess fd

If the function tcp_fd_handler is handling input from the line editor and detects that the file
descriptor is no longer reusable, by default it removes it from the list of file descriptors handled by
this method and prints a message. If the function tcp_on_awol is defined it is called immediately
before this point. It may return status 100, which indicates that the normal handling should still be
performed; any other return status indicates that no further action should be taken and the
tcp_fd_handler should return immediately with the given status. Typically the action of tcp_on_awol
will be to close the session.

The variable TCP_INVALIDATE_ZLE will be a non-empty string if it is necessary to invalidate the line
editor display using ‘zle -I’ before printing output from the function.

(‘AWOL’ is military jargon for ‘absent without leave’ or some variation. It has no pre-existing technical
meaning known to the author.)

tcp_on_close sess fd

This is called with the name of a session being closed and the file descriptor which corresponded to
that session. Both will be invalid by the time the function is called.

tcp_on_open sess fd

This is called after a new session has been defined with the session name and file descriptor as
arguments. If it returns a non-zero status, opening the session is assumed to fail and the session is
closed again; however, tcp_open will continue to attempt to open any remaining sessions given on
the command line.

tcp_on_rename oldsess fd newsess

This is called after a session has been renamed with the three arguments old session name, file
descriptor, new session name.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 509 of 616
:
tcp_on_spam sess command ...

This is called once for each session spammed, just before a command is executed for a session by
tcp_spam. The arguments are the session name followed by the command list to be executed. If
tcp_spam was called with the option -t, the first command will be tcp_send.

This function is called after $TCP_SESS is set to reflect the session to be spammed, but before any
use of it is made. Hence it is possible to alter the value of $TCP_SESS within this function. For
example, the session arguments to tcp_spam could include extra information to be stripped off and
processed in tcp_on_spam.

If the function sets the parameter $REPLY to ‘done’, the command line is not executed; in addition,
no prompt is printed for the -v option to tcp_spam.

tcp_on_unalias alias fd

This is called with the name of an alias and the corresponding session’s file descriptor after an alias
has been deleted.

24.4 TCP Utility Functions


The following functions are used by the TCP function system but will rarely if ever need to be called
directly.

tcp_fd_handler

This is the function installed by tcp_open for handling input from within the line editor, if that is
required. It is in the format documented for the builtin ‘zle -F’ in Zle Builtins .

While active, the function sets the parameter TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE to 1. This allows shell code
called internally (for example, by setting tcp_on_read) to tell if is being called when the shell is
otherwise idle at the editor prompt.

tcp_output [ -q ] -P prompt -F fd -S sess

This function is used for both logging and handling output to standard output, from within tcp_read
and (if $TCP_OUTPUT is set) tcp_send.

The prompt to use is specified by -P; the default is the empty string. It can contain:

%c
Expands to 1 if the session is the current session, otherwise 0. Used with ternary expressions such
as ‘%(c.-.+)’ to output ‘+’ for the current session and ‘-’ otherwise.

%f

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 510 of 616
:
Replaced by the session’s file descriptor.

%s
Replaced by the session name.

%%
Replaced by a single ‘%’.

The option -q suppresses output to standard output, but not to any log files which are configured.

The -S and -F options are used to pass in the session name and file descriptor for possible
replacement in the prompt.

24.5 TCP User Parameters


Parameters follow the usual convention that uppercase is used for scalars and integers, while
lowercase is used for normal and associative array. It is always safe for user code to read these
parameters. Some parameters may also be set; these are noted explicitly. Others are included in this
group as they are set by the function system for the user’s benefit, i.e. setting them is typically not
useful but is benign.

For example, ‘local TCP_SILENT=1’ specifies that data read during the function call will not be printed
to standard output, regardless of the setting outside the function. Likewise, ‘local TCP_SESS= sess ’
sets a session for the duration of a function, and ‘local TCP_PROMPT=’ specifies that no prompt is
used for input during the function.

tcp_expect_lines

Array. The set of lines read during the last call to tcp_expect, including the last ($TCP_LINE).

tcp_filter

Array. May be set directly. A set of extended globbing patterns which, if matched in tcp_output, will
cause the line not to be printed to standard output. The patterns should be defined as described for
the arguments to tcp_expect. Output of line to log files is not affected.

TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE

Scalar. Set to 1 within tcp_fd_handler to indicate to functions called recursively that they have been
called during an editor session. Otherwise unset.

TCP_LINE

The last line read by tcp_read, and hence also tcp_expect.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 511 of 616
:
TCP_LINE_FD

The file descriptor from which $TCP_LINE was read. ${tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]} will give the
corresponding session name.

tcp_lines

Array. The set of lines read during the last call to tcp_read, including the last ($TCP_LINE).

TCP_LOG

May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log. The name of a file to which output from
all sessions will be sent. The output is proceeded by the usual $TCP_PROMPT. If it is not an absolute
path name, it will follow the user’s current directory.

TCP_LOG_SESS

May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log. The prefix for a set of files to which
output from each session separately will be sent; the full filename is ${TCP_LOG_SESS}. sess . Output
to each file is raw; no prompt is added. If it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user’s
current directory.

tcp_no_spam_list

Array. May be set directly. See tcp_spam for how this is used.

TCP_OUTPUT

May be set directly. If a non-empty string, any data sent to a session by tcp_send will be logged. This
parameter gives the prompt to be used in a file specified by $TCP_LOG but not in a file generated
from $TCP_LOG_SESS. The prompt string has the same format as TCP_PROMPT and the same rules
for its use apply.

TCP_PROMPT

May be set directly. Used as the prefix for data read by tcp_read which is printed to standard output
or to the log file given by $TCP_LOG, if any. Any ‘%s’, ‘%f’ or ‘%%’ occurring in the string will be
replaced by the name of the session, the session’s underlying file descriptor, or a single ‘%’,
respectively. The expression ‘%c’ expands to 1 if the session being read is the current session, else 0;
this is most useful in ternary expressions such as ‘%(c.-.+)’ which outputs ‘+’ if the session is the
current one, else ‘-’.

If the prompt starts with %P, this is stripped and the complete result of the previous stage is passed
through standard prompt %-style formatting before being output.

TCP_READ_DEBUG

May be set directly. If this has non-zero length, tcp_read will give some limited diagnostics about
data being read.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 512 of 616
:
TCP_SECONDS_START

This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.

The functions tcp_read and tcp_expect use the shell’s SECONDS parameter for their own timing
purposes. If that parameter is not of floating point type on entry to one of the functions, it will create
a local parameter SECONDS which is floating point and set the parameter TCP_SECONDS_START to
the previous value of $SECONDS. If the parameter is already floating point, it is used without a local
copy being created and TCP_SECONDS_START is not set. As the global value is zero, the shell elapsed
time is guaranteed to be the sum of $SECONDS and $TCP_SECONDS_START.

This can be avoided by setting SECONDS globally to a floating point value using ‘typeset -F
SECONDS’; then the TCP functions will never make a local copy and never set TCP_SECONDS_START
to a non-zero value.

TCP_SESS

May be set directly. The current session; must refer to one of the sessions established by tcp_open.

TCP_SILENT

May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log. If of non-zero length, data read by
tcp_read will not be written to standard output, though may still be written to a log file.

tcp_spam_list

Array. May be set directly. See the description of the function tcp_spam for how this is used.

TCP_TALK_ESCAPE

May be set directly. See the description of the function tcp_talk for how this is used.

TCP_TIMEOUT

May be set directly. Currently this is only used by the function tcp_command, see above.

24.6 TCP User-defined Parameters


The following parameters are not set by the function system, but have a special effect if set by the
user.

tcp_on_read

This should be an associative array; if it is not, the behaviour is undefined. Each key is the name of a
shell function or other command, and the corresponding value is a shell pattern (using
EXTENDED_GLOB). Every line read from a TCP session directly or indirectly using tcp_read (which

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 513 of 616
:
includes lines read by tcp_expect) is compared against the pattern. If the line matches, the
command given in the key is called with two arguments: the name of the session from which the line
was read, and the line itself.

If any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero status, the line is not output. Thus a
tcp_on_read handler containing only the instruction ‘return 1’ can be used to suppress output of
particular lines (see, however, tcp_filter above). However, the line is still stored in TCP_LINE and
tcp_lines; this occurs after all tcp_on_read processing.

24.7 TCP Utility Parameters


These parameters are controlled by the function system; they may be read directly, but should not
usually be set by user code.

tcp_aliases

Associative array. The keys are the names of sessions established with tcp_open; each value is a
space-separated list of aliases which refer to that session.

tcp_by_fd

Associative array. The keys are session file descriptors; each value is the name of that session.

tcp_by_name

Associative array. The keys are the names of sessions; each value is the file descriptor associated
with that session.

24.8 TCP Examples


Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.

To create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the dc manual page for quite how infuriating the
underlying command is):

tcp_proxy 7337 dc

To connect to this from the same host with a session also named ‘dc’:

tcp_open localhost 7337 dc

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 514 of 616
:
To send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for output (assuming dc is the
current session):

tcp_command 2 4 + p

To close the session:

tcp_close

The tcp_proxy needs to be killed to be stopped. Note this will not usually kill any connections which
have already been accepted, and also that the port is not immediately available for reuse.

The following chunk of code puts a list of sessions into an xterm header, with the current session
followed by a star.

print -n "\033]2;TCP:" ${(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*} "\a"

24.9 TCP Bugs


The function tcp_read uses the shell’s normal read builtin. As this reads a complete line at once, data
arriving without a terminating newline can cause the function to block indefinitely.

Though the function suite works well for interactive use and for data arriving in small amounts, the
performance when large amounts of data are being exchanged is likely to be extremely poor.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 515 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

25 Zftp Function System


25.1 Description
25.2 Installation
25.3 Functions
25.3.1 Opening a connection
25.3.2 Directory management
25.3.3 Status commands
25.3.4 Retrieving files
25.3.5 Sending files
25.3.6 Closing the connection
25.3.7 Session management
25.3.8 Bookmarks
25.3.9 Other functions
25.4 Miscellaneous Features
25.4.1 Configuration
25.4.2 Remote globbing
25.4.3 Automatic and temporary reopening
25.4.4 Completion

25 Zftp Function System

25.1 Description
This describes the set of shell functions supplied with the source distribution as an interface to the
zftp builtin command, allowing you to perform FTP operations from the shell command line or
within functions or scripts. The interface is similar to a traditional FTP client (e.g. the ftp command
itself, see ftp(1)), but as it is entirely done within the shell all the familiar completion, editing and
globbing features, and so on, are present, and macros are particularly simple to write as they are
just ordinary shell functions.

The prerequisite is that the zftp command, as described in The zsh/zftp Module , must be available
in the version of zsh installed at your site. If the shell is configured to load new commands at run
time, it probably is: typing ‘zmodload zsh/zftp’ will make sure (if that runs silently, it has worked). If
this is not the case, it is possible zftp was linked into the shell anyway: to test this, type ‘which zftp’
and if zftp is available you will get the message ‘zftp: shell built-in command’.

Commands given directly with zftp builtin may be interspersed between the functions in this suite; in
a few cases, using zftp directly may cause some of the status information stored in shell parameters
to become invalid. Note in particular the description of the variables $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 516 of 616
:
and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.

25.2 Installation
You should make sure all the functions from the Functions/Zftp directory of the source distribution
are available; they all begin with the two letters ‘zf’. They may already have been installed on your
system; otherwise, you will need to find them and copy them. The directory should appear as one of
the elements of the $fpath array (this should already be the case if they were installed), and at least
the function zfinit should be autoloaded; it will autoload the rest. Finally, to initialize the use of the
system you need to call the zfinit function. The following code in your .zshrc will arrange for this;
assume the functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
autoload -U zfinit
zfinit

Note that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load the zftp command. If it is
already built into the shell, change zfinit to zfinit -n. It is helpful (though not essential) if the call to
zfinit appears after any code to initialize the new completion system, else unnecessary compctl
commands will be given.

25.3 Functions
The sequence of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially the same as that in a standard
FTP client. Note that, due to a quirk of the shell’s getopts builtin, for those functions that handle
options you must use ‘--’ rather than ‘-’ to ensure the remaining arguments are treated literally (a
single ‘-’ is treated as an argument).

25.3.1 Opening a connection

zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]

Set or show the parameters for a future zfopen with no arguments. If no arguments are given, the
current parameters are displayed (the password will be shown as a line of asterisks). If a host is
given, and either the user or password is not, they will be prompted for; also, any parameter given
as ‘?’ will be prompted for, and if the ‘?’ is followed by a string, that will be used as the prompt. As
zfopen calls zfparams to store the parameters, this usually need not be called directly.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 517 of 616
:
A single argument ‘-’ will delete the stored parameters. This will also cause the memory of the last
directory (and so on) on the other host to be deleted.

zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]

If host is present, open a connection to that host under username user with password password
(and, on the rare occasions when it is necessary, account account ). If a necessary parameter is
missing or given as ‘?’ it will be prompted for. If host is not present, use a previously stored set of
parameters.

If the command was successful, and the terminal is compatible with xterm or is sun-cmd, a summary
will appear in the title bar, giving the local host:directory and the remote host:directory; this is
handled by the function zftp_chpwd, described below.

Normally, the host , user and password are internally recorded for later re-opening, either by a
zfopen with no arguments, or automatically (see below). With the option ‘-1’, no information is
stored. Also, if an open command with arguments failed, the parameters will not be retained (and
any previous parameters will also be deleted). A zfopen on its own, or a zfopen -1, never alters the
stored parameters.

Both zfopen and zfanon (but not zfparams) understand URLs of the form ftp:// host / path... as
meaning to connect to the host , then change directory to path (which must be a directory, not a
file). The ‘ftp://’ can be omitted; the trailing ‘/’ is enough to trigger recognition of the path . Note
prefixes other than ‘ftp:’ are not recognized, and that all characters after the first slash beyond host
are significant in path .

zfanon [ -1 ] host

Open a connection host for anonymous FTP. The username used is ‘anonymous’. The password
(which will be reported the first time) is generated as user @ host ; this is then stored in the shell
parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manually to a

25.3.2 Directory management

zfcd [ dir ]

zfcd -

zfcd old new

Change the current directory on the remote server: this is implemented to have many of the
features of the shell builtin cd.

In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir . The command ‘zfcd ..’ is treated

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 518 of 616
:
specially, so is guaranteed to work on non-UNIX servers (note this is handled internally by zftp). If
dir is omitted, has the effect of ‘zfcd ~’.

The second form changes to the directory previously current.

The third form attempts to change the current directory by replacing the first occurrence of the
string old with the string new in the current directory.

Note that in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename is expected, the string which
on the local host corresponds to ‘~’ is converted back to a ‘~’ before being passed to the remote
machine. This is convenient because of the way expansion is performed on the command line
before zfcd receives a string. For example, suppose the command is ‘zfcd ~/foo’. The shell will
expand this to a full path such as ‘zfcd /home/user2/pws/foo’. At this stage, zfcd recognises the initial
path as corresponding to ‘~’ and will send the directory to the remote host as ~/foo, so that the ‘~’
will be expanded by the server to the correct remote host directory. Other named directories of the
form ‘~name’ are not treated in this fashion.

zfhere

Change directory on the remote server to the one corresponding to the current local directory, with
special handling of ‘~’ as in zfcd. For example, if the current local directory is ~/foo/bar, then zfhere
performs the effect of ‘zfcd ~/foo/bar’.

zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]

Produce a long directory listing. The arguments dir-options and dir are passed directly to the
server and their effect is implementation dependent, but specifying a particular remote directory
dir is usually possible. The output is passed through a pager given by the environment variable
$PAGER, or ‘more’ if that is not set.

The directory is usually cached for re-use. In fact, two caches are maintained. One is for use when
there is no dir-options or dir , i.e. a full listing of the current remote directory; it is flushed when
the current remote directory changes. The other is kept for repeated use of zfdir with the same
arguments; for example, repeated use of ‘zfdir /pub/gnu’ will only require the directory to be
retrieved on the first call. Alternatively, this cache can be re-viewed with the -r option. As relative
directories will confuse zfdir, the -f option can be used to force the cache to be flushed before the
directory is listed. The option -d will delete both caches without showing a directory listing; it will
also delete the cache of file names in the current remote directory, if any.

zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]

List files on the remote server. With no arguments, this will produce a simple list of file names for
the current remote directory. Any arguments are passed directly to the server. No pager and no
caching is used.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 519 of 616
:
25.3.3 Status commands

zftype [ type ]

With no arguments, show the type of data to be transferred, usually ASCII or binary. With an
argument, change the type: the types ‘A’ or ‘ASCII’ for ASCII data and ‘B’ or ‘BINARY’, ‘I’ or ‘IMAGE’ for
binary data are understood case-insensitively.

zfstat [ -v ]

Show the status of the current or last connection, as well as the status of some of zftp’s status
variables. With the -v option, a more verbose listing is produced by querying the server for its
version of events, too.

25.3.4 Retrieving files

The commands for retrieving files all take at least two options. -G suppresses remote filename
expansion which would otherwise be performed (see below for a more detailed description of that).
-t attempts to set the modification time of the local file to that of the remote file: see the description
of the function zfrtime below for more information.

zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...

Retrieve all the listed files file1 ... one at a time from the remote server. If a file contains a ‘/’, the
full name is passed to the remote server, but the file is stored locally under the name given by the
part after the final ‘/’. The option -c (cat) forces all files to be sent as a single stream to standard
output; in this case the -t option has no effect.

zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...

As zfget, but only retrieve files where the version on the remote server is newer (has a later
modification time), or where the local file does not exist. If the remote file is older but the files have
different sizes, or if the sizes are the same but the remote file is newer, the user will usually be
queried. With the option -s, the command runs silently and will always retrieve the file in either of
those two cases. With the option -v, the command prints more information about the files while it is
working out whether or not to transfer them.

zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...

As zfget, but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter than the corresponding remote file, the
command assumes that it is the result of a partially completed transfer and attempts to transfer the
rest of the file. This is useful on a poor connection which keeps failing.

Note that this requires a commonly implemented, but non-standard, version of the FTP protocol, so
is not guaranteed to work on all servers.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 520 of 616
:
zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file

zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir

This retrieves files from the remote server with arguments behaving similarly to the cp command.

In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local file local-file .

In the second form, copy all the remote files rfile1 ... into the local directory ldir retaining the
same basenames. This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

25.3.5 Sending files

zfput [ -r ] file1 ...

Send all the file1 ... given separately to the remote server. If a filename contains a ‘/’, the full
filename is used locally to find the file, but only the basename is used for the remote file name.

With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are sent recursively with all their
subdirectories, including files beginning with ‘.’. This requires that the remote machine understand
UNIX file semantics, since ‘/’ is used as a directory separator.

zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...

As zfput, but only send files which are newer than their remote equivalents, or if the remote file
does not exist. The logic is the same as for zfuget, but reversed between local and remote files.

zfcput file1 ...

As zfput, but if any remote file already exists and is shorter than the local equivalent, assume it is the
result of an incomplete transfer and send the rest of the file to append to the existing part. As the
FTP append command is part of the standard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.

zfpcp local-file remote-file

zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir

This sends files to the remote server with arguments behaving similarly to the cp command.

With two arguments, copy local-file to the server as remote-file .

With more than two arguments, copy all the local files lfile1 ... into the existing remote directory
rdir retaining the same basenames. This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

A problem arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1 rdir , i.e. the second form of copying but with
two arguments, as the command has no simple way of knowing if rdir corresponds to a directory
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 521 of 616
:
or a filename. It attempts to resolve this in various ways. First, if the rdir argument is ‘.’ or ‘..’ or
ends in a slash, it is assumed to be a directory. Secondly, if the operation of copying to a remote file
in the first form failed, and the remote server sends back the expected failure code 553 and a reply
including the string ‘Is a directory’, then zfpcp will retry using the second form.

25.3.6 Closing the connection

zfclose

Close the connection.

25.3.7 Session management

zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]

Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once. By default, connections take place in a session
called ‘default’; by giving the command ‘zfsession sessname ’ you can change to a new or existing
session with a name of your choice. The new session remembers its own connection, as well as
associated shell parameters, and also the host/user parameters set by zfparams. Hence you can
have different sessions set up to connect to different hosts, each remembering the appropriate
host, user and password.

With no arguments, zfsession prints the name of the current session; with the option -l it lists all
sessions which currently exist, and with the option -v it gives a verbose list showing the host and
directory for each session, where the current session is marked with an asterisk. With -o, it will
switch to the most recent previous session.

With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed; everything to do with it is completely
forgotten. If it was the only session, a new session called ‘default’ is created and made current. It is
safest not to delete sessions while background commands using zftp are active.

zftransfer sess1 : file1 sess2 : file2

Transfer files between two sessions; no local copy is made. The file is read from the session sess1
as file1 and written to session sess2 as file file2 ; file1 and file2 may be relative to the
current directories of the session. Either sess1 or sess2 may be omitted (though the colon should
be retained if there is a possibility of a colon appearing in the file name) and defaults to the current
session; file2 may be omitted or may end with a slash, in which case the basename of file1 will
be added. The sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.

The operation is performed using pipes, so it is required that the connections still be valid in a
subshell, which is not the case under versions of some operating systems, presumably due to a
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 522 of 616
:
system bug.

25.3.8 Bookmarks

The two functions zfmark and zfgoto allow you to ‘bookmark’ the present location (host, user and
directory) of the current FTP connection for later use. The file to be used for storing and retrieving
bookmarks is given by the parameter $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when one of the two functions is
called, it will be set to the file .zfbkmarks in the directory where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).

zfmark [ bookmark ]

If given an argument, mark the current host, user and directory under the name bookmark for later
use by zfgoto. If there is no connection open, use the values for the last connection immediately
before it was closed; it is an error if there was none. Any existing bookmark under the same name
will be silently replaced.

If not given an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the points to which they refer in the form
user @ host : directory ; this is the format in which they are stored, and the file may be edited
directly.

zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark

Return to the location given by bookmark , as previously set by zfmark. If the location has user ‘ftp’ or
‘anonymous’, open the connection with zfanon, so that no password is required. If the user and host
parameters match those stored for the current session, if any, those will be used, and again no
password is required. Otherwise a password will be prompted for.

With the option -n, the bookmark is taken to be a nickname stored by the ncftp program in its
bookmark file, which is assumed to be ~/.ncftp/bookmarks. The function works identically in other
ways. Note that there is no mechanism for adding or modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp
functions.

25.3.9 Other functions

Mostly, these functions will not be called directly (apart from zfinit), but are described here for
completeness. You may wish to alter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.

zfinit [ -n ]

As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function system. The -n option should be used if
the zftp command is already built into the shell.

zfautocheck [ -dn ]
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 523 of 616
:
This function is called to implement automatic reopening behaviour, as described in more detail
below. The options must appear in the first argument; -n prevents the command from changing to
the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting the variable do_close, which it otherwise does as a
flag for automatically closing the connection after a transfer. The host and directory for the last
session are stored in the variable $zflastsession, but the internal host/user/password parameters
must also be correctly set.

zfcd_match prefix suffix

This performs matching for completion of remote directory names. If the remote server is UNIX, it
will attempt to persuade the server to list the remote directory with subdirectories marked, which
usually works but is not guaranteed. On other hosts it simply calls zfget_match and hence completes
all files, not just directories. On some systems, directories may not even look like filenames.

zfget_match prefix suffix

This performs matching for completion of remote filenames. It caches files for the current directory
(only) in the shell parameter $zftp_fcache. It is in the form to be called by the -K option of compctl,
but also works when called from a widget-style completion function with prefix and suffix set
appropriately.

zfrglob varname

Perform remote globbing, as describes in more detail below. varname is the name of a variable
containing the pattern to be expanded; if there were any matches, the same variable will be set to
the expanded set of filenames on return.

zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]

Set the local file lfile to have the same modification time as the remote file rfile , or the explicit
time time in FTP format CCYYMMDDhhmmSS for the GMT timezone. This uses the shell’s
zsh/datetime module to perform the conversion from GMT to local time.

zftp_chpwd

This function is called every time a connection is opened, or closed, or the remote directory changes.
This version alters the title bar of an xterm-compatible or sun-cmd terminal emulator to reflect the
local and remote hostnames and current directories. It works best when combined with the function
chpwd. In particular, a function of the form

chpwd() {
if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
zftp_chpwd
else
# usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
fi
}

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 524 of 616
:
fits in well.

zftp_progress

This function shows the status of the transfer. It will not write anything unless the output is going to
a terminal; however, if you transfer files in the background, you should turn off progress reports by
hand using ‘zstyle ’:zftp:*’ progress none’. Note also that if you alter it, any output must be to
standard error, as standard output may be a file being received. The form of the progress meter, or
whether it is used at all, can be configured without altering the function, as described in the next
section.

zffcache

This is used to implement caching of files in the current directory for each session separately. It is
used by zfget_match and zfrglob.

25.4 Miscellaneous Features

25.4.1 Configuration

Various styles are available using the standard shell style mechanism, described in The zsh/zutil
Module. Briefly, the command ‘zstyle ’:zftp:*’ style value ...’. defines the style to have value
value ; more than one value may be given, although that is not useful in the cases described here.
These values will then be used throughout the zftp function system. For more precise control, the
first argument, which gives a pattern that matches contexts in which the style applies, can be
modified to include a particular function, as for example ‘:zftp:zfget’: the style will then have the
given value only in the zfget function, and will override styles set under ‘:zftp:*’. Note that only the
top level function name, as called by the user, is used; calling of lower level functions is transparent
to the user. Hence modifications to the title bar in zftp_chpwd use the contexts :zftp:zfopen,
:zftp:zfcd, etc., depending where it was called from. The following styles are understood:

progress

Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the progress of a transfer. If empty, unset, or ‘none’,
no progress report is made; if ‘bar’ a growing bar of inverse video is shown; if ‘percent’ (or any other
string, though this may change in future), the percentage of the file transferred is shown. The bar
meter requires that the width of the terminal be available via the $COLUMNS parameter (normally
this is set automatically). If the size of the file being transferred is not available, bar and percent
meters will simply show the number of bytes transferred so far.

When zfinit is run, if this style is not defined for the context :zftp:*, it will be set to ‘bar’.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 525 of 616
:
update

Specifies the minimum time interval between updates of the progress meter in seconds. No update
is made unless new data has been received, so the actual time interval is limited only by
$ZFTP_TIMEOUT.

As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to 1.

remote-glob

If set to ‘1’, ‘yes’ or ‘true’, filename generation (globbing) is performed on the remote machine
instead of by zsh itself; see below.

titlebar

If set to ‘1’, ‘yes’ or ‘true’, zftp_chpwd will put the remote host and remote directory into the titlebar
of terminal emulators such as xterm or sun-cmd that allow this.

As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to 1.

chpwd

If set to ‘1’ ‘yes’ or ‘true’, zftp_chpwd will call the function chpwd when a connection is closed. This is
useful if the remote host details were put into the terminal title bar by zftp_chpwd and your usual
chpwd also modifies the title bar.

When zfinit is run, it will determine whether chpwd exists and if so it will set the default value for the
style to 1 if none exists already.

Note that there is also an associative array zfconfig which contains values used by the function
system. This should not be modified or overwritten.

25.4.2 Remote globbing

The commands for retrieving files usually perform filename generation (globbing) on their
arguments; this can be turned off by passing the option -G to each of the commands. Normally this
operates by retrieving a complete list of files for the directory in question, then matching these
locally against the pattern supplied. This has the advantage that the full range of zsh patterns
(respecting the setting of the option EXTENDED_GLOB) can be used. However, it means that the
directory part of a filename will not be expanded and must be given exactly. If the remote server
does not support the UNIX directory semantics, directory handling is problematic and it is
recommended that globbing only be used within the current directory. The list of files in the current
directory, if retrieved, will be cached, so that subsequent globs in the same directory without an
intervening zfcd are much faster.

If the remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead performed on the remote host: the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 526 of 616
:
server is asked for a list of matching files. This is highly dependent on how the server is
implemented, though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic glob patterns. This may in
some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the entire list of directory contents.

25.4.3 Automatic and temporary reopening

As described for the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no parameters will reopen the
connection to the last host (this includes connections made with the zfanon command). Opened in
this fashion, the connection starts in the default remote directory and will remain open until
explicitly closed.

Automatic re-opening is also available. If a connection is not currently open and a command
requiring a connection is given, the last connection is implicitly reopened. In this case the directory
which was current when the connection was closed again becomes the current directory (unless, of
course, the command given changes it). Automatic reopening will also take place if the connection
was close by the remote server for whatever reason (e.g. a timeout). It is not available if the -1 option
to zfopen or zfanon was used.

Furthermore, if the command issued is a file transfer, the connection will be closed after the transfer
is finished, hence providing a one-shot mode for transfers. This does not apply to directory changing
or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen a connection but will leave it open. Also,
automatic closure will only ever happen in the same command as automatic opening, i.e a zfdir
directly followed by a zfget will never close the connection automatically.

Information about the previous connection is given by the zfstat function. So, for example, if that
reports:

Session: default
Not connected.
Last session: ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles

then the command zfget file.txt will attempt to reopen a connection to ftp.bar.com, retrieve the file
/pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately close the connection again. On the other hand, zfcd .. will
open the connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.

Note that all the above is local to each session; if you return to a previous session, the connection
for that session is the one which will be reopened.

25.4.4 Completion

Completion of local and remote files, directories, sessions and bookmarks is supported. The older,
compctl-style completion is defined when zfinit is called; support for the new widget-based

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 527 of 616
:
completion system is provided in the function Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp, which should be
installed with the other functions of the completion system and hence should automatically be
available.

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 528 of 616
:
Table of Contents generated with DocToc

26 User Contributions
26.1 Description
26.2 Utilities
26.2.1 Accessing On-Line Help
26.2.2 Recompiling Functions
26.2.3 Keyboard Definition
26.2.4 Dumping Shell State
26.2.5 Manipulating Hook Functions
26.3 Remembering Recent Directories
26.3.1 Installation
26.3.2 Use
26.3.3 Options
26.3.4 Configuration
26.3.5 Use with dynamic directory naming
26.3.6 Details of directory handling
26.4 Abbreviated dynamic references to directories
26.4.1 Usage
26.4.2 Configuration
26.4.3 Complete example
26.5 Gathering information from version control systems
26.5.1 Quickstart
26.5.2 Configuration
26.5.3 Oddities
26.5.4 Quilt Support
26.5.5 Function Descriptions (Public API)
26.5.6 Variable Description
26.5.7 Hooks in vcs_info
26.5.8 Examples
26.6 Prompt Themes
26.6.1 Installation
26.6.2 Theme Selection
26.6.3 Utility Themes
26.6.4 Writing Themes
26.7 ZLE Functions
26.7.1 Widgets
26.7.2 Utility Functions
26.7.3 Styles
26.8 Exception Handling
26.9 MIME Functions
26.10 Mathematical Functions
26.11 User Configuration Functions
26.12 Other Functions

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 529 of 616
:
26.12.1 Descriptions
26.12.2 Styles

26 User Contributions

26.1 Description
The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items contributed by the user community. These
are not inherently a part of the shell, and some may not be available in every zsh installation. The
most significant of these are documented here. For documentation on other contributed items such
as shell functions, look for comments in the function source files.

26.2 Utilities

26.2.1 Accessing On-Line Help

The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help widget (see Zsh Line
Editor). This invokes the run-help command with the command word from the current input line as
its argument. By default, run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often fails when the
command word is a shell builtin or a user-defined function. By redefining the run-help alias, one can
improve the on-line help provided by the shell.

The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution, is a Perl program that can be used
to process the zsh manual to produce a separate help file for each shell builtin and for many other
shell features as well. The autoloadable run-help function, found in Functions/Misc, searches for
these helpfiles and performs several other tests to produce the most complete help possible for the
command.

Help files are installed by default to a subdirectory of /usr/share/zsh or /usr/local/share/zsh.

To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a directory where the individual
command help files will reside. For example, you might choose ~/zsh_help. If you unpacked the zsh
distribution in your home directory, you would use the commands:

mkdir ~/zsh_help
perl ~/zsh-5.9/Util/helpfiles ~/zsh_help

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 530 of 616
:
The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help files. When unset, it uses the
default installation path. To use your own set of help files, set this to the appropriate path in one of
your startup files:

HELPDIR=~/zsh_help

To use the run-help function, you need to add lines something like the following to your .zshrc or
equivalent startup file:

unalias run-help
autoload run-help

Note that in order for ‘autoload run-help’ to work, the run-help file must be in one of the directories
named in your fpath array (see Parameters Used By The Shell). This should already be the case if
you have a standard zsh installation; if it is not, copy Functions/Misc/run-help to an appropriate
directory.

26.2.2 Recompiling Functions

If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update your zsh installation to track the
latest developments, you may find that function digests compiled with the zcompile builtin are
frequently out of date with respect to the function source files. This is not usually a problem,
because zsh always looks for the newest file when loading a function, but it may cause slower shell
startup and function loading. Also, if a digest file is explicitly used as an element of fpath, zsh won’t
check whether any of its source files has changed.

The zrecompile autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be used to keep function
digests up to date.

zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]

zrecompile [ -qt ] -p arg ... [ -- arg ... ]

This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them if at least one of the original files is
newer than the compiled file. This works only if the names stored in the compiled files are full paths
or are relative to the directory that contains the .zwc file.

In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a directory containing *.zwc files that
should be checked. If no arguments are given, the directories and *.zwc files in fpath are used.

When -t is given, no compilation is performed, but a return status of zero (true) is set if there are
files that need to be re-compiled and non-zero (false) otherwise. The -q option quiets the chatty
output that describes what zrecompile is doing.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 531 of 616
:
Without the -t option, the return status is zero if all files that needed re-compilation could be
compiled and non-zero if compilation for at least one of the files failed.

If the -p option is given, the arg s are interpreted as one or more sets of arguments for zcompile,
separated by ‘--’. For example:

zrecompile -p \
-R ~/.zshrc -- \
-M ~/.zcompdump -- \
~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*

This compiles ~/.zshrc into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that doesn’t exist or if it is older than ~/.zshrc. The
compiled file will be marked for reading instead of mapping. The same is done for ~/.zcompdump
and ~/.zcompdump.zwc, but this compiled file is marked for mapping. The last line re-creates the file
~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of the files matching the given pattern is newer than it.

Without the -p option, zrecompile does not create function digests that do not already exist, nor
does it add new functions to the digest.

The following shell loop is an example of a method for creating function digests for all functions in
your fpath, assuming that you have write permission to the directories:

for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do


dir=$fpath[i]
zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
continue
fi
files=($dir/*(N-.))
if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
if ( cd $dir:h &&
zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
fi
fi
done

The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default zsh installation fpath; you may
need to use different options for your personal function directories.

Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer to them, you can keep them up
to date by running zrecompile with no arguments.

26.2.3 Keyboard Definition

The large number of possible combinations of keyboards, workstations, terminals, emulators, and

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 532 of 616
:
window systems makes it impossible for zsh to have built-in key bindings for every situation. The
zkbd utility, found in Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create key bindings for your configuration.

Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:

zsh -f ~/zsh-5.9/Functions/Misc/zkbd

When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your terminal type; if the default it offers is correct, just
press return. It then asks you to press a number of different keys to determine characteristics of
your keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it finds anything out of the ordinary, such as a Delete
key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.

The keystrokes read by zkbd are recorded as a definition for an associative array named key, written
to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR directory. The name of the
file is composed from the TERM, VENDOR and OSTYPE parameters, joined by hyphens.

You may read this file into your .zshrc or another startup file with the ‘source’ or ‘.’ commands, then
reference the key parameter in bindkey commands, like this:

source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
[[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
[[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
# etc.

Note that in order for ‘autoload zkbd’ to work, the zkdb file must be in one of the directories named
in your fpath array (see Parameters Used By The Shell). This should already be the case if you have a
standard zsh installation; if it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appropriate directory.

26.2.4 Dumping Shell State

Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in the shell, particularly if you are using a
beta version of zsh or a development release. Usually it is sufficient to send a description of the
problem to one of the zsh mailing lists (see Mailing Lists), but sometimes one of the zsh developers
will need to recreate your environment in order to track the problem down.

The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the distribution, is provided for this
purpose. (It is also possible to autoload reporter, but reporter is not installed in fpath by default.)
This script outputs a detailed dump of the shell state, in the form of another script that can be read
with ‘zsh -f’ to recreate that state.

To use reporter, read the script into your shell with the ‘.’ command and redirect the output into a
file:

. ~/zsh-5.9/Util/reporter > zsh.report

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 533 of 616
:
You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such as passwords and delete
them by hand before sending the script to the developers. Also, as the output can be voluminous,
it’s best to wait for the developers to ask for this information before sending it.

You can also use reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state. This is sometimes useful for
creating startup files for the first time. Most of the output from reporter is far more detailed than
usually is necessary for a startup file, but the aliases, options, and zstyles states may be useful
because they include only changes from the defaults. The bindings state may be useful if you have
created any of your own keymaps, because reporter arranges to dump the keymap creation
commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.

As is usual with automated tools, if you create a startup file with reporter, you should edit the results
to remove unnecessary commands. Note that if you’re using the new completion system, you should
not dump the functions state to your startup files with reporter; use the compdump function instead
(see Completion System).

reporter [ state ... ]

Print to standard output the indicated subset of the current shell state. The state arguments may
be one or more of:

all
Output everything listed below.

aliases
Output alias definitions.

bindings
Output ZLE key maps and bindings.

completion
Output old-style compctl commands. New completion is covered by functions and zstyles.

functions
Output autoloads and function definitions.

limits
Output limit commands.

options
Output setopt commands.

styles
Same as zstyles.

variables
Output shell parameter assignments, plus export commands for any environment variables.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 534 of 616
:
zstyles
Output zstyle commands.

If the state is omitted, all is assumed.

With the exception of ‘all’, every state can be abbreviated by any prefix, even a single letter; thus a
is the same as aliases, z is the same as zstyles, etc.

26.2.5 Manipulating Hook Functions

add-zsh-hook [ -L | -dD ] [ -Uzk ] hook function

Several functions are special to the shell, as described in the section Special Functions, Functions, in
that they are automatically called at specific points during shell execution. Each has an associated
array consisting of names of functions to be called at the same point; these are so-called ‘hook
functions’. The shell function add-zsh-hook provides a simple way of adding or removing functions
from the array.

hook is one of chpwd, periodic, precmd, preexec, zshaddhistory, zshexit, or zsh_directory_name, the
special functions in question. Note that zsh_directory_name is called in a different way from the
other functions, but may still be manipulated as a hook.

function is name of an ordinary shell function. If no options are given this will be added to the
array of functions to be executed in the given context. Functions are invoked in the order they were
added.

If the option -L is given, the current values for the hook arrays are listed with typeset.

If the option -d is given, the function is removed from the array of functions to be executed.

If the option -D is given, the function is treated as a pattern and any matching names of functions
are removed from the array of functions to be executed.

The options -U, -z and -k are passed as arguments to autoload for function . For functions
contributed with zsh, the options -Uz are appropriate.

add-zle-hook-widget [ -L | -dD ] [ -Uzk ] hook widgetname

Several widget names are special to the line editor, as described in the section Special Widgets, Zle
Widgets, in that they are automatically called at specific points during editing. Unlike function hooks,
these do not use a predefined array of other names to call at the same point; the shell function add-
zle-hook-widget maintains a similar array and arranges for the special widget to invoke those
additional widgets.

hook is one of isearch-exit, isearch-update, line-pre-redraw, line-init, line-finish, history-line-set, or

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 535 of 616
:
keymap-select, corresponding to each of the special widgets zle-isearch-exit, etc. The special widget
names are also accepted as the hook argument.

widgetname is the name of a ZLE widget. If no options are given this is added to the array of widgets
to be invoked in the given hook context. Widgets are invoked in the order they were added, with

zle widgetname -Nw -f "nolast" -- "$@"

Note that this means that the ‘WIDGET’ special parameter tracks the widgetname when the widget
function is called, rather than tracking the name of the corresponding special hook widget.

If the option -d is given, the widgetname is removed from the array of widgets to be executed.

If the option -D is given, the widgetname is treated as a pattern and any matching names of widgets
are removed from the array.

If widgetname does not name an existing widget when added to the array, it is assumed that a shell
function also named widgetname is meant to provide the implementation of the widget. This name
is therefore marked for autoloading, and the options -U, -z and -k are passed as arguments to
autoload as with add-zsh-hook. The widget is also created with ‘zle -N widgetname ’ to cause the
corresponding function to be loaded the first time the hook is called.

The arrays of widgetname are currently maintained in zstyle contexts, one for each hook context,
with a style of ‘widgets’. If the -L option is given, this set of styles is listed with ‘zstyle -L’. This
implementation may change, and the special widgets that refer to the styles are created only if add-
zle-hook-widget is called to add at least one widget, so if this function is used for any hooks, then all
hooks should be managed only via this function.

26.3 Remembering Recent Directories


The function cdr allows you to change the working directory to a previous working directory from a
list maintained automatically. It is similar in concept to the directory stack controlled by the pushd,
popd and dirs builtins, but is more configurable, and as it stores all entries in files it is maintained
across sessions and (by default) between terminal emulators in the current session. Duplicates are
automatically removed, so that the list reflects the single most recent use of each directory.

Note that the pushd directory stack is not actually modified or used by cdr unless you configure it to
do so as described in the configuration section below.

26.3.1 Installation

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 536 of 616
:
The system works by means of a hook function that is called every time the directory changes. To
install the system, autoload the required functions and use the add-zsh-hook function described
above:

autoload -Uz chpwd_recent_dirs cdr add-zsh-hook


add-zsh-hook chpwd chpwd_recent_dirs

Now every time you change directly interactively, no matter which command you use, the directory
to which you change will be remembered in most-recent-first order.

26.3.2 Use

All direct user interaction is via the cdr function.

The argument to cdr is a number N corresponding to the N th most recently changed-to directory. 1
is the immediately preceding directory; the current directory is remembered but is not offered as a
destination. Note that if you have multiple windows open 1 may refer to a directory changed to in
another window; you can avoid this by having per-terminal files for storing directory as described for
the recent-dirs-file style below.

If you set the recent-dirs-default style described below cdr will behave the same as cd if given a non-
numeric argument, or more than one argument. The recent directory list is updated just the same
however you change directory.

If the argument is omitted, 1 is assumed. This is similar to pushd’s behaviour of swapping the two
most recent directories on the stack.

Completion for the argument to cdr is available if compinit has been run; menu selection is
recommended, using:

zstyle ':completion:*:*:cdr:*:*' menu selection

to allow you to cycle through recent directories; the order is preserved, so the first choice is the
most recent directory before the current one. The verbose style is also recommended to ensure the
directory is shown; this style is on by default so no action is required unless you have changed it.

26.3.3 Options

The behaviour of cdr may be modified by the following options.

-l
lists the numbers and the corresponding directories in abbreviated form (i.e. with ~ substitution

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 537 of 616
:
reapplied), one per line. The directories here are not quoted (this would only be an issue if a
directory name contained a newline). This is used by the completion system.

-r
sets the variable reply to the current set of directories. Nothing is printed and the directory is not
changed.

-e
allows you to edit the list of directories, one per line. The list can be edited to any extent you like; no
sanity checking is performed. Completion is available. No quoting is necessary (except for newlines,
where I have in any case no sympathy); directories are in unabbreviated form and contain an
absolute path, i.e. they start with /. Usually the first entry should be left as the current directory.

-p ’ pattern ’
Prunes any items in the directory list that match the given extended glob pattern; the pattern needs
to be quoted from immediate expansion on the command line. The pattern is matched against each
completely expanded file name in the list; the full string must match, so wildcards at the end (e.g.
’*removeme*’) are needed to remove entries with a given substring.

If output is to a terminal, then the function will print the new list after pruning and prompt for
confirmation by the user. This output and confirmation step can be skipped by using -P instead of -
p.

26.3.4 Configuration

Configuration is by means of the styles mechanism that should be familiar from completion; if not,
see the description of the zstyle command in The zsh/zutil Module. The context for setting styles
should be ’:chpwd:*’ in case the meaning of the context is extended in future, for example:

zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-max 0

sets the value of the recent-dirs-max style to 0. In practice the style name is specific enough that a
context of ’*’ should be fine.

An exception is recent-dirs-insert, which is used exclusively by the completion system and so has the
usual completion system context (’:completion:*’ if nothing more specific is needed), though again ’*’
should be fine in practice.

recent-dirs-default
If true, and the command is expecting a recent directory index, and either there is more than one
argument or the argument is not an integer, then fall through to "cd". This allows the lazy to use only
one command for directory changing. Completion recognises this, too; see recent-dirs-insert for how
to control completion when this option is in use.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 538 of 616
:
recent-dirs-file
The file where the list of directories is saved. The default is ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.chpwd-recent-dirs,
i.e. this is in your home directory unless you have set the variable ZDOTDIR to point somewhere
else. Directory names are saved in $’ ... ’ quoted form, so each line in the file can be supplied
directly to the shell as an argument.

The value of this style may be an array. In this case, the first file in the list will always be used for
saving directories while any other files are left untouched. When reading the recent directory list, if
there are fewer than the maximum number of entries in the first file, the contents of later files in the
array will be appended with duplicates removed from the list shown. The contents of the two files
are not sorted together, i.e. all the entries in the first file are shown first. The special value + can
appear in the list to indicate the default file should be read at that point. This allows effects like the
following:

zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file \


~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-${TTY##*/} +

Recent directories are read from a file numbered according to the terminal. If there are insufficient
entries the list is supplemented from the default file.

It is possible to use zstyle -e to make the directory configurable at run time:

zstyle -e ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file pick-recent-dirs-file


pick-recent-dirs-file() {
if [[ $PWD = ~/text/writing(|/*) ]]; then
reply=(~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-writing)
else
reply=(+)
fi
}

In this example, if the current directory is ~/text/writing or a directory under it, then use a special file
for saving recent directories, else use the default.

recent-dirs-insert
Used by completion. If recent-dirs-default is true, then setting this to true causes the actual
directory, rather than its index, to be inserted on the command line; this has the same effect as
using the corresponding index, but makes the history clearer and the line easier to edit. With this
setting, if part of an argument was already typed, normal directory completion rather than recent
directory completion is done; this is because recent directory completion is expected to be done by
cycling through entries menu fashion.

If the value of the style is always, then only recent directories will be completed; in that case, use the
cd command when you want to complete other directories.

If the value is fallback, recent directories will be tried first, then normal directory completion is
performed if recent directory completion failed to find a match.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 539 of 616
:
Finally, if the value is both then both sets of completions are presented; the usual tag mechanism
can be used to distinguish results, with recent directories tagged as recent-dirs. Note that the recent
directories inserted are abbreviated with directory names where appropriate.

recent-dirs-max
The maximum number of directories to save to the file. If this is zero or negative there is no
maximum. The default is 20. Note this includes the current directory, which isn’t offered, so the
highest number of directories you will be offered is one less than the maximum.

recent-dirs-prune
This style is an array determining what directories should (or should not) be added to the recent list.
Elements of the array can include:

parent
Prune parents (more accurately, ancestors) from the recent list. If present, changing directly down
by any number of directories causes the current directory to be overwritten. For example, changing
from ~pws to ~pws/some/other/dir causes ~pws not to be left on the recent directory stack. This
only applies to direct changes to descendant directories; earlier directories on the list are not
pruned. For example, changing from ~pws/yet/another to ~pws/some/other/dir does not cause
~pws to be pruned.

pattern: pattern
Gives a zsh pattern for directories that should not be added to the recent list (if not already there).
This element can be repeated to add different patterns. For example, ’pattern:/tmp(|/*)’ stops /tmp
or its descendants from being added. The EXTENDED_GLOB option is always turned on for these
patterns.

recent-dirs-pushd
If set to true, cdr will use pushd instead of cd to change the directory, so the directory is saved on
the directory stack. As the directory stack is completely separate from the list of files saved by the
mechanism used in this file there is no obvious reason to do this.

26.3.5 Use with dynamic directory naming

It is possible to refer to recent directories using the dynamic directory name syntax by using the
supplied function zsh_directory_name_cdr a hook:

autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook


add-zsh-hook -Uz zsh_directory_name zsh_directory_name_cdr

When this is done, ~[1] will refer to the most recent directory other than $PWD, and so on.
Completion after ~[ ... also works.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 540 of 616
:
26.3.6 Details of directory handling

This section is for the curious or confused; most users will not need to know this information.

Recent directories are saved to a file immediately and hence are preserved across sessions. Note
currently no file locking is applied: the list is updated immediately on interactive commands and
nowhere else (unlike history), and it is assumed you are only going to change directory in one
window at once. This is not safe on shared accounts, but in any case the system has limited utility
when someone else is changing to a different set of directories behind your back.

To make this a little safer, only directory changes instituted from the command line, either directly
or indirectly through shell function calls (but not through subshells, evals, traps, completion
functions and the like) are saved. Shell functions should use cd -q or pushd -q to avoid side effects if
the change to the directory is to be invisible at the command line. See the contents of the function
chpwd_recent_dirs for more details.

26.4 Abbreviated dynamic references to directories


The dynamic directory naming system is described in the subsection Dynamic named directories of
Filename Expansion. In this, a reference to ~[ ... ] is expanded by a function found by the hooks
mechanism.

The contributed function zsh_directory_name_generic provides a system allowing the user to refer
to directories with only a limited amount of new code. It supports all three of the standard interfaces
for directory naming: converting from a name to a directory, converting in the reverse direction to
find a short name, and completion of names.

The main feature of this function is a path-like syntax, combining abbreviations at multiple levels
separated by ":". As an example, ~[g:p:s] might specify:

g
The top level directory for your git area. This first component has to match, or the function will
return indicating another directory name hook function should be tried.

p
The name of a project within your git area.

s
The source area within that project.

This allows you to collapse references to long hierarchies to a very compact form, particularly if the
hierarchies are similar across different areas of the disk.

Name components may be completed: if a description is shown at the top of the list of completions,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 541 of 616
:
it includes the path to which previous components expand, while the description for an individual
completion shows the path segment it would add. No additional configuration is needed for this as
the completion system is aware of the dynamic directory name mechanism.

26.4.1 Usage

To use the function, first define a wrapper function for your specific case. We’ll assume it’s to be
autoloaded. This can have any name but we’ll refer to it as zdn_mywrapper. This wrapper function
will define various variables and then call this function with the same arguments that the wrapper
function gets. This configuration is described below.

Then arrange for the wrapper to be run as a zsh_directory_name hook:

autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook zsh_directory_name_generic zdn_mywrapper


add-zsh-hook -U zsh_directory_name zdn_mywrapper

26.4.2 Configuration

The wrapper function should define a local associative array zdn_top. Alternatively, this can be set
with a style called mapping. The context for the style is :zdn: wrapper-name where wrapper-name is
the function calling zsh_directory_name_generic; for example:

zstyle :zdn:zdn_mywrapper: mapping zdn_mywrapper_top

The keys in this associative array correspond to the first component of the name. The values are
matching directories. They may have an optional suffix with a slash followed by a colon and the
name of a variable in the same format to give the next component. (The slash before the colon is to
disambiguate the case where a colon is needed in the path for a drive. There is otherwise no syntax
for escaping this, so path components whose names start with a colon are not supported.) A special
component :default: specifies a variable in the form /: var (the path section is ignored and so is
usually empty) that will be used for the next component if no variable is given for the path. Variables
referred to within zdn_top have the same format as zdn_top itself, but contain relative paths.

For example,

local -A zdn_top=(
g ~/git
ga ~/alternate/git
gs /scratch/$USER/git/:second2
:default: /:second1
)

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 542 of 616
:
This specifies the behaviour of a directory referred to as ~[g:...] or ~[ga:...] or ~[gs:...]. Later path
components are optional; in that case ~[g] expands to ~/git, and so on. gs expands to
/scratch/$USER/git and uses the associative array second2 to match the second component; g and
ga use the associative array second1 to match the second component.

When expanding a name to a directory, if the first component is not g or ga or gs, it is not an error;
the function simply returns 1 so that a later hook function can be tried. However, matching the first
component commits the function, so if a later component does not match, an error is printed
(though this still does not stop later hooks from being executed).

For components after the first, a relative path is expected, but note that multiple levels may still
appear. Here is an example of second1:

local -A second1=(
p myproject
s somproject
os otherproject/subproject/:third
)

The path as found from zdn_top is extended with the matching directory, so ~[g:p] becomes
~/git/myproject. The slash between is added automatically (it’s not possible to have a later
component modify the name of a directory already matched). Only os specifies a variable for a third
component, and there’s no :default:, so it’s an error to use a name like ~[g:p:x] or ~[ga:s:y] because
there’s nowhere to look up the x or y.

The associative arrays need to be visible within this function; the generic function therefore uses
internal variable names beginning _zdn_ in order to avoid clashes. Note that the variable reply needs
to be passed back to the shell, so should not be local in the calling function.

The function does not test whether directories assembled by component actually exist; this allows
the system to work across automounted file systems. The error from the command trying to use a
non-existent directory should be sufficient to indicate the problem.

26.4.3 Complete example

Here is a full fictitious but usable autoloadable definition of the example function defined by the
code above. So ~[gs:p:s] expands to /scratch/$USER/git/myscratchproject/top/srcdir (with $USER
also expanded).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 543 of 616
:
local -A zdn_top=(
g ~/git
ga ~/alternate/git
gs /scratch/$USER/git/:second2
:default: /:second1
)

local -A second1=(
p myproject
s somproject
os otherproject/subproject/:third
)

local -A second2=(
p myscratchproject
s somescratchproject
)

local -A third=(
s top/srcdir
d top/documentation
)

# autoload not needed if you did this at initialisation...


autoload -Uz zsh_directory_name_generic
zsh_directory_name_generic "$@

It is also possible to use global associative arrays, suitably named, and set the style for the context of
your wrapper function to refer to this. Then your set up code would contain the following:

typeset -A zdn_mywrapper_top=(...)
# ... and so on for other associative arrays ...
zstyle ':zdn:zdn_mywrapper:' mapping zdn_mywrapper_top
autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook zsh_directory_name_generic zdn_mywrapper
add-zsh-hook -U zsh_directory_name zdn_mywrapper

and the function zdn_mywrapper would contain only the following:

zsh_directory_name_generic "$@"

26.5 Gathering information from version control systems


In a lot of cases, it is nice to automatically retrieve information from version control systems (VCSs),
such as subversion, CVS or git, to be able to provide it to the user; possibly in the user’s prompt. So
that you can instantly tell which branch you are currently on, for example.

In order to do that, you may use the vcs_info function.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 544 of 616
:
The following VCSs are supported, showing the abbreviated name by which they are referred to
within the system:

Bazaar (bzr)
https://bazaar.canonical.com/

Codeville (cdv)
http://freecode.com/projects/codeville/

Concurrent Versioning System (cvs)


https://www.nongnu.org/cvs/

Darcs (darcs)
http://darcs.net/

Fossil (fossil)
https://fossil-scm.org/

Git (git)
https://git-scm.com/

GNU arch (tla)


https://www.gnu.org/software/gnu-arch/

Mercurial (hg)
https://www.mercurial-scm.org/

Monotone (mtn)
https://monotone.ca/

Perforce (p4)
https://www.perforce.com/

Subversion (svn)
https://subversion.apache.org/

SVK (svk)
https://svk.bestpractical.com/

There is also support for the patch management system quilt


(https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt). See Quilt Support below for details.

To load vcs_info:

autoload -Uz vcs_info

It can be used in any existing prompt, because it does not require any specific $psvar entries to be
available.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 545 of 616
:
26.5.1 Quickstart

To get this feature working quickly (including colors), you can do the following (assuming, you loaded
vcs_info properly - see above):

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' actionformats \


'%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{3}|%F{1}%a%F{5}]%f '
zstyle ':vcs_info:*' formats \
'%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{5}]%f '
zstyle ':vcs_info:(sv[nk]|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%F{1}:%F{3}%r'
precmd () { vcs_info }
PS1='%F{5}[%F{2}%n%F{5}] %F{3}%3~ ${vcs_info_msg_0_}%f%# '

Obviously, the last two lines are there for demonstration. You need to call vcs_info from your
precmd function. Once that is done you need a single quoted ’${vcs_info_msg_0_}’ in your prompt.

To be able to use ’${vcs_info_msg_0_}’ directly in your prompt like this, you will need to have the
PROMPT_SUBST option enabled.

Now call the vcs_info_printsys utility from the command line:

% vcs_info_printsys
## list of supported version control backends:
## disabled systems are prefixed by a hash sign (#)
bzr
cdv
cvs
darcs
fossil
git
hg
mtn
p4
svk
svn
tla
## flavours (cannot be used in the enable or disable styles; they
## are enabled and disabled with their master [git-svn -> git])
## they *can* be used in contexts: ':vcs_info:git-svn:*'.
git-p4
git-svn
hg-git
hg-hgsubversion
hg-hgsvn

You may not want all of these because there is no point in running the code to detect systems you
do not use. So there is a way to disable some backends altogether:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 546 of 616
:
zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr cdv darcs mtn svk tla

You may also pick a few from that list and enable only those:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable git cvs svn

If you rerun vcs_info_printsys after one of these commands, you will see the backends listed in the
disable style (or backends not in the enable style - if you used that) marked as disabled by a hash
sign. That means the detection of these systems is skipped completely. No wasted time there.

26.5.2 Configuration

The vcs_info feature can be configured via zstyle.

First, the context in which we are working:

:vcs_info:vcs-string:user-context:repo-root-name

vcs-string
is one of: git, git-svn, git-p4, hg, hg-git, hg-hgsubversion, hg-hgsvn, darcs, bzr, cdv, mtn, svn, cvs, svk,
tla, p4 or fossil. This is followed by ‘.quilt- quilt-mode ’ in Quilt mode (see Quilt Support for details)
and by ‘+ hook-name ’ while hooks are active (see Hooks in vcs_info for details).

Currently, hooks in quilt mode don’t add the ‘.quilt- quilt-mode ’ information. This may change in the
future.

user-context
is a freely configurable string, assignable by the user as the first argument to vcs_info (see its
description below).

repo-root-name
is the name of a repository in which you want a style to match. So, if you want a setting specific to
/usr/src/zsh, with that being a CVS checkout, you can set repo-root-name to zsh to make it so.

There are three special values for vcs-string : The first is named -init-, that is in effect as long as
there was no decision what VCS backend to use. The second is -preinit-; it is used before vcs_info is
run, when initializing the data exporting variables. The third special value is formats and is used by
the vcs_info_lastmsg for looking up its styles.

The initial value of repo-root-name is -all- and it is replaced with the actual name, as soon as it is
known. Only use this part of the context for defining the formats, actionformats or branchformat
styles, as it is guaranteed that repo-root-name is set up correctly for these only. For all other styles,
just use ’*’ instead.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 547 of 616
:
There are two pre-defined values for user-context :

default
the one used if none is specified

command
used by vcs_info_lastmsg to lookup its styles

You can of course use ’:vcs_info:*’ to match all VCSs in all user-contexts at once.

This is a description of all styles that are looked up.

formats

A list of formats, used when actionformats is not used (which is most of the time).

actionformats

A list of formats, used if there is a special action going on in your current repository; like an
interactive rebase or a merge conflict.

branchformat

Some backends replace %b in the formats and actionformats styles above, not only by a branch
name but also by a revision number. This style lets you modify how that string should look.

nvcsformats

These "formats" are set when we didn’t detect a version control system for the current directory or
vcs_info was disabled. This is useful if you want vcs_info to completely take over the generation of
your prompt. You would do something like PS1=’${vcs_info_msg_0_}’ to accomplish that.

hgrevformat

hg uses both a hash and a revision number to reference a specific changeset in a repository. With
this style you can format the revision string (see branchformat) to include either or both. It’s only
useful when get-revision is true. Note, the full 40-character revision id is not available (except when
using the use-simple option) because executing hg more than once per prompt is too slow; you may
customize this behavior using hooks.

max-exports

Defines the maximum number of vcs_info_msg_*_ variables vcs_info will set.

enable

A list of backends you want to use. Checked in the -init- context. If this list contains an item called
NONE no backend is used at all and vcs_info will do nothing. If this list contains ALL, vcs_info will use
all known backends. Only with ALL in enable will the disable style have any effect. ALL and NONE are

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 548 of 616
:
case insensitive.

disable

A list of VCSs you don’t want vcs_info to test for repositories (checked in the -init- context, too). Only
used if enable contains ALL.

disable-patterns

A list of patterns that are checked against $PWD. If a pattern matches, vcs_info will be disabled. This
style is checked in the :vcs_info:-init-:*:-all- context.

Say, ~/.zsh is a directory under version control, in which you do not want vcs_info to be active, do:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable-patterns "${(b)HOME}/.zsh(|/*)"

use-quilt

If enabled, the quilt support code is active in ‘addon’ mode. See Quilt Support for details.

quilt-standalone

If enabled, ‘standalone’ mode detection is attempted if no VCS is active in a given directory. See Quilt
Support for details.

quilt-patch-dir

Overwrite the value of the $QUILT_PATCHES environment variable. See Quilt Support for details.

quiltcommand

When quilt itself is called in quilt support, the value of this style is used as the command name.

check-for-changes

If enabled, this style causes the %c and %u format escapes to show when the working directory has
uncommitted changes. The strings displayed by these escapes can be controlled via the stagedstr
and unstagedstr styles. The only backends that currently support this option are git, hg, and bzr (the
latter two only support unstaged).

For this style to be evaluated with the hg backend, the get-revision style needs to be set and the use-
simple style needs to be unset. The latter is the default; the former is not.

With the bzr backend, lightweight checkouts only honor this style if the use-server style is set.

Note, the actions taken if this style is enabled are potentially expensive (read: they may be slow,
depending on how big the current repository is). Therefore, it is disabled by default.

check-for-staged-changes

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 549 of 616
:
This style is like check-for-changes, but it never checks the worktree files, only the metadata in the
.${vcs} dir. Therefore, this style initializes only the %c escape (with stagedstr) but not the %u escape.
This style is faster than check-for-changes.

In the git backend, this style checks for changes in the index. Other backends do not currently
implement this style.

This style is disabled by default.

stagedstr

This string will be used in the %c escape if there are staged changes in the repository.

unstagedstr

This string will be used in the %u escape if there are unstaged changes in the repository.

command

This style causes vcs_info to use the supplied string as the command to use as the VCS’s binary.
Note, that setting this in ’:vcs_info:*’ is not a good idea.

If the value of this style is empty (which is the default), the used binary name is the name of the
backend in use (e.g. svn is used in an svn repository).

The repo-root-name part in the context is always the default -all- when this style is looked up.

For example, this style can be used to use binaries from non-default installation directories. Assume,
git is installed in /usr/bin but your sysadmin installed a newer version in /usr/local/bin. Instead of
changing the order of your $PATH parameter, you can do this:

zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*:-all-' command /usr/local/bin/git

use-server

This is used by the Perforce backend (p4) to decide if it should contact the Perforce server to find out
if a directory is managed by Perforce. This is the only reliable way of doing this, but runs the risk of a
delay if the server name cannot be found. If the server (more specifically, the host : port pair
describing the server) cannot be contacted, its name is put into the associative array
vcs_info_p4_dead_servers and is not contacted again during the session until it is removed by hand.
If you do not set this style, the p4 backend is only usable if you have set the environment variable
P4CONFIG to a file name and have corresponding files in the root directories of each Perforce client.
See comments in the function VCS_INFO_detect_p4 for more detail.

The Bazaar backend (bzr) uses this to permit contacting the server about lightweight checkouts, see
the check-for-changes style.

use-simple

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 550 of 616
:
If there are two different ways of gathering information, you can select the simpler one by setting
this style to true; the default is to use the not-that-simple code, which is potentially a lot slower but
might be more accurate in all possible cases. This style is used by the bzr, hg, and git backends. In
the case of hg it will invoke the external hexdump program to parse the binary dirstate cache file;
this method will not return the local revision number.

get-revision

If set to true, vcs_info goes the extra mile to figure out the revision of a repository’s work tree
(currently for the git and hg backends, where this kind of information is not always vital). For git, the
hash value of the currently checked out commit is available via the %i expansion. With hg, the local
revision number and the corresponding global hash are available via %i.

get-mq

If set to true, the hg backend will look for a Mercurial Queue (mq) patch directory. Information will
be available via the ‘%m’ replacement.

get-bookmarks

If set to true, the hg backend will try to get a list of current bookmarks. They will be available via the
‘%m’ replacement.

The default is to generate a comma-separated list of all bookmark names that refer to the currently
checked out revision. If a bookmark is active, its name is suffixed an asterisk and placed first in the
list.

use-prompt-escapes

Determines if we assume that the assembled string from vcs_info includes prompt escapes. (Used
by vcs_info_lastmsg.)

debug

Enable debugging output to track possible problems. Currently this style is only used by vcs_info’s
hooks system.

hooks

A list style that defines hook-function names. See Hooks in vcs_info below for details.

patch-format

nopatch-format

This pair of styles format the patch information used by the %m expando in formats and
actionformats for the git and hg backends. The value is subject to certain %-expansions described
below. The expanded value is made available in the global backend_misc array as
${backend_misc[patches]} (also if a set-patch-format hook is used).

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 551 of 616
:
get-unapplied

This boolean style controls whether a backend should attempt to gather a list of unapplied patches
(for example with Mercurial Queue patches).

Used by the quilt, hg, and git backends.

The default values for these styles in all contexts are:

formats
" (%s)-[%b]%u%c-"

actionformats
" (%s)-[%b|%a]%u%c-"

branchformat
"%b:%r" (for bzr, svn, svk and hg)

nvcsformats
""

hgrevformat
"%r:%h"

max-exports
2

enable
ALL

disable
(empty list)

disable-patterns
(empty list)

check-for-changes
false

check-for-staged-changes
false

stagedstr
(string: "S")

unstagedstr
(string: "U")

command

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 552 of 616
:
(empty string)

use-server
false

use-simple
false

get-revision
false

get-mq
true

get-bookmarks
false

use-prompt-escapes
true

debug
false

hooks
(empty list)

use-quilt
false

quilt-standalone
false

quilt-patch-dir
empty - use $QUILT_PATCHES

quiltcommand
quilt

patch-format
backend dependent

nopatch-format
backend dependent

get-unapplied
false

In normal formats and actionformats the following replacements are done:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 553 of 616
:
%s
The VCS in use (git, hg, svn, etc.).

%b
Information about the current branch.

%a
An identifier that describes the action. Only makes sense in actionformats.

%i
The current revision number or identifier. For hg the hgrevformat style may be used to customize
the output.

%c
The string from the stagedstr style if there are staged changes in the repository.

%u
The string from the unstagedstr style if there are unstaged changes in the repository.

%R
The base directory of the repository.

%r
The repository name. If %R is /foo/bar/repoXY, %r is repoXY.

%S
A subdirectory within a repository. If $PWD is /foo/bar/repoXY/beer/tasty, %S is beer/tasty.

%m
A "misc" replacement. It is at the discretion of the backend to decide what this replacement expands
to.

The hg and git backends use this expando to display patch information. hg sources patch
information from the mq extensions; git from in-progress rebase and cherry-pick operations and
from the stgit extension. The patch-format and nopatch-format styles control the generated string.
The former is used when at least one patch from the patch queue has been applied, and the latter
otherwise.

The hg backend displays bookmark information in this expando (in addition to mq information). See
the get-mq and get-bookmarks styles. Both of these styles may be enabled at the same time. If both
are enabled, both resulting strings will be shown separated by a semicolon (that cannot currently be
customized).

The quilt ‘standalone’ backend sets this expando to the same value as the %Q expando.

%Q
Quilt series information. When quilt is used (either in ‘addon’ mode or as a ‘standalone’ backend),
this expando is set to the quilt series’ patch-format string. The set-patch-format hook and nopatch-

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 554 of 616
:
format style are honoured.

See Quilt Support below for details.

In branchformat these replacements are done:

%b
The branch name. For hg, the branch name can include a topic name.

%r
The current revision number or the hgrevformat style for hg.

In hgrevformat these replacements are done:

%r
The current local revision number.

%h
The current global revision identifier.

In patch-format and nopatch-format these replacements are done:

%p
The name of the top-most applied patch; may be overridden by the applied-string hook.

%u
The number of unapplied patches; may be overridden by the unapplied-string hook.

%n
The number of applied patches.

%c
The number of unapplied patches.

%a
The number of all patches (%a = %n + %c).

%g
The names of active mq guards (hg backend).

%G
The number of active mq guards (hg backend).

Not all VCS backends have to support all replacements. For nvcsformats no replacements are
performed at all, it is just a string.

26.5.3 Oddities
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 555 of 616
:
If you want to use the %b (bold off) prompt expansion in formats, which expands %b itself, use %%b.
That will cause the vcs_info expansion to replace %%b with %b, so that zsh’s prompt expansion
mechanism can handle it. Similarly, to hand down %b from branchformat, use %%%%b. Sorry for
this inconvenience, but it cannot be easily avoided. Luckily we do not clash with a lot of prompt
expansions and this only needs to be done for those.

When one of the gen-applied-string, gen-unapplied-string, and set-patch-format hooks is defined,


applying %-escaping (‘foo=${foo//’%’/%%}’) to the interpolated values for use in the prompt is the
responsibility of those hooks (jointly); when neither of those hooks is defined, vcs_info handles
escaping by itself. We regret this coupling, but it was required for backwards compatibility.

26.5.4 Quilt Support

Quilt is not a version control system, therefore this is not implemented as a backend. It can help
keeping track of a series of patches. People use it to keep a set of changes they want to use on top
of software packages (which is tightly integrated into the package build process - the Debian project
does this for a large number of packages). Quilt can also help individual developers keep track of
their own patches on top of real version control systems.

The vcs_info integration tries to support both ways of using quilt by having two slightly different
modes of operation: ‘addon’ mode and ‘standalone’ mode).

Quilt integration is off by default; to enable it, set the use-quilt style, and add %Q to your formats or
actionformats style:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' use-quilt true

Styles looked up from the Quilt support code include ‘.quilt- quilt-mode ’ in the vcs-string part of
the context, where quilt-mode is either addon or standalone. Example: :vcs_info:git.quilt-
addon:default: repo-root-name .

For ‘addon’ mode to become active vcs_info must have already detected a real version control
system controlling the directory. If that is the case, a directory that holds quilt’s patches needs to be
found. That directory is configurable via the ‘QUILT_PATCHES’ environment variable. If that variable
exists its value is used, otherwise the value ‘patches’ is assumed. The value from $QUILT_PATCHES
can be overwritten using the ‘quilt-patch-dir’ style. (Note: you can use vcs_info to keep the value of
$QUILT_PATCHES correct all the time via the post-quilt hook).

When the directory in question is found, quilt is assumed to be active. To gather more information,
vcs_info looks for a directory called ‘.pc’; Quilt uses that directory to track its current state. If this
directory does not exist we know that quilt has not done anything to the working directory (read: no
patches have been applied yet).

If patches are applied, vcs_info will try to find out which. If you want to know which patches of a
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 556 of 616
:
series are not yet applied, you need to activate the get-unapplied style in the appropriate context.

vcs_info allows for very detailed control over how the gathered information is presented (see
Configuration and Hooks in vcs_info), all of which are documented below. Note there are a number
of other patch tracking systems that work on top of a certain version control system (like stgit for git,
or mq for hg); the configuration for systems like that are generally configured the same way as the
quilt support.

If the quilt support is working in ‘addon’ mode, the produced string is available as a simple format
replacement (%Q to be precise), which can be used in formats and actionformats; see below for
details).

If, on the other hand, the support code is working in ‘standalone’ mode, vcs_info will pretend as if
quilt were an actual version control system. That means that the version control system identifier
(which otherwise would be something like ‘svn’ or ‘cvs’) will be set to ‘-quilt-’. This has implications on
the used style context where this identifier is the second element. vcs_info will have filled in a proper
value for the "repository’s" root directory and the string containing the information about quilt’s
state will be available as the ‘misc’ replacement (and %Q for compatibility with ‘addon’ mode).

What is left to discuss is how ‘standalone’ mode is detected. The detection itself is a series of
searches for directories. You can have this detection enabled all the time in every directory that is
not otherwise under version control. If you know there is only a limited set of trees where you would
like vcs_info to try and look for Quilt in ‘standalone’ mode to minimise the amount of searching on
every call to vcs_info, there are a number of ways to do that:

Essentially, ‘standalone’ mode detection is controlled by a style called ‘quilt-standalone’. It is a string


style and its value can have different effects. The simplest values are: ‘always’ to run detection every
time vcs_info is run, and ‘never’ to turn the detection off entirely.

If the value of quilt-standalone is something else, it is interpreted differently. If the value is the name
of a scalar variable the value of that variable is checked and that value is used in the same ‘always’/
‘never’ way as described above.

If the value of quilt-standalone is an array, the elements of that array are used as directory names
under which you want the detection to be active.

If quilt-standalone is an associative array, the keys are taken as directory names under which you
want the detection to be active, but only if the corresponding value is the string ‘true’.

Last, but not least, if the value of quilt-standalone is the name of a function, the function is called
without arguments and the return value decides whether detection should be active. A ‘0’ return
value is true; a non-zero return value is interpreted as false.

Note, if there is both a function and a variable by the name of quilt-standalone, the function will take
precedence.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 557 of 616
:
26.5.5 Function Descriptions (Public API)

vcs_info [ user-context ]

The main function, that runs all backends and assembles all data into ${vcs_info_msg_*_}. This is the
function you want to call from precmd if you want to include up-to-date information in your prompt
(see Variable Description below). If an argument is given, that string will be used instead of default in
the user-context field of the style context.

vcs_info_hookadd

Statically registers a number of functions to a given hook. The hook needs to be given as the first
argument; what follows is a list of hook-function names to register to the hook. The ‘+vi-’ prefix
needs to be left out here. See Hooks in vcs_info below for details.

vcs_info_hookdel

Remove hook-functions from a given hook. The hook needs to be given as the first non-option
argument; what follows is a list of hook-function names to un-register from the hook. If ‘-a’ is used as
the first argument, all occurrences of the functions are unregistered. Otherwise only the last
occurrence is removed (if a function was registered to a hook more than once). The ‘+vi-’ prefix
needs to be left out here. See Hooks in vcs_info below for details.

vcs_info_lastmsg

Outputs the current values of ${vcs_info_msg_*_}. Takes into account the value of the use-prompt-
escapes style in ’:vcs_info:formats:command:-all-’. It also only prints max-exports values.

vcs_info_printsys [ user-context ]

Prints a list of all supported version control systems. Useful to find out possible contexts (and which
of them are enabled) or values for the disable style.

vcs_info_setsys

Initializes vcs_info’s internal list of available backends. With this function, you can add support for
new VCSs without restarting the shell.

All functions named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

26.5.6 Variable Description

${vcs_info_msg_ N _} (Note the trailing underscore)


Where N is an integer, e.g., vcs_info_msg_0_. These variables are the storage for the informational
message the last vcs_info call has assembled. These are strongly connected to the formats,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 558 of 616
:
actionformats and nvcsformats styles described above. Those styles are lists. The first member of
that list gets expanded into ${vcs_info_msg_0_}, the second into ${vcs_info_msg_1_} and the Nth into
${vcs_info_msg_N-1_}. (See the max-exports style above.)

All variables named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

26.5.7 Hooks in vcs_info

Hooks are places in vcs_info where you can run your own code. That code can communicate with
the code that called it and through that, change the system’s behaviour.

For configuration, hooks change the style context:

:vcs_info:vcs-string+hook-name:user-context:repo-root-name

To register functions to a hook, you need to list them in the hooks style in the appropriate context.

Example:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*+foo:*' hooks bar baz

This registers functions to the hook ‘foo’ for all backends. In order to avoid namespace problems, all
registered function names are prepended by a ‘+vi-’, so the actual functions called for the ‘foo’ hook
are ‘+vi-bar’ and ‘+vi-baz’.

If you would like to register a function to a hook regardless of the current context, you may use the
vcs_info_hookadd function. To remove a function that was added like that, the vcs_info_hookdel
function can be used.

If something seems weird, you can enable the ‘debug’ boolean style in the proper context and the
hook-calling code will print what it tried to execute and whether the function in question existed.

When you register more than one function to a hook, all functions are executed one after another
until one function returns non-zero or until all functions have been called. Context-sensitive hook
functions are executed before statically registered ones (the ones added by vcs_info_hookadd).

You may pass data between functions via an associative array, user_data. For example:

+vi-git-myfirsthook(){
user_data[myval]=$myval
}
+vi-git-mysecondhook(){
# do something with ${user_data[myval]}
}

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 559 of 616
:
There are a number of variables that are special in hook contexts:

ret
The return value that the hooks system will return to the caller. The default is an integer ‘zero’. If and
how a changed ret value changes the execution of the caller depends on the specific hook. See the
hook documentation below for details.

hook_com
An associated array which is used for bidirectional communication from the caller to hook functions.
The used keys depend on the specific hook.

context
The active context of the hook. Functions that wish to change this variable should make it local
scope first.

vcs
The current VCS after it was detected. The same values as in the enable/disable style are used.
Available in all hooks except start-up.

Finally, the full list of currently available hooks:

start-up
Called after starting vcs_info but before the VCS in this directory is determined. It can be used to
deactivate vcs_info temporarily if necessary. When ret is set to 1, vcs_info aborts and does nothing;
when set to 2, vcs_info sets up everything as if no version control were active and exits.

pre-get-data
Same as start-up but after the VCS was detected.

gen-hg-bookmark-string
Called in the Mercurial backend when a bookmark string is generated; the get-revision and get-
bookmarks styles must be true.

This hook gets the names of the Mercurial bookmarks that vcs_info collected from ‘hg’.

If a bookmark is active, the key ${hook_com[hg-active-bookmark]} is set to its name. The key is
otherwise unset.

When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]} will be used in the %m
escape in formats and actionformats and will be available in the global backend_misc array as
${backend_misc[bookmarks]}.

gen-applied-string
Called in the git (with stgit or during rebase or merge), and hg (with mq) backends and in quilt
support when the applied-string is generated; the use-quilt zstyle must be true for quilt (the mq and
stgit backends are active by default).

The arguments to this hook describe applied patches in the opposite order, which means that the

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 560 of 616
:
first argument is the top-most patch and so forth.

When the patches’ log messages can be extracted, those are embedded within each argument after
a space, so each argument is of the form ‘ patch-name first line of the log message ’, where
patch-name contains no whitespace. The mq backend passes arguments of the form ‘ patch name ’,
with possible embedded spaces, but without extracting the patch’s log message.

When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[applied-string]} will be available as %p in the
patch-format and nopatch-format styles. This hook is, in concert with set-patch-format, responsible
for %-escaping that value for use in the prompt. (See Oddities.)

The quilt backend passes to this hook the inputs ${hook_com[quilt-patches-dir]} and, if it has been
determined, ${hook_com[quilt-pc-dir]}.

gen-unapplied-string
Called in the git (with stgit or during rebase), and hg (with mq) backend and in quilt support when
the unapplied-string is generated; the get-unapplied style must be true.

This hook gets the names of all unapplied patches which vcs_info in order, which means that the
first argument is the patch next-in-line to be applied and so forth.

The format of each argument is as for gen-applied-string, above.

When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[unapplied-string]} will be available as %u in


the patch-format and nopatch-format styles. This hook is, in concert with set-patch-format,
responsible for %-escaping that value for use in the prompt. (See Oddities.)

The quilt backend passes to this hook the inputs ${hook_com[quilt-patches-dir]} and, if it has been
determined, ${hook_com[quilt-pc-dir]}.

gen-mqguards-string
Called in the hg backend when guards-string is generated; the get-mq style must be true (default).

This hook gets the names of any active mq guards.

When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[guards-string]} will be used in the %g escape
in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

no-vcs
This hooks is called when no version control system was detected.

The ‘hook_com’ parameter is not used.

post-backend
Called as soon as the backend has finished collecting information.

The ‘hook_com’ keys available are as for the set-message hook.

post-quilt
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 561 of 616
:
Called after the quilt support is done. The following information is passed as arguments to the hook:
1. the quilt-support mode (‘addon’ or ‘standalone’); 2. the directory that contains the patch series; 3.
the directory that holds quilt’s status information (the ‘.pc’ directory) or the string "-nopc-" if that
directory wasn’t found.

The ‘hook_com’ parameter is not used.

set-branch-format
Called before ‘branchformat’ is set. The only argument to the hook is the format that is configured at
this point.

The ‘hook_com’ keys considered are ‘branch’ and ‘revision’. They are set to the values figured out so
far by vcs_info and any change will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.

If ret is set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[branch-replace]} will be used unchanged as the
‘%b’ replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.

set-hgrev-format
Called before a ‘hgrevformat’ is set. The only argument to the hook is the format that is configured
at this point.

The ‘hook_com’ keys considered are ‘hash’ and ‘localrev’. They are set to the values figured out so far
by vcs_info and any change will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.

If ret is set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[rev-replace]} will be used unchanged as the ‘%i’
replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.

pre-addon-quilt
This hook is used when vcs_info’s quilt functionality is active in "addon" mode (quilt used on top of a
real version control system). It is activated right before any quilt specific action is taken.

Setting the ‘ret’ variable in this hook to a non-zero value avoids any quilt specific actions from being
run at all.

set-patch-format
This hook is used to control some of the possible expansions in patch-format and nopatch-format
styles with patch queue systems such as quilt, mqueue and the like.

This hook is used in the git, hg and quilt backends.

The hook allows the control of the %p (${hook_com[applied]}) and %u (${hook_com[unapplied]})


expansion in all backends that use the hook. With the mercurial backend, the %g
(${hook_com[guards]}) expansion is controllable in addition to that.

If ret is set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[patch-replace]} will be used unchanged instead of
an expanded format from patch-format or nopatch-format.

This hook is, in concert with the gen-applied-string or gen-unapplied-string hooks if they are defined,

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 562 of 616
:
responsible for %-escaping the final patch-format value for use in the prompt. (See Oddities.)

The quilt backend passes to this hook the inputs ${hook_com[quilt-patches-dir]} and, if it has been
determined, ${hook_com[quilt-pc-dir]}.

set-message
Called each time before a ‘vcs_info_msg_ N _’ message is set. It takes two arguments; the first being
the ‘ N ’ in the message variable name, the second is the currently configured formats or
actionformats.

There are a number of ‘hook_com’ keys, that are used here: ‘action’, ‘branch’, ‘base’, ‘base-name’,
‘subdir’, ‘staged’, ‘unstaged’, ‘revision’, ‘misc’, ‘vcs’ and one ‘miscN’ entry for each backend-specific
data field (N starting at zero). They are set to the values figured out so far by vcs_info and any
change will be used directly when the actual replacement is done.

Since this hook is triggered multiple times (once for each configured formats or actionformats), each
of the ‘hook_com’ keys mentioned above (except for the miscN entries) has an ‘_orig’ counterpart, so
even if you changed a value to your liking you can still get the original value in the next run.
Changing the ‘_orig’ values is probably not a good idea.

If ret is set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[message]} will be used unchanged as the message
by vcs_info.

If all of this sounds rather confusing, take a look at Examples and also in the Misc/vcs_info-examples
file in the Zsh source. They contain some explanatory code.

26.5.8 Examples

Don’t use vcs_info at all (even though it’s in your prompt):

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable NONE

Disable the backends for bzr and svk:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr svk

Disable everything but bzr and svk:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable bzr svk

Provide a special formats for git:

zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' formats ' GIT, BABY! [%b]'


zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' actionformats ' GIT ACTION! [%b|%a]'

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 563 of 616
:
All %x expansion in all sorts of formats (formats, actionformats, branchformat, you name it) are
done using the ‘zformat’ builtin from the ‘zsh/zutil’ module. That means you can do everything with
these %x items what zformat supports. In particular, if you want something that is really long to
have a fixed width, like a hash in a mercurial branchformat, you can do this: %12.12i. That’ll shrink
the 40 character hash to its 12 leading characters. The form is actually ‘% min . max x’. More is
possible. See The zsh/zutil Module for details.

Use the quicker bzr backend

zstyle ':vcs_info:bzr:*' use-simple true

If you do use use-simple, please report if it does ‘the-right-thing[tm]’.

Display the revision number in yellow for bzr and svn:

zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' \
branchformat '%b%%F{yellow}:%r'

The doubled percent sign is explained in Oddities.

Alternatively, one can use the raw colour codes directly:

zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' \
branchformat '%b%{'${fg[yellow]}'%}:%r'

Normally when a variable is interpolated into a format string, the variable needs to be %-escaped. In
this example we skipped that because we assume the value of ${fg[yellow]} doesn’t contain any %
signs.

Make sure you enclose the color codes in %{ ... %} if you want to use the string provided by
vcs_info in prompts.

Here is how to print the VCS information as a command (not in a prompt):

vcsi() { vcs_info interactive; vcs_info_lastmsg }

This way, you can even define different formats for output via vcs_info_lastmsg in the
’:vcs_info:*:interactive:*’ namespace.

Now as promised, some code that uses hooks: say, you’d like to replace the string ‘svn’ by
‘subversion’ in vcs_info’s %s formats replacement.

First, we will tell vcs_info to call a function when populating the message variables with the gathered
information:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 564 of 616
:
Nothing happens. Which is reasonable, since we didn’t define the actual function yet. To see what
the hooks subsystem is trying to do, enable the ‘debug’ style:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug true

That should give you an idea what is going on. Specifically, the function that we are looking for is ‘+vi-
svn2subversion’. Note, the ‘+vi-’ prefix. So, everything is in order, just as documented. When you are
done checking out the debugging output, disable it again:

zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug false

Now, let’s define the function:

function +vi-svn2subversion() {
[[ ${hook_com[vcs_orig]} == svn ]] && hook_com[vcs]=subversion
}

Simple enough. And it could have even been simpler, if only we had registered our function in a less
generic context. If we do it only in the ‘svn’ backend’s context, we don’t need to test which the active
backend is:

zstyle ':vcs_info:svn+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion

function +vi-svn2subversion() {
hook_com[vcs]=subversion
}

And finally a little more elaborate example, that uses a hook to create a customised bookmark string
for the hg backend.

Again, we start off by registering a function:

zstyle ':vcs_info:hg+gen-hg-bookmark-string:*' hooks hgbookmarks

And then we define the ‘+vi-hgbookmarks’ function:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 565 of 616
:
function +vi-hgbookmarks() {
# The default is to connect all bookmark names by
# commas. This mixes things up a little.
# Imagine, there's one type of bookmarks that is
# special to you. Say, because it's *your* work.
# Those bookmarks look always like this: "sh/*"
# (because your initials are sh, for example).
# This makes the bookmarks string use only those
# bookmarks. If there's more than one, it
# concatenates them using commas.
# The bookmarks returned by `hg' are available in
# the function's positional parameters.
local s="${(Mj:,:)@:#sh/*}"
# Now, the communication with the code that calls
# the hook functions is done via the hook_com[]
# hash. The key at which the `gen-hg-bookmark-string'
# hook looks is `hg-bookmark-string'. So:
hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]=$s
# And to signal that we want to use the string we
# just generated, set the special variable `ret' to
# something other than the default zero:
ret=1
return 0
}

Some longer examples and code snippets which might be useful are available in the examples file
located at Misc/vcs_info-examples in the Zsh source directory.

This concludes our guided tour through zsh’s vcs_info.

26.6 Prompt Themes

26.6.1 Installation

You should make sure all the functions from the Functions/Prompts directory of the source
distribution are available; they all begin with the string ‘prompt_’ except for the special function
‘promptinit’. You also need the ‘colors’ and ‘add-zsh-hook’ functions from Functions/Misc. All these
functions may already be installed on your system; if not, you will need to find them and copy them.
The directory should appear as one of the elements of the fpath array (this should already be the
case if they were installed), and at least the function promptinit should be autoloaded; it will
autoload the rest. Finally, to initialize the use of the system you need to call the promptinit function.
The following code in your .zshrc will arrange for this; assume the functions are stored in the
directory ~/myfns:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 566 of 616
:
fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
autoload -U promptinit
promptinit

26.6.2 Theme Selection

Use the prompt command to select your preferred theme. This command may be added to your
.zshrc following the call to promptinit in order to start zsh with a theme already selected.

prompt [ -c | -l ]
prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
Set or examine the prompt theme. With no options and a theme argument, the theme with that
name is set as the current theme. The available themes are determined at run time; use the -l option
to see a list. The special theme ‘random’ selects at random one of the available themes and sets
your prompt to that.

In some cases the theme may be modified by one or more arguments, which should be given after
the theme name. See the help for each theme for descriptions of these arguments.

Options are:

-c
Show the currently selected theme and its parameters, if any.

-l
List all available prompt themes.

-p
Preview the theme named by theme , or all themes if no theme is given.

-h
Show help for the theme named by theme , or for the prompt function if no theme is given.

-s
Set theme as the current theme and save state.

prompt_ theme _setup


Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the prompt function to install that
theme. This function may define other functions as necessary to maintain the prompt, including
functions used to preview the prompt or provide help for its use. You should not normally call a
theme’s setup function directly.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 567 of 616
:
26.6.3 Utility Themes

prompt off
The theme ‘off’ sets all the prompt variables to minimal values with no special effects.

prompt default
The theme ‘default’ sets all prompt variables to the same state as if an interactive zsh was started
with no initialization files.

prompt restore
The special theme ‘restore’ erases all theme settings and sets prompt variables to their state before
the first time the ‘prompt’ function was run, provided each theme has properly defined its cleanup
(see below).

Note that you can undo ‘prompt off’ and ‘prompt default’ with ‘prompt restore’, but a second restore
does not undo the first.

26.6.4 Writing Themes

The first step for adding your own theme is to choose a name for it, and create a file
‘prompt_ name _setup’ in a directory in your fpath, such as ~/myfns in the example above. The file
should at minimum contain assignments for the prompt variables that your theme wishes to modify.
By convention, themes use PS1, PS2, RPS1, etc., rather than the longer PROMPT and RPROMPT.

The file is autoloaded as a function in the current shell context, so it may contain any necessary
commands to customize your theme, including defining additional functions. To make some
complex tasks easier, your setup function may also do any of the following:

Assign prompt_opts
The array prompt_opts may be assigned any of "bang", "cr", "percent", "sp", and/or "subst" as values.
The corresponding setopts (promptbang, etc.) are turned on, all other prompt-related options are
turned off. The prompt_opts array preserves setopts even beyond the scope of localoptions, should
your function need that.

Modify hooks
Use of add-zsh-hook and add-zle-hook-widget is recommended (see the Manipulating Hook
Functions section above). All hooks that follow the naming pattern prompt_ theme _ hook are
automatically removed when the prompt theme changes or is disabled.

Declare cleanup
If your function makes any other changes that should be undone when the theme is disabled, your
setup function may call

prompt_cleanup command

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 568 of 616
:
where command should be suitably quoted. If your theme is ever disabled or replaced by another,
command is executed with eval. You may declare more than one such cleanup hook.

Define preview
Define or autoload a function prompt_ name _preview to display a simulated version of your prompt.
A simple default previewer is defined by promptinit for themes that do not define their own. This
preview function is called by ‘prompt -p’.

Provide help
Define or autoload a function prompt_ name _help to display documentation or help text for your
theme. This help function is called by ‘prompt -h’.

26.7 ZLE Functions

26.7.1 Widgets

These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see Zsh Line Editor) which can be bound to
keystrokes in interactive shells. To use them, your .zshrc should contain lines of the form

autoload function
zle -N function

followed by an appropriate bindkey command to associate the function with a key sequence.
Suggested bindings are described below.

bash-style word functions


If you are looking for functions to implement moving over and editing words in the manner of bash,
where only alphanumeric characters are considered word characters, you can use the functions
described in the next section. The following is sufficient:

autoload -U select-word-style
select-word-style bash

forward-word-match, backward-word-match
kill-word-match, backward-kill-word-match
transpose-words-match, capitalize-word-match
up-case-word-match, down-case-word-match
delete-whole-word-match, select-word-match
select-word-style, match-word-context, match-words-by-style
The first eight ‘-match’ functions are drop-in replacements for the builtin widgets without the suffix.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 569 of 616
:
By default they behave in a similar way. However, by the use of styles and the function select-word-
style, the way words are matched can be altered. select-word-match is intended to be used as a text
object in vi mode but with custom word styles. For comparison, the widgets described in Text
Objects use fixed definitions of words, compatible with the vim editor.

The simplest way of configuring the functions is to use select-word-style, which can either be called
as a normal function with the appropriate argument, or invoked as a user-defined widget that will
prompt for the first character of the word style to be used. The first time it is invoked, the first eight -
match functions will automatically replace the builtin versions, so they do not need to be loaded
explicitly.

The word styles available are as follows. Only the first character is examined.

bash
Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.

normal
As in normal shell operation: word characters are alphanumeric characters plus any characters
present in the string given by the parameter $WORDCHARS.

shell
Words are complete shell command arguments, possibly including complete quoted strings, or any
tokens special to the shell.

whitespace
Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.

default
Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as ‘normal’.

All but ‘default’ can be input as an upper case character, which has the same effect but with subword
matching turned on. In this case, words with upper case characters are treated specially: each
separate run of upper case characters, or an upper case character followed by any number of other
characters, is considered a word. The style subword-range can supply an alternative character range
to the default ‘[:upper:]’; the value of the style is treated as the contents of a ‘[ ... ]’ pattern (note
that the outer brackets should not be supplied, only those surrounding named ranges).

More control can be obtained using the zstyle command, as described in The zsh/zutil Module. Each
style is looked up in the context :zle: widget where widget is the name of the user-defined widget,
not the name of the function implementing it, so in the case of the definitions supplied by select-
word-style the appropriate contexts are :zle:forward-word, and so on. The function select-word-style
itself always defines styles for the context ‘:zle:*’ which can be overridden by more specific (longer)
patterns as well as explicit contexts.

The style word-style specifies the rules to use. This may have the following values.

normal

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 570 of 616
:
Use the standard shell rules, i.e. alphanumerics and $WORDCHARS, unless overridden by the styles
word-chars or word-class.

specified
Similar to normal, but only the specified characters, and not also alphanumerics, are considered
word characters.

unspecified
The negation of specified. The given characters are those which will not be considered part of a
word.

shell
Words are obtained by using the syntactic rules for generating shell command arguments. In
addition, special tokens which are never command arguments such as ‘()’ are also treated as words.

whitespace
Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.

The first three of those rules usually use $WORDCHARS, but the value in the parameter can be
overridden by the style word-chars, which works in exactly the same way as $WORDCHARS. In
addition, the style word-class uses character class syntax to group characters and takes precedence
over word-chars if both are set. The word-class style does not include the surrounding brackets of
the character class; for example, ‘-:[:alnum:]’ is a valid word-class to include all alphanumerics plus
the characters ‘-’ and ‘:’. Be careful including ‘]’, ‘^’ and ‘-’ as these are special inside character classes.

word-style may also have ‘-subword’ appended to its value to turn on subword matching, as
described above.

The style skip-chars is mostly useful for transpose-words and similar functions. If set, it gives a count
of characters starting at the cursor position which will not be considered part of the word and are
treated as space, regardless of what they actually are. For example, if

zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1

has been set, and transpose-words-match is called with the cursor on the X of foo X bar, where X
can be any character, then the resulting expression is bar X foo.

Finer grained control can be obtained by setting the style word-context to an array of pairs of
entries. Each pair of entries consists of a pattern and a subcontext . The shell argument the cursor
is on is matched against each pattern in turn until one matches; if it does, the context is extended
by a colon and the corresponding subcontext . Note that the test is made against the original word
on the line, with no stripping of quotes. Special handling is done between words: the current context
is examined and if it contains the string between the word is set to a single space; else if it is
contains the string back, the word before the cursor is considered, else the word after cursor is
considered. Some examples are given below.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 571 of 616
:
The style skip-whitespace-first is only used with the forward-word widget. If it is set to true, then
forward-word skips any non-word-characters, followed by any non-word-characters: this is similar to
the behaviour of other word-orientated widgets, and also that used by other editors, however it
differs from the standard zsh behaviour. When using select-word-style the widget is set in the
context :zle:* to true if the word style is bash and false otherwise. It may be overridden by setting it
in the more specific context :zle:forward-word*.

It is possible to create widgets with specific behaviour by defining a new widget implemented by the
appropriate generic function, then setting a style for the context of the specific widget. For example,
the following defines a widget backward-kill-space-word using backward-kill-word-match, the
generic widget implementing backward-kill-word behaviour, and ensures that the new widget always
implements space-delimited behaviour.

zle -N backward-kill-space-word backward-kill-word-match


zstyle :zle:backward-kill-space-word word-style space

The widget backward-kill-space-word can now be bound to a key.

Here are some further examples of use of the styles, actually taken from the simplified interface in
select-word-style:

zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard


zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars ''

Implements bash-style word handling for all widgets, i.e. only alphanumerics are word characters;
equivalent to setting the parameter WORDCHARS empty for the given context.

style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space

Uses space-delimited words for widgets with the word ‘kill’ in the name. Neither of the styles word-
chars nor word-class is used in this case.

Here are some examples of use of the word-context style to extend the context.

zstyle ':zle:*' word-context \


"*/*" filename "[[:space:]]" whitespace
zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:whitespace' word-style shell
zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-style normal
zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-chars ''

This provides two different ways of using transpose-words depending on whether the cursor is on
whitespace between words or on a filename, here any word containing a /. On whitespace, complete
arguments as defined by standard shell rules will be transposed. In a filename, only alphanumerics
will be transposed. Elsewhere, words will be transposed using the default style for :zle:transpose-
words.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 572 of 616
:
The word matching and all the handling of zstyle settings is actually implemented by the function
match-words-by-style. This can be used to create new user-defined widgets. The calling function
should set the local parameter curcontext to :zle: widget , create the local parameter
matched_words and call match-words-by-style with no arguments. On return, matched_words will
be set to an array with the elements: (1) the start of the line (2) the word before the cursor (3) any
non-word characters between that word and the cursor (4) any non-word character at the cursor
position plus any remaining non-word characters before the next word, including all characters
specified by the skip-chars style, (5) the word at or following the cursor (6) any non-word characters
following that word (7) the remainder of the line. Any of the elements may be an empty string; the
calling function should test for this to decide whether it can perform its function.

If the variable matched_words is defined by the caller to match-words-by-style as an associative


array (local -A matched_words), then the seven values given above should be retrieved from it as
elements named start, word-before-cursor, ws-before-cursor, ws-after-cursor, word-after-cursor, ws-
after-word, and end. In addition the element is-word-start is 1 if the cursor is on the start of a word
or subword, or on white space before it (the cases can be distinguished by testing the ws-after-
cursor element) and 0 otherwise. This form is recommended for future compatibility.

It is possible to pass options with arguments to match-words-by-style to override the use of styles.
The options are:

-w
word-style

-s
skip-chars

-c
word-class

-C
word-chars

-r
subword-range

For example, match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0 may be used to extract the command argument
around the cursor.

The word-context style is implemented by the function match-word-context. This should not usually
need to be called directly.

bracketed-paste-magic
The bracketed-paste widget (see Miscellaneous in Standard Widgets) inserts pasted text literally into
the editor buffer rather than interpret it as keystrokes. This disables some common usages where
the self-insert widget is replaced in order to accomplish some extra processing. An example is the
contributed url-quote-magic widget described below.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 573 of 616
:
The bracketed-paste-magic widget is meant to replace bracketed-paste with a wrapper that re-
enables these self-insert actions, and other actions as selected by zstyles. Therefore this widget is
installed with

autoload -Uz bracketed-paste-magic


zle -N bracketed-paste bracketed-paste-magic

Other than enabling some widget processing, bracketed-paste-magic attempts to replicate


bracketed-paste as faithfully as possible.

The following zstyles may be set to control processing of pasted text. All are looked up in the context
‘:bracketed-paste-magic’.

active-widgets
A list of patterns matching widget names that should be activated during the paste. All other key
sequences are processed as self-insert-unmeta. The default is ‘self-*’ so any user-defined widgets
named with that prefix are active along with the builtin self-insert.

If this style is not set (explicitly deleted) or set to an empty value, no widgets are active and the
pasted text is inserted literally. If the value includes ‘undefined-key’, any unknown sequences are
discarded from the pasted text.

inactive-keys
The inverse of active-widgets, a list of key sequences that always use self-insert-unmeta even when
bound to an active widget. Note that this is a list of literal key sequences, not patterns.

paste-init
A list of function names, called in widget context (but not as widgets). The functions are called in
order until one of them returns a non-zero status. The parameter ‘PASTED’ contains the initial state
of the pasted text. All other ZLE parameters such as ‘BUFFER’ have their normal values and side-
effects, and full history is available, so for example paste-init functions may move words from
BUFFER into PASTED to make those words visible to the active-widgets.

A non-zero return from a paste-init function does not prevent the paste itself from proceeding.

Loading bracketed-paste-magic defines backward-extend-paste, a helper function for use in paste-


init.

zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic paste-init \


backward-extend-paste

When a paste would insert into the middle of a word or append text to a word already on the line,
backward-extend-paste moves the prefix from LBUFFER into PASTED so that the active-widgets see
the full word so far. This may be useful with url-quote-magic.

paste-finish
Another list of function names called in order until one returns non-zero. These functions are called

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 574 of 616
:
after the pasted text has been processed by the active-widgets, but before it is inserted into ‘BUFFER’.
ZLE parameters have their normal values and side-effects.

A non-zero return from a paste-finish function does not prevent the paste itself from proceeding.

Loading bracketed-paste-magic also defines quote-paste, a helper function for use in paste-finish.

zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic paste-finish \


quote-paste
zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic:finish quote-style \
qqq

When the pasted text is inserted into BUFFER, it is quoted per the quote-style value. To forcibly turn
off the built-in numeric prefix quoting of bracketed-paste, use:

zstyle :bracketed-paste-magic:finish quote-style \


none

Important: During active-widgets processing of the paste (after paste-init and before paste-finish),
BUFFER starts empty and history is restricted, so cursor motions, etc., may not pass outside of the
pasted content. Text assigned to BUFFER by the active widgets is copied back into PASTED before
paste-finish.

copy-earlier-word
This widget works like a combination of insert-last-word and copy-prev-shell-word. Repeated
invocations of the widget retrieve earlier words on the relevant history line. With a numeric
argument N , insert the N th word from the history line; N may be negative to count from the end of
the line.

If insert-last-word has been used to retrieve the last word on a previous history line, repeated
invocations will replace that word with earlier words from the same line.

Otherwise, the widget applies to words on the line currently being edited. The widget style can be
set to the name of another widget that should be called to retrieve words. This widget must accept
the same three arguments as insert-last-word.

cycle-completion-positions
After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the new function based completion
system may know about multiple places in this string where characters are missing or differ from at
least one of the possible matches. It will then place the cursor on the position it considers to be the
most interesting one, i.e. the one where one can disambiguate between as many matches as
possible with as little typing as possible.

This widget allows the cursor to be easily moved to the other interesting spots. It can be invoked
repeatedly to cycle between all positions reported by the completion system.

delete-whole-word-match

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 575 of 616
:
This is another function which works like the -match functions described immediately above, i.e.
using styles to decide the word boundaries. However, it is not a replacement for any existing
function.

The basic behaviour is to delete the word around the cursor. There is no numeric argument
handling; only the single word around the cursor is considered. If the widget contains the string kill,
the removed text will be placed in the cutbuffer for future yanking. This can be obtained by defining
kill-whole-word-match as follows:

zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match

and then binding the widget kill-whole-word-match.

up-line-or-beginning-search, down-line-or-beginning-search
These widgets are similar to the builtin functions up-line-or-search and down-line-or-search: if in a
multiline buffer they move up or down within the buffer, otherwise they search for a history line
matching the start of the current line. In this case, however, they search for a line which matches the
current line up to the current cursor position, in the manner of history-beginning-search-backward
and -forward, rather than the first word on the line.

edit-command-line
Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.

bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line

The editor to be used can also be specified using the editor style in the context of the widget. It is
specified as an array of command and arguments:

zstyle :zle:edit-command-line editor gvim -f

expand-absolute-path
Expand the file name under the cursor to an absolute path, resolving symbolic links. Where possible,
the initial path segment is turned into a named directory or reference to a user’s home directory.

history-search-end
This function implements the widgets history-beginning-search-backward-end and history-
beginning-search-forward-end. These commands work by first calling the corresponding builtin
widget (see History Control) and then moving the cursor to the end of the line. The original cursor
position is remembered and restored before calling the builtin widget a second time, so that the
same search is repeated to look farther through the history.

Although you autoload only one function, the commands to use it are slightly different because it
implements two widgets.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 576 of 616
:
zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
history-search-end
zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
history-search-end
bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end

history-beginning-search-menu
This function implements yet another form of history searching. The text before the cursor is used
to select lines from the history, as for history-beginning-search-backward except that all matches are
shown in a numbered menu. Typing the appropriate digits inserts the full history line. Note that
leading zeroes must be typed (they are only shown when necessary for removing ambiguity). The
entire history is searched; there is no distinction between forwards and backwards.

With a numeric argument, the search is not anchored to the start of the line; the string typed by the
use may appear anywhere in the line in the history.

If the widget name contains ‘-end’ the cursor is moved to the end of the line inserted. If the widget
name contains ‘-space’ any space in the text typed is treated as a wildcard and can match anything
(hence a leading space is equivalent to giving a numeric argument). Both forms can be combined, for
example:

zle -N history-beginning-search-menu-space-end \
history-beginning-search-menu

history-pattern-search
The function history-pattern-search implements widgets which prompt for a pattern with which to
search the history backwards or forwards. The pattern is in the usual zsh format, however the first
character may be ^ to anchor the search to the start of the line, and the last character may be $ to
anchor the search to the end of the line. If the search was not anchored to the end of the line the
cursor is positioned just after the pattern found.

The commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those in the example immediately above:

autoload -U history-pattern-search
zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search

incarg
Typing the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed on or to the left of an integer causes
that integer to be incremented by one. With a numeric argument, the number is incremented by the
amount of the argument (decremented if the numeric argument is negative). The shell parameter
incarg may be set to change the default increment to something other than one.

bindkey '^X+' incarg

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 577 of 616
:
incremental-complete-word
This allows incremental completion of a word. After starting this command, a list of completion
choices can be shown after every character you type, which you can delete with ^H or DEL. Pressing
return accepts the completion so far and returns you to normal editing (that is, the command line is
not immediately executed). You can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G to abort back to the state
when you started, and ^D to list the matches.

This works only with the new function based completion system.

bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word

insert-composed-char
This function allows you to compose characters that don’t appear on the keyboard to be inserted
into the command line. The command is followed by two keys corresponding to ASCII characters
(there is no prompt). For accented characters, the two keys are a base character followed by a code
for the accent, while for other special characters the two characters together form a mnemonic for
the character to be inserted. The two-character codes are a subset of those given by RFC 1345 (see
for example http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc1345.html).

The function may optionally be followed by up to two characters which replace one or both of the
characters read from the keyboard; if both characters are supplied, no input is read. For example,
insert-composed-char a: can be used within a widget to insert an a with umlaut into the command
line. This has the advantages over use of a

For best results zsh should have been built with support for multibyte characters (configured with –
enable-multibyte); however, the function works for the limited range of characters available in
single-byte character sets such as ISO-8859-1.

The character is converted into the local representation and inserted into the command line at the
cursor position. (The conversion is done within the shell, using whatever facilities the C library
provides.) With a numeric argument, the character and its code are previewed in the status line

The function may be run outside zle in which case it prints the character (together with a newline) to
standard output. Input is still read from keystrokes.

See insert-unicode-char for an alternative way of inserting Unicode characters using their
hexadecimal character number.

The set of accented characters is reasonably complete up to Unicode character U+0180, the set of
special characters less so. However, it is very sporadic from that point. Adding new characters is
easy, however; see the function define-composed-chars. Please send any additions to zsh-
[email protected].

The codes for the second character when used to accent the first are as follows. Note that not every
character can take every accent.

!
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 578 of 616
:
Grave.


Acute.

>
Circumflex.

?
Tilde. (This is not ~ as RFC 1345 does not assume that character is present on the keyboard.)

-
Macron. (A horizontal bar over the base character.)

(
Breve. (A shallow dish shape over the base character.)

.
Dot above the base character, or in the case of i no dot, or in the case of L and l a centered dot.

:
Diaeresis (Umlaut).

c
Cedilla.

_
Underline, however there are currently no underlined characters.

/
Stroke through the base character.

"
Double acute (only supported on a few letters).

;
Ogonek. (A little forward facing hook at the bottom right of the character.)

<
Caron. (A little v over the letter.)

0
Circle over the base character.

2
Hook over the base character.

9
Horn over the base character.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 579 of 616
:
The most common characters from the Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek and Hebrew alphabets are available;
consult RFC 1345 for the appropriate sequences. In addition, a set of two letter codes not in RFC
1345 are available for the double-width characters corresponding to ASCII characters from ! to ~
(0x21 to 0x7e) by preceding the character with ^, for example ^A for a double-width A.

The following other two-character sequences are understood.

ASCII characters
These are already present on most keyboards:

<(
Left square bracket

//
Backslash (solidus)

)>
Right square bracket

(!
Left brace (curly bracket)

!!
Vertical bar (pipe symbol)

!)
Right brace (curly bracket)

’?
Tilde

Special letters
Characters found in various variants of the Latin alphabet:

ss
Eszett (scharfes S)

D-, d-
Eth

TH, th
Thorn

kk
Kra

’n
’n

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 580 of 616
:
NG, ng
Ng

OI, oi
Oi

yr
yr

ED
ezh

Currency symbols
Ct
Cent

Pd
Pound sterling (also lira and others)

Cu
Currency

Ye
Yen

Eu
Euro (N.B. not in RFC 1345)

Punctuation characters
References to "right" quotes indicate the shape (like a 9 rather than 6) rather than their grammatical
use. (For example, a "right" low double quote is used to open quotations in German.)

!I
Inverted exclamation mark

BB
Broken vertical bar

SE
Section

Co
Copyright

-a
Spanish feminine ordinal indicator

<<
Left guillemet
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 581 of 616
:
--
Soft hyphen

Rg
Registered trade mark

PI
Pilcrow (paragraph)

-o
Spanish masculine ordinal indicator

>>
Right guillemet

?I
Inverted question mark

-1
Hyphen

-N
En dash

-M
Em dash

-3
Horizontal bar

:3
Vertical ellipsis

.3
Horizontal midline ellipsis

!2
Double vertical line

=2
Double low line

’6
Left single quote

’9
Right single quote

.9

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 582 of 616
:
"Right" low quote

9’
Reversed "right" quote

"6
Left double quote

"9
Right double quote

:9
"Right" low double quote

9"
Reversed "right" double quote

/-
Dagger

/=
Double dagger

Mathematical symbols
DG
Degree

-2, +-, -+
- sign, +/- sign, -/+ sign

2S
Superscript 2

3S
Superscript 3

1S
Superscript 1

My
Micro

.M
Middle dot

14
Quarter

12

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 583 of 616
:
Half

34
Three quarters

*X
Multiplication

-:
Division

%0
Per mille

FA, TE, /0
For all, there exists, empty set

dP, DE, NB
Partial derivative, delta (increment), del (nabla)

(-, -)
Element of, contains

*P, +Z
Product, sum

*-, Ob, Sb
Asterisk, ring, bullet

RT, 0(, 00
Root sign, proportional to, infinity

Other symbols
cS, cH, cD, cC
Card suits: spades, hearts, diamonds, clubs

Md, M8, M2, Mb, Mx, MX


Musical notation: crotchet (quarter note), quaver (eighth note), semiquavers (sixteenth notes), flag
sign, natural sign, sharp sign

Fm, Ml
Female, male

Accents on their own


’>
Circumflex (same as caret, ^)

’!
Grave (same as backtick, ‘)
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 584 of 616
:
’,
Cedilla

’:
Diaeresis (Umlaut)

’m
Macron


Acute

insert-files
This function allows you type a file pattern, and see the results of the expansion at each step. When
you hit return, all expansions are inserted into the command line.

bindkey '^Xf' insert-files

insert-unicode-char
When first executed, the user inputs a set of hexadecimal digits. This is terminated with another call
to insert-unicode-char. The digits are then turned into the corresponding Unicode character. For
example, if the widget is bound to ^XU, the character sequence ‘^XU 4 c ^XU’ inserts L (Unicode
U+004c).

See insert-composed-char for a way of inserting characters using a two-character mnemonic.

narrow-to-region [ -p pre ] [ -P post ]


[ -S statepm | -R statepm | [ -l lbufvar ] [ -r rbufvar ] ]
[ -n ] [ start end ]
narrow-to-region-invisible
predict-on
This set of functions implements predictive typing using history search. After predict-on, typing
characters causes the editor to look backward in the history for the first line beginning with what
you have typed so far. After predict-off, editing returns to normal for the line found. In fact, you
often don’t even need to use predict-off, because if the line doesn’t match something in the history,
adding a key performs standard completion, and then inserts itself if no completions were found.
However, editing in the middle of a line is liable to confuse prediction; see the toggle style below.

With the function based completion system (which is needed for this), you should be able to type
TAB at almost any point to advance the cursor to the next ‘‘interesting’’ character position (usually
the end of the current word, but sometimes somewhere in the middle of the word). And of course as
soon as the entire line is what you want, you can accept with return, without needing to move the
cursor to the end first.

The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional widget functions:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 585 of 616
:
delete-backward-and-predict
Replaces the backward-delete-char widget. You do not need to bind this yourself.

insert-and-predict
Implements predictive typing by replacing the self-insert widget. You do not need to bind this
yourself.

predict-off
Turns off predictive typing.

Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is necessary to create a keybinding for
predict-off as well.

zle -N predict-on
zle -N predict-off
bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
bindkey '^Z' predict-off

read-from-minibuffer
This is most useful when called as a function from inside a widget, but will work correctly as a widget
in its own right. It prompts for a value below the current command line; a value may be input using
all of the standard zle operations (and not merely the restricted set available when executing, for
example, execute-named-cmd). The value is then returned to the calling function in the parameter
$REPLY and the editing buffer restored to its previous state. If the read was aborted by a keyboard
break (typically ^G), the function returns status 1 and $REPLY is not set.

If one argument is supplied to the function it is taken as a prompt, otherwise ‘? ’ is used. If two
arguments are supplied, they are the prompt and the initial value of $LBUFFER, and if a third
argument is given it is the initial value of $RBUFFER. This provides a default value and starting cursor
placement. Upon return the entire buffer is the value of $REPLY.

One option is available: ‘-k num ’ specifies that num characters are to be read instead of a whole line.
The line editor is not invoked recursively in this case, so depending on the terminal settings the
input may not be visible, and only the input keys are placed in $REPLY, not the entire buffer. Note
that unlike the read builtin num must be given; there is no default.

The name is a slight misnomer, as in fact the shell’s own minibuffer is not used. Hence it is still
possible to call executed-named-cmd and similar functions while reading a value.

replace-argument, replace-argument-edit
The function replace-argument can be used to replace a command line argument in the current
command line or, if the current command line is empty, in the last command line executed (the new
command line is not executed). Arguments are as delimited by standard shell syntax,

If a numeric argument is given, that specifies the argument to be replaced. 0 means the command
name, as in history expansion. A negative numeric argument counts backward from the last word.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 586 of 616
:
If no numeric argument is given, the current argument is replaced; this is the last argument if the
previous history line is being used.

The function prompts for a replacement argument.

If the widget contains the string edit, for example is defined as

zle -N replace-argument-edit replace-argument

then the function presents the current value of the argument for editing, otherwise the editing
buffer for the replacement is initially empty.

replace-string, replace-pattern
replace-string-again, replace-pattern-again
The function replace-string implements three widgets. If defined under the same name as the
function, it prompts for two strings; the first (source) string will be replaced by the second
everywhere it occurs in the line editing buffer.

If the widget name contains the word ‘pattern’, for example by defining the widget using the
command ‘zle -N replace-pattern replace-string’, then the matching is performed using zsh patterns.
All zsh extended globbing patterns can be used in the source string; note that unlike filename
generation the pattern does not need to match an entire word, nor do glob qualifiers have any
effect. In addition, the replacement string can contain parameter or command substitutions.
Furthermore, a ‘&’ in the replacement string will be replaced with the matched source string, and a
backquoted digit ‘\ N ’ will be replaced by the N th parenthesised expression matched. The form ‘\
{ N }’ may be used to protect the digit from following digits.

If the widget instead contains the word ‘regex’ (or ‘regexp’), then the matching is performed using
regular expressions, respecting the setting of the option RE_MATCH_PCRE (see the description of the
function regexp-replace below). The special replacement facilities described above for pattern
matching are available.

By default the previous source or replacement string will not be offered for editing. However, this
feature can be activated by setting the style edit-previous in the context :zle: widget (for example,
:zle:replace-string) to true. In addition, a positive numeric argument forces the previous values to be
offered, a negative or zero argument forces them not to be.

The function replace-string-again can be used to repeat the previous replacement; no prompting is
done. As with replace-string, if the name of the widget contains the word ‘pattern’ or ‘regex’, pattern
or regular expression matching is performed, else a literal string replacement. Note that the
previous source and replacement text are the same whether pattern, regular expression or string
matching is used.

In addition, replace-string shows the previous replacement above the prompt, so long as there was
one during the current session; if the source string is empty, that replacement will be repeated
without the widget prompting for a replacement string.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 587 of 616
:
For example, starting from the line:

print This line contains fan and fond

and invoking replace-pattern with the source string ‘f(?)n’ and the replacement string ‘c\1r’ produces
the not very useful line:

print This line contains car and cord

The range of the replacement string can be limited by using the narrow-to-region-invisible widget.
One limitation of the current version is that undo will cycle through changes to the replacement and
source strings before undoing the replacement itself.

send-invisible
This is similar to read-from-minibuffer in that it may be called as a function from a widget or as a
widget of its own, and interactively reads input from the keyboard. However, the input being typed is
concealed and a string of asterisks (‘*’) is shown instead. The value is saved in the parameter
$INVISIBLE to which a reference is inserted into the editing buffer at the restored cursor position. If
the read was aborted by a keyboard break (typically ^G) or another escape from editing such as
push-line, $INVISIBLE is set to empty and the original buffer is restored unchanged.

If one argument is supplied to the function it is taken as a prompt, otherwise ‘Non-echoed text: ’ is
used (as in emacs). If a second and third argument are supplied they are used to begin and end the
reference to $INVISIBLE that is inserted into the buffer. The default is to open with ${, then
INVISIBLE, and close with }, but many other effects are possible.

smart-insert-last-word
This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:

zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word

With a numeric argument, or when passed command line arguments in a call from another widget, it
behaves like insert-last-word, except that words in comments are ignored when
INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS is set.

Otherwise, the rightmost ‘‘interesting’’ word from the previous command is found and inserted. The
default definition of ‘‘interesting’’ is that the word contains at least one alphabetic character, slash, or
backslash. This definition may be overridden by use of the match style. The context used to look up
the style is the widget name, so usually the context is :insert-last-word. However, you can bind this
function to different widgets to use different patterns:

zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word


zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment

If no interesting word is found and the auto-previous style is set to a true value, the search
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 588 of 616
:
continues upward through the history. When auto-previous is unset or false (the default), the widget
must be invoked repeatedly in order to search earlier history lines.

transpose-lines
Only useful with a multi-line editing buffer; the lines here are lines within the current on-screen
buffer, not history lines. The effect is similar to the function of the same name in Emacs.

Transpose the current line with the previous line and move the cursor to the start of the next line.
Repeating this (which can be done by providing a positive numeric argument) has the effect of
moving the line above the cursor down by a number of lines.

With a negative numeric argument, requires two lines above the cursor. These two lines are
transposed and the cursor moved to the start of the previous line. Using a numeric argument less
than -1 has the effect of moving the line above the cursor up by minus that number of lines.

url-quote-magic
This widget replaces the built-in self-insert to make it easier to type URLs as command line
arguments. As you type, the input character is analyzed and, if it may need quoting, the current
word is checked for a URI scheme. If one is found and the current word is not already in quotes, a
backslash is inserted before the input character.

Styles to control quoting behavior:

url-metas
This style is looked up in the context ‘:url-quote-magic: scheme ’ (where scheme is that of the current
URL, e.g. "ftp"). The value is a string listing the characters to be treated as globbing metacharacters
when appearing in a URL using that scheme. The default is to quote all zsh extended globbing
characters, excluding ’<’ and ’>’ but including braces (as in brace expansion). See also url-seps.

url-seps
Like url-metas, but lists characters that should be considered command separators, redirections,
history references, etc. The default is to quote the standard set of shell separators, excluding those
that overlap with the extended globbing characters, but including ’<’ and ’>’ and the first character of
$histchars.

url-globbers
This style is looked up in the context ‘:url-quote-magic’. The values form a list of command names
that are expected to do their own globbing on the URL string. This implies that they are aliased to
use the ‘noglob’ modifier. When the first word on the line matches one of the values and the URL
refers to a local file (see url-local-schema), only the url-seps characters are quoted; the url-metas are
left alone, allowing them to affect command-line parsing, completion, etc. The default values are a
literal ‘noglob’ plus (when the zsh/parameter module is available) any commands aliased to the
helper function ‘urlglobber’ or its alias ‘globurl’.

url-local-schema
This style is always looked up in the context ‘:urlglobber’, even though it is used by both url-quote-
magic and urlglobber. The values form a list of URI schema that should be treated as referring to
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 589 of 616
:
local files by their real local path names, as opposed to files which are specified relative to a web-
server-defined document root. The defaults are "ftp" and "file".

url-other-schema
Like url-local-schema, but lists all other URI schema upon which urlglobber and url-quote-magic
should act. If the URI on the command line does not have a scheme appearing either in this list or in
url-local-schema, it is not magically quoted. The default values are "http", "https", and "ftp". When a
scheme appears both here and in url-local-schema, it is quoted differently depending on whether
the command name appears in url-globbers.

Loading url-quote-magic also defines a helper function ‘urlglobber’ and aliases ‘globurl’ to ‘noglob
urlglobber’. This function takes a local URL apart, attempts to pattern-match the local file portion of
the URL path, and then puts the results back into URL format again.

vi-pipe
This function reads a movement command from the keyboard and then prompts for an external
command. The part of the buffer covered by the movement is piped to the external command and
then replaced by the command’s output. If the movement command is bound to vi-pipe, the current
line is used.

The function serves as an example for reading a vi movement command from within a user-defined
widget.

which-command
This function is a drop-in replacement for the builtin widget which-command. It has enhanced
behaviour, in that it correctly detects whether or not the command word needs to be expanded as
an alias; if so, it continues tracing the command word from the expanded alias until it reaches the
command that will be executed.

The style whence is available in the context :zle:$WIDGET; this may be set to an array to give the
command and options that will be used to investigate the command word found. The default is
whence -c.

zcalc-auto-insert
This function is useful together with the zcalc function described in Mathematical Functions. It
should be bound to a key representing a binary operator such as ‘+’, ‘-’, ‘*’ or ‘/’. When running in
zcalc, if the key occurs at the start of the line or immediately following an open parenthesis, the text
"ans " is inserted before the representation of the key itself. This allows easy use of the answer from
the previous calculation in the current line. The text to be inserted before the symbol typed can be
modified by setting the variable ZCALC_AUTO_INSERT_PREFIX.

Hence, for example, typing ‘+12’ followed by return adds 12 to the previous result.

If zcalc is in RPN mode (-r option) the effect of this binding is automatically suppressed as operators
alone on a line are meaningful.

When not in zcalc, the key simply inserts the symbol itself.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 590 of 616
:
26.7.2 Utility Functions

These functions are useful in constructing widgets. They should be loaded with ‘autoload -U
function ’ and called as indicated from user-defined widgets.

split-shell-arguments

This function splits the line currently being edited into shell arguments and whitespace. The result is
stored in the array reply. The array contains all the parts of the line in order, starting with any
whitespace before the first argument, and finishing with any whitespace after the last argument.
Hence (so long as the option KSH_ARRAYS is not set) whitespace is given by odd indices in the array
and arguments by even indices. Note that no stripping of quotes is done; joining together all the
elements of reply in order is guaranteed to produce the original line.

The parameter REPLY is set to the index of the word in reply which contains the character after the
cursor, where the first element has index 1. The parameter REPLY2 is set to the index of the
character under the cursor in that word, where the first character has index 1.

Hence reply, REPLY and REPLY2 should all be made local to the enclosing function.

See the function modify-current-argument, described below, for an example of how to call this
function.

modify-current-argument [ expr-using- $ARG | func ]

This function provides a simple method of allowing user-defined widgets to modify the command
line argument under the cursor (or immediately to the left of the cursor if the cursor is between
arguments).

The argument can be an expression which when evaluated operates on the shell parameter ARG,
which will have been set to the command line argument under the cursor. The expression should be
suitably quoted to prevent it being evaluated too early.

Alternatively, if the argument does not contain the string ARG, it is assumed to be a shell function, to
which the current command line argument is passed as the only argument. The function should set
the variable REPLY to the new value for the command line argument. If the function returns non-
zero status, so does the calling function.

For example, a user-defined widget containing the following code converts the characters in the
argument under the cursor into all upper case:

modify-current-argument '${(U)ARG}'

The following strips any quoting from the current word (whether backslashes or one of the styles of
quotes), and replaces it with single quoting throughout:
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 591 of 616
:
modify-current-argument '${(qq)${(Q)ARG}}'

The following performs directory expansion on the command line argument and replaces it by the
absolute path:

expand-dir() {
REPLY=${~1}
REPLY=${REPLY:a}
}
modify-current-argument expand-dir

In practice the function expand-dir would probably not be defined within the widget where modify-
current-argument is called.

26.7.3 Styles

The behavior of several of the above widgets can be controlled by the use of the zstyle mechanism.
In particular, widgets that interact with the completion system pass along their context to any
completions that they invoke.

break-keys

This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget. Its value should be a pattern, and all
keys matching this pattern will cause the widget to stop incremental completion without the key
having any further effect. Like all styles used directly by incremental-complete-word, this style is
looked up using the context ‘:incremental’.

completer

The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set up their top-level context name
before calling completion. This allows one to define different sets of completer functions for normal
completion and for these widgets. For example, to use completion, approximation and correction
for normal completion, completion and correction for incremental completion and only completion
for prediction one could use:

zstyle ':completion:*' completer \


_complete _correct _approximate
zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
_complete _correct
zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
_complete

It is a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction, because they may be automatically
invoked as you type. The _list and _menu completers should never be used with prediction. The
_approximate, _correct, _expand, and _match completers may be used, but be aware that they may

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 592 of 616
:
change characters anywhere in the word behind the cursor, so you need to watch carefully that the
result is what you intended.

cursor

The insert-and-predict widget uses this style, in the context ‘:predict’, to decide where to place the
cursor after completion has been tried. Values are:

complete
The cursor is left where it was when completion finished, but only if it is after a character equal to
the one just inserted by the user. If it is after another character, this value is the same as ‘key’.

key
The cursor is left after the n th occurrence of the character just inserted, where n is the number of
times that character appeared in the word before completion was attempted. In short, this has the
effect of leaving the cursor after the character just typed even if the completion code found out that
no other characters need to be inserted at that position.

Any other value for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor at the position where the completion
code left it.

list

When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style says if the matches should be listed on
every key press (if they fit on the screen). Use the context prefix ‘:completion:incremental’.

The insert-and-predict widget uses this style to decide if the completion should be shown even if
there is only one possible completion. This is done if the value of this style is the string always. In
this case the context is ‘:predict’ (not ‘:completion:predict’).

match

This style is used by smart-insert-last-word to provide a pattern (using full EXTENDED_GLOB syntax)
that matches an interesting word. The context is the name of the widget to which smart-insert-last-
word is bound (see above). The default behavior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:

zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'

However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:

zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'

Or include numbers as long as the word is at least two characters long:

zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'

The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 593 of 616
:
prompt

The incremental-complete-word widget shows the value of this style in the status line during
incremental completion. The string value may contain any of the following substrings in the manner
of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:

%c
Replaced by the name of the completer function that generated the matches (without the leading
underscore).

%l
When the list style is set, replaced by ‘...’ if the list of matches is too long to fit on the screen and with
an empty string otherwise. If the list style is ‘false’ or not set, ‘%l’ is always removed.

%n
Replaced by the number of matches generated.

%s
Replaced by ‘-no match-’, ‘-no prefix-’, or an empty string if there is no completion matching the word
on the line, if the matches have no common prefix different from the word on the line, or if there is
such a common prefix, respectively.

%u
Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there is any, and if it is different from the word
on the line.

Like ‘break-keys’, this uses the ‘:incremental’ context.

stop-keys

This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget. Its value is treated similarly to the one
for the break-keys style (and uses the same context: ‘:incremental’). However, in this case all keys
matching the pattern given as its value will stop incremental completion and will then execute their
usual function.

toggle

This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets in the context ‘:predict’. If set to one
of the standard ‘true’ values, predictive typing is automatically toggled off in situations where it is
unlikely to be useful, such as when editing a multi-line buffer or after moving into the middle of a
line and then deleting a character. The default is to leave prediction turned on until an explicit call to
predict-off.

verbose

This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related widgets in the context ‘:predict’. If set to one
of the standard ‘true’ values, these widgets display a message below the prompt when the predictive
state is toggled. This is most useful in combination with the toggle style. The default does not display

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 594 of 616
:
these messages.

widget

This style is similar to the command style: For widget functions that use zle to call other widgets, this
style can sometimes be used to override the widget which is called. The context for this style is the
name of the calling widget (not the name of the calling function, because one function may be bound
to multiple widget names).

zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word

Check the documentation for the calling widget or function to determine whether the widget style is
used.

26.8 Exception Handling


Two functions are provided to enable zsh to provide exception handling in a form that should be
familiar from other languages.

throw exception

The function throw throws the named exception . The name is an arbitrary string and is only used
by the throw and catch functions. An exception is for the most part treated the same as a shell error,
i.e. an unhandled exception will cause the shell to abort all processing in a function or script and to
return to the top level in an interactive shell.

catch exception-pattern

The function catch returns status zero if an exception was thrown and the pattern exception-
pattern matches its name. Otherwise it returns status 1. exception-pattern is a standard shell
pattern, respecting the current setting of the EXTENDED_GLOB option. An alias catch is also defined
to prevent the argument to the function from matching filenames, so patterns may be used
unquoted. Note that as exceptions are not fundamentally different from other shell errors it is
possible to catch shell errors by using an empty string as the exception name. The shell variable
CAUGHT is set by catch to the name of the exception caught. It is possible to rethrow an exception
by calling the throw function again once an exception has been caught.

The functions are designed to be used together with the always construct described in Complex
Commands. This is important as only this construct provides the required support for exceptions. A
typical example is as follows.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 595 of 616
:
{
# "try" block
# ... nested code here calls "throw MyExcept"
} always {
# "always" block
if catch MyExcept; then
print "Caught exception MyExcept"
elif catch ''; then
print "Caught a shell error. Propagating..."
throw ''
fi
# Other exceptions are not handled but may be caught further
# up the call stack.
}

If all exceptions should be caught, the following idiom might be preferable.

{
# ... nested code here throws an exception
} always {
if catch *; then
case $CAUGHT in
(MyExcept)
print "Caught my own exception"
;;
(*)
print "Caught some other exception"
;;
esac
fi
}

In common with exception handling in other languages, the exception may be thrown by code
deeply nested inside the ‘try’ block. However, note that it must be thrown inside the current shell,
not in a subshell forked for a pipeline, parenthesised current-shell construct, or some form of
command or process substitution.

The system internally uses the shell variable EXCEPTION to record the name of the exception
between throwing and catching. One drawback of this scheme is that if the exception is not handled
the variable EXCEPTION remains set and may be incorrectly recognised as the name of an exception
if a shell error subsequently occurs. Adding unset EXCEPTION at the start of the outermost layer of
any code that uses exception handling will eliminate this problem.

26.9 MIME Functions


Three functions are available to provide handling of files recognised by extension, for example to
dispatch a file text.ps when executed as a command to an appropriate viewer.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 596 of 616
:
zsh-mime-setup [ -fv ] [ -l [ suffix ... ] ]

zsh-mime-handler [ -l ] command argument ...

These two functions use the files ~/.mime.types and /etc/mime.types, which associate types and
extensions, as well as ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap files, which associate types and the programs that
handle them. These are provided on many systems with the Multimedia Internet Mail Extensions.

To enable the system, the function zsh-mime-setup should be autoloaded and run. This allows files
with extensions to be treated The function zsh-mime-handler should not need to be called by the
user.

The system works by setting up suffix aliases with ‘alias -s’. Suffix aliases already installed by the user
will not be overwritten.

For suffixes defined in lower case, upper case variants will also automatically be handled (e.g. PDF is
automatically handled if handling for the suffix pdf is defined), but not vice versa.

Repeated calls to zsh-mime-setup do not override the existing is given. Note, however, that this does
not override existing suffix aliases assigned to handlers other than zsh-mime-handler.

Calling zsh-mime-setup with the option -l lists the existing mappings without altering them. Suffixes
to list (which may contain pattern characters that should be quoted from immediate interpretation
on the command line) may be given as additional arguments, otherwise all suffixes are listed.

Calling zsh-mime-setup with the option -v causes verbose output to be shown during the setup
operation.

The system respects the mailcap flags needsterminal and copiousoutput; see mailcap(4) or
mailcap(5) (the man page’s name varies across platforms).

The functions use the following styles, which are defined with the zstyle builtin command (The
zsh/zutil Module). They should be defined before zsh-mime-setup is run. The contexts used all start
with :mime:, with additional components in some cases. It is recommended that a trailing * (suitably
quoted) be appended to style patterns in case the system is extended in future. Some examples are
given below.

For files that have multiple suffixes, e.g. .pdf.gz, where the context includes the suffix it will be
looked up starting with the longest possible suffix until a match for the style is found. For example, if
.pdf.gz produces a match for the handler, that will be used; otherwise the handler for .gz will be
used. Note that, owing to the way suffix aliases work, it is always required that there be a handler for
the shortest possible suffix, so in this example .pdf.gz can only be handled if .gz is also handled
(though not necessarily in the same way). Alternatively, if no handling for .gz on its own is needed,
simply adding the command

alias -s gz=zsh-mime-handler

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 597 of 616
:
to the initialisation code is sufficient; .gz will not be handled on its own, but may be in combination
with other suffixes.

current-shell

If this boolean style is true, the mailcap handler for the context in question is run using the eval
builtin instead of by starting a new sh process. This is more efficient, but may not work in the
occasional cases where the mailcap handler uses strict POSIX syntax.

disown

If this boolean style is true, mailcap handlers started in the background will be disowned, i.e. not
subject to job control within the parent shell. Such handlers nearly always produce their own
windows, so the only likely harmful side effect of setting the style is that it becomes harder to kill
jobs from within the shell.

execute-as-is

This style gives a list of patterns to be matched against files passed for execution with a handler
program. If the file matches the pattern, the entire command line is executed in its current form,
with no handler. This is useful for files which might have suffixes is not set, the pattern *(*) *(/) is
used; handler, and the option AUTO_CD may be used to change to directories that happen to have
MIME suffixes.

execute-never

This style is useful in combination with execute-as-is. It is set to an array of patterns corresponding
to full paths to files that the MIME handler matches execute-as-is. This is useful for file from another
operating system. For example, if /mnt/windows is a Windows mount, then

zstyle ':mime:*' execute-never '/mnt/windows/*'

will ensure that any files found in that area will be executed as MIME file name is matched against
the pattern, regardless of how the file was passed to the handler. The file is resolved to a full path
using the :P modifier described in Modifiers; this means that symbolic links are resolved where
possible, so that links into other file systems behave in the correct fashion.

file-path

Used if the style find-file-in-path is true for the same context. Set to an array of directories that are
used for searching for the file to be handled; the default is the command path given by the special
parameter path. The shell option PATH_DIRS is respected; if that is set, the appropriate path will be
searched even if the name of the file to be handled as it appears on the command line contains a ‘/’.
The full context is :mime:. suffix :, as described for the style handler.

find-file-in-path

If set, allows files whose names do not contain absolute paths to be searched for in the command
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 598 of 616
:
path or the path specified by the file-path style. If the file is not found in the path, it is looked for
locally (whether or not the current directory is in the path); if it is not found locally, the handler will
abort unless the handle-nonexistent style is set. Files found in the path are tested as described for
the style execute-as-is. The full context is :mime:. suffix :, as described for the style handler.

flags

Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for the handler style, and the format is as for the
flags in mailcap.

handle-nonexistent

By default, arguments that don’t correspond to files are not passed to the MIME handler in order to
prevent it from intercepting commands found in the path that happen to have suffixes. This style
may be set to an array of extended glob patterns for arguments that will be passed to the handler
even if they don’t exist. If it is not explicitly set it defaults to [[:alpha:]]#:/* which allows URLs to be
passed to the MIME handler even though they don’t exist in that format in the file system. The full
context is :mime:. suffix :, as described for the style handler.

handler

Specifies a handler for a suffix; the suffix is given by the context as :mime:. suffix :, and the format
of the handler is exactly that in mailcap. Note in particular the ‘.’ and trailing colon to distinguish this
use of the context. This overrides any handler specified by the mailcap files. If the handler requires a
terminal, the flags style should be set to include the word needsterminal, or if the output is to be
displayed through a pager (but not if the handler is itself a pager), it should include copiousoutput.

mailcap

A list of files in the format of ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap to be read during setup, replacing the
default list which consists of those two files. The context is :mime:. A + in the list will be replaced by
the default files.

mailcap-priorities

This style is used to resolve multiple mailcap entries for the same MIME type. It consists of an array
of the following elements, in descending order of priority; later entries will be used if earlier entries
are unable to resolve the entries being compared. If none of the tests resolve the entries, the first
entry encountered is retained.

files
The order of files (entries in the mailcap style) read. Earlier files are preferred. (Note this does not
resolve entries in the same file.)

priority
The priority flag from the mailcap entry. The priority is an integer from 0 to 9 with the default value
being 5.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 599 of 616
:
flags
The test given by the mailcap-prio-flags option is used to resolve entries.

place
Later entries are preferred; as the entries are strictly ordered, this test always succeeds.

Note that as this style is handled during initialisation, the context is always :mime:, with no
discrimination by suffix.

mailcap-prio-flags

This style is used when the keyword flags is encountered in the list of tests specified by the mailcap-
priorities style. It should be set to a list of patterns, each of which is tested against the flags specified
in the mailcap entry (in other words, the sets of assignments found with some entries in the mailcap
file). Earlier patterns in the list are preferred to later ones, and matched patterns are preferred to
unmatched ones.

mime-types

A list of files in the format of ~/.mime.types and /etc/mime.types to be read during setup, replacing
the default list which consists of those two files. The context is :mime:. A + in the list will be replaced
by the default files.

never-background

If this boolean style is set, the handler for the given context is always run in the foreground, even if
the flags provided in the mailcap entry suggest it need not be (for example, it doesn’t require a
terminal).

pager

If set, will be used instead of $PAGER or more to handle suffixes where the copiousoutput flag is set.
The context is as for handler, i.e. :mime:. suffix : for handling a file with the given suffix .

Examples:

zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap


zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal

When zsh-mime-setup is subsequently run, it will look for mailcap entries in the two files given. Files
of suffix .txt will be handled by running ‘less file.txt ’. The flag needsterminal is set to show that
this program must run attached to a terminal.

As there are several steps to dispatching a command, the following should be checked if attempting
to execute a file by extension . ext does not have the expected effect.

The command ‘alias -s ext ’ should show ‘ps=zsh-mime-handler’. If it shows something else, another

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 600 of 616
:
suffix alias was already installed and was not overwritten. If it shows nothing, no handler was
installed: this is most likely because no handler was found in the .mime.types and mailcap
combination for .ext files. In that case, appropriate handling should be added to ~/.mime.types and
mailcap.

If the extension is handled by zsh-mime-handler but the file is not opened correctly, either the
handler defined for the type is incorrect, or the flags associated with it are in appropriate. Running
zsh-mime-setup -l will show the handler and, if there are any, the flags. A %s in the handler is
replaced by the file (suitably quoted if necessary). Check that the handler program listed lists and
can be run in the way shown. Also check that the flags needsterminal or copiousoutput are set if the
handler needs to be run under a terminal; the second flag is used if the output should be sent to a
pager.

text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal

Running ‘zsh-mime-handler -l command line ’ prints the command line that would be executed,
simplified to remove the effect of any flags, and quoted so that the output can be run as a complete
zsh command line. This is used by the completion system to decide how to complete after a file
handled by zsh-mime-setup.

pick-web-browser

This function is separate from the two MIME functions described above and can be assigned directly
to a suffix:

autoload -U pick-web-browser
alias -s html=pick-web-browser

It is provided as an intelligent front end to dispatch a web browser. It may be run as either a
function or a shell script. The status 255 is returned if no browser could be started.

Various styles are available to customize the choice of browsers:

browser-style
The value of the style is an array giving preferences in decreasing order for the type of browser to
use. The values of elements may be

running
Use a GUI browser that is already running when an X Window display is available. The browsers
listed in the x-browsers style are tried in order until one is found; if it is, the file will be displayed in
that browser, so the user may need to check whether it has appeared. If no running browser is
found, one is not started. Browsers other than Firefox, Opera and Konqueror are assumed to
understand the Mozilla syntax for opening a URL remotely.

x
Start a new GUI browser when an X Window display is available. Search for the availability of one of

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 601 of 616
:
the browsers listed in the x-browsers style and start the first one that is found. No check is made for
an already running browser.

tty
Start a terminal-based browser. Search for the availability of one of the browsers listed in the tty-
browsers style and start the first one that is found.

If the style is not set the default running x tty is used.

x-browsers
An array in decreasing order of preference of browsers to use when running under the X Window
System. The array consists of the command name under which to start the browser. They are looked
up in the context :mime: (which may be extended in future, so appending ‘*’ is recommended). For
example,

zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror firefox

specifies that pick-web-browser should first look for a running instance of Opera, Konqueror or
Firefox, in that order, and if it fails to find any should attempt to start Opera. The default is firefox
mozilla netscape opera konqueror.

tty-browsers
An array similar to x-browsers, except that it gives browsers to use when no X Window display is
available. The default is elinks links lynx.

command
If it is set this style is used to pick the command used to open a page for a browser. The context is
:mime:browser:new:$browser: to start a new browser or :mime:browser:running:$browser: to open
a URL in a browser already running on the current X display, where $browser is the value matched in
the x-browsers or tty-browsers style. The escape sequence %b in the style’s value will be replaced by
the browser, while %u will be replaced by the URL. If the style is not set, the default for all new
instances is equivalent to %b %u and the defaults for using running browsers are equivalent to the
values kfmclient openURL %u for Konqueror, firefox -new-tab %u for Firefox, opera -newpage %u for
Opera, and %b -remote "openUrl(%u)" for all others.

26.10 Mathematical Functions


zcalc [ -erf ] [ expression ... ]

A reasonably powerful calculator based on zsh’s arithmetic evaluation facility. The syntax is similar
to that of formulae in most programming languages; see Arithmetic Evaluation for details.

Non-programmers should note that, as in many other programming languages, expressions

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 602 of 616
:
involving only integers (whether constants without a ‘.’, variables containing such constants as
strings, or variables declared to be integers) are by default evaluated using integer arithmetic, which
is not how an ordinary desk calculator operates. To force floating point operation, pass the option -f;
see further notes below.

If the file ~/.zcalcrc exists it will be sourced inside the function once it is set up and about to process
the command line. This can be used, for example, to set shell options; emulate -L zsh and setopt
extendedglob are in effect at this point. Any failure to source the file if it exists is treated as fatal. As
with other initialisation files, the directory $ZDOTDIR is used instead of $HOME if it is set.

The mathematical library zsh/mathfunc will be loaded if it is available; see The zsh/mathfunc
Module. The mathematical functions correspond to the raw system libraries, so trigonometric
functions are evaluated using radians, and so on.

Each line typed is evaluated as an expression. The prompt shows a number, which corresponds to a
positional parameter where the result of that calculation is stored. For example, the result of the
calculation on the line preceded by ‘4> ’ is available as $4. The last value calculated is available as
ans. Full command line editing, including the history of previous calculations, is available; the history
is saved in the file ~/.zcalc_history. To exit, enter a blank line or type ‘:q’ on its own (‘q’ is allowed for
historical compatibility).

A line ending with a single backslash is treated in the same fashion as it is in command line editing:
the backslash is removed, the function prompts for more input (the prompt is preceded by ‘...’ to
indicate this), and the lines are combined into one to get the final result. In addition, if the input so
far contains more open than close parentheses zcalc will prompt for more input.

If arguments are given to zcalc on start up, they are used to prime the first few positional
parameters. A visual indication of this is given when the calculator starts.

The constants PI (3.14159...) and E (2.71828...) are provided. Parameter assignment is possible, but
note that all parameters will be put into the global namespace unless the :local special command is
used. The function creates local variables whose names start with _, so users should avoid doing so.
The variables ans (the last answer) and stack (the stack in RPN mode) may be referred to directly;
stack is an array but elements of it are numeric. Various other special variables are used locally with
their standard meaning, for example compcontext, match, mbegin, mend, psvar.

The output base can be initialised by passing the option ‘-# base ’, for example ‘zcalc -#16’ (the ‘#’
may have to be quoted, depending on the globbing options set).

If the option ‘-e’ is set, the function runs non-interactively: the arguments are treated as expressions
to be evaluated as if entered interactively line by line.

If the option ‘-f’ is set, all numbers are treated as floating point, hence for example the expression
‘3/4’ evaluates to 0.75 rather than 0. Options must appear in separate words.

If the option ‘-r’ is set, RPN (Reverse Polish Notation) mode is entered. This has various additional
properties:

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 603 of 616
:
Stack
Evaluated values are maintained in a stack; this is contained in an array named stack with the most
recent value in ${stack[1]}.

Operators and functions


If the line entered matches an operator (+, -, *, /, **, ^, | or &) or a function supplied by the
zsh/mathfunc library, the bottom element or elements of the stack are popped to use as the
argument or arguments. The higher elements of stack (least recent) are used as earlier arguments.
The result is then pushed into ${stack[1]}.

Expressions
Other expressions are evaluated normally, printed, and added to the stack as numeric values. The
syntax within expressions on a single line is normal shell arithmetic (not RPN).

Stack listing
If an integer follows the option -r with no space, then on every evaluation that many elements of the
stack, where available, are printed instead of just the most recent result. Hence, for example, zcalc -
r4 shows $stack[4] to $stack[1] each time results are printed.

Duplication: =
The pseudo-operator = causes the most recent element of the stack to be duplicated onto the stack.

pop
The pseudo-function pop causes the most recent element of the stack to be popped. A ‘>’ on its own
has the same effect.

> ident
The expression > followed (with no space) by a shell identifier causes the most recent element of the
stack to be popped and assigned to the variable with that name. The variable is local to the zcalc
function.

< ident
The expression < followed (with no space) by a shell identifier causes the value of the variable with
that name to be pushed onto the stack. ident may be an integer, in which case the previous result
with that number (as shown before the > in the standard zcalc prompt) is put on the stack.

Exchange: xy
The pseudo-function xy causes the most recent two elements of the stack to be exchanged. ‘<>’ has
the same effect.

The prompt is configurable via the parameter ZCALCPROMPT, which undergoes standard prompt
expansion. The index of the current entry is stored locally in the first element of the array psvar,
which can be referred to in ZCALCPROMPT as ‘%1v’. The default prompt is ‘%1v> ’.

The variable ZCALC_ACTIVE is set within the function and can be tested by nested functions; it has
the value rpn if RPN mode is active, else 1.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 604 of 616
:
A few special commands are available; these are introduced by a colon. For backward compatibility,
the colon may be omitted for certain commands. Completion is available if compinit has been run.

The output precision may be specified within zcalc by special commands familiar from many
calculators.

:norm
The default output format. It corresponds to the printf %g specification. Typically this shows six
decimal digits.

:sci digits
Scientific notation, corresponding to the printf %g output format with the precision given by
digits . This produces either fixed point or exponential notation depending on the value output.

:fix digits
Fixed point notation, corresponding to the printf %f output format with the precision given by
digits .

:eng digits
Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf %E output format with the precision given by
digits .

:raw
Raw output: this is the default form of the output from a math evaluation. This may show more
precision than the number actually possesses.

Other special commands:

:! line...
Execute line... as a normal shell command line. Note that it is executed in the context of the
function, i.e. with local variables. Space is optional after :!.

:local arg ...


Declare variables local to the function. Other variables may be used, too, but they will be taken from
or put into the global scope.

:function name [ body ]


Define a mathematical function or (with no body ) delete it. :function may be abbreviated to :func or
simply :f. The name may contain the same characters as a shell function name. The function is
defined using zmathfuncdef, see below.

Note that zcalc takes care of all quoting. Hence for example:

:f cube $1 * $1 * $1

defines a function to cube the sole argument. Functions so defined, or indeed any functions defined

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 605 of 616
:
directly or indirectly using functions -M, are available to execute by typing only the name on the line
in RPN mode; this pops the appropriate number of arguments off the stack to pass to the function,
i.e. 1 in the case of the example cube function. If there are optional arguments only the mandatory
arguments are supplied by this means.

[# base ]
This is not a special command, rather part of normal arithmetic syntax; however, when this form
appears on a line by itself the default output radix is set to base . Use, for example, ‘[#16]’ to display
hexadecimal output preceded by an indication of the base, or ‘[##16]’ just to display the raw number
in the given base. Bases themselves are always specified in decimal. ‘[#]’ restores the normal output
format. Note that setting an output base suppresses floating point output; use ‘[#]’ to return to
normal operation.

$ var
Print out the value of var literally; does not affect the calculation. To use the value of var, omit the
leading ‘$’.

See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.

min( arg , ...)

max( arg , ...)

sum( arg , ...)

zmathfunc

The function zmathfunc defines the three mathematical functions min, max, and sum. The functions
min and max take one or more arguments. The function sum takes zero or more arguments.
Arguments can be of different types (ints and floats).

Not to be confused with the zsh/mathfunc module, described in The zsh/mathfunc Module.

zmathfuncdef [ mathfunc [ body ] ]

A convenient front end to functions -M.

With two arguments, define a mathematical function named mathfunc which can be used in any
form of arithmetic evaluation. body is a mathematical expression to implement the function. It may
contain references to position parameters $1, $2, ... to refer to mandatory parameters and ${1:-
defvalue } ... to refer to optional parameters. Note that the forms must be strictly adhered to for
the function to calculate the correct number of arguments. The implementation is held in a shell
function named zsh_math_func_ mathfunc ; usually the user will not need to refer to the shell
function directly. Any existing function of the same name is silently replaced.

With one argument, remove the mathematical function mathfunc as well as the shell function
implementation.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 606 of 616
:
With no arguments, list all mathfunc functions in a form The functions have not necessarily been
defined by zmathfuncdef.

26.11 User Configuration Functions


The zsh/newuser module comes with a function to aid in configuring shell options for new users. If
the module is installed, this function can also be run by hand. It is available even if the module’s
default behaviour, namely running the function for a new user logging in without startup files, is
inhibited.

zsh-newuser-install [ -f ]
The function presents the user with various options for customizing their initialization scripts.
Currently only ~/.zshrc is handled. $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc is used instead if the parameter ZDOTDIR is set;
this provides a way for the user to configure a file without altering an existing .zshrc.

By default the function exits immediately if it finds any of the files .zshenv, .zprofile, .zshrc, or .zlogin
in the appropriate directory. The option -f is required in order to force the function to continue. Note
this may happen even if .zshrc itself does not exist.

As currently configured, the function will exit immediately if the user has root privileges; this
behaviour cannot be overridden.

Once activated, the function’s behaviour is supposed to be self-explanatory. Menus are present
allowing the user to alter the value of options and parameters. Suggestions for improvements are
always welcome.

When the script exits, the user is given the opportunity to save the new file or not; changes are not
irreversible until this point. However, the script is careful to restrict changes to the file only to a
group marked by the lines ‘# Lines configured by zsh-newuser-install’ and ‘# End of lines configured
by zsh-newuser-install’. In addition, the old version of .zshrc is saved to a file with the suffix .zni
appended.

If the function edits an existing .zshrc, it is up to the user to ensure that the changes made will take
effect. For example, if control usually returns early from the existing .zshrc the lines will not be
executed; or a later initialization file may override options or parameters, and so on. The function
itself does not attempt to detect any such conflicts.

26.12 Other Functions


There are a large number of helpful functions in the Functions/Misc directory of the zsh distribution.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 607 of 616
:
Most are very simple and do not require documentation here, but a few are worthy of special
mention.

26.12.1 Descriptions

colors

This function initializes several associative arrays to map color names to (and from) the ANSI
standard eight-color terminal codes. These are used by the prompt theme system (Prompt Themes).
You seldom should need to run colors more than once.

The eight base colors are: black, red, green, yellow, blue, magenta, cyan, and white. Each of these
has codes for foreground and background. In addition there are seven intensity attributes: bold,
faint, standout, underline, blink, reverse, and conceal. Finally, there are seven codes used to negate
attributes: none (reset all attributes to the defaults), normal (neither bold nor faint), no-standout, no-
underline, no-blink, no-reverse, and no-conceal.

Some terminals do not support all combinations of colors and intensities.

The associative arrays are:

color
colour
Map all the color names to their integer codes, and integer codes to the color names. The eight base
names map to the foreground color codes, as do names prefixed with ‘fg-’, such as ‘fg-red’. Names
prefixed with ‘bg-’, such as ‘bg-blue’, refer to the background codes. The reverse mapping from code
to color yields base name for foreground codes and the bg- form for backgrounds.

Although it is a misnomer to call them ‘colors’, these arrays also map the other fourteen attributes
from names to codes and codes to names.

fg
fg_bold
fg_no_bold
Map the eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set the corresponding
foreground text properties. The fg sequences change the color without changing the eight intensity
attributes.

bg
bg_bold
bg_no_bold
Map the eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set the corresponding
background properties. The bg sequences change the color without changing the eight intensity
attributes.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 608 of 616
:
In addition, the scalar parameters reset_color and bold_color are set to the ANSI terminal escapes
that turn off all attributes and turn on bold intensity, respectively.

fned [ -x num ] name

Same as zed -f. This function does not appear in the zsh distribution, but can be created by linking
zed to the name fned in some directory in your fpath.

histed [ [ name ] size ]

Same as zed -h. This function does not appear in the zsh distribution, but can be created by linking
zed to the name histed in some directory in your fpath.

is-at-least needed [ present ]

Perform a greater-than-or-equal-to comparison of two strings having the format of a zsh version
number; that is, a string of numbers and text with segments separated by dots or dashes. If the
present string is not provided, $ZSH_VERSION is used. Segments are paired left-to-right in the two
strings with leading non-number parts ignored. If one string has fewer segments than the other, the
missing segments are considered zero.

This is useful in startup files to set options and other state that are not available in all versions of
zsh.

is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS


is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."

nslookup [ arg ... ]

This wrapper function for the nslookup command requires the zsh/zpty module (see The zsh/zpty
Module). It behaves exactly like the standard nslookup except that it provides customizable prompts
(including a right-side prompt) and completion of nslookup commands, host names, etc. (if you use
the function-based completion system). Completion styles may be set with the context prefix
‘:completion:nslookup’.

See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.

regexp-replace var regexp replace

Use regular expressions to perform a global search and replace operation on a variable. POSIX
extended regular expressions (ERE) are used, unless the option RE_MATCH_PCRE has been set, in
which case Perl-compatible regular expressions are used (this requires the shell to be linked against
the pcre library).

var is the name of the variable containing the string to be matched. The variable will be modified
directly by the function. The variables MATCH, MBEGIN, MEND, match, mbegin, mend should be

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 609 of 616
:
avoided as these are used by the regular expression code.

regexp is the regular expression to match against the string.

replace is the replacement text. This can contain parameter, command and arithmetic expressions
which will be replaced: in particular, a reference to $MATCH will be replaced by the text matched by
the pattern.

The return status is 0 if at least one match was performed, else 1.

Note that if using POSIX EREs, the ^ or word boundary operators (where available) may not work
properly.

run-help cmd

This function is designed to be invoked by the run-help ZLE widget, in place of the default alias. See
‘Accessing On-Line Help’ (Utilities) for setup instructions.

In the discussion which follows, if cmd is a file system path, it is first reduced to its rightmost
component (the file name).

Help is first sought by looking for a file named cmd in the directory named by the HELPDIR
parameter. If no file is found, an assistant function, alias, or command named run-help- cmd is
sought. If found, the assistant is executed with the rest of the current command line (everything
after the command name cmd ) as its arguments. When neither file nor assistant is found, the
external command ‘man cmd ’ is run.

An example assistant for the "ssh" command:

run-help-ssh() {
emulate -LR zsh
local -a args
# Delete the "-l username" option
zparseopts -D -E -a args l:
# Delete other options, leaving: host command
args=(${@:#-*})
if [[ ${#args} -lt 2 ]]; then
man ssh
else
run-help $args[2]
fi
}

Several of these assistants are provided in the Functions/Misc your search path, in order to be found
and used by run-help.

run-help-btrfs

run-help-git

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 610 of 616
:
run-help-ip

run-help-openssl

run-help-p4

run-help-sudo

run-help-svk

run-help-svn

Assistant functions for the btrfs, git, ip, openssl, p4, sudo, svk, and svn, commands.

tetris

Zsh was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs, because it lacked a Tetris game. This
function was written to refute this vicious slander.

This function must be used as a ZLE widget:

autoload -U tetris
zle -N tetris
bindkey keys tetris

To start a game, execute the widget by typing the keys . Whatever command line you were editing
disappears temporarily, and your keymap is also temporarily replaced by the Tetris control keys. The
previous editor state is restored when you quit the game (by pressing ‘q’) or when you lose.

If you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of the tetris widget will continue where you
left off. If you lost, it will start a new game.

tetriscurses

This is a port of the above to zcurses. The input handling is improved a bit so that moving a block
sideways doesn’t automatically advance a timestep, and the graphics use unicode block graphics.

This version does not save the game state between invocations, and is not invoked as a widget, but
rather as:

autoload -U tetriscurses
tetriscurses

zargs [ option ... -- ] [ input ... ] [ -- command [ arg ... ] ]

This function has a similar purpose to GNU xargs. Instead of reading lines of arguments from the
standard input, it takes them from the command line. This is useful because zsh, especially with
recursive glob operators, often can construct a command line for a shell function that is longer than
can be accepted by an external command.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 611 of 616
:
The option list represents options of the zargs command itself, which are the same as those of
xargs. The input list is the collection of strings (often file names) that become the arguments of the
command, analogous to the standard input of xargs. Finally, the arg list consists of those
arguments (usually options) that are passed to the command each time it runs. The arg list precedes
the elements from the input list in each run. If no command is provided, then no arg list may be
provided, and in that event the default command is ‘print’ with arguments ‘-r --’.

For example, to get a long ls listing of all non-hidden plain files in the current directory or its
subdirectories:

autoload -U zargs
zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -ld --

The first and third occurrences of ‘--’ are used to mark the end of options for zargs and ls
respectively to guard against filenames starting with ‘-’, while the second is used to separate the list
of files from the command to run (‘ls -ld –’).

The first ‘--’ would also be needed if there was a chance the list might be empty as in:

zargs -r -- ./*.back(#qN) -- rm -f

In the event that the string ‘--’ is or may be an input , the -e option may be used to change the end-
of-inputs marker. Note that this does not change the end-of-options marker. For example, to use ‘..’
as the marker:

zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -ld --

This is a good choice in that example because no plain file can be named ‘..’, but the best end-marker
depends on the circumstances.

The options -i, -I, -l, -L, and -n differ slightly from their usage in xargs. There are no input lines for
zargs to count, so -l and -L count through the input list, and -n counts the number of arguments
passed to each execution of command , including any arg list. Also, any time -i or -I is used, each
input is processed separately as if by ‘-L 1’.

For details of the other zargs options, see the xargs(1) man page (but note the difference in function
between zargs and xargs) or run zargs with the --help option.

zed [ -f [ -x num ] ] name

zed [ -h [ name ] size ]

zed -b

This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 612 of 616
:
Only one name argument is allowed. If the -f option is given, the name is taken to be that of a
function; if the function is marked for autoloading, zed searches for it in the fpath and loads it. Note
that functions edited this way are installed into the current shell, but not written back to the
autoload file. In this case the -x option specifies that leading tabs indenting the function according to
syntax should be converted into the given number of spaces; ‘-x 2’ is consistent with the layout of
functions distributed with the shell.

Without -f, name is the path name of the file to edit, which need not exist; it is created on write, if
necessary. With -h, the file is presumed to contain history events.

When no file name is provided for -h the current shell history is edited in place. The history is
renumbered when zed exits successfully.

When editing history, multi-line events must have a trailing backslash on every line before the last.

While editing, the function sets the main keymap to zed and the vi command keymap to zed-vicmd.
These will be copied from the existing main and vicmd keymaps if they do not exist the first time zed
is run. They can be used to provide special key bindings used only in zed.

If it creates the keymap, zed rebinds the return key to insert a line break and ‘^X^W’ to accept the
edit in the zed keymap, and binds ‘ZZ’ to accept the edit in the zed-vicmd keymap.

The bindings alone can be installed by running ‘zed -b’. This is this will overwrite the existing zed and
zed-vicmd keymaps.

Completion is available, and styles may be set with the context prefix ‘:completion:zed:’.

A zle widget zed-set-file-name is available. This can be called by name from within zed using ‘\ex zed-
set-file-name’ or can be bound to a key in either of the zed or zed-vicmd keymaps after ‘zed -b’ has
been run. When the widget is called, it prompts for a new name for the file being edited. When zed
exits the file will be written under that name and the original file will be left alone. The widget has no
effect when invoked from ‘zed -f’. The completion context is changed to ‘:completion:zed-set-file-
name:’. When editing the current history with ‘zed -h’, the history is first updated and then the file is
written, but the global setting of HISTFILE is not altered.

While zed-set-file-name is running, zed uses the keymap zed-normal-keymap, which is linked from
the main keymap in effect at the time zed initialised its bindings. (This is to make the return key
operate normally.) The result is that if the main keymap has been changed, the widget won’t notice.
This is not a concern for most users.

zcp [ -finqQvwW ] srcpat dest

zln [ -finqQsvwW ] srcpat dest

Same as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively. These functions do not appear in the zsh distribution, but
can be created by linking zmv to the names zcp and zln in some directory in your fpath.

zkbd
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 613 of 616
:
See ‘Keyboard Definition’ (Utilities).

zmv [ -finqQsvwW ] [ -C | -L | -M | -{p|P} program ] [ -o optstring ]

srcpat dest

Move (usually, rename) files matching the pattern srcpat to corresponding files having names of
the form given by dest , where srcpat contains parentheses surrounding patterns which will be
replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest . For example,

zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'

renames ‘foo.lis’ to ‘foo.txt’, ‘my.old.stuff.lis’ to ‘my.old.stuff.txt’, and so on.

The pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern. Any file whose name is not changed
by the substitution is simply ignored. Any error (a substitution resulted in an empty string, two
substitutions gave the same result, the destination was an existing regular file and -f was not given)
causes the entire function to abort without doing anything.

In addition to pattern replacement, the variable $f can be referred to in the second (replacement)
argument. This makes it possible to use variable substitution to alter the argument; see examples
below.

Options:

-f
Force overwriting of destination files. Not currently passed down to the mv/cp/ln command due to
vagaries of implementations (but you can use -o-f to do that).

-i
Interactive: show each line to be executed and ask the user whether to execute it. ‘Y’ or ‘y’ will
execute it, anything else will skip it. Note that you just need to type one character.

-n
No execution: print what would happen, but don’t do it.

-q
Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now assumed by default, so this has no effect.

-Q
Force bare glob qualifiers on. Don’t turn this on unless you are actually using glob qualifiers in a
pattern.

-s
Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.

-v
Verbose: print each command as it’s being executed.
https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 614 of 616
:
-w
Pick out wildcard parts of the pattern, as described above, and implicitly add parentheses for
referring to them.

-W
Just like -w, with the addition of turning wildcards in the replacement pattern into sequential ${1} ..
${N} references.

-C
-L
-M
Force cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the name of the function.

-p program
Call program instead of cp, ln or mv. Whatever it does, it should at least understand the form

program -- oldname newname

where oldname and newname are filenames generated by zmv. program will be split into words, so
might be e.g. the name of an archive tool plus a copy or rename subcommand.

-P program
As -p program , except that program does not accept a following -- to indicate the end of options. In
this case filenames must already be in a sane form for the program in question.

-o optstring
The optstring is split into words and passed down verbatim to the cp, ln or mv command called to
perform the work. It should probably begin with a ‘-’.

Further examples:

zmv -v '(* *)' '${1// /_}'

For any file in the current directory with at least one space in the name, replace every space by an
underscore and display the commands executed.

zmv -v '* *' '${f// /_}'

This does exactly the same by referring to the file name stored in $f.

For more complete examples and other implementation details, see the zmv source file, usually
located in one of the directories named in your fpath, or in Functions/Misc/zmv in the zsh
distribution.

zrecompile

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 615 of 616
:
See ‘Recompiling Functions’ (Utilities).

zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]

This makes defining styles a bit simpler by using a single ‘+’ as a special token that allows you to
append a context name to the previously used context name. Like this:

zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \


+':baz' style2 value2 \
+':frob' style3 value3

This defines style1 with value1 for the context :foo:bar as usual, but it also defines style2 with
value2 for the context :foo:bar:baz and style3 with value3 for :foo:bar:frob. Any subcontext
may be the empty string to re-use the first context unchanged.

26.12.2 Styles

insert-tab

The zed function sets this style in context ‘:completion:zed:*’ to turn off completion when TAB is
typed at the beginning of a line. You may override this by setting your own value for this context and
style.

pager

The nslookup function looks up this style in the context ‘:nslookup’ to determine the program used
to display output that does not fit on a single screen.

prompt

rprompt

The nslookup function looks up this style in the context ‘:nslookup’ to set the prompt and the right-
side prompt, respectively. The usual expansions for the PS1 and RPS1 parameters may be used (see
Prompt Expansion).

This document was generated on May 14, 2022 using texi2html 5.0.
Zsh version 5.9, released on May 14, 2022.

https://zsh-manual.netlify.app/print 6/4/25, 23 38
Page 616 of 616
:

You might also like